65371
The World Bank
Legal Review
Volume 3
Edited by
Hassane Cissé
Daniel D. Bradlow
Benedict Kingsbury
International
Financial
Institutions
and
Global Legal
Governance
The World Bank
Legal Review
Volume 3
The World Bank Legal Review
Volume 3
International Financial Institutions
and Global Legal Governance
The World Bank Legal Review is a publication for policy makers and their advis-
ers, judges, attorneys, and other professionals engaged in the �eld of interna-
tional development with a particular focus on law, justice, and development.
It offers a combination of legal scholarship, lessons from experience, legal de-
velopments, and recent research on the many ways in which the application
of the law and the improvement of justice systems promote poverty reduction,
economic development, and the rule of law.
The World Bank Legal Review is part of the World Bank Law, Justice, and De-
velopment Series managed by the Research and Editorial Board of the World
Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency, composed of Hassane Cissé, Editor in Chief;
Kenneth Mwenda and Alberto Ninio, Co-chairs; Christina Biebesheimer,
Charles di Leva, Laurence Folliot Laulliot, Vikram Raghavan, Vijay Tata, and
Kishor Uprety, Members.
The present volume of The World Bank Legal Review bene�ted from inputs
from members of the World Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency and other units of
the World Bank Group, including Alexis Albion, Luiz Henrique Alcoforado,
Evarist Baimu, Christina Biebesheimer, Anna Chytla, Adrian di Giovanni,
Frank Fariello, Rowena Gorospe, Zoe Kolovou, Siobhan McInerney-Lankford,
Patricia Miranda, Marco Nicoli, Alberto Ninio, Aristeidis Panou, Maurizio
Ragazzi, Vikram Raghavan, Elena Segura, Barry Walsh, and Yesha Yadav. The
preparation of this volume was made possible with the invaluable help of
Paola Scalabrin and Nigel Quinney.
The World Bank
Legal Review
Volume 3
International Financial Institutions
and Global Legal Governance
Hassane Cissé
Daniel D. Bradlow
Benedict Kingsbury
Editors
© 2012 International Bank for Reconstruction and Development / International
Development Association or
The World Bank
1818 H Street NW
Washington, DC 20433
Telephone: 202-473-1000
Internet: www.worldbank.org
1 2 3 4 15 14 13 12 11
This work is a product of the staff of The World Bank with external
contributions. The �ndings, interpretations, and conclusions expressed in
this work do not necessarily reflect the views of The World Bank, its Board
of Executive Directors or the governments they represent.
The World Bank does not guarantee the accuracy of the data included in this
work. The boundaries, colors, denominations, and other information shown on
any map in this work do not imply any judgement on the part of The World
Bank concerning the legal status of any territory or the endorsement or
acceptance of such boundaries.
Rights and Permissions
The material in this work is subject to copyright. Because The World Bank
encourages dissemination of its knowledge, this work may be reproduced, in
whole or in part, for noncommercial purposes as long as full attribution to
this work is given.
For permission to reproduce any part of this work for commercial purposes,
please send a request with complete information to the Copyright Clearance
Center Inc., 222 Rosewood Drive, Danvers, MA 01923, USA; telephone:
978-750-8400; fax: 978-750-4470; Internet: www.copyright.com.
All other queries on rights and licenses, including subsidiary rights,
should be addressed to the Of�ce of the Publisher, The World Bank, 1818 H
Street NW, Washington, DC 20433, USA; fax: 202-522-2422; e-mail:
pubrights@worldbank.org.
ISBN: 978-0-8213-8863-1
e-ISBN: 978-0-8213-8864-8
DOI: 10.1596/978-0-8213-8863-1
Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication data has been requested.
The World Bank
Legal Review
Volume 3
International Financial Institutions
and Global Legal Governance
EDITORS
Hassane Cissé
Deputy General Counsel, Knowledge and Research, World Bank
Daniel D. Bradlow
SARCHI Professor of International Development Law and African Economic
Relations, University of Pretoria, and Professor of Law, American University
Washington College of Law
Benedict Kingsbury
Murry and Ida Becker Professor of Law and Director of the Institute
for International Law and Justice at New York University School of Law;
Visiting Professor of Law, University of Utah
PRODUCTION EDITOR
Aristeidis Panou
Legal Associate, World Bank
Contents
Foreword ix
Robert B. Zoellick, World Bank Group President
Preface xi
Anne-Marie Leroy, Senior Vice President and Group General Counsel
Contributors xii
Introduction: Global Administrative Law in the
Institutional Practice of Global Regulatory Governance 3
Benedict Kingsbury
PART I
LAW OF INTERNATIONAL ORGANIZATIONS: ISSUES CONFRONTING IFIS
The Reform of the Governance of the IFIs: A Critical Assessment 37
Daniel D. Bradlow
Should the Political Prohibition in Charters of International
Financial Institutions Be Revisited? The Case of the World Bank 59
Hassane Cissé
International Financial Institutions and Claims of Private Parties:
Immunity Obliges 93
Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha
Squaring the Concept of Immunity with the Fundamental Right
to a Fair Trial: The Case of the OAS 133
William M. Berenson
Responsibility of International Organizations and the World Bank
Inspection Panel: Parallel Tracks Unlikely to Converge? 147
Evarist Baimu and Aristeidis Panou
Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination: Toward the Emergence
of a Droit Commun in the Field of Development Finance 173
Laurence Boisson de Chazournes
Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption: Agreement
on Cross-Debarment among Multilateral Development Banks 189
Stephen S. Zimmermann and Frank A. Fariello, Jr.
viii The World Bank Legal Review
PART II
LEGAL OBLIGATIONS AND INSTITUTIONS OF DEVELOPING COUNTRIES:
RETHINKING APPROACHES OF IFIS
The Rule of Law and Development: In Search of the Holy Grail 207
Michael Trebilcock
Rethinking Justice Reform in Fragile and Conflict-Affected States:
The Capacity of Development Agencies and Lessons from Liberia
and Afghanistan 241
Deval Desai, Deborah Isser, and Michael Woolcock
International Norms and Standards Applicable to Situations
of State Fragility and Failure: An Overview 263
Chiara Giorgetti
Legal Obligations and Institutions of Developing Countries:
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 293
Annie Petsonk
PART III
INTERNATIONAL FINANCE AND THE CHALLENGES OF
REGULATORY GOVERNANCE
Networks In(-)Action? The Transgovernmental Origins of,
and Responses to, the Financial Crisis 323
Chris Brummer
Mitigating the Impact of Financial Crises on the Brazilian
Capital Market 335
Alexandre Pinheiro dos Santos
Developments in Climate Finance from Rio to Cancun 345
Charlotte Streck and Thiago Chagas
Governing a Fragmented Climate Finance Regime 363
Richard B. Stewart, Bryce Rudyk, and Kiri Mattes
INDEX 391
Foreword
ROBERT B. ZOELLICK
The global �nancial crisis encouraged a major rethinking of our global �nan-
cial architecture, policies, and institutions. But it also reminded us that effec-
tive rule of law, including respect for property rights and access to justice,
remains fundamental for inclusive and sustainable globalization. This was
clearly demonstrated earlier this year: The frustration of a fruit vendor when
his weighing scales were con�scated and he was mistreated by police—which
led him to set himself on �re in public—ignited a �restorm that engulfed Tuni-
sia and the wider Middle East, and led to a demand for justice, rules, and laws
that are fair, predictable, and transparent.
The rule of law is not just a set of rules and their judicial application. As
the third volume of The World Bank Legal Review makes clear in its subtitle,
International Financial Institutions and Global Legal Governance, the law is also
about policy making, institutional frameworks, international politics, devel-
opment, and—ultimately—freedom. The law broadens the scope of the ques-
tions that people ask, and so helps policy makers �nd solutions to complex,
multifaceted problems. To do that effectively, however, legal research and le-
gal practitioners must focus on how the law can support innovative and prag-
matic responses to development challenges.
One such challenge is how we can link international norms with local laws
and customs. For example, today �ghting corruption is a key part of develop-
ment projects and programs. We know that corruption is a drag on economies,
taxes the poor, and strangles opportunity. But anticorruption legislation and
conventions can be effective only if they are linked with the needs of develop-
ing economies and are seen as enabling rather than hampering.
This linkage is particularly important for states affected by fragility and
conflict, which struggle to break free from vicious cycles of violence. Effective
justice and justice administration—both formal justice institutions and local
legal institutions—are key factors in breaking that cycle. Legal research and
legal practitioners need to focus on exploring and promoting the linkages be-
tween the formal justice institutions and local mechanisms.
The law also has a role to play at the microlevel of community-driven
development. Ethiopia, for example, has used intellectual property tools to
renegotiate the distribution and selling arrangements of its coffee production
with multinational enterprises. The results have bene�ted both local farmers
and traders.
ix
x Foreword
Legal research and practice need to identify, and make full use of, the
law’s potential to encourage innovation in the development process and em-
power otherwise marginalized groups so that they can play a key role in de-
velopment interventions. We need to develop a global platform to facilitate
this kind of knowledge exchange in the �eld of law.
I hope that legal practitioners will take up this challenge and invest in a
more innovative use of law for the bene�t of development. The World Bank
Legal Review can be a useful guide.
Preface
ANNE-MARIE LEROY
Even today, the aftershocks of the global �nancial crisis of 2008 continue to be
felt throughout the world. Economists wisely warn us that a global recovery
remains fragile and uneven, and progress needs to be made in dealing with
some of the underlying legal and regulatory failures that led to the crisis in
the �rst place. In addition, the World Bank’s member countries continue to
experience a myriad of other food, �nancial, and economic crises, as well as
natural disasters.
At the same time, demand for World Bank assistance continues to be high,
especially from the poorest countries, which need help to move beyond the
crisis and make progress in their quest for development. In this respect, I am
certain that our legal expertise will continue to play a crucial role in helping
our institution design effective, innovative, and legally sound responses to the
variety of crises faced by our member countries.
However, our legal expertise needs to constantly evolve and be enriched
by the knowledge and experience of outside partners. We need to continue
learning from others, and to let others bene�t from our own experiences.
In particular, given the global and multidisciplinary nature of the crisis, we
would be remiss not to listen to as many different perspectives as possible,
whether from academia, civil society, government, or the private sector.
For this reason, the World Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency greatly values col-
laborative initiatives and openness, and we have strived to forge close links
with institutions around the world. Such North-South and South-South link-
ages are central elements in the broader knowledge creation and exchange
agenda of the Bank, and we will continue to widen and strengthen them.
A variety of perspectives and partnerships can create a critical mass of
thought-provoking and imaginative ideas with the potential to generate new
solutions to the legal problems that confront development.
The third volume of The World Bank Legal Review, subtitled International
Financial Institutions and Global Legal Governance, exempli�es our commitment
to partnerships in the area of knowledge development.
In November 2010, the Legal Vice Presidency held the �rst Law, Justice
and Development Week, “International Financial Institutions in a Post-crisis
World: Legal Challenges and Opportunities.� Organized in close cooperation
with leading law schools and policy institutes, this event took stock of the
xi
xii Preface
role and record of these institutions and analyzed their future, focusing on
their legal mandates, competencies, and operations. The golden strand that
ran through and linked all the discussions and debates was a shared commit-
ment to good governance and the rule of law at national and international lev-
els. While the law should continue to give different actors in the international
community access to globalization, the law should also provide incentives for
good global citizenship, as well as sanctions against those that offend it.
Much of this volume of The World Bank Legal Review consists of contribu-
tions by speakers at the 2010 Law, Justice and Development Week. The volume
examines international �nancial institutions as international organizations
and development agencies, and explores international regulatory governance.
This multiplicity of topics and perspectives has been developed by two dis-
tinguished law professors, Daniel D. Bradlow and Benedict Kingsbury, and
our Deputy General Counsel for Knowledge and Research, Hassane Cissé.
Touching on current and cutting-edge issues, this volume presents incisive
analyses and stimulating recommendations that will interest policy makers,
practitioners, academics, and, indeed, anyone interested in the interplay of
global legal governance and international �nancial institutions.
Contributors
Evarist Baimu is Senior Counsel in the World Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency.
He received his legal education in Tanzania (LL.B. from University of Dar es
Salaam), South Africa (LL.M. and LL.D. from University of Pretoria), and the
United States (LL.M. from Harvard Law School). Before joining the Bank in
2004, Mr. Baimu worked for four years in government, academia, and inter-
national organizations in Dar es Salaam and Pretoria. Since joining the World
Bank, he has worked in various practice groups of the Legal Vice Presidency,
including Operations Policy, Corporate Finance, and Africa.
William M. Berenson is currently Chief of Litigation in the Department of Le-
gal Services of the Secretary General of the Organization of American States,
where he has served in a number of legal positions since 1980, including Gen-
eral Counsel. He is also an adjunct professor at American University’s Wash-
ington College of Law, where since 1984 he has taught a survey course in
United States law for foreign lawyers in the LL.M. international legal studies
program. He has authored articles on a wide range of legal topics, which re-
flect the diversity of his practice. Mr. Berenson received his J.D. from Boston
University (1978). He has both M.A. and Ph.D. degrees in political science
from Vanderbilt University (1972 and 1975) and an A.B. from Dartmouth Col-
lege (1969). He is admitted to the practice of law in the District of Columbia,
Virginia, and Massachusetts.
Daniel D. Bradlow is SARCHI Professor of International Development Law
and African Economic Relations, University of Pretoria, and Professor of Law,
American University Washington College of Law. He is the Chair of the Roster
of Experts for the Independent Review Mechanism at the African Develop-
ment Bank, and is a member of the Executive Council of the American Society
of International Law, the Board of Directors of New Rules for Global Finance
Coalition, and the High Level Panel on Governance of the Financial Stability
Board. His current scholarship focuses on international �nancial institutions,
legal aspects of global economic governance, and international legal aspects of
sustainable and equitable development.
Chris Brummer is an expert in international �nancial regulation whose re-
search interests concern globalization and its impact on �nancial markets
and �nancial market regulation. Prior to joining Georgetown University’s
faculty with tenure in 2009, he was an assistant professor of law at Vander-
bilt Law School. In 2008, he served as the Securities and Exchange Commis-
sion’s �rst Academic Fellow in the agency’s Of�ce of International Affairs.
Professor Brummer lectures widely on �nance and international governance,
as well as on public and private international law, market microstructure, and
xiii
xiv Contributors
international trade. His writings have appeared, or are slated to appear, in
several leading journals. He earned his J.D. from Columbia Law School, where
he graduated with honors, and he holds a Ph.D. in Germanic studies from the
University of Chicago. Before becoming a professor, he practiced law in the
New York and London of�ces of Cravath, Swaine & Moore. In 2011 he joined
the Milken Institute as a Senior Fellow.
Thiago Chagas is a Legal Counsel at Climate Focus. He has provided legal
and regulatory advice on climate �nance to a number of international institu-
tions and governmental and nongovernmental agencies. He has also assisted
many companies in establishing an optimal legal structure for greenhouse gas
mitigation activities, as well as in adjusting to key climate and energy policies.
He holds an LL.B. from Ponti�cia Universidade Catolica de São Paulo and an
LL.M. in international law from the University of Edinburgh.
Hassane Cissé, a national of Senegal, is presently Deputy General Counsel,
Knowledge and Research, of the World Bank. Before holding this position,
he served for six years as Chief Counsel for Operations Policy. Since 2007, he
has been a member of the World Bank’s Sanctions Board. Before joining the
World Bank in 1997, Mr. Cissé served for seven years as Counsel at the Interna-
tional Monetary Fund. He is a member of the World Economic Forum Global
Agenda Council on the Rule of Law and has authored reports and publica-
tions on international economic law topics. Mr. Cissé obtained his LL.B. from
Dakar University in Senegal; he also holds a LL.M. degree from Harvard Law
School, as well as graduate degrees in international law from the universities
of Paris I Panthéon–Sorbonne and Paris II Panthéon–Assas and a graduate
degree in history from Paris I Panthéon–Sorbonne University.
Laurence Boisson de Chazournes is Professor of International Law at the Uni-
versity of Geneva. She was the Director of the Department of International
Law and International Organization from 1999 until 2009. Her areas of exper-
tise include the law of international organizations, international environmen-
tal law, international economic law, and international dispute settlement. She
was a Senior Counsel to the World Bank (1995–99) and is an adviser to various
international organizations, including the World Bank, the World Health Orga-
nization, the United Nations Development Programme, and the International
Labour Organization. She is a member of the Permanent Court of Arbitration’s
list of arbitrators, has served as chairperson of World Trade Organization arbi-
tration panels on pre-shipment inspections, and is counsel in cases before the
International Court of Justice and other dispute-settlement procedures.
Deval Desai is a Research Associate with the Faculty of Law at the School of
Oriental and African Studies (University of London) and an Honorary Fel-
low at the School of Environment and Development at the University of Man-
chester. He was previously a justice and conflict specialist at the World Bank,
where he jointly established the Justice and Conflict Program. His research
encompasses building and strengthening justice institutions in fragile and
conflict-affected states, with a particular emphasis on demand-side account-
ability and on extractive industries in sub-Saharan Africa. He has worked on
Contributors xv
these issues across West Africa (including in Nigeria) and South Asia, with a
focus on building community voice and empowering communities to hold
public and private actors to account. He has published widely on these issues
in a range of academic and policy forums.
Alexandre Pinheiro dos Santos is Attorney General of the Brazilian Securi-
ties Commission (CVM), Professor of Business Law and Capital Market, and
a former lawyer of Rio de Janeiro Stock Exchange. He is also a member of
the Forum of Attorneys General of Brazilian Regulators; Co-Chairman of the
Committee on Emerging Markets Issues, Follow-Up and Implementation of
the Convention on Substantive Rules Regarding Intermediated Securities; and
one of the �ve Vice-Presidents of the Final Session of the Diplomatic Con-
ference for the adoption of the Convention on Substantive Rules Regarding
Intermediated Securities. He coordinated the cooperation agreement between
CVM and the Brazilian Federal Public Prosecutor’s Of�ce, and acted directly
on their joint work in the �rst civil and criminal cases related to insider trad-
ing in Brazil. He has also worked directly for the conclusion of a cooperation
agreement between CVM and the Brazilian Federal Police.
Frank A. Fariello Jr. a graduate of Brown University and New York Univer-
sity School of Law, is currently Lead Counsel, Operations Policy, in the World
Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency (LEG). He is LEG’s primary focal point for the
Bank’s sanctions regime and governance and anticorruption policies. In that
capacity, he coordinated the recent comprehensive reforms of the Bank’s sanc-
tions process and advised INT in connection with the Agreement on Mu-
tual Enforcement of Debarment Decisions among Multilateral Development
Banks. Before joining the Bank in 2005, Mr. Frank worked for nine years at the
International Fund for Agricultural Development (IFAD) as Senior Counsel
and subsequently as Special Advisor to the Vice President. For the �rst ten
years of his career, prior to his service at IFAD, he practiced corporate law,
with an emphasis on international �nancial transactions, at a number of New
York �rms, including Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flor.
Chiara Giorgetti is an Associate at White & Case, LLP (International Arbi-
tration Group) and Adjunct Professor of Law at Georgetown University Law
Center, where she teaches classes on international courts and tribunals and
international transitional justice. Dr. Giorgetti’s work focuses on international
dispute resolution and postconflict issues. Her practice includes states repre-
sentation at the Permanent Court of Arbitration and United Nations Claims
Commission, as well as acting as co-counsel for both claimants and respon-
dents in international investment disputes. She clerked at the International
Court of Justice and worked for the United Nations in New York and Kenya.
She holds a degree in law from Bologna University, an M.Sc. from the London
School of Economics, and an LL.M. and JSD from Yale Law School. She has
written extensively on various aspects of international law. Her book, A Prin-
cipled Approach to State Failure, was published in 2010.
Deborah Isser is Senior Counsel and Global Program Manager of the Justice
for the Poor program (J4P) at the World Bank. J4P promotes the development
xvi Contributors
of legitimate and effective institutions for managing disputes and promoting
equity in development processes, especially in contexts marked by fragility
and legal pluralism. Formerly, she was Senior Rule of Law Advisor at the
United States Institute of Peace, Senior Policy Advisor at the Of�ce of the High
Representative of Bosnia and Herzegovina, and Special Advisor at the United
States Mission to the United Nations. She is the editor of Customary Justice and
the Rule of Law in War-Torn Societies (2011) and author of numerous publica-
tions on justice in fragile and conflict-affected states.
Benedict Kingsbury is Murry and Ida Becker Professor of Law and Director of
the Institute for International Law and Justice at New York University School
of Law (iilj.org), and Visiting Professor of Law at the University of Utah. With
Richard Stewart, Kingsbury initiated and directs the IILJ’s Global Administra-
tive Law Research Project, a pioneering approach to issues of accountability,
transparency, participation, and review in global governance, focused espe-
cially on developing countries. His coedited volumes in that project include
Climate Finance: Regulatory and Funding Strategies for Climate Change and Global
Development (2009) and El nuevo derecho administrativo global en América Latina
(2009). With Kevin Davis and Sally Merry, Kingsbury leads an IILJ project,
Indicators as a Technology of Global Governance, including a forthcoming
book, Governance by Indicators: Global Power through Quanti�cation and Rank-
ings. Kingsbury works also on the history and theory of international law.
Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha has been the General Counsel of the Internat-
ional Fund for Agricultural Development (Rome, Italy) since 2008. He was the
Minister of Justice of the Netherlands Antilles and Minister Plenipotentiary in
the Netherlands Permanent Representation to the European Union. He also
worked as Counsellor in the Legal Department of the International Monetary
Fund and, prior to this, as Legal Advisor of the Central Bank of the Nether-
lands Antilles. Dr. Martha is a Visiting Professor of Law in the NYU@NUS
Programme at the National University of Singapore and was Adjunct Pro-
fessor of Law at the Washington College of Law of the American University.
He has published extensively on international law, including Tax Treatment
of International Civil Servants (2009), The Jurisdiction to Tax in International Law
(1989), and The Legal Foundations of INTERPOL (2010).
Kiri Mattes is currently working as a Senior Solicitor specializing in consti-
tutional law at the New South Wales Crown Solicitor’s Of�ce. She graduated
from the University of Sydney with a Bachelor of Commerce in 2000, an LL.B.
with �rst-class honors in 2002, and a Graduate Diploma of Law in 2009. In 2010
she completed her LL.M. at New York University as an Arthur T. Vanderbilt
Scholar, with a focus in public international law and constitutional law. In
2010–11, she worked as a Fellow at NYU Law’s Global Climate Finance project.
Aristeidis Panou is Legal Associate in the World Bank’s Legal Vice Presi-
dency. He holds degrees from NYU School of Law (LL.M. in international
legal studies) and from the National and Kapodistrian University of Athens
School of Law (LL.B. and LL.M. in public international law).
Contributors xvii
Annie Petsonk is International Counsel with the Environmental Defense
Fund (EDF), an 800,000-member nonpro�t, nonpartisan, nongovernmental
organization that develops innovative, economically sensible, and scienti-
�cally sound solutions to environmental challenges. Ms. Petsonk works to
create legal frameworks that deliver economic incentives for companies, coun-
tries, and communities to cut pollution while they grow their economies. She
has worked in the private bar, the United Nations Environment Programme,
and the administrations of Presidents George H. W. Bush and Bill Clinton, in-
cluding in the Of�ce of the U.S. Trade Representative in the Executive Of�ce of
the President. A graduate of The Colorado College and Harvard Law School,
she has published extensively. At the George Washington University Law
School, she teaches international trade and sustainable development law.
Bryce Rudyk is Coordinator of the Global Climate Finance Project at the
New York University School of Law and Fellow at the Center for Environ-
mental and Land Use Law at New York University School of Law. His research
focuses on the institutional regime for climate �nance. He has previously
worked as a lawyer in transnational litigation.
Richard B. Stewart is University Professor and John Edward Sexton Professor
of Law at New York University School of Law, where he directs the school’s
Center on Environmental and Land Use Law and Global Law School Program.
He has formerly served as Assistant Attorney General for Environment and
Natural Resources, U.S. Department of Justice, and Chairman, Environmental
Defense Fund.
Charlotte Streck is Director of Climate Focus and a former Senior Counsel
with the World Bank in Washington, D.C. Dr. Streck serves as an adviser to
numerous governments, private companies, foundations, and nonpro�t or-
ganizations and is actively involved in the debate around the development
of new carbon �nance mechanisms in the areas of reducing emissions from
deforestation, climate-resilient agriculture, national and international climate
frameworks, and reform of the current Kyoto Mechanisms. She serves on the
Board of the Rainforest Partnership, is an associate editor of Climate Policy, and
is lead counsel for climate change with the Center for International Sustain-
able Development Law with McGill University. She holds a J.D. and Ph.D.
from Humboldt University in Berlin and an M.Sc. from the University of Re-
gensburg, Germany.
Michael Trebilcock is University Professor and Professor of Law and Eco-
nomics at the University of Toronto. In 1999, Professor Trebilcock received an
Honorary Doctorate in Laws from McGill University and was awarded the
Canada Council Molson Prize in the Humanities and Social Sciences. In the
same year, he was elected an Honorary Foreign Fellow of the American Acad-
emy of Arts and Sciences. In 2003, he received an Honorary Doctorate in Law
from the Law Society of Upper Canada and in 2007 he was the recipient of the
Ontario Attorney General’s Mundell Medal for contributions to Law and Let-
ters. In 2010, he was the recipient of the Ontario Premier’s Discovery Award
in the Social Sciences. He has published widely in contract law, economic and
xviii Contributors
social regulation, competition law, international trade law, law and develop-
ment, and immigration law and policy.
Michael Woolcock is Lead Social Development Specialist in the World Bank’s
Development Research Group, where he was worked since 1998. He has been
a visiting fellow at Cambridge University and in 2007–09 he was the founding
Research Director of the Brooks World Poverty Institute at the University of
Manchester, where he was also Professor of Social Science and Development
Policy. He has also taught part-time at the Harvard Kennedy School for many
years. At the World Bank, he has been on two World Development Report teams
(“Poverty� in 2000, and “Equity� in 2005) and is the cofounder of the global
Justice for the Poor program, working on marginalized groups’ engagement
with customary and formal justice systems. He is also the coauthor or coedi-
tor of six books, the most recent being Contesting Development: Participatory
Projects and Local Conflict Dynamics in Indonesia (2011).
Stephen S. Zimmermann is the Director of Operations for the World Bank’s
Integrity Vice Presidency, where he directs a multidisciplinary team charged
with detecting, investigating, sanctioning, and preventing fraud and corrup-
tion in Bank-�nanced activities around the world. He has had a leading role
in developing and implementing an expanded strategy for the World Bank’s
integrity agenda, including the introduction of negotiated resolutions of in-
vestigations and enhancements to the Voluntary Disclosure Program, as well
as leading efforts to reach the historic Cross-Debarment Agreement. Before
joining the World Bank Group, Mr. Zimmermann was the Chief of the Of�ce
of Institutional Integrity for the Inter-American Development Bank and also
served as the interim Chief of Staff for the Independent Inquiry Committee
into the United Nations Oil for Food Program. He was an Assistant United
States Attorney in the District of Maryland from 1991 until 1999, and an at-
torney with Wilmer, Cutler & Pickering from 1987 to 1991.
The World Bank
Legal Review
Volume 3
Introduction
Global Administrative Law in the Institutional
Practice of Global Regulatory Governance
BENEDICT KINGSBURY*
Introduction
Long-term changes in the nature of global political and social order include
the use of increasingly �ne-grained regulatory arrangements intended to over-
come collective action problems and market failures and to take advantage of
global cooperation. Although framing the changes in these politico-economic
terms suggests that the key drivers are the maximization by each actor of
achievement of its own (self-de�ned) interests within the constraints of the
prevailing constellation of power, any global order model must also address
values conflicts and cultural diversity, on the one hand, and the implications
of dramatic but shifting inequalities of power, on the other.
Two long-standing state-based models of global order blending these
considerations provide the framework for standard approaches to interna-
tional law: minimal interstate pluralism and more ambitious and moralistic
interstate solidarism.1 Global regulatory governance (GRG) can be framed as
a third model of global order, dependent on and layered over the existing
models and grappling in distinctive ways with the considerations of power,
value conflicts, and inequality. This introduction surveys some speci�c roles
of law in the emerging GRG model, with particular attention to the present
and future roles of global administrative law (GAL).
GRG involves the increasingly dense and politically signi�cant exercise of
power beyond the state. New understandings of law and its roles are emerg-
ing through the practice of GRG. Several features of GRG have distinctive
legal implications:
• GRG employs an array of distinctive regulatory techniques, including
disclosure and reporting requirements; “reg-neg� negotiations between
the regulator and the regulated entity; use of private monitoring and en-
forcement; peer review; and governance by information. GRG regimes are
often designed to create incentives or costs for private actors even when
the formal legal regime and regulatory structure are interstate. Some
of these techniques seek to shift behavior at the margins, rather than
∗ This chapter reflects close collaboration with Richard B. Stewart and draws on joint work
with Megan Donaldson. Conversations with Danny Bradlow and Hassane Cissé and sug-
gestions from Vikram Raghavan, Aristeidis Panou, Estefania Ponce, and Florencia Leben-
sohn are gratefully acknowledged.
1 Andrew Hurrell, On Global Order (Oxford U. Press 2007). 3
4 The World Bank Legal Review
aiming to change behavior of all regulated entities. Regulation frequently
involves cost-bene�t calculations, not only in rule making but also in the
processes of supervision and in determining consequences of breaches.
Regulation depends on an intricate mesh of institutions, market and polit-
ical forces, social and cultural features, historic experiences, and path de-
pendencies. The relevant institutions and regimes may not be designed or
operated in close coordination—indeed, they may have redundancies or
run in opposing directions, which can create arbitrage opportunities and
problematic externalities, although redundancy and checking structures
sometimes can have positive value. Much regulatory design is premised
on informational uncertainty, the de�nition of tolerable and nontolerable
levels of risk, management of risk, planning for contingencies, and rapid
adaptation. GRG is probabilistic rather than closely determinate. It may
be designed to encourage experimentation rather than uniformity of ap-
proaches, and to foster and incorporate learning through feedback loops,
benchmarking, and revision processes. Regulation, like other governance
arrangements, is dynamic and responsive to interactions and to changes
in external conditions. These elements of regulation are often not captured
in the simple legal binaries of obligation/no obligation, violation/no vio-
lation (or breach/no breach), and liability (or responsibility) vel non. Nor
are they exactly aligned with precepts incorporated into some de�nitions
of rule of law, such as requirements that every comparable case be ad-
dressed in the same way.2
• The organizational forms of the international institutions with signi�cant
roles in GRG are highly diverse, and they vary greatly in the breadth and
publicness of their purposes, membership, reach, and the interests or
expertise they embody. They extend far beyond the range of traditional
treaty-based intergovernmental institutions to include entities that under
traditional analysis are not subjects of international law. Yet many such
entities set formal or informal standards that determine practice and ex-
pectations in markets, and in some cases are incorporated into other sets
of standards or supervisory mechanisms or made binding or cognizable
by formal agreements or national law. Some such entities also exercise
decisional powers, directly or through their participation in other GRG
entities. Many play signi�cant specialist governance roles, for example, in
certi�cation or in generation and control of information. Examples of such
extrastate institutions in global �nancial regulation include,3
2 Michael Trebilcock, The Rule of Law and Development: In Search of the Holy Grail, in this volume,
discusses the model of legal liberalism, according to which rules are made to achieve the
purposes of the society as a whole, not of limited groups within it, and the rules are enforced
equally for all citizens.
3 See the discussion of these actors in Chris Brummer, Networks In(-)Action? The Trans-
governmental Origins of, and Responses to, the Financial Crisis, in this volume.
Global Administrative Law 5
• Formal intergovernmental bodies created by treaties, such as the In-
ternational Monetary Fund (IMF), the World Bank, and the regional
development banks.
• Networks of government or regulatory of�cials in particular sectors,
sometimes with membership that is deliberately restricted by the
founding states to like-minded states they select or to the most impor-
tant states as regards the issues involved.4 Participants may directly
represent the national political leadership, such as in meetings of the
group of 20 (G20) state leaders or governmental ministers, or they
may represent national regulatory agencies with varying degrees of
independence from the national political leadership, such as the Basel
Committee of banking supervisors or regulators, the International
Organization of Securities Commissions, and the International Asso-
ciation of Insurance Supervisors. In some cases, such as the Financial
Stability Board, representatives of other GRG institutions such as the
World Bank and IMF join with national regulators.
• Hybrid bodies involving both public and private actors, such as the
International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) structure, under
which the International Accounting Standards Board, consisting of
private individuals with relevant commercial and professional expe-
rience (including some former regulators), produces the standards
and consults with and reports to a monitoring board comprising pub-
lic capital market authorities whose decisions may be essential if the
IFRS are to be required or accepted from businesses as meeting na-
tional regulatory standards for �nancial reporting.
• Purely private actors, such as the International Swaps and Deriva-
tives Association, which consists of participants in over-the-counter
derivatives markets and associated service providers.
• GRG blends formal and informal instruments in highly varying concoc-
tions. This combination creates many challenges for traditional interna-
tional law analysis. International legal doctrine addresses rules on the
conclusion, entry into force, and legal effects of formal interstate treaties.
In many countries, national law also sets detailed formal requirements
relating to treaties, including approval by the legislature and conditions
for application within the national legal system. But informal instru-
ments used in GRG are made through rule-making processes with few
established legal controls. Such instruments may have substantial practi-
cal effects and sometimes legal effects, for example, when they are incor-
porated by reference into a legal text or weighed by a body exercising a
4 Coalitions of the Willing: Avant-Garde or Threat? (Christian Calliess, Georg Nolte, & Peter-
Tobias Stoll ed., Heymann 2007), particularly Eyal Benvenisti, Coalitions of the Willing and the
Evolution of Informal International Law, 1–24.
6 The World Bank Legal Review
law-governed discretion, yet only sparse international or national legal
doctrines squarely address these effects.5
• Much GRG rule making and decision making takes place within institu-
tions operating under distinctive processes that are largely beyond the
reach of national public law or the traditional law of international orga-
nizations, which has focused mainly on questions of legal competence
or mandate. Even in formal intergovernmental institutions with broad
global or regional membership, the controlling governance arrangements
may be problematic for many states and nonstate groups. These institu-
tions may have tenuous structures of representation of under-represented
states and rules or practices of decision making that date from earlier eras
and do not align with current geopolitical or economic distributions of
power, let alone with demands for justice or equality.6 Efforts to reform
IMF and World Bank governance have sought to respond to some such
concerns, although many critics do not regard the reforms as suf�cient.7
The rapid growth of GRG has posed sharp challenges to traditional inter-
national law, to standard approaches to the law of international organizations,
and to some elements of national legal systems that struggle to grapple with
5 The French Ministry of Foreign Affairs, in its general note on the international engagements
of France issued on May 3, 2010, asserts that administrative arrangements concluded be-
tween ministers of different national governments are not recognized by international law
and ought to be avoided as much as possible because of uncertainty about their effects:
“Les arrangements administratifs conclus par un ministre français avec son homologue
étranger ne sont pas répertoriés dans la base de données documentaire. En effet, il ne s’agit
pas de traités ou d’accords internationaux. Les arrangements administratifs sont conclus
par un ministre avec son homologue étranger pour compléter ou préciser un accord existant
ou, à la rigueur, pour organiser une coopération administrative de portée limitée dans la
stricte limite de ses attributions. Cette catégorie n’est pas reconnue par le droit international.
La circulaire du 30 mai 1997 relative à l’élaboration et à la conclusion des accords inter-
nationaux recommande aux négociateurs français de ne recourir à ce type d’arrangements
qu’exceptionnellement et souligne que les effets qu’ils produisent sont incertains.� Available
at . This statement is somewhat less sanguine than
the view taken in the French Prime Minister’s circular of May 30, 1997, that such agree-
ments can be made on matters entirely within the purview of a single minister but are in
a category unknown to international law. Circulaire du 30 mai 1997 relative à l‘élaboration et Ã
la conclusion des accords internationaux, Journal of�cial de la République Francais 8415 (May
31, 1997), available at . The German
government takes a more favorable approach to the use of such instruments in its Collective
Standing Order for all federal ministries of 2000, §72 Gemeinsame Geschäftsordnung der
Bundesministerien of 2000: “Before the planning and the conclusion of international agree-
ments (international treaties, agreements, interministerial or interagency agreements, notes
and exchanges of letters) the responsible federal ministry must always inquire whether the
conclusion of the international undertaking is indeed required, or whether the same goal
may also be attained through other means, especially through understandings which are
below the threshold of an international agreement.� See Benvenisti, supra note 4.
6 Ngaire Woods, Multilateralism and Building Strong International Institutions, in Global Account-
abilities: Participation, Pluralism, and Public Ethics 27 (Alnoor Ebrahim & Edward Weisband
ed., Cambridge U. Press 2007).
7 Daniel D. Bradlow, The Reform of the Governance of the IFIs: A Critical Assessment, in this
volume.
Global Administrative Law 7
external sources of regulation and regulatory decision making. How does law
�t into a GRG model of global order?
The role of law is modest (although not negligible) in the overall con�gu-
rations of power for GRG, the stocks and flows of resources and capabilities,
and the organizational forms these take, which are key variables determining
who shapes agendas and who gets what in GRG.8 Law contributes apprecia-
bly, but generally only in limited ways, alongside political, economic, social,
and historical factors in explaining why certain institutions exist in the global
administrative space with particular memberships and structures, why these
have the mandates and decision rules they do, and why other institutions,
mandates, or rules do not exist.
Basic legal concepts and principles of a constitutional or systemic nature
play a signi�cant role in instantiating, and to some extent in constituting, inter-
state pluralist and solidarist order. These basic legal concepts and principles of
global order include the juridical conception of the state and its representation
and contracting capacity; core principles of imperium such as the entitlements
of the state to control its territory and monopolize violence there; fundamental
human rights; some emerging principles limiting environmental harm; and
rights relating to dominium, including property rights. Public international
law and national public law together do this legal work in interstate orders.9
In relation to GRG, scholars have proposed that general principles of public
law, or international public law, might play a comparable role,10 but the practi-
cal influence of these proposals has not yet been great.
For purposes of GRG, the roles of law are of rapidly growing importance.
Some of these roles are explicated in work on GAL. This chapter explores spe-
ci�c issues arising for the legal and governance work of intergovernmental
international �nancial institutions (IFIs). It introduces and draws out themes
developed by contributors to this volume of the World Bank Legal Review.11
8 See, for example, Miles Kahler & David Lake, Economic Integration and Global Governance:
Why So Little Supranationalism?, in The Politics of Global Regulation 242 (Walter Mattli & Ngaire
Woods ed., Princeton U. Press 2009).
9 Several relevant international law principles are surveyed in Chiara Giorgetti, International
Norms and Standards Applicable to Situations of State Fragility and Failure: An Overview, in this
volume.
10 The Exercise of Public Authority by International Institutions (Armin von Bogdandy, et al. ed.,
Springer 2010); Benedict Kingsbury, International Law as Inter-Public Law, in Moral Universal-
ism and Pluralism: NOMOS XLIX 167 (Henry R. Richardson & Melissa S. Williams ed., N.Y.U.
Press 2008); Giacinto della Cananea, The Genesis and Structure of General Principles of Global
Public Law, in Global Administrative Law and EU Administrative Law 89 (Edoardo Chiti & Ber-
nardo Mattarella ed., Springer 2011).
11 This volume is based on papers presented and themes discussed at the 2010 Law, Justice and
Development Week, organized by the Legal Vice Presidency of the World Bank and cospon-
sored by several academic institutions, including the Global Administrative Law Network
convened by the Institute for International Law and Justice at New York University Law
School. The website of the Global Administrative Law Project, which includes papers and
symposia, is . Symposia on GAL have been published in 68:(3–4)
L. & Contemp. Probs. (2005); 37(4) N.Y.U. J. Intl. L. & Pol. (2005); 17 Eur. J. Intl. L. 1 (2006). See
8 The World Bank Legal Review
GAL is based on the insight that much of global regulatory governance
can be understood as “administration.� Intergovernmental organizations
and other institutions engage in this activity beyond the reach of controls
imposed by the public law, democratic apparatus, or other review structures
of individual states. The term “administration� in this context encompasses
bureaucratic or routine adjudicative decisions on individual situations short of
major interstate dispute settlement, general rule making short of treaty
making, and other important managerial actions affecting voice and out-
comes—all of which bear a resemblance to what is considered administration
in domestic legal systems. This administrative component of global gover-
nance is undertaken by a wide array of actors.
These actors frequently overlap in their domains of activity, and the regu-
latory processes in which any particular actor is engaged are often influenced
by, and perhaps in tension with, activities of other global (extrastate) institu-
tions and national or subnational institutions. 12 For some purposes, it is distor-
tionary to separate global from national/subnational processes of regulatory
administration. Extranational actors and regimes (both global actors and other
states) shape domestic administrative practices, and domestic actors play a
also Global Administrative Law in the Operations of International Organizations (Laurence Boisson
de Chazournes, Lorenzo Casini, & Benedict Kingsbury ed.), 6 International Organizations L.
Rev. (2009). Books from this project include El Nuevo Derecho Administrative Global en América
Latina (Benedict Kingsbury et al. ed., Ediciones Rap 2009); Global Administrative Law: Devel-
opment and Innovation (Hugh Corder ed., Juta 2009); Climate Finance: Regulatory and Funding
Strategies for Climate Change and Global Development (Richard Stewart, Benedict Kingsbury, &
Bryce Rudyk ed., N.Y.U. Press 2009). The GAL Project, jointly with leading law schools and
research institutes in Africa, Asia, Europe, and Latin America, has convened research and
policy conferences with San Andrés University and the University of Buenos Aires, the Cen-
tre for Policy Research in New Delhi, the University of Cape Town, FGV Law School in São
Paulo, Tsinghua Law School in Beijing, Los Andes University in Bogotá, and the University
of Toronto. Together these institutions form the Global Administrative Network, which has
completed innovative joint research projects on relations between foreign and local anticor-
ruption activities in Brazil and Argentina; access to essential medicines under TRIPS regimes
in Latin America; procedures used by national and supranational competition authorities;
and the Regulatory State of the South (a project on models and experience of water, elec-
tricity and telecommunications regulations in developing countries, directed by Navroz
Dubash and Bronwen Morgan). Publications from these projects are forthcoming; research
reports are at .
12 A modest point on terminology concerns the term “global,� which is frequently used in
GAL to refer to all regulatory or other administrative structures that extend beyond a single
state. In many cases (for example, a binational mutual recognition regulatory arrangement),
this use stretches the ordinary meaning of “global.� However, these regulatory structures
typically do not operate in isolation; they may be part of a network of other comparable
regulatory arrangements, or they may be nested in or influenced by a regional (for example,
Mercosur) or worldwide (such as the WTO GATS) regulatory structure, and the relevant
commercial actors and even consumer or public interest groups involved are often trans-
national. Moreover, many regulatory structures, whether purporting to span the globe or
not, are highly exclusionary, and not “global� in the sense of being inclusive. Nonetheless,
although it can be important to differentiate truly worldwide structures from more local
structures, and to distinguish between more and less inclusive structures, for the purpose
of understanding the exercise of governance power beyond the state, a stretched use of
“global� is practical.
Global Administrative Law 9
role in global and foreign regimes. There thus exists an uneven but discernible
“global administrative space.�13
International institutions have increasingly sought to shore up their le-
gitimacy, and to enhance the effectiveness of their regulatory activities, by
applying to (and between) themselves procedural norms (referred to here as
“GAL norms�) of transparency, participation, reasoned decision making, and
legality, and by establishing mechanisms of review and accountability.14 These
procedural norms and mechanisms resemble, at least in their general orienta-
tion, administrative law as applied to regulatory agencies and other execu-
tive bodies within some national legal systems. GRG institutions frequently
incorporate GAL norms and mechanisms (in varying mixes) when they alter
structures for control and conduct of operations as wider forces of change
reshape the activities and missions of these institutions. The law bearing on
these operational features and dynamics can have considerable signi�cance
for on-the-ground outcomes and for normative evaluation of these institu-
tions (for example, in terms of justice or of political acceptability).
Four forms of legal development prompted by the dynamic requirements
of GRG and the global administrative space are highlighted in this volume.
• The operational law of speci�c intergovernmental institutions. Stretching and
adapting principles of the established law of international organizations,
and crafting newer regulatory modalities and mechanisms, are charac-
teristic of efforts to structure and control the operations of IFIs in GRG
and to meet the intensifying demands for procedural speci�cation of, and
compliance with, the emerging principles of GAL.
• Interinstitutional governance arrangements. Effective GRG depends more
and more on interinstitutional arrangements and structures. The capacity
of intergovernmental institutions to make such arrangements and adapt
their policies and culture to work effectively with other institutions is
one measure of their quality and success. Increasingly, GAL consider-
ations are signi�cant in the crafting and operation of interinstitutional
arrangements.
• Internationally prescribed national administrative law. A third strand of GAL,
in which IFIs are very involved, comprises the norms and mechanisms
that international bodies urge or impose on states as prescriptions for
good administration within the state. Some such norms and mechanisms
are requirements intended to support the state’s adherence to a speci�c
international legal regime; for example, the World Trade Organization
requires states to meet requirements of transparency, notice, and reason
13 Benedict Kingsbury, Nico Krisch, & Richard Stewart, The Emergence of Global Administrative
Law, 68(3–4) L. & Contemp. Probs. 15 (2005). See also Sabino Cassese, Lo spazio giuridico glo-
bale (Laterza 2003).
14 Kingsbury, Krisch, & Stewart, supra note 13; Sabino Cassese, Administrative Law without the
State? The Challenge of Global Regulation, 37 N.Y.U. J. Intl. L. & Pol. 663 (2005); Benedict Kings-
bury, The Concept of “Law� in Global Administrative Law, 20 Eur. J. Intl. L. 23 (2009).
10 The World Bank Legal Review
giving when they restrict trade in goods and services with another state.
Comparable requirements are set for particular states as part of pro-
grammatic obligations of “good governance� or “rule of law� that may be
prescribed as conditions for funding from international development agen-
cies. International organizations promote such norms and mechanisms
through funding, capacity building, and epistemic influences, including
rankings of states based in part on such criteria (for example, the World
Bank’s Governance Indicators and Ease of Doing Business Indicators).15
• New GRG regimes. New or deepened GRG regimes are being crafted in vi-
tal �elds such as �nancial market supervision, forests, and climate regula-
tion. Typically, these new regimes incorporate different mixes of the three
kinds of legal development already mentioned: operations of existing
intergovernmental institutions, interinstitutional arrangements, and in-
ternational standards for coordinated national regulation. But these new
regimes are dependent on behavior in markets as well as other forms of
private conduct. Private and hybrid governance bodies play major roles,
and innovative governance mechanisms and techniques are deployed.
This chapter discusses these four kinds of legal development in the global
administrative space, using the topics covered in this volume of the World
Bank Legal Review as illustrations. Although the relatively new terminology of
“global administrative law� is used in only some of the chapters in this vol-
ume, all can be read through the lens of GAL.
Danny Bradlow, in a critical assessment of what has been achieved and
remains to be achieved in reforms of governance of the World Bank and the
IMF, deploys an evaluative structure that integrates these four kinds of legal
development into a wider set of political-economy dimensions of GRG. He
assesses their governance arrangements in �ve dimensions: “voice and vote�
(decision rules, allocation of voting power, and representation of different
groups of states by executive directors); political requirements that the IMF be
headed by a European and the World Bank by a U.S. national, with further al-
locative arrangements for other senior management positions; accountability
of member states and affected persons and publics; transparency (particularly
disclosure of information publicly); and adequacy of operational policies and
of public consultations in making the arrangements.16 Bradlow proposes a set of
normative criteria to use as metrics in evaluating governance arrangements of
these IFIs: a holistic understanding of development; flexibility of management
arrangements to meet expectations of diverse stakeholders; implementation
of relevant international law principles (respect for national sovereignty; non-
discrimination, including special attention to participation of low-capacity
states; ensuring respect for customary international law human rights and
15 Kevin Davis, Benedict Kingsbury, & Sally Engle Merry, Indicators as a Technology of Global
Governance, IILJ Working Paper 2010/2 Rev. (Jul. 2011).
16 Bradlow, supra note 7. See also the contributions to International Financial Institutions and In-
ternational Law (Daniel Bradlow & David Hunter ed., Kluwer Law International 2010).
Global Administrative Law 11
rights of foreign legal persons; respect for international environmental law);
adequate and meaningful coordination with other relevant institutions; and
adherence to GAL principles in operations. These criteria integrate a substan-
tive standard (a holistic approach to development), basic principles of interna-
tional law, a management standard concerning suppleness and effectiveness,
and two criteria to which GAL is directly relevant: GAL within the IFI and
interinstitutional arrangements. One might argue the addition of a further cri-
terion concerning relations between IFI governance and approaches the IFI
takes and promotes toward governance issues (including GAL issues) within
member states. Thus, it might be asked, can the governance arrangements of
the World Bank and the IMF contribute to the advancement within states of
human rights, environmental standards, and equity and nondiscrimination in
development; policies and practices of governmental transparency and anti-
corruption; or enumerated features of rule of law, good governance, or demo-
cratic national governance?
Each of these issues is either addressed as an objective or deliberately not
addressed in poverty reduction strategy papers (PRSPs) negotiated jointly by
the World Bank and the IMF with recipient countries.17 What requirements are
set in each PRSP, and what processes of participation and consultation within
the country were required in order for the country to be deemed in negotiat-
ing the PRSP to have taken “national ownership� of it, may in some measure
reflect governance processes within the World Bank and IMF.
Adapting Traditional International Organizations Law to
Contemporary Operations of GRG Institutions: The Political
Prohibition, Mandate, Immunities, Review, and Responsibility
Adaptation, stretching, and even reconstruction of existing concepts in the tra-
ditional law of international organizations have been the dominant strategy of
IFI lawyers as they deal with changes generated by GRG and demands for ad-
herence to GAL principles. The long-established concepts of the law of inter-
national organizations subject to these processes include the “political prohi-
bition� applicable to some IFIs, more general mandate issues connected with
the “principle of speciality,� the law of immunities, and the law of responsibil-
ity. Whether these traditional concepts for mobilizing, channeling, limiting,
controlling, and legitimizing the power of intergovernmental institutions are
suf�cient for functional GRG or to meet GAL requirements is questionable.
Newer legal strategies include structures of review, principles of accountabil-
ity (or “soft responsibility�), and the coalescing of substantive and procedural
policies into what may become a droit commun for specialist institutions or
part of a more general law of global governance.
17 For a critical assessment, see Celine Tan, Governance through Development: Poverty Reduction
Strategies, International Law and the Disciplining of Third World States (Routledge 2011).
12 The World Bank Legal Review
The Political Prohibition
The powers and mandate conferred on an organization by its constitutive in-
struments are the basis for its action and for limiting its action, but these can
be subject to extension through the legal doctrines of inherent and attributed
and implied powers,18 through creative interpretation of the mandate,19 and
through practice as supported by or acquiesced to by member states or other
relevant actors.20
The political prohibition (a categorical term for a highly variegated prac-
tice) in the World Bank’s Articles of Agreement raises a concern regarding
mandates. The articles specify that the Bank “shall not interfere in the political
affairs of any member [state],� and that “only economic considerations shall be
relevant� to its decisions. These principles are accompanied by other mandate-
related restrictions, such as that the Bank �nance only expenditures for “pro-
ductive purposes,� and by limits on the substantive mandates of the various
organizations of the World Bank Group. The ways in which the political prohi-
bition and the other restrictions have worked are analyzed in Hassane Cissé’s
account of how lines are drawn and adjusted in speci�c policy areas.21
For example, with its adoption of OP 7.30 (2001), the Bank can consider
attitudes of regional organizations in deciding on its �nancial dealings with a
government that came to power through a military coup or other unconstitu-
tional means; this consideration has enabled the Bank to avoid undermining
prodemocratic norms such as those of the Inter-American Democratic Charter
of 2000 or the African Charter on Democracy, Elections and Governance of
2007,22 without itself articulating a prodemocratic or even an anticoup nor-
mative stance. The Bank has pursued the policy articulated in OP 2.30 (1997)
of not �nancing peacemaking, peacekeeping, and humanitarian relief, but it
has delicately nuanced its practice in order to support some activities related
to peace processes (for example, making presentations to delegates to peace
negotiations in Burundi and Sierra Leone in 1999). The Bank continues not
to �nance military expenditures, but it has assisted with demobilization and
landmine clearance projects. Its long-standing refusal to �nance criminal jus-
tice projects, on the basis that these might involve political activities, is grad-
ually being eased, with ongoing debate as to �nancing police, prosecutors,
and prisons, but the Bank likely will not �nance speci�c actions against ter
18 Jan Klabbers, An Introduction to International Institutional Law ch. 4 (2d ed., Cambridge U.
Press 2009).
19 Rutsel Martha, Mandate Issues in the Activities of the International Fund for Agricultural Develop-
ment (IFAD), 6 International Organizations L. Rev. 447 (2009).
20 Jan Klabbers, Global Governance before the ICJ: Re-reading the WHA Opinion, 13 Max Planck
Yearbook of United Nations Law 1 (2009).
21 Hassane Cissé, Should the Political Prohibition in Charters of International Financial Institutions
be Revisited? The Case of the World Bank, in this volume.
22 Alison Duxbury, The Participation of States in International Organisations: The Role of Human
Rights and Democracy (Cambridge U. Press 2011).
Global Administrative Law 13
rorism and crimes of state. Its articulated positions on taking account of hu-
man rights considerations have become more permissive, but without a major
cultural shift or a comprehensive human rights policy.23 The Bank partners
with donors who set political conditions for recipients, such as the inclusion
of marginalized groups, but it does not join these partners in threatening to
withhold funds for breach of such conditions, and it seeks humanitarian or
other exemptions in UN sanctions so as not to face dilemmas about whether
to honor such sanctions. The Bank supports anticorruption measures, includ-
ing recovery of proceeds of corruption from other countries, but it does not
�nance work on individual cases.
All this line drawing operates as a shield for the Bank and its staff against
pressures from borrowing states and their allies, other donors, nongovern-
mental organizations (NGOs), and national legislatures. It may help retain the
con�dence of lenders to the Bank, it may improve the effectiveness of the Bank
by narrowing its focus, and it may boost the professional self-esteem of Bank
staff and their sense of having a mission that is insulated from politics. Yet, the
question can be asked whether the evidence for (or against) such results from
the political prohibition is conclusive. (The European Bank for Reconstruc-
tion and Development may provide informative counterpoint experiences,
because its constitutive instruments do not include any political prohibition,
but the European regional context makes it a special case.) There is a risk of
decoupling when some parts of the Bank’s processes, such as the reduction of
lending to India and Pakistan after they inducted nuclear weapons into their
arsenals in 1998, are readily construed by commentators as the Bank being
brought into interstate geopolitics.
Even in more quotidian work, much of what the IFIs do within their own
rules can be characterized as highly political and open to denunciation. How-
ever, the drawing, nudging, and redrawing of the lines are themselves a sig-
ni�cant form of governance. Such actions may empower IFI legal counsels;24
but, from a broader legal standpoint, they constitute a law-based governance
with some connection to principles and rules, and require some reason giving
and internal review and contestation.
A case for the value of law-based governance is made in the account given
by a former IMF lawyer of what he considered improvements in outcomes
that resulted from IMF staff adhering to policies. These included the IMF’s
insistence that if it was to be involved in anti-money-laundering assessments,
these assessments must be applied to all countries on the basis of preset stan-
dards and methodologies, effectively bringing to an end the Financial Action
Task Force strategy of evaluating nonmember states and denouncing some of
23 Galit Sarfaty, Why Culture Matters in International Institutions: The Marginality of Human Rights
at the World Bank, 103 Am J. Intl. L. 647 (2009).
24 Cf. Treasa Dunworth, The Legal Adviser in International Organizations: Technician or Guardian?,
46 Alberta L. Rev. 869 (2009).
14 The World Bank Legal Review
them as “noncooperating countries and territories� who were then potentially
subject to sanctions from member states.25
Mandate
The main control mechanisms for the political prohibition, as for other man-
date restrictions in most intergovernmental institutions, are the intergovern-
mental organs such as the institution’s executive board or general assembly,
and the legal counsel; these bodies may be prompted to act, or be assertively
augmented, by legal arguments or unilateral policies made by governments of
particular member states. National courts have addressed mandate issues in
cases directly involving intergovernmental institutions, such as in rulings that
functional immunity is not available to an organization because it has acted
outside its mandate.26 A few international institutions, including regional or-
ganizations such as the European Union, have their own courts with powers
of judicial review. Mandate issues may arise collaterally in national or interna-
tional courts, typically in cases to which the institution is not itself a party.27
The International Court of Justice (ICJ, and its predecessor, the Permanent
Court of International Justice) has addressed some questions concerning the
powers of international organizations in global regulatory governance. No-
table was the announcement by the ICJ of a new framing of a principle of
speciality, according to which the responsibilities of the World Health Orga-
nization (WHO) could not be extended (in the absence of an express textual
commitment in its mandate) to peace and security because this would “en-
croach on the responsibilities of other parts of the United Nations system.�28
The ICJ’s opinion in this case was self-enforcing, as the only immediate legal
consequence was that the WHO could not get an opinion from the ICJ on
the question it had asked, relating to whether the use of nuclear weapons by
a state in armed conflict would be a breach of the state’s obligations under
international law. If the ICJ’s principle of speciality were to be ampli�ed into
a major principle of the law of GRG, it would have signi�cant consequences,
including for IFIs. Its bene�ts in curbing wasteful duplication and overexten-
sion may be dif�cult to capture without generating other, larger problems.
25 Richard Gordon, On the Use and Abuse of Standards for Law: Global Governance and Offshore
Financial Centers, 88 N.C. L. Rev. 502, 577–84, 588 (2010).
26 In INTERSIDE v. Ministerio de Agricultura y SecretarÃa Ejecutiva del Convenio Andrés Bello, Sala
de lo Contencioso Administrativo del Consejo de Estado (Mar. 26, 2009), the Colombian
Council of State denied functional immunity to the Convenio Andrés Bello (an intergovern-
mental institution) in a contract case on the basis that the purposes stated in its charter did
not even remotely include administering government-�nanced agricultural subsidies.
27 Such issues have been raised in interstate cases under the ICJ’s contentious jurisdiction, for
example in the Lockerbie cases (Libya v. UK; Libya v. USA), ICJ Reports 1992 p. 3 and p. 114,
with regard to the powers of the UN Security Council.
28 Legality of the Use by a State of Nuclear Weapons in Armed Conflict, Advisory Op., 1996 I.C.J.
Reports, paragraph 26. See generally Klabbers, supra note 20.
Global Administrative Law 15
Overlapping mandates and competences are a feature of the increasingly
dense institutionalization of GRG. Although the concept of a functional de-
lineation under which one global organization exists for each �eld of activity
is attractive, GRG is not organized in such a way. Much of the architecture of
GRG is pluralist by design; for example, the Cartagena Protocol to the Biodi-
versity Convention of 1992 purposefully created a second normativity, more
accommodating of public anxieties about genetically modi�ed foods, that
weakened the exclusivity of WTO Sanitary and Phyto-Sanitary rules on this
issue.29 Powerful states encountering obstacles to the pursuit of their objectives
(including interests of particular private sector constituencies) on a particular
topic within one institution may expand the range and reach of another insti-
tution in which the set of members or the decision rules or the culture is more
favorable.30 They may create new treaty-based intergovernmental institutions,
as is likely to happen in the development of a climate �nance regime, although
political objections to the cost, cumbersomeness, and potential intractabil-
ity of new formal intergovernmental institutions have been a brake on the
drivers for such institutionalization. States may instead create intergovern-
mental network institutions, or support hybrid public-private institutions, or
leave the terrain to privately constituted institutions of global governance in
which states play signi�cant roles.
Immunity and Remedies
The issue of increased judicial review of GRG institutions, particularly formal
intergovernmental institutions, arises when considering whether intergov-
ernmental organizations should have immunity before national courts and
what legal forums should be available for persons seeking remedies against
intergovernmental organizations. The stakes can be high, as in proceedings
in Swiss courts seeking to force the Bank for International Settlements, which
since the 2000–2001 Argentine �nancial crisis had come to hold a high pro-
portion (reportedly reaching 99 percent) of Argentina’s total foreign reserves,
to make available funds to satisfy monetary awards secured by bondholders
against Argentina.31
Intergovernmental organizations’ legal counsel tend to favor sweeping
immunities for their organizations and personnel in national courts. Most rec-
ognize that a quid pro quo for immunity is that the institution ensures that
alternative venues are available in which claims against the organization can
be brought and fairly adjudicated and remediated. This formalized bargain—
for claims by third parties and staff—is embodied in the 1994 Headquarters
29 Nico Krisch, Beyond Constitutionalism: The Pluralist Structure of Postnational Law 189–220 (Ox-
ford U. Press 2010).
30 Eyal Benvenisti & George Downs, The Empire’s New Clothes: Political Economy and the Frag-
mentation of International Law, 60 Stanford L. Rev. 595 (2007).
31 NML Capital Ltd, EM Limited v. Bank für Internationalen Zahlungsausgleich (BIZ), (Swiss
Federal Tribunal, Basel), Jul. 12, 2010, upholding immunity, and subsequent developments.
16 The World Bank Legal Review
Agreement between the United States and the Organization of American
States (OAS).32 The OAS has absolute immunity from suit and execution
in U.S. courts, but must provide arbitration for any claims not within the
jurisdiction of its Administrative Tribunal (which deals largely with claims
by staff).33 Even when no explicit agreement has been made, many interna-
tional organizations have strengthened the due process qualities and remedies
powers of staff administrative tribunals, partly under the shadow of national
courts that have threatened to deny immunity to international organizations
in employment-related cases brought by staff members.34
Most international organizations also provide for arbitration of contractual
disputes with private parties. Much weaker, however, are their provisions and
policies in relation to third-party claims, that is, noncontract claims by nonstaff.35
Although some such claims are arbitrated by agreement or settled by negotia-
tion, international civil servants face dif�culties in committing an organization
to binding arbitration or to making �nancial settlements in the absence of a le-
gal obligation to do so. It can be dif�cult to persuade interstate organs to enter-
tain such expenditures. A commitment to binding arbitration of all third-party
claims could entail exposure to huge �nancial risks and might have a chilling
effect on the activities of the organization, especially in risky settings. Adequate
insurance of such risks ensures �nancial predictability and that recalcitrance or
grandstanding by member states will not block payment of liabilities. Prohi-
bitions of punitive damages in the arbitrations, ceilings on awards, and some
limits to the range of arbitrable claims can all help cabin such risks.36
32 William M. Berenson, Squaring the Concept of Immunity with the Fundamental Right to a Fair
Trial: The Case of the OAS, in this volume.
33 The US-OAS agreement may be compared, as Martha suggests, with an agreement between
Interpol and France. Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, International Financial Institutions and Claims
of Private Parties: Immunity Obliges, in this volume. Interpol, the International Criminal Police
Organization, reached a similar arrangement with the French government in 1982 over Inter-
pol’s exemption from laws on databases otherwise applicable in France. Interpol established
a Commission on the Control of Files (CFF), which receives and potentially acts on petitions
by individuals who believe data held about them in Interpol databases is erroneous, or that
Interpol should not have issued a “red notice� asking other countries to arrest that person
as requested by the police of a member state. Mario Savino, Global Administrative Law Meets
“Soft� Powers: The Uncomfortable Case of Interpol Red Notices, 43 N.Y.U. J. Intl. L. & Pol. 263
(2011); Allan Brewer-CarÃas, Global Administrative Law on International Police Cooperation: A
Case of Global Administrative Law Procedure, in Global Administrative Law: Towards a Lex Admin-
istrativa 341 (Javier Robalino-Orellana & Jaime RodrÃguez-Arana Muñoz ed., Cameron 2010);
Wui Ling Cheah, Policing Interpol: The Commission for the Control of Interpol’s Files and the Right
to a Remedy, 7 International Organizations L. Rev. 375 (2010). The most controversial disputes
concerning red notices, such as those relating to a leader of the Kazakhstan opposition or to
prominent Iranian of�cials accused by Argentine authorities of involvement in bombings
in Buenos Aires, have been addressed, not in the CFF, but in the Executive Committee and
General Assembly of Interpol (Savino, 301–21).
34 Martha, supra note 33, discusses cases in European and Argentine courts, as well as a per-
plexing decision of a court in Dacca, Bangladesh. Berenson, supra note 32, adds discussion of
several cases in Brazilian and U.S. courts.
35 Martha, supra note 33.
36 Berenson, supra note 32.
Global Administrative Law 17
If sweeping immunities from national jurisdiction and enforcement are as
essential to the operation of intergovernmental institutions as their legal coun-
sel suggest, one may wonder how private and hybrid institutions are able to
exercise signi�cant powers in global governance without the bene�ts of such
immunity. Some private institutions do have immunity, for example, the In-
ternational Committee of the Red Cross (ICRC). The Global Fund to Fight TB,
HIV/AIDS, and Malaria, although constituted as a private foundation under
Swiss law, has immunity in Switzerland, where it is based, and in the United
States, where its funds are mainly held, and it has undertaken an energetic
campaign to be accorded immunities in other countries. The ICRC and the
Global Fund are comparable to major intergovernmental institutions in some
functional respects: they engage in activities that might risk liability and oper-
ate all over the world, often in dangerous conditions and in countries where
judicial or state power might be exercised arbitrarily. Nonetheless, most ma-
jor private and hybrid operational and standard-setting institutions operate
without generalized immunity arrangements. Detailed empirical studies of
the consequences of different regimes of immunity and nonimmunity for par-
ticular kinds of operations of speci�c types of institutions may make a valu-
able contribution to future policy and practice.
Responsibility, Accountability, and Review
The principle that intergovernmental institutions are responsible for breaches
of rules of international law applicable to them, along with the related prin-
ciple that these institutions are liable to victims for harm caused by their
breaches of such rules, has achieved considerable prominence with the efforts
of the UN International Law Commission (ILC) to codify the legal elements of
such responsibility. The ILC draft has been the subject of academic criticism,
as well as submissions by international institutions eager to clarify limits to
their exposure, as exempli�ed by the World Bank’s request that the ILC clarify
limits on responsibility arising from the provision to a state of �nancial as-
sistance.37 The extensive literature on this form of legal responsibility of in-
tergovernmental institutions is out of proportion to the amount of practice of
such responsibility, which remains modest for most institutions other than in
employment and contract matters or preset arrangements, such as compensa-
tion for death or injury of personnel in UN peacekeeping operations.
The normative demands that have accompanied GRG, including demands
framed in terms of GAL principles and procedures, have prompted explora-
tion in the practice of GRG institutions of review mechanisms with distinc-
tive rules and practices concerning participation, transparency, and remedies.
37 ILC, Responsibility of International Organizations: Comments and Observations Received
from International Organizations, at 28, UN Doc. A/CN.4/637 (Feb. 14, 2011). This and
other comments and criticisms relating to the ILC draft articles are noted in Evarist Baimu
& Aristeidis Panou, Responsibility of International Organizations and the World Bank Inspection
Panel: Parallel Tracks Unlikely to Converge? in this volume.
18 The World Bank Legal Review
These are associated with extension of (or sidestepping from) issues of man-
date and responsibility to broader concepts of accountability.38
The term �accountability� is used in many different ways in political dis-
course and academic writing,39 and is often underspeci�ed for any operational
purpose. Richard B. Stewart proposes that the term be con�ned to
institutionalized mechanisms under which an identi�ed account
holder has the right to obtain an accounting from an identi�ed ac-
countor for [the accountor’s] conduct, evaluate that conduct, and im-
pose a sanction or obtain another appropriate remedy for de�cient
performance. . . . Such mechanisms are of two basic types. The �rst is
where the account holder delegates or grants authority or resources
to the accountor; it includes electoral, �scal, hierarchical, and super-
visory accountability mechanisms. The second is legal accountabil-
ity, where the account holder seeks redress for infringement by the
accountor of [the account holder’s] legally protected interests.40
The World Bank Inspection Panel, although clearly a mechanism of re-
view, is not so clearly on its own a mechanism of accountability under Stew-
art’s de�nition. The Bank’s Executive Board must approve a full inspection of
a Bank project. The Inspection Panel has powers in relation to management-
proposed remedial action plans, but these powers depend on the Board; the
Inspection Panel cannot impose remedies or sanctions on the Bank’s man-
agement other than naming and shaming (although for individual staff, that
prospect can operate as a strong and potentially disproportionate sanction).
When combined with the Bank’s Executive Board, however, the panel can be
viewed as a composite accountability mechanism vis-Ã -vis management. The
accountor is the Bank’s management. The account holders are those persons
or groups who trigger the inspection request and are able to participate in the
panel’s investigation and in any remedial arrangements made.
What are the parallels and divergences between the Inspection Panel’s
mandate and practice and the principles of responsibility set forth by the
International Law Commission?41 The panel investigates actions or omis-
sions of the Bank that are inconsistent with Bank policies. Because of the
38 A thoughtful analysis of the genesis, features, and limitations in relation to international
organizations of different approaches to responsibility and accountability is provided by Jan
Klabbers, Autonomy, Constitutionalism and Virtue in International Institutional Law, in Interna-
tional Organizations and the Idea of Autonomy: Institutional Independence in the International Legal
Order 120 (Richard Collins & Nigel D. White ed., Routledge 2011).
39 Some of the different usages are reviewed in Mark Bovens, Two Concepts of Accountability:
Accountability as a Virtue and as a Mechanism, 33 West European Politics 946 (2010).
40 Richard B. Stewart, Accountability, Participation, and the Problem of Disregard in Global Reg-
ulatory Governance 5 (unpublished draft of Jan. 2008, subject to revision). Electoral, �scal,
hierarchical, supervisory, and legal accountability are among the eight categories speci�ed
in Ruth W. Grant & Robert O. Keohane, Accountability and Abuses of Power in World Politics,
99 Am. Pol. Sci. Rev. 29 (2005).
41 This question is creatively posed and addressed by Baimu & Panou, supra note 37. This para-
graph summarizes arguments they make.
Global Administrative Law 19
way Bank policies are written, with Bank staff as addressees, the panel is un-
likely to investigate actions or omissions of the Board, or indeed of itself (quite
apart from the improbability of such an investigation being proposed or au-
thorized). As Evarist Baimu and Aristeidis Panou point out, the primary rules
(here, the Bank’s policies) set a narrower limit on the actors whose conduct is
actually investigated than do the ILC’s rules on attribution, under which the
acts or omissions of the Board of Governors and the Executive Board as well
as different units of Bank management could all entail responsibility of the
Bank. The obligations in relation to which the panel can investigate breaches
are the Bank’s policies. The panel does not generally have jurisdiction to ad-
dress any other primary rules of international law that a project may infringe,
many of which would be rules applicable to the borrowing state, although
some may be rules applicable to the Bank. However, some such rules may be
made relevant by the terms of the Bank’s policies, and the panel has in some
cases found other bases to treat such rules as relevant.42 The panel is able to
investigate Bank action or inaction in situations where the Bank would not
bear responsibility under the ILC draft articles (because, for example, only the
borrowing state is responsible). But the panel can only investigate where harm
has occurred or will occur,43 and its investigations do not necessarily result in
remedies that are the same as what the responsibility regime would theoreti-
cally entail.
The creation of mechanisms of investigation and review within intergov-
ernmental institutions in response to the dynamics of GRG may be related not
only to responsibility but also to other traditional public international law doc-
trines, such as immunity. For example, Ibrahim Shihata, while general counsel
of the World Bank, emphasized that the reports of the World Bank Inspection
Panel, even if highly critical of particular Bank conduct, were unlikely to be
used in evidence in cases against the Bank in national courts because of the
Bank’s immunity.44 It seems plausible that investigative mechanisms, espe-
cially those that produce detailed and reasoned reports made widely available
under a principle of transparency, are more likely to be established or to oper-
ate effectively when the IFI creating the mechanism is largely shielded from li-
ability. Thus, immunity may make possible the increased use of investigation,
review, transparency, and some other GAL procedures within IFIs.
Operational Policies and Other Normative Instruments for GRG
GAL comprises some “hard law� obligations (including in international trea-
ties and the juridical output of international organizations) and a body of more
42 Baimu & Panou, supra note 37, point to the Chad Petroleum Development and Pipeline Project
case (2002), and the Honduras—Land Administration Project case (2007).
43 In theory, the harm must be caused by the Bank’s failures to follow its own policies; but the
panel has in practice moved away from treating this nexus as a requirement for investigation
or remediation.
44 Ibrahim Shihata, The World Bank Inspection Panel: In Practice 243–53 (2d ed., Oxford U. Press
2000).
20 The World Bank Legal Review
general normative principles, many of which mirror requirements and quali-
ties set by domestic administrative law. The hard international law obligations
tend to be most developed in speci�c areas, particularly trade, investment,
and environmental law, and to apply primarily to states and state agencies
engaging in functions pursuant to global regimes rather than to international
institutions themselves.
More general normative principles emerge reflexively from practice, often
prompted by contestation of an institution’s authority or legitimacy and bor-
rowing from other institutions or domestic administrative law traditions. The
World Bank’s 2010 reform of its transparency arrangements is an example of
this process. One of the main motivations for reform appears to have been
long-standing criticism from NGOs, including the Global Transparency Ini-
tiative (GTI), an alliance formed to press for greater transparency in the IFIs,
coupled with a sense within the Bank that its own protocols fell short of what
it urged on client countries. The Bank issued a draft policy and embarked on
consultations, relying on NGO interlocutors to help organize this outreach,
and reprinting a “scorecard� prepared by the GTI rating different IFIs as “ac-
ceptable,� “needs improvement,� or “unacceptable� based on principles of
access to information. During the policy redrafting, Bank of�cials declined to
articulate transparency as a human right, a position the NGOs urged on them,
but in some consultations, of�cials did say that they understood the Bank as
a “public institution� and had drawn on state freedom of information policies
in approaching questions of institutional transparency. Once the broad Access
to Information Policy was adopted, the Bank promoted it extensively. NGOs
proclaimed the World Bank as a “leader� on transparency and inaugurated a
campaign to spread these new, more extensive transparency mechanisms to
other IFIs. Moreover, the Bank’s reformed policy, inspired by domestic free-
dom of information laws, extends to information that client countries share
with the World Bank when doing business with it.
The World Bank and the various regional development banks have
adopted broadly similar sets of operational policies and supervisory mecha-
nisms. This cross-institutional normativity might eventually assume qualities
of a droit commun.45 The mechanisms by which policy convergence and insti-
45 Laurence Boisson de Chazournes, Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination: Toward the Emer-
gence of a Droit Commun in the Field of Development Finance, in this volume. The evidence for
the World Bank as �rst mover is strong in some cases. For example, the World Bank’s Inspec-
tion Panel, created in 1993, was the �rst independent accountability mechanism (IAM); by
2010, all multilateral development banks had IAMs in some form, although with differences
in design and powers (Bradlow, supra note 7). However, the IMF does not have an IAM; nor
do many other international organizations whose operations directly affect vast numbers
of identi�able individuals, such as the Of�ce of the United Nations High Commissioner for
Refugees. Further research may contribute to mapping and explaining these discontinuities
in diffusion patterns even when the demand and the functional case for comparable inno-
vations seem strong. Even among MDBs, more unevenness is evident in practices concern-
ing public consultation before adoption of substantive institutional policies on some topics
of particular public interest; and the IMF engages in such consultation much less than the
World Bank does.
Global Administrative Law 21
tutional similarity occur among international institutions have been the sub-
jects of little recent study (whereas diffusion, convergence, and differentiation
among states, economies, �rms, and nonstate institutions have been exten-
sively investigated across different issue areas). One model suggests that inno-
vations that are diffused are typically those �rst initiated in the World Bank.46
This might be due to the World Bank’s large size, meaning it has greater re-
sources for innovation. Subsequent uptake by regional institutions could then
be due to learning as the results of the innovation are assessed and the meth-
ods for implementing it are re�ned. Widespread adoption of the innovation
makes it more cost-effective for institutions to align to the new norm and more
costly to be an outlier, and often these institutions also wish to be regarded as
up-to-date. Another driver of uptake could be pressure (or coercion), probably
not usually exerted by the World Bank on regional development banks but
perhaps exerted by powerful states (that is, lenders, or the biggest borrowers).
The size, global mandate, and location of the World Bank may lead to external
pressures for reform so that political bargains struck there are in effect also
bargains for the regional multilateral development banks (MDBs), in which
many of the major lenders are the same countries. Whether the World Bank is
always the �rst mover, as this model implies, may be questioned.
It is to be expected that innovations on some issues will originate in diverse
experimentation by regional development banks, with promising experiences
then drawn upon by the World Bank, which could learn from these experi-
ences so as not to incur political and resource costs for untried innovations.
This seems to have occurred, for example, in policies promoting transparency,
where innovations, particularly in the Asian Development Bank, preceded
the 2010 World Bank reforms. The incorporation of a problem-solving func-
tion into the mandate of MDB independent accountability mechanisms, along
with the policy-compliance function, is an innovation developed in several
regional MDBs that has not been incorporated into the mandate of the World
Bank Inspection Panel. Fine-grained and robust studies of pathways of dif-
fusion and reasons for variation and nonadoption of speci�c GAL principles
and mechanisms among IFIs and among other GRG institutions are needed to
understand how and why change occurs in GAL and GRG.
Interinstitutional Relations
GRG has been likened to polysynody,47 the system in which a 10-person coun-
cil took the place of each government minister that was introduced in France
by the regent in 1715 and eloquently defended by the Abbé Saint-Pierre.48
46 Boisson de Chazournes, supra note 45.
47 The parallel is drawn by Cassese, supra note 14.
48 Charles-Irénée Castel (Abbé) de Saint-Pierre, Discours sur la polysynodie [1718] (Du Villard
and Changuion 1719). This work is an argument for constitutional monarchy and against
despotism, including excessive powers of the king’s ministers. The councils were introduced
after the death of King Louis XIV in response to complaints about ministerial power, but
22 The World Bank Legal Review
Organizing the relations between collective entities in global governance, or
between different legal regimes of which different entities are part, has been
tortuous, with much less systematicity and coherence than French polysynody
envisaged. Nonetheless, institutions are in increasingly intricate relationships
with each other, including in structures of interagency coordination, priori-
tization (for example, appointment of a lead agency to deal with a speci�c
government receiving humanitarian aid), and representation.
Isomorphism among clusters of institutions with similar missions, tak-
ing informal mimetic steps to resemble each other institutionally or to adopt
similar operational policies, might provide a foundation for interinstitutional
relations. However, similitude is not suf�cient—cultural differences and sheer
inequality may weigh heavily against interinstitutional arrangements. Staff
in some agencies believe that the World Bank, because of its size and culture,
is unwilling to adjust its policies or practices to conform to those of other
institutions or to easily enable interoperability or greater speed and cost-
effectiveness through harmonization in joint activities.
One clear modality for organizing change is through interinstitutional
agreements harmonizing policies or linking institutional responses in pre-
speci�ed classes of cases. The cross-debarment regime, established in the
Agreement for Mutual Enforcement of Debarment Decisions among a group
of MDBs in 2010, illustrates this modality.49 Each participating institution
adopted a harmonized de�nition of fraud and corruption. An institution in-
vestigating such phenomena in a project it has �nanced follows the IFI Prin-
ciples and Guidelines for Investigations. Its sanctions decision must be made
by a distinct body and conform to requirements of due process, publicity, and
proportionality. If a debarment from further contracting is imposed for more
than one year, a debarment for the same period is automatically applied by the
other participating institutions unless they give written notice (albeit without
a requirement to state reasons) that they are opting out due to institutional or
legal considerations. This agreement required a considerable amount of har-
monization. The step of creating a single uni�ed body to decide on and impose
debarment sanctions, while potentially advantageous in unifying the juris-
prudence and the length of sanctions imposed, proved impossible to achieve.
Partly this was due to a divide between MDBs that consider economic actors
to have a right to bid and contract with the MDB, and thus insist on robust
due process before interfering in that right, and MDBs that consider it their
prerogative to decide on contracts subject only to more modest requirements
of nonarbitrariness.
they proved ineffective, partly due to the delinquency of their aristocratic members, and
they were dissolved over the period 1718–23.
49 Stephen S. Zimmermann & Frank A. Fariello Jr., Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Cor-
ruption: Agreement on Cross-Debarment among Multilateral Development Banks, in this volume.
This paragraph summarizes points they make.
Global Administrative Law 23
The dif�culties for IFIs in achieving interinstitutional integration even on
fundamentally shared objectives are manifest in relation to an anticorruption
strategy operated by the World Bank since 2006.50 The Voluntary Disclosure
Program (VDP), which was approved by the Board of Executive Directors,
aims to encourage disclosure to the Bank of corrupt or fraudulent practices.
Any entity or individual involved in contracts or projects �nanced by the
World Bank Group (excluding World Bank Group staff) that is not already
under active investigation by the Bank may request entry into the VDP by
providing preliminary background details. Once the Bank con�rms the enti-
ty’s eligibility, the entity commits to cease all corrupt and fraudulent practices
and to disclose all details of impropriety to the Bank. The requirement that an
entity not already be under investigation sets up a clear incentive for wrong-
doers to come forward, because there is otherwise a risk that accomplices will
come forward �rst, leaving later disclosers ineligible for the VDP and exposed
to the sanctions that would usually follow an investigation (including debar-
ment from bidding for future Bank projects and sanctions imposed by state
authorities alerted by the Bank). Once the VDP begins, the participating entity
completes an internal investigation (subject to Bank veri�cation), implements
a compliance plan, and is subject to external monitoring of adherence to that
plan for three years. In exchange, the Bank does not debar the participating
entity (as it may do if the corruption or fraud is discovered by the Bank’s own
investigations) and, although the Bank does not confer immunity of any kind
on the participating entity, the Bank has the discretion not to disclose the con-
duct or the entity’s participation in the VDP to third parties (including host
countries and other MDBs).51 To some extent, this nontransparency is neces-
sitated by the logic of the program, including the risk in some countries that
transparency about the fact that a participating entity has come forward might
compromise the safety of individuals involved with the participating entity.
The Bank’s creation of the program reflects a judgment that major draw-
backs such as nontransparency are outweighed by the bene�ts of using this
kind of regulatory technique for reducing corruption. It was hoped that the
VDP would give the Bank �ne-grained information on how corruption oper-
ates so that system vulnerabilities could be attenuated and prevention and
detection efforts could be focused on speci�c areas. Bank or state-initiated in-
vestigations alone might not produce this information, and major investiga-
tions are so expensive (as well as facing other challenges) that they cannot
cover nearly as many situations as the VDP. In theory, the Bank can use this
information in working with member states and other agencies on forward-
looking anticorruption programs. These forward-looking elements, and the
50 This paragraph, and the discussion of the World Bank’s Access to Information Policy, draws
on joint work with Megan Donaldson.
51 World Bank, Department of Institutional Integrity, VDP Guidelines for Participants (2011),
available at . Redacted reports of the misconduct, not identifying the participat-
ing entity, may be provided to member countries and to other international organizations
or civil society.
24 The World Bank Legal Review
general deterrence effects of these measures and of the VDP, were given con-
siderable weight in the decision to create the VDP, on top of the possible roles
of the VDP in detecting speci�c corruption and reducing risks of repetition.
At the same time, the VDP may have undesirable consequences.52 The
VDP puts the Bank’s VDP unit in the position of keeping wrongdoing secret
from other Bank staff and from other MDBs working with the wrongdoers.
Perhaps most problematic, the VDP means the Bank may keep secret from
citizens of the host state wrongdoing affecting projects in that state funded
by loans that will be repaid from public monies and possibly also wrongdo-
ing by that state’s of�cials.53 The VDP differs from similar programs within
states, where the agency to which the wrongdoing is disclosed is itself an arm
of the state acting (at least theoretically) in the interests of its citizens. Under
the VDP, there is a risk that the Bank may be seen as keeping secrets from the
state and the public. Moreover, the VDP process is triggered by the decision
of wrongdoers to disclose. This decision is not contingent on any evidence
that host state authorities would be unable to investigate or prosecute wrong-
doing, or that disclosing the confession to the host country would result in
some conceivable risk of retaliation to personnel of the participating entity.
Obvious tensions arise with GAL principles of transparency: secrecy can be
a necessary part of good administration and can advance accountability and
the rule of law.
Attempts to curb corruption in projects funded by IFIs illustrate three
points. First, different institutional mechanisms directed toward the same
goals may vary signi�cantly in their deployment of speci�c GAL princi-
ples. In regard to transparency, the World Bank’s Sanctions Board process
accomplishes highly public performative acts against corruption,54 the cross-
debarment process is public but not so performative, and the VDP is non-
public and nontransparent. Second, each speci�c institutional mechanism is
nested in, or connected with, several others. The substantive signi�cance of
one mechanism cannot be evaluated without studying the whole regime. Some
mechanisms are deliberately designed to mesh together, as in the case of the
cross-debarment system meshing with the sanctions board system to impose
costs on a wrongdoer and reduce incoherence between different IFIs. Among
meshed mechanisms, differences in levels of adherence to GAL principles may
result in the displacement of an activity from one mechanism to another. Other
52 For example, by favoring larger (and more likely Western) contractors because it privileges
the �rst party to disclose wrongdoing; larger contractors are likely to be in the best position
to understand and make use of the VDP process. It may also be easier for larger contrac-
tors to comply with the VDP requirements, although the Bank offers technical assistance to
reduce the costs of compliance for smaller contractors; see Sarah B. Rogers, The World Bank
Voluntary Disclosure Program: A Distributive Justice Critique, 46 Colum. J. Transnatl. L. 709
(2008).
53 However, if the World Bank determines that it has a legal obligation or receives a judicial
notice, it can disclose the name of the participating entity after providing notice to it.
54 World Bank Group Sanctions Regime—An Overview (Oct. 8, 2010), available at .
Global Administrative Law 25
key parts of the regime may be designed separately and controlled by different
actors. Thus, IFI sanctions processes may be influenced by investigatory and
sanctions practices of national institutions, which may precipitate an entrant
into the VDP or provide material for an IFI sanctions investigation. Across the
gamut of meshed and unmeshed mechanisms, regulatory and institutional
competition and arbitrage may occur, including over levels of adherence to
different GAL principles. Third, differences of culture and values and great
disparities in capacity are highly relevant to these GRG processes and their
GAL dimensions.
The anticorruption �eld illustrates some of the dif�culties of creating joint
institutions. The dense and variegated institutional environment is nonethe-
less increasingly populated by institutions that were themselves created by
existing institutions. Some are subsidiaries of a single existing entity, but many
are interinstitutional structures.55 Their governing authorities might consist of
both state institutions and international institutions,56 multiple intergovern-
mental institutions,57 or hybrid and private organizations. These institutions
may create further institutions, and they themselves are frequently part of
complex interinstitutional and inter-regime arrangements. The substantive
nature and importance of these phenomena in global governance has not been
fully investigated;58 the relevance and potential value of applying GAL prin-
ciples to this organogenesis and to the operations of these complexes have
scarcely been studied.
Prescriptions of International Institutions for Governance
within States
Formal and informal international institutions have long been in the business
of promoting good governance within states.59 Among the myriad prescrip-
tions by different international agencies for governance within states, few have
provoked more introspection among lawyers in recent decades than those in
55 Edoardo Chiti & Ramses Wessel, The Emergence of International Agencies in the Global Adminis-
trative Space, in International Organizations and the Idea of Autonomy: Institutional Independence
in the International Legal Order 142 (Richard Collins & Nigel D. White ed., Routledge 2011).
56 Edoardo Chiti, EU and Global Administrative Organizations, in Global Administrative Law and
EU Administrative Law 13 (Edoardo Chiti & Bernardo Mattarella ed., Springer 2011).
57 Boisson de Chazournes, supra note 45, discussing the Global Environmental Facility (GEF)
and other examples.
58 Many works bear on this vast topic. See, for example, Margaret Young, Trading Fish, Saving
Fish: The Interaction between Regimes in International Law 241–305 (Cambridge U. Press 2011);
Robert Keohane & David Victor, The Regime Complex for Climate Change (Harvard Project on
International Climate Agreements, Discussion Paper 10-33, Jan. 2010), available at .
59 For critical assessment, see Antony Anghie, Civilization and Commerce: The Concept of Gover-
nance in Historical Perspective, 45 Vill. L. Rev. 887 (2000); Antony Anghie, International Finan-
cial Institutions, in The Politics of International Law 217 (Christian Reus-Smit ed., Cambridge U.
Press 2004).
26 The World Bank Legal Review
the �eld of law and development. Efforts by international institutions and
bilateral aid agencies to promote justice sector reform or rule of law within
recipient countries are premised on a view of what is good practice in the ad-
ministration of particular activities by state institutions in these sectors.
Critiques in the early 1970s of such reform efforts focused on societal dif-
ferences as reasons why ethnocentric Western liberal-legalist interventions
aimed at enabling “them� to be like “us� were unlikely to succeed. Third
world societies, David Trubek and Mark Galanter wrote, tend to be strati�ed
and divided, with political governance that is authoritarian or totalitarian.60
State institutions are less important to social control than tribal or other struc-
tures. Legal rules are made not by and for the whole society but by small elites
or power groups, and in any case are often not observed, nor are state courts
very independent or very important. Efforts to apply a liberal-legalist model
in such contexts are thus, these authors suggest, likely to be misguided.
Similar perceptions led some Western scholars and institutions into a re-
action akin to Montaigne’s quietist focus on cultivating his own garden. This
reticence was overwhelmed by the resurgence of rule-of-law interventionism
from the late 1980s onward. This resurgence was a manifestation of several
starkly different agendas arising from postconflict state building, conflict pre-
vention, waves of democratic transitions, and a new interest among develop-
ment economists in law and legal institutions as contributors to prosperity.
Some modest convergence may be occurring among these agendas, although
they pull in competing directions. Hence, much current work is devoted to the
renovation of some central tenets discernible in this convergence. These more
recent development interventions have been guilty, it is argued, of excessive
state centrism and “skipping straight to Weber� in assuming that rules-based
meritocratic politically accountable public agencies can be built and perform
well in desperately poor and divided fragile states,61 where many local people
may see these as just another manifestation of the power and interests of a
small elite in the capital city.62
Concerns are also raised about persisting tendencies of foreign actors to
advocate isomorphic transplantation of institutional models from one set-
ting to another, and about short time horizons driven by budget or election
cycles or by career paths of task managers, when in fact 30 or 40 years may be
needed for transformations to take root.63 A fundamental issue is the theory
of change used by external actors. The rhetoric of rule-of-law interventions
60 David Trubek & Marc Galanter, Scholars and Self-Estrangement: Some Reflections on the Crisis in
Law and Development Studies in the United States, 4 Wis. L. Rev. 1062 (1974).
61 Lant Pritchett & Michael Woolcock, Solutions Where the Solution Is the Problem: Arraying the
Disarray in Development, 32 World Development 191 (2004).
62 Deval Desai, Deborah Isser, & Michael Woolcock, Rethinking Justice Reform in Fragile and
Conflict-Affected States: The Capacity of Development Agencies and Lessons from Liberia and
Afghanistan, in this volume.
63 Id.
Global Administrative Law 27
has often assumed that the trajectory of change in a country’s institution will
be linear (more or less).64 Experience demonstrates, however, that change oc-
curs in many other trajectories, including j curves (deterioration followed
eventually by improvement), f curves (rapid early gains followed by some
deterioration), n curves (short-term improvements but an eventual return to
baseline), and punctuated equilibria or step functions (periods of stasis or in-
cremental change, punctuated by moments of major change).
Understanding of circumstances and trajectories under which change oc-
curs, or does not occur, in societies or institutions can be sought through the
locally speci�c perspective and expertise of change-agents or astute observers
within the society, or through more detached general models.
Rational-actor models emphasize the weights against change that arise
from self-reinforcing mechanisms built into the status quo and from switch-
ing costs.65 Reforms may thus have better prospects of success when existing
ways of doing things can be grandfathered in or allowed a long transition;
new constituencies with proreform interests can be empowered on the de-
mand side; extensive education and retraining are provided to enable job
holders to work successfully in reformed institutions; and traditional institu-
tions (with adaptations) are accorded signi�cant roles in the reformed system
to minimize cultural dissonance.66 The embeddedness of any speci�c national
regulatory or justice institution in a wider set of practices and understand-
ings and a matrix of other institutions can make lasting and effective reform
of any single institution dif�cult to achieve. The aggregate of all of this means
that reforms must usually be modest in aspiration and carefully sequenced
across institutions; critical junctures at which wholesale reform across a
whole society might succeed are extremely rare and pass quickly. Reform ef-
forts in ordinary times might thus focus on relatively autonomous, separable,
or wholly new institutions, in the hope of demonstrating for other institu-
tions that switching costs are lower and bene�ts higher than constituencies of
resistance expect.67 Uneven results have been attained in reforms of courts,
police, prisons, independent regulatory agencies for utilities, tax administra-
tions, and competition authorities.68
What might GAL contribute to contextualized or generalized understand-
ings of national reform?69 A starting point is to study closely the connections
between national (or subnational) public or public-private governance in
these sectors and extranational sources of norms, practices, ideas, funding,
expertise, and assessment. When suf�ciently dense and interdependent, these
64 Id.
65 Trebilcock, supra note 2.
66 Id.
67 Id.; Mariana Mota Prado & Michael Trebilcock, Path Dependence, Development, and the Dynam-
ics of Institutional Reform, 59 U. Toronto L.J. 341 (2009).
68 Trebilcock, supra note 2; Desai, Isser, & Woolcock, supra note 63.
69 This discussion draws on work with Megan Donaldson.
28 The World Bank Legal Review
connections bring the national and extranational governance together in the
loosely uni�ed global administrative space. Local and extralocal programs
and sites of speci�c activities can be integrated through GAL norms and
mechanisms.
This integrative process is continuous, iterative, and reflexive. It begins
with abstractions from broad normative principles and mechanisms found in
national public law systems, which are given abstract or more speci�c expres-
sion in the internal and external practice of international agencies; these ab-
stractions or more speci�c prescriptions are then invoked in the concretization
of practices at national and transnational institutional sites.
For example, an IFI may have a broad program of promoting good gov-
ernance and rule of law for states.70 In dealing with a borrowing state on a
speci�c project, the IFI may urge that state to establish particular national in-
stitutions (such as an insurance industry supervisory body or an electricity
regulator) that follow principles of transparency, participation, reason giving,
review, and accountability in forms distilled as best practices from the same
sector in other countries. This advocacy may be represented by the IFI as a
vindication of the broad program of good governance and rule of law. Such
practices then influence a further round of abstractions as the process contin-
ues. Moreover, these abstract norms are likely to �nd some application and be
given weight in the internal practices of the relevant international institutions
and in their interinstitutional arrangements, partly to avoid cognitive disso-
nance. Intrastate and extrastate programs and practices are thus brought into
unity through common framings, normativities, mechanisms, and metrics.
Much research is required on the implications and consequences of adop-
tion of particular GAL mechanisms by national or subnational regulators and
other agencies. Further work could also be done tracing the way in which GAL
mechanisms diffuse within a state. There is often an assumption that GAL
mechanisms have positive externalities beyond a speci�c sector, for example,
acting as a beachhead or best practices standard for procedural norms that
can then be applied to other sectors and areas of government. Yet, depend-
ing on how they operate in practice, GAL mechanisms in one sector could
have negative impacts beyond that sector; for example, if the mechanisms do
not work or prove unwieldy, the failure might discourage governments from
implementing similar measures in other areas. These theories might be tested
by more detailed qualitative work tracking the evolution of particular ideas
among policy makers.
70 The distinction is between a broad program identi�ed in the discourse of leading decision
makers and a more speci�c practice or technology that, although described by participants
as simply a means to advance the program, is in fact likely to be decoupled from it. Peter
Miller & Nikolas Rose, Governing Economic Life, 19 Economy and Society 1 (1990). GAL, at
least as it applies to the design and operation of regulatory structures and institutions, can be
understood as a technology for the pursuit of, or as congruent with, sweeping programmatic
ideas of “good governance� and “rule of law� that are proclaimed and promoted by many
global institutions for states and, to some extent, for themselves.
Global Administrative Law 29
Empirical law and development work on theories of change and differ-
ential uptake or success of reforms is likely to provide valuable insights as
the questions are addressed in relation to GAL in national or subnational in-
stitutions. For example, modes of regulation in authoritarian or centralized
regimes may simply not accommodate many GAL mechanisms; conversely,
more populist modes of regulation, in which there is a signi�cant measure
of public participation or regulation is conducted in a corporatist framework
by unions or municipal governments, may accommodate some GAL mecha-
nisms (public participation) but not others (legality). If GAL is dependent on a
particular political order—liberal capitalism—then regimes that reject liberal-
ism in favor of some more comprehensive and substantive account of value
(religious or otherwise) might be expected to reject GAL as irrelevant, except
insofar as it fosters the particular ends to which the regime is committed.
New Forms of Global Regulatory Governance
Three major areas in which some but not all necessary elements of political
agreement have come into place for newly crafted GRG arrangements are �-
nancial markets supervision, forest governance, and climate �nance. In each
area, existing or proposed governance arrangements feature signi�cant but
varied uptake of GAL principles and mechanisms. Little research has been
done, however, on the impacts or consequences of these uses of GAL or on the
reasons for and consequences of the variations.
National regulators of capital markets, including in some of the most suc-
cessful emerging markets, place considerable emphasis on the conformity of
regulatory rules and practices with the increasingly dense bodies of standards
set by international bodies and on the effectiveness of rules, enforcement, and
educational initiatives.71 These include provisions aimed at ensuring transpar-
ency and accountability among market participants. Although some models
exist for central bank independence or the design of governmental securities
regulatory institutions, and signi�cant arrangements exist for transnational
cooperation among counterpart institutions, there appears to be less prescrip-
tion for the design and procedures of national market regulatory institutions
than there is with regard to the standards they ought to apply.
Global bodies in this sector vary considerably with regard to their own
institutional design features (such as general or restricted membership) and
their norms of process and procedure. To give one example of variation in
uptake of GAL norms, the International Accounting Standards Board and as-
sociated bodies producing the International Financial Reporting Standards
have given a high priority to public transparency and to enabling interested
groups to make comments before drafts are �nalized. The IFRS Foundation
Trustees have a prominent Due Process Oversight Committee devoted to such
71 Alexandre Pinheiro dos Santos, Mitigating the Impact of Financial Crises on the Brazilian Capital
Market, in this volume.
30 The World Bank Legal Review
matters. A contrast is the Committee on Payment and Settlement Systems
(CPSS), hosted by the Bank for International Settlements in Basel. The mem-
bership of CPSS, initially a very small club, was expanded in 2009 and now
comprises representatives of 25 national central banks, with a further program
of outreach to other central banks. The committee, which produces principles
and recommendations, meets three times per year. Its website informs the pub-
lic that “No public releases of the meeting agendas or discussions are made.
Regular reports on the Committee meetings are made by the Chairman to the
Governors of the Global Economy Meeting.�72 Why does such great variation
exist between the IFRS bodies and the CPSS with regard to GAL principles of
transparency and participation?
There may be differences on the demand side, with narrower interest in
CPSS work and little pressure to change from a historic model of operating
in private. CPSS has as members many of the key public and governmental
actors needed to implement its recommendations, whereas the IFRS bodies
must persuade government regulators to accept or require the use of IFRS in
nationally regulated markets. The IFRS bodies thus need greater nonmember
buy-in and face greater risk of challenges to their legitimacy, which is linked
to their private or nongovernmental character. This comparison suggests a
few of many possible hypotheses to explain differential uptake of GAL norms.
Such hypotheses, and hypotheses concerning the effects of application of GAL
norms by different bodies, are only now being systematically developed and
tested.
From the standpoint of forest preservation, national governmental perfor-
mance has varied greatly, and existing intergovernmental arrangements for
forest governance are not adequate. Institutional solutions have not been able
to overcome the fundamental incentives to tropical deforestation that arise
from the market price of timber (and in some cases the value of cleared land),
producing returns that far outweigh monetary returns from the use of intact
forests. Governance initiatives for conservation easements or protected areas,
bene�t sharing from plant genetic resources, curbing of forest-destructive
lending and conditionality by IFIs, partnerships to improve enforcement and
curb trade in tropic timber, recognition of indigenous peoples’ land and re-
source rights, and forest certi�cation by entities such as the Forest Stewardship
Council have all produced some positive results,73 and debates about the con-
tributions of GAL norms to effectiveness or legitimacy have been prominent
in several of these regimes. In aggregate, however, these initiatives have not
provided a solution. Many advocates hope that �nancial mechanisms aimed
at mitigating climate change will provide, through initiatives such as Reduc-
ing Emissions from Deforestation and Forest Degradation (REDD+) with as-
sociated national reforestation and forest management modalities, suf�cient
economic incentives to keep forests standing. The administration of forests
72 .
73 Annie Petsonk, Legal Obligations and Institutions of Developing Countries: Rethinking Approaches
to Forest Governance, in this volume.
Global Administrative Law 31
under REDD+ will largely be national, but under conditions of monitoring,
reporting, and veri�cation that are likely to entail substantial international
prescription of both substantive and process standards. National administra-
tion will in many cases be dependent also on international administration of
a climate �nance regime—GAL procedures will play an essential role in mak-
ing these different administrative structures transparent to each other and to
market actors and in ensuring that they are subject to adequate processes for
review and accountability.
The scale of fund flows and of projects envisaged in an effective global
climate �nance regime, albeit a decentralized regime with numerous differ-
ent carbon markets and signi�cant powers of initiation and control exercised
by national agencies, 74 will necessitate a sophisticated global administrative
apparatus with intricate relations between national and international insti-
tutions.75 GAL issues have become increasingly central in debates about the
clean development mechanism and its reform and viability.76 Although they
have not featured as much in evaluations of the work of some of the special-
purpose climate funds, such as those administered by the World Bank,77 GAL
issues have loomed larger in relation to the Global Environmental Facility
(GEF), especially in response to proposals that the GEF be a signi�cant vehicle
for climate �nance in the future. GAL issues are likely to feature prominently
in the work of the Green Climate Fund and its associated board and imple-
menting agencies, in compliance mechanisms, and perhaps also in the work
of the nationally appropriate mitigation action (NAMA) registry.78 GAL prin-
ciples are likely also to play a signi�cant role in the intricate set of interinsti-
tutional governance arrangements that the emerging climate �nance regime
will entail.
74 For thoughtful advocacy of a bottom-up approach, see Navroz Dubash, Climate Change and
Development: A Bottom-Up Approach to Mitigation for Developing Countries?, in Climate Finance:
Regulatory and Funding Strategies for Climate Change and Global Development 172 (Richard B.
Stewart, Benedict Kingsbury, & Bryce Rudyk ed., N.Y.U. Press 2009).
75 Charlotte Streck & Thiago Chagas, Developments in Climate Finance from Rio to Cancun, in
this volume; Arunabha Ghosh, Harnessing the Power Shift: Governance Options for International
Climate Financing (Oxfam Research Report 2010).
76 See, for example, Charlotte Streck & Jolene Lin, Making Markets Work: A Review of CDM Per-
formance and the Need for Reform, 19 Eur. J. Intl. L. 409 (2008); Moritz von Unger & Charlotte
Streck, An Appellate Body for the Clean Development Mechanism: A Due Process Requirement, 3
Carbon & Climate L. Rev. 31 (2009).
77 See, however, the critique of such funds in Sophie Smyth, Agency and Accountability in Mul-
tilateral Development Finance, 4(1) L. & Dev. Rev. (Article No. 3) (2011); also Ilias Bantekas,
Trust Funds under International Law: Trustee Obligations of the United Nations and International
Development Banks (TMC Asser Press 2009).
78 Richard B. Stewart, Bryce Rudyk, & Kiri Mattes, Governing a Fragmented Climate Finance
Regime, in this volume.
32 The World Bank Legal Review
Conclusion
The stakes involved in GRG regimes are high. Too little is yet known about
the differences law makes in such regimes. Enough evidence is now avail-
able, however, to suggest that it is unwise to be sanguine about GAL. GAL
has winners and losers. GAL can provide substantial net bene�ts. But in some
contexts it can legitimize the highly unjust, and mask or divert substantive
critique. Requirements of process can blunt the effectiveness of institutions.
Moreover, GAL operates mainly where institutional forms exist or are being
created; the lens of GAL may provide little insight into power that is not exer-
cised in such institutional forms, or into ways in which formal institutions can
draw gaze and effort away from dynamics or basic structures that ought to be
at the center of inquiry and challenge.79
GAL can and frequently does serve the interests of powerful actors—a
central reason for the rapid uptake of GAL norms, mechanisms, and rheto-
ric.80 One major strand of GAL, oriented to stability and due process for for-
eign investors and for businesses engaged in trade, includes economic-liberal
requirements concerning transparency, participation, review, and (to some
extent) reason giving in trade institutions and in investor-state arbitration.81
These norms align closely with those urged on, or required of, developing
countries by international institutions.82
Some GAL norms, although ful�lling such purposes, are oriented more
toward enhancing the rights of a wider public. These include the norms pre-
scribed in the Convention on Access to Information, Public Participation in
Decision-Making and Access to Justice in Environmental Matters of 1998 (the
Aarhus Convention), developed under the auspices of the United Nations
Economic Commission for Europe. This convention requires public authori-
ties to make available environmental information to the public on request and
to provide certain types of information on a routine and proactive basis; it also
requires structures for public participation in various stages of environmental
decision making. These norms have informed and been woven into policies of
the World Bank and other IFIs, and the Aarhus Convention Compliance Com-
mittee processes have overlapped with World Bank Inspection Panel proceed-
ings in relation to the Vlora power plant in Albania.83
79 David Kennedy, The Mystery of Global Governance, 34 Ohio N.U.L. Rev. 827 (2008).
80 This and the following paragraphs draw on work with Megan Donaldson.
81 Gus van Harten & Martin Loughlin, Investment Treaty Arbitration as a Species of Global Admin-
istrative Law, 17 Eur. J. Intl. L. 121 (2006); Benedict Kingsbury & Stephan Schill, Investor-State
Arbitration as Governance: Fair and Equitable Treatment, Proportionality and the Emerging Global
Administrative Law, IILJ Working Paper No. 2009/6 (2009).
82 Rene Urueña, Espejismos constitucionales: La promesa incumplida del constitucionalismo global, 24
Revista de Derecho Público (Bogotá 2010).
83 World Bank Inspection Panel Investigation Report No. 49504-AL, Albania-Power Sector Genera-
tion and Restructuring Project (IDA Credit No. 3872-ALB) (Aug. 7, 2009), available at . There were 44 states parties to the Aarhus Convention in August 2011.
Global Administrative Law 33
GAL serves other agendas of IFIs. The World Bank is exemplary of IFIs
positioning themselves as “knowledge banks� and sources of expertise.84 GAL
processes and procedures have been mobilized by the IFIs in this endeavor.
Extensive external consultations and reason giving on proposed “safeguards�
policies and other normative instruments, requirements that the public and
affected groups receive adequate information and have opportunities to com-
ment before a project proposed by a state is approved for �nancing, mecha-
nisms for review of the institutions’ compliance with their own policies, and
Access to Information policies may all facilitate greater public access to, and
contestation of, ideas espoused by IFIs. Reporting and inspection or review
can bring feedback about on-the-ground experience into the renovation or cre-
ation of global regulatory regimes. Some of these mechanisms shape knowl-
edge dissemination and interaction, and they may tip these processes toward
being more inclusive and less “top-down� than in the past.
GAL can be state buttressing. In its orientation to a strong if vague sense
of �publicness� and public interest,85 not only may it influence extrastate pub-
lic authority, but it may also articulate a distinctive role for the state. In areas
such as investment and trade law, GAL may have a potential, only glimpsed
so far, to strengthen the sense that states and state authorities have a respon-
sibility to the public that in some situations overrides commercial or other
obligations to private actors.
At the same time, GAL may facilitate critique, contestation, resistance, and
reform in GRG.86 The extent to which GAL norms, processes, and mechanisms
have been signi�cant in opening space for disregarded groups and interests
or in advancing the realization of different conceptions of substantive justice
is unknown. Vignettes and anecdotes suggest, however, that such effects are
more than de minimis and may be increasing.
New legal ideas are required in the work of IFIs as in the work of other
key institutional actors in global governance. GAL may provide one concep-
tual resource in this regard. At the same time, innovative work in or relating
to GRG institutions and to national practices may inform and shape some
aspects of GAL.
84 A nomenclature popular in Bank rhetoric from World Bank, World Development Report 1998–
99: Knowledge for Development (World Bank 1999). Cf. David Kennedy, Challenging Expert Rule:
The Politics of Global Governance, 27 Sydney L. Rev. 5 (2005).
85 Kingsbury, supra note 14; Benedict Kingsbury & Megan Donaldson, From Bilateralism to
Publicness in International Law, in From Bilateralism to Community Interest: Essays in Honour of
Bruno Simma 79 (Ulrich Fastenrath et al. ed., Oxford U. Press, 2011).
86 Bhupinder S. Chimni, Co-option and Resistance: Two Faces of Global Administrative Law,
37 N.Y.U. J. Intl. L. & Pol. 799 (2005); Bronwen Morgan, Turning Off the Tap: Urban Water
Service Delivery and the Social Construction of Global Administrative Law, 17 Eur. J. Intl. L. 216
(2006); Doreen Lustig & Benedict Kingsbury, Displacement and Relocation from Protected Areas:
International Law Perspectives on Rights, Risks and Resistance, 4 Conservation and Society
404 (2006).
PART I
LAW OF INTERNATIONAL
ORGANIZATIONS: ISSUES
CONFRONTING IFIS
The Reform of the Governance
of the IFIs
A Critical Assessment
DANIEL D. BRADLOW*
The �rst two global international �nancial institutions (IFIs), the Inter-
national Monetary Fund (IMF) and the International Bank for Reconstruction
and Development (IBRD), were created at the Bretton Woods Conference in
1944. Their governance, their functions, and, ultimately, their membership
were shaped by the geopolitical realities of the time.1 The IMF’s function was
to use its �nancial resources to create and support a rules-based international
monetary system based on stable exchange rates and relatively free payments
for current transactions.2 The IMF was expected to use its surveillance author-
ity to oversee the operation of the international monetary system and advise
members on their balance of payments and the maintenance of the par value
of their currencies.3 The founding states anticipated that the IMF would use
its �nancial resources to help member states correct their balance-of-payments
problems in ways that were not destructive to international or domestic pros-
perity. The Articles of Agreement of the IMF made clear that, although mem-
ber states were surrendering some control over their exchange rates and their
policy discretion in regard to current transactions, they retained full authority
to regulate capital transfers as they saw �t.4 Thus, the founding member states
did not anticipate that the IMF would play any direct role in the regulation or
oversight of either national or international �nancial markets or in the inter-
national allocation of credit. At the time, this made good sense because very
few banks operated across national boundaries, all �nancial regulation was
national, and international �nancial activity was a relatively small part of the
global �nancial scene.
∗
The views in this chapter are the author’s own and should not be attributed to any institu-
tion with which he is af�liated. The author would like to thank Veronique Lendresse for her
research assistance.
1 For a history of these institutions, see, for example, Devesh Kapur, John P. Lewis, & Richard
Webb, The World Bank: Its First Half Century (Brookings Institute 1997); Margaret Garritsen
De Vries, The IMF in a Changing World, 1945–85 (Intl. Monetary Fund 1986).
2 Articles of Agreement of the IMF, Article I, available at .
3 Under the system established with the creation of the IMF, each state was expected to es-
tablish the value of its currency in terms of the U.S. dollar, which would be �xed in terms
of gold. The member state was expected to maintain this value, known as the “par value of
the currency,� within narrow limits. It could change the par value only with the consent of
the IMF.
4 Articles of Agreement of the IMF, Article VI. 37
38 The World Bank Legal Review
The IBRD’s role was to help �nance the reconstruction of Europe and the
economic development of its erstwhile colonies and a few independent states
in Africa, Asia, and Latin America.5 At the time this was understood to mean
that the IBRD would provide �nancial support primarily for physical infra-
structure projects in member states that were not able to raise suf�cient �nanc-
ing from private sources.
Since the IMF and the IBRD were established, the world has changed dra-
matically. The number of states participating in the global monetary and �-
nancial system has increased; the IMF and the institutions in the World Bank
Group6 each now have more than 180 member states. In addition, many more
IFIs have been created. There are now IFIs such as the International Develop-
ment Association (IDA), which provides concessional �nancing to the poorest
states; regional and subregional development banks; and institutions dedi-
cated to funding the private sector, such as the International Finance Corpora-
tion (IFC). The par value system of exchange rates has broken down; we now
live in a world with freely fluctuating exchange rates and liberalized �nancial
flows. In this environment, international �nancial flows exceed by several or-
ders of magnitude annual international trade volumes; international capital
markets are a key component of the global �nancial order; and, in a number
of cases, the IFIs either compete or cooperate with the private sector and other
of�cial creditors in funding projects in their member states.
In addition, no �nancial regulator in a major economic power can effec-
tively regulate its �nancial industry without addressing the international as-
pects of that industry’s operations and without collaborating in some way
with its counterparts in other key countries. As a result, the IMF has become
involved in international �nancial market oversight and in reviewing its mem-
ber states’ �nancial regulatory frameworks.7 It is supported in these efforts by
a broad range of relatively new international forums and bodies involved in
the various aspects of international �nancial governance. These include the
Financial Stability Board (FSB), the Basel Committee of Banking Supervision,
the International Organization of Securities Commissions, and the Interna-
tional Association of Insurance Administrators.8 The IMF also plays a leading
role when a member state needs support in dealing with its international debt
problems.
5 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article I, available at
6 The members of the World Bank Group are the International Bank for Reconstruction and
Development (IBRD), the International Development Association (IDA), the International
Finance Corporation (IFC), the Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency (MIGA), and the
International Centre for the Settlement of Investment Disputes (ICSID).
7 The IMF’s website provides a useful overview of the diversity of its activities; see .
8 For a useful overview of these institutions and their functions, see, generally, Howard
Davies & David Green, Global Financial Regulation: The Essential Guide (Polity Press 2008);
Kern Alexander, Rahul Dhumale, & John Eatwell, Global Governance of Financial Systems: The
International Regulation of Systemic Risk (Oxford U. Press 2006).
Reform of IFI Governance 39
The various entities in the World Bank Group and the regional develop-
ment banks are involved in helping their member states develop the institu-
tional and technical capacity to effectively regulate, supervise, and manage
their evolving �nancial systems and to develop capital markets. The grow-
ing complexity of the international �nancial and economic system and our
deepening understanding of the complexities of poverty and development
are also changing the ways in which these multilateral development banks
(MDBs) operate. They can no longer limit their operations to funding physical
infrastructure projects. They are now involved in helping their member states
improve various aspects of their governance arrangements; deal with such
complex social issues as legal and judicial reform, education reform, vulner-
able population groups, and health care; confront such environment-related
challenges as climate change, sustainable energy and water strategies, and
food security; manage their public �nances; and fund physical infrastructure
projects.9
These changes are occurring at the same time that the global political
economy is undergoing a shift in power. This process of change is not yet over,
and its �nal outcome is not yet clear. Currently, the rising powers are power-
ful enough to demand changes in some aspects of the existing international
economic governance arrangements but not powerful enough to shape the
global economic governance agenda, including reforming the key institutions
in global �nancial governance. The existing powers, primarily the Group of
Seven (G7) countries, still control the global agenda and can still block reform
efforts that they oppose. This situation has two implications for governance
reforms. First, it suggests that reform any faster or more extensive than the
existing powers are willing to accept is not feasible in the short run. This situ-
ation may change over time as power shifts more toward newly rising pow-
ers, but at the moment, this is an important constraint on governance reform.
Second, the current governance reforms are unlikely to produce sustainable
and stable governance arrangements in the IFIs until the process of change in
the balance of global power plays itself out.
One effect of these changes has been to produce differences in the relation-
ships between the IFIs and their member states. Today, the major IFIs, de facto,
are important actors in the policy-making processes of many of the member
states that rely on their �nancial services. The IFIs have become more sensi-
tive to the interests of those member states that use their �nancial services and
are gaining international power and influence while remaining subject to the
influence of the IFI’s richer and more powerful member states.
As is clear from the number of �nancial crises that the world has experi-
enced since the 1980s, international governance arrangements do not always
9 The websites of the MDBs provide a useful overview of the diversity of their activities. See,
for example, World Bank Group, ; African Development Bank,
; Asian Development Bank, ; European Bank
for Reconstruction and Development, ; Inter-American Development
Bank, ; International Finance Corporation, .
40 The World Bank Legal Review
function effectively. In fact, even though some signi�cant reforms in IFIs’ gov-
ernance occurred before then, the 1997 Asian �nancial crisis resulted in a gen-
eral agreement that both the existing arrangements for international �nancial
governance, often referred to as the global �nancial architecture, and the gov-
ernance of the key IFIs needed to be reformed. However, since that time, the
attention paid to this topic has been inversely proportional to the well-being
of the global �nancial system. Consequently, during the early years of the mil-
lennium, the topic was not high on the international agenda and some com-
mentators even began to question the need for the IFIs, particularly the IMF.
As signs that the global political economy could be running into prob-
lems appeared and accelerated after the �nancial crisis fully erupted in 2008,
there were signi�cant efforts to reform the governance of the IFIs. These efforts
resulted in changes in voting arrangements, representation on boards of di-
rectors, and the selection of top management.10 These reforms were comple-
mented by a strengthening of the role of some of the IFIs, most notably the IMF.
Given all the governance changes that the IFIs have undergone in recent
years, now is an opportune time to assess the actual signi�cance of these re-
forms. Such an evaluation asks three questions: What has been achieved in
terms of reforming the governance of the IFIs? What standards should one
use in assessing the adequacy of these reforms? How well do these reforms
measure up to these assessment standards?
The thesis of this chapter is that, despite all the governance changes that
the IFIs have undergone, they still do not have adequate governance arrange-
ments and will need to undergo further reform if they are to perform their
mandates effectively. In order to establish this thesis, this chapter is divided
into four parts. First, it describes the reforms the IFIs have agreed to and have
implemented. Second, it sets out some benchmarks against which these gov-
ernance reforms can be measured. Third, it assesses the adequacy of the re-
forms undertaken based on the benchmarks identi�ed in the second section.
The �nal section is a conclusion.
The Governance Reform of the IFIs
Over the past twenty years, the IFIs, particularly the World Bank11 and
the IMF,12 have undergone more substantial changes in their governance and
10 The recent election of another European, Christine Lagarde, as the management director of
the IMF suggests that these reforms may not be as solid as they �rst appeared.
11 For a useful overview of the reforms at the World Bank Group, see .
12 For a useful overview of the reforms at the IMF, see IMF Finance, Legal and Strategy, Policy
and Review Departments, IMF Quota and Governance Reform—Elements of an Agreement
(IMF, Oct. 31, 2010); IMF, Factsheet: A Changing IMF—Responding to the Crisis (Mar. 16,
2011), available at .
Reform of IFI Governance 41
operational practices than have other international organizations.13 As a re-
sult, they are more transparent and more open to interactions with their exter-
nal stakeholders than are other international organizations. The World Bank is
also more accountable to its various stakeholders than are other international
organizations.
Voice and Vote
One of the most persistent complaints about the governance of the IFIs, par-
ticularly the World Bank and the IMF, was that they were not representing
their membership very effectively and they needed to realign both their vot-
ing arrangements and the way in which their member states were represented
on their boards of executive directors. In the past few years, both the World
Bank and the IMF have made efforts to address this issue. The IMF has in-
creased its member states’ basic votes in order to enhance the representation
of its smallest and poorest member states in its total vote. It also increased and
redistributed the quotas of some of its member states to ensure that formerly
underrepresented states are now more appropriately represented in the total
votes of the organization. As a result, a number of the major emerging markets
now have some of the biggest quotas in the IMF. In addition, the IMF member-
ship agreed to reassess the formula used in assigning quotas (and therefore
votes) to its member states so that the counts more accurately reflect the role
of its member states in the global �nancial and economic system.14
The membership of the IMF has also agreed to reform the structure of its
board of executive directors. In particular, it has agreed to appoint a second
alternative executive director to support those executive directors who repre-
sent large numbers of states. There will also be a reduction in the European
representation on the board and a concomitant increase in the developing-
country representatives on the board. Finally, the membership has also agreed
to move to an all-elected board, thereby eliminating the privileged position
that its �ve largest shareholders held on the board.15
The World Bank has made similar reforms. Its member states have agreed
to increase the share of its developing and transitional member states in its
total vote.16 Following the implementation of these changes, these countries
will constitute 47.19 percent of the total vote in the Bank. This represents an
13 It should be noted that the regional development banks have also undertaken substantial
governance reforms. However, they tend to follow the lead of the World Bank in their reform
efforts. Consequently, it can be assumed that these banks have implemented roughly analo-
gous reforms to those that the World Bank has undertaken and described in this section.
14 For a general overview of these reforms, see IMF Press Release No. 08/64, IMF Executive
Board Recommends Reforms to Overhaul Quota and Voice (Mar. 28, 2008), available at
.
15 Id.
16 For an overview of these voting reforms, see .
42 The World Bank Legal Review
increase of 4.59 percent in their share of the total vote since 2008. In addition,
within these totals, there will be some realignment of voting shares so that the
most dynamic emerging markets increase their share of the votes and have
a vote in the Bank that is more commensurate with their role in the global
economy. The member states have also increased the size of the Bank’s Board
from 24 to 35 members, with the new member being a third African executive
director.
Senior Management
Historically, the selection of the chief executive of�cers of the IMF and the
World Bank has been governed by a “gentlemen’s agreement� according to
which the managing director of the IMF was a European and the president
of the World Bank was an American. In addition, the process through which
this person was selected was opaque and closed to outside participation. The
member states have now agreed that the process should be transparent and
understandable to outsiders and that it should be based on merit without re-
gard to national origin.17 Analogous procedures should also apply to the se-
lection of other senior management of�cials. It is important to note that the
IMF failed to fully implement this reform and followed the old “gentlemen’s
agreement� in its recent selection of a new managing director. Despite their
commitments to the contrary, the leading member states banded together to
elect another European as the IMF’s managing director.18
Accountability
Over the past 20 years, the World Bank and the other MDBs have made sig-
ni�cant efforts to become more accountable. In 1993, the World Bank created
the Inspection Panel, the �rst mechanism in any international organization
through which nonstate actors that believed that they had been harmed by
the failure of the Bank to comply with its own policies and procedures could
have their concerns investigated by an independent body that reports to the
Board of the Bank. This was an important breakthrough for all international
organizations; subsequently, most MDBs created similar mechanisms, known
17 See, for example, Development Committee, Strengthening Governance and Accountabil-
ity: Shareholder Stewardship and Oversight, DC2011-0006 (Apr. 4, 2011) (discussing selec-
tion process for World Bank president), available at ; G20,
Declaration on Strengthening the Financial System (Apr. 2, 2009), available at ; G20, Decla-
ration Summit on Financial Markets and the World Economy (Nov. 15, 2008), available at
.
18 See “IMF Executive Board Selects Christine Lagarde as Managing Director,� Press Release
No. 11/259 (Jun. 28, 2011), available at: .
Reform of IFI Governance 43
collectively as independent accountability mechanisms.19 Interestingly, the
one IFI that has not created such a mechanism is the IMF.20
The IFIs have taken other steps to improve their accountability to their
member states and to the public, who ultimately provide their funding. Sig-
ni�cantly, the World Bank has agreed that it will establish dual performance
reviews of its president by its Board and of the Board by the president and
senior management. The goal of these reviews will be to ensure more effec-
tive performance by both parties. The World Bank is also working to create a
corporate governance scorecard that will allow for more effective assessment
of its governance and the ef�cacy of its operations.21
Transparency
The most substantial and far-reaching change in the operations of the IFIs
has been in regard to transparency. All the IFIs have adopted information-
disclosure policies.22 These policies, many of which have been revised over
time, have steadily increased the amount of information that the IFIs disclose.
As a result, they are rapidly establishing as a standard operating procedure
that all their documents and information be publicly available unless speci�-
cally decreed not to be so. It is important to note that this does not mean that
all information is disclosed. In a number of cases, the clients of the IFIs—either
the member state or the private sector borrower—claim that the information
belongs to them and cannot be disclosed due to market sensitivities.
Operational Policies
The MDBs have always had policies to guide their staff in the complex opera-
tions that they undertake.23 However, initially these policies were viewed as
internal documents of no interest to anyone other than the staff. Over time, this
perception changed, and the policies are now publicly available. One conse-
quence of this development is that the policies, particularly those dealing with
19 For overviews of these various independent accountability mechanisms and comparisons
of their structures and mandates, see Richard E. Bissell & Suresh Nanwani, Multilateral De-
velopment Bank Accountability Mechanisms: Developments and Challenges, 6(1) Manchester J.
Intl. Econ. L., 2 (2009); Daniel D. Bradlow, Private Complaints and International Organizations:
A Comparative Study of the Independent Inspection Mechanisms in International Financial Institu-
tions, 36 Geo. J. Intl. L. 403 (2005).
20 See Daniel D. Bradlow, Operational Policies and Procedures and an Ombudsman, in Accountability
of the International Monetary Fund 88 (Barry Carin & Angela Wood ed., Ashgate 2005).
21 See, for example, Development Committee, supra note 17, at 2 (discussing the creation of a
corporate scorecard for the World Bank Group).
22 See, for example, IMF, FactSheet Transparency at the IMF (Mar. 24, 2011), available at
; World Bank Policy on Access to
Information (Jul. 1, 2010), available at .
23 See, for example, the World Bank Operational Manual, available at .
44 The World Bank Legal Review
the controversial social and environmental aspects of the MDB operations,
have become the subject of great public interest and public debate. These poli-
cies have also tended to be the ones most often invoked in the requests for
inspection to the independent accountability mechanisms.
One consequence of this development is that the MDBs have recognized
that their policies have signi�cance and relevance outside the institutions and
that their external stakeholders have the capacity to influence the content of
these policies. As a result, the MDBs have begun to develop informal, trans-
parent, and participatory procedures for making these policies.24 The World
Bank Group, in particular, has used such informal procedures with suf�cient
frequency that it is developing an implicit rule-making procedure that in-
volves disclosure of policy drafts, opportunities for public comment on these
drafts, and explanations of how the public comments have been addressed by
the institution in formulating the �nal versions of the policy.
Interestingly, the other IFIs have not followed this practice in a consistent
way. Most of the regional MDBs have occasionally provided opportunities for
public consultation on drafts of policies and practices, particularly in regard to
the structuring or amending of their independent accountability mechanisms.
However, they have not regularly done so in regard to their substantive op-
erational policies. The IMF has not developed such an implicit policy, partly
because it does not have a comparable set of publicly available operational
policies. It does, however, have some policies that are publicly available and,
in at least one case—its policy on conditionality—it followed a process similar
to the evolving process in the World Bank:25 the policy was developed in a
relatively transparent and participatory process.
Principles for Assessing the Governance of the MDBs
This section formulates �ve principles that can help assess the ef�cacy of the
governance reforms undertaken by the IFIs: a holistic approach to develop-
ment; flexible management; respect for applicable international law; coordi-
nated specialization; and good administrative practice.
Holistic Approach to Development
The original vision of development as an economic process that focuses on
growth, as measured by gross domestic product (GDP) per capita, is no lon-
ger seen as suf�cient. It is now recognized that the development of individu-
als and societies is influenced by both noneconomic factors and economic
criteria.26 This insight has led to a new understanding of development as a
24 See David B. Hunter, International Law and Public Participation in Policy-Making at the Inter-
national Financial Institutions, in International Financial Institutions and International Law 199
(Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed., Kluwer Law International 2010).
25 See, Bradlow, supra note 20.
26 UNDP, Human Development Report 1990 (Oxford U. Press 1990); Amartya Sen, Development
Reform of IFI Governance 45
comprehensive and holistic process that involves intertwined economic, en-
vironmental, social, cultural, political, and even ethical dimensions. Accord-
ing to this view, the economic aspects of development and its social, political,
environmental, and cultural aspects are all components of one dynamically
integrated process. Thus, one measure of the performance of the IFIs should
be the extent to which their own governance arrangements support their insti-
tutions’ ability to implement this holistic vision of development.
Flexible Management
The principle of flexible management means that the governance and opera-
tions of the IFIs must be suf�ciently flexible and dynamic that they can adapt
to the differing and changing needs, circumstances, and activities of their di-
verse stakeholders. For example, the IFIs must have the ability to assist mem-
ber states with the technical, institutional, and economic capacity to design,
implement, and manage large, complex operations, often with substantial
social, environmental, and cultural impacts and policy implications; to help
countries with limited technical, institutional, and economic capacity under-
take infrastructure projects and governance reform projects that are both com-
mensurate with their management capacity and appropriately scaled to meet
their needs; and to �nance and support smaller-scale operations that are more
focused on directly meeting the needs of the poor and other vulnerable popu-
lation groups in their member states.
Two corollaries follow from the principle of flexible management. First,
the IFIs themselves need to have personnel and the management systems that
enable them to effectively respond to the broad range of needs of their mem-
ber states; they need to ensure that their staff has both the social and the cul-
tural background necessary to understand the people and countries in which
they operate and the technical expertise and professional experience to meet
the demands of their member states. In addition, the IFIs need to have effec-
tive feedback mechanisms so that they can understand all the impacts of their
operations in their borrower countries. Without such capacity to learn lessons
from their operations, the IFIs are unlikely to fully understand their successes
and failures and are more likely to repeat the failures. In addition, they are
less likely to be able to identify problems in their operations in a timely man-
ner and to mitigate any unintended or unanticipated adverse consequences of
these operations.
Second, given the broad range and diversity of the demands on IFI’s ser-
vices, no IFI can fully meet the needs of its member states. Consequently, the
IMF, the World Bank, and the other MDBs need some mechanism for coordi-
nating their operations and ensuring that together the organizations can ef-
fectively address their member states’ demands. One possible approach for
as Freedom (Alfred Knopf 1999); Declaration on the Right to Development, GA Res. 41/128,
UN GAOR, 41st Sess./UN Doc. A/RES/41/128 (Dec. 4, 1986). See also, Daniel D. Bradlow,
Differing Conceptions of Development and the Content of International Development Law, 21S. Afr.
J. Hum. Rights 47 (2005).
46 The World Bank Legal Review
ensuring that overall these institutions function in a flexible, ef�cient, and not
unduly centralized manner is based on the principle of subsidiarity,27 which
holds that all decisions should be taken at the lowest level in the system com-
patible with effective decision making. This principle is complicated to imple-
ment because it must apply both in standard operating conditions and in crisis
situations, which may require that decision-making authority be moved to a
different level in the system or institution than is the case during standard
operating conditions.
Respect for Applicable International Law
All the IFIs are formal international organizations created by treaties. Con-
sequently, they are subjects of international law and should comply with ap-
plicable international legal principles.28 Although international law does not
offer many detailed standards that the IFIs can apply to international �nancial
transactions, it does provide general principles that they can use in structuring
their governance arrangements.29 In particular, the IFIs’ governance structures
and decision-making principles should conform to universally applicable cus-
tomary and treaty-based international legal principles. Four sets of principles
are pertinent in this regard.30
Sovereignty
The �rst is the principle of respect for national sovereignty, which must be
respected even though, by joining an IFI, a state agrees to surrender some
decision-making autonomy in return for the bene�ts of participation in the
IFI. This means that, even though their different power and wealth character-
istics and the particular voting rules in the various IFIs mean, de facto, that
the amount of independence the member states give up on joining the IFI will
be related to their power and wealth and their need for the services of the par-
ticular IFI, all member states remain sovereign states with equal international
27 The principle of subsidiarity is de�ned in Article 5 of the treaty establishing the European
Community. It is intended to ensure that decisions are made as closely as possible to the citi-
zen and that constant checks are made as to whether action at the community level is justi-
�ed in light of the possibilities available at the national, regional, or local level. Speci�cally, it
is the principle whereby the union does not take action (except in the areas that fall within its
exclusive competence) unless the potential action would be more effective than action taken
at a national, regional, or local level. This principle is closely bound up with the principles
of proportionality and necessity, which require that any action by the union not go beyond
what is necessary to achieve the objectives of the treaty. See the de�nition of subsidiarity at
.
28 See, for example, Philippe Sands & Pierre Klein, Bowett’s: Law of International Institutions (6th
ed., Sweet & Maxwell 2009); Jan Klabbers, An Introduction to International Institutional Law
(Cambridge U. Press 2007); Henry G. Schermers & Niels M. Blokker, International Institu-
tional Law: Unity within Diversity (4th ed., Martinus Nijhoff 2003).
29 Daniel D. Bradlow, International Law and the Operations of the IFIs, in International Financial
Institutions and International Law 1 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed., Kluwer Law
International 2010).
30 See, generally, Ian Brownlie, Principles of Public International Law (7th ed., Oxford U.
Press 2008).
Reform of IFI Governance 47
legal status. Thus, the principle of national sovereignty imposes some con-
straint on the demands that an IFI can place on a particular member state and
should help each member state preserve as much independence and policy
space as is practicable in its relation with each IFI and consistent with the de-
mands of overall effective global �nancial governance.
Nondiscrimination
The principle of nondiscrimination applies to both the member states of the
IFIs and all those nonstate actors with which the IFIs interact or which are di-
rectly affected by their operations. The principle of nondiscrimination means
that all similarly situated states and nonstate actors should receive similar
treatment in their dealings with the IFIs and that those who are differently sit-
uated should receive differential treatment that reflects the differences in their
situations. The key question thus becomes what standards can be used for
ensuring that all stakeholders receive treatment that is fair and reasonable.
Although the IFIs should base their treatment of all states on the same
principles, they should apply these principles in a way that is responsive to
the similarities and differences in the situations of each member state and of
the affected nonstate actors.
Recognition should be given to the fact that weaker and poorer states are
signi�cantly different in capacities from rich and powerful nations. One way
of implementing this standard could be to apply the general principle of spe-
cial and differential treatment that is applicable in a number of international
legal contexts, for example, in international environment and international
trade law, to international �nancial governance. In the IFI governance context,
this principle means that special attention is paid to ensuring that weak and
poor countries are able to enjoy a meaningful level of participation in interna-
tional �nancial decision-making structures, even when their participation is
based on principles such as weighted voting. For example, in cases where it is
not possible to offer states a full seat at the decision-making table,31 one alter-
native could be that the organization create a mechanism through which these
states and their citizens can raise concerns in connection with any decisions
that adversely affect them and that they do not believe are receiving adequate
attention at the relevant decision-making level in the IFI.
The relevant principles applicable to how IFIs should treat natural persons
are derived largely from customary international law. This means that they
should be derived from the Universal Declaration of Human Rights, which
is now considered to be part of customary international law.32 Pursuant to
31 For example, boards of executive directors at the IFIs would become too large and unwieldy
if all poor and weak member states were full participants in the boards’ deliberations that
directly affect them.
32 Universal Declaration of Human Rights, GA Res. 217(III), UN GAOR, 3d Sess., Supp.
No. 13, UN Doc. A/810 (1948); Report of the Special Representative of the Secretary-Gen-
eral on the Issue of Human Rights and Transnational Corporations and Other Business
48 The World Bank Legal Review
this document, individuals, at a minimum, are entitled to expect that the IFIs
respect and protect their social, economic, and cultural rights, such as rights
to housing, health care, education, jobs, and social security. The IFIs should
also ensure that member states’ operations do not de facto undermine respect
for or protection of their civil and political rights, such as rights to freedom of
speech and association.33
The situation of juridical persons is more complex because judicial per-
sons are not clearly covered by the Universal Declaration of Human Rights.
However, the treatment of foreign juridical persons is covered by the custom-
ary international law on state responsibility.
State Responsibility
Pursuant to the principles applicable to state responsibility for treatment of
foreigners located in the sovereign’s home territory,34 states have an obliga-
tion to provide foreign legal persons who are present in the state with fair and
equitable treatment. This means that foreign entities should receive treatment
that conforms to certain minimum standards, a term not clearly de�ned in in-
ternational law, but that at least must be comparable to the treatment of simi-
larly situated domestic institutions. This principle does not necessarily mean
that foreign entities should receive the same treatment received by domestic
institutions that, because of the particular roles they play in the domestic po-
litical economy, have different relations to the state and the market than the
foreign entities.
International Environmental Law
The principles derived from international environmental law35 impose on �-
nancial regulators an obligation to insist that �nancial institutions fully under-
stand the environmental and social impacts of their policies and procedures
and of their individual transactions.
The principle of respect for applicable international law, therefore, es-
tablishes a third test for good governance, namely, to what extent the gov-
ernance arrangements of the IFIs promote respect for national sovereignty,
Enterprises, paragraph 38, UN Doc. A/HRC/4/35 (2007); also, see, generally, Hurst Hannum,
The UDHR in National and International Law, 3(2) Health and Human Rights 144 (1998).
33 For an overview of the World Bank’s approach to human rights, see Robert Danino, Legal
Opinion on Human Rights and the Work of the World Bank (Jan. 27, 2006), available at ; Siobhán
McInerney-Lankford, International Financial Institutions and Human Rights, in International
Financial Institutions and International Law 239 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed.,
Kluwer Law International 2010).
34 See, generally, GA Res. 62/61, UN GAOR, 61st Sess., UN Doc. A/RES/62/61 (Jan. 8, 2008);
Report of the International Law Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Third Session, UN
GAOR, 56th Sess., at 43, Supp. No. 10, UN Doc. A/56/10 (2001).
35 See, generally, David Hunter, James Salzman, & Durwood Zaelke, International Environmental
Law and Policy (Foundation Press 2006).
Reform of IFI Governance 49
the environment, and the rights of all natural and legal stakeholders in the
international �nancial system.
Coordinated Specialization
The principle of coordinated specialization acknowledges that, even though
development is holistic and all aspects of international governance are inter-
connected, IFIs cannot function ef�ciently without a limited mandate and
without the of�cials in these institutions having the requisite specialist knowl-
edge to implement these mandates. Thus, the principle of coordinated special-
ization has two requirements in regard to the governance of the IFIs. First, the
IFIs’ mandates must be clearly de�ned and limited to their areas of expertise,
while not being insensitive to how their specialization �ts into a holistic vision
of development. Second, the IFIs cannot ignore the fact that other interna-
tional organizations have expertise in and responsibility for other aspects of
development. Consequently, to ensure that all these organizations help their
member states implement a holistic vision of development, IFIs need to en-
sure some form of coordination between themselves and other international
organizations. An effective mechanism for ensuring such coordination must
be transparent and predictable. It may also need some dispute-settlement
mechanism.
In this respect, it is important to keep in mind that the IFIs are not free
actors. In some cases, they are subject to receiving “direction� from other in-
tergovernmental entities in which their member states are active. For example,
the IMF, together with the World Bank Group and the FSB, is subject to “guid-
ance� from the Group of Twenty (G20). Previously the IMF and the World
Bank would receive such “guidance� from the G7.
This principle, therefore, establishes a fourth standard for measuring the
adequacy of the IFIs’ governance arrangements: the extent to which the IFIs
coordinate their policies and operations with other relevant international in-
stitutions, each of which has its own limited mandate. At a minimum, this
principle should ensure that the IFIs offer other international institutions with
relevant areas of expertise a meaningful and timely opportunity to raise their
concerns with them. It should also offer both the IFIs and all other relevant in-
ternational organizations a mechanism for resolving tensions between them.
Good Administrative Practice
The basic principles of good administrative practice in global governance are
the same as those applicable to any public institution:36 transparency, predict-
ability, participation, accountability, and clear and predictable rule making. In
the case of IFIs, these principles have the following meanings:
36 See, generally, Benedict Kingsbury, Nico Krisch, & Richard B. Stewart, The Emergence of
Global Administrative Law, 68 Law & Contemp. Probs. 15 (2005), and the materials available
on the Institute for International Law and Justice website at .
50 The World Bank Legal Review
• Transparency: This term refers to the degree to which an IFI discloses in-
formation about its operational policies and procedures, operations, and
decisions.37
• Predictability: IFIs should conduct their operations in a manner that is suf-
�ciently open so that their procedures, decisions, and actions are predict-
able and understandable to all stakeholders. An aspect of predictability is
that decisions should be made in a timely manner.
• Participation: Mechanisms exist for allowing all stakeholders to participate
in the decisions of the IFIs that directly affect them. Important factors to
consider are both the extent to which member states are able to express
their views and have their votes factored into the decisions of the IFIs and
the extent to which nonstate actors can participate in those operational
and policy decisions that affect them.38
• Accountability: Mechanisms are available to both member states and
nonstate actors to hold the IFIs accountable for their actions.39 These
mechanisms include the channels through which member states can raise
their concerns to the highest levels of the institution and the means that
nonstate actors can use to have claims that they have been harmed by the
actions and decisions of the IFIs heard by the institution. These claims can
arise from the contractual relations between these actors and the IFIs as
well as from noncontractual claims.
• Clear and predictable rule making: IFIs follow certain procedures in formu-
lating and adopting their operational policies and procedures. Best prac-
tice in IFI rule making means that the IFIs provide all stakeholders who
have an interest in a proposed policy with an opportunity to comment on
the proposed policy, to submit comments on it, and to receive feedback
on their comments and submissions. Ideally, the procedures to follow in
developing these policies and procedures should be based on clear and
predictable rules and should not be ad hoc.40
Thus, the �nal standard against which the IFI governance reforms can be
measured is the extent to which they comply with the �ve principles of good
administrative practice stated above.
Summary of the Standards for Evaluating
the Governance of the MDBs
Based on the �ve principles, following are questions that can be used for
assessing the adequacy of the IFIs’ governance arrangements:
37 See supra note 23.
38 See, for example, Hunter, supra note 24.
39 See Bissell & Nanwani, supra note 19; Bradlow, supra note 19.
40 See Hunter, supra note 24.
Reform of IFI Governance 51
• Are the governance arrangements based on a holistic understanding of
development?
• Are the management arrangements suf�ciently flexible to deal with the
full range of demands that the IFIs can expect from their diverse collection
of stakeholders?
• Do the mechanisms for IFI governance implement and comply with all
applicable international law standards, including respect for national sov-
ereignty, the rights of all natural and legal persons, and responsible envi-
ronmental law practices?
• Do the decision-making procedures in the IFIs provide adequate and
meaningful opportunities for coordination with other international insti-
tutions with relevant expertise?
• Do IFI governance arrangements comply with the principles of good ad-
ministrative practice, namely, transparency, predictability, participation,
accountability, and clear and predictable rule making?
An Assessment of the IFI Governance Reforms
against the Principles of Good Governance
This section evaluates the extent to which the reforms that have been under-
taken in the governance of the IFIs conform to the principles of good gover-
nance set out above.
Approach to Holistic Development
The MDBs have substantially expanded their view of development over
the past twenty years. They all recognize that development is not purely
an economic process and that it involves social, cultural, political, and en-
vironmental aspects. This recognition is reflected, for example, in the safe-
guard policies of the IBRD and IDA, the performance standards of the IFC,
and the comparable social, poverty, gender, and environmental policies at
the other MDBs. In addition, the MDBs recognize that political factors are
an integral part of the development process, as evidenced by their work
in postconflict states and on governance issues and in their statements on
such sensitive development issues as gender and indigenous people. How-
ever, the IMF, although not denying that development involves more than
purely economic matters, has not explicitly incorporated a more holistic
vision of development into its operations. This is in part a reflection of its
speci�c monetary and macroeconomic focus. It may also be due, in part,
to the fact that the IMF lacks the publicly available operational policies
in which the MDBs tend to express their visions of speci�c aspects of the
development process.
Despite the MDBs’ impressive efforts in regard to this principle of good
governance, one aspect of their approach to development is de�cient. They
have been slow to link their operational policies and procedures explicitly to
52 The World Bank Legal Review
applicable international legal treaties and conventions and to the declarations,
standards, and norms developed in other international organizations and fo-
rums. This can be seen, for example, in the policies on involuntary resettle-
ment and indigenous people at the World Bank and the regional MDBs, which
are silent about the applicable human rights conventions, declarations, and
norms and do not discuss how they should be applied in their operations. This
de�ciency in the policies of the MDBs, particularly in regard to human rights,
may be related to the political prohibitions in their articles, to the fact that the
MDBs are not signatories to the relevant international legal instruments, and
to the fact that often the applicable standards provide limited guidance on
how they should be implemented in dealing with such complex issues as the
appropriate standard of compensation in cases of involuntary resettlement
or the nature of consent required from indigenous people. Nevertheless, it is
striking that the MDBs’ policies do not explicitly reference either the appli-
cable international legal standards or the applicable decisions, declarations, or
other legal instruments of those institutions and bodies that have the expertise
and the mandate to develop the standards and norms in these areas that are
outside the scope of the MDBs’ assigned areas of expertise. In this sense, the
MDBs’ implementation of a holistic vision of development is linked to their
performance under the coordinated specialization criteria.
Flexible Management
Although the IFIs have often worked together in speci�c projects or programs
in a country, their interactions have grown more intense over the past twenty
years. As a result, they are making greater efforts to ensure better coordina-
tion between their operations within speci�c member states. For example,
the MDBs now work to ensure cross-debarments for contractors found to be
involved in fraudulent and corrupt practices.41 In addition, the independent
accountability mechanisms of these institutions have begun to cooperate in
joint investigations of projects for which they have received requests for in-
vestigations.42
The IFIs have enhanced their ability to respond flexibly to developments
in their member states by increasing the voice and vote of underrepresented
member states in their governance. For example, the World Bank, by increas-
ing the share of the total votes of their developing- and emerging-market
member states and by agreeing to a third African chair on its Board of Execu-
tive Directors, has enhanced the ability of at least some of these countries to
have their voices heard in its decision-making process. In theory, these changes
should result in the World Bank being more responsive to the needs and con-
cerns of these countries.
41 See Stephen S. Zimmerman & Frank A. Fariello, Jr., Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Cor-
ruption: Agreement on Cross-Debarment among Multilateral Development Banks in this volume.
42 For example, the independent review mechanism of the African Development Bank and the
World Bank Inspection Panel conducted a joint investigation of the Bujagali Dam Project in
Uganda in 2007.
Reform of IFI Governance 53
In addition, the World Bank, with the encouragement of the Develop-
ment Committee, has initiated a number of organizational reforms designed
to enhance its responsiveness to the needs of its member states.43 It is actively
working to improve the diversity of its workforce so that it is more representa-
tive of its full membership. The Bank is also actively working to devolve more
management authority from its headquarters to its �eld staff, which is ex-
pected to grow as a portion of the total staff. This effort has been slowed down
because of budgetary constraints and the complexities of this change. Finally,
and more controversially, the Bank is working to make the formulation of its
country assistance strategies a more participatory process that is more respon-
sive to the development priorities of its member states. Some external observ-
ers of the Bank are concerned that this effort is intended more to weaken the
Bank’s current operational policies and standards than to enhance each mem-
ber state’s influence in the Bank’s assistance strategy for that country.
These developments could result in a more responsive Bank and in more
effective allocations of responsibilities between the World Bank and the other
IFIs working in a particular country or region. This in turn would suggest
greater compliance with the principle of flexible management. However, these
reforms are relatively new, and it is too soon to predict how successful they
will be.
Respect for Applicable International Law
It is clear that all the IFIs respect and work to comply fully with the require-
ments of their constituent treaties and with the customary international law
and general principles of law applicable to them as international organiza-
tions. However, it is also clear that it is easier for the IFIs to enunciate these
principles than to apply them in the day-to-day management of their opera-
tions and in their governance.
In this regard, it is particularly noteworthy how few of the MDBs’ opera-
tional policies mention relevant international legal principles or explain how
management and staff are expected to ensure that operations comply with
applicable international law. To some extent, this can be explained by the fact
that the applicable international legal principles, standards, and norms are not
easy to implement, particularly within the contexts of complex development
projects. However, the MDBs cannot avoid dealing with the issues addressed
by these international legal principles in their operations, particularly those
that raise safeguard issues.44 Consequently, the fact that there is no reference
to these principles, standards, and norms in their policies means, in effect, that
43 See Development Committee, Enhancing Voice and Participation of Developing and Transi-
tional Countries in the World Bank Group: Update and Proposal for Discussion, paragraphs
26–27(a–c), DC2009-0011 (Sep. 29, 2009), available at .
44 World Bank, Safeguard Policies, available at ;
International Finance Corporation, Performance Standards, available at .
54 The World Bank Legal Review
the MDBs are leaving to their staff and management the responsibility of de-
ciding whether or not to utilize applicable legal principles in their implemen-
tation of MDB policies and how to interpret these principles when they do
use them. Staff decisions in regard to the applicability and the interpretation
of these principles may then be reviewed by the independent accountability
mechanisms during their review of the complaints that they receive and the
investigations that they conduct of staff and management compliance with
the applicable policies, in particular MDB-funded operations.
The decisions of the MDB staff and management and the reports of the
independent accountability mechanisms, therefore, amount to precedents of
how various international actors are determining the applicability and the
interpretation of particular principles, norms, and standards of international
law in speci�c cases. Thus, the MDBs are helping to make the international
law in regard to complex issues such as the rights of indigenous people, invol-
untarily resettled people, treatment of physical cultural property, women in
development, and environmental issues such as impact assessments, respon-
sibilities to mitigate adverse impacts, and the nonnavigable uses of interna-
tional waterways.
Unfortunately, the MDBs appear reluctant to accept the concept that they
are de facto establishing precedents on important legal issues that can influ-
ence the evolution of these legal principles. As a result, they have not accepted
the responsibilities that go with performing law-making functions and so are
not effectively meeting their obligations in terms of transparency, participa-
tion, and reasoned decision making in this regard. Thus, the MDBs cannot be
viewed as being fully compliant with this principle of good governance.
Coordinated Specialization
The issue of IFIs’ relationships with other international organizations has be-
come more important because the scope of their missions has expanded so
dramatically.45 As a result, IFIs are now undertaking work that involves the
specialized competence of other international organizations.46 For example,
the World Bank funds public health projects that overlap with the expertise
and responsibility of the World Health Organization; it funds agricultural
projects that may “trespass� into the jurisdiction of the Food and Agricultural
Organization or the International Fund for Agricultural Development. How-
ever, although they may do so on an ad hoc basis, IFIs are not formally obli-
gated to consult with other international organizations or to ensure that there
is effective coordination among them. Given this situation, it is noteworthy
45 Claudio Grossman & Daniel Bradlow, Limited Mandates and Intertwined Problems: A New Chal-
lenge for the World Bank and the IMF, 17(3) H. Rig. Quar. 41l, 412 (Aug. 1995) (also available at
).
46 In this regard, it is important to recall that the World Bank and the IMF are, de jure, special-
ized agencies of the UN system. Thus, they are expected to report to the UN Economic and
Social Council, and their relationships with the United Nations are governed by the terms of
their relationship agreement.
Reform of IFI Governance 55
that the Bank is making a concerted effort to coordinate its operations in cri-
ses and emergencies with other international organizations. In this regard,
the Bank has updated its operational policies so that they acknowledge the
leadership role of other international organizations, particularly the United
Nations, in certain aspects of this work.47
One consequence of this development is that, because IFIs tends to be
better resourced than most other international organizations, they are able to
more effectively influence their member states’ approaches to issues in which
they are interested, even when other organizations have expertise in those
issues and the mandate to operate in regard to them. Thus the IFIs tend to
become de facto, although not de jure, the primary international bodies for
dealing with these issues.
Because their role in these issues is not consistent with the division of
responsibility inherent in having international organizations with limited
mandates, the IFIs have a distorting effect on the overall global governance
architecture. In particular, the MDBs’ assertion of influence in a particular area
tends to undermine the authority and effectiveness of any other international
organization with responsibility in that area. In addition, it creates governance
challenges for the IFIs because it means that they have assumed responsibili-
ties in regard to issues and activities for which their governance structures
were not necessarily designed.
One possible channel for mitigating this distortion could be through the
international bodies in which either the IFIs and these other international or-
ganizations or their member states are represented. This is particularly appli-
cable to bodies such as the United Nations Economic and Social Council, the
International Monetary and Finance Committee, the Development Commit-
tee, and the G20. Although these bodies are not unaware of these governance
challenges, they have not yet effectively addressed the global governance dis-
tortions that result from the IFIs asserting authority over issues that fall within
the expertise and mandate of other international organizations.
Good Administrative Practice
The best way for determining how well the IFIs are complying with this prin-
ciple of good global governance is to assess their performance in regard to
four aspects of good administrative practice.
Transparency
Over the past 20 years, MDBs have gone from being closed institutions to
being probably the most open international organizations. During this time,
47 See OP 2.30—Development Cooperation and Conflict and OP 8.00—Rapid Response to
Crises and Emergencies, available at . Also see, generally, Towards a New Framework
for a Rapid Bank Response to Crises and Emergencies (World Bank Jan. 12, 2007).
56 The World Bank Legal Review
they have developed, amended, and redrafted information-disclosure poli-
cies so that today their basic operational assumption is the opposite of what it
used to be: today all information is presumed to be disclosable unless there is
a good reason not to disclose the information.48 The primary exceptions to this
operating assumption are categories of information that do not technically be-
long to the organization or could have market implications for the institution,
the member state, or other actors in the transaction. This is particularly an is-
sue in regard to IFI transactions that involve the private sector. As a result, the
IFIs are in substantial compliance with this principle of good governance.
Participation
The MDBs have made an effort to encourage consultations with all affected
peoples in their particular operations. Thus, under the safeguard policies of
the IBRD and the IDA, the performance standards of the IFC, and the social
and environmental policies of other MDBs, the MDBs are all required to con-
sult with indigenous people, those who will feel the impacts of the MDBs’
operations, and those who will be adversely affected by these operations.49
In addition, as indicated above, the World Bank has made substantial efforts
to incorporate, albeit informally, greater public participation into its rule-
making procedures, at least for those rules of greatest interest to nonstate
actors.50 Given these developments, the IFIs can be deemed to have made sig-
ni�cant progress toward meeting the applicable standards for good gover-
nance but are not as yet fully compliant with them.
Accountability
The IFIs have made signi�cant progress in promoting accountability to non-
state stakeholders in their operations. By 2010, all the MDBs had established
independent accountability mechanisms that were authorized to investigate
claims from nonstate actors that they had been harmed or threatened with
harm by the failure of the MDBs to comply with their operational policies and
procedures in regard to a particular project.51 These mechanisms usually are
independent of the management and staff of the MDBs and report directly to
the boards of executive directors of these institutions.
The IMF is the only IFI that has not created an independent accountability
mechanism. Although the nature of its operations is different from that of the
other IFIs, the IMF could establish some form of independent accountabil-
ity mechanism.52 In fact, given that its operations have important impacts on
nonstate actors in its member countries and that these impacts are not neces-
sarily well understood by the institution, the creation of such a mechanism
48 See supra note 22.
49 See supra note 44.
50 See Hunter, supra note 24.
51 See Bissell & Nanwani, supra note 19; Bradlow, supra note 19.
52 For one model of such a mechanism for the IMF, see Bradlow, supra note 20.
Reform of IFI Governance 57
could have a positive impact on the IMF and thus improve the quality of its
operations. In this regard, it should be noted that the IMF’s board of executive
directors can introduce such a mechanism on its own authority without any
decision by its board of governors or amendment to its articles of agreement.
The IFIs have made less progress in promoting accountability to those
member states that use their �nancial services but are not directly represented
on their boards. These states, in principle, can use the executive director rep-
resenting them on the board of the particular IFI to raise issues of concern to
the board. However, the current constituency system of representation at the
board level makes this dif�cult in practice. The reason is that the executive
director may not believe it is an opportune time to raise a claim to his or her
board colleagues; there are only limited ways for a frustrated state to hold the
executive director accountable for this decision. In this regard, the recent ef-
forts of the World Bank and the IMF to hold their boards more accountable for
their performance is a positive development that has the potential to result in
more accountable IFIs.
Clear and Predictable Rule Making
Over the past twenty years, the World Bank Group has evolved an informal
practice of participatory rule making. The practice has not yet been formalized
into a “policy on policies,� but it has evolved from the practice the Bank has
followed in connection with important Bank Group policies. Thus, the practice
of consulting interested stakeholders, providing opportunities for interested
parties to submit comments on draft policies, and responding to these com-
ments was a prominent feature of the development of the indigenous people’s
policy and the information-disclosure policy in the IBRD and the IDA and
of the review of the performance standards in the IFC. This practice has also
been used in the reviews of the independent accountability mechanisms of the
IBRD and IDA, the European Bank for Reconstruction and Development, the
Inter-American Development Bank, the Asian Development Bank, and the Af-
rican Development Bank. A version of it was followed by the IMF in its review
of its conditionality policy. However, this practice remains informal and at the
discretion of an IFI. It is not yet consistent practice, and the process followed
in each policy review is a matter for discussion and negotiation. Therefore,
while the IFIs have made substantial progress toward meeting this principle
of good governance, they are not yet fully compliant with it.
Conclusion
This chapter has set out a framework for assessing efforts to reform the gov-
ernance of the IFIs. Based on this framework, it is clear that, while the recent
reform efforts, despite the setback in the selection of the current IMF manag-
ing director, have the potential to produce substantial changes in the opera-
tions and governance of the IFIs, they do not fully comply with the principles
of good governance. However, the international community, in light of the
58 The World Bank Legal Review
problems in Europe, the uncertain state of the global economy, and the ongo-
ing shifts in global power, seems to have exhausted its interest in reforming
IFI governance. Consequently, there is little reason to expect the additional re-
forms that are required for full compliance to be undertaken in the short run.
Nevertheless, it is to be hoped that in the medium term the shift in the balance
of global political and economic power will create the conditions for another
round of signi�cant IFI governance reforms.
Should the Political Prohibition
in Charters of International Financial
Institutions Be Revisited?
The Case of the World Bank
HASSANE CISSÉ
The World Bank Articles of Agreement1 prohibit the Bank from interfering in
the political affairs of its members and from taking political considerations
into account in its decision making.2 Three principal clauses in the articles en-
shrine the prohibition on interference with the political affairs of Bank mem-
bers. First, Article IV, Section 10, of the IBRD articles stipulates that “the Bank
and its of�cers shall not interfere in the political affairs of any member; nor shall
they be influenced in their decisions by the political character of [a] member. . . . only
economic considerations shall be relevant to their decisions, and these . . . shall be
weighed impartially in order to achieve the purposes stated in Article I� [em-
phasis added].3 Article III, Section 5(b), of the IBRD articles provides that the
Bank’s loan proceeds must be used only for their intended purposes and “with due
attention� to economy “without regard to political or other non-economic influences
or considerations� [emphasis added].4 Finally, Article V, Section 5(c), of the IBRD
articles states that “the President, of�cers and staff . . . owe their duty entirely
to the Bank,� and each member is obliged to respect that duty and “[r]efrain
from all attempts to influence any of them in the discharge of their duties.�
In essence, these provisions allow the Bank to make decisions based only
on economic considerations and impose a mutual obligation on the member
states and the Bank’s president, of�cers, and staff to respect the independence
of each other.5
1 In this chapter, unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “Bank� and “the World
Bank� include both the International Bank for Reconstruction and Development (IBRD)
and the International Development Association (IDA), and the term “articles� denotes the
Articles of Agreement of the IBRD and the IDA.
2 The author would like to thank Evarist Baimu and Aristeidis Panou for their invaluable
assistance in the preparation of this article. Useful comments were also provided by Frank
A. Fariello, Vikram Raghavan, Adrian Di Giovanni, Siobhán McInerney-Lankford, and
Jonathan Heath. Responsibility for any errors or omissions remains with the author.
3 IDA Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section 6.
4 IDA Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section 1(g).
5 Aron Broches, International Legal Aspects of the Operations of the World Bank, 98 Recueil des
Cours 297, 327–28 (1959). 59
60 The World Bank Legal Review
The political prohibition provisions were enshrined in the articles for two
reasons that have to do with the nature of the Bank as an international �nancial
institution and as a cooperative international organization with membership
from all over the world.6 A �nancial intermediary, the Bank borrows funds
from capital markets to �nance its lending operations. If political consider-
ations were to drive decisions, the smooth operation of the Bank’s business
model might be affected, because the Bank might have dif�culty maintain-
ing the con�dence of the capital markets where it sources its funds as well
as the member countries to which it lends the borrowed funds.7 In addition,
given the diversity of political beliefs and approaches of its membership, the
“Bank’s broad acceptability and its continuity required depoliticization of its
decisions and impartiality in weighting the economic considerations which
alone were to be taken into account.�8 Indeed one explanation of the political
prohibition provision is that it was adopted “with the Soviet Union princi-
pally in mind.�9
The nonpolitical10 mandate of the Bank can be also explained as a char-
acteristic of the functionalist approach to international organizations,11 which
was widely accepted at the time.12 This approach is reflected in the technical
and focused mandate of other international organizations that came to life
before or after World War II (e.g., the International Labour Organization; the
United Nations Educational, Scienti�c and Cultural Organization; the Food
and Agriculture Organization, the World Health Organization, and the Inter-
national Civil Aviation Organization). In the case of the Bank, the functionalist
approach reflected deeper views about development and prevailing economic
6 The political prohibition provisions, especially Article IV, Section 10, do not seem to have
been adopted with the purpose of protecting the sovereign equality of member states. How-
ever, given the use of similar language in Article 15(8) of the Covenant of the League of
Nations and Article 2(7) of the UN Charter, one could argue that an incidental function of
Article IV, Section 10, is to protect and retain the sovereignty of states; see Bartram S. Brown,
The United States and the Politicization of the World Bank: Issues of International Law and Policy
103 (Kegan Paul International 1992).
7 Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, World Bank Legal Papers 226 (Kluwer Law International 2000).
8 Id.
9 Edward S. Mason & Robert E. Asher, The World Bank since Bretton Woods 27 (Brookings Insti-
tution Press 1973). The Soviet Union never became a member of the Bank. In addition, Soviet
scholars viewed the Bank as an organization that was used by the United States to pursue
its own policy; see Grigori I. Tunkin, Theory of International Law 315 (William Butler trans.,
Harvard U. Press 1974).
10 The Bank’s mandate could be characterized as nonpolitical but not apolitical. The word
“apolitical� is de�ned as “unconcerned with or detached from politics�; the word “nonpo-
litical� is de�ned as “not involved in politics�; see New Shorter Oxford English Dictionary 94,
1935 (Lesley Brown ed., 3d ed., Oxford U. Press 1993).
11 David Mitrany, The Functional Approach to World Organization, 24 Intl. Aff. 350 (1948).
12 Philippe Sands & Pierre Klein, Bowett’s Law of International Institutions 76 (6th ed., Sweet and
Maxwell 2009). For an overview of the intellectual theory of international organizations, see
José E. Alvarez, International Organizations as Law-Makers 17–57 (Oxford U. Press 2005).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 61
thought in the post–World War II period. From this perspective, development
was seen primarily as an economic endeavor, aimed at increasing gross domes-
tic product and productivity of economies, which in turn could be achieved
through technical, nonpolitical solutions. Interestingly, no sooner did the func-
tionalist approach diminish than instances of politicization became apparent
in international organizations.13
The political prohibition clause played a signi�cant role in the develop-
ment of the Bank’s governance in the mid-1940s.14 The British vision of creat-
ing technical and expert organizations, free of political control, informed the
UK position about the role of the executive directors in both the Bank and the
International Monetary Fund (IMF).15 The British had argued for part-time
executive directors with �nancial expertise, but the American preference for
full-time directors prevailed.16
The political prohibition clause has continued to shape the Bank’s policy
decisions over the years. On the one hand, the Bank has declined to predi-
cate its lending on the human rights record of the governments of member
countries or the form of political governance found in such states (whether
a monarchy or a republic, a single-party or multiparty state). At the same
time, with the Board-endorsed general counsel’s legal opinions, the Bank has
been able to expand to new areas previously regarded as lying outside the
13 Gene M. Lyons, David A. Baldwin, & Donald W. Mcnemar, The “Politicization� Issue in
the UN Specialized Agencies, in The Changing United Nations: Options for the United States 81
(David A. Kay ed., Praeger 1978), and Victor-Yves Ghebali, The Politicisation of UN Special-
ised Agencies: A Preliminary Analysis, 14 Millennium: J. of Intl. Studs. 317 (1985). These stud-
ies note that the Bank was at the time one of the least “politicized� specialized agencies of
the UN.
14 The Bretton Woods institutions were established in 1944, but several issues—such as the seat
of the institutions, the adoption of bylaws, and the relations between Management and the
executive directors—were resolved at the inaugural meeting of the Board of Governors at
Savannah, Georgia, in March 1946.
15 The British delegation argued, early in the negotiations, that “so far as practicable . . . we
want to aim at a governing structure doing a technical job and developing a sense of cor-
porate responsibility to all members, and not the need to guard the interests of particular
countries,� quoted in Kenneth W. Dam, The Rules of the Game: Reform and Evolution in the
International Monetary System 111 (U. of Chicago Press 1982).
16 These decisions earned the skepticism of Lord Keynes, one of the main architects of the Bret-
ton Woods institutions, who eloquently warned the Board of Governors in Savannah about
the dangers of politicization: “I hope that Mr. Kelchner [chief of the Division of International
Conferences, U.S. Department of State] has not made any mistake and that there is no mali-
cious fairy, no Carabosse, whom he has overlooked and forgotten to ask to the party. For if
so, the curses which that bad fairy will pronounce will, I feel sure, run as follows: ‘You two
brats shall grow up politicians; your every thought and act shall have an arrière-pensée;
everything you determine shall not be for its own merits but because of something else.’
If this should happen, then the best that could befall—and that is how it might turn out—
would be for the children to fall into an eternal slumber, never to waken or be heard in the
courts and markets of mankind.� Id., at 114.
62 The World Bank Legal Review
boundaries of the political prohibition clause, including legal and judicial re-
form and governance17 issues.18
Although the language of the political prohibition clause appears to be
absolute and does not permit any exceptions,19 from early on “certain political
circumstances were recognized� in Bank practice as being “clearly relevant to
the Bank’s work� and could not be disregarded.20 For example, a World Bank
document dated April 1968 acknowledges that the Bank “cannot ignore condi-
tions of obvious internal political instability or uncertainty which may directly
affect the economic prospects of a borrower.�21
This chapter traces and evaluates the development and the controversies of
the political prohibition provision. More speci�cally, it discusses the evolution
of application of the political prohibition clause in Bank practice. It then notes
that contemporary criticism of the political prohibition takes two forms, with
some critics expressing concern about the extent of the Bank’s mission creep
while others worry that the Bank’s sense of responsibility has not kept pace
with its expanding role. It evaluates the tools available for evolving, through
amendment or interpretation, the political prohibition and explores in greater
depth the arguments for and against retaining the prohibition. It concludes
with the suggestion that the Bank’s business might be best served by continu-
ing the institutional practice of adapting political prohibition through creative
but responsible interpretation.
Evolving Practice: Overview of Current Frontier Issues
The drafters of the IBRD articles in 1944 and the IDA articles in the 1950s were
mindful of the needs of their time. It is unlikely that they could have antici-
pated all evolving challenges and the changing operating environment that
the Bank and its member countries would face. Some of these contemporary
challenges and the changing political, social, and economic landscape might
have a bearing on the political prohibition clause. These challenges include
17 Governance is de�ned as “the traditions and institutions by which authority in a country
is exercised. This includes (a) the process by which governments are selected, monitored
and replaced; (b) the capacity of the government to effectively formulate and implement
sound policies; and (c) the respect of citizens and the state for the institutions that gov-
ern economic and social interactions among them.� See Daniel Kaufmann, Aart Kraay, &
Massimo Mastruzzi, The Worldwide Governance Indicators: Methodology and Analytical Issues,
World Bank Policy Research Working Paper No. 5430 (Sep. 2010).
18 Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, The Creative Role of the Lawyer—Example: The Of�ce of the World Bank’s
General Counsel, 48 Cath. U.L. Rev. 1041, 1048 (1998–99). Because the authority to interpret
the articles is vested in the Board of Executive Directors of the Bank, the legal opinion of the
general counsel does not constitute an authoritative interpretation of the articles. Neverthe-
less, the Board’s endorsement (or concurrence) grants such opinions the authority that allow
for their incorporation into the Bank’s practice.
19 Shihata, supra note 7, at 227.
20 Id., at 228.
21 Id., quoting World Bank, IDA and IFC—Policies and Operations 43.
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 63
• Increasingly more intense and violent conflict within states, which is cre-
ating an environment quite different in nature from the post–World War
II European landscape that the Bank was established to address. The re-
sultant weak postconflict states of today are in need of enhanced sup-
port to prevent recurrence of conflict.22 There is also a need for a different
approach to the growing number of “fragile pockets�—territory outside
government control or under a government’s weakening control leading
to illicit trade in drugs and gang warfare and raising issues of criminal
justice.
• Evolving demands of member countries, including a growing share of de-
velopment policy lending relative to speci�c investment lending and a
growing number of requests for fee-based services.
• Unconstitutional changes in government and the evolving response of re-
gional organizations to such changes.
• Increased complexity of the international aid architecture at the global
level, creating growing pressure to achieve harmonization and coordina-
tion among bilateral and multilateral donors in the Bank’s member coun-
tries, which brings up its own challenges, because most of these bilateral
donors do not have constraints such as the Bank’s political prohibition.
• Increased impact of and challenges posed by emerging problems such as
climate change, compounding threats such as overpopulation pressures,
increased scarcity of resources, and environmental degradation faced by
vulnerable societies.
• Growing recognition that many challenges of development stem from
poor governance and a failure to achieve the participation of citizens in
government and to develop a sense of public ownership of government.
This recognition requires, in turn, engagement with actors at all levels of
society, not just within the executive.
The Bank’s response to the challenges over the years is a story of an
incremental, measured opening of space for the Bank to intervene23 in ways
that may not have been envisaged in 1944.24 This trend is illustrated in the
examples discussed below, which are drawn from some of the most pressing
and challenging issues faced by the Bank in recent years.
22 Paul Collier, The Bottom Billion: Why the Poorest Countries Are Failing and What Can Be Done
about It 177–78 (Oxford U. Press 2007).
23 The terms “intervene� and “intervention�—as used with reference to the Bank in this chap-
ter—include all Bank activities, including lending, grants, trust funds, donor and aid coordi-
nation, research, and economic and sector work, all of which are subject to the provision of
the articles.
24 Some key terms in the articles that are of relevance to political prohibition, including “de-
velopment,� “political considerations,� “economic considerations,� “productive purposes,�
and “political affairs,� are not de�ned in the articles. Their meaning has thus been subject to
interpretation and has evolved.
64 The World Bank Legal Review
Dealing with Extraconstitutional Governments
The Bank’s operational framework restricts it from operating in the territory
of a member without the approval of that member state. In situations where
there is no government, the Bank operates upon the request of the internat-
ional community and with the approval of its Board.25 A challenge arises when
more than one government purports to represent a member country or when a
government comes to power through means that are unconstitutional. This is
a common phenomenon in many states that borrow from the Bank.
The Bank’s early approach was that it recognized the political situation,
that is, the existence of a de facto government, but it took into account only the
economic effects of this situation. The IBRD/IDA report on the economic po-
sition and prospects of Greece in 1969 acknowledged that a military govern-
ment was installed in 1967 and noted that “certain constitutional provisions
on civil rights remain in abeyance, to be made effective at the discretion of the
military authorities.�26 The report evaluated only the economic implications of
this situation, and stated that the economic slowdown that emerged at the end
of 1966 was signi�cantly reinforced by political uncertainties in 1967–68.27 The
way the situation in Greece was treated by the Bank is characteristic of how
the Bank’s staff understood the political prohibition provisions, realizing that
a political situation cannot be taken into account per se but that its economic
implications can be factored into the Bank’s decision making.
In the mid-1960s, the Bank codi�ed certain legal and policy principles for
dealing with de facto governments.28 It subsequently issued more compre-
hensive policies,29 including the current framework provided by Operational
Policy (OP)/Bank Procedure (BP) 7.30—Dealings with de Facto Governments,
issued in July 2001.
25 Consistent with this practice, in 2008, the Bank provided resources drawn from its Food
Price Crisis Trust Fund to �nance a project in Somalia implemented by the Food and Agri-
culture Organization following a request by the UN resident representative in Somalia, and
with the approval of the Bank’s Board.
26 Greece was condemned by the European Commission on Human Rights for violations of
human rights enshrined in the European Convention on Human Rights (ECHR); to avoid
embarrassment, Greece withdrew from the Council of Europe and denounced the ECHR.
27 During the seven years of the military regime, the Bank offered a number of loans to
Greece.
28 During the early years of its existence, the Bank took a rather strict attitude and in certain
cases took the position that it could not properly enter into agreements with the de facto
governments because of their extraconstitutional nature and the absence of parliaments. As
experience with de facto governments accumulated, the Bank’s attitude became more prag-
matic, and loans were made to de facto governments.
29 The �rst principles were issued in 1964; these were revised and restated in Operational Man-
ual Statement (OMS) No. 1.27, issued in June 1978. In 1991, Operational Directive (OD) 7.30
superseded OMS No. 1.27. In November 1994, the Bank replaced OD 7.30 with OP/BP 7.30.
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 65
In determining its attitude toward de facto governments,30 the Bank has
been concerned with the establishment of a proper legal framework for its
loans. Consequently, OP/BP 7.30 states that the Bank’s decision to make a
loan to a de facto government does not constitute “approval,� nor does the
Bank’s refusal to make a loan indicate “disapproval� of the government.31 Ac-
cording to the policy framework, immediately upon the emergence of a de
facto government, the Bank takes three actions. First, it avoids processing any
further withdrawal requests under existing loans, with certain limited excep-
tions, pending consultations with the de facto government.32 Second, it gathers
all relevant information about the status, policies, and public acceptance of the
new government. Third, it initiates an internal process to determine whether
to continue or suspend disbursements under existing loans and whether to
process new operations.33
Under the existing policy, the Bank cannot stop disbursements under ex-
isting loans unless there are grounds for such suspension or termination based
on existing agreements or pragmatic concerns about the de facto government’s
ability and willingness to honor its obligations under the loan agreements.
The situation seems more perplexing with respect to new operations. In this
case, the policy requires that the Bank weigh (a) whether a new lending would
expose the Bank to additional legal or political risks; (b) whether the govern-
ment is in effective control of the country and enjoys a reasonable degree of
stability and public acceptance; (c) whether the government generally recog-
nizes the country’s past international obligations; (d) the number of countries
that have recognized the government or dealt with it as the government of the
country; and (e) the position of other international organizations toward the
government.34
Since 2001, the Bank has applied OP/BP 7.30 to a number of situations
involving coups and other extraconstitutional changes in governments. Most
of these situations arose from military coups, and the Bank’s operational
response varied from case to case.35
In the context of dealing with de facto governments, the Bank has devel-
oped an approach that allows it to take into account a number of factors that
30 Under the current framework, a government is de facto if it comes into, or remains in, power
“by means not provided for in the country’s constitution, such as a coup d’état, revolution,
usurpation, abrogation, or suspension of the constitution.�
31 OP 7.30, paragraph 2. In this connection, the policy notes that the Bank, under its articles, is
required to refrain from interference in the political affairs of any member and may not be
influenced in its decision by the political character of the member or members served.
32 BP 7.30, paragraph 2. The Bank may also reach an informal agreement with the new regime
to withhold disbursements until a decision has been made on dealing with it.
33 Id., at paragraph 1.
34 See OP 7.30, paragraph 5.
35 In some instances, the emergence of de facto governments caused certain institutional and
governance implications, especially in connection with the appointment of governors and
executive directors and annual meeting representation.
66 The World Bank Legal Review
might seem to go beyond its obligation to evaluate only economic consider-
ations but are consistent with the Bank’s will to act as a good and responsible
international citizen.36 OP 7.30 elevates the role of other international organi-
zations, an approach that appears to �t with subsequent regional efforts to
deal with the problem of unconstitutional governments.37 In this respect, it
gives the Bank grounds to consider (formally or informally, implicitly or ex-
plicitly) the decisions of these organizations with respect to unconstitutional
changes occurring in their region.38
Security, Conflicts, and Postconflict Situations
The World Bank was originally established to support the reconstruction of
Europe in the post–World War II period. Although, it quickly moved from re-
construction to development,39 conflicts continued to occur and acquired new
forms. Thus, the operations of the Bank proliferated in countries affected by
conflict. The “R� in IBRD started to obtain a new meaning.40
For many years, the Bank did not have a comprehensive policy on how to
deal with hostilities. It took a case-by-case approach. In deciding whether it
could lend or continue lending to conflict-affected countries, the Bank would
take into account the extent to which (a) the expected bene�ts from the project
would be realized; (b) the borrowing country would be in a position to repay
the loan; (c) the borrowing country could effectively carry out the project; and
(d) Bank staff could safely and regularly visit project areas for purposes of su-
pervision. In that respect, only economic factors appeared to guide the Bank’s
approach toward conflict-affected countries.
In 1997, the Bank endorsed A Framework for World Bank Involvement in
Post-conflict Reconstruction to guide work in postconflict countries, followed
by the adoption of OP 2.30—Development Cooperation and Conflict. Three
main principles guide the Bank’s involvement in conflict-affected areas.41 The
�rst principle is that the Bank should act within the limits of its mandate,
without aspiring to be the “world government� and leaving peacemaking,
peacekeeping, and humanitarian relief to other organizations or donors.42 The
second principle is a reminder of the political prohibition provisions, which
36 OP 7.30, paragraph 2, serves as a reminder of the political prohibition in the Bank’s articles.
37 See Inter-American Democratic Charter (2001); the Declaration on Unconstitutional Changes
of Government (2000)—Lomé Declaration; and the African Charter on Democracy, Elections,
and Governance (2007).
38 This could also be interpreted as an adequate division of core competencies.
39 Mason & Asher, supra note 9, at 52–53. This was mainly due to the development of the
Marshall Plan by the United States, which aimed to support the reconstruction of Europe.
40 Robert B. Zoellick, Speech, Fragile States: Securing Development (International Institute for
Strategic Studies, Geneva, Switzerland, Sep. 12, 2008), available at .
41 Maurizio Ragazzi, The Role of the World Bank in Conflict-Afflicted Areas, 95 Am. Socy. Intl. L.
Proc. 240, 243 (2001).
42 OP 2.30, paragraph 3(a).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 67
require that the Bank refrain from interfering “in the domestic affairs of a
member or from questioning the political character of a member.�43 Although
a corollary of the principle of noninterference is that the Bank cannot oper-
ate in the territory of a member state without its consent, this OP goes a step
further, allowing the international community to invite the Bank to provide
assistance if there is no government in power. The third principle is that the
resources and facilities of the World Bank may be used only for the bene�t of
its member states.44
Besides OP 2.30, the Bank adopted an operational policy (OP/BP 8.50)
to deal with emergencies and crises in 1995.45 This policy was replaced by
OP 8.00—Rapid Response to Crises and Emergencies in 2007; it provides that
the Bank, at the request of the borrower state,46 can “support, in partnership
with other donors, an integrated emergency recovery program that includes
activities outside the Bank’s traditional areas, such as relief, security, and
specialized peace-building.�47
It is important to note that, although OP 8.00 expands the Bank’s work
compared with OP 2.30, the two policies are to be considered together. In ad-
dition, the Bank recognizes the comparative advantage of other organizations
in providing support in the areas of security and political governance (and
humanitarian relief).48 Following are some speci�c examples of the activities
that the Bank has �nanced in postconflict situations.
In relation to peacekeeping, the Bank does not �nance negotiations of
peace accords, political reconciliation processes, or the organization of elec-
tions. However, four speci�c areas within the broader realm of peacebuild-
ing are eligible for the Bank’s support: contributions to peace processes,
contributions to peacebuilding and social and economic stabilization programs,
leadership training, and state building.49
43 Id., at paragraph 3(b). Interestingly, this OP uses slightly different language than IBRD Ar-
ticles of Agreement, Article IV, Section 10; OP 2.30 uses the phrase “domestic affairs,� the
IBRD article, the term “political affairs.� Although the articles are the “constitution� of the
Bank, the choice of different wording in OP 2.30 might constitute a subsequent interpretation
of Article IV, Section 10, endorsed by the Board; see Article 31(3) of the Vienna Convention on
the Law of Treaties.
44 OP 2.30, paragraph 3(c). Under certain requirements, the Bank can and has provided assis-
tance to nonmember states, but this goes beyond the scope of this chapter.
45 OP/BP 8.50—Emergency Recovery Assistance (Aug. 1995).
46 The request could come from the international community if there is no government in power.
47 OP 8.00, paragraph 5.
48 Id., at endnote 7.
49 Examples of involvement in peace processes include Bosnia and Herzegovina and the Day-
ton peace process, Burundi (1999), Sierra Leone (1999), Democratic Republic of Congo and
Rwanda (2002–03), West Bank and Gaza (2005), Kosovo (2005–07). Examples of Bank contri-
butions to integrated peacebuilding and social and economic stabilization programs include
Bosnia and Herzegovina (1994), Timor-Leste (1999), Democratic Republic of Congo (2006),
Afghanistan, Liberia (2006), Haiti, Rwanda (1996), the Greater Lakes Regional Strategy for
Demobilization and Reintegration, and the Democratic Republic of Congo Emergency Ur-
68 The World Bank Legal Review
With respect to humanitarian relief, the Bank generally refrains from pro-
viding support because of the constraints imposed by its mandate and out of
respect for the existing division of powers and the comparative advantage of
other international organizations.50 However, there are no strict divisions be-
tween but rather a continuum in the postemergency phases of recovery from
relief to development. The Bank may thus have a comparative expertise and
may respond to requests for assistance from governments and international
partners, requests that could otherwise be characterized as requests for relief,
where such assistance is in support of affected persons, including cash trans-
fers and other livelihood support to refugees, internally displaced persons,
and demobilized ex-combatants.51
The Bank does not �nance peacekeeping operations, expenditures incurred
by a recipient for military purposes (including the security-related elements
of security sector reform), or the disarmament of combatants. These activities
are left to national governments, bilateral donors, and, where appropriate, the
United Nations. In this regard, the Bank refrains from establishing specialized
trust funds that would �nance only police or other security expenditures.52
However, in responding to requests from member states, donors, and interna-
tional organizations, the Bank has provided �nancial support or administered
donor contributions for demobilization and reintegration programs; under-
taken the responsibilities of a �scal agent to manage trust fund resources in-
tended for certain police-related expenditures; supported the development of
veterans’ policy and pensions; and carried out analytic work relating to the
security sector. The Bank has undertaken these activities in partnership with
other donors or international agencies with expertise in peace and security
matters and within the legal and policy parameters relating to postconflict
and reconstruction assistance.53
Overall, the Bank has developed an active role in conflict and postconflict
situations, with two signi�cant caveats.
ban and Social Rehabilitation Project. Examples of leadership capacity-building activities
include Central African Republic (2004) and Liberia (2006). Examples of Bank involvement
in state building include Sudan and Afghanistan.
50 Legal Opinion from Ana Palacio, senior vice president and group general counsel, Peace-
Building, Security, and Relief Issues under the Bank’s Policy Framework for Rapid Response to Crises
and Emergencies, at paragraph 25 (Mar. 22, 2007).
51 Examples include Turkey’s response to the Marmara earthquake, the Sri Lanka Tsunami
Emergency Recovery Program, and the Pakistan Earthquake Emergency Recovery Credit.
52 According to OP 14.40—Trust Funds, activities �nanced from trust funds should be in keep-
ing with the IBRD and IDA Articles of Agreement.
53 Relevant examples are the Sierra Leone Disarmament, Demobilization, and Reintegration
(DDR) Program (multidonor trust fund), the Rwanda Demobilization and Reintegration Pro-
gram, support to the police through the Afghanistan Reconstruction Trust Fund, the Timor-
Leste Transition Support Program, the West Bank and Gaza Public Financial Management,
the Reform Trust Fund, the Veterans Policy Preparation in Timor-Leste, the Cambodia Public
Expenditure Review, the Central African Republic Public Financial Management Review of
the Security Sector, and the Croatia Social and Economic Recovery Project.
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 69
The �rst is the articulation of activities that the Bank explicitly refuses to
support because it cannot reconcile them with its legitimate mandate and the
requirement to �nance expenditures only for “productive purposes.�54 For ex-
ample, the Bank explicitly does not �nance military expenditures.55 Although
the Bank has declined to �nance military expenditures, it has established guide-
lines under which it can intervene in landmine–clearing activities. As in other
frontier areas of support, the Bank intervention is permitted if the landmine–
clearance activity can be justi�ed on economic grounds, taking into account
the scarcity of �nancial resources; is an integral part of a development project
or a prelude to a future development project or program to be adopted by the
recipient; and is carried out under the responsibility of civilian authorities.
The Bank’s activities in these areas must be triggered either by the mem-
ber states or by other donors and international organizations. The Bank is a
member-driven organization responsive to the necessities and the realities of
the contemporary world, trying to preserve its character as an impartial and
technical �nancial institution.
Criminal Justice Reform
The Bank is increasingly requested to intervene in countries, especial-
ly countries emerging from conflict,56 undertaking reforms in the crimi-
nal justice sector.57 Often recipient countries request the Bank to assist in
restructuring police or prison forces or customs enforcement agencies,
supporting specialized units that deal with unique problems such as
gangs, narcotics, and illegal �shing. In other instances, the Bank has been
requested to intervene in activities aimed at addressing the issue of urban
violence. In considering these requests, the Bank has to draw the line between
permissible and nonpermissible interventions, considering its political prohi-
bition constraints.
54 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article I.
55 “The Bank does not �nance . . . military expenditures, nor does it provide direct support for
disarming combatants.� See OP 6.00—Bank Financing, April 2004, footnote 2. Indeed, the
Bank cannot even consider whether military expenditures at a certain level are appropriate.
In his oral statement at the Board meeting on December 13, 1991, the Bank general counsel
opined that the Bank should not determine the appropriate level of military expenditures
for a country because this is “a matter which is typically based on security and political
considerations, and as such falls . . . outside the Bank’s legally authorized powers, let alone
its competence.� See Shihata, supra note 7, at 218.
56 The importance of strengthening the criminal justice sector so as to assist fragile and conflict-
affected states to break the cycle of violence was highlighted in the 2011 World Development
Report on Conflict, Security, and Development; available at .
57 The criminal justice sector comprises all the institutions, processes, and services responsible
for the prevention, investigation, adjudication, treatment, and response to illegal behaviors.
The sector includes the institutions traditionally associated with it, such as police, prosecu-
tors, public defenders, courts, and prisons, as well as a wide range of other institutions such
as private police, victim services, private lawyers and bar associations, human rights and
ombudsman’s of�ces, addiction treatment programs, and community service programs.
70 The World Bank Legal Review
In at least two instances, Sudan and Afghanistan, the Bank has been in-
volved in supporting police and prisons-related activities carried out by other
agencies. In both cases, funds were provided by donors through multido-
nor trust funds administered by the Bank, whereby the Bank agreed to serve
in a limited capacity as a �scal agent and played no appraisal, supervision,
or monitoring and evaluation role with respect to those activities. In Afghani-
stan, the Bank channeled funds contributed by various donors to the Afghani-
stan Reconstruction Trust Fund, administered by the Bank, to the United
Nations Development Programme (UNDP) for �nancing certain police-
related expenses, including salaries, uniforms, and vehicles of Afghan police.58
The Bank has historically refrained from involvement in criminal justice
because criminal justice is considered to be an exercise of sovereign power,
and thus any involvement would require the Bank to make political judg-
ments. However, selective interventions in the criminal justice sector may fall
within the development purpose of the Bank and thus can be legally permis-
sible if the Bank is satis�ed that the proposed intervention is grounded in an
appropriate and objective economic rationale showing that the intervention is
relevant to the overall economic development of the country in which it is to
be carried out; the risk of political interference is properly assessed; and any
potential risks are appropriately mitigated. The Bank is in the process of de-
veloping an approach to engaging in the criminal justice sector.
In order to mitigate the risks of political interference that any involve-
ment in the criminal justice sector might entail, the Bank generally uses a risk-
management approach. Under this approach, the Bank distinguishes three
categories of activities:
• Activities that likely pose no serious legal issues, for example, public
health activities that target the general population and may include par-
ticipants in the criminal justice sector, such as the prison population or
police, as risk groups; case management systems for courts of general ju-
risdiction; research on crime or criminal justice; and support to help poor
and vulnerable people to deal with the effects of crime.
• Activities that pose serious legal issues, for example, �nancing the pur-
chase of weapons and other lethal equipment and antinarcotics law en-
forcement campaigns, and supporting speci�c law enforcement cases.
Furthermore, this category likely includes areas of criminal justice that en-
tail inherently high risks of political involvement, such as political crimes
or crimes against the state, as well as the investigation, prosecution, and
judgment of persons suspected of terrorist activities.
• “Gray areas� that merit particular attention, for example, the �nancing of
policing, prosecutors, and prisons.
58 Legal Note from Ko-Yung Tung, vice president and general counsel, Police-Related Activi-
ties under the Afghanistan Reconstruction Trust Fund (Mar. 26, 2002) (copy on �le with the
author).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 71
Human Rights
The debate about human rights in the Bank’s policies and operations is not
new, and much has been written about this issue.59 In the early years, both the
Bank and the IMF took the position that human rights fall outside their �eld
of work.60 However, two instances forced the Bank to seriously reflect upon its
position toward human rights.61
The �rst one was in the 1960s, when the UN General Assembly recom-
mended that the Bank suspend lending to Portugal and South Africa because
of their colonial and apartheid policies.62 The legal dispute that followed was
centered on the interpretation of the Bank’s political prohibition and the Rela-
tionship Agreement between the Bank and the United Nations.63 The Bank at
that time adopted a very narrow interpretation of its Articles of Agreement,
arguing that the “policies and the conduct which are being condemned by
the General Assembly constitute an essential element of the ‘political char-
acter’ of those States� and the Bank “may and does take into consideration,
and is influenced in its lending decisions by, the economic effects which
stem from the political character of a member and from the censures and
condemnations of that member by United Nations organs.� The Bank also
stressed that it “must consider such economic effects together with all other
relevant economic factors, in the light of the purposes of the Organization.
What it is precluded from considering is the political character of a member as
an independent criterion for decision.�64
59 For one of the �rst comprehensive approaches to this issue, see Victoria E. Marmorstein,
World Bank Power to Consider Human Rights Factors in Loan Decisions, 13 J. Intl. L. & Econ.
113 (1978). See also John D. Ciorciari, The Lawful Scope of Human Rights Criteria in World Bank
Credit Decisions: An Interpretive Analysis of the IBRD and IDA Articles of Agreement, 33 Cornell
Intl. L.J. 331 (2000); Sigrun Skogly, The Human Rights Obligations of the World Bank and the
International Monetary Fund (Cavendish 2001); Dana L. Clark, The World Bank and Human
Rights: The Need for Greater Accountability, 15 Harv. Hum. Rights J. 205 (2002); Korinna Horta,
Rhetoric and Reality: Human Rights and the World Bank, 15 Harv. Hum. Rights J. 227 (2002);
Mac Darrow, Between Light and Shadow: The World Bank, the International Monetary Fund and
International Human Rights Law (Hart 2003); Bahram Ghazi, The IMF, the World Bank Group and
the Question of Human Rights (Transnational 2005); Margot E. Salomon, International Economic
Governance and Human Rights Accountability, in Casting the Net Wider: Human Rights, Develop-
ment and New Duty-Bearers 153 (Margot E. Salomon, Arne Tostensen, & Wouter Vandenhole
ed., Intersentia 2007).
60 It is characteristic that the Bretton Woods institutions refused to participate at the negotia-
tions of the International Covenant on Economic, Social, and Cultural Rights in the early
1950s, even though they constitute UN specialized agencies; see François Gianviti, Economic,
Social and Cultural Human Rights and the International Monetary Fund, in Non-state Actors and
Human Rights 113, 114 (Philip Alston ed., Oxford U. Press 2005).
61 Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, The World Bank and Human Rights: An Analysis of the Legal Issues and the
Records of Achievements, 17 Denv. J. Int. L. & Policy 39, 40–48 (1988).
62 For an overview of the UN-Bank dispute, see Samuel A. Bleicher, UN v. IBRD: A Dilemma of
Functionalism, 24 Intl. Org. 31 (1970).
63 Agreement between the United Nations and the International Bank for Reconstruction and
Development, November 15, 1947, 16 U.N.T.S. 346.
64 Comments of the Legal Department on the United Nations Con�dential Memorandum
on “The International Bank for Reconstruction and Development and Implementation of
72 The World Bank Legal Review
Although the debate was not framed in terms of a possible obligation of
the Bank to respect human rights, the Bank believed that it was not allowed
under its mandate to use the human rights record of a government as a crite-
rion for making loan decisions. It did, however, stop lending to South Africa
and Portugal, invoking reasons not related to the political situation of these
countries.65
A decade after this controversy, the Bank was again confronted with the
issue of human rights in its borrowing countries when the United States en-
acted legislation that authorized and instructed the U.S. executive director to
oppose any loan agreement to a country with a consistent pattern of gross
human rights violations. This legislation posed the question of whether the
Bank’s political prohibition covers the activities of the executive directors.
Although the Legal Department answered this question in the af�rmative,
it noted that there was no legal sanction to challenge the vote of an executive
director motivated by political considerations.66
In the above two instances, the Bank was clearly reluctant to include hu-
man rights considerations in its mandate. However, it has not been indifferent
to these concerns. Indeed, the Bank has long funded studies and operations
that promote social, economic, and cultural rights such as health, education,
freedom from poverty, and employment. It has also influenced the status of
vulnerable groups such as women, children, indigenous people, and refu-
gees.67 Some critics of the Bank’s record on human rights acknowledge that the
Bank’s role has been focused more on promoting social and economic rights
and less on promoting civil and political rights;68 these critics have expressed
concern about the lack of a consistent and comprehensive human rights policy
in the Bank’s practice.69
United Nations General Assembly Resolutions to Withhold Assistance of Any Kind to the
Governments of Portugal and South Africa� (May 4, 1967), available at United Nations
Juridical Y.B. 108, 124 (1967).
65 Shihata, supra note 61, at 44.
66 Id., at 45–46. This argument highlights the fact that the Bank could implicitly take into ac-
count human rights considerations, if that was the true will of its member states.
67 Id., at 48–65.
68 However, there is research showing that substantial violations of political and civil rights
are related to lower economic growth; see Robert J. Barro, Determinants of Economic Growth:
A Cross-Country Empirical Study (MIT Press 1997). In addition, the distinction between the
two sets of rights is not accepted under the principles of indivisibility, interdependency, and
interrelatedness; see Vienna Declaration and Programme for Action, UN Doc. A/CONF.157/
23 (1993).
69 Daniel D. Bradlow, The World Bank, the IMF, and Human Rights, 6 Transnatl. L. & Contemp.
Probs. 47 (1996).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 73
Ibrahim Shihata argues that “the Bank may even take political human
rights violations into account if they are so pervasive and repugnant as to clear-
ly affect the country’s investment climate and its economic performance.�70
In line with this more “careful� approach toward civil and political rights,
Shihata suggests that the Bank “may not pursue the �nancing of a project if
the freedom of speech and assembly required� for the purposes of “consulta-
tion with the local NGOs and participation of affected people in the design of
many projects to be �nanced by the Bank� is lacking.71
The above developments, the debate over the relationship between
human rights and development,72 and the fact that some bilateral donors and
other multilateral agencies have adopted human rights “as the normative
foundation of their aid policies�73 have led the World Bank to reexamine its
views on these issues and inquire to what extent it should follow this trend.
Indeed, in the past decade, the Bank’s of�cials have been more active in speak-
ing openly about human rights. James Wolfensohn, president of the World Bank
at the time, said in a paper published in 2005 that the Bank might need to mention
more often the “R� word: “rights.�74 The Bank’s general counsel at the time also
promoted human rights inside the Bank.75 In 2005, he was asked by senior man-
agement to explore the extent to which human rights considerations would be
consistent with the Bank’s mandate. This request resulted in a January 2006 note,
Legal Opinion on Human Rights and the Work of the World Bank, which concluded that
“the Articles of Agreement permit, and in some cases require, the Bank to recog-
nize the human rights dimensions of its development policies and activities, since
it is now evident that human rights are an intrinsic part of the Bank’s mission.�76
Although outsiders considered that this opinion had a limited impact
inside the Bank,77 a former bank general counsel, Ana Palacio, has acknowl-
edged that the above-mentioned legal opinion
70 Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, The Dynamic Evolution of International Organizations: The Case of the World
Bank, 2 J. of the Hist. of Intl. L. 217, 246 (2000).
71 Id.
72 Philip Alston, Ships Passing in the Night: The Current State of the Human Rights and Develop-
ment Debate Seen through the Lens of the Millennium Development Goals, 27 Hum. Rights Q. 755
(2005).
73 Arne Tostensen, The Bretton Woods Institutions: Human Rights and the PRSPs, in Casting the Net
Wider: Human Rights, Development and New Duty-Bearers 185, 185 (Margot E. Salomon, Arne
Tostensen, & Wouter Vandenhole ed., Intersentia 2007).
74 James D. Wolfensohn, Some Reflections on Human Rights and Development, in Human Rights and
Development: Towards Mutual Enforcement 19, 22 (Philip Alston & Mary Robinson ed., Oxford
U. Press 2005).
75 Roberto Dañino, Legal Aspects of the World Bank’s Work on Human Rights, in Human Rights and
Development: Towards Mutual Enforcement 509 (Philip Alston & Mary Robinson ed., Oxford U.
Press 2005).
76 This legal note was never adopted by the Board. For this reason, it does not represent an
of�cial policy of the Bank.
77 Galit A. Sarfaty, Why Culture Matters in International Institutions: The Marginality of Human
Rights at the World Bank, 103 Am. J. Intl. L. 647, 665 (2009).
74 The World Bank Legal Review
marks a clear evolution from the pre-existing restrictive legal inter-
pretation of the Bank’s explicit consideration of human rights. It is
“permissive�: allowing, but not mandating, action on the part of the
Bank in relation to human rights. It clari�es “the state of the law,�
and gives the Bank the necessary leeway to explore its proper role
in relation to human rights, updating the legal stance adopted inter-
nally to accord with the Bank’s practice and the current international
legal context. It facilitates a more comprehensive understanding of
human rights in development, and enables the Bank to take these
issues into account where they are relevant. Finally, it represents a
point of departure for future legal analysis on human rights by the
Legal Vice-Presidency as well as my own thinking on this matter as
General Counsel of the World Bank Group.78
In addition, the Bank established the Nordic Trust Fund, which stands
as a �rst major initiative, at the programmatic level, of the Bank in the area
of human rights. To reconcile this development with the Bank’s obligation of
noninterference, the Bank argued that there is scope for the Bank to engage in
human rights provided that engagement is undertaken in a nonpartisan, non-
ideological, and neutral manner and the reason for the engagement is related
to activities the Bank aims to support. This thinking reflects mainstream views
that the notion of sovereignty has evolved under international law and that
certain norms penetrate national boundaries (e.g., corruption, environmental
hazards, and war crimes).79
Despite the recent developments, the of�cial approach of the Bank toward
human rights
is based on outlining the substantive and factual ways in which its
activities overlap with the human rights through the reach of Bank
projects and program areas touching upon human rights . . . the ap-
proach acknowledges the substantive interrelatedness of human
rights and development but remains non explicit in terms of the
direct or formal relevance of speci�c duties or international treaty
obligations.80
As an interim conclusion, one could argue that the political prohibition
is an important hurdle, but not the only hurdle, on a case-by-case or
project-by-project basis to the Bank’s engagement with human rights. What
remains to be seen is the potential reaction of the member states if the Bank
were to take a position on human rights at a corporate level, for instance,
should there be a proposal for the adoption of a comprehensive Bank human
78 Ana Palacio, The Way Forward: Human Rights and the World Bank (Oct. 2006), available at
.
79 Dañino, supra note 75, at 517–20.
80 Siobhán McInerney-Lankford & Hans-Otto Sano, Human Rights Indicators in Development: An
Introduction 6 (World Bank 2010).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 75
rights policy.81 It is important to note that states are bound by their treaty-
based human rights obligations even when they act as members of the World
Bank.82 In this respect, some critics have argued that it is important to achieve
“international policy coherence,� which demands “coherence across policies
governing different issues, as well as coherence in terms of their engagement
with and participation in international organizations and processes.�83
Governance, Participation, and Engagement
with Bilateral Donors, Multilateral Agencies, and NGOs
Another issue connected to human rights is that of promoting democracy.84
The Bank has been extremely cautious in addressing this issue. Although it is
accepted that there is a link between democracy and development, the actual
involvement of the Bank in the promotion of democracy could lead the Bank
into politically charged areas that go beyond its mandate and competence.85
Indeed, the Bank explicitly does not support activities such as orga-
nizing or assisting political parties or setting up, monitoring, and running
elections because these endeavors could collectively be seen as promoting
democracy, and are thus considered to imply an inherently high risk of
political interference.86
However, the Bank and its member countries have recognized the links
between governance, corruption, growth, and poverty reduction.87 In that
context, the Bank has recently sought to strengthen its engagement on the
demand side of governance,88 requiring engagement with government and a
81 President Wolfensohn has said that “to some of our shareholders the very mention of human
rights is inflammatory language�; James D. Wolfensohn, Some Reflections on Human Rights
and Development, in Human Rights and Development: Towards Mutual Enforcement 19, 21 (Philip
Alston & Mary Robinson ed., Oxford U. Press 2005).
82 See Article 60 of the Draft Articles on the Responsibility of International Organizations;
see International Law Commission Report on the Work of Its Sixty-First Session (May 4–
Jun. 5 and Jul. 6–Aug. 7, 2009) UN GAOR, 64th Sess., Supp. No. 10, at paragraph 50, UN Doc.
A/64/10 (2009).
83 Siobhán McInerney-Lankford, International Financial Institutions and Human Rights, in Inter-
national Financial Institutions and International Law 239, 265 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B.
Hunter ed., Kluwer Law International 2010).
84 There is an interesting discussion on whether there is a human right to democracy that goes
beyond the scope of this chapter; see, inter alia, Thomas Franck, The Emerging Right to Demo-
cratic Governance, 86 Am. J. Intl. L. 46 (1992), and Democratic Governance and International Law
(Gregory H. Fox & Brad R. Roth ed., Cambridge U. Press 2000).
85 Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, Democracy and Development, 46 Intl. & Comp. L.Q. 635 (1997).
86 World Bank Group, Guidance Note on Bank Multi-stakeholder Engagement, at paragraph 16
(Jun. 2009).
87 World Bank Group, Operations Policy and Country Services, Implementation Plan for Strengthening
World Bank Group Engagement on Governance and Anticorruption, at paragraph 4 (Sep. 28, 2007).
88 “A governance system comprises a wide variety of processes, systems, organizations, and
rules (that is, institutions) on the public bureaucracy ‘supply’ side and on the ‘demand’
side through which non-executive oversight institutions and citizens hold the bureaucracy
accountable for performance�; id., at paragraph 1.
76 The World Bank Legal Review
wide range of other stakeholders, including parliaments, the media sector, and
civil society, but always inside the limits of the political prohibition clause.
More speci�cally, the Bank has been engaged with parliaments in helping
to strengthen responses to the poverty reduction strategy process and to un-
derstand the Bank’s policies and practices. It has provided nonpartisan, tech-
nical capacity building and training to parliaments and parliamentary staff
to help them ful�ll their responsibilities, for instance, with regard to public
accountability committees, their oversight role over government policy im-
plementation, the budgetary process, and ensuring greater transparency in
decision making.89 This support is provided on a nonpartisan basis to the par-
liament as an institution and does not, either by design or in practice, alter
the existing division of power or favor particular political members or forces
within the institution.90
The main guidance in all these activities is that the Bank seek to avoid any
involvement in partisan politics, which could be seen as the outer limit of the
political prohibition clause.91
Moving away from the domestic level toward the �eld of cooperation
between international actors, the Bank has been working with other donors
in the spirit of the Paris Declaration on Aid Effectiveness (2005) in coordi-
nating its development assistance to member countries. The mechanism is
captured in a memorandum of understanding (MoU) or other nonbinding
instruments—however designated. These instruments commit the donors to
provide assistance, often in the form of budget support,92 over the course of
years. Occasionally, donors want certain principles that seem to fly in the face
89 For example, members of parliament from Ghana and Kiribati, building on their participa-
tion in training activities organized by the World Bank Institute and its partner institutions,
have developed action plans and introduced new oversight mechanisms in their national
system that have strengthened the capacity of government institutions.
90 World Bank Group, Guidance Note on Bank Multi-stakeholder Engagement, at paragraph 30
(Jun. 2009).
91 Id., at paragraph 15.
92 From designation in the articles, as lending provided in special circumstances (as opposed
to more standard investment lending), development policy lending (DPL, previously known
as structural adjustment lending) has assumed a growing importance in the institution, par-
ticularly following the oil crisis of 1979 and debt crisis of the 1980s. See Andres Rigo Sureda,
Informality and Effectiveness in the Operation of the World Bank, 6 J. Intl. Econ. L. 565, 570 (2003).
The growth of DPL coincided with a growing involvement of the Bank in policy decision
making in the member countries. In effect, DPL involves loans provided in exchange for
good policies as de�ned by the lending institution. Occasionally, a policy action that has po-
litical overtones (touching on such subjects as governance, corruption, public participation)
will slip in as conditionality; to avoid having to include conditionality with political over-
tone, the Bank has insisted on picking from a matrix of conditionalities agreed to with other
donors only those conditionalities that are relevant to its economic development mandate. In
this connection, the former general counsel of the Bank acknowledges that in their attempt
to do what in their judgment is “essential for effective [development policy] lending� Bank
staff often “�nd it relevant or useful to take certain political considerations into account� and
indeed “[a]t times, they are blamed if they fail to do so.� Shihata, supra note 7, at 220.
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 77
of the Bank’s political prohibition constraints. In other instances, bilateral do-
nors demand that the recipient government include previously marginalized
groups as a prerequisite for resumption of �nancial assistance, particularly in
countries emerging from (or at risk of falling into) violent civil conflict. An-
other challenge arises when donors seek to invoke the clause of the MoU to
suspend disbursement and expect the Bank to do the same, notwithstanding
its political prohibition clause.
The Bank response has been to sign these MoUs but to invoke the political
prohibition clause in seeking to free itself from provisions of these memo-
randa that involve interference with political affairs of member countries. It
has likewise insisted on refraining from exercising its remedies on the basis of
political considerations; the Bank would not, for example, suspend disburse-
ment because the new government came into power through an election that,
in the overwhelming opinion of the international community, was not free
and fair. The Bank is required to exercise caution “when supporting broad or
integrated programs and participating in donor partnerships� to avoid be-
ing perceived as “encouraging other donors to take particular positions on
matters that are outside the Bank’s mandate� and to ensure that it does not
endorse or appear to endorse “controversial program components or activi-
ties . . . that are inconsistent with the political prohibition.�93 In this regard,
in instances in which the Bank has found itself chairing donor meetings in
a country, the Bank has declined from serving as a conduit for political mes-
sages from bilateral donors to recipient governments.
The need to coordinate with other agencies is relevant when a multilateral
agency or regional organization adopts a decision imposing economic sanc-
tions on countries where the Bank has operations. As a legal matter, the Bank
is an independent international organization not bound by decisions of any
other multilateral entity. However, it is required to pay due regard to the UN
Security Council’s decisions made under Chapter VII of the UN Charter and
to take note of its members’ obligations to comply with those decisions.94
Several UN Security Council resolutions have been made under Chap-
ter VII of the UN Charter that target the Bank’s member countries. However,
few refer speci�cally to the Bank or international �nancial institutions.95 The
resolutions that do, tend not to articulate clear and speci�c action that the Bank
needs to take to comply with the resolution or direct the Bank to act in a man-
ner inconsistent with its developmental mandate.96 In any event, if the Bank
93 Legal Opinion from Ana Palacio, senior vice president and group general counsel, Peace-
Building, Security, and Relief Issues under the Bank’s Policy Framework for Rapid Response to Crises
and Emergencies, at paragraph 19 (Mar. 22, 2007).
94 Article VI of Agreement between the United Nations and the International Bank for Recon-
struction and Development, 16 United Nations Treaty Series 346 (1948).
95 See, for example, UN SCOR, 58th Sess., 4761st mtg., UN Doc. S/RES/1483 (2003).
96 See, for example, UN SCOR, 62d Sess., 5647th mtg., UN Doc. S/RES/1747 (2007), which
called upon international �nancial institutions not to provide new �nancial assistance to
Iran except for humanitarian and developmental purposes.
78 The World Bank Legal Review
were to take action pursuant to its obligation to pay due regard to a Security
Council decision, it would also have the obligation to ensure that its action
was consistent with its articles, in particular the purposes provision and the
political prohibition.
Fraud, Corruption, and Stolen Asset Recovery
The Bank’s engagement with corruption is a long and interesting story. Presi-
dent Wolfensohn said that the general counsel once informed him that he was
not allowed to use the “C� word.97 Although prevention of corruption seems to
have always been a legitimate objective of the Bank with respect to its lending
operations,98 it became a major issue in the Bank’s development agenda only
in 1996.99 Because corruption is widely perceived as a matter of governance,100
and the Bank had already been involved in the governance sector,101 the Bank
did not provoke great controversy when it explained why it was legitimate for
the Bank to deal with the “cancer of corruption.�
When explaining the Bank’s involvement in addressing corruption issues,
the general counsel cautioned that the Bank is not a “world government�: “its
role as a world reformer� should not go beyond its de�ned purposes, and should
avoid “complex political considerations.� However, the Bank did develop the
operational experience “to deal with a large number of governance and insti-
tutional issues which have direct relevance to its development mandate, with-
out entanglement in partisan domestic politics and corruption had become a
97 Wolfensohn, supra note 81, at 22.
98 See IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article III, Section 5(b). In 1966, in the context of the dispute
with the UN over the loans to Portugal and South Africa, when the Bank adopted a very
restrictive interpretation of the political prohibition provision, the general counsel hinted
that corruption could be taken into account when making loan decisions. Responding to an
observation by the representative of Zambia, who had heard “of countries applying for loans
which had not been forthcoming because of alleged extravagance, corruption or bad plan-
ning,� the general counsel said that “the extravagance mentioned might have been caused
by a policy of national or military prestige, or might have been merely a way of life. Cor-
ruption would, of course, cut down on the use of resources. Some countries could obviously
afford to sin a little, economically, and still progress, while others were forced to make the
most, in every sense, of what they had. The situation was that all factors were taken into
consideration and a judgment reached with which an observer was then free to agree or
disagree.�
99 In the 1996 annual meetings address, President Wolfensohn publicly committed to “deal
with the cancer of corruption.� The 1997 World Development Report entitled “The State
in a Changing World� contains a chapter on corruption; it was followed by the influential
publication “Helping Countries Combat Corruption: The Role of the World Bank.�
100 Joel S. Hellman et al., Measuring Governance, Corruption, and State Capture: How Firms and Bu-
reaucrats Shape the Business Environment in Transition Economies, World Bank Policy Research
Working Paper No. 2312, at 4 (Apr. 2000); Susan Rose-Ackerman, Governance and Corruption,
in Global Crises, Global Solutions 301 (Bjørn Lomborg ed., Cambridge U. Press 2004).
101 One of the �rst Bank reports to mention the issue of governance was “Sub-Saharan Africa—
From Crisis to Sustainable Growth: A Long Term Perspective Study� (�rst published in Nov.
1989).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 79
major issue of development policy, the Bank could take action in relation to
the �ght against corruption.�102
This evolution has been viewed as an example of reconciling the Bank’s
mandate with a politically charged issue. Susan Rose-Ackerman argues that
“an explicit concern with corruption is consistent with a focus on economic
rationality and is one way to counter some of the political pressures faced by
the Bank.�103
The Bank developed both remedial measures to investigate and sanction
activities involving fraud and corruption and preventive measures aimed
at fostering an environment in which instances of fraud and corruption are
reduced.104 A recent development in the Bank’s �ght against corruption that
appears to be in tension with the political prohibition is the Stolen Asset Re-
covery (StAR) Initiative.
This joint initiative between the Bank and the UN Of�ce on Drugs and
Crime (UNODC) focuses on helping developing countries recover assets sto-
len by corrupt of�cials and hidden abroad. The initiative was launched on
September 17, 2007, in recognition of the concept that asset recovery is a critical
component of anticorruption efforts and is strongly linked to development.105
The key risk related to the StAR Initiative arises from the fact that asset re-
covery is pursued by national authorities in a highly politicized environment.
Often a new government pursues corruption charges (and asset recovery ef-
forts) against individuals linked with a predecessor government dominated
by an opposing political party or faction. This means that sometimes political
vendetta—rather than commitment to rule of law—is a key motivating factor
for such prosecutions. Thus, the Bank’s involvement in the StAR Initiative
could expose it to interfering, or being perceived as interfering, with domestic
partisan politics in violation of the political prohibition clause. Equally sig-
ni�cant, the Bank could risk interfering with the foreign political affairs of
a member if it takes sides (or appears to do so) with one member country (or
group of countries) against another country (or group of countries).
To manage these risks, the Bank has operational guidelines for country as-
sistance in support of asset recovery activities at the country level. The guide-
lines limit the Bank’s involvement in asset recovery to activities of a prepara-
tory nature (mostly fact �nding and advice) and require that staff refrain from
102 Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, Corruption: A General Review with an Emphasis on the Role of the World
Bank, 15 Dick. J. Intl. L. 451, 475–76 (1997).
103 Susan Rose-Ackerman, The Role of the World Bank in Controlling Corruption, 29 L. & Policy Intl.
Bus. 93, 94 (1997–98).
104 For a recent Bank initiative in sanctioning fraud and corruption, see Stephen S. Zimmer-
mann & Frank A. Fariello, Jr., Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption: Agreement
on Cross-Debarment among Multilateral Development Banks, this volume.
105 For an overview of the StAR Initiative, see Theodore S. Greenberg et al., Stolen Asset Recovery:
A Good Practices Guide for Non-conviction Based Asset Forfeiture (World Bank 2009).
80 The World Bank Legal Review
getting involved in any case-speci�c law enforcement activities. In addition,
the initiative was designed such that certain activities that pose unacceptable
political interference risks for the Bank are carried out exclusively by UNODC,
with the Bank playing a limited �scal agency role.
Nonlending Decisions
There have been several cases in which the Bank decided not to lend to coun-
tries for factors that do not appear to be purely economic, referred to in Bank
parlance as “nonlending.� Examples of nonlending due to noneconomic con-
siderations can be found in the early practice of the Bank. In the �rst years
of its operations, the Bank denied lending to Poland, despite the fact that
economic considerations seemed favorable, because the U.S. executive
director informed the Bank’s president that he would vote against the loan
proposal. The Third Annual Report (1947–48) stated with regard to the non-
lending decision in regard to Poland that
the Bank is fully cognizant of the injunction in its Articles of Agree-
ment that its decisions shall be based only on economic consider-
ations. Political tensions and uncertainties in or among its member
countries, however, have a direct effect on economic and �nancial
conditions in those countries and upon their credit position.
This led to the subsequent withdrawal of Poland from the institution.106
The reduction of lending to both India and Pakistan after the 1998 nuclear
weapons tests is also a case in point. The distinction between various forms
of nonlending decisions and their relationship to political prohibition is well
articulated by Andres Rigo Sureda:
Non-lending has been seized by commentators as an indication of
the politicization of decision making in the Bank. While in general
non-lending or diminished lending would be for economic reasons,
the non-presentation to the Board of operations which have been prepared
and that in the Management’s judgment are sound, may be prompted by
shareholders’ politically motivated pressure on Management. [emphasis
added]107
Summary of Bank Practice
Bank practice with respect to political prohibition can be summarized as fol-
lows: The political prohibition clause imposes two broad constraints on Bank
operations. First, the Bank is prohibited from interfering in the internal affairs
of a member. This means the Bank must refrain from interfering in partisan
106 A similar story occurred with respect to a loan proposal from Czechoslovakia; see Mason &
Asher, supra note 9, at 170–71. In the early 1970s, after Salvador Allende won the presidential
elections of Chile, the Bank did not approve any new loans to this country during his presi-
dency. The Bank was criticized for aligning with the U.S. policy, but there is no conclusive
evidence to support this claim; see Brown, supra note 6, at 157–70.
107 Rigo Sureda, supra note 92, at 588.
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 81
political affairs. It cannot favor, or appear to favor, one side in political or ideo-
logical disputes. Second, the Bank is required to ensure that only economic
considerations (weighed impartially in order to achieve the Bank’s purposes)
are relevant to its decisions. This means that all activities that the Bank under-
takes must be grounded on an appropriate and objective economic rationale.
Relying on this two-part test, the Bank has refrained from �nancing military
expenditures and direct law enforcement, including investigation and pros-
ecution of speci�c individual cases.
The Criticism of the Political Prohibition Clause
The decades-long practice of the Bank and its position on the political prohibi-
tion clause have triggered two-pronged criticism. On the one hand, the Bank
has been accused of creeping politicization because of the expansion of its
mandate. On the other hand, the Bank has been accused of invoking political
prohibition as a constraint. Both criticisms are based on the “mission creep� of
the Bank, but there is a distinction between those arguing against the mission
creep per se and those arguing against the direction of the mission creep.108
The Creeping Politicization of the World Bank
Critics have claimed that the Bank has added too many tasks to its agenda. It
has, the critics allege, moved too far beyond its original mandate, hampering
its effectiveness. The prescribed remedy is for the Bank to reverse direction
and return to its basic mandate.109
Mission creep affects not only the Bank’s effectiveness but also its tech-
nical and nonpolitical character. In other words, mission creep results in a
creeping politicization. This has been argued particularly with respect to the
Bank’s work in the �ght against corruption.110 In this respect, the Bank has
been perceived, through its activities in governance and anticorruption, to
make recommendations on democratization.111 The main argument is that the
Bank promotes “the idea that good governance was a precondition for eco-
nomic growth, including accountable and transparent decision-making, an
independent judiciary, a free press, increased popular participation through
a vital civil society and, �nally, a commitment to combating corruption,� but
“has stopped short of calling this ‘democracy.’�112
The mission creep of the Bank, which has been made possible by the expan-
sive interpretation of the political prohibition clause, has also been criticized
108 John Head, Law and Policy in International Financial Institutions: The Changing Role of Law in the
IMF and the Multilateral Development Banks, 17 Kan. J.L. & Pub. Pol. 194, 205 (2007/08).
109 Jessica Einhorn, The World Bank’s Mission Creep, 80(5) Foreign Affairs 22 (Sep.–Oct. 2001).
110 Heather Marquette, The Creeping Politicisation of the World Bank: The Case of Corruption, 52 Pol.
Studs. 413 (2004).
111 Id., at 427.
112 Id., at 419.
82 The World Bank Legal Review
by advocates of the Third World Approaches to International Law (TWAIL).
For instance, Bhupinder Chimni has argued that
through the different interpretative moves, the Bank’s actions give
meaning to the term “political� in a way that serves the purpose of
the powerful Member States. First, it de�nes “political� in a manner
that the “non-economic� interests of advanced capitalist states are
subsumed under the rubric of “economic� decision-making. Second,
the term “political� is assigned a meaning that disregards the impli-
cations of the Bank agenda and the conditionalities prescribed for
principles of sovereignty and non-intervention in the internal affairs
of states.113
The creeping politicization has been seen as a deviation from the Bank’s
mandate and from the perception that it acts as an independent and techno-
cratic organization. In this respect, critics argue, politicization leads to a legiti-
macy crisis for the Bank.114
The criticism of creeping politicization implies two different things. First,
it means that the Bank takes political factors into account when making deci-
sions about lending, and due to the existence of a weighted voting system is
seen as promoting the interests of powerful states.115 Second, it implies that
some of the Bank’s activities extend to areas that affect the political affairs of
its borrowing states.
The Political Prohibition Invoked as a Constraint
Other critics are more concerned about the content of the mission creep and
about the fact that the expansion of the Bank’s activities is not accompanied
by a similar expansion of its responsibilities.116 This criticism is mostly related
to the Bank’s refusal to take human rights considerations into account when
deciding to make loans. This position has resulted in some rather uncomfort-
able situations. For example, the World Bank issued a report on development
in Rwanda in 1994 as the genocide was ongoing. The report took note of the
massacres, but went on with speci�c recommendations.117
113 Bhupinder S. Chimni, IFIs and International Law: A Third World Perspective, in International
Financial Institutions and International Law 30, 40 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed.,
Kluwer Law International 2010).
114 Antony Anghie, International Financial Institutions, in The Politics of International Law 217, 235
(Christian Reus-Smit ed., Cambridge U. Press, 2004).
115 It is interesting to note that President McNamara signed a letter to the U.S. Congress making
a commitment that the Bank would not provide any loan to Vietnam for the �scal year 1980,
in light of a proposed bill that would impose restrictions on the use of the U.S. contributions;
see Brown, supra note 6, at 173–90; Devesh Hapur, John P. Lewis, & Richard Webb, The World
Bank: Its First Half Century vol. 1, 1150 (Brookings Institute 1997).
116 Daniel D. Bradlow, International Law and Operations of the IFIs, in International Financial Insti-
tutions and International Law 1, 16 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed., Kluwer Law
International 2010).
117 William Easterly, The White Man’s Burden: Why the West’s Efforts to Aid the Rest Have Done So
Much Ill and So Little Good 151 (Penguin Press 2006).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 83
The main criticism from this camp is that, due to the ambiguity of the
political prohibition clause, the Bank’s decisions as to whether to �nance par-
ticular projects appear to be arbitrary.118 This ambiguity is enhanced by the
imprecise way in which the political prohibition clause is interpreted by the
Bank’s general counsel.119
Although the political prohibition clause is often invoked as the rationale
for the Bank’s reluctance to explicitly take into account human rights when it
�nances a project, it does not constitute the only explanation of the Bank’s po-
sition. In the �rst place, as an international organization with a separate legal
personality, the Bank is not a party to any human rights treaty, and its human
rights obligations under customary international law remain unclear.120 In ad-
dition, �nancing decisions might be affected by the Bank’s capacity to address
human rights matters, given the comparative advantage and the speci�city of
functions of different international organizations operating in a complemen-
tary fashion.
Human rights is not the only area in which the Bank has been reluctant
to engage fully. The Bank is not involved in peacekeeping, mainly because of
the political prohibition clause. Thus, some critics argue that the Bank should
adopt a narrow interpretation of the term “political� that will allow early
engagement with peace operations.121
These two types of criticism have led scholars to argue that the political
prohibition clause in the Bank’s articles is an “organizational myth� and that
“the point about such a myth is not whether it is true or false, but that it plays an
essential role in an institution’s self-conception and quest for legitimacy.�122
Tools for Evolving the Political Prohibition Clause
Changing Bank practice with respect to the political prohibition would
require either amending the Articles of Agreement or expanding the interpre-
tation (whether formal or informal) of the clause.
Challenges of Following an Unexplored Path: Amendment
At �rst glance, amendment appears to be the appropriate way to deal with
the matter. Amending the Bank’s articles is not a simple process, however. To
amend the IBRD articles, the approval by the Board of Governors is required,
118 Daniel D. Bradlow, The World Bank, the IMF, and Human Rights, 6 Transnatl. L. & Contemp.
Probs. 47, 61 (1996).
119 Bradlow, supra note 116, at 14.
120 For a discussion of the human rights obligations of the Bank, which falls outside the purview
of the present study, see Bradlow, supra note 116, at 17–23.
121 John D. Ciorciari, A Prospective Enlargement of the Roles of the Bretton Woods Financial Institu-
tions in International Peace Operations, 22 Fordham Intl. L.J. 292 (1998–99).
122 Michelle Miller-Adams, The World Bank: New Agendas in a Changing World 22 (Routledge
1999).
84 The World Bank Legal Review
as well as acceptance by 60 percent of IBRD members holding 80 percent of
the total voting power.123 Given these stringent requirements, it is not surpris-
ing that only two sets of amendments have been approved with respect to
the IBRD articles and none for the IDA articles. Considering that the politi-
cal prohibition clause touches on an issue on which little consensus seems to
exist among member countries, it is doubtful whether suf�cient votes could
be mustered to effect the requisite amendment. Even if they could, there is a
danger that introducing amendments to the articles of both institutions might
encourage shareholders to introduce their own amendments, with unforeseen
implications for the institution.124
The Long-Standing Practice but Limited Option: Interpretation
Likewise, there are limits to the desirability and practicability of expanding
the scope of the Bank’s mandate through Board-endorsed interpretations of
its mandate issued by the Bank’s general counsel. Article 31 of the Vienna
Convention on the Law of Treaties, which is widely held as reflecting custom-
ary international law on the question of interpretation of treaties, requires
treaties to be interpreted “in good faith in accordance with the ordinary mean-
ing to be given to the terms of the treaty in their context.�125 One would thus
�nd it dif�cult to develop a legally defensible basis for the general counsel to
reinterpret a provision of a treaty whose language is clearly prohibitive. To
paraphrase Heribert Golsong, a former general counsel of the Bank who has
weighed in on this issue, any decision under a provision of the IBRD articles
dealing with interpretation that would lead to a change in the ordinary mean-
ing of the articles would constitute an abuse of the power of interpretation
and should be made subject to the formal amendment procedure.126 More-
over, as a practical matter, even in cases where the provisions of the articles
could plausibly be read in a more expansive and permissive manner, such
an interpretation could nonetheless face pushback from the country mem-
bers (viz., executive directors) who have the ultimate say in how the articles
should be interpreted.127
Using interpretation as a tool to effect changes in the text that would
ignore or contradict the ordinary meaning of the words used in the text does
not seem appropriate. In rare and unusual instances, however, interpretation
123 Article VIII of IBRD Articles; Article VII of IDA Articles.
124 Rigo Sureda, supra note 92, at 569.
125 According to the ICJ, “some of the rules laid down in [the Vienna Convention on the Law
of Treaties] might be considered as a codiï¬?cation of existing customary lawâ€?; see GabÄ?Ãkovo-
Nagymaros Project Case (Hungary v. Slovakia) 1997 I.C.J. 7, 38. The same provision is found
in the Vienna Convention on the Law between States and International Organizations or
between International Organizations.
126 Legal Opinion from Heribert Golsong, vice president and general counsel, Valuation of the
Bank’s Capital (May 1, 1981) (copy on �le with the author).
127 Andres Rigo Sureda, The Law Applicable to the Activities of International Development Banks, 308
Recueil des Cours 1, 48–53 (2004).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 85
that contradicts the ordinary meaning of the terms of a text may be war-
ranted.128 To respond to Golsong’s point, there may be cases in which in-
terpretation does not function as a means that will “lead to a change in the
ordinary meaning� of the words used in a text, but merely formalizes or con-
�rms changes in the meaning of a text that have been brought about by obso-
lescence or incremental interpretations that modify the ordinary meaning of
these words.
An Assessment of the Available Tools
Despite the challenges associated with the process of amendment, if the Bank
decides to move away from the political prohibition clause, the option of
amendment will be more consistent with three fundamental general princi-
ples of law: rule of law, transparency, and equitable treatment of members.
Rule of Law
As for an organization committed in letter and spirit to the rule of law, the
Bank’s organs must operate, and must be perceived to operate, within certain
proper and prede�ned legal limits set out in its constituent document. This
is important not only for the sake of the rule of law but also because of the
close relationship between the “proper adherence to applicable legal rules and
principles� and “the �nancial strength that the [Bank] enjoys.�129 The Board
does not have unfettered discretion to modify the provisions of the articles as
it pleases. As noted by Ibrahim Shihata:
In interpreting the Articles, the Executive Directors . . . should weigh
carefully both the requirements of legal interpretation as well as the
policy requirements dictated by the Bank’s objectives and its chang-
ing environment. They should not, however, amend existing provisions
under the guise of interpreting them. Amendment is a separate process to
be undertaken under the different requirements of Article VIII. [emphasis
added]130
Modifying such a fundamental clause without a formal process could con-
stitute an ultra vires act for failing to follow the prede�ned procedures, im-
properly appropriating the powers of the Board of Governors and ultimately
of member states. To apply a principle derived from municipal administrative
law—as ultra vires actions—these attempts at interpretations are void ab initio.
128 See John L. Taylor, Legal Challenges at the Start of a New International Financial Institution, 17
Kan. J.L. & Pub. Pol. 349, 361 (2007/08). Taylor, a former general counsel of EBRD, discussing
the merits of interpretations over amendment, argues: “In some cases, proposed interpreta-
tions proved controversial, but for the most part this process served as an ef�cient method
for bringing clarity to the meaning that should be ascribed to the charter in uncertain cases,
without going through the laborious exercise required for actually amending the charter.
This increased clarity, in turn . . . contributed to the process of developing . . . a shared un-
derstanding, particularly among the shareholder countries, as to the meaning of the EBRD’s
nature, powers, and mission.�
129 See Head, supra note 108, at 217.
130 Shihata, supra note 7, at xlviii.
86 The World Bank Legal Review
Transparency
Amending the constituent document and other steps to reshape the Bank’s
mission are so far-reaching in nature that they should be undertaken only in
a proper transparent process. Informal interpretation is certainly not a model
of transparency.
Equitable Treatment of Members
Because a simple majority of Board members can effect certain changes to the
articles if “amendment through interpretation� is adopted, small shareholders
stand to be deprived of “protection of their interests guaranteed by the high
majority required for formal amendment.�
However, interpretation, which is consistent with the “overall tendency
to informality that has pervaded [the Bank] throughout its history,� might
continue to be useful if the political prohibition is still meaningful despite the
accumulation of changes in the Bank’s activities. 131 After all, it seems that the
preferred interpretation of the Bank’s articles is teleological, because a mul-
tilateral institution “by the nature of its mandate must be able to respond to
the changing needs of its members.�132 This type of interpretation is generally
considered the most dynamic and the most adequate for international orga-
nizations because it “can take account of the living charter of an international
organization . . . in a rapidly changing world.�133
Should the Political Prohibition Clause Be Retained?
This section elaborates various arguments for and against retaining the
political prohibition clause.
A Case against Retaining the Political Prohibition Clause
The arguments against retaining the political prohibition are related to
the evolution of development thinking, the interrelationship between politics
and economics, and the existence of competing sources of �nancing.
The Evolution in Development Thinking and the Establishment of the EBRD
Development is a concept that has evolved greatly over the past sixty years. In
the 1950s and the 1960s, the focus of development policy was on the role of the
state in managing the economy and transforming traditional societies.134 In the
131 Rigo Sureda, supra note 92, at 595.
132 Andres Rigo Sureda, The Law Applicable to the Activities of International Development Banks, 308
Recueil des Cours 1, 157 (2004).
133 Henry G. Schermers & Niels M. Blokker, International Institutional Law: Unity within Diversity
844 (4th ed., Martinus Nijhoff 2003).
134 David M. Trubek & Alvaro Santos, Introduction: The Third Moment in Law and Development
Theory and the Emergence of a New Critical Practice, in The New Law and Economic Development:
A Critical Appraisal 1, 2 (David M. Trubek & Alvaro Santos ed., Cambridge U. Press 2006).
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 87
1980s, a neoliberal agenda took over and the so- called Washington consen-
sus emerged.135 The neoliberal development policy viewed the government
as a facilitator to participation in the market, and the focus was on property
rights, free trade, and foreign investment.136 The transition in the countries of
Eastern Europe proved the limits of the neoliberal agenda and coincided with
the newly emerged theory of institutional economics that put emphasis on
the institutions.137 Another watershed event in the evolution of development
thinking is the work of Amartya Sen, who viewed development “as a process
of expanding the real freedoms that people enjoy.�138
This evolution in development thinking could not but have an impact on
development agencies and multilateral development banks (MDBs).139 The
EBRD, a third-generation MDB established in 1990, is the most characteris-
tic example. Established during the apogee of the Washington consensus, the
EBRD is not subject to political prohibition, and indeed is directed to factor in
environmental considerations as well as to help foster multiparty democracy,
pluralism, and market economies. These goals have been incorporated into
other institutions, including the Bank, through practice.140
Intertwined Economics and Politics and the Bank’s Effectiveness
The increasing extent to which economics and politics are intertwined might
mean that retaining the clause has the effect of tying the Bank’s hands and thus
adversely affecting its effectiveness. If the Bank had the ability to make decisions
for political reasons, it would be easily exposed to reputational risks, which in
turn could affect its ability to raise funds in capital markets.141 The IBRD has
135 Tor Krever, The Legal Turn in Late Development Theory: The Rule of Law and the World Bank’s
Development Model, 52 Harv. J. Intl. L. 287, 297 (2011).
136 David Kennedy, Political Choices and Development Common Sense, in The New Law and
Economic Development: A Critical Appraisal 95, 128–50 (David M. Trubek & Alvaro Santos ed.,
Cambridge U. Press 2006).
137 Douglass C. North, Institutions, Institutional Change, and Economic Performance (Cambridge U.
Press 1990).
138 Amartya Sen, Development as Freedom 3 (Alfred Knopf 1999).
139 For the impact on the World Bank, see Alvaro Santos, The World Bank’s Uses of the “Rule of
Law� Promise, in The New Law and Economic Development: A Critical Appraisal 253 (David M.
Trubek & Alvaro Santos ed., Cambridge U. Press 2006).
140 See Head, supra note 108, at 206.
141 This argument applies to the IBRD and is less relevant to the IDA. For an interesting dis-
cussion on how confusion about the Bank’s role results from the Bank’s dual nature,
which supports dual-model thinking (the Bank as �nancial intermediary—the Bank as a
bank model) that is linked with IBRD and the Bank as a mechanism for the transfer of re-
sources from wealthier to poorer countries in its membership, see Moises Naim, The World
Bank: Its Role, Governance and Organizational Culture (Apr. 1994), available at . According to Naim,
the differing assumptions about the “basic role of the World Bank not only engender very
different visions about its goals and policies� but also engender “standards with which to
judge the organization’s performance [and] changes needed to respond to new problems.�
88 The World Bank Legal Review
begun to position itself in the capital market as an appealing, socially respon-
sible investment for both retail and institutional investors. By putting itself in
this position, the IBRD hopes to widen and diversify the investor base of its
debt instruments by tapping into the growing number of investors who incor-
porate environmental, social, and governance criteria into their investment
decisions.142 The downside of this is that the IBRD has opened itself to scru-
tiny of its “social responsibility record.� If its actions are perceived as being
inconsistent with its rhetoric and image143 (e.g., if it continues to fund projects
in countries where human rights violations are pervasive), its ability to raise
funds from socially responsible investors could be impaired. More broadly,
political risk assessments are being used ever more frequently within private
capital and investment sectors to help guide investment decisions. The Bank
needs to keep up with best practices in capital markets, which in this case
means that the Bank must be increasingly attuned to political considerations.
As a socially responsible actor, the Bank may �nd that its expertise or
funds are required for more extensive and enduring interventions than
the ones that exist today in support of governments or state building. Nu-
merous types of flaws in a political system can make it impossible for an
honest government to come to power through a political process. Cam-
paign �nance reform “nudged� by the Bank, in coordination with other
bilateral donors, may be warranted in some cases because it may help
to create a more equitable political arena from which an honest govern-
ment can emerge. In cases of state collapse where temporary administra-
tion of the state by the international community may be needed (as was
the case in East Timor and Kosovo), the Bank could use its expertise to help a
nascent state establish its �nancial institutions.
142 Heike Reichelt, Green Bonds: A Model to Mobilize Private Capital to Fund Climate Change Miti-
gation and Adaptation Projects, in The Euromoney Environmental Finance Handbook 2010, avail-
able at .
143 Borrowing a page from the Apartheid South Africa disinvestment campaign, some activ-
ist organizations that have been seeking for years to get institutional investors to boycott
the World Bank bonds. See, for example, Jubilee 2000 campaign at . There is
hardly any evidence that these organizations had a detrimental effect on the ability of the
Bank to raise funds. However, it is worth recalling that the Bank made hardly any efforts to
appeal to socially responsible investors in the past as it has been doing lately.
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 89
Competing Sources of Financing
Competing sources of �nancing in countries can effectively discipline the
Bank in its application of political considerations. Many Bank member coun-
tries can obtain funding and investments from other sources, including capi-
tal markets;144 bilateral lenders;145 international �nancial institutions, includ-
ing multilateral development banks; sovereign wealth funds; and charitable
organizations.146 The member countries may opt to turn to one or more of
these alternative sources of funding if those countries adjudge the Bank to
be factoring inappropriate political considerations into its decision making.
Additionally, the Bank might be seen by its clients as irrelevant or misguided
if, because it is constrained by its political prohibition clause, it fails to factor
political issues into its decision making while other donors do incorporate
those factors into their decisions.
A Case for Retaining the Political Prohibition Clause
Despite the above arguments against the political prohibition, one could argue
that this clause should be retained, because its underlying rationale remains
relevant and it has served the Bank as both a �nancing and a knowledge
institution.
The Rationale for the Prohibition Remains Relevant Today
The political prohibition helps the Bank focus on its core competence. Impor-
tantly, the Bank is viewed as a neutral arbiter on many sensitive and technical
issues and is able to provide an independent and mediating voice on those
issues to the extent that the Bank’s decisions are seen primarily to be based on
empirical data and guided by technical and nonpolitical considerations.
Ibrahim Shihata wrote with respect to the political mandate of the EBRD
that “it will also be interesting to note the extent to which the new provi-
sions in the EBRD Agreement may influence the practice of other MDBs or
inspire calls for the amendment of their constituent instruments.�147 The fact
that twenty years after the creation of the EBRD nothing has changed in the
144 Many middle-income countries, including most countries in Latin America and a few Af-
rican countries (notably South Africa, Morocco, and Egypt), can and do borrow from inter-
national capital markets by issuing debt instruments. Even poorer countries have shown
interest in accessing capital markets—Ghana and Gabon issued their debut Eurobond in
2007. Since then, several other countries in Africa, including Nigeria, Kenya, Tanzania, and
Uganda, have demonstrated interest in doing the same.
145 In addition to traditional bilateral donors, mostly European countries, and North America,
there are “new� bilateral donors such as Brazil, India, China, and South Korea.
146 The Bill and Melinda Gates Foundation, for example, has over US $33 billion in an assets
trust endowment and operations in over a hundred, and made grant payments of over $3
billion in 2009. Compare these �gures with the IBRD, which had net disbursements of $8.3
billion in the �scal year ending in June 2009.
147 Ibrahim F. Shihata, The European Bank for Reconstruction and Development: A Comparative Anal-
ysis of the Constituent Agreement 4 (Graham & Trotman/Martinus Nijhoff 1990).
90 The World Bank Legal Review
Bank and the other international �nancial institutions might indicate that the
EBRD will remain the exception with respect to this issue and that the political
prohibition continues to serve these institutions.148
The Interpretation of This Clause Has Served the Organization Well
By allowing certain political considerations that have a direct and obvious
relation to economic considerations to be factored into its decisions, Bank
Management has some leeway, thus obviating the need to dispense with the
political prohibition.149 It is signi�cant that the Bank can get involved in many
activities related to governance—including many that were previously con-
sidered outside its mandate, such as civil service reform, legal, regulatory
and judicial reform, accountability for public �nance, and ef�ciency in public
functions150—as long as the recipient government requests such assistance and
areas of governance “fall reasonably within its developmental mandate.�151
Because development is not de�ned in the Articles of Agreement, the meaning
of the term can evolve in such a manner that more activities can be interpreted
as falling within the Bank’s mandate.152
In addition, the political prohibition could be seen as a protection or a
shield for the Bank. It has permitted the Bank to make decisions that in other
organizations would have been too controversial to contemplate.153 The po-
litical prohibition and the absence of Soviet countries among its membership
allowed the Bank to be insulated from the debates of the Cold War and to
focus on its development mandate.154
148 It is noteworthy that the amendment of the African Development Bank Articles of Agree-
ment in 2002 was not seen as an opportunity to introduce the principles, which characterize
the EBRD’s mandate; see Rigo Sureda, supra note 132, at 193.
149 See Shihata, supra note 70, at 241, where he argues that “the limitations on the Bank’s interfer-
ence in the political affairs of its members, cannot, however, be interpreted away or treated
as if they did not exist. These are legal limitations that have been reasonably and flexibly
applied and have served the Bank well through the years.�
150 Discussing this point in the context of EBRD, John Taylor argues, “with legal reform so
closely aligned, certainly in the minds of national government of�cials, with national sov-
ereignty, any involvement—much less pressure—by an IFI in the area of “legal reform� is
highly suspect, especially in view of the fact that all of the IFIs created before the EBRD in-
cluded speci�c “political prohibition provisions.� See Taylor, supra note 128, at 357.
151 See Shihata, supra note 70, at 242.
152 The need for an evolving understanding of development has become even more compelling
in light of recent events in the Middle East and North Africa. According to the president of
the World Bank, “it is vital that the World Bank Group continually challenges itself to refresh
our development thinking�; see Robert B. Zoellick, Speech, The Middle East and North Africa:
A New Social Contract for Development (Peterson Institute for International Economics, Wash-
ington, D.C., Apr. 6, 2006), available at .
153 For example, the Bank has been able to extend lending to entities that are not recognized as
states, such as the West Bank and Gaza, and to accept Kosovo as a member state.
154 Perhaps it is not irrelevant that the expansion of the Bank’s activities coincided with the end
of the Cold War and the emergence of the Washington consensus.
Should the Political Prohibition Be Revisited? 91
The Importance of Prohibition for the Knowledge Products of the Bank
The World Bank has learned that its knowledge services are just as impor-
tant as—for some of its clients, increasingly more than—the �nancing that it
provides. However, the signi�cance of the political prohibition clause for the
knowledge services of the Bank has rarely been noted.155
The Bank has been transformed over the past twenty years into a knowl-
edge institution, and it has assumed the responsibility not only to collect and
produce knowledge but also to share it. But if others are to want to mine this
rich resource, they must be convinced that the Bank’s knowledge is objective
and stands on a �rm technical, rather than political, basis. By extending its
political prohibition provisions to its research and analytical work, the Bank
has thus endowed its knowledge base with special authority.
Conclusion
The purpose of this chapter is to give an overview of the practice of the Bank
with respect to the political prohibition clause, to present the criticism raised
against this provision, and to outline the arguments against and in favor
of this clause. In this respect, this chapter can be seen as check on the sustain-
ability of a fundamental provision of the Bank’s Articles of Agreement. This
check is necessary because of the changing environment in which the Bank
operates. Other international organizations have engaged in similar exercises.
For example, it has been argued that Article 2(7) of the UN Charter—a provi-
sion similar to the Bank’s Article IV, Section 10—has become obsolete, but the
UN secretary-general has opined that it is still as relevant as it was in 1945.156
The same conclusion could be reached with respect to the political pro-
hibition clause: it continues to remain as relevant as it was in 1944. Back then
the dangers for the newly established institution and the dif�culties of distin-
guishing between politics and economics were obvious to everyone. For this
reason, a “Questions and Answers� paper prepared by the U.S. Treasury tried
to answer the question of whether the Bank could avoid making loans based
chiefly on political considerations.
The paper concluded that “no set of rules will of itself completely
eliminate political considerations and that proper limitation of the Bank’s
activities depends ultimately on the character of the men responsible for its
operations.� Besides the men (and women) responsible for the Bank’s opera-
tions, there are also men and women responsible for providing legal advice
155 Anghie, supra note 114, at 223.
156 Georg Noelte, Article 2(7), in The Charter of the United Nations: A Commentary 148, 149–50
(Bruno Simma ed., 2d ed., Oxford U. Press 2002).
92 The World Bank Legal Review
on the interpretation of the Bank’s articles. It is upon the latter that falls the
task of providing not only legally correct advice but also advice that will allow
the executive directors and the senior management to perform their responsi-
bilities in a manner that best suits the requirements of the Bank’s business.157
What seems to suit the requirements of the Bank’s business, as long its articles
are not amended, is to continue the “constructive and creative stretching� of
the political prohibition provisions, without breaking them.158
157 Shihata, supra note 18, at 1049.
158 This term was coined by Joachim von Amsberg, World Bank vice president, Operations Pol-
icy and Country Services, during the discussion on the political prohibition on November 9,
2010, during the 2010 Law, Justice, and Development Week.
International Financial Institutions
and Claims of Private Parties
Immunity Obliges
RUTSEL SILVESTRE J. MARTHA*
Writing in 1997, Judge Kooijmans of the International Court of Justice (ICJ) ob-
served that although the system of judicial protection of the European Union
(EU) is unique, much can be learned from the European Court of Justice’s
case law concerning the noncontractual liability of the European Communi-
ties (currently the European Union) and the provision of effective remedy for
third parties seeking compensation for damages.1 A primary lesson is that the
immunity from domestic legal process enjoyed by the European institutions
pursuant to the (predecessors of the) Protocol on the Privileges and Immuni-
ties of the European Union is not questioned because it is accompanied by a
system that provides for protection against unlawful acts of the institutions.
Central to the European system is the division of tasks between the national
courts, the European Court of Justice, and the General Court (formerly the
Court of First Instance), in particular the preliminary ruling procedure. The
combination of preliminary ruling proceedings brought in the national courts
(which may by themselves grant suf�cient protection) and proceedings under
which protection is sought directly before the General Court and the Court of
Justice enables the European Court to safeguard the independent functioning
of the EU while affording adequate means for redress to private parties.2
Unlike in the case of the European Union, the immunity from domestic le-
gal process of the other international organizations, in particular multilateral
�nancial institutions, is being attacked for being anachronistic or excessive.
The mounting pressure from a range of observers (scholars, private sector ac-
tors, and civil society) to strip international organizations of their immunity,3
or at a minimum to restrict such immunity,4 is directly linked to the actual
* This paper represents the author’s personal views. He is thankful to Sarah Dadush.
1 Peter H. Kooijmans, Foreword, in The Action for Damages in Community Law v (Ton Heukels &
Alison McDonnel ed., Kluwer Law International 1997).
2 See Henry G. Schermers & Denis F. Waelbroeck, Judicial Protection in the European Union (6th
ed., Kluwer Law International 2000).
3 See, for example, Steven Herz, Rethinking International Financial Institution Immunity, in Inter-
national Financial Institutions and International Law 137 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter
ed., Kluwer Law International 2010).
4 See, arguing that absolute immunity is an anachronism, McElhinney v. Ireland, App.
No. 31253/96, 2001-XI, Eur. Ct. Hum. Rights 37 (2001) (Dissenting Opinion of Judge Lou-
caides), Stephen Herz, International Organization in U.S. Courts: Reconsidering the Anachronism of
Absolute Immunity, 31 Suffolk Transnatl. L. Rev. 471 (2007–08), and Gerhard Thallinger, Piercing
93
94 The World Bank Legal Review
or perceived absence of adequate means to facilitate the resolution of mostly
noncontractual private claims against such organizations.5
This chapter demonstrates that international �nancial institutions’ immu-
nity from domestic legal process is neither an anachronism nor unnecessary nor
excessive, but that, as in the European Union, full attention ought to be given
to implementing the obligation of international organizations to provide appro-
priate modes for the settlement of disputes with private parties. Speci�cally, the
establishment of a default mechanism for the settlement of disputes between
international organizations and private parties seems to be the way to go.
The chapter also discusses the link between the reason for the existence
of international �nancial institutions and their immunity from legal domestic
process. When there is no longer an international public need for an organi-
zation, its privileges and immunities serve no purpose. Only in such cases
could it validly be argued that immunity from domestic legal process is un-
necessary and should be rescinded. Subsequently, the chapter addresses the
fundamental differences between states and international organizations that
render the restrictive immunity theory that applies to states in respect of their
commercial operations inapplicable to international �nancial institutions.
Membership in international organizations requires states to abstain from in-
terfering with the functioning of these organizations, including through the
states’ courts, which in and of itself severely limits any role domestic courts
could play in this �eld.
This chapter then examines the inherent jurisdictional limitations of do-
mestic legal orders under international law that entail categorical impedi-
ments to the role that domestic courts could play in the settlement of claims
against international �nancial institutions. The relevant international legal
instruments exclude a role for domestic courts in the settlement of disputes
between private parties and international organizations. However, the en-
joyment of immunity comes with responsibilities. In other words, immunity
obliges. Accordingly, the aforementioned instruments require international
organizations to provide appropriate modes for the settlement of claims of
private parties. Although usually mechanisms are put into place to deal with
contractual claims of private parties, unfortunately, too often international �-
nancial institutions fail to make arrangements for dealing with noncontractual
claims. Drawing on examples from the practice of international organizations
(the Bank for International Settlements, BIS; the International Fund for Agri-
cultural Development, IFAD; INTERPOL; and the Organization of American
States, OAS), the chapter discusses the default mechanisms that could and
should be put into place by international �nancial institutions in order to ad-
dress the legitimate complaint that immunity from domestic legal process
Jurisdictional Immunity: The Possible Role of Domestic Courts in Enhancing World Bank Accountabil-
ity, 1 Vienna Online J. Intl. Const. L. 4 (2008), (available at ).
5 Emmanuel Gaillard & Isabelle Pingel-Lenuzza, International Organisations and Immunity from
Jurisdiction: To Restrict or to Bypass, 51 Intl. Comp. L.Q. 1 (2002).
IFIs and Private Parties 95
would otherwise infringe on the right of private parties to effective remedies
against international organizations.
Why Do International Financial Institutions Exist?
The discussion about the desirability and the extent of multilateral �nancial
institutions’ immunity from domestic legal process is linked to the raison
d’être of these institutions. Yet this important aspect is often relegated to the
background. This is regrettable because the reasons for the existence of inter-
national organizations, international �nancial institutions in particular, hold
clues for understanding the continued need for and relevance of their immu-
nities as well as for contextualizing the limited role—if any—that domestic
courts could play in settling disputes between private parties and interna-
tional organizations.
Consider the trajectory of the International Telecommunications Satellite
Organization (INTELSAT), from its inception as a public international orga-
nization to its conversion into a private organization. INTELSAT was formed
by a 1964 treaty to improve global communication, particularly between de-
veloping and developed economies. In response to the 1960 launch of the �rst
telecommunications satellite, Echo I, a 1962 UN resolution called for a system
of “communications by means of satellite� that would be “available to the
nations of the world . . . on a global and nondiscriminatory basis.�6 Accord-
ingly, as a public international organization, INTELSAT was set up to provide
reliable, high-quality international public telephony on a nondiscriminatory
basis to all areas of the world through the development and operation of a
global commercial telecommunications satellite system. However, dramat-
ic changes took place over the years, especially the growing popularity of
�ber-optic cable as a substitute for satellites in providing telephone links and
the emergence of private satellite providers, that rendered the global public-
good function of the organization unnecessary.7 This development led to the
privatization of the organization and the attendant removal of its privileges
and immunities.8 What this story shows is that when the international public
function for which an international organization has been set up is no longer
necessary, the reason for its immunity disappears.
Unfortunately, in a discussion about jurisdictional immunity, one
often forgets that unlike states, which are created on the principle of self-
determination, international organizations are usually created out of functional
6 GA Res. 1721 (XVI), UNGAOR, 16th Sess., Supp. No. 17, U.N. Doc. A/5100 (1962).
7 See The White House, Towards Competition in International Satellite Services: Rethinking the Role
of INTELSAT, available at .
8 See Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, The Tax Treatment of International Civil Servants 192–94 (Marti-
nus Nijhoff 2010), and the sources cited there.
96 The World Bank Legal Review
necessity.9 As the example of INTELSAT con�rms, in the case of international
�nancial institutions, that functional need is captured by the concept of “capital
market imperfections.�10 According to this concept, international capital mar-
kets tend to discriminate among borrowers; more speci�cally, countries whose
ability to repay is perceived as being uncertain are typically forced to pay a
premium when they borrow. Considerations of creditworthiness—whether or
not based on economic fundamentals11—often affect not only the cost of credit
in international �nancial markets but also its availability. The perception that
a country’s creditworthiness has deteriorated or is about to deteriorate can
lead to an abrupt curtailment of funding to all domestic borrowers, public
and private,12 and can thus impair the allocation of needed resources for mat-
ters such as postconflict reconstruction and social and economic development.
Hence the decision by states (and sometimes international organizations) to
establish international �nancial institutions in order to rectify this and other
related capital market imperfections.13 It is for this reason that the constitu-
tional instruments of institutions such as the World Bank Group and regional
development banks invariably contain certain operational principles, includ-
ing the speci�c condition that, when deciding on loans, the institution must be
satis�ed that the borrower would be unable to obtain credit under prevailing
market conditions. Because of these clauses, the World Bank Group (and the
regional development banks) was required to adopt a graduation policy.14 In
the same vein, several institutions have been created to remedy the conditions
that stand in the way of access to capital for private sector growth in devel-
oping countries,15 as well as the problems with dispute settlement between
investors and developing-country governments,16 the need for resources to fa-
cilitate transition from planned economies to market economies,17 and sectoral
9 Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, Mandate Issues in the Activities of the International Fund for
Agricultural Development (IFAD), 6 Intl. Organizations L. Rev. 447, 450–52 (2009).
10 See Yilmaz Akyüz, Rectifying Capital Market Imperfections: The Continuing Rationales for Mul-
tilateral Lending, in The New Public Finance: Responding to Global Challenges 486 (Inge Kaul &
Pedro Conceição ed., Oxford U. Press 2006). See also Daniel Cohen, Pierre Jacquet, & Helmut
Reisen, Beyond “Grants versus Loans�: How to Use Debt for Development? (Dec. 15, 2005), avail-
able at .
11 See Georges Ugeux, Are Sovereign Ratings a Legacy of Colonialism? Huf�ngton Post (Oct. 16,
2009), available at .
12 For example, on April 27, 2010, the Greek debt rating was decreased to BB+ (a “junk�
status) by Standard & Poor’s amid fears of default by the Greek government.
13 Koen de Feyter, World Development Law—Sharing Responsibility for Development 78 (Intersen-
tia 2001).
14 See Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, The World Bank Legal Papers 493–507 (Martinus Nijhoff 2000).
15 See Aron Broches, International Legal Aspects of the Operations of the World Bank, in Selected
Essays—World Bank, ICSID, and Other Subjects of Public and Private International Law 3, 28–29
(Martinus Nijhoff 1995).
16 Aron Broches, Settlement of Investment Disputes, in Selected Essays, at 161–63.
17 See Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, The European Bank for Reconstruction and Development (Martinus
Nijhoff 1990).
IFIs and Private Parties 97
needs such as agriculture18 and the environment.19 In the case of monetary
institutions, balance-of-payments needs are a critical condition for accessing
their resources.20
An important conclusion to draw is that as long as there is a functional
need for international �nancial institutions to address market imperfections,
such entities must be regarded and treated as what they are, namely, provid-
ers of international public goods. Their privileges and immunities cannot be
properly discussed without keeping this in mind.
Functional Need to Operate in a Domestic Market
The conflicts that arise when the function of an international organization
collides with the demands of national law can be attributed to the fact that
national courts tend to see international organizations through the prism of
their legal personality under domestic law. From this perspective, it is easy to
assume that international organizations should not be treated any differently
than other market participants. Yet this perception is misguided, because “the
legal position of international organizations is governed by the fact that their
competences in every �eld are restricted by their purposes. . . . In other words,
every act performed by an international organization must be compatible
with the purposes which the organization is supposed to pursue.�21 The basic
premise here is that unless international organizations expressly undertake
actions that are not compatible with their purposes, they should receive differ-
ent treatment from that accorded to ordinary market participants.
Aside from the matters beyond national jurisdiction discussed below,
which underscore the special status of international organizations, one should
remain mindful of the fact that, unlike other foreign participants in the mar-
ket, in order to execute their mandates and administer their resources, inter-
national organizations—both legally and factually—cannot avoid operating
in domestic markets. Thus, whereas foreign states and foreign private par-
ties can be required to bear the consequences of their choice to operate in the
domestic market of another country, an international organization’s presence
in the domestic market of its members is a matter not of choice but of neces-
sity. Some critics might argue that the claim that international organizations
have no choice but to operate within states, whereas foreign states do have
a choice, is overdrawn because in reality, many foreign states do not see any
option but to engage in capital markets, give and receive aid in foreign curren-
18 Martha, supra note 9, at 450–52.
19 Stephen A. Silard, The Global Environment Facility: A New Development in International Law and
Organization, 28 Geo. Wash. J. Intl. L. & Econ. 607 (1995).
20 See Richard W. Edwards Jr., International Monetary Collaboration 240–41 (Transnational Pub-
lishers 1985).
21 Pieter H. F. Bekker, The Legal Position of Intergovernmental Organizations: A Functional Necessity
Analysis of Their Legal Status and Immunities 157 (Martinus Nijhoff 1994).
98 The World Bank Legal Review
cies, conduct diplomacy abroad, and the like. The proponents of this theory
believe that the �nancial operations and commercial transactions of interna-
tional organizations are ordinary market operations that deserve no special
treatment; further, international organizations should not receive immunities
that states acting alone do not receive.22 The proponents of this theory23 must
have celebrated the 2010 judgment of the court of appeals in OSS Nokalva v.
European Space Agency,24 in which the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Third Cir-
cuit expressly broke with the often-followed interpretation of Atkinson v. Inter-
American Development Bank,25 adopted by the District of Columbia Court of
Appeals, and found that the U.S. International Organizations Immunities Act
(IOIA) grants international organizations only limited immunity, consistent
with the contemporary understanding and application of the U.S. Foreign
Sovereign Immunities Act (FSIA).
The case came to the court under the collateral order doctrine on appeal
from the district court’s order denying the European Space Agency’s (ESA)
motion to dismiss a breach-of-contract claim by OSS Nokalva (OSSN). In its
motion to dismiss, ESA asserted absolute immunity from suit under the IOIA
based on ESA’s status as an international organization. The court noted that
Congress had not included any language to convey an intent to tether the
IOIA to the law of foreign sovereign immunity as it existed in 1945, and that
allowing international organizations to enjoy absolute immunity while for-
eign sovereigns were subject to the immunity limitations of the FSIA could
create an incentive for foreign governments to evade legal obligations by
acting through international organizations. In the end, the court saw no com-
pelling reason to accord the international organization any kind of special
treatment, and concluded that the ESA was not entitled to absolute immu-
nity.26 This holding reveals the fundamental misunderstanding that fuels the
argument for restricting the immunity of international organizations:
If a foreign government, such as Germany, had contracted with
OSSN, it would not be immune from suit because the FSIA provides
that a foreign government involved in a commercial arrangement
such as that in this case may be sued, as ESA acknowledged at oral
argument. We �nd no compelling reason why a group of states act-
ing through an international organization is entitled to broader im-
munity than its member states enjoy when acting alone. Indeed, such
a policy may create an incentive for foreign governments to evade
legal obligations by acting through international organizations.27
22 Herz, supra note 3, at 159.
23 See Herz, supra note 4.
24 OSS Nokalva, Inc. v. European Space Agency, 617 F.3d 756 (3d Cir. 2010).
25 Atkinson v. Inter-American Development Bank, 156 F.3d 1335 (D.C. Cir. 1998).
26 Matthew Parish, U.S. Courts Chip Away at the Crumbling Edi�ce of Legal Immunity (Sep. 29,
2010), available at .
27 Id.
IFIs and Private Parties 99
Although one may agree with the view that where international orga-
nizations and states are comparable, they should be subject to comparable
treatment, the flaws in the reasoning are obvious. Irrespective of their con-
siderable size, stature, and influence, international organizations differ from
states exactly on the points that are relevant for the question of immunity from
domestic legal process. Both the Permanent Court of International Justice and
the ICJ clearly state that although international organizations are subjects of
international law, they cannot be compared with states. The argument that
an international organization’s operation in the domestic market should be
treated in the same way as that of states for the purpose of jurisdictional im-
munity is therefore flawed in four ways.
Functional Gaps in the International Legal Order
The presence of certain functional gaps in the international legal order compels
reliance on domestic markets in order to perform organizational functions.
This is particularly evident in relation to the resources of international organi-
zations. Take the issue of the currency for the remuneration of staff members
of international organizations, a recognized problem for international orga-
nizations.28 Unlike states, with the exception of a few regional organizations
that constitute a monetary union (for example, the Eastern Caribbean States
and the European Union), international organizations do not have their own
currency and must rely on the currency of some country.29 With respect to
the operational cash of international organizations, applicable international
law typically requires the organization’s executive to designate the banks in
which the organization’s funds will be kept and to establish bank accounts
for the transaction of the organization’s business.30 Although the resources of
international organizations are inherently international and as such beyond
national jurisdiction,31 once these resources are converted into assets, namely,
through the acquisition of bank holdings, securities, real property, and the
like, they become at least in part subject to national law.32 For instance, the na-
tional legislation that regulates the currency in which assets are denominated
(the lex monetae) will also govern the valuation of these assets. Real property
owned by the organization is subject to the principle of lex rei sitae, that is, the
law where the property is situated, including zoning and safety regulations.
28 Henry G. Schermers & Niels M. Blokker, International Institutional Law 357–58 (4th ed.,
Martinus Nijhoff 2004).
29 See Mann on the Legal Aspect of Money 587–88 (Charles Proctor ed., 6th ed., Oxford U. Press
2005).
30 See, for example, ICC Financial Regulation 8; INTERPOL Financial Regulation 3.9; ILO
Financial Regulations, Article 22; ICAO Financial Regulations, Article X, 10.1; and WMO
Financial Regulations, Article 11.
31 Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, International Organizations and the Global Financial Crisis: The Status
of Their Assets in Insolvency and Forced Liquidation Proceedings, 6 Intl. Organizations L. Rev. 117,
118–20 (2009).
32 See James Fawcett, Trade and Finance in International Law, 128 Recueil des Cours 215, 237–39
(1968).
100 The World Bank Legal Review
Similarly, the foreign exchange laws of the jurisdictions involved affect the
transfer of funds across borders.33 With respect to the management of interna-
tional organization assets, the division of tasks and responsibilities between
the custodian and the entity issuing the securities is likely to be governed by
a national legal system, unless the parties agree otherwise. Finally, the laws
regulating domestic �nancial institutions and the insolvency laws that apply
in the country of a debtor of an international organization will impact the as-
sets of an international organization.34
Thus, there is simply no way for any international organization to avoid
entanglement with at least one domestic market of a member state. Two do-
mestic court rulings prove the point that failure to acknowledge the unavoid-
ability of international organizations operating in domestic markets can lead
to the misappropriation of international resources. Imagine the following
situation: States come together and set up an international fund to combat
the effects of climate change on agriculture. They pay contributions, and the
fund sets aside the resources that are not immediately needed for operations
in demand accounts and time deposits. Then, for whatever reason, the bank
holding the deposits is liquidated. In such a situation, would the organiza-
tion’s assets be frozen? The Court of Appeals of Paris ruled in the af�rmative
in ECOWAS v. BCCI (1993).
The Economic Community of West African States (ECOWAS), a regional
group of �fteen West African countries whose mission is to promote economic
integration, learned an important lesson when a portion of its deposits and
those of the ECOWAS Fund were placed under the control of the Bank of
Credit and Commerce International (BCCI) and subsequently liquidated. On
July 5, 1991, what was then described as the biggest bank fraud in history
came to light when regulators in seven countries raided and took control of
the branch of�ces of the BCCI. An administrator appointed by the French
Banking Commission suspended BCCI’s operations and froze its accounts.
The bank was subsequently put into liquidation by a French court. The
Paris branches of BCCI, whose operations were effectively suspended as of
July 5, 1991, held a total amount of US$12.6 million of resources that belonged
to the ECOWAS Fund.35 In the lawsuit against BCCI to unfreeze the assets, the
claims of ECOWAS and the ECOWAS Fund were rejected on the �rst hear-
ing by the Tribunal de commerce of Paris. On appeal, the Court of Appeals
of Paris maintained that international organizations could invoke immunities
in France only if the entitlement to immunity resulted from either an inter-
33 See William Blair, Interference of Public Law in the Performance of International Monetary Obliga-
tions, in International Monetary Law—Issues for the New Millennium 395 (Mario Giovanoli ed.,
Oxford U. Press 2000).
34 See, generally on the application of national law to international organizations, August Rein-
isch, Accountability of International Organizations According to National Law, 36 Neth. Y.B. Intl.
L. 119 (2005).
35 Chibuike U. Uche, Can African Institutions Finance African Development? Evidence from the
ECOWAS Fund, in Africa and Development Challenges in the New Millennium: The NEPAD
Debate 235 (Jimi O. Adesina, Yao Graham, & Adebayo Olukoshi ed., Codesria 2005).
IFIs and Private Parties 101
national agreement to which France was party or from a rule of customary
international law relevant to the case.
The principal grounds for rejection of immunity were articulated around
two arguments: �rst, that France neither was a member country of ECOWAS
nor had entered into any agreement with ECOWAS and the ECOWAS Fund;
and second, that there was no established applicable rule of customary inter-
national law. The Court of Appeals of Paris thus contended that ECOWAS
and the ECOWAS Fund were not entitled to immunity. Moreover, the court
of appeals reasoned that by initiating the proceedings, the ECOWAS and the
ECOWAS Fund waived the jurisdictional immunity that they might other-
wise have enjoyed. Finally, the court argued that immunity was inapplicable
because no measure had been taken against the ECOWAS or the ECOWAS
Fund. According to the court of appeals, the assets belonging to ECOWAS and
the ECOWAS Fund could no longer be (re)claimed due to French private law
peremptory rules, which are a matter of public policy.36
By depositing its cash in a nonmember state with which the organization
had no agreement on privileges and immunities, ECOWAS exposed its funds
to serious risk. ECOWAS could have been more diligent in choosing where to
place its resources, and one could argue that it brought this outcome on itself.
Taking additional measures to protect resources doesn’t necessarily mitigate
risk, however. A 1996 decision of the D.C. Court of Appeals in U.S. v. BCCI37
af�rms this assertion. In that case, the general secretariat of the OAS appealed
the district court’s dismissal of its petition for adjudication of its interest in
funds deposited with the BCCI. The funds had been ordered forfeited un-
der U.S. law. The court of appeals af�rmed the district court’s dismissal on
the ground that, notwithstanding its status as an international organization,
OAS was, like any other bank depositor, a general creditor of BCCI, with no
legal interest in any speci�c forfeited property. The effect of this ruling is that
one member of the organization allowed its bankruptcy court to appropriate
international resources that were destined to support the operations of the
organization.
If the above two cases represent the state of international law on the control
over international organizations’ �nancial resources held in domestic banks,
then there is a sizable risk that the funds pooled by sovereign states to �nance
international public goods may be made unavailable to serve their intend-
ed purpose. This deviation could occur when national laws permit an inter-
national organization’s funds to be frozen and distributed among the creditors
of bankrupt banks or banks in liquidation. Clearly, allowing national courts to
apply national bankruptcy or forced-liquidation laws, or any national law for
that matter, can deprive an international organization of the funding supplied
by its member states, which is tantamount to allowing a single member state
36 Economic Community of West African States v. Bank of Credit and Commerce International (Paris
Court of Appeals, 1993), 113 Intl. L. Rep. 473.
37 United States v. BCCI Holdings (Luxembourg), S.A., 73 F.3d 403 (D.C. Cir. 1996).
102 The World Bank Legal Review
to undermine the very purpose for which the funds were pooled. By ignoring
the exclusive international nature of the international organizations’ resources
and the fact that, unlike other market participants, international organizations
cannot avoid operating in the domestic market of the forum, both the Court of
Appeals of Paris and the D.C. Court of Appeals condoned a situation whereby
France and the United States essentially misappropriated funds that had been
assembled in the service of international public welfare.
Need to Engage Services of Private Parties
The most frequent source of legal matters brought to national courts for settle-
ment concerns natural persons who work at or have rendered to international
organizations.38 Unlike states, international organizations have neither their
own citizens nor their own residents.39 International organizations are abstract
(�ctional) entities that cannot act in the physical world. The same is true for
corporate entities established under domestic law and for the state itself. Con-
duct always originates in individuals, that is, natural persons. As acknowl-
edged in the Reparation for Injuries case, 40 because international organizations
do not have citizens or residents, the link between international organizations
and individuals is not a nationality link but a functionality link. Whereas
states have citizens and residents from whom they can recruit civil servants
and thus exclude exposure to foreign legal orders, international civil servants
must be recruited from among citizens of the organization’s members. The
natural persons the organizations engage, whether staff members, service pro-
viders, or vendors, are necessarily the nationals and residents of some state.
Thus, the contracting of individuals by international organizations establishes
links with the domestic legal orders of at least one country.
Lack Territory of Their Own
As Judge Ago wrote in his opinion in the WHO/Egypt case, an international
organization is, like a state, a subject of international law, but one that en-
joys limited international legal capacity and, unlike a state, a subject of law
that lacks territorial bases. An international organization’s “establishment�
in the territory of a given state is therefore a condition sine qua non of its
functioning as an organization, carrying on its activities and ful�lling its
objects and purposes.41 In other words, unlike foreign states, when interna-
tional organizations operate in the territory of a state, they do so not out of
38 August Reinisch, International Organizations before National Courts 25–26 (Cambridge U. Press
2000). Also Finn Seyersted, Common Law of International Organizations 449–50 (Martinus
Nijhoff 2008).
39 When an international organization governs an inhabited territory, which is exceptional, it
normally also exercises jurisdiction over the residents and nationals of the territory in ques-
tion. See Seyersted, supra note 38, at 208.
40 Reparation for Injuries Suffered in the Service of the United Nations, Advisory Op., 1949 I.C.J. 174.
41 Interpretation of the Agreement of 25 March 1951 between the World Health Organization and Egypt,
Advisory Op., 1980 I.C.J. 73, 155 (Separate Opinion, Judge Ago). Cf. Felice Morgenstern, Legal
Problems of International Organizations 5 (Cambridge U. Press 1986).
IFIs and Private Parties 103
volition but because they have no alternative. According to special rapporteur
DÃaz-González, this fact provides the rationale for the unrestricted immunity
accorded to international organizations:
Being unable to enjoy the protection conferred by territorial sover-
eignty, as States can, international organizations have as their sole
protection the immunities granted to them. The ample immunity
afforded them is fully justi�ed, in contrast to the increasingly
restricted immunity of States, for the good reason that States are
political entities pursuing their own interests while international
organizations are service agencies operating on behalf of all their
member States.42
The Functional Nature of Their Powers
In the Legality of Nuclear Weapons case, citing European Commission of the
Danube,43 the ICJ stated that
international organizations are subjects of international law which
do not, unlike states, possess a general competence like States. Inter-
national organizations are governed by the “principle of speciality,�
that is to say, they are invested by the States which create them with
powers, the limits of which are a function of the common interests
whose promotion those States entrust to them.44
Due to this principle of specialty, unlike with states, the activities of inter-
national organizations can be divided not between public activities (acta iure
imperii) and commercial activities (acta iure gestionis) but rather by whether
the activities are functional or not.45 It must be stressed, however, that the fact
that an act is functional does not necessarily mean that it cannot engage the re-
sponsibility of the actor. The point here is that because the distinction between
acta iure imperii and acta iure gestionis cannot be made in respect to the actions
of international organizations, the restrictive immunity doctrine that applies
to states cannot be applied to international organizations.
The conclusions to draw from the foregoing are that the activities of inter-
national organizations are determined on the basis of their functionality; the
absence of certain functions at the international level compels international
42 Leonardo DÃaz-González, special rapporteur, Fourth Report on Relations between States and
International Organizations (Second Part of the Topic), 2 Y.B. Intl. L. Commn. (part 1) 153, 158
(1989).
43 Jurisdiction of the European Commission of the Danube, Advisory Op., 1927 P.C.I.J. Series B, No.
14, at 64.
44 Legality of the Use by a State of Nuclear Weapons in Armed Conflict, Advisory Op., 1996 I.C.J. 66,
78. See also Elihu Lauterpacht, The Development of the Law of International Organizations by the
Decisions of International Tribunals, 152 Recueil des Cours 377, 414 (1976) (noting that interna-
tional organizations are arti�cial and deliberate creations that owe their existence not only to
the instrument on which they are founded but also to their ability to act).
45 Felice Morgenstern, Legal Problems of International Organizations, Hersh Lauterpacht Memorial
Lectures 6 (Grotius 1986).
104 The World Bank Legal Review
organizations to rely on and expose themselves to domestic markets; and
international organizations have no territory, nationals, or residents of their
own, which compels further exposure. These aspects render any comparison
of international organizations and states for the purpose of the application of
the principles of immunity from legal process utterly misguided.46
Functional Need of Noninterference by Domestic Authorities
Given the functional needs of international organizations to operate in do-
mestic markets, it is necessary to establish safeguards against interference at
the national level, a principle that is captured in the phrase ne impediatur of-
�cia. This basic principle was articulated by the IV/2 Committee of the United
Nations Conference as follows: “No Member state may hinder in any way
the working of the Organization or take measures the effect of which might
increase its burdens, �nancial or other.�47 It has been argued that the obliga-
tion not to intervene is inherent in the status of a member of an international
organization. As succinctly articulated by Judge Rezek in Cumaraswamy:
There is no obligation on sovereign States to found international or-
ganizations, or to remain Members of them against their will. How-
ever, the fact of membership—even in the case of an organization
whose objectives are less essential than those of the United Nations,
and in �elds less salient than that of human rights—requires that
every State, in its relations with the Organization and its agents, dis-
play an attitude at least as constructive as that which characterizes
diplomatic relations between States.48
In line with the principle of ne impediatur of�cia, the parties to the con-
stituent instrument of an international organization undertake the obligation
to recognize the privileges and immunities necessary for the exercise of the
entity’s functions and the ful�llment of its objectives. This obligation is often
expressed in a general clause that can be found in the constituent instrument
itself and is further de�ned in special agreements on privileges and immu-
nities.49 In the case of the United Nations, its specialized agencies (which in-
cludes, inter alia, the World Bank Group; the International Monetary Fund,
46 Cf. Christian Dominicé, La nature et l’étendue de l’immunité de juridiction des organisations inter-
nationales, in Law of Nations, Law of International Organizations, World’s Economic Law—Liber
amicorum Honouring Ignaz Seidl-Hohenveldern 77, 85 (Hans-Ernst Folz, Jörg Manfred Mössner,
& Karl Zemanek ed., Kluwer Law International 1988).
47 UNCIO, Report of the Rapporteur of Committee IV/2, Doc. 933, IV/2/42, at 3.
48 Difference Relating to Immunity from Legal Process of a Special Rapporteur of the Commission on
Human Rights, Advisory Op., 1999 I.C.J. 62, 109–10.
49 For example, UN Charter, Article 105; Agreement Establishing IFAD, Article 10, Section 2(a);
WHO Constitution, Article 67; ILO Constitution, Article 40.
IFIs and Private Parties 105
IMF; and the International Fund for Agricultural Development, IFAD), and
their related organizations, two general conventions are relevant. Article II
of the Convention on the Privileges and Immunities of the United Nations
(1946) and Article III of the Convention on the Privileges and Immunities of
the Specialized Agencies (1947) both stipulate that the United Nations and the
specialized agencies, their property, and their assets, wherever located and
by whomsoever held, shall enjoy immunity from every form of legal process,
except insofar as in any particular case it has expressly waived its immunity.50
These and similar stipulations in other conventions often provide the basis for
domestic court rulings that decline to exercise jurisdiction over international
organizations.
A case in point is the decision of the D.C. Court of Appeals in the land-
mark case of Broadbent v. OAS, where the court upheld the doctrine of non-
interference and held that OAS was immune from suit. The use of the term
“absolute immunity� in Broadbent, inspired by the national legislation that the
court was interpreting in that case, should not be understood as meaning that
the scope of the immunity is unlimited. As Bekker explains, strictly speaking,
immunities of international organizations are neither absolute nor restrictive,
but functional.51 In this sense, absolute immunity from domestic legal process
merely means that the answer to the question of whether the claimed immu-
nity is functionally necessary is reserved for the competent international body.
This was explained by Judge Weeramanty in Cumaraswamy:
The Secretary-General’s determination as to whether a particular ac-
tion is within an of�cial’s or rapporteur’s sphere of authority should
therefore be binding on the domestic tribunal, unless compelling
reasons can be established for displacing that weighty presumption
. . . if a State disputes such a ruling by the Secretary General, there is
always room for the matter to be brought to the Court.52
50 The property and assets of the United Nations and the specialized agencies, wherever lo-
cated and by whomsoever held, shall also be immune from search, requisition, con�scation,
expropriation, and any other form of interference, whether by executive, administrative,
judicial, or legislative action. Moreover, the United Nations and its specialized agencies may,
without being restricted by �nancial controls, regulations, or moratoria of any kind, hold
funds, gold, or currency of any kind and operate accounts in any currency; and freely trans-
fer its funds, gold, or currency from one country to another or within any country and con-
vert any currency held by it into any other currency. The rationale for conferring immunity
in these provisions can be attributed to the fact that without immunity, states could interfere
with or affect the functioning of an international organization, for instance, by impounding
its assets.
51 Bekker, supra note 21, at 156–59.
52 Difference Relating to Immunity from Legal Process of a Special Rapporteur of the Commission on
Human Rights, supra note 48, at 97.
106 The World Bank Legal Review
International practice reveals that such bodies sometimes agree with the
organization that it entitled to immunity,53 but not always.54 In the latter cases,
the organization will have to accept the consequences of the operation of do-
mestic law in accordance with the terms of the international decision.
Jurisdictional Limitations of Domestic Courts
Much of the discussion around the desirability and the extent of multilateral
�nancial institutions’ immunity from legal process fails to consider the fact
that certain matters involving international organizations are simply beyond
the powers of national courts. This fact imposes signi�cant limitations on the
role that domestic courts can play in the settlement of private-party claims
against international �nancial institutions. It also makes the legal viability of
removing or restricting immunity from legal process a highly questionable
proposition. Although it may be obvious at a theoretical level that certain mat-
ters speci�cally fall to international organizations and are beyond national
competence, both scholars and national courts struggle with this issue. Much
of the debate and judicial musings about the purported anachronism of the
immunity of international organizations, at least in its absolute version, is
conducted without considering the threshold question of whether national
courts even have jurisdiction over international organizations. Such ap-
proaches tend to overlook the fact that, from an international law perspective,
the answer to this question is not found in domestic law: “The existence of a
State’s right to exercise jurisdiction,� whether regulation, adjudication, or en-
forcement related, “is exclusively determined by public international law.�55
Scholars and national courts that look at international organizations
through the lens of immunity from jurisdiction are likely to limit their exami-
nation to the exemption from the powers of courts and tribunals. Given that
in most cases, international instruments contain provisions on organizational
immunity, such an approach is tempting. However, as stated by the ICJ in the
Arrest Warrant case: “It is only where a State has jurisdiction under interna-
tional law in relation to a particular matter that there can be any question of
immunities in regard to the exercise of that jurisdiction.�56 According to the
53 Applicability of Article VI, Section 22, of the Convention on the Privileges and Immunities of
the United Nations, Advisory Op., 1989 I.C.J. 177; Difference Relating to Immunity from Legal
Process of a Special Rapporteur of the Commission on Human Rights, supra note 48; Case Concerning
the Taxation Liability of Euratom Employees between the Commission of the European Atomic
Energy Community (Euratom) and the United Kingdom Atomic Energy Authority, decision of
February 25, 1967, XVIII UNRIAA 467.
54 European Molecular Biology Laboratory case (v. Germany) (Arbitration Tribunal, 1990) 105 Intl.
L. Rep. 1; Question of the Tax Regime Governing Pensions Paid to Retired UNESCO Of�cials Resid-
ing in France (France v. UNESCO), decision of January 14, 2003, XXV UNRIAA 231.
55 Frederick A. Mann, The Doctrine of Jurisdiction in International Law, 111 Recueil des Cours 9,
96 (1964).
56 Arrest Warrant of 11 April 2000 (Democratic Republic of the Congo v. Belgium), 2002 I.C.J. 3, 19,
paragraph 46.
IFIs and Private Parties 107
then president of the court, Judge G. Guillaume, this means that “a domestic
court’s jurisdiction is a question which it must decide before considering the
immunity of those before it. In other words, there can only be immunity from
jurisdiction where there is jurisdiction.�57 This view was shared by judges Hig-
gins, Kooijmans, and Buergenthal who stated in their joint separate opinion:
“If there is no jurisdiction en principe, then the question of immunity from a ju-
risdiction which would otherwise exist simply does not arise.�58 This con�rms
what Lalive pointed out in 1953: “L’immunité présuppose un tribunal terri-
torial qui serait normalement compétent� (Immunity presupposes a tribunal
that is otherwise competent to deal with the matter).59
The far-reaching implications of this statement cannot be overstated: be-
cause most issues concerning international organizations, including interna-
tional �nancial institutions, involve matters that are beyond domestic jurisdic-
tion, many cases could be disposed of by domestic courts on lack of jurisdiction
rationae materiae grounds, without requiring inquiry into immunity issues.
The Exclusive International Nature of the Corporate Life
of International Organizations
As Kelsen asserts, “certain subject matters cannot be regulated by national law
but only by international law.�60 The categorical nature of this assertion, which
cannot be reduced to dogmatic postulation, has occasionally been recognized
by national courts. Aware of the inherent dangers of exercising national juris-
diction over international organizations, some national courts have resorted
to a wide array of means and procedural devices in order to avoid doing so.61
It took the International Tin Council (ITC) litigations in British courts to make
visible the logical extreme of accepting national jurisdiction over international
organizations.62
Established in 1956 by a treaty, the ITC was an international organization
that acted on behalf of large tin producers and bought surplus tin stocks to
maintain prices. However, with the advent of aluminum containers, the use of
protective polymer lacquers inside cans, and increased recycling by industry,
the demand for tin had decreased considerably by the early 1980s; in Octo-
ber 1985, the ITC could no longer carry out its price-maintaining function. It
57 Id., at 35, paragraph 1.
58 Id., at 64, paragraph 3. Cf. Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, The Jurisdiction to Tax in International Law
17–18 (Kluwer Law and Taxation 1989).
59 Jean-Flavien Lalive, L’immunité de juridiction des états et des organisations internationales 84
Recueil des Cours 205, 293 (1953).
60 Hans Kelsen, Principles of International Law 241 (Rinehart 1952); also Hans Kelsen, General
Theory of Law and State 365 (Harvard U. Press 1945).
61 See Reinisch, supra note 38, and Challenging Acts of International Organizations before National
Courts (August Reinisch ed., Oxford U. Press 2010).
62 Philippe Sands, The Tin Council Litigation in the English Courts, 34 Neth. Intl. L. Rev. 367 (1987);
Christopher Greenwood, The Tin Council Litigation in the House of Lords, 49 Cambridge L.J. 8
(Mar. 1990).
108 The World Bank Legal Review
eventually ran out of money, accumulating a staggering debt of nine hundred
million pounds sterling through borrowings from the capital market.63 Faced
with the insolvency of the organization, the creditors �led suits, inter alia, in
British courts seeking the appointment of a receiver for the purpose of wind-
ing up the organization in accordance with English bankruptcy laws. In other
words, a national court was asked to use domestic law to liquidate an organi-
zation that was created under international law by a group of sovereign states.
Not much imagination is needed to understand the legal, political, and practi-
cal unattractiveness of this proposition. To the disappointment of the credi-
tors, the national courts politely declined the honor. Starting from the premise
that international organizations are created not by the territorial enactments
of any single state but by an international legal instrument, and �nding that
they are, as a consequence, not subject to any territorial system of law,64 Justice
Millet reasoned in the following way:
An international organisation . . . is merely the means by which a
collective enterprise of the member States is carried on, and through
which their relations with each other in a particular sphere of com-
mon interest are regulated. Any attempt by one of the member States
to assume responsibility for the administration and winding up of
the organisation would be inconsistent with the arrangements made
by them as to the manner in which the enterprise is to be carried on
and their relations with each other in that sphere regulated. Sover-
eign States are free, if they wish, to carry on a collective company in-
corporated in the territory of one of their number. But if they choose
instead to carry it on through the medium of an international or-
ganisation, no one member State, by executive, legislative or judicial
action, can assume the management of the enterprise and subject it
to its own domestic law.65
Because international organizations are creatures of international law that
cannot be regulated by domestic law, “the court has no jurisdiction to wind
up the ITC�; further, “this makes it unnecessary to consider the question of
immunity, for there is no need for immunity from jurisdiction which does not
exist.�66
Indeed, the charters of international organizations, embodied in interna-
tional agreements, are multilateral treaties according to the ICJ, albeit of a par-
ticular type.67 One of these particularities is that the constituent instruments
63 Sandhya Chandrasekhar, Cartel in a Can: The Financial Collapse of the International Tin Council,
10 Nw. J. Intl. L. & Bus. 309 (1989–90); Ian A. Mallory, Conduct Unbecoming: The Collapse of the
International Tin Agreement, 5 Am. U.J. Intl. L. & Policy 835 (1989–90).
64 Re International Tin Council (England High Court, 1987), 77 Intl. L. Rep. 18, 28.
65 Id., at 36.
66 Id.
67 See, for example, Legality of the Use by a State of Nuclear Weapons in Armed Conflict supra note
44, at 74–75; and, more comprehensively, Tetsuo Sato, Evolving Constitutions of International
Organizations (Kluwer Law International 1996).
IFIs and Private Parties 109
create new subjects of law endowed with certain autonomy.68 The ICJ says that
international organizations “are subjects of international law and, as such, are
bound by any obligation incumbent upon them under general rules of inter-
national law.�69 In other words, the legal existence and operations of interna-
tional organizations are, by de�nition, governed by international law.70 More
recently, the Hague Arbitration Tribunal con�rmed in its partial award in the
Bank for International Settlements (BIS) case71 that any matter that implicates the
organic principles or internal governance of international organizations shall
be governed by international law. By consequence, the question of whether
the BIS was authorized to squeeze out certain shareholders by recalling the
privately held shares in the organization was to be answered not by any
system of national law but by international law.72
The obligations of international organizations that emanate from their
constitutional instruments and from the secondary law of international or-
ganizations are international legal norms, just as the obligations emanating
from treaties to which an organization is a party are legal norms; the same
can also be said of customary international law.73 By de�nition, then, the op-
erations of international organizations are governed by international law.74
International tribunals have often declared that the laws of member states of
international organizations, whether statutory or judicial, do not govern the
organizations or any of their organs. Otherwise, operations could be encum-
bered by entanglements and (possible) conflicts created by domestic laws
and regulations and by the (possibly) divergent rulings of its many member
states.75
68 Paul Reuter, Introduction to the Law of Treaties 85–86, paragraph 169 (Pinter 1989).
69 Interpretation of the Agreement of 25 March 1951 between WHO and Egypt, supra note 41, at 89,
paragraph 37. For a discussion of ICJ’s case law applicable to international organizations,
see Hugh Thirlway, The Law and Procedure of the International Court of Justice, 1960–1989, Part
Eight, 67 British Y.B. Intl. L. 1, 4–36 (1996).
70 Cf. Westland Helicopters Ltd. v. Arab Organisation for Industrialization et al., 23 Intl. Leg.
Materials 1071 (1984) and Broches, supra note 15.
71 Dr. Horst Reinecius et al. v. Bank for International Settlement, Hague Arbitral Tribunal, Partial
Award of November 22, 2002, available at . This case stems from a decision on January 8, 2001, of the extraordinary general meet-
ing of the BIS to restrict the right to hold shares in the BIS exclusively to central banks and
approve the mandatory repurchase of all BIS shares held by private shareholders against
payment of compensation of 16,000 Swiss francs per share. Three former private share-
holders had challenged the repurchase by initiating proceedings before the Hague Arbitral
Tribunal, which has sole jurisdiction in this matter. The Hague Arbitral Tribunal con�rmed
that the compulsory repurchase by the BIS was legally valid and consistent with its public
interest mandate as an international organization.
72 Id., at paragraph 123.
73 See Chittharanjan F. Amerasinghe, Principles of the Institutional Law of International Organisa-
tions 326 (2nd ed., Cambridge U. Press 2005). See also Philippe Sands & Pierre Klein, Bowett’s
Law of International Institutions 441 (5th ed., Sweet & Maxwell 2001).
74 Cf. Westland Helicopters case, supra note 70, and Broches, supra note 15.
75 See World Bank Administrative Tribunal (WBAT): de Merode, Decision No. 1 (1981), para-
graph 36; Mould, Decision No. 210 (1999), paragraphs 23–24; Cissé, Decision No. 242 (2001),
110 The World Bank Legal Review
Such a view is illustrated by an event in 2000 in which a South Korean
court rejected a lawsuit �led by a group of labor unions against the IMF for
alleged policy mistakes. The unions were suing the IMF for 480 million won
(US$426,000) in compensation for job losses caused by austerity measures
adopted by the Korean government as conditions for a US$57 billion IMF
balance-of-payments credit. The unions claimed that the IMF had given bad
advice—including maintaining high interest rates and pushing for corporate
restructuring—that had caused businesses to fail and unemployment to rise.
The judge accepted the IMF’s defense that no signatory country can hold the
IMF civilly or criminally liable over its policy implementation.76 This is en-
tirely different from saying that the IMF—and, for that matter, international
�nancial institutions—cannot be held responsible internationally for its policy
implementation; it merely means that such responsibility can only be estab-
lished by a competent international body—whether ad hoc or standing—
applying governing international norms.
The Exclusive International Nature of Financial Resources
The problem manifests itself also in relation to the ability of domestic courts to
dispose of the �nancial resources of international �nancial institutions. Inter-
national organizations typically derive the �nancial resources needed to fund
their operations from contributions by their member states. The funding so ob-
tained in effect constitutes a common international fund, the exclusive use of
which is to support and sustain organizational functioning. Members transfer
resources to international organizations through legal transactions governed
by international law,77 namely, by using the constituent instrument of a given
organization as the appropriate legal vehicle. These transactions may consist
of the payment of assessed contributions, the discharge of pledges to contrib-
ute to the replenishment of the organization, the payment for quotas or shares
in the capital of an organization, and loans from member states to the orga-
nization.78 Such loans are governed by international law.79 The fact that these
legal transactions are governed by international law signi�es that an interna-
tional organization’s property title over its resources does not hail from any
system of national law.80 This in turn explains why international organizations
paragraph 23; Rodriguez-Sawyer, Decision No. 330 (2005), paragraph 14; and Aida Shekib,
Decision No. 358 (2007).
76 Korean Workers Lawsuit against IMF Thrown Out, available at .
77 Cf. Frederick A. Mann, Money in Public International Law, 96 Recueil des Cours 99–104 (1959)
(discussing the monetary law of interstate obligations).
78 For example, IFAD, Establishment of the Spanish Food Security Co-�nancing Facility Trust Fund,
IFAD Doc. EB 2010/100/R.29/Rev.2, available at .
79 On the legal implications of the possibility of IMF borrowing from other than of�cial
sources, see Joseph Gold, Borrowing by the International Monetary Fund from Nonof�cial Lenders,
20 Intl. Law. 455 (1986).
80 See Ian Brownlie, Principles of Public International Law 416 (6th ed., Oxford U. Press 2003).
IFIs and Private Parties 111
can be liquidated only through the operation of a rule of international law,81
which for most organizations is a decision reserved for the institution’s high-
est governing body. Once such a body decides to liquidate the organization, it
must also make decisions concerning the orderly collection and liquidation of
the organization’s assets and the settlement of its liabilities. Thus, the property
rights that international organizations hold over the �nancial resources made
available to them by their member states belong to the realm of matters that
cannot be regulated by any national legal order. As stated in Maclaine Wat-
son v. International Tin Council, “it is axiomatic that municipal courts have not
and cannot have the competence to adjudicate upon or to enforce the rights
arising out of transactions entered into by independent sovereign states
between themselves on the plane of international law.�82
The Exclusive International Nature of Employment Relations
A third area that is beyond domestic jurisdiction concerns the employment
relations between international organizations and their international civil
servants. To avoid conflicting norms, international administrative tribunals
have often declared that domestic laws, whether statutory or judicial, do not
govern the international organizations or any of their organs.83 Although this
declaration should suf�ce to explain the nonapplicability of national laws,
another persuasive reason is that an autonomous system of law is necessary
for preserving the independence of international civil servants from national
pressures and thus to protect the organizations from unilateral control by a
member over the activities in its territory.84
According to Amerasinghe, this “principle is basic for the operation of in-
ternational organizations.�85 Taking a softer approach, others caution against
using national rules and laws in the practice of international courts and inter-
national administrative tribunals unless the organization in question has spe-
ci�cally submitted to such rules to a limited degree and in a limited context,
meaning that these rules amount to customary international law.86 In this re-
spect, mention is made of Saunoi v. INTERPOL, in which the International La-
bour Organization Administrative Tribunal (ILOAT) based its dismissal of the
complaint on the plaintiff’s reliance on the legislation and case law of the host
state by stating that as an international organization, INTERPOL is not subject
to national law and that the claims that the plaintiff sought to support using
81 Re International Tin Council, supra note 64, at 27–36.
82 Maclaine Watson & Co. Ltd. v. International Tin Council, 3 All Eng. L. Rep. 523 (1989).
83 See WBAT: de Merode, Decision No. 1 (1981), paragraph 36; Mould, Decision No. 210 (1999),
paragraphs 23–24; Cissé, Decision No. 242 (2001), paragraph 23; Rodriguez-Sawyer, Decision
No. 330 (2005), paragraph 14; and Aida Shekib, Decision No. 358 (2007).
84 Cf. Mendaro v. World Bank, 717 F.2d 610 at 615 (D.C. Cir. 1983).
85 Chittharanjan F. Amerasinghe, The Law of the International Civil Service vol. I, 7 (2d ed.,
Oxford U. Press 1994); see also Reinisch, supra note 38, at 242–43.
86 Finn Seyersted, Applicable Law in Relations between Intergovernmental Organizations and Private
Parties, 122 Recueil des Cours 427 (1967).
112 The World Bank Legal Review
French law had to be set aside because the complainant was not able to refer
to any INTERPOL text that would warrant taking such law into account.87
According to the tribunal, therefore, the application of national law must be
justi�ed and cannot be presumed.88 It should be noted that in Kock, N’Diaye and
Silbereiss, the ILOAT clari�ed that it never ruled out municipal law a priori.
Af�rming its competence in international law contexts, the tribunal acknowl-
edged that under certain circumstances, it could bene�t from drawing upon
municipal law provisions, particularly where there is a renvoi to such law in a
contract of service or in an organization’s rules. Precedent further illustrates
that reference to municipal law can be made for comparative purposes in or-
der to deduce certain general principles of law that apply to the international
civil service.89 Such renvoi to national law is inherently limited, however, and
can never lead to the total submission of an international organization to a
national legal order unless the organization ceases to be a creature of interna-
tional law.
The reverse would imply that national courts would be able to apply
national standards to international organizations and impose national rem-
edies in handling complaints. This scenario is �rmly rejected in the decision
of the D.C. Court of Appeals in Broadbent v. OAS, an appeal of a district court
judgment that had dismissed an action by appellants who claimed that they
had been improperly discharged by the OAS:
The United States has accepted without quali�cation the principles
that international organizations must be free to perform their func-
tions and that no member state may take action to hinder the organi-
zation. . . . Denial of immunity opens the door to divided decisions of
the courts of different member states passing judgment on the rules,
regulations, and decisions of the international bodies. Undercutting
uniformity in the application of staff rules or regulations would un-
dermine the ability of the organization to function effectively.90
The World Bank’s epic journey through the Bangladeshi courts further
renders testimony to the undesirability of domestic courts sitting in judgment
over disputes between international organizations and their staff. 91 Ismet
Zerin Khan, who challenged the Bank’s decision not to con�rm her probation-
ary appointment on the grounds of abuse of discretion and failure to apply the
staff rules, had exhausted all the internal administrative grievance recourses
of the World Bank, including the appeals committee and the administrative
87 ILOAT Judgment 1020 (1990).
88 ILOAT Judgment 1080 (1991), paragraph 13.
89 ILOAT Judgment 1451 (1995). See also ILOAT Judgments 1311 (1994) and 1369 (1994).
90 See the reasoning of the D.C. Court of Appeals in Broadbent v. OAS, 628 F.2d 27, 35 (D.C. Cir.
1980) (references omitted).
91 IFI WATCH Bangladesh, Bangladesh Working Group on International Financial Insti-
tutions and Trade Organizations, The World Bank and the Question of Immunity (Sep. 4,
2004), available at .
IFIs and Private Parties 113
tribunal. An advertisement for recruitment to the disputed position while
Kahn’s application was pending review in the appeals committee led her to
�le a case in the court of Dhaka. After ignoring several summons, the Bank
�led an application for rejection of the complaint. The primary ground cited
was that the Bank enjoyed immunity from legal process and could therefore
not be sued in Bangladesh. In the meantime, a judgment favorable to Khan
was rendered by the World Bank Administrative Tribunal. The tribunal did
not accede to Khan’s request for reinstatement, however, awarding only pe-
cuniary compensation (one year’s salary plus costs).92 This development did
not end the proceedings in Dhaka. Instead, on the critical issue of immunity,
the court observed, “no Establishment Agreement existed between the World
Bank and Bangladesh.� The court also determined that the provision of im-
munity is in opposition to the Constitution of Bangladesh and that immunity
in this setting is fundamentally contrary to the spirit of the constitution. As to
the merits, the court ruled that the plaintiff was entitled to be reinstated and
receive arrear salaries and bene�ts93 and
that the instant suit be decreed against the defendants on contest
without any order as to costs and further declared that the letter
dated 03/05/2001 terminating the plaintiff from service is illegal,
mala�de, arbitrary and not binding upon the plaintiff. The plaintiff
is entitled to be reinstated in her post and get all arrear salaries and
bene�ts. Defendants are directed to pay the salaries and other ben-
e�ts to the plaintiff deducting the compensation money which the
plaintiff has received earlier as she is still now in service as External
Affairs Of�cer of the defendant.94
Thus, a domestic court of a World Bank member state asserted jurisdiction
to ignore a �nal decision (res judicata) of the World Bank Administrative Tribu-
nal; set aside an employment decision of the chief administrative of�cer; and
expressly issued an order to the World Bank to reinstate the claimant. This rul-
ing is unprecedented, and it illustrates why domestic courts cannot be given
a role in examining the legality of decisions of international organizations.
Recall that “from the standpoint of international law . . . municipal laws are
merely facts which express the will and constitute the activities of the States,
in the same manner as do legal decisions or administrative measures.�95 As
a result, no decision of a national court can invalidate an act or conduct that
owes its existence and validity to international law.96
92 WBAT Decision No. 293, Khan (2003).
93 News from Bangladesh, Termination of WB Employee Declared Illegal: Dhaka Court, available at
.
94 Ismet Zerin Khan v. World Bank and Others, High Court of Dhaka, April 28, 2010, Suit/Case
No. 48.
95 Certain German Interests in Polish Upper Silesia (Merits) (Germany v. Poland), 1926 P.C.I.J.
Series A, No. 7, at 19.
96 Cf. Chorzow Factory (Merits) (Germany v. Poland), 1928 P.C.I.J. Series A, No. 17, at 33–34.
114 The World Bank Legal Review
By ignoring this principle, the Dhaka High Court contributed to a situa-
tion in which the World Bank was confronted with two conflicting judgments
dealing with the same matter: one rendered by an incompetent domestic court
that ordered reinstatement and compensation, and another decided by a com-
petent international tribunal that awarded only compensation. Even though
this ruling clearly exceeded Bangladesh’s jurisdictional authority under inter-
national law, relegating it to little more than brutum fulnem at the international
level, the undesirability of its outcome remains problematic: it is compelling
evidence against the argument favoring a role for domestic courts in the settle-
ment of disputes between private parties and international organizations.
The foregoing analysis shows that the issue of inherent constraints on
domestic legal orders—that is, that domestic law cannot regulate matters that
are essentially international by their nature—poses limitations on the role
domestic courts can play in settling claims of private parties against interna-
tional organizations. Domestic courts will have to declare that they are incom-
petent to deal with such questions without having to expressly address the
issue of immunity from legal process:
chacun sait qu’il y a des litiges qui, par leur nature même, relevant ex-
clusivement d’une ordre juridique determiné . . . et à l’égard desquels
un juge est radicalement incompétent [anyone knows that there are
cases which, by their nature, relate to only a given legal order . . . and
in respect of which the judge is manifestly incompetent].97
The Exclusion of a Role for Domestic Courts by International Law
When considering the argument for allowing domestic courts to deal with
private claims against international organizations, one should not forget that,
given the principle of the unity of the state, domestic courts are no more than
organs of states whose conduct—notwithstanding their independence from
the executive power—is attributable to the state for the purposes of interna-
tional responsibility.98 As a matter of fact, at the time of the writing of this
chapter, a case is pending before the ICJ on the very question of whether the
denial of immunity to Germany by Italian courts was lawful under interna-
tional law.99 As regards the immunity from legal process of international orga-
nizations, this was con�rmed by the Cumaraswamy case in 1999, when the ICJ
ruled that any decision by a domestic court that denies or restricts its immuni-
ty can be ruled wrongful by a competent international authority.100 In the same
97 Dominicé, supra note 46, at 83.
98 James Crawford, The International Law Commission’s Article on State Responsibility—Introduc-
tion, Text and Commentaries 95 (Cambridge U. Press 2002).
99 ICJ Press Release No. 2008/44, Germany Institutes Proceedings against Italy for Failing to Respect
Its Jurisdictional Immunity as a Sovereign State (Dec. 23, 2008), available at .
100 Difference Relating to Immunity from Legal Process of a Special Rapporteur of the Commission on
Human Rights, supra note 48, at 88. See also Rosalyn Higgins, The Changing Position of Domestic
IFIs and Private Parties 115
case, the ICJ stated that international organizations should not go free when
their actions harm private parties, clarifying that “the question of immunity
from legal process is distinct from the issue of compensation for any damages
incurred as a result of acts performed� by an international organization.101 In
other words, “an international organization which deals with private parties
cannot use its jurisdictional immunity to hide from its responsibilities.�102 The
court continued, “the United Nations may be required to bear responsibility
for the damage arising from such acts. However, as is clear from Article VIII,
Section 29, of the General Convention, any such claims against the United
Nations shall not be dealt with by national courts but shall be settled in ac-
cordance with the appropriate modes of settlement that “the United Nations
shall make provisions for� pursuant to Section 29.103
In other words, as con�rmed by the Brussels Civil Tribunal in Manderlier
(1966), there is no role to be played by national courts in resolving private-
party claims against international organizations: “it is for the United Nations,
and for it alone, to set up courts that could produce an appropriate method of
settlement for disputes which it may have with third parties (sic).�104 More re-
cently, in Cynthia Brzak v. United Nations, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Sec-
ond Circuit con�rmed that the convention “unequivocally grants the United
Nations absolute immunity without exception.�105
An identical obligation is found in Article IX, Section 31, of the Conven-
tion on the Privileges and Immunities of the Specialized Agencies,106 which
means that this obligation applies as well to the International Bank for Recon-
struction and Development (IBRD), International Development Association
(IDA), International Finance Corporation (IFC), IMF, and International Fund
for Agricultural Development (IFAD) by virtue of their status as specialized
agencies of the United Nations. As a result, in the territories of the member-
state parties to the Convention on the Privileges and Immunities of the Spe-
cialized Agencies that have not made a reservation in respect of that provision,
Courts in the International Legal Order, in Themes & Theories: Selected Essays, Speeches, and Writ-
ings in International Law vol. 2, 1340, 1344 (Oxford U. Press 2009).
101 Difference Relating to Immunity from Legal Process of a Special Rapporteur of the Commission on
Human Rights, supra note 48, at 88.
102 Alexander S. Muller, International Organizations and Their Host States: Aspects of Their Legal
Relationship (Kluwer Law International 1995), at 177.
103 Difference Relating to Immunity from Legal Process of a Special Rapporteur of the Commission on
Human Rights, supra note 48, at 88–89.
104 Manderlier v. United Nations and the Belgian State, Civil Tribunal of Brussels, May 11, 1966,
45 Intl. L. Rep. 446, 452. For a discussion, see Jan Wouters & Pierre Schmidt, Challenging
Acts of Other United Nations Organs, Subsidiary Organs and Of�cials, in Challenging Acts of
International Organizations before National Courts 76, 102, 105 (August Reinisch ed., Oxford
U. Press 2010).
105 Cynthia Brzak, Nasr Ishak, Plaintiffs v. United Nations, Ko� Annan, Ruud Lubbers, Wendy Cham-
berlin, 597 F.3d 107 (2010), cert. denied.
106 Convention on the Privileges and Immunities of the Specialized Agencies (Nov. 21, 1947), 33
U.N.T.S. 261.
116 The World Bank Legal Review
domestic courts have no role to play in the settlement of disputes between pri-
vate parties and these international �nancial institutions unless the immunity
has expressly been waived in respect to the claim or quali�ed by a special rule
contained in the charters of the organizations concerned or another relevant
international instrument, such as a headquarters agreement.
In the case of the World Bank Group and the IMF, a provision in their
respective annexes107 to the convention restricts the authority of the ICJ to
“differences arising out of the interpretation and application of privileges and
immunities solely derived from the Convention and which are not included
in the privileges and immunities that these agencies can claim under their
Articles of Agreement or otherwise.�108 The only real question is whether in
light of Section 34—which stipulates that the provisions of the convention in
relation to any specialized agency must be interpreted in light of the func-
tions with which that agency is entrusted by its constitutional instrument—
the quali�ed amenability to domestic legal process contained in the Articles
of Agreement of the IBRD and IFC must be deemed to limit the scope of
Section 4. This question is a matter on which ultimately the ICJ will have the
�nal say pursuant to Section 32: “it is . . . for the Court to exercise the authority
vested in it to make a determination . . . on the applicability of the Convention,
and on . . . entitlement to immunity.�109
Article 35.2 of the Statute of the European System of Central Banks and
of the European Central Bank (ECB) states that the European Court of Justice
shall have jurisdiction in any dispute between the ECB and its servants within
the limits and under the conditions laid down in the terms of employment.
In other words, disputes between the ECB and its staff fall under the exclu-
sive competence of the court of justice, speci�cally the European Union Civil
Service Tribunal, and must not be brought before a national court. Similarly,
Article 28.5 of the EIB statute stipulates that the European Court of Justice
shall have jurisdiction in disputes concerning measures adopted by organs of
a body incorporated under European Union law.
Thus, even where the charters of the international �nancial institutions
contain a special arrangement concerning the position of the institution with
regard to legal process, as is the case with the IBRD, IDA, and IFC, the role
107 Section 33 of the convention states that in their application to each specialized agency, the
standard clauses shall operate subject to any modi�cation set forth in the �nal (or revised)
text of the annex relating to that agency, as provided in Sections 36 and 38.
108 The Practice of the United Nations, the Specialized Agencies and the International Atomic Energy
Agency Concerning Their Status, Privileges and Immunities: Study Prepared by the Secretariat, 2
Y.B. Intl. L. Commn. 154, 322 (1967).
109 Difference Relating to Immunity from Legal Process of a Special Rapporteur of the Commis-
sion on Human Rights, supra note 48, at 99, 102 (Separate Opinion, Judge Oda). See also
Charles N. Brower & Pieter H. F. Bekker, Understanding “Binding� Advisory Opinions of the
International Court of Justice, in Liber amicorum Judge Shigeru Oda vol. 1, 351 (Nisuke Ando,
Edward McWhinney, & Rudiger Wolfrum ed., Kluwer Law International 2002).
IFIs and Private Parties 117
accorded to domestic courts is restricted to speci�ed dealings.110 Domestic
courts cannot deny or narrowly interpret the scope of existing immunities un-
der the Specialized Agencies Convention and thereby vest themselves with
the jurisdiction to adjudicate suits against the global international �nancial
institutions. The same is true with respect to the immunity clauses in the
charters of these institutions as well as in the constituent instruments of the
regional development banks. These charters contain provisions reserving the
right to provide authoritative interpretation to an organ of such institutions
(often the executive board);111 learned opinion112 and at least one domestic quasi-
judicial body113 hold that there is an obligation to defer to the competent execu-
tive board on matters concerning the interpretation of charters of international
�nancial institutions.
Seen in this light, the choice of whether immunity from domestic le-
gal process of international �nancial institutions is obsolete or should be
restricted must be understood to be proffered as a possible new direction of
the law (lege ferenda). The remainder of this chapter clari�es that, in order to
ensure that claims of private parties against international �nancial institutions
are afforded (procedural and substantive) due process, it is not necessary to
eliminate or restrict their immunity from domestic legal process.
Immunity Obliges
It has been established that
• The relevant international legal instruments reserve the �nal authority to
determine the scope of the immunity from legal process to designated
international bodies.
110 For a discussion of those provisions see August Reinisch & Jakub Wurm, International
Financial Institutions before National Courts, in International Financial Institutions and Interna-
tional Law 103, 104–07 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed., Kluwer Law International
2010).
111 Andres Rigo Sureda, The Law Applicable to the Activities of International Development Banks, 308
Recueil des Cours 9, 48–52 (2005).
112 For example, Joseph Gold, Interpretation: The IMF and International Law 32, 38, & 39
(Kluwer Law International 1996), and Christoph C. Schreuer, Decisions of International
Institutions before Domestic Courts 67–70 (Oceana 1981). Contra, but not going as far as saying
that national courts are competent, Frederick A. Mann, The “Interpretation� of the Constitutions of
International Financial Organizations, in Studies in International Law 591, 606–08 (Oxford U.
Press 1973).
113 IBRD, IMF v. All American Cables et al., 22 Intl. L. Rep. 705. For discussions, see Joseph Gold,
The Fund Agreement in the Courts vol. I, 20–27 (IMF 1962); Ervin P. Hexner, Interpretation by
Public International Organizations of Their Basic Instruments, 53 Am. J. Intl. L. 341, 354–55
(1959); and Lester Nurick, Certain Aspects of the Law and Practice of the International Bank for
Reconstruction and Development, in The Effectiveness of International Decisions: Papers of a Confer-
ence of the American Society of International Law and the Proceedings of the Conference 100, 123–26
(Stephen M. Schwebel ed., Sijthoff/Oceana 1971).
118 The World Bank Legal Review
• Some of the international instruments expressly exclude any role of do-
mestic courts in the settlement of private claims against international or-
ganizations.
• The potential role of domestic courts in the settlement of private claims
against international �nancial institutions is inherently limited due to the
fact that certain matters cannot be regulated by domestic law.
• Unlike states, international organizations operate in domestic markets out
of functional necessity, rather than choice, and therefore they cannot be
treated in the same way as states for the purpose of the application of the
doctrine of immunity.
• Given the responsibility of international �nancial institutions to mitigate,
if not eliminate, the imperfections of the capital market as it relates to the
developing needs of the eligible countries, noninterference by domestic
legal order, including immunity from domestic legal process, is a conditio
sine qua non for their functioning.
The Obligation to Provide an Appropriate Mode of Settlement
However, the conversation does not end with the conclusion that the immu-
nities of international organizations are not anachronistic or that they are a
conditio sine qua non for their functioning. The ICJ con�rmed in Cumaraswamy
that this is only a part of the story. The rest of the story is equally important.
The court made it crystal clear that immunity from national legal process does
not mean impunity; it further explained that international organizations are
required to adopt appropriate modes of settlement for resolving disputes be-
tween international organizations and private claimants.114 Thus, although the
court underscored that issues concerning the responsibility of international
organizations, whether contractual or noncontractual, are not to be dealt with
by domestic courts, the court also emphasized that the settlement of disputes
with private parties through appropriate means is mandatory.115 This is in line
with the court’s 1954 advisory opinion in the Effect of Awards case, in which it
upheld the legality of the creation of the UN Administrative Tribunal (UNAT).
According to the court,
it would … hardly be consistent with the expressed aim of the Char-
ter to promote freedom and justice for individuals … that it [the UN]
should afford no judicial or arbitral remedy to its own staff for the
settlement of any disputes which may arise between it and them.116
The court’s ruling indicates that both the immunity of international orga-
nizations from domestic legal process and the duty to establish an adequate
114 Difference Relating to Immunity from Legal Process of a Special Rapporteur of the Commission on
Human Rights, supra note 48, at 88–89.
115 See Muller, supra note 102, at 176–77.
116 Effect of Awards of Compensation Made by the U.N. Administrative Tribunal, Advisory Op., 1954
I.C.J. 57.
IFIs and Private Parties 119
dispute settlement system are absolute.117 In other words, immunity obliges!
Unlike suggestions by William Berenson in this volume,118 there is no inher-
ent conflict between immunity from national legal process and the right to a
fair trial, and the concept of immunity is in no way anathema to the concept
of fair play and substantial justice. A clear expression of this dual obligation
can be found in Article VIII, Section 29, of the Convention on the Privileges
and Immunities of the United Nations119 and in Article IX, Section 31, the Con-
vention on the Privileges and Immunities of the Specialized Agencies.120 The
latter convention applies to the global multilateral �nancial institutions—that
is, the World Bank Group, the IMF, and the IFAD—by virtue of their status as
specialized agencies of the United Nations. This fact is important because Sec-
tion 31 requires those institutions to establish appropriate modes of settling
disputes with private parties.
In Cabrera (1983), the Argentine Supreme Court took the position that
when a treaty containing immunity from domestic legal process is not paired
with alternative means to settle disputes with private parties, such a clause
is not valid under international law. The court declared unconstitutional Ar-
ticle 4 of the headquarters agreement between Argentina and the Comisión
Técnica Mixta de Salto Grande, which accorded immunity from domestic ju-
dicial process to this bi-national organization. The court reasoned that the ab-
sence in the agreement of an obligation for the organization to set up dispute
settlement mechanisms for private claims infringed on the right to judicial
protection enshrined in the Argentine Constitution and in international law.
Most striking about this decision is that in the eyes of the court, this omission
rendered the immunity from legal process invalid on account of Article 53
of the 1969 Vienna Convention on the Law of Treaties, that is, for breach of a
peremptory norm of international law (ius cogens): the right of access to
justice.121 Interestingly, the court based this quali�cation of the right of ac-
cess to justice, inter alia, on Articles 8 and 10 of the Universal Declaration of
Human Rights, and on Section 31 of the Convention on the Privileges and
Immunities of the Specialized Agencies.
117 Cf. Karel Wellens, Remedies against International Organizations 125 (Cambridge U. Press 2002).
118 William M. Berenson, Squaring the Concept of Immunity with the Fundamental Right to a Fair
Trial: The Case of the OAS, in this volume.
119 Convention on the Privileges and Immunities of the United Nations (Feb. 13, 1946), 1
U.N.T.S. 15.
120 Convention on the Privileges and Immunities of the Specialized Agencies (Nov. 21, 1947), 33
U.N.T.S. 261.
121 Cabrera, Washington J. E. c. Comisión Técnica Mixta de Salto Grande, Corte Suprema de
Justicia de la Nación (CS) (1983), available at . For a discussion, see Zlata Drnas de Clément & Marta Susana Sartori, La aplicación
del Derecho Internacional en los fallos de la Corte Suprema de Justicia de la Nación Argentina 161
(Lerner 2010). See also Christian Dominicé, Morgan v. World Bank (Ten Years Later), in Liber
amicorum Ibrahim F. I. Shihata—International Finance and Development Law 155, 166 (Sabine
Schlemmer-Schulte & Ko-Yung Tung ed., Kluwer Law International 2001) (supporting the
view that the right to access to court is jus cogens).
120 The World Bank Legal Review
In reaching this decision, the court took into account that the Comisión
Técnica Mixta de Salto Grande had established its Tribunal Arbitral Interna-
cional de Salto Grande, which had jurisdiction over private claims against
the organization. However, because the case started before the establishment
of said tribunal, the tribunal did not have jurisdiction over the case and was
not deemed suf�cient to remedy the situation confronted in that case. In a
subsequent judgment, Fibraca Constructora (1993),122 the Argentine Supreme
Court took the opportunity to clarify that Cabrera does not apply in cases in
which the organization has established an adequate dispute-settlement mech-
anism. What was at stake was the immunity of the Comisión Técnica Mixta de
Salto Grande. The court ruled that due to the availability of the Tribunal Ar-
bitral Internacional de Salto Grande, Cabrera did not apply. A few years later,
in Duhalde (1999),123 the court underscored this view. The case involved the
immunity from legal process of the World Health Organization (WHO) and
the Pan-American Health Organization. The court upheld WHO’s immunity
given the existence of appropriate alternative remedies for WHO employees
(in particular the ILOAT), but only after recalling that without such remedies,
the treaty-based immunity would be struck down by operation of a jus cogens
norm.
The Cabrera jurisprudence failed to garner international attention, but its
assertion of a synallagmatic relationship between international organizations’
immunity and the duty to provide means of redress to private parties was
catapulted to the forefront by the European Court of Human Rights in 1999.124
Less than three months prior to the ICJ’s ruling in Cumarasawamy, in Waite and
Kennedy, by unanimous judgment, a grand chamber of the European Court
of Human Rights rejected attempts to question the compatibility of absolute
immunity with human rights obligations.
In a case arising from domestic litigation before the German labor court,
instituted by the applicants against the European Space Agency (ESA), the
court held that Germany had not violated Article 6(1) of the European Con-
vention on Human Rights by granting the ESA immunity from suit. The court
reiterated the principle that Article 6(1) secures the right to have any claim re-
lating to civil rights and obligations brought before a court or tribunal. In this
way, the article embodies the “right to a court,� of which the right of access
or the right to institute proceedings before a court in civil matters constitutes
only one aspect. The court deemed that the reasons advanced by the German
labor court to give effect to the immunity from legal process of the ESA could
122 Fibraca Constructora S.C.A. c. Comisión Técnica Mixta de Salto Grande, Fallo de la Corte
Suprema: Buenos Aires (Jul. 7, 1993), available at .
123 Duhalde, Mario Alfredo c. Demandado: Organizacion Panamericana de la Salud Organizacion
Mundial de la Salud O�cina Sanitaria Panamericana, Dictamen nº D. 73. XXXIV de Corte
Suprema de Justicia de la Nación (Mar. 31, 1999), available at .
124 Wellens, supra note 117, at 13–14.
IFIs and Private Parties 121
not be regarded as arbitrary. It examined whether access, when limited to a
preliminary issue, was suf�cient to secure the applicants’ right to a court in
light of its case law, and in particular in light of the principle that such re-
stricted access be in pursuit of a legitimate aim and the principle that there
is a reasonable relationship of proportionality between the means employed
and the aim.
According to the court, the rule of immunity of international organizations
from domestic legal process as applied to the ESA by the German courts had
a legitimate objective. The court noted that the attribution of privileges and
immunities to international organizations was an essential means of ensuring
the proper functioning of such organizations free from unilateral interference
by individual governments. Rather than invoking jus cogens, as was done in
Cabrera, the European Court of Human Rights analyzed the issue in terms of
proportionality. A material factor in determining whether granting ESA immu-
nity from German jurisdiction was permissible was whether the applicants had
available reasonable alternative means to protect their rights under the conven-
tion. The court opined that, because the applicants had claimed the existence
of an employment relationship with ESA, they could and should have had re-
course to the ESA Appeals Board, which is “independent of the Agency� and
has jurisdiction “to hear disputes relating to any explicit or implicit decision
taken by the Agency and arising between it and a staff member� (Regulation
33.1 of the ESA Staff Regulations). The court also considered the possibility for
temporary workers to seek redress from the �rms that had employed them and
contracted with them. It concluded that the test of proportionality could not be
applied in such a way as to compel an international organization to submit itself
to national litigation for matters concerning employment conditions prescribed
under national labor law. Such an interpretation of Article 6(1) would thwart the
proper functioning of international organizations:
The Court shares the Commission’s conclusion that, bearing in mind
the legitimate aim of immunities of international organisations (see
paragraph 63 above), the test of proportionality cannot be applied
in such a way as to compel an international organisation to submit
itself to national litigation in relation to employment conditions pre-
scribed under national labour law. To read Article 6 § 1 of the Con-
vention and its guarantee of access to court as necessarily requiring
the application of national legislation in such matters would, in the
Court’s view, thwart the proper functioning of international organi-
sations and run counter to the current trend towards extending and
strengthening international cooperation.125
Yet, except in Switzerland, the court’s unequivocal assertion did not reso-
nate. Rather, the decision in Waite and Kennedy is understood to state that an
alternative means of redress is a precondition for the enjoyment of immunity
125 Waite and Kennedy v. Germany, App. No. 26083/94, 30 Eur. Ct. Hum. Rights 261 (1999).
122 The World Bank Legal Review
from national legal process.126 More important, some domestic courts read
into Waite and Kennedy a license to examine the presence and adequacy of
the alternative means of redress offered by international organizations and
to deny immunity where they deem the means not to be adequate.127 This
development feeds the controversy and uncertainty about jurisdictional im-
munity beyond the shores of Europe.128 However, as the Swiss Federal Tri-
bunal held in NML Capital Ltd., to read into the right of access to court an
entitlement to deny immunity when an alternative means is deemed to ex-
ist would thwart the proper functioning of international organizations and
run counter to the trend toward extending and strengthening international
cooperation.129
None of the foregoing judicial rulings recognized any link between the
obligation to provide appropriate means to deal with claims of private parties
and the question of whether the immunity should be restricted or absolute.
According to Wellens, the “obligation to establish such a (judicial) remedial
system for the settlement of conflicts or disputes in which international or-
ganisations may become involved does not disappear when the immunity is
restrictive, rather than absolute.�130 Be that as it may, these rulings contain
important advice that should be heeded by any international organization in
light of its duty to guard its own independent functioning against interference
by national authorities.
Discharging the Obligation
Quali�ed Amenability to Domestic Legal Process
The position of international �nancial institutions with regard to judicial
process, as stated in their constituent instruments, generally does not assert
uncompromised immunity from legal process, but rather entails a regime of
quali�ed amenability to lawsuits. In fact, only Article IX, Section 3, of the Ar-
ticles of Agreement of the IMF is as uncompromising as the Convention on
the Privileges and Immunities of the Specialized Agencies. It provides that the
IMF, its property, and its assets, wherever located and by whomsoever held,
shall enjoy immunity from every form of judicial process except to the extent
that it expressly waives its immunity for the purpose of any proceedings or
126 See discussion at August Reinisch, The Immunity of International Organizations and the Jurisdic-
tion of Their Administrative Tribunals, 7 Chinese J. Intl. L. 285 (2008).
127 Cedric Ryngaert, The Immunity of International Organizations before Domestic Courts: Some
Recent Trends, 7 Intl. Organizations L. Rev. 121 (2010).
128 For example, a letter dated February 6, 2009, from the chair of the Senate economic affairs
committee (Miriam Defensor Santiago) to the Philippine Country Director of the World
Bank, available at .
129 NML Capital Ltd., EM Limited v. Bank für Internationalen Zahlungsausgleich (BIZ), Betrei-
bungsamt Basel-Stadt, Bundesgericht, July 12, 2010, Consideration 4.5.3. available at
130 Wellens, supra note 117, at 125.
IFIs and Private Parties 123
by the terms of any contract. The position of the other international �nancial
institutions is much more nuanced. For example, Section 4 of Article VII of the
IBRD Articles of Agreement states:
Actions may be brought against the Bank only in a court of com-
petent jurisdiction in the territories of a member in which the Bank
has an of�ce, has appointed an agent for the purpose of accepting
service of process, or has issued or guaranteed securities. No action
shall, however, be brought by members or persons acting for or de-
riving claims from members.131
The regime established by this provision entails that the World Bank may
be subjected to legal process only in a competent court in a member country,
provided that it either has an of�ce in the territory concerned or has appointed
an agent to accept service or notice of process, or has issued or guaranteed
securities.132 This regime, which is replicated in the charters of the IDA,133 the
IFC,134 the Nordic Investment Bank,135 the European Bank for Reconstruction
and Development (EBRD),136 and the Inter-American Development Bank,137
differs from the one established in the constituent instruments of the Carib-
bean Development Bank,138 the Asian Development Bank,139 the Black Sea
Trade and Development Bank,140 the African Development Bank,141 and the
African Development Fund.142 In the latter cases, amenability to legal process
is provided as an express exception to the immunity that otherwise applies.
The attendant provisions typically state that an institution shall enjoy immu-
nity from every form of legal process, except in cases arising out of or in con-
nection with the exercise of its powers to borrow money, guarantee obliga-
tions, or buy, sell, or underwrite the sale of securities, in which cases actions
may be brought against the institution in a court of competent jurisdiction in
the territory of a country in which it has its principal or a branch of�ce, or has
131 U.S. courts have held that Article VII does not constitute a waiver of Bank immunity with
regard to employment-related suits under the immunities conferred upon the Bank by the
U.S. International Organizations Immunities Act of 1945. See, for example, Mendaro v. World
Bank, supra note 84; Chiriboga v. International Bank for Reconstruction and Development, 616 F.
Supp. 963 (D.D.C. 1985); Morgan v. International Bank for Reconstruction and Development, 752
F. Supp. 492 (D.C. Cir. 1990).
132 Broches, supra note 15, at 9.
133 IDA Articles of Agreement, Article VIII, Section 3.
134 IFC Articles of Agreement, Article VI, Section 3.
135 Article 5, Agreement on the Nordic Investment Bank.
136 Article 46, Agreement Establishing the European Bank for Reconstruction and Development.
137 Article XI, Section 3, Agreement Establishing the Inter-American Development Bank.
138 Article 49.1, Agreement Establishing the Caribbean Development Bank.
139 Article 50.1, Agreement Establishing the Asian Development Bank.
140 Article 45.1, Establishing Agreement of the Black Sea Trade and Development Bank.
141 Article 52.1, Agreement Establishing the African Development Bank.
142 Article 43.1, Agreement Establishing the African Development Fund.
124 The World Bank Legal Review
appointed an agent for the purpose of accepting service or notice of process, or
has issued or guaranteed securities. Although stated in substantially different
terms, the quali�ed amenability to domestic legal process is also followed by
the EIB and the ECB. Article 27 (ex Article 29) of the Statute of the European
Investment Bank provides that disputes between the bank, on the one hand,
and its creditors, debtors, or any other person, on the other, shall be decided
by the competent national courts, save where jurisdiction has been conferred
on the Court of Justice of the European Union. The same rule applies to the
ECB.143 This means that the EIB and the ECB enjoy immunity from national
jurisdiction only for those cases that fall under the exclusive jurisdiction of
the European Court of Justice as laid down in the European Union Treaty, the
EIB statute and EC treaty, and the ESCB statute. In particular, the European
Court’s exclusive competence relates to actions against the foregoing institu-
tions aimed at reviewing their acts and omissions as well as claims for dam-
ages.
Noncontractual Claims
In light of the above, the problem of adequate means for dealing with claims
of private parties against international �nancial institutions exists mainly in
the relatively narrow area of noncontractual liability of non-EU international
�nancial institutions. In addition to the international administrative tribu-
nals that have been conferred jurisdiction over employment disputes involv-
ing international �nancial institutions, contracts between those institutions
and private parties invariably contain provisions designating arbitration as
a manner for resolving the disputes arising out of such contracts. Although
arbitration is deemed acceptable for contractual disputes, no standard mode
of settlement exists for disputes concerning noncontractual claims against in-
ternational �nancial institutions, such as tort, promissory estoppel, and other
quasi-contractual claims.144
As shown in Morgan,145 too often the litigation strategy of international �-
nancial institutions in noncontractual cases brought in domestic courts invites
criticism about their immunity. The plaintiff in Morgan sought compensatory
and punitive damages for intentional infliction of emotional distress, false im-
prisonment, libel, and slander. Although no alternative means for settling the
dispute was offered, the World Bank asserted that it was immune from suit,
and the court agreed. Ten years later, Christian Dominicé revisited the case
in light of evolving views about the fundamental right to access courts and
143 Article 35.2 of the Statute of the European System of Central Banks.
144 Cf. August Reinisch, Immunity of International Organizations and Alternative Remedies against
International Organizations, Seminar on State Immunity (2006), available at .
145 Morgan v. IBRD, 752 F. Supp. 492 (D.D.C. 1990). For a discussion, see Daniel Hammerschlag,
Morgan v. International Bank for Reconstruction and Development, 16 Md. J. Intl. L. & Trade 279
(1992).
IFIs and Private Parties 125
pointed out that it was unlikely that the outcome in Morgan would have been
the same in 2000, given the absence of an alternative means for the dispute
settlement.146
However, if international �nancial institutions were to adopt a different
strategy with respect to private noncontractual liability claims, they would
likely silence the growing call for the limitation or even elimination of their
immunity from domestic legal process. The 2009 D.C. Court of Appeals judg-
ment in Jorge Vila v. Inter-American Investment Corporation, involving a consul-
tant’s claim of unjust enrichment, underscores that courts will be tempted to
side with claimants in these cases. Indeed, most of the calls for eliminating or
restricting the immunities of international organizations invoke the absence
of alternative dispute-settlement mechanisms for noncontractual disputes in
order to justify why the concept of immunity is anathema to the concept of fair
play and substantial justice. 147
Outside the realm of risk-bearing activities of international organizations,
the noncontractual claims of private parties cannot easily be anticipated.148
Because of this, when engaging in risk-bearing activities (for example, debar-
ring of vendors),149 organizations would do well to accompany those activities
with default arbitration clauses or other provisions having equivalent effect.
Such default arbitration provisions are used by the IFAD with respect to the
debarment of vendors on account of violations of the organization’s policy on
fraud and corruption. The IFAD’s debarment decisions contain a suspension
clause and are communicated to the affected vendor. An affected vendor is
offered the possibility of initiating arbitration against the IFAD, within a speci-
�ed period, under the Permanent Court of Arbitration Optional Rules for Ar-
bitration between International Organizations and Private Parties. Debarment
decisions become effective either upon expiration of the time limit for appeal
or on the date of the �nal award.
There is no reason why arbitration cannot serve as the required alterna-
tive default mechanism for dealing with the noncontractual claims of private
parties against international �nancial institutions. Availability of arbitration in
such cases would shift the debate away from the legitimacy of immunity and
draw attention instead to the lack of subject matter jurisdiction of the domestic
146 Dominicé, supra note 121.
147 Jorge Vila v. Inter-American Investment Corporation, 2009 U.S. App. LEXIS 13279 (D.C. Cir.
2009).
148 For instance, an unfortunate event involving renowned economist Jacques Polak at the
eighth annual meeting of the IMF institute named after him led to an action against the
IMF for alleged negligence and negligence per se in the construction and maintenance of
stairs on the IMF’s premises. Holding that a functional necessity analysis is called for only
in cases where the immunity has been waived, the court ruled that the plaintiff’s reliance on
the functional necessity test was misplaced. As a result, the court concluded that the IMF is
immune and dismissed the suit for want of subject matter jurisdiction. See Jacques Polak v.
International Monetary Fund, 657 F. Supp. 2d 116 (D.D.C. 2009).
149 See Scope Williams, The Debarment of Corrupt Contractors from World Bank–Financed Contracts,
36 Pub. Contract L.J. 277 (2006–07).
126 The World Bank Legal Review
court, which should defer decision making to the established dispute-settle-
ment mechanism. An example of such a deferral can be found in the memo-
randum order of Judge Green of the U.S. District Court of Pennsylvania in
Bro Tech Corporation v. EBRD.150 The EBRD �led a motion to dismiss for lack of
subject matter jurisdiction, pursuant to Rule 12(b)(1) of the U.S. Federal Rules
of Civil Procedure. In addition to the subject matter jurisdiction arguments
posited by the organization, the motion invoked lack of personal jurisdiction,
improper venue, and insuf�ciency of process. The court concluded that the
EBRD had absolute immunity but had waived that immunity in its dealings
with the plaintiffs. More important, the court found that the EBRD’s waiver
was limited, and that the EBRD had waived its immunity only with respect to
the resolution of disputes through arbitration. This led to the conclusion that
all plaintiffs’ claims were controlled by the arbitration clauses in their agree-
ments with the EBRD. Accordingly, the court held that it did not have subject
matter jurisdiction over the dispute and dismissed the claims.
Although the result in Bro Tech can be relied upon to support the
notion of deferral, because the court based its conclusion on an analysis of
the effects of commercial arbitration clauses, the ruling invites reflection
on the viability of a default arbitration provision unilaterally declared by an
international organization. This issue was addressed in First Eagle in respect to
Article 54 of the BIS statutes, which speci�es that any dispute concerning the
interpretation or application of the statutes—including an amendment such as
the one at issue here—“shall be referred for �nal decision� to the arbitration
tribunal established by the Hague Agreement of 1930. The plaintiff, a private
shareholder, moved for a temporary restraining order against the BIS to pre-
vent the buyback of privately held shares. This action was prompted by the
fact that in September 2000, the bank announced that it would hold a meeting
of its central bank members on January 8, 2001, to vote on an amendment to its
statutes allowing a mandatory redemption of all public shares. The mandatory
redemption was apparently motivated by problems inherent in the restricted
market for public bank shares and by the tension between the bank’s purpose
of promoting international �nancial cooperation and a publicly owned com-
pany’s goal of maximizing pro�t to shareholders. The plan called for the bank
to cancel the registrations of all of the public shares, redistribute these shares
to the central banks, and then issue a statutory right of payment of 16,000
Swiss francs per share to the public shareholders. The U.S. District Court for
the Southern District of New York denied the motion on the ground that no
irreparable harm was threatened. On appeal, a consideration on which the
con�rmation was based was that
the primary complaint advanced by First Eagle appears to be that the
valuation methods employed by J.P. Morgan and Arthur Andersen
undervalued the privately held shares. Should First Eagle succeed in
150 Bro Tech v. EBRD, 2000 U.S. Dist. LEXIS 75626 (E.D. Pa. 2000).
IFIs and Private Parties 127
this complaint, its injury can be fully compensated by an award in
the district court or in the mandatory arbitration forum designated
by the Bank’s statutes plan.
The appeal was thus dismissed for lack of appellate jurisdiction.
Two points spring to the fore in this ruling. First, the fact that the arbitra-
tion clause is statutory—thus unilateral—rather than contractual did not seem
to constitute a problem for the domestic court. Second, the fact that the fully
competent international arbitral tribunal would deal with the substance of the
claim and provide the appropriate substantive remedies was a decisive fac-
tor in the court’s decision to defer. At the international level, this was further
underscored by the Hague Arbitral Tribunal’s subscription to BIS’s assertion
that the costs of access to justice must be regulated in such a way that the ex-
ercise of the right is not rendered impossible for those affected private parties
who lack the resources of large corporate entities.151 Furthermore, the Hague
Tribunal, in awarding BIS’s claim to recover the costs of its defense in the case
�led in the United States, pointed to the combination of BIS’s immunity from
domestic legal processes and the mandatory arbitration in order to assert the
exclusive character of its own jurisdiction.152 Admittedly, the tribunal hedged
its argument by emphasizing the declaration of acceptance of shares, which
contained the acceptance of the mandatory arbitration; however, if an interna-
tional organization is required to provide alternative means for the settlement
of disputes, there is no way to avoid a certain degree of unilateralism.
Learning from INTERPOL
The way INTERPOL handled the matter of noncontractual claims related to
its operations is exemplary. Long before the World Bank Inspection Panel
saw the light of day, INTERPOL responded to the requirement that inter-
national organizations whose actions directly affect individuals establish a fo-
rum in which individuals may bring claims.153 The establishment of the Com-
mission for Control of INTERPOL Files (CCF154), an implementation of this
requirement,155 arose out of need. As technology evolved and INTERPOL be-
came more and more effective, the calls for remedies against the organization
became louder;156 this, combined with the French data protection authority’s
151 Dr. Horst Reinecius et al. v. Bank for International Settlement, Hague Arbitral Tribunal, Final
Award of September 19, 2003, paragraph 126, at .
152 Id., at paragraphs 113–15.
153 See Daniel D. Bradlow & Sabine Schlemmer-Schulte, The World Bank New Inspection Panel, 45
Recht der Internationales Wirtschaft 175, 179 (1999).
154 See Claude Valleix, INTERPOL, 88 Revue Générale de Droit International Public 621 (1984),
and S. El Zein, Nature juridique de la Commission de contrôle des �chiers de l’OIPC-INTERPOL,
480 Revue Internationale de Police Criminelle 2 (2000).
155 See Wellens, supra note 117, at 209–12.
156 C. Eick & A. Tritel, Verfassungsrechtliche bedenken gegen deutsche Mitarbeit bei INTERPOL,
EurGRZ 1985/Seite 81 (12. Jg. Heft 4); and James Sheptycki, The Accountability of
128 The World Bank Legal Review
attempt to assert jurisdiction over INTERPOL’s �les, triggered the creation of
the commission.
France argued that individuals should have access to data concerning
them, a right that could be exercised through its Commission Nationale de
l’Informatique et des Libertés, which had been established under the above-
mentioned law and given power to control computerized �les in France. To
accept the French view would have meant that INTERPOL no longer had au-
tonomy from the authority of any one country. INTERPOL therefore coun-
tered that this law could not apply to the police information processed by the
general secretariat because information sent by member countries does not
belong to INTERPOL, which merely acts as a depository, and applying the law
of 1978 to INTERPOL’s �les could hamper international police cooperation,
because certain countries would prefer not to communicate police informa-
tion that could be disclosed to French bodies.
Acknowledging these powerful arguments, France was nevertheless un-
willing to strengthen INTERPOL’s status on its territory without some kind
of guarantee concerning the processing of personal data protected by the
law of 1978. INTERPOL, meanwhile, was keen to ensure the smooth function-
ing of international police cooperation through its channels.157 These
conflicting aims were reconciled as a result of both parties’ commitment to
data protection, in order to protect both international police cooperation and
individual rights, and the commission was thus established.158
The implication of these developments for domestic courts with respect
to INTERPOL is alluded to in Balkir v. INTERPOL (1993).159 The High Court of
Lyon found that it lacked subject matter jurisdiction over INTERPOL’s activi-
ties due to a combination of factors derived from the headquarters agreement
between France and INTERPOL, including INTERPOL’s system of internal
control of the processing of police information. In X & Y v. INTERPOL (2009)
the District Court of Jerusalem went a step farther by explaining (obiter) that
declining to hear the case would not deprive the applicants of a remedy:
The Plaintiffs approached to Defendant and their approach was
transferred for the attendance of the CCF on 4.4.07. The CCF
(Commission for Control of Interpol’s Files) is a specialized body
established by Interpol whose purpose and specialization is the
examination of complaints by individuals regarding the information
stored at the Organization’s information databases, including red
Transnational Policing Institutions: The Strange Case of INTERPOL, 19 Can. J.L. & Society 107 (2004).
157 Cf. Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, Remedies against INTERPOL: Role and Practice of Defence Lawyers,
Address to the European Criminal Bar Association, Autumn Conference 2007, available at
.
158 See Valleix, supra note 154, Alice Pezard, L’organisation internationale de police criminelle et son
nouvel accord de siège, 29 Annuaire Français de Droit International 564, 572–75 (1983), and El
Zein, supra note 154.
159 Balkir v. INTERPOL, Tribunal de Grande Instance de Lyon, Premier Chambre, March 17, 1993
(unpublished).
IFIs and Private Parties 129
notices published against some individuals. This body is authorized
to ensure that the transfer of the information inside and outside
the Organisation is carried out in accordance to the Organization’s
rules. The CCF has a supervising role regarding the use, processing
and storing of the information, it is given the authority to examine
any �le and to request clari�cations from the information sources
which were transferred to the Organization. The CCF updates the
INTERPOL General Secretariat of its �ndings, and to the measure its
�ndings determine that a notice was published in negation to the
Organization’s rules, this notice will be removed.160
As far as staff disputes are concerned, INTERPOL recognized the jurisdic-
tion of the ILOAT. For any residual dispute with private parties, INTERPOL
agreed to a default mechanism. Effective September 1, 2009, Article 24(1) of the
new headquarters agreement between France and INTERPOL161 provides that
unless the parties to the dispute decide otherwise, any dispute between the or-
ganization and a private party shall be settled in accordance with the Optional
Rules for Arbitration between International Organizations and Private Par-
ties of the Permanent Court of Arbitration.162 These new arrangements were
clearly inspired by the 1994 revision of the headquarters agreement between
the United States and the OAS, which clari�ed that the immunities enjoyed
by the OAS were absolute, not quali�ed, and that its of�cials enjoyed immu-
nity in relation to the performance of their of�cial functions. Like INTERPOL,
the 1994 USA-OAS headquarters agreement clearly identi�ed viable alterna-
tive dispute-resolution mechanisms for persons with grievances against the
organization.163
The case of INTERPOL is of particular interest because the organization
is based on an agreement that has not been formally celebrated, as have those
of most international organizations.164 In the absence of a formal conventional
foundation, which would contain a clause equivalent to Article 105 of the UN
160 X & Y v. INTERPOL, District Court of Jerusalem, March 31, 2009, paragraph 9 (unpublished).
161 The agreement between INTERPOL and the government of the French Republic came into
force on September 1, 2009, and replaced the headquarters agreement of February 14, 1984;
it is available at .
162 Permanent Court of Arbitration, Optional Rules for Arbitration between International Organi-
zations and Private Parties of the Permanent Court of Arbitration, available at . By virtue of Article 24(3) of the Agreement be-
tween INTERPOL and the Government of the French Republic, the procedure speci�ed in
paragraph 1 is not applicable to disputes whose origins lie in the application or interpreta-
tion of the INTERPOL Constitution or its appendices, which include the staff regulations
and the rules concerning the processing of police information and the publication of notices.
See also Agreement between the Republic of Austria and the International Criminal Police
Organisation (ICPO-INTERPOL) regarding the seat of the INTERPOL Anti-Corruption
Academy in Austria, available at .
163 See Berenson, supra note 118; also, Muller, supra note 102, at 180–81.
164 See Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, The Legal Foundations of INTERPOL (Hart 2010).
130 The World Bank Legal Review
Charter detailing a general arrangement, INTERPOL is left to �nd bilat-
eral solutions for the “privileges and immunities� needed for its operation.
Nevertheless, INTERPOL has been highly successful in averting domestic
lawsuits. The organization’s assurance that aggrieved individuals have re-
course to a forum competent to hear their cases has reduced the incentive
for courts to deny immunity to the organization or to interfere with its
operations.165
Conclusions
Leaving the European Union aside, with the exception of their suppliers,
service providers, staff, and—where applicable—nongovernmental credi-
tors and bene�ciaries (of grants and loans), international organizations do
not normally have direct relations with private parties; their interlocutors are
states and other international organizations.166 In most cases, the multilateral
�nancial institutions provide for mechanisms to settle claims of such private
parties, including quali�ed amenability to the jurisdiction of domestic courts
with respect to disputes with bondholders. A blind side exists with regard
to noncontractual claims of private parties in the case of most international
organizations, with the exception of the European Union, the OAS, and IN-
TERPOL. The habit of international organizations to claim immunity even in
those cases without offering alternative means to deal with such claims seems
to be the main feeder of the argument against the continued need and scope
of the judicial immunity.
This chapter argues that although the unrestricted immunity from domes-
tic legal process cannot be dispensed with without scarifying the independent
functioning of the multilateral �nancial institutions, international �nancial
institutions are obliged to provide appropriate means for the settlement of
all private claims, not only contractual ones. That exercise produces the fol-
lowing conclusions:
• Ιt cannot be said that the immunities of international organizations are
either unnecessary or out-of-date.
• The suggestion that domestic courts would be capable of dealing with
all or most of the issues that may be involved in disputes between in-
ternational organizations and private parties ignores the fact that certain
matters are simply beyond national jurisdiction. In other words, such dis-
putes may involve issues that can be adequately handled only by an inter-
national forum.
165 Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, Challenging Acts of INTERPOL in Domestic Courts, in Challenging
Acts of International Organizations before National Courts 206 (August Reinisch ed., Oxford U.
Press 2010). See also Martha, supra note 164, at 92–105 and 131–36.
166 Cf. Giorgio Malinverni, Le règlement des différends dans le cadre des organisations internationales,
in Droit International: Bilan et perspectives tome 1, 571 (Mohammed Bedjaoui ed., Éditions
A. Pedone 1991).
IFIs and Private Parties 131
• The argument that the doctrine of restrictive foreign sovereign immunity
should apply to international organizations ignores the fact that, unlike
states, international organizations have no territory or citizens. They are
therefore functionally required to operate in the domestic market of a
state. This functional necessity implies that rules that apply to free choices
of foreign states to operate in the territories of other states cannot apply
to international organizations without interfering with their independent
functioning.
• The resultant obligation to respect the immunities of international or-
ganizations does not mean that international organizations escape
accountability. Rather, inherent in the immunity of international
organizations is their duty to establish a dispute settlement mechanism to
handle complaints of private parties.
• Many organizations do not observe this obligation diligently—in particu-
lar with regard to noncontractual claims—which has contributed to the
increased calls for limitation or denial of immunity of international orga-
nizations before national courts.
• As demonstrated by the experiences of certain international organiza-
tions—notably the European Union, the IFAD, INTERPOL and the OAS—
the only way for international organizations to remedy this situation is to
establish either unilateral or collective default mechanisms to deal with
any dispute that may arise between them and private parties.
Squaring the Concept of Immunity with
the Fundamental Right to a Fair Trial
The Case of the OAS
WILLIAM M. BERENSON*
The Inherent Conflict between Immunity
and the Right to a Fair Trial
In many respects, the concept of immunity is anathema to the American con-
cept of fair play and substantial justice. The granting of immunity to interna-
tional organizations and their of�cials,1 in those cases where reasonable alter-
native dispute-resolution mechanisms are unavailable, likely deprives their
victims of the right to a fair trial for the redress of their grievances and com-
pensation for their injuries. The right to a fair trial is a fundamental human
right under the American Convention on Human Rights,2 Article 8 of which
de�nes the right to a fair trial as “the right to a hearing with due guarantees
and within a reasonable time by a competent and impartial tribunal previ-
ously established by law . . . for the determination of [a person’s] rights, and
obligations of a civil, labor, �scal, or any other nature.�
Possible Rationalization of the Conflict through Substantive
Due Process Analysis
How can one square the right to a fair trial guaranteed under the American
Convention on Human Rights with the concept of immunity? Perhaps the
simple answer is that in a perfect world, one cannot. Nonetheless, in attempt-
ing to reconcile these two conflicting interests, jurists and lawyers have sought
rationales for balancing one against the other in the search for “reasonable
accommodation.�
One rationale that can serve the purpose of reasonable accommodation
well is substantive due process analysis, as developed by the U.S. courts. This
rationale provides a framework for determining under what circumstances a
government may limit a fundamental right and to what extent.
* This chapter was the basis for remarks made by the author at the World Bank’s Law, Justice,
and Development Week 2010, held in Washington, D.C. The views expressed herein are not
necessarily shared by the institutions with which the author is associated.
1 In this chapter, the term “of�cials� connotes both the employees, also known as “staff,� “staff
members,� or “personnel,� and other of�cers of those organizations.
2 See American Convention on Human Rights, Article 8 (Nov. 22, 1969), available at .
133
134 The World Bank Legal Review
The doctrine of substantive due process accepts that no fundamental right
is absolute. That is, when the government has a “compelling state� interest,
the government may limit or trim that right, but only by way of the “least re-
strictive means.� Of all the possible measures that the government may adopt
to achieve its compelling state interest, the measure selected must be the least
restrictive of the affected fundamental right. If it is not the least restrictive or
at least “carefully tailored� to be the least restrictive, the measure restricting
the fundamental right is illegal.
Immunity for International Organizations as a Compelling State
Interest for Their Member States
When looking at immunity through the lens of substantive due process
analysis, one must ask whether the interest member governments have
in granting international organizations and their of�cials immunities is
“compelling.� Those who truly appreciate the mission of international orga-
nizations would answer “yes.� For most member states, international organi-
zations offer compelling services relating to development, �nance, security,
and the conduct of foreign policy. Without immunity, international organiza-
tions would be reticent to establish of�ces, implement projects, and conduct
other operations in their member states. Immunity is a sine qua non for doing
business in those states.
Why is that? There are several reasons. First, immunity prevents any sin-
gle member state from exercising undue influence on an international organi-
zation and thwarting the will of the majority by way of its courts. Certainly,
for example, adjudication by the courts of one country declaring the activities
of an international organization illegal or arresting or detaining its of�cials in
penal facilities on trumped-up charges could frustrate the objectives of that
organization. An injunction from the court of one member state or a multi-
million-dollar judgment, particularly in the courts of the host country where
the organization’s accounts are maintained, could virtually cripple an organi-
zation if it is not shielded by immunity. Moreover, in the absence of immunity,
a member state wishing to obstruct the activities of an organization in pursuit
of its own political designs could simply urge its citizens to bring suit against
the organization, thus tying up the organization’s resources in litigation, to the
prejudice of its other member states and its noble objectives.
In addition, in disputes between a member state and an international or-
ganization, the member state may become both judge and party in the dispute
if the matter is adjudicated in its own courts or administrative forum. Separa-
tion of powers is more an ideal in many countries rather than a reality: the
independence of the judiciary from the other branches of government cannot
be presumed. Immunity guarantees protection for international organizations
and their of�cials from those instances in which reality strays from the ideal.
Scholars may list a dozen or more additional reasons why international
organizations generally demand immunity as a condition for operating in or
Immunity and the Right to a Fair Trial 135
doing business within their member states.3 But in the end, they boil down to
the two basic reasons stated above:
• Preventing any one state from gaining an unfair advantage in or crippling
an international organization by way of its courts or administrative agen-
cies with adjudicative authority
• Providing a guarantee that a member state, in disputes with international
organizations, is not likely to become both judge and party, thereby deny-
ing the organization a mechanism for the fair and independent adjudica-
tion of the dispute in accordance with due process
Measures That Restrict the Adverse Impact of Immunity
on the Right to a Fair Trial
Under substantive due process analysis, the conclusion that member states
have a compelling state interest in providing immunity to international orga-
nizations is not enough, by itself, to justify the limitation immunity poses on
the fundamental right to a fair trial for persons who have disputes with those
organizations. The issue persists of whether the immunity, as granted, is the
least restrictive means for obtaining the compelling state interest in having
international organizations operate within member states. If that question can
be answered af�rmatively, then the conflict between the internationally recog-
nized right to a fair trial and the immunities evaporates (at best) or becomes
tolerable both intellectually and in practice (at worst).
Certainly, a member state and an international organization can employ
measures to minimize the adverse impact of immunity upon the right to a fair
trial in disputes with international organizations. None of these measures is
mutually exclusive.
One such measure is limiting the scope of immunity by granting functional
immunity instead of absolute immunity. That is, the organization and its of-
�cials are immune only with regard to those activities they engage in with
respect to the organization’s functions stated in its charter or constituent
treaty. They have no immunity for acts they commit not within the scope of those
functions. The Council of State of Colombia, a high-level court in Colombia,
recently took this position when it denied immunity to an international orga-
nization sued over activities that clearly did not fall within its objectives and
functions under its charter.4
3 See, for example, August Reinisch, International Organizations before National Courts 233–51
(Cambridge U. Press 2000); Richard J. Oparil, Immunity of International Organizations in
United States Courts: Absolute or Restrictive? 24 V. and J. Transnatl L. 689, 709–10. See also
Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, International Financial Institutions and Claims of Private Parties: Im-
munity Obliges, in this volume.
4 INTERSIDE v. Ministerio de Agricultura y SecretarÃa Ejecutiva del Convenio Andrés Bello, Sala de
lo Contencioso Administrativo del Consejo de Estado (Mar. 26, 2009) (defendant organiza-
tion not immune with regard to claims of breach of contract with subcontractor arising out of
the organization’s administration of agricultural subsidies �nanced by government because
its purposes under its charter are strictly educational and cultural).
136 The World Bank Legal Review
Another measure to minimize the adverse impact of immunity is to deny
immunity to organizations with respect to their pursuit of activities of a com-
mercial nature, as opposed to their political or “sovereign� functions. Under
international law, this measure is often referred to as “restrictive immunity�;
under the modern doctrine of sovereign immunity applied to states, it is prev-
alent.5 With regard to international organizations such as the United Nations
(UN) and the Organization of American States (OAS), this distinction makes
little sense because, unlike many sovereign states, those organizations do not
engage in commercial enterprises.6 Nonetheless, this distinction does make
some sense with regard to lending institutions, insofar as lending money is a
commercial activity.
Another means states may use for limiting the exposure of international
organizations to crippling or otherwise seemingly unfair judgments in na-
tional courts is limiting the amount of damages that may be awarded against
an international organization in any civil case or excluding international or-
ganizations for liability for punitive damages.7 Such a limitation provides, in
effect, immunity from those claims. But it leaves open the possibility that na-
tional courts or mutually agreed-on arbitration tribunals may adjudicate dis-
putes and compensate the aggrieved party with actual damages.
Still another means is the language set out in the charters for the World
Bank Group, which grant immunity from suits by member states but leave
open the possibility of actions against the World Bank (but not against its of�-
cials) brought by other possible plaintiffs. Compliance with the resulting judg-
ments, however, is left largely to the will of the defendant institution due to the
immunity of its assets from seizure and con�scation under those charters.8
5 Beginning in 1952, the concept of sovereign immunity was adopted by the U.S. Department
of State (the Tate Letter, 26 Dep’t State Bull. 984 (1952); in 1976, it was codi�ed by Congress in
the Foreign Sovereign Immunities Act, 28 U.S.C. paragraphs 1602–11.
6 See Restatement of the Foreign Relations Law of the United States, paragraph 467 cmt. d (1987),
which states: “It appears that the restrictive theory that limits the immunity of a state from
legal process (Sec. 451) does not apply to the United Nations, to most of its Specialized Agen-
cies, or to the Organization of American States. These organizations enjoy immunity from
jurisdiction to adjudicate in all cases, both under their charters and other international agree-
ments (comment b) and under the law of the United States.�
7 For example, in the Foreign Sovereign Immunities Act (FSIA) and the 1994 Headquarters
Agreement with the Organization of American States (OAS), available at , the United States exempts for-
eign sovereigns and the OAS from claims for punitive damages. In the case of the OAS,
which enjoys absolute immunity subject to its agreement to arbitrate all civil disputes, the
limitation applies to the arbitration tribunal.
8 For example, International Bank for Reconstruction and Development (IBRD) Articles of
Agreement, Article VII, Section 4, states: “Actions may be brought against the Bank only in
a court of competent jurisdiction in the territories of a member in which the Bank has an of-
�ce, has appointed an agent for the purpose of accepting service of process, or has issued or
guaranteed securities. No action shall, however, be brought by members or persons acting
for or deriving claims from members. The property and assets of the Bank, wherever located
and by whomever held, shall be immune from all forms of seizure, attachment, or execution
before the delivery of �nal judgment against the Bank.� Section 4 continues: “Property
Immunity and the Right to a Fair Trial 137
In legislation or a treaty recognizing immunity, perhaps the most effec-
tive measure for curtailing the adverse impact of immunity on the right to a
fair trial is to include a provision that requires the international organization
to provide alternative measures for the resolution of its disputes with others.
Generally, those alternative measures include establishing or providing access
to a specialized labor court, called an “administrative tribunal,� for the adju-
dication of employment-related claims against the organization, and provid-
ing for independent binding arbitration in all commercial agreements or for
the settlement of tort claims that cannot be reasonably settled by negotiation
with the organization’s insurers.
Of course, the effectiveness of alternative measures as a substitute for a
fair trial in the national courts and in the administrative agencies with adju-
dicatory functions of the member states depends on the degree of indepen-
dence and accessibility of these courts and agencies. Courts in Europe, North
America, and Latin America have examined that issue in considering whether
to recognize the immunities of international organizations.9 In other words,
the comfort level of today’s nations with the concept of immunity depends on
how effective alternative dispute mechanisms provided by international orga-
nizations are in limiting the adverse effect of immunity upon the fundamental
right to a fair trial.
Governments may cushion the impact of immunity on the right to a fair
trial by including in their agreements with international organizations a pro-
vision that requires the legal representative of an organization to waive privi-
leges and immunities when, in his or her judgment, justice so demands and
the waiver will not necessarily thwart the organization in the pursuit of its
objectives. Under such a provision, the waiver is not mandatory. It depends
on the opinion or discretion of the legal representative, who is usually the
and assets of the Bank, wherever located and by whomsoever held, shall be immune from
all from search, requisition, con�scation, expropriation, or any other form of seizure by ex-
ecutive or legislative action.� Note, however, that the 116 countries that are parties to the
Convention on Privileges and Immunities of the United Nations Specialized Agencies have,
under Article III(4) of the convention, accorded broader immunities to the World Bank as one
of those agencies. The United States is not a party to that convention; however, the World
Bank, as a public international organization, enjoys in the United States functional immuni-
ties under the International Organizations Immunities Act of 1945, 22 U.S.C. Section 288a
(IOIA). U.S. courts have held that the more limited immunities granted under Article VII,
which appears to permit suits by nonbank members against the Bank, do not constitute a
waiver of the broader immunity accorded the Bank under the IOIA as a shield against such
suits in the United States. See, for example, Mendaro v. World Bank, 717 F.2d 610, 612 (D.C.
Cir. 1983); Chiriboga v. International Bank for Reconstruction and Development, 616 F. Supp. 963
(D.D.C. 1985); Morgan v. International Bank for Reconstruction and Development, 752 F. Supp.
492 (D.C.C. 1990).
9 See, for example, cases discussed by R. S. J. Martha, supra note at 26–34, including Waite and
Kennedy v. Germany, App. No. 26083/94, 30 Eur. Ct. Hum. Rights 261 (1999); Dulhalde v. Orga-
nización Panamericana de Salud, Dictámen No. D.73, XXXIV de Corte Suprema de Justicia de
la Nación (Argentina, Mar. 31, 1999). See also In re Illemassene v. OECD, Cour de Cassation,
Chambre Sociale (France, Sep. 29, 2010).
138 The World Bank Legal Review
secretary general, director general, or president. But it does imply their obliga-
tion to consider the waiver option in good faith.
The Case of the OAS
First established in 1889 as the International Union of American Republics
and later known as the Pan American Union, the OAS is the oldest of the ma-
jor international organizations.10 The mission of the OAS is to promote peace
and security in the Americas by promoting representative democracy; facili-
tating integral development; providing mechanisms for the common defense,
as well as for the peaceful settlement of disputes among its members; and
eradicating extreme poverty.
As described more fully below, the OAS member states have recognized, in
the OAS Charter,11 national legislation, and a host of bilateral and multilateral
agreements, that to achieve the OAS mission, the OAS and its personnel must
have immunity from national courts and the adjudicative jurisdiction of national
administrative agencies. Nonetheless, in order to sustain political support for
that immunity in many of its member states, the OAS has had to agree to provide
or otherwise submit to reasonable alternative dispute-resolution mechanisms.
The OAS Charter
Article 133 of the OAS Charter provides that the OAS shall have “such legal
capacity and privileges and immunities necessary for the exercise of its func-
tions and the accomplishment of its purposes.� That immunity is clearly func-
tional in scope.
Broader language is used for de�ning the privileges and immunities of
the secretary general, the assistant secretary general, and member-state del-
egations to the OAS and their personnel. It suggests that the kind of absolute
immunity conveyed under the 1961 Vienna Convention on Diplomatic Rela-
tions to “diplomatic agents� may be appropriate for those individuals so as to
guarantee their independence of action in the interest of the organization.12
10 Conferencias Internacionales Americanas, 1889-1936 (Washington 1938), at 36.
11 The OAS Charter is a multilateral treaty �rst adopted in 1948. Since then, it has been
amended four times by the member states. See . See also W. Berenson, The Struc-
ture of the Organization of American States: A Summary, , originally published as La estructura de la
organización de los Estados Americanos: Una reseña in el sistema interamericana frente el nuevo siglo
(Antioquia, Colombia 2002).
12 Article 134 of the charter states: “The representatives of the Member States on the organs
of the Organization, the personnel of their delegations as well as the Secretary General and
the Assistant Secretary General, shall enjoy the privileges and immunities corresponding
to their position and necessary for the independent performance of their duties.� See
also Articles 29–37 of the Vienna Convention on Diplomatic Relations (Apr. 18, 1961),
500 U.N.T.S. 95.
Immunity and the Right to a Fair Trial 139
Article 135 of the charter leaves the elaboration of the speci�c immunities
to be enjoyed by the staff members of the OAS General Secretariat and other
organs to further agreement between the member states in the general secre-
tariat or those organs.13 Pursuant to Article 135, the OAS opened a multilateral
agreement for signature in 1949 that entered into force in 1951. Since then, 13
member states have rati�ed it. All the other OAS member states have sub-
scribed to bilateral agreements with the OAS General Secretariat extending
functional immunity to the OAS, the general secretariat, and its rank-and-
�le staff. Some member states have extended diplomatic immunities to the
secretary general, assistant chief of mission, and director of the of�ce of
the general secretariat in country.14
The Multilateral and Bilateral Agreements
The multilateral and bilateral agreements that the OAS has concluded with
its member states contain language requiring the OAS to establish alternative
dispute-resolution mechanisms for disputes arising under contract and tort law,
as well as for disputes between third parties and OAS of�cials.15 Most agree-
ments also provide that the secretary general may waive the immunities, when
in his or her discretion they will not have an adverse effect upon the goals and
objectives of the organization and it is in the interest of justice to do so.16
13 Article 135 of the charter states: “The juridical status of the Specialized Organizations and the
privileges and immunities that should be granted to them and to their personnel, as well as to the
of�cials of the General Secretariat, shall be determined in a multilateral agreement. The forego-
ing shall not preclude, when it is considered necessary, the concluding of bilateral agreements.�
14 Pursuant to Article 135, several other OAS organs have entered into separate agreements for
privileges and immunities with member states. They include the Inter-American Institute
for Cooperation on Agriculture, with headquarters in Costa Rica; the Inter-American Chil-
dren’s Institute, headquartered in Uruguay; and the Inter-American Human Rights Court, in
Costa Rica.
15 For example, Article 12 of the Agreement on Privileges and Immunities of the OAS (the
multilateral agreement), provides: “The Pan American Union [now the OAS General Sec-
retariat under the 1967 Protocol of Buenos Aires to the OAS Charter] shall make provi-
sions for appropriate modes of settlement of: (a) disputes arising out of contracts or other
disputes of a private law character to which the Pan American Union is a party; (b) dis-
putes involving any of�cial or member of the staff of the Pan American Union with ref-
erence to which immunity is enjoyed, if immunity has not been waived by the Secretary
General in accordance with Article 14.� See Agreement on Privileges and Immunities of
the Organization of American States (May 15, 1949), available at . Similar language is included in the bilateral agreements on
privileges and immunities that the OAS has negotiated with its other member states.
16 Regarding the obligation of the secretary general to consider waiving immunities, Article
14 of the multilateral agreement speci�es: “Privileges and immunities are granted to of-
�cials and personnel of the Pan American Union in the interests of the Organization only.
Consequently, the Secretary General shall waive the privileges and immunities of any of-
�cial or member of the staff in the case where, in the judgment of the Secretary General, the
exercise thereof would impede the course of justice and the waiver can be made without
prejudice to the interests of the Organization. In the case of the Secretary General or of the
Assistant Secretary General, the Council of the Organization shall have the right to waive the
immunity.�
140 The World Bank Legal Review
Alternative Dispute Mechanisms Established by the OAS
Over the years the OAS has adopted a panoply of dispute-resolution mecha-
nisms as an alternative to national justice systems. As described more fully
below, they include the OAS Administrative Tribunal, established by the OAS
General Assembly in 1971 for the resolution of disputes with its employees;
arbitration pursuant to agreements with contractors and other aggrieved per-
sons; maintenance of adequate insurance policies to cover reasonable poten-
tial liability; and the occasional waiver of immunity when justice so demands
and it can be done without substantial damage to the organization.
The Administrative Tribunal
Like most other major international organizations, the OAS has established
an administrative tribunal for handling disputes between its organs and their
employees. The tribunal judges are elected by the general assembly. Judges
must all be lawyers and cannot hold positions within the OAS or serve on the
member-state delegations to the organization. All staff members and others
claiming entitlement to the rights of staff members have access to the tribunal
once they have exhausted the corresponding internal grievance procedures.17
Arbitration
Regarding all other disputes with contractors and others, the OAS has adopted
a policy of providing for arbitration in accordance with generally recognized
rules. In the case of contracts, the arbitration authority and rules to be used are
usually established from among several options. They include the American
Arbitration Association (AAA), the Inter-American Commercial Arbitration
Commission (IACAC), and the United Nations Commission on International
Trade Law (UNCITRAL).
The OAS’s most extensive agreement on immunities is its Headquar-
ters Agreement with the United States of America, which entered into force
in November 1994 (“Headquarters Agreement�).18 In exchange for recogni-
tion of absolute immunity from the jurisdiction of the courts and administra-
tive proceedings in the United States, the OAS agreed under Article VIII of
the Headquarters Agreement to provide arbitration for all disputes that do
not fall under the jurisdiction of its administrative tribunal. The arbitration
17 See Statute of the Administrative Tribunal of the Organization of American States, Article VI,
available at . No �ling fees are required of
current staff members; however, all others are required to post a bond to cover possible at-
torneys’ fees and costs if the reconsideration committee, which must consider the case before
the case goes to the tribunal, does not �nd in favor of the staff member. The reconsideration
committee, which advises the secretary general on the disposition of employment-related
grievances, is made up of a representative of the staff association, a representative of the
secretary general, and a chair appointed by both of them.
18 There is a separate March 20, 1975, agreement between the OAS and the United States that
recognizes diplomatic immunity for representatives of the member-state and permanent-
observer missions to the OAS, available at .
Immunity and the Right to a Fair Trial 141
must proceed in accordance with the rules of either the AAA or the IACAC, or
such other rules to which the parties may agree. Article VIII of the Headquar-
ters Agreement prohibits the arbitration tribunal from entertaining claims for
punitive damages.
In the case of small claims, the OAS provides a special arbitration proce-
dure under rules attached to the Headquarters Agreement and under which it
is obligated to pay the cost. The agreement �xed the amount of a small claim
at $2,000 in 1994, and provided that after �ve years, the amount could be in-
creased by agreement with the U.S. secretary of state or, in the absence of such
agreement, the amount would increase automatically each year in accordance
with the consumer price index for the District of Columbia.19
Insurance
As for satisfying claims, the OAS General Secretariat maintains insurance
policies at a responsible level. The availability of these policies has facilitated
the resolution of most reasonable claims against the organization arising out
of contract disputes or torts with third parties and has obviated the need for
frequent recourse to arbitration and other dispute-resolution mechanisms.
Waivers of Immunity
Pursuant to its obligation to waive immunity when, at the discretion of the
secretary general, the interests of justice so demand and the interests of the
organization are not impaired, the OAS General Secretariat generally com-
plies with orders for the garnishment of staff wages for payment of delin-
quent child support and alimony. It may also, depending on the facts in each
case, comply with bankruptcy garnishment orders, and its pension committee
will voluntarily comply with quali�ed domestic support orders in divorce ac-
tions. In so doing, however, the general secretariat or the pension committee,
as the case may be, usually sends a note back to the court underscoring that its
compliance is voluntary and should in no way be considered a waiver of its
immunities.
In rare instances, the OAS General Secretariat has waived its immunities
in order to obtain mortgage �nancing for the purchase of real estate.20 In doing
so, however, it has insisted that the waiver be limited to the value of the facil-
ity being mortgaged and not extend to all other assets. The secretariat has also
occasionally waived immunities in order to recover past-due payments from
delinquent recipients of OAS student loans or to pursue commercial claims
19 Headquarters Agreement, Section 2(b). See also W. Berenson, Privilegios e Inmunidades de
organizaciones internacionales: El acuerdo de sede entre la Organización de los Estados America-
nos y los Estados Unidos; Apuntes (1995), available at , also published in XXII Curso de Derecho Internacio-
nal, Comite JurÃdico Interamericano, 1995 235–50 (Ediciones JurÃdicas de las Américas 1997).
20 Those waivers, under both common and civil law, have been construed to require the ap-
proval of the OAS General Assembly or, when it is not meeting, the OAS Permanent Council,
because a mortgage constitutes an encumbrance upon real property.
142 The World Bank Legal Review
it may have in contract or tort where no arbitration provision is binding the
adverse party. The secretariat will not, however, waive immunities by initiat-
ing an adverse action in the courts of a member state unless it is reasonably
assured that the possibilities of a meaningful counterclaim by the defendant
are minimal.
Cases Challenging OAS Immunities
Since the OAS Headquarters Agreement entered into effect in 1994, there
have been no cases in the United States challenging the immunities of the
organization, its general secretariat, or its staff. The Headquarters Agreement
de�nitively clari�ed that the immunities enjoyed by the organization are ab-
solute, not quali�ed, and that its of�cials enjoy immunity in relation to the
performance of their of�cial functions. Moreover, the Headquarters Agree-
ment clearly identi�ed viable alternative dispute-resolution mechanisms for
persons with grievances against the organization, thereby reducing the need
to challenge the organization’s immunities.
During the early 1980s, however, the extent of those immunities was chal-
lenged in two cases before the U.S. Court of Appeals for the District of Co-
lumbia Circuit. In Broadbent v. OAS,21 the plaintiffs, who had received a rul-
ing in their favor at the OAS Administrative Tribunal for wrongful discharge,
brought another claim for wrongful discharge and signi�cantly higher dam-
ages in the federal courts. The court of appeals reaf�rmed a lower district
court decision holding that the organization was immune from employment-
related claims, and it suggested in a footnote that the immunities that the OAS
then enjoyed under the International Organizations Immunity Act were ab-
solute immunities, rather than the restricted immunities enjoyed by foreign
sovereigns under the Foreign Sovereign Immunities Act (FSIA).22
In another wrongful-discharge case previously adjudicated by the OAS
Administrative Tribunal in the plaintiff’s favor, Donald v. Or�la,23 the plaintiff
sued the former secretary general in the federal courts. The amount was for
$1 million, instead of the maximum of three years’ basic salary he had been
awarded under the Administrative Tribunal Statute. The court concluded
that the secretary general was entitled to immunity “to the extent that the
acts alleged in the complaint relate to his functions as director,� and that the
termination of the plaintiff “unquestionably relates� to the secretary gener-
al’s of�cial functions. It further observed that it would be improper for the
court to investigate the appropriateness of the motive for the secretary
general’s decision to terminate the plaintiff, because if it were to do so, “the
21 628 F.2d 27 (D.C. Cir. 1980).
22 Id., at footnote 20. Moreover, the court held: “the relationship of an international organiza-
tion with its internal administrative staff is noncommercial, and absent a waiver, activities
de�ning or arising out of that relationship may not be the basis of an action against the
organization, regardless of whether international organizations enjoy absolute or restrictive
immunity.� Id., at 35.
23 618 F. Supp. 545 (D.D.C. 1985), aff’d per curiam, 788 F.2d 36 (D.C. Cir. 1986).
Immunity and the Right to a Fair Trial 143
immunity shield which Congress intended to afford solid protection would
indeed be evanescent.�
In another pre–Headquarters Agreement case, In re Lopez Cayzedo, a bank-
ruptcy trustee petitioned the bankruptcy court to order the secretary trea-
surer of the OAS Retirement and Pension Fund to turn over to the trustee
the bankrupt’s OAS pension fund account for distribution to creditors. The
court agreed with the secretary treasurer that his functional immunities as an
OAS General Secretariat staff member shielded him from the jurisdiction of
the court and dismissed the trustee’s petition.24
In other OAS member states, the secretariat has had to defend its immuni-
ties against claims alleging violation of the local labor laws. In most instances,
the organization has reached reasonable settlements with the plaintiffs, result-
ing in the abandonment or dismissal of those claims prior to judgment.
In Brazil, however, courts were reluctant in the years immediately follow-
ing the adoption of the 1988 constitution to recognize the immunities of the
OAS and other international organizations from employment-related claims.
That reluctance was based on Article 114 of Brazil’s constitution, which ex-
tended jurisdiction over employment-related disputes arising between “enti-
ties of public international law� and their employees to Brazilian labor tribu-
nals. They used Article 114 to support the thesis that when it came to questions
of immunity, international organizations were identical to foreign sovereigns,
which under modern customary international law, as embodied in the FSIA,
were entitled to only restrictive immunities. The Brazilian courts went on to
assume that the contracting of the staff of international organizations, like
the contracting of staff for foreign sovereigns, was a commercial activity, and
therefore immunity did not apply to labor disputes between international or-
ganizations and their employees. The OAS appealed those judgments, assert-
ing that the agreements approved by the executive and legislative authorities
were valid under the doctrine of separation of powers and also noting that,
due to the differences between international organizations and foreign sover-
eigns, the Brazilian courts were mistaken in assuming that the contracting of
staff was a commercial activity for international organizations. Initially, the
results of those appeals were mixed.
In 2004, the momentum turned in favor of the OAS and other interna-
tional organizations. In March, Brazil’s federal supreme court reaf�rmed a
24 See Memorandum Decision Granting Motion to Dismiss, Case No. 88-4-1546SD,
Chapter 7, Adversary No. 90A-0333SD (unpublished, on �le with the author). The OAS Re-
tirement and Pension Fund is a quali�ed pension fund under the U.S. Internal Revenue
Code, and as such it should have been excluded from the bankrupt estate under Maryland
and federal law. Nonetheless, because of the erroneous testimony of a witness in a proceed-
ing in which the OAS did not participate, the fund was mistakenly characterized as nonqual-
i�ed by the witness and included in the bankrupt estate. Thus, it was necessary to assert the
immunity defense, which the court endorsed without having to recall the confused witness.
Section 7 of Article I and Section 2 of Article IV of the Headquarters Agreement now make it
clear that the OAS Retirement and Pension Plan, for purposes of OAS immunities, is an asset
of the organization and therefore exempt from con�scation and seizure by U.S. authorities.
144 The World Bank Legal Review
2002 supreme labor court judgment in Orlando da Silva v. OEA25 holding that,
although Brazilian courts could take jurisdiction of cases against the OAS un-
der Article 114 of its constitution, they could not enforce a judgment in favor
of the plaintiff due to the immunity from con�scation and seizure conferred
upon OAS assets under the organization’s agreements with Brazil. That same
month, the Appellate Labor Tribunal for the Tenth Region (Brasilia) issued a
judgment in the case of Fernandez Duarte v. OEA26 recognizing immunity from
subject matter jurisdiction in labor disputes based on the doctrine of sepa-
ration of powers under the constitution. That doctrine, asserted the court in
Duarte, requires courts to respect the agreements with the OAS on immuni-
ties signed by the executive branch and rati�ed by the legislature. Since then,
most courts have adopted the position taken by the appellate court in Duarte,
and in 2009, the supreme labor tribunal, in a case brought by a former em-
ployee of the Inter-American Institute for Cooperation in Agriculture (IICA), a
specialized organization of the OAS, upheld the IICA’s immunities on that
same rationale.27
Concluding Observations
What conclusions might one draw from all of this?
First, in returning to the lens of substantive due process analysis, the OAS
and its member states have gone a long way toward restricting the adverse
impact of OAS immunities on the right to a fair trial. What they have come up
with may not be considered by all to be the ideal “least restrictive means.� But
it cannot be denied that signi�cant “tailoring� has taken place over the years,
particularly by way of the Headquarters Agreement, to de�ne the scope of the
immunities and provide reasonable independent alternative dispute-resolu-
tion mechanisms and insurance for the purpose of satisfying claims.
Second, international organizations that do not follow a similar path are
destined, in a world of ever-increasing consciousness and advocacy of funda-
mental human rights, to have their immunities challenged and scrutinized by
national courts through a lens similar to that of the substantive due process.
The analysis may not go by that name, but it is the kind of process many
courts use in attempting to balance one vital interest against another and to
�nd a reasonable accommodation between the two.
Third, in the Americas, for the most part, national courts are still inclined
to respect the functional immunities of international organizations with
noncommercial objectives, such as the OAS and the United Nations. Those
25 Supremo Tribunal Federal, No. 468.498-6 Distrito Federal (Mar. 16, 2004).
26 See, for example, Tribunal Regional do Trabalho, 10 Regiao, Proceso 00101 2004-006-10-00-6
(2004).
27 See Judiciário não pode afastar imunidade de organismo internacional (Nov. 24, 2009), at .
Immunity and the Right to a Fair Trial 145
immunities are considered to be absolute with regard to all claims relating to
the of�cial functions of those organizations and their of�cials.
Fourth, the general wisdom regarding immunities is that if you abuse
them, you will eventually lose them. Abuse occurs when international orga-
nizations and their of�cials do not provide alternative independent means for
recourse for claims against them—that is, when they infringe upon the funda-
mental right to a fair trial.
All the active member states of the OAS and governments in most other
parts of the world are representative democracies. The elected of�cials of those
democracies will be called upon to explain to the citizens who elected them
why they cannot pursue a cause of action against an international organiza-
tion or its of�cials in their national courts when they have been harmed by
them. Unless those elected of�cials can satisfactorily demonstrate that other
reasonable means of pursuing those claims are available, their explanations
will fall on deaf ears, and it will be politically inconvenient for those of�cials
to continue to support the legislation and treaties that confer immunities on
international organizations. Thus, in those cases where immunity denies a
path of redress through the courts, the onus is upon governments, working
with international organizations, to assure that other means are available.
Responsibility of International
Organizations and the
World Bank Inspection Panel
Parallel Tracks Unlikely to Converge?
EVARIST BAIMU AND ARISTEIDIS PANOU*
Following the adoption of the articles on state responsibility in 2001, the In-
ternational Law Commission (ILC) took on the momentous task of address-
ing the issue of the responsibility of international organizations.1 This chap-
ter reviews the preliminary outcome of these efforts, and the draft articles
on responsibility of international organizations adopted on �rst reading in
2009 (and on second reading in 2011), in light of the particular features and
challenges of international �nancial institutions (IFIs),2 speci�cally the World
Bank.3
IFIs, including the Bank, have a variety of legal relationships with a vari-
ety of actors, including their employees and investors, as well as member and
nonmember states that receive funds or technical assistance from the IFIs. In
addition, IFIs have legal relationships with other international organizations
and legal persons (other than states) with whom IFIs enter into lending agree-
ments in support of developmental projects. In all instances, legal agreements
de�ne the reciprocal rights and obligations of the parties. There have been
calls to extend the reach of responsibility beyond contractually de�ned obliga-
tions under these agreements,4 so that international organizations including
IFIs are held responsible for, inter alia, acts or omissions in relation to tortious
* The authors are grateful to Alberto Ninio, Maurizio Ragazzi, and Adrian Di Giovanni for
their invaluable comments. This chapter represents personal views of the authors and should
not be attributed to the institution with which they are associated.
1 GA Res. 56/82, UN GAOR, 56th Sess., UN Doc. A/56/82 (2002).
2 On IFIs, see Maurizio Ragazzi, Financial Institutions, International, in The Max Planck Encyclo-
pedia of Public International Law (Rüdiger Wolfrum ed., Oxford U. Press 2008), available at
.
3 In this chapter, unless noted otherwise, the terms “Bank� and “World Bank� include the
International Bank for Reconstruction and Development (IBRD) and the International De-
velopment Association (IDA).
4 As international organizations, IFIs are obliged to act consistently with peremptory norms
of international law and applicable rules of customary international law. See Henry G.
Schermers & Niels M. Blokker, International Institutional Law: Unity within Diversity 832–35
(4th ed., Martinus Nijhoff 2003). 147
148 The World Bank Legal Review
acts,5 human rights violations,6 �nancial leakages on projects,7 and actions that
harm or threaten to harm the environment.8
It is a well-accepted tenet today that responsibility is not reserved for
states but is an attribution of the international legal personality of all sub-
jects of international law, including international organizations.9 However,
the mere recognition of responsibility of international organizations is useless
without a framework to regulate the occurrence and the consequences of re-
sponsibility. The ILC work provides this general framework, but uncertainty
persists about how this one-size-�ts-all framework will be compatible with
the characteristics of every organization.10
In the area of state responsibility, there has been a signi�cant discussion
about the relation between the general rules of state responsibility and spe-
cial or self-contained regimes.11 With the exception of the European Union,12
a similar discussion has not happened for international organizations. This
5 Steven Herz, Rethinking International Financial Institution Immunity, in International Financial
Institutions and International Law 137, 158 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed., Kluwer
Law International 2010).
6 Daniel D. Bradlow, The World Bank, the IMF, and Human Rights, 6 Transnational Law and Con-
temporary Problems 47, 64–66 (1996); Margot E. Salomon, International Economic Governance
and Human Rights Accountability, in Casting the Net Wider: Human Rights, Development and New
Duty-Bearers 153, 174–81 (Margot E. Salomon, Arne Tostensen, & Wouter Vandenhole ed.,
Intersentia 2007).
7 Fatma Marouf, Holding the World Bank Accountable for Leakage of Funds from Africa’s Health
Sector, 12 (1) Health and Human Rights in Practice 95 (2010).
8 The Independent Evaluation Group, an oversight body of the World Bank, has observed
that the Bank “needs to do a better job of measuring the environmental performance and
impacts of its activities�; see IEG-World Bank, Environmental Sustainability: An Evaluation
of World Bank Group Support 89 (2008), available at .
9 See Reparation for Injuries Suffered in the Service of the United Nations, Advisory Op., 1949 I.C.J.
174, 179; Giorgio Gaja, special rapporteur, First Report on Responsibility of International Orga-
nizations, at paragraph 15, UN Doc. A/CN.4/532 (Mar. 26, 2003); Alain Pellet, The De�nition
of Responsibility in International Law, in The Law of International Responsibility 3, 6 (James Craw-
ford, Alain Pellet, & Simon Olleson ed., Oxford U. Press 2010).
10 After the adoption of the draft articles on �rst reading, almost all international organizations
and states that sent comments to the ILC commented on Article 63 on lex specialis; see ILC, Re-
sponsibility of International Organizations: Comments and Observations Received from In-
ternational Organizations, at 37–41, UN Doc. A/CN.4/637 (Feb. 14, 2011); ILC, Responsibil-
ity of International Organizations: Comments and Observations Received from International
Organizations, at 34–35, UN Doc. A/CN.4/637/Add.1 (Feb. 17, 2011); ILC, Responsibility
of International Organizations: Comments and Observations Received from International
Organizations, at 41, UN Doc. A/CN.4/636 (Feb. 14, 2011).
11 For an overview of this topic, see Bruno Simma & Dirk Pulkowski, Leges Speciales and Self-
Contained Regimes, in The Law of International Responsibility 139 (James Crawford, Alain Pellet,
& Simon Olleson ed., Oxford U. Press 2010).
12 Stefan Talmon, Responsibility of International Organizations: Does the European Community Re-
quire Special Treatment? in International Responsibility Today: Essays in Memory of Oscar Schachter
405 (Maurizio Ragazzi ed., Martinus Nijhoff 2005).
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 149
discussion might be particularly necessary for organizations that have put
into place a framework and a mechanism for addressing violations of their
obligations.
One such organization is the World Bank, which has established the In-
spection Panel as an accountability mechanism to address failures to abide by
its policies and procedures. It is instructive to examine the interaction between
the ILC work on the responsibility of international organizations and the ac-
countability regime of the Inspection Panel to evaluate13 the added value that
general international law of responsibility could bring to the panel.14
Before discussing the international legal responsibility of IFIs from the
perspective of their compatibility with the World Bank Inspection Panel, this
chapter provides a discussion of some key features that characterize the World
Bank and sets it apart from other international organizations.
Setting the Context: Unique Features of the World Bank
The unique features of the World Bank relate to the fact that it is a �nancial
institution with similarities to a private corporation and an actor in the capital
market. At the same time, it has a development mandate, is accountable to its
member states, and has gradually established a spectrum of accountability
and review mechanisms.
A Global Credit Union with a Mandate to Finance Development
The Bank is an international �nancial cooperative institution15 “whose re-
sources are available only for the bene�t of members�16 that is required to “act
prudently in the interests both of the particular member in whose territories
the project is located and of the members as a whole� when making or guar-
anteeing a loan.17
13 This chapter touches upon the interrelated but distinct concepts of responsibility, account-
ability, and liability. The relationships among these concepts have been explored exten-
sively in the literature; see William E. Holder, Can International Organizations Be Controlled?
Accountability and Responsibility, 97 Am. Socy. Intl. L. Procs. 231 (2003); Jutta Brunnée, Inter-
national Legal Accountability through the Lens of the Law of State Responsibility, 36 Netherlands
Y.B. Intl. Law 21 (2005); Malgosia Fitzmaurice, International Responsibility and Liability, in The
Oxford Handbook of International Environmental Law 1010 (Daniel Bodansky, Jutta Brunnée, &
Ellen Hey ed., Oxford U. Press 2007). See also the discussion and the references in footnotes
35 and 120.
14 Simma & Pulkowski, supra note 11, at 148.
15 See Salman M. A. Salman, Downstream Riparians Can Also Harm Upstream Riparians: The Con-
cept of Foreclosure of Future Uses, 35 (4) Water International 350, 358 (2010) (describing the
Bank as an “international �nancial cooperative institution�).
16 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article III, Section 1(a). This limitation does not preclude as-
sistance to nonmembers when the World Bank Board of Executive Directors has deemed this
assistance to be in the interest of membership.
17 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article III, Section 4(v).
150 The World Bank Legal Review
This characterization is buttressed by the corporate structure of the Bank,
which, like other corporations, comprises shareholders whose interests are
represented by a Board of Governors and a Board of Executive Directors.18
The executive directors exercise both executive and oversight powers over
the Bank. The ultimate control of the Bank’s operations rests with the Bank’s
members, which are also its shareholders and exercise such control through
the Board of Governors and Board of Executive Directors.19 The executive di-
rectors function in continuous session and exercise substantially all the Bank’s
powers related to operations.20 The resident Board of Executive Directors has
exclusive jurisdiction on the question of interpretation of the constituent in-
strument of the organization.21
The purposes of the Bank as set forth in its Articles of Agreement are, inter
alia, to assist in the reconstruction and development of territories of its mem-
bers, to promote private foreign investment, and to promote the long-range
balanced growth of international trade and the maintenance of an equilibrium
in balances of payments by encouraging international investment for the de-
velopment of the productive resources of members.22
Broadly put, the Bank has a mandate to assist in development through
�nancing investment or technical assistance projects and policy reform pro-
grams. Clear delineation of the role of the Bank in projects (the Bank does
not get involved in implementing the projects it �nances—the borrower or
recipient of Bank �nancing does) is critical in evaluating the Bank’s exposure
to responsibility.23
18 See Tobias M. C. Asser, The World Bank, 7 J. Intl. L. & Econ. 207, 211 (1972) (stating that “the
relationship between the World Bank and its clients is a very special one which approaches
partnership. This quality of businesslike cooperation which permeates the Bank operations
calls for more than what sometimes appear to be conflicting interests�).
19 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section 4(a).
20 Aron Broches, International Bank for Reconstruction and Development, in Legal Advisers and In-
ternational Organizations 83, 85 (Herbert C. L. Merillat ed., Oceana Publications 1966). See also
IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section 4(a), providing that the “Executive Directors
shall be responsible for the conduct of the general operations of the Bank, and for this pur-
pose, shall exercise all the powers delegated to them by the Board of Governors.�
21 Under IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article IX, any question of interpretation of provisions of
the Articles of Agreement must be submitted to the executive directors of the IBRD for their
decision.
22 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article I. The purpose of the IDA is to promote economic devel-
opment and to increase productivity and thus raise standards of living in the less-developed
areas of the world included within its membership—in particular by providing �nance to
meet their developmental requirements on terms that are more flexible and bear less heavily
on the balance of payments than those of conventional loans—thereby furthering the IBRD
developmental objectives and supplementing the IBRD activities. See IDA Articles of Agree-
ment, Article I. IDA Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section I, states: “The Association shall
provide �nancing to further development in the less-developed areas of the world included
within the Association’s membership.�
23 That said, the Bank has an obligation under its Articles of Agreement to “make arrangements
to ensure that the proceeds of any loan are used only for the purposes for which the loan
was granted, with due attention to considerations of economy and ef�ciency and without
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 151
The World Bank and, more generally, IFIs are entities created by states
with limited mandates and competence.24 Unlike sovereign states, which have
sovereign powers, IFIs have limited powers by virtue of their constituent
documents.25 Additional constraints through broad-based concepts such as
international responsibility may have unintended consequences by limiting
the capacity of these institutions to discharge their mandate.
IBRD as an Actor in Capital Markets
Some IFIs, including the International Bank for Reconstruction and Develop-
ment (IBRD), the European Investment Bank, and other multilateral de-
velopment banks, operate according to a business model that uses capital
markets to source funds used to �nance loans to borrowers. These institutions
rely on access to relatively cheap �nancing from the capital markets to operate
effectively in ful�llment of their mandate. Unlike states, IFIs cannot raise taxes
to ful�ll unexpected �nancial payouts resulting from being held responsible
for harmful actions attributable to them.26
In this respect, IFIs face a dual challenge. On the one hand, as �nancial
entities, they may be assumed to possess the �nancial wherewithal to make
payouts if �nancial liability follows international responsibility for wrongful
acts. On the other hand, IFIs that are also actors in capital markets are perhaps
more sensitive to such contingent liability to make payments than interna-
tional organizations that rely on voluntary contributions as the basis of their
�nancing, because contingent risks may impair these IFIs’ risk pro�le and
therefore the attractiveness of their bonds as investments.
Accountability Mechanisms
The Bank has created a spectrum of accountability and review mechanisms
with an oversight function over the Bank’s operations. In addition to the In-
spection Panel, the principal accountability and supervisory mechanisms are
the Administrative Tribunal, the Internal Auditing Department (IAD), the In-
dependent Evaluations Group (IEG), and the Integrity Vice Presidency (INT).
regard to political or other non-economic influences or considerations� (IBRD Articles of
Agreement, Article III, Section 5{b}). The Bank discharges this obligation by agreeing with
the borrower on certain disbursement, procurement, �nancial management, monitoring,
and supervision provisions for each project that it �nances. The borrower is responsible for
ensuring that the proceeds of the �nancing are used for their intended purposes.
24 The Bank plays a speci�c role in relation to projects, namely, that of a �nancier. See Asser,
supra note 18, at 210.
25 Unlike a state, “an international organization represents not a subject of international law
that has a continuing base of resources in a given population and territory, but a subject that
is the creation of other subjects� with “a life and influence of its own� but that “can move
only as far and as fast as the leading strings of member states permit.� See Herbert C. L. Mer-
illat, Preface, in Legal Advisers and International Organizations vii, viii (Herbert C. L. Merillat
ed., Oceana Publications 1966).
26 This is crucial for the IBRD because the liability of its member states is limited to the unpaid
portion of the issue price of the shares; see IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article II, Section 6.
152 The World Bank Legal Review
These mechanisms operate under various mandates and cover different
aspects of the Bank’s operations. The Administrative Tribunal is entrusted
with hearing and deciding complaints by staff members, or persons claiming
through them, that a decision or action taken by the Bank has violated the
staff member’s terms of appointment or contract of employment.27 The IAD
is responsible for auditing operational, �nancial, administrative, personnel,
and information resource management systems and other activities with the
objective of assessing their ef�ciency, compliance with policies, and effective-
ness.28 The IEG’s mandate extends to the assessment of the relevance, ef�cacy,
and ef�ciency of World Bank operational programs and activities and their
contribution to development effectiveness.29 The INT is primarily responsible
for investigating allegations of fraud or corruption at the World Bank or in
connection with Bank-related projects and allegations of misconduct by Bank
staff members.30
Accountability is pursued not only through oversight mechanisms but
also through the promotion of transparency.31 In July 2010, the World Bank
adopted a policy on access to information that is based on the principle of
maximizing access to information.32 Under this policy, the Bank allows access
to any information in its possession unless such information falls under a list
of exceptions;33 an oversight mechanism, consisting of the access to informa-
tion committee and the appeals board, has been established.34
27 World Bank Administrative Tribunal Statute, Article II, paragraph 1.
28 Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, The World Bank Inspection Panel: In Practice 15–16 (2d ed., Oxford U.
Press 2000).
29 IEG, Mandate of the Director-General, Evaluation, available at .
30 See World Bank Sanctions Procedures (as adopted by the World Bank as of Jan. 1, 2011),
available at . After completing an investigation in which �rms or indi-
viduals are found to have engaged in a sanctionable practice, the INT will initiate the sanc-
tions process by preparing a Notice of Sanctions Proceedings. The appropriate sanctions are
determined �rst by the suspension and evaluation of�cer; if the sanctions are challenged,
they are reviewed by the sanctions board.
31 Benedict Kingsbury, The Concept of “Law� in Global Administrative Law, 20 Eur. J. Intl. L. 23, 25
(2009).
32 World Bank, Policy on Access to Information, paragraph 5 (Jul. 2010), available at .
33 Id., at paragraph 6.
34 The committee serves as the �rst stage of appeal for appeals alleging a violation of the policy.
It also serves as the �rst and �nal stage of appeal for appeals making a public interest case,
and its decisions in these cases are �nal. The appeals board hears only appeals alleging a
violation of the policy. It serves as the second stage of appeal if requesters whose appeal has
been denied by the committee wish to �le a second appeal. Id., at paragraphs 35–40.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 153
Thus, it is clear that accountability is “a multifaceted phenomenon.�35
Among the accountability mechanisms of the Bank, the Inspection Panel
stands out for two reasons: its subject matter extends to almost all aspects
of the principal activity of the institution, namely, �nancing projects; and the
Inspection Panel can examine ongoing projects and provide the possibility of
a remedial action, not just an ex post evaluation. In this respect, the Inspec-
tion Panel offers the most comprehensive and more “binding� review of the
Bank’s activities.
The Two Regimes
Before examining the interaction between the ILC work on the responsibility
of international organizations and the Inspection Panel, it is helpful to briefly
introduce these two regimes and discuss the links that exist between their
respective rules.
ILC Work on the Responsibility of International Organizations
The ILC completed the �rst reading of the draft articles on the responsibil-
ity of international organizations in 2009.36 The ILC decided to deal with this
topic after it concluded its consideration of the topic of state responsibility,
which had been under discussion for almost half a century, in 2001.37 The
working method adopted by the ILC for the new topic was to use the articles
on state responsibility as the starting point and build similar provisions on the
responsibility of international organizations.38
The decision of the ILC to deal with this topic, and its working method,
has met considerable criticism. The main points of criticism have been the
wide variety of international organizations, which impedes the development
35 International Law Association, Final Report on Accountability of International Organizations 5
(2004), available at . According
to this report, depending on the particular circumstances surrounding the acts or omissions
of international organizations, their member states, or third parties, accountability can take
different forms: legal, political, administrative, or �nancial. See also Rekha Oleschak-Pillai,
Accountability of International Organizations: An Analysis of the World Bank’s Inspection Panel,
in Accountability for Human Rights Violations by International Organizations 401, 402–08 (Jan
Wouters et al. ed., Intersentia 2010).
36 UNGA Resolution 64/114, January 15, 2010, UN Doc. A/RES/64/114 (2010). For an assess-
ment of the draft articles, see Kristen E. Boon, New Directions in Responsibility: Assessing the
International Law Commission’s Draft Articles on the Responsibility of International Organiza-
tions, 37 Yale J. Intl. L. Online 1 (Spring 2011), available at .
37 The ILC began discussing the issue of state responsibility in 1949 and concluded it with the
adoption of the draft articles on responsibility of states for internationally wrongful acts
in 2001. For an account of the ILC’s work on this topic, see James Crawford, International
Law Commission’s Articles on State Responsibility: Introduction, Text and Commentaries 1–61
(Cambridge U. Press 2002).
38 Giorgio Gaja, special rapporteur, First Report on Responsibility of International Organizations, at
paragraph 11, UN Doc. A/CN.4/532 (Mar. 26, 2003).
154 The World Bank Legal Review
of uniform principles; the lack of available practice from international organi-
zations; and the ambiguity concerning the primary rules applicable to inter-
national organizations.39Another factor that may undermine the effectiveness
of the ILC’s work on this topic is the immunities accorded to international
organizations.40
Although there is a trend to restrict the immunities accorded to interna-
tional organizations,41 and the draft articles may contribute to this trend, there
is an additional problem. No international judicial or quasi-judicial bodies
have direct jurisdiction over the acts or omissions of international organiza-
tions.42 Most multilateral treaties, which set forth international obligations and
establish international judicial or quasi-judicial bodies to ensure compliance
with those obligations, can have only states as parties to these treaties.43 More-
over, only states can institute contentious proceedings before the International
Court of Justice.44
World Bank Inspection Panel
Several international organizations have established internal accountability
mechanisms, the most notable of which is the World Bank’s Inspection Panel.
The rationale behind the panel’s establishment was twofold: to enhance the ef-
�ciency of the Bank’s operations and to meet the demand for greater transpar-
ency and accountability.45 Linked to these two factors is the question of institu-
tional reputation; although it is an elusive concept in the case of international
39 Jose Alvarez, International Organizations: Accountability or Responsibility? Luncheon Address,
Canadian Council of International Law, Thirty-Fifth Annual Conference on Responsibility of
Individuals, States and Organizations (Oct. 27, 2006).
40 Eisuke Suzuki, Responsibility of IFIs under International Law, in International Financial Institu-
tions and International Law 61, 67–69 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed., Kluwer Law
International 2010).
41 August Reinisch, International Organizations before National Courts (Cambridge U. Press 2000);
Stephen Hertz, International Organization in U.S. Courts: Reconsidering the Anachronism of Abso-
lute Immunity, 31 Suffolk Transnatl. L. Rev. 471 (2007–08). For a discussion of the immunity of
international organizations, see also William Berenson, Squaring the Concept of Immunity with
the Fundamental Right to a Fair Trial: The Case of the OAS, and Rutsel Silvestre J. Martha, Interna-
tional Financial Institutions and Claims of Private Parties: Immunity Obliges; both in this volume.
42 Shihata, supra note 28, at 263–64. The various administrative tribunals of international orga-
nizations have exclusive jurisdiction for matters related to the staff of the organizations. For
an overview of the administrative tribunals of international organizations, see Chittharanjan
F. Amerasinghe, The Law of the International Civil Service: As Applied by International Admin-
istrative Tribunals (2d ed., Oxford U. Press 1994). The judicial organs of the European Union
have jurisdiction over actions of the European Union.
43 Where international organizations have become parties to multilateral treaties, the relevant
adjudicatory bodies under these treaties have acquired jurisdiction over these organizations
(for example, the WTO Dispute Settlement Body has jurisdiction over the European Union,
and the European Court of Human Rights will acquire jurisdiction over the European Union
if the EU accedes to the European Convention on Human Rights).
44 See Article 34, paragraph 1, of the Statute of the International Court of Justice. International
organizations may request only advisory opinions; see Article 96(2) of the UN Charter.
45 Shihata, supra note 28, at 1–5.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 155
organizations, reputation appears to have played no insigni�cant role in the
circumstances leading to the creation of the Inspection Panel.46
The panel was established by a resolution47 of the Bank’s executive direc-
tors in September 1993 and has since served as a model for instituting inspec-
tion functions in other IFIs.48 The resolution and two subsequent Board clari-
�cations constitute the legal framework that regulates the panel’s mandate
and procedure.49 Based on this framework, the panel examines requests for
inspection by an affected party,50 which should allege that “its rights or inter-
ests have been or are likely to be directly affected by an action or omission of
the Bank as a result of a failure of the Bank to follow the Bank’s operational
policies and procedures� in projects �nanced or to be �nanced by the Bank
(including development policy operations).51 The resolution sets forth three
preliminary requirements to be met before the panel can consider a request
for inspection.
First, the subject matter of the request must have been dealt with by Bank
Management and the Management must have failed to demonstrate that it
followed, or is taking adequate steps to follow, the Bank’s policies and pro-
cedures. Second, the alleged violation of the Bank’s policies and procedures
must be, in the view of the panel, of a serious character.52 Third, the act or the
omission should have—or be likely to have—a materially adverse effect on
the rights or interests of the affected person.53
46 In the mid-1980s, the Bank decided to partially �nance two major projects on the Narmada
River in India. The projects caused environmental impacts and were expected to require the
resettlement of a large number of people. The criticism from civil society led the president
of the Bank to commission an independent review. The Narmada case fueled the debate on
the Bank’s accountability, which resulted in the establishment of the panel. See Shihata, supra
note 28, at 5-8. See also Ian Johnstone, Do International Organizations Have Reputations? 7 Intl.
Organizations L. Rev. 235 (2011) (arguing that the reputation can be a strong factor in induc-
ing compliance with the law).
47 Resolution of the Executive Directors Establishing the World Bank Inspection Panel (No. 93-10 for
the IBRD and No. 93-6 for IDA), SecM93-988 (IBRD) and SecM93-313 (IDA) (Sep. 23, 1993).
48 For an overview of the inspection mechanisms of the various IFIs, see Daniel D. Bradlow,
Private Complaints and International Organizations: A Comparative Study of the Independent In-
spection Mechanisms in International Financial Institutions, 36 Geo. J. Intl. L. 403 (2005).
49 The inspection function was subsequently reviewed by the Board in 1996. The �rst review
resulted in the adoption of clari�cations to the resolution establishing the panel. These clari-
�cations did not solve all the problems in the operation of the panel, and thus a second
review took place in 1998–99. This review ended with the Board issuing a statement entitled
“Conclusions of the Board’s Second Review of the Inspection Panel�; see Shihata, supra note
28, at 155–203. On August 19, 1994, the Inspection Panel adopted operating procedures that
elaborate on certain aspects of its constituent resolution. Bank Procedure (BP) 17.55—Inspec-
tion Panel clari�es internal steps that Bank staff are required to follow when responding to a
request for inspection.
50 A request for inspection can also be submitted by an executive director.
51 Resolution, paragraph 12.
52 Id., at paragraph 13.
53 Id., at paragraph 12.
156 The World Bank Legal Review
Nature of Draft Articles and Panel Regimes
In the course of its work on the topic of state responsibility, the ILC introduced
a distinction between primary and secondary rules. This distinction allowed
the ILC to limit its focus on rules speci�cally regulating international respon-
sibility (secondary rules), excluding those rules whose violations give rise to
responsibility (primary rules).54 The ILC did not see a reason to depart from
the approach adopted on the topic of state responsibility when it decided to
tackle the responsibility of international organizations. In fact, the ILC has
explicitly stated that “the meaning of ‘responsibility’ in the new topic at least
comprises the same concept,� namely, the “consequences under international
law of internationally wrongful acts.�55
However, the distinction between the two sets of rules has at times been
characterized as “arti�cial.�56 In particular, with respect to international orga-
nizations whose international obligations are not de�ned with the same clar-
ity as the obligations of states,57 the lines between the two sets of rules can
become easily blurred.58 Commentators have also noted that the draft articles
introduce some primary obligations for international organizations.59
The panel’s framework also sets secondary rules. The obligations of
the Bank are found not in the panel’s resolution but in the Bank’s policies
and procedures. In addition, the panel is not mandated to examine or make
recommendations on the adequacy or the underlying merits of the policies
themselves.60 The resolution determines only the consequences of violations
54 Roberto Ago �rst proposed to focus only on responsibility; Herbert Briggs �rst used the
expression “primary and secondary� rules; see Eric David, Primary and Secondary Rules, in
The Law of International Responsibility 27, 28 (James Crawford, Alain Pellet, & Simon Olleson
ed., Oxford U. Press 2010). According to ILC commentary on articles on state responsibility,
“The emphasis is on the secondary rules of State responsibility: that is to say, the general
conditions under international law for the State to be considered responsible for wrongful
actions or omissions, and the legal consequences which flow therefrom. The articles do not
attempt to de�ne the content of the international obligations, the breach of which gives rise
to responsibility. This is the function of the primary rules, whose codi�cation would involve
restating most of substantive customary and conventional international law.� Report of the
International Law Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Third Session, UN GAOR, 56th Sess.,
at 31, paragraph (1), Supp. No. 10, UN Doc. A/56/10 (2001).
55 Report of the International Law Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Fourth Session, UN
GAOR, 57th Sess., at 228, paragraph 465, Supp. No. 10, UN Doc. A/57/10 (2002).
56 David, supra note 54, at 29–33 (discussing mainly the provisions on the circumstances
precluding wrongfulness as an example of primary rules embedded in the articles on state
responsibility).
57 Alvarez, supra note 39.
58 This risk has been pointed out to the ILC by international organizations. See ILC, Responsi-
bility of International Organizations: Comments and Observations Received from Interna-
tional Organizations, at 14, UN Doc. A/CN.4/637 (Feb. 14, 2011).
59 Pieter J. Kuijper, Introduction to the Symposium on Responsibility of International Organizations
and of (Member) States: Attributed or Direct Responsibility or Both? 7 Intl. Organizations L. Rev.
9, 22 (2010) (arguing that draft articles 13–16 contain primary obligations for international
organizations); and Boon supra note 36, at 5, footnote 26.
60 Shihata, supra note 28, at 54.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 157
of these policies and the procedure of bringing to the panel and processing a
request for inspection.
In that respect, both the draft articles and the panel’s framework “spell
out consequences of a deviation from normative expectations.�61
The next part of this chapter reviews speci�c provisions of the panel’s
legal framework as well as those of the draft articles to identify the relations
between the two sets of rules.62
An Overview of the Panel’s Mandate through the Lens
of the Draft Articles
The general principle relating to the concept of international responsibility of
an international organization is found in draft article 3:63
Every internationally wrongful act of an international organiza-
tion entails the international responsibility of the international
organization.
Because an “internationally wrongful act� triggers the responsibility of an in-
ternational organization, the elements of an internationally wrongful act must
be identi�ed. These elements are presented in draft article 4, which states:
There is an internationally wrongful act of an international organiza-
tion when conduct consisting of an action or omission:
(a) Is attributable to the international organization under interna-
tional law; and
(b) Constitutes a breach of an international obligation of that inter-
national organization.
This section discusses how these two basic elements of the internationally
wrongful act �t together, whether they are consistent with the panel’s legal
61 Simma & Pulkowski, supra note 11, at 141.
62 The ILC has identi�ed four types of relationships between norms: relations between special
and general law; relations between prior and subsequent law; relations between laws at
different hierarchical levels; and relations of law to its “normative environment� more gen-
erally; see Report of the Study Group of the International Law Commission, Fragmentation
of International Law: Dif�culties Arising from the Diversi�cation and Expansion of Interna-
tional Law, at paragraph 18, UN Doc. A/CN.4/L.682 (2006).
63 The text of the draft articles is found in the Report of the International Law Commission on
the Work of Its Sixty-First Session, GAOR, 64th Sess., at paragraph 50, Supp. No. 10, UN
Doc. A/64/10 (2009) (ILC Report). On June 3, 2011, the ILC adopted the draft articles on the
responsibility of international organizations, on second reading; see ILC, Responsibility of
International Organizations: Texts and Titles of Draft Articles 1 to 67 Adopted by the Draft-
ing Committee on Second Reading in 2011, UN Doc. A/CN.4/L.778 (2011). Although there
are some substantive and stylistic changes between the draft articles adopted on �rst read-
ing and the ones adopted on second reading, these changes do not affect the analysis of this
chapter, and so reference is made only to the draft articles adopted on �rst reading.
158 The World Bank Legal Review
framework, and the main discrepancies, if any, between the draft articles and
the panel’s legal framework.
Attribution
The rules of attribution of conduct are set forth in draft articles 5–8. The term
“conduct� is intended to cover both acts and omissions on the part of interna-
tional organizations.64 In the same vein, the Inspection Panel has competence
to examine both acts and omissions of the Bank.65
The general rule on attribution is in draft article 5, which states:
1. The conduct of an organ or agent of an international organiza-
tion in the performance of functions of that organ or agent shall be
considered as an act of that organization under international law
whatever position the organ or agent holds in respect of the orga-
nization.
2. Rules of the organization shall apply to the determination of the
functions of its organs and agents.
Although the term “agent� is de�ned in draft article 2(c), the term “organ�
has no corresponding de�nition in the draft articles.66 According to the ILC,
the distinction between the two terms is not relevant, because “when persons
or entities are characterized as organs or agents by the rules of the organiza-
tion, there is no doubt that the conduct of those persons or entities has to be
attributed, in principle, to the organization.�67
Because international organizations have adopted divergent interpreta-
tions of draft article 5, it is interesting to consider how the panel might de�ne
the terms “organ� and “agent.� 68 According to the resolution, the panel covers
only the activities of IBRD and the IDA.69 Furthermore, unlike constituent in-
struments of other international organizations,70 neither the IBRD nor the IDA
64 ILC Report, at 54, paragraph (1).
65 Resolution, paragraph 12.
66 Several international organizations have noted this discrepancy. See ILC, Responsibility
of International Organizations: Comments and Observations Received from International
Organizations, at 17–19, UN Doc. A/CN.4/637 (Feb. 14, 2011).
67 ILC Report, at 60, paragraph (5).
68 Kuijper, supra note 59, at 14–15.
69 Resolution, paragraph 28. The panel’s mandate does not extend to actions or omissions of
two other af�liates of the World Bank Group, namely, the International Financial Corpo-
ration (IFC) and the Multilateral Guarantee Agency (MIGA); see Shihata, supra note 28, at
33. One of the �rst requests to the panel involved a project �nanced by the IFC. The panel
refused to register the request because its mandate did not extend to the IFC; id., at 114–15.
On the World Bank Group, see Maurizio Ragazzi, World Bank Group, in The Max Planck Ency-
clopedia of Public International Law (Rüdiger Wolfrum ed., Oxford U. Press 2008), available at
.
70 Cf. Article 7 of the UN Charter.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 159
articles of agreement use the term “organ� or “agent.�71 However, the IBRD
Articles of Agreement state that “[t]he Bank shall have a Board of Governors,
Executive Directors, a President and such other of�cers and staff to perform
such duties as the Bank may determine.�72 From this clause, one may infer
that the Bank’s organs are the Board of Governors, the executive directors,
and Management.
The draft articles do not make a distinction between the position and the
functions of organs and agents of an international organization.73 Similarly, the
resolution refers to actions and omissions of the Bank resulting from failure
of the Bank to follow its own policies and procedures, without indicating
whether it matters which organ acted or failed to act in the particular circum-
stances. In this respect, the position adopted by the resolution appears to cor-
respond to the position of the draft articles.74 The diversity of international ob-
ligations may explain this position of making no distinction among organs for
the purpose of assigning responsibility. As the ILC observed when comment-
ing on the corresponding provision of the articles on state responsibility:
There is no category of organs specially designated for the commis-
sion of international wrongful acts, and virtually any State organ
may be the author of such an act. The diversity of international ob-
ligations does not permit any general distinction between organs
which can commit internationally wrongful acts and those which
cannot.75
Despite the broad wording of the resolution, the panel examines actions
and omissions of Bank staff because the Bank’s policies, the observance of
which the panel reviews, are addressed to Bank staff.76 This reality suggests
that the specialty of primary obligations of international organizations can
diminish the scope of secondary obligations of such organizations.77
71 The term “agent� is used in the IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article VII, Section 3 (and IDA
Articles of Agreement, Article VIII, Section 3), but these provisions refer to privileges and
immunities.
72 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section I. Article V is entitled “Organization and
Structure.�
73 ILC Report, at 61, paragraph (7).
74 Resolution, paragraph 12.
75 Report of the International Law Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Third Session, supra
note 54, at 40, paragraph (5).
76 Shihata, supra note 28, at 47.
77 Although the distinction between primary and secondary rules is well established, Kelsen
provides a compelling account of the unity between the primary and the secondary norms;
see Hans Kelsen, General Theory of Norms 142 (Clarendon Press 1991).
160 The World Bank Legal Review
Breach of an International Obligation
The second element for an internationally wrongful act of an international or-
ganization to arise is that the conduct constitutes a breach of an international
obligation of that organization. This issue is covered in chapter 3 of the draft
articles, the main provision (draft article 9) of which is:
1. There is a breach of an international obligation by an international
organization when an act of that international organization is not in
conformity with what is required of it by that obligation, regardless
of its origin and character.
2. Paragraph 1 includes the breach of an international obligation that
may arise under the rules of the organization.
The ILC acknowledges that “for an international organization most obliga-
tions are likely to arise from the rules of the organization.�78 The “rules of the
organization� are de�ned in draft article 2(c) as “the constituent instruments,
decisions, resolutions and other acts of the organization adopted in accor-
dance with those instruments, and established practice of the organization.�79
Thus, the panel can review whether the Bank has followed its operational pol-
icies, procedures,80 and operational directives (as well as similar documents
issued before these series were implemented) and exclude guidelines,81 best
practices, or similar documents or statements. These operational policies and
procedures82 are consistent with the Bank’s Articles of Agreement.83
78 ILC Report, at 78, paragraph (4).
79 However, it is contested whether “all the obligations arising from rules of the organization
are to be considered as international obligations�; see id., at 78–79, paragraphs (5)–(6).
80 Resolution, paragraph 12, clari�es the content of operational policies and procedures. Shiha-
ta, the World Bank’s General Counsel at the time of the establishment of the panel, observed
that the de�nition of the operational policies and procedures in the resolution is not exhaus-
tive. The fact that an operational rule incorporated into the Bank’s Articles of Agreement or
in any decision of the Board of Executive Directors is not reflected in the operational policies
and procedures does not preclude the panel from examining its alleged violation. See Shi-
hata, supra note 28, at 45. On this basis, one could argue that unless explicitly prohibited from
doing so by the Board, the panel can review any violation of the rules of the Bank.
81 Certain Bank rules were explicitly taken out of the panel’s purview. For example, the panel
cannot review compliance with the Bank’s guidelines on procurement; see resolution, para-
graph 14(b) and Shihata, supra note 28, at 52–54.
82 Although the operational policies and procedures are primarily internal rules of the Bank,
they become legally binding conditions when incorporated into loan or credit agreements
between the Bank and a borrowing state; see Benedict Kingsbury, Operational Policies of Inter-
national Institutions as Part of the Lawmaking Process: The World Bank and Indigenous Peoples, in
The Reality of International Law: Essays in Honour of Ian Brownlie 323, 338 (Guy Goodwin-Gill
& Stefan Talmon ed., Clarendon Press 1999).
83 Shihata, supra note 28, at 42. This approach is consistent with the position taken by the ILC
in de�ning the “rules of the organization.� The ILC notes: “The rules of the organization
concerned will provide, expressly or implicitly, for a hierarchy among the different kinds of
rules. For instance, the acts adopted by an international organization will generally not be
able to derogate from its constituent instruments�; see ILC Report, at 50.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 161
According to the ILC, the responsibility of an international organization
is not limited to cases where there is a violation of the rules of the organiza-
tion. Draft article 9, paragraph 1, refers to a breach of international obligations,
regardless of their origin or character. In its commentary on this provision,
the ILC alludes to its commentary on the corresponding provision in the ar-
ticles on state responsibility and suggests that the obligations of international
organizations “may be established by a customary rule of international law,
by a treaty or by a general principle applicable within the international legal
order.�84 This comment triggers two distinct questions: Which of the obliga-
tions of the Bank are based on treaty law, international custom, or general
principles of international law, and is the panel competent to examine alleged
violations of these obligations?
The question on the source and nature of international obligations of the
Bank is outside the scope of this chapter, which focuses on the secondary
rules. Considerable literature seeks to identify these obligations, especially in
relation to human rights and environmental law.85 Can the panel review Bank
compliance with these obligations? The text of the resolution is clear that the
panel’s mandate covers only the Bank’s policies and procedures, which are
de�ned in an exclusive way. In other words, there is no indication in the reso-
lution and the two subsequent reviews that the panel can apply international
legal norms beyond the Bank’s legal framework.86
Two examples drawn from the panel’s practice illustrate how the panel
has navigated the dif�cult issue of the application of international legal norms
84 Report of the International Law Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Third Session, supra
note 54, at 55, paragraph (3).
85 For a comprehensive overview of the general principles of international law applicable to
IFIs, see Daniel D. Bradlow, International Law and Operations of the IFIs, in International Finan-
cial Institutions and International Law 1, 11–25 (Daniel D. Bradlow & David B. Hunter ed.,
Kluwer Law International 2010). Being a nonparty to international environmental treaties
has not prevented the Bank from reflecting international law principles derived from some
of these treaties in its own environmental policies. The content of these policies is translated
into speci�c obligations that are incorporated into agreements that the Bank enters with bor-
rowing states. As Di Leva observes, “OP 4.01 and other safeguard policies provide the Bank
with tools that support environmental and social principles that can be found in the 1992 Rio
Declaration on Environment and Development, the 1991 Convention on Environmental Im-
pact Assessment in the Transboundary Context (Espoo Convention), and the 1998 Conven-
tion on Access to Information, Public Participation in Decision Making and Access to Justice
in Environmental Matters (Aarhus Convention), among other international environmental
instruments.� See Charles Di Leva, Transboundary Management of Natural Resources: A Brief
Overview of World Bank Policies and Projects, in Shared Resources: Issues of Governance 33, 39
(Sharell Hart ed., IUCN 2008).
86 There have been proposals that the panel broaden the scope of its mandate; see Gudmun-
dur Alfredsson, Introduction: Broadening the Scope of the Applicable Standards, in The Inspection
Panel of the World Bank: A Different Complaints Procedure 47 (Gudmundur Alfredsson and Rolf
Ring ed., Martinus Nijhoff 2001).
162 The World Bank Legal Review
other than the Bank’s “rules of the organization.� In the Chad Petroleum case,87
the requesters alleged, inter alia, violations of the Bank’s “directives on re-
spect for human rights.�88 In response, Bank Management emphasized that
the Bank’s Articles of Agreement require the Bank to focus on economic con-
siderations—not on political or other noneconomic influences—as the basis of
its decisions.89 This line of argument, although reflective of the of�cial Bank
position toward human rights,90 was not persuasive to the panel. The panel
took issue “with the Management’s narrow view� and drew attention “in
this connection to the UN Universal Declaration of Human Rights adopted in
December 1948, three years after the Bank’s articles of agreement entered into
effect.�91 It also clari�ed:
It is not within the Panel’s mandate to assess the status of gover-
nance and human rights in Chad in general or in isolation, and the
Panel acknowledges that there are several institutions (including
UN bodies) speci�cally in charge of this subject. However, the Panel
felt obliged to examine whether the issues of proper governance
or human rights violations in Chad were such as to impede the
implementation of the Project in a manner compatible with the
Bank’s policies. (emphasis in the original)92
It is noteworthy that the panel felt compelled to declare that it was not
broadening its mandate and to argue that speci�c human rights consider-
ations are included in the Bank’s policies. In that respect, the panel did not
argue that the Bank has human rights obligations under international customs
or general principles of international law. The panel is mindful of the impera-
tive to operate within the con�nes of the rules of the organization, even when
it tries to expand its mandate.
In the Honduras–Land Administration Project case, the panel was asked to
examine the relevance of International Labor Organization (ILO) Convention
No. 169, concerning indigenous and tribal peoples in independent countries,
to the Bank policies. In that respect, the panel observed that
the Bank is responsible for compliance with its own policies and
procedures. But it also notes that Honduras is a party to ILO Con-
vention No. 169. The General Counsel’s Response indicates that OD
[Operational Directive] 4.20 does not require compliance with ILO
87 World Bank Inspection Panel Investigation Report, Chad: Petroleum Development and Pipe-
line Project (Loan No. 4558-CD); Management of the Petroleum Economy Project (Credit
No. 3316-CD); Petroleum Sector Management Capacity-Building Project (Credit No. 3373-
CD) (Jul. 17, 2002) (Chad Petroleum case), available at .
88 Chad Petroleum case, at paragraph 210.
89 Id., at paragraph 212.
90 Siobhán McInerney-Lankford & Hans Otto-Sano, Human Rights Indicators in Development: An
Introduction 6 (World Bank Study 2010).
91 Chad Petroleum case, at paragraph 214.
92 Id., at paragraph 215.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 163
Convention No. 169. The Panel observes that OD 4.20 broadly re-
flects the spirit and provisions of ILO Convention No. 169.93
The panel then added that
it is a matter for Honduras to implement the obligations of an inter-
national agreement to which it is party and does not comment on this
matter. However, the Panel is concerned that the Bank, consistently
with OMS [Operational Manual Statement] 2.20, did not adequately
consider whether the proposed Project plan and its implementation
would be consistent with ILO Convention No. 169.94
In conclusion, for the World Bank Inspection Panel, there is a breach of
an international obligation by the Bank only when an act of the Bank is not in
conformity with its rules. In other words, although the Bank’s policies may
reference, for example, international environmental obligations,95 the panel
can render judgment only upon the Bank’s compliance with its own rules.
Concurrent Responsibility
An issue of particular interest for the Bank and other IFIs is that of the respon-
sibility of international organizations in connection with the acts of a state
(or an international organization).96 According to draft articles 13–16, an in-
ternational organization is responsible when (a) it aids or assists a state in
the commission of an internationally wrongful act by the state; (b) it directs
and controls a state in the commission of an internationally wrongful act by
the state; (c) it coerces a state to commit an internationally wrongful act; and
(d) it adopts a decision binding a member state or authorizes a member state
to commit an act that would be internationally wrongful if committed by the
former organization and would circumvent an international obligation of the
former organization.
The ILC did not �nd a compelling reason not to follow the respective pro-
visions of the articles on state responsibility, even though it had to rely on
93 World Bank Inspection Panel Investigation Report No. 39933-HN, Honduras: Land Ad-
ministration Project (IDA Credit 3858-HO), at paragraph 256 (Jun. 12, 2007), avail-able at
.
94 Id., at paragraph 257.
95 See also Operational Policy (OP) 4.01—Environmental Assessment, paragraph 4, which re-
quires the Bank not to �nance project activities that would contravene states’ obligations
“under relevant international environmental treaties and agreements.� However, the policy
adds that such obligations must have been identi�ed during an environmental assessment,
which is an activity for which the borrowing state, not the Bank, is responsible.
96 ILC, Responsibility of International Organizations: Comments and Observations Received
from International Organizations, at 27–28, UN Doc. A/CN.4/637 (Feb. 14, 2011). For previ-
ous comments by the International Monetary Fund, see ILC, Responsibility of International
Organizations, Comments and Observations Received from International Organizations,
UN Doc. A/CN.4/582 (May 1, 2007).
164 The World Bank Legal Review
limited practice of international organizations in this matter.97 With respect
to aid and assistance, the special rapporteur observed that “an international
organization could incur responsibility for assisting a State, through �nancial
support or otherwise, in a project that would entail an infringement of human
rights of certain affected individuals.�98
Although the text of draft article 13 does not explicitly exclude �nancial
aid and assistance,99 there are two additional conditions for the responsibility
of the international organization to occur: the organization provides aid or as-
sistance with knowledge of the circumstances of the internationally wrongful
act; and the act would be internationally wrongful if committed by the organi-
zation. It has been argued that, on the basis of the commentary to the articles
on state responsibility,100 there might be an additional condition, namely, that
the aid or assistance must have a certain level of severity.101
These explicitly mentioned conditions pose problems. It is unclear what
level of knowledge is required. Some authors have remarked that, if one seeks
guidance in the commentary to the articles on state responsibility,102 knowl-
edge may include intent.103 Furthermore, the requirement that the act be inter-
nationally wrongful by the organization leads us back to the determination of
primary obligations. These two considerations would likewise apply to draft
article 14 on direction and control, because it contains the same conditions as
draft article 13.
The crucial question is whether and how the panel addresses issues of
concurrent responsibility between the Bank and the borrowing state. The reso-
lution is explicit that the panel will examine
97 ILC Report, at 82, paragraph (1).
98 Giorgio Gaja, special rapporteur, Third Report on Responsibility of International Organizations,
at paragraph 28, UN Doc. A/CN.4/553 (May 13, 2005).
99 The World Bank has asked the ILC to “consider expressly indicating, in its commentary to
draft article 13, that organizations providing �nancial assistance do not, as a rule, assume
the risk that assistance will be used to carry out an international wrong, as the commentary
to the articles on the responsibility of States for internationally wrongful acts clearly pro-
vides�; see ILC, Responsibility of International Organizations: Comments and Observations
Received from International Organizations, at 28, UN Doc. A/CN.4/637 (Feb. 14, 2011).
100 “There is no requirement that the aid or assistance should have been essential to the perfor-
mance of the internationally wrongful act; it is suf�cient if it contributed signi�cantly to that
act�; see Report of the International Law Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Third Session,
supra note 54, at 66, paragraph (5).
101 August Reinisch, Aid or Assistance and Direction and Control between States and International
Organizations in the Commission of Internationally Wrongful Acts, 7 Intl. Organizations L. Rev.
63, 70–71 (2010).
102 “Where the allegation is that the assistance of a State has facilitated human rights abuses
by another State, the particular circumstances of each case must be carefully examined to
determine whether the aiding State by its aid was aware of and intended to facilitate the
commission of the internationally wrongful conduct�; see Report of the International Law
Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Third Session, supra note 54, at 67, paragraph (9).
103 Reinisch, supra note 101, at 72.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 165
action[s] or omission[s] of the Bank as a result of a failure of the
Bank to follow its operational policies and procedures with respect
to the design, appraisal and/or implementation of a project �nanced
by the Bank (including situations where the Bank is alleged to have
failed in its follow-up on the borrower’s obligations under loan
agreements with respect to such policies and procedures).104
During the design, appraisal, and implementation of projects, the Bank
and the borrowing state have different roles and obligations. For example,
project preparation is a task for the borrowing state, whereas the Bank’s role
includes making sure that the borrower understands the Bank’s requirements
and standards and helping the borrower �nd the �nancing and the technical
assistance for preparatory work. The project’s implementation is the responsi-
bility of the borrowing state, whereas supervision rests with the Bank.
The distinct roles of the Bank and the borrowing state are reflected in the
Bank’s policies and procedures. For example, under Operational Policy (OP)
4.12—Involuntary Resettlement, the borrowing state is responsible for, inter
alia, preparing the resettlement plan, carrying out a census to identify the per-
sons who will be affected by the project, determining who will be eligible for
assistance, discouraging the inflow of people ineligible for assistance, and de-
veloping a procedure for establishing the criteria by which displaced persons
will be deemed eligible for compensation and other resettlement assistance.105
All these actions must be acceptable to the Bank.
The panel is concerned only with the Bank’s role. In the Albania–Power
Sector Generation and Restructuring Project case,106 the requesters had—prior to
submitting a request to the panel—approached the Compliance Committee
of the Aarhus Convention107 to allege that Albania was not complying with
its obligations concerning public access to information and participation in
the construction of a Bank-�nanced thermal power plant project and an
energy park. The committee accepted the request and found the allegation
to be justi�ed.108 The panel considered the decision of the committee and
observed that
the Aarhus Convention Compliance Committee’s review focused on
the actions of Albania (Party), not on the Bank. However, the conclu-
sions of the Committee are relevant because Bank policy gives the
104 Resolution, paragraph 12.
105 See OP 4.10—Involuntary Resettlement, paragraphs 7 and 14.
106 World Bank Inspection Panel Investigation Report No. 49504-AL, Albania–Power Sector
Generation and Restructuring Project (IDA Credit No. 3872-ALB) (Aug. 7, 2009) (Alba-
nia case), available at .
107 Convention on Access to Information, Public Participation in Decision-Making and Access
to Justice in Environmental Matters (Jun. 25, 1998), 38 ILM 517.
108 Albania case, at ix.
166 The World Bank Legal Review
main responsibility for consultation to the borrower and requires the
Bank to ensure that the borrower ful�lls this requirement.109
The panel concluded that the Bank did not ensure that the project prep-
aration activities complied with the consultation and public participation
requirements of the Aarhus Convention, and thus did not comply with OP
4.01—Environmental Assessment.110
This case could be analyzed through the prism of the draft articles as fol-
lows: the Bank omitted to direct Albania to conduct consultations in accor-
dance with the Aarhus Convention and therefore it incurred responsibility for
Albania’s internationally wrongful act. However, this interpretation would
have to consider the additional conditions under draft article 14. In particu-
lar, Albania’s act, namely, noncompliance with the Aarhus Convention, would
have constituted an internationally wrongful act if it had been committed by
the Bank. Because the Bank was not a party to the Aarhus Convention, it was
not under a legal obligation to comply with that convention.
Overall, the panel’s provisions seem to create a flexible framework to deal
with issues of concurrent responsibility, whereas the draft articles impose con-
ditions that, if applied in this context, might lead to the dismissal of many
requests for inspection.
The Requirement of Harm
The ILC has clari�ed that “as in the case of States, damage does not appear to
be an element necessary for international responsibility of an international or-
ganization to arise.�111 With respect to state responsibility, the ILC has noted:
It is sometimes said that international responsibility is not engaged
by conduct of a State in disregard of its obligations unless some fur-
ther element exists, in particular, “damage� to another State. But
whether such elements are required depends on the content of the
primary obligation, and there is no general rule in this respect.112
On the contrary, the panel’s resolution requires a request for inspection
to state “the harm suffered by or threatened to such party or parties by the
alleged action or omission of the Bank.�113 The party submitting a request is
required to prove the existence of harm and a causal link between the Bank’s
alleged failure to follow its policies and procedures and such harm.114 Harm
resulting from actions or omissions of parties other than the Bank (such as
109 Id., at paragraph 323.
110 Id., at paragraph 332.
111 ILC Report, at 54, paragraph (3).
112 Report of the International Law Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Third Session, supra
note 54, at 36, paragraph (3).
113 Resolution, paragraph 16.
114 Shihata, supra note 28, at 58.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 167
harm caused by the borrower alone) cannot be the subject of the panel’s
investigation.115
The regime of the Inspection Panel straddles the classic concept of responsi-
bility and the more dynamic concept of liability for transboundary environmen-
tal harm.116 On the one hand, for a case to be considered, there must be a viola-
tion of the Bank’s policies and procedures (the activity should be prohibited by
the rules of the organization). On the other hand, the activity should result—or
threaten to result—in harm to the affected party, since the primary obligation of
the Bank is to avoid or minimize harm that may afflict people and the environ-
ment as a result of its �nancing. This duality illustrates that the responsibility
under the panel regime is close to the idea of responsibility as conceived by the
ILC in the early years of its work on the topic of state responsibility.117
It is noteworthy that harm is a requirement even when an executive
director or board member submits a request.118 Harm is not only an eligibility
requirement when a request is brought by an affected party but a condition for
responsibility under the panel’s regime.
Consequently, the idea of responsibility as liability—which, as explained
by Crawford and Watkins, relates to the principles that determine the legal
115 Resolution, paragraph 14(a). There has been a feeling among Bank staff that the panel was
more concerned with the issue of harm, regardless of its cause, than with material harm re-
sulting from the Bank’s violation of its operational policies and procedures; see Shihata, supra
note 28, at 259.
116 This topic, which focuses on the consequences of the speci�c activities and not their lawful-
ness, is outside the scope of this chapter. Suf�ce it to point out that the concept of liability
for nonwrongful activities consists of four elements: (a) activities are not prohibited by inter-
national law; (b) activities involve a risk of causing signi�cant harm; (c) such harm must be
transboundary; and (d) the transboundary harm must be caused by such activities through
their physical consequences. In relation to this topic, the ILC produced draft articles on the
prevention of transboundary harm from hazardous activities and draft principles on the
allocation of loss in the case of transboundary harm arising out of hazardous activities. See
Report of the International Law Commission on the Work of Its Fifty-Third Session, supra
note 54, at 150–51, paragraphs (6)–(17). The ILC dealt only with the liability of states for
transboundary environmental harm and not international organizations, but nothing pre-
cludes a mutatis mutandis application. For more information on this topic, see Alan E. Boyle,
State Responsibility and International Liability for Injurious Consequences of Acts Not Prohibited by
International Law: A Necessary Distinction? 39 Intl. Comp. L. Quarterly 1 (1990), and Patricia
Birnie & Alan Boyle, International Law and the Environment 181–200 (2d ed., Oxford U. Press
2002).
117 The traditional understanding of responsibility included damage as a condition for respon-
sibility; see Pellet, supra note 9, at 9. However, certain commentators support the reintroduc-
tion of the requirement of damage; see Brigitte Stern, A Plea for “Reconstruction� of Interna-
tional Responsibility Based on the Notion of Legal Injury, in International Responsibility Today:
Essays in Memory of Oscar Schachter 93 (Maurizio Ragazzi ed., Martinus Nijhoff 2005).
118 The Board indirectly exercised this authority once, in a request regarding the China West-
ern Poverty Reduction Project. However, even in that instance, the request was initially
presented to the panel by an international NGO acting on behalf of people affected by
the project. See World Bank Inspection Panel, Accountability at the World Bank: The Inspec-
tion Panel 10 Years On 71–72 (2003), available at .
168 The World Bank Legal Review
consequences following from the violation of an international obligation—
requires an additional element, namely, the occurrence of or the risk of harm.
Responsibility as liability is contrasted to the idea of responsibility as answer-
ability, which is “at work at the point in the legal process before it has been
decided one way or another whether a breach of international law has taken
place� and “�nds expression, for example, in the rules that determine locus
standi and the admissibility of claims.�119
The primary rule applicable to the Bank, as simpli�ed, is “do no harm,�120
and for this reason, the requirement of the existence of harm or the threat of
harm in addition to a mere violation of the Bank’s policies and procedures
makes sense. Under this approach, harm is not only a requirement of stand-
ing but also an intrinsic element of responsibility under the Bank’s rules. Ac-
cordingly, the ILC’s position that the inclusion of damage as an element of
the internationally wrongful act depends on the primary rule is vindicated.
Moreover, this approach underlines the interdependence between primary
and secondary rules, irrespective of the fact that the rules may be captured in
distinct responsibility regimes in speci�c instances.
Remedies
Having examined the main elements of responsibility of international organi-
zations and the main requirements for an inspection under the panel’s legal
framework, what remain to be discussed are the consequences of assigning
responsibility under the two regimes.
The legal consequences of internationally wrongful acts of international
organizations are provided in part III of the draft articles. There are four basic
principles.
• The organization continues to have a duty to perform the obligation
breached (draft article 28).
• The organization must cease the internationally wrongful act and provide
guarantees of nonrepetition (draft article 29).
• The organization must make full reparation for the injury caused by the
internationally wrongful act (draft article 30). The draft articles further
specify that reparation can take the form of restitution, compensation, or
satisfaction (draft article 33).
• The organization may not rely on its rules as justi�cation for failure to
comply with the previous obligations (draft article 31).
119 “These rules organize the lines of international legal accountability, determining who is an-
swerable to whom, and in respect of what contact.� See James Crawford & Jeremy Watkins,
International Responsibility in The Philosophy of International Law 283, 284 (Samantha Besson &
John Tasioulas ed., Oxford U. Press 2010).
120 Shihata, supra note 28, at 241.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 169
The fundamental principle behind these provisions is that “reparation
must, so far as possible, wipe out all the consequences of the illegal act and
re-establish the situation that would, in all probability, have existed if that act
had not been committed.�121
Under the panel’s legal framework, once the investigation phase is com-
plete, the panel submits its �ndings through an investigation report to the
Board of Executive Directors of the Bank.122 Bank Management then submits
to the Board its report and recommendation in response to the panel’s �nd-
ings.123 The recommendations are intended to bring the project into compli-
ance with Bank policies and procedures. The Board meets to consider both
the panel’s investigation report and Management’s recommendations, and
decides whether to approve Management’s recommendations.
The panel’s process does not provide legal remedies per se. In other words,
resort to the panel does not by itself give affected people rights of redress from
the Bank, such as the right to seek �nancial compensation.124 However, the
panel’s process leads to the adoption of an action plan, which seeks to bring
the project into compliance with Bank policies and addresses related �ndings
of harm or potential harm. This action plan is developed in agreement with
the borrowing state and in consultation with the requesters.125 In that respect,
the panel does not make speci�c recommendations for actions that should be
taken by Management, which means that it does not provide speci�c rem-
edies. Rather, the result of the entire process is to reestablish the situation that
would, in all probability, have existed if the violation of the Bank’s policies
and procedures had not occurred. In addition, Bank Management is required
to monitor the implementation of the action plan.126 This could correspond to
the requirement under draft article 29, paragraph 2, that an international or-
ganization offer appropriate assurances and guarantees of nonrepetition after
the violation has ceased.
Overall, one could argue that the remedial regime under the panel’s le-
gal framework is consistent with the main principles of the draft articles, but
it is also in some ways distinct from the draft articles because of the Bank’s
speci�c supervisory role at various project cycle stages, including design, ap-
praisal, and implementation. Supervision rests with the Bank, whereas project
121 Factory at Chorzow, Jurisdiction, PCIJ Series A, No. 9 (1927), 47.
122 Resolution, at paragraph 22.
123 Id., at paragraph 23.
124 Shihata, supra note 28, at 240.
125 World Bank Inspection Panel, Accountability at the World Bank: The Inspection Panel at 15 Years
41 (2009), available at .
126 The Board may ask Management to subsequently submit progress reports either on imple-
mentation of the action plan or, more generally, on addressing panel �ndings on noncompli-
ance and harm; on a few occasions, it has requested the panel to take on a formal follow-up
role. Id., at 44.
170 The World Bank Legal Review
implementation is the responsibility of the borrowing state. Additionally, in all
these stages of project cycle, the Bank, as an international �nancial cooperative
institution, acts in cooperation with the borrowing state, including designing
and carrying out measures to address challenges related to compliance with
Bank policies and procedures that the panel may have unearthed in the course
of its investigations.
Conclusion
The creation of the Inspection Panel was seen as an opportunity to influence
the issue of an international organization’s responsibility.127 This prediction
never materialized. The “jurisprudence� of the Inspection Panel appears nei-
ther in the ILC’s commentary on the draft articles nor in any of the reports of
the special rapporteur.128 The ILC may have ignored the rules and jurispru-
dence of the Inspection Panel, but that does not mean that there is no relation
between the draft articles and the panel’s legal framework, which regulates
aspects of responsibility of the Bank. One could argue that the panel’s regime
constitutes lex specialis that, according to draft article 63, could preclude the
application of the remainder of the draft articles’ provisions.129 In addition,
this chapter has shown that the panel’s legal framework is broadly consistent
with the main principles of the draft articles.
Yet there are discrepancies between the panel and the draft articles re-
gimes. First, the panel’s resolution refers only to violations of the Bank’s poli-
cies and procedures—and the panel itself has been reluctant to explore the ob-
ligations of the Bank under international law, unless the obligation is anchored
in the Bank’s policies. Second, under the panel’s legal framework, evidence of
harm (in addition to a mere violation of Bank policy) is required for the ques-
tion of Bank responsibility to arise. The draft articles do not contain such a
127 Daniel D. Bradlow & Sabine Schlemmer-Schulte, The World Bank’s New Inspection Panel:
A Constructive Step in the Transformation of the International Legal Order, 54 ZaöRV 392, 409
(1994).
128 In his eighth report, the special rapporteur made reference to the West African Gas Pipe-
line Project, which was brought before the Inspection Panel; see Giorgio Gaja, special rap-
porteur, Eighth Report on Responsibility of International Organizations, at paragraph 46, footnote
43, UN Doc. A/CN.4/640 (Mar. 14, 2011). However, this reference is slightly misleading be-
cause it relates to the primary obligations of the World Bank, which fall outside the scope of
work of the ILC. In that respect, this reference does not alter our conclusion that the panel’s
“jurisprudence� was not taken into account in order to identify secondary rules, which
might have been developed by this accountability mechanism of the World Bank.
129 Draft article 63 provides:
These articles do not apply where and to the extent that the conditions for the
existence of an internationally wrongful act or the content or implementa-
tion of the international responsibility of an international organization, or a
State for an internationally wrongful act of an international organization, are
governed by special rules of international law, including rules of the organi-
zation applicable to the relations between the international organization and
its members.
International Organizations and the Inspection Panel 171
requirement. Third, the draft articles on the responsibility of international orga-
nizations in connection with acts of states appear to be inadequately equipped
to deal with the speci�c relationship between the Bank and a borrowing state
in the project cycle—the relationship that forms the basis of the panel’s legal
framework. Finally, the panel’s procedure leads to a remedy that is limited
to a Bank Management-proposed action plan to restore compliance with the
Bank’s policies and procedures. The draft articles have a much broader array
of remedies in their toolbox.
What could be the added value of the draft articles on the panel’s special
regime? According to Simma and Pulkowski, “added value� exists when “a
fallback on general international law is expedient to serve the purposes of the
special regime.�130 One area where the general law on responsibility might be
useful for the panel’s regime could be the provisions on the circumstances pre-
cluding wrongfulness. A situation could occur in which the Bank could invoke
necessity in order to justify its failure to comply with its rules.131
Moving beyond the comparison and interaction of the two regimes, there
remains a more fundamental issue. The draft articles are inadequate for an
institution like the World Bank. The law of responsibility is a constituent char-
acteristic of the international legal system, since ubi responsabilitas, ibi jus.132
The panel regime, on the contrary, is usually described as a compliance mech-
anism.133 However, because there is no forum to invoke claims of violations
of the Bank’s policies and there is uncertainty about the Bank’s international
obligations—with the exception of its obligation to respect peremptory norms
of international law and applicable rules of customary international law—the
panel’s regime is probably the “hardest� mechanism in existence for enforc-
ing, albeit indirectly, the Bank’s obligations under its internal rules.
In addition, the draft articles provide that only states or international or-
ganizations can invoke the responsibility of an international organization.134
To the contrary, the panel offers a mechanism through which the grievances of
individuals harmed by the Bank’s action or omission can be addressed.135
This leads to the same conclusion reached by Jean-Marc Sorel, namely, that
“the recognition of ‘soft responsibility’ remains a timely subject, particularly
130 Simma & Pulkowski, supra note 11, at 148.
131 The World Bank has supported the inclusion of necessity in the draft articles; see ILC,
Responsibility of International Organizations: Comments and Observations Received from
International Organizations, at 8, UN Doc. A/CN.4/568 (Mar. 17, 2006).
132 Pellet, supra note 9, at 1–2.
133 Laurence Boisson de Chazournes, Policy Guidance and Compliance: The World Bank Operational
Standards, in Commitment and Compliance: The Role of Non-binding Norms in the International
Legal System 281, 292 (Dinah Shelton ed., Oxford U. Press 2000).
134 See draft articles 42–49.
135 Under the law of responsibility, the grievances of the individual can be vindicated only
through the exercise of diplomatic protection; see Kingsbury, supra note 84, at 327.
172 The World Bank Legal Review
regarding the legal framework that needs to be created for the implementation
of the responsibility of international organizations.�136 This conclusion is all
the more important for an international organization, such as the Bank, that
is concerned not only with its legal accountability but equally—if not more—
with its public reputational accountability.137
136 Jean-Marc Sorel, The Concept of “Soft Responsibility�? in The Law of International Responsibil-
ity 165, 171 (James Crawford, Alain Pellet, & Simon Olleson ed., Oxford U. Press 2010). The
inef�ciency of a hard law of responsibility for international organizations is stressed by Ian
Johnstone, who notes that “one of the concerns about the rulings of the European Court of
Human Rights in Behrami and Saramati is that, by attributing responsibility for the acts com-
mitted by peacekeepers to the United Nations and NATO (as opposed to the States contrib-
uting to the operations), the remedies available to the complainants are limited.� Johnstone,
supra note 46, at 237.
137 According to Grant and Keohane, “the category of public reputational accountability is
meant to apply to situations in which reputation, widely and publicly known, provides a
mechanism for accountability even in the absence of other mechanisms as well as in conjunc-
tion with them,� whereas “[l]egal accountability refers to the requirement that agents abide by
formal rules and be prepared to justify their actions in those terms, in courts or quasi-judicial
arenas.� See Ruth W. Grant & Robert O. Keohane, Accountability and Abuses of Power in World
Politics, 99 Am. Pol. Sci. Rev. 29, 36–37 (2005).
Partnerships, Emulation,
and Coordination
Toward the Emergence of a Droit Commun
in the Field of Development Finance
LAURENCE BOISSON DE CHAZOURNES
Cooperation among international organizations has developed in various
ways. The need for cooperation was foreseen at their inception and is re-
flected in their constitutive agreements. The articles of the International Bank
for Reconstruction and Development (IBRD), for example, state that “the
Bank, within the terms of this Agreement, shall cooperate with any general
international organization and with public organizations having specialized
responsibilities in related �elds.�1 An example in this context of such means
for cooperation is the agreement that the IBRD concluded with the United
Nations (UN) in 1947.2
In addition to this type of cooperative relationship, the IBRD and the other
institutions of the World Bank Group3 (hereinafter, the “World Bank�) have
developed relationships with regional development banks. This chapter fo-
cuses on these relationships and the legal consequences that arise from them.
Because of the institutional features that the World Bank and regional devel-
opment banks have in common (for example, their capital-based structure and
their mandate),4 there is sometimes an emulation phenomenon in their legal
1 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section 8(a), adopted at Bretton Woods, July 22, 1944,
2 U.N.T.S. 135 (1944) as amended February 16, 1989; amended version available at .
2 Agreement between the United Nations and the International Bank for Reconstruction and
Development, 16 U.N.T.S. 346 (1947) (entered into force on Nov. 15, 1947).
3 The International Bank for Reconstruction and Development was established in July 1944 at
the Monetary and Financial Conference at Bretton Woods. Since then, four other institutions
have been established: the International Finance Corporation (IFC) in 1956, the International
Development Association (IDA) in 1960, the International Centre for the Settlement of In-
vestment Disputes (ICSID) in 1966, and the Multilateral Investment Guarantee (MIGA) in
1988. These �ve institutions form the World Bank Group.
4 The IBRD Articles of Agreement, for example, contain a provision that states that “the Bank
and its of�cers shall not interfere in the political affairs of any member; nor shall they be in-
fluenced in their decisions by the political character of the member or members concerned�
(Article IV, Section 10); see also IDA Articles of Agreement, which contain an identical pro-
vision (Article V, Section 6). Almost identical provisions are contained in the Agreement
Establishing the Inter-American Development Bank (Article VIII, paragraph 5[f], the Articles
of Agreement of the Asian Development Bank (Chapter VI, Article 36), and the Agreement
Establishing the African Development Bank (Chapter V, Article 38), as mentioned by Ste-
phen S. Zimmermann & Frank A. Fariello Jr., Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corrup-
tion: Agreement on Cross-Debarment among Multilateral Development Banks, this volume. 173
174 The World Bank Legal Review
and institutional practices. By emulation, what is meant is that the regional
development banks emulate the policies, rules, and procedures in place at the
World Bank. Emulation may also more broadly refer to the willingness of these
regional organizations to put into place procedures framed around similar
policies and rules, although the latter may present speci�c features. In some
instances, this process can be multidirectional, with the World Bank and other
regional �nancial institutions emulating the practice followed by a regional
institution. These various practices often give rise to a harmonization trend
around a standard, a policy, or a rule �rst developed by one of the concerned
organizations. In some cases, this trend is complemented by organized coor-
dination around common procedures. Based on this emulation phenomenon
and the harmonization and coordination endeavors, one might wonder if a
droit commun in the area of development �nance is emerging.
In the context of this chapter, the notion of a droit commun is de�ned as a
process through which various organizations develop and implement similar
standards, rules, or procedures. A droit commun allows for the emergence of a
distinct legal corpus of the harmonized standards, rules, and procedures that
the institutions have in common.
The emergence of droit commun indicates that international �nancial in-
stitutions (IFIs) and other actors feel the need to use policy instruments and
a legal language presenting similar features in areas of common concern. Al-
though efforts to obtain greater market share might be a reason for replicating
the normative and institutional features of another institution and thus attract
more interest, the need for increased cooperation and partnerships among
these institutions appears to be a key driver in this direction. Decision makers
in groups such as the Group of Seven (G7), Group of Eight (G8), and Group
of Twenty (G20), or within the executive organs of �nancial institutions, often
advocate the promotion of similar objectives, such as transparency and ac-
countability by all concerned institutions.5 Civil society is also moving in this
direction through domestic and transnational strategies.
These trends do not follow from rules laid down in the articles of agree-
ment of the concerned institutions, but rather are developed from practice and
necessity. The institutions are involved in similar types of business activities,
that is, development �nance and assistance, and thus face similar challenges,
such as the promotion of sustainable development.
It should also be stressed that the emulation of the World Bank’s practices
by regional development banks is in part due to the gravitational force of the
World Bank and the links that exist between the regional banks and the World
5 See, for example, the Anti-Corruption Action Plan issued in November 2010 by the G20 Seoul
Summit, which states that “the G20 will exercise its voice in the governance of international
organizations to encourage that they operate with transparency, high ethical standards, ef-
fective internal safeguards and the highest standard of integrity. To that end, we call for
continued dialogue among international organizations and national authorities on de�ning
good practices and ways forward on this objective�; available at .
Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination 175
Bank. The World Bank’s gravitational force can be explained by the fact that
the Bank was established earlier than the other institutions,6 as well as by its
size and �nancial power. The representative power of the World Bank is also
partly attributable to the desire of regional development banks to use the World
Bank as a proxy for access to forums such as the G8 and the G20. For example,
the ten international organizations that were invited to the G20 Seoul Summit
in November 2010 (the African Union, the Association of Southeast Asian Na-
tions, the Financial Stability Board, the International Labour Organization, the
International Monetary Fund [IMF], the New Partnership for Africa’s Devel-
opment, the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development, the
United Nations, the World Bank Group, and the World Trade Organization)
did not include one regional �nancial institution.7 The emulative process is
therefore based, not on any formal or informal hierarchy between the institu-
tions, but simply on political and economic dynamics.
This emulation and these cooperative and coordination processes have
led to harmonization and mutual recognition, thereby cultivating the devel-
opment of common practices in both normative and institutional terms. Three
examples are discussed in this chapter. Before addressing them, the chapter
presents the various types of partnerships that may develop among these in-
stitutions; partnerships that help forge an increasingly close relationship be-
tween the World Bank and regional development banks.
Partnerships among IFIs
Partnerships among IFIs are manifold. IFIs may receive logistical, material,
or �nancial aid from each other in order to carry out their activities. Some-
times, these institutions participate in discussions and negotiations held in
their respective forums. On other occasions, they put into place institutional
partnerships aimed at the implementation of a certain activity or the pursuit
of a given objective.
Partnerships between international organizations have blossomed in the
�eld of environmental protection and, more generally, in the area of sustain-
able development. For instance, Agenda 21, the action plan adopted in 1992
6 The World Bank was created at the Bretton Woods Conference in 1944. Four other institutions
are examined in this chapter. The Inter-American Development Bank (IDB) was established
in 1959. It has 48 member countries, including 26 Latin American and Caribbean borrowing
members. The African Development Bank (AfDB) was founded in 1964. It is composed of 77
member countries; 53 are African countries and 24 are non-African countries. The Asian De-
velopment Bank (ADB) was established in 1966 and is composed of 67 members, of which 48
are from the region and 19 are from other parts of the globe. The European Bank for Recon-
struction and Development (EBRD) was established in 1991. It is composed of 61 member
countries, of which 16 are non-European countries, the European Union, and the European
Investment Bank.
7 See .
176 The World Bank Legal Review
during the UN Conference on the Environment and Development, calls on
several actors—namely, the United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP),
the World Bank, and regional development banks—to establish programs and
take action for the promotion of developing countries’ capacities in environ-
mental protection.8 Within this framework, some of these institutions may
rely on other organizations for carrying out activities in the �eld. The primary
goal of such partnerships is to enhance the overall effectiveness of operations
jointly managed by them.
The Global Environment Facility (GEF) constitutes another type of part-
nership.9 Established in 1991 and restructured in 1994 with the World Bank, the
United Nations Development Programme, and UNEP as implementing agen-
cies, it provides �nancing to developing countries for projects dealing with
the protection of the global environment (including, inter alia, climate change
and biodiversity issues). Moreover, institutions such as the African Develop-
ment Bank (AfDB), the Asian Development Bank (ADB), the European Bank
for Reconstruction and Development (ERDB), and the Inter-American Devel-
opment Bank (IDB) have also been given the option of acting as executing
agencies and thus being directly involved with projects of the GEF.
Crucial to these initiatives and, more generally, to the relations between
international organizations is the issue of �nancing. The granting of �nancial
aid by one organization to another may be foreseen in treaty provisions or in
other types of legal instruments.10 Such assistance is intended to strengthen an
organization and to provide guaranteed support for its activity.
In this context, it is interesting to recall that the statute of the International
Development Agency (IDA), a member of the World Bank Group, provides:
The Association shall not provide �nancing for any project if the
member in whose territories the project is located objects to such
�nancing, except that it shall not be necessary for the Association
to assure itself that individual members do not object in the case
of �nancing provided to a public international or regional
organization.11
8 See Agenda 21, Chapter 37.11.
9 See Laurence Boisson de Chazournes, The Global Environment Facility Galaxy: On Linkages
among Institutions, 3 Max Planck United Nations Y.B. 243 (1999); and Laurence Boisson de
Chazournes, The Global Environment Facility (GEF): A Unique and Crucial Institution, 14(3) Rev.
European Community & Intl. Envl. L. 193 (2005).
10 See, for example, the European Development Fund; Council Regulation (EC) No. 617/2007
of May 14, 2007, on the implementation of the 10th European Development Fund under the
ACP-EC Partnership Agreement, JO L 152/1, June 13, 2007.
11 IDA Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section 1(e), available at .
Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination 177
On this basis, the IDA has granted loans at privileged rates to the West Af-
rican Development Bank (WADB) and to the Caribbean Development Bank.12
In 2004, the World Bank approved a �nancing plan in favor of the WADB
as part of the project for market integration among West African countries
engaged in by the West African Economic and Monetary Union (WAEMU).
Some World Bank �nancing has been aimed at consolidating the WADB’s po-
sition as a regional player, transforming it into an institution capable of inde-
pendently acquiring its own resources.
In addition to the above-mentioned types of partnerships, IFIs have un-
dertaken further forms of multilateral collaboration, such as the Heavily In-
debted Poor Countries (HIPC) Initiative, set up by the IMF and the World
Bank in 1996 and aimed at avoiding situations in which poor countries may be
faced with an unsustainable debt.13 In 2005, the objectives of the HIPC were re-
iterated through the creation of the Multilateral Debt Relief Initiative (MDRI),
a G8-promoted initiative taken in view of the UN Millennium Development
Goals.14
The objective of the MDRI is the cancellation of 100 percent of the claims of
three multilateral institutions—the IMF, the IDA, and the AfDB—on countries
that have reached, or will reach, the completion point under the enhanced
HIPC Initiative. This initiative is managed through a fully fledged partner-
ship between the three international organizations. In 2007, the IDB joined
the MDRI and then to canceled the debt of �ve Latin American countries.
Partnerships of this type entail close cooperation among the organiza-
tions, and some pragmatism is necessary for meeting the desired operational
objectives. The same is true when IFIs co�nance projects. There is a need to
�nd a common approach in the appraisal and monitoring of a project.15 The
search for consistency among social and environmental policies helps direct
this common approach.
The quest for effectiveness is central to the effort to achieve mutual col-
laboration among IFIs. This quest has given rise to various types of emulative
practices by IFIs and caused these institutions to forge new forms of institu-
tional and normative relationships.
12 See Ibrahim F. I. Shihata, The World Bank Legal Papers 812 (Kluwer Law International 2000).
13 See Leonie F. Guder, The Administration of Debt Relief by the International Financial Institutions:
A Legal Reconstruction of the HIPC Initiative (Springer 2009).
14 For more details, see .
15 See EBRD, Environmental and Social Policy paragraph 10 (May 12, 2008), available at .
178 The World Bank Legal Review
Emulation in the Harmonization of Operational Policies
and Procedures
Emulation may take the form of a harmonization of operational policies and
procedures. Regional development banks have adopted certain rules and pro-
cedures that had earlier been developed and adopted by the World Bank.16
One example is social and environmental policies adopted by the World Bank
that are intended to apply to operational activities. These policies, called
“safeguard policies,� are a set of rules and procedures that must be followed
by personnel of the World Bank in the design, implementation, and monitor-
ing of projects by the Bank. Such operational policies are important tools. By
requiring an environmental assessment of projects, consultation with affected
communities, the publication of information, compensation for any impact,
and the restoration of the living environment or biodiversity protection, safe-
guard policies reduce the negative impacts of projects funded by the Bank.17
The adoption of safeguard policies by the World Bank in the 1990s and
their subsequent revision have given rise to the adoption of operational
rules by regional development banks. Regional banks have developed pol-
icies providing for similar standards of behavior in the areas of impact as-
sessment and the protection of indigenous populations.18 For example, the
ADB adopted bank policies in the �eld of environmental protection; these
policies are included in its operations manual.19 In a recent review of its safe-
guard policies, the ADB took account of other �nancial institutions’ social
and environmental policies so to ensure that its policies are consistent with
those of the World Bank Group and also those of regional institutions.20 The
fact that the ADB was involved in co�nancing projects with these institutions
was stressed as a reason for this harmonization process.
Similarly, the IDB developed a series of social and environmental policies
in line with the World Bank’s approach. Taking into account the widespread
recognition of the rights of indigenous people in different countries’ constitu-
tional and legislative acts, as well as the international practice of international
�nancial and donor institutions, the IDB adopted the Operational Policy on
Indigenous Peoples and Strategy for Indigenous Development (OP-765) in
16 On the influence of the World Bank in this area, see David Hunter, Civil Society Networks and
the Development of Environmental Standards at International Financial Institutions, 8 Chi. J. Intl.
L. 437, 442 (2008).
17 Laurence Boisson de Chazournes, Policy Guidance and Compliance Issues: The World Bank
Operational Standards, in Commitment and Compliance—The Role of Non Binding Norms in the
International Legal System 281 (Dinah Shelton ed., Oxford U. Press 2000).
18 Benedict Kingsbury, Operational Policies of International Institutions as Part of the Law-Making
Process: The World Bank and Indigenous People, in The Reality of International Law Essays in Hon-
our of Ian Brownlie 323 (Guy S. Goodwin-Gill and Stefan Talmon ed., Clarendon Press 1999).
19 Available at .
20 ADB, Policy Paper: Safeguard Policy Statement (June 2009), available at .
Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination 179
February 2006.21 Regarding the phenomenon of emulation, it is interesting to
note that the Pro�le of the Operational Policy on Indigenous Peoples (March
2004), approved by the Policy Committee and the Assessment Council of the
IDB, indicated that
many international �nancial institutions including the World Bank
Group, the Asian Development Bank, the European Commission as
well as bilateral donors and the private sector, have adopted speci�c
safeguard policies regarding indigenous peoples.22
The EBRD undertook a review of many of its policies and strategies, and
in May 2008, the EBRD board of directors approved the revision of the Envi-
ronment Policy of 2003 into an Environment and Social Policy,23 more in line
with challenges in terms of protecting the global environment and with the
policies of other �nancial institutions.
It is noteworthy that at the level of the United Nations, the need for a
systemwide strategy for environmental and social safeguards has been identi-
�ed. There is agreement that a common framework would build con�dence
through cooperation and the sharing of resources and would make the imple-
mentation of safeguards easier.24
These developments underline the emergence of common practices in the
international �nancing of development projects. Regional development banks’
emulation of World Bank approaches to issues of environmental and social
protection, even if they retain some aspects of each regional bank’s identity
in their precise formulation and sometimes differ in their scope, has led to the
emergence of common normative practices among IFIs operating in the �eld of
environmental and social protection. These harmonized practices constitute a
�rst step toward the emergence of a droit commun. The policies adopted by the
regional development banks may present some speci�c features. This is in great
part due to the fact that these institutions �nance both public and private sector
projects, a fact that their rules and practices need to take into account.
Institutional Emulation
Institutional emulation refers to situations in which regional development
banks establish bodies and mechanisms similar to those set up within
the World Bank. In this context, the most illustrative example of institutional
emulation is the establishment of independent inspection and compliance
21 Available at .
22 Available at .
23 Available at .
24 See UNEP, Environment Management Group, Drafting Group on Environmental and So-
cial Safeguards, Progress Report on Options for a System-Wide Approach to Environmen-
tal and Social Safeguards (Feb. 2011), available at .
180 The World Bank Legal Review
mechanisms. These mechanisms respond to the demand for more transpar-
ency on the part of �nancial institutions and the call for them to be more ac-
countable.
In September 1993, the directors of the World Bank created an indepen-
dent inspection panel to ensure that the Bank meets its own operational poli-
cies and procedures during the design, preparation, and implementation of
projects. Any group of individuals whose rights or interests are affected or
likely to be affected as a result of a failure by the World Bank to follow its
operational policies and procedures with respect to a project may institute a
request with the inspection panel alleging that the institution has not com-
plied with its operational or procedural policies. The directors then decide,
on the basis of recommendations put forward by the panel, whether or not to
proceed with an inspection.25
Building on the experience of the World Bank Inspection Panel, reg-
ional development banks put into place similar types of accountability mecha-
nisms. Each of these mechanisms is different in its structure, procedure, and
practice.26 Yet all the banks are participating in broader efforts to render IFIs
more accountable and more participatory.27 The IDB was the �rst institution
to follow the example of the World Bank Inspection Panel with the creation,
in 1994, of an independent investigation mechanism. This mechanism was re-
vised in 2010 and became the “independent consultation and investigation
mechanism.�28 Similarly, the ADB revised its inspection procedure, originally
set up in 1995, in 2003. The new procedure is based on an accountability mech-
anism comprising a consultation phase and an inspection phase administered
by a compliance review panel.29
The AfDB established an independent review mechanism in June 2004.
The mechanism includes aspects of monitoring and compliance with policies
as well as mediation (problem solving) for projects in the public and private
sectors.30
25 Laurence Boisson de Chazournes, The World Bank Inspection Panel: About Public Participa-
tion and Dispute Settlement, in Civil Society, International Courts and Compliance Bodies 187, 198
(Tulio Treves et al. ed., T. M. C. Asser Press 2005).
26 Daniel Bradlow, Private Complainants and International Organizations: A Comparative Study of
the Independent Inspection Mechanisms in International Financial Institutions, 36 Geo. J. Intl. L.
403 (2005).
27 World Bank Inspection Panel, Accountability at the World Bank: The Inspection Panel at 15
Years (2009), available at .
28 See IDB, Policy Establishing the Independent Consultation and Investigation Mechanism (Feb. 17,
2010), available at .
29 In May 2010, the ADB announced a review of the mechanism. See ADB, Review of the
Accountability Mechanism Policy (April 2011), available at .
30 Available at .
Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination 181
Mention should also be made of the project complaint mechanism estab-
lished by the EBRD in 2010 to replace the independent recourse mechanism
of 2004.31
Finally, the Of�ce of the Compliance Advisor/Ombudsman (CAO), es-
tablished in 1999 by the International Finance Corporation (IFC), was the �rst
mechanism to comprise a two-phase approach: a consultation phase, which in-
volves an ombudsman or an adviser, and a compliance review phase.32 Other
IFIs, such as the ADB, subsequently implemented a two-phase approach.33
Even though each of these mechanisms has its own distinctive features,
they were all created in the same spirit and with the same objectives as the
World Bank Inspection Panel, that is, to increase the transparency and ac-
countability of the organizations that established them. In other words, the
establishment of the World Bank Inspection Panel initiated a movement in
favor of the creation of such kinds of mechanisms and procedures.
The degree of cooperation and harmonization among these mechanisms
is demonstrated by the relationships between them and how they interact in
practice.
The existence of inspection panels and compliance mechanisms in devel-
opment banks can lead to these panels and mechanisms being seized at the
same time as those of the World Bank in connection with projects that are co�-
nanced by the World Bank and a regional development bank. Coordination in
such instances can lead to further harmonization practices. One such situation
arose during the inspection request concerning the Yacyreta Hydroelectric
Project in Argentina and Paraguay. The World Bank Inspection Panel stated:
it may be noted that a Request for Inspection relating to the same
Project had been simultaneously �led with the IDB inspection mech-
anism. The President of that institution recommended and the Board
of Executive Directors likewise agreed to a review of the project un-
der similar terms of reference. Collaboration with the IDB inspection
mechanism included a joint visit to the project area in July 1997 as
well as an exchange of views on the main �ndings.34
In his report on this matter, the chairman of the Organization, Human
Resources and Board Matters Committee of the IDB Board of Executive
Directors said that
31 Available at .
32 Available at .
33 Id.
34 Memorandum to the Executive Directors and Alternates, Request for Inspection—Argentina/
Paraguay: Yacyretá Hydroelectric Project—Panel Review and Assessment, IPN Request RQ96/2,
at paragraph 2 (Sep. 16, 1997), available at .
182 The World Bank Legal Review
in light of the Bank’s interest in harmonizing its efforts with those of
its co-lender, the World Bank, the Board also instructed Management
to report on any measures taken with respect to this project by the
World Bank.35
As one can see, a desire to harmonize institutional practices is clearly a prior-
ity for both institutions.
The inspection request concerning the Bujagali Hydropower Project in
Uganda also shows cooperation between two multilateral development banks.
The project, co�nanced by the World Bank and the AfDB, was brought before
the inspection mechanisms of both institutions.36 The Bujagali project, the �rst
case brought before the inspection mechanism of the AfDB, laid the founda-
tion for cooperation between that institution and the World Bank. The World
Bank Inspection Panel underlined “its appreciation to the CRMU [Compli-
ance Review and Mediation Unit] for this fruitful and precedent-setting
cooperation.�37
Meanwhile, in its investigation report, the AfDB panel stated:
The Compliance Review Panel and the World Bank Inspection Panel
coordinated their �eld investigations of the Bujagali projects and
shared consultants and technical information during this investiga-
tion in order to enhance the ef�ciency and cost effectiveness of each
of their investigations.38
The World Bank Inspection Panel and the AfDB panel agreed to a memo-
randum of understanding to de�ne the conditions for their cooperation and
information exchange regarding the project.39
35 Available at .
36 The AfDB, the World Bank, and other donors �nance the Bujagali Hydropower Proj-
ect, while the African Development Fund and the Japan Bank for International Co-
operation �nanced the Bujagali Interconnection Project. World Bank Inspection Panel
Investigation Report No. 44977-UG, Uganda: Private Power Generation (Bujagali) Project
(Guarantee n° B0130-UG) (Aug. 29, 2008), available at .
37 Id., at xix.
38 AfDB Independent Review Panel, Compliance Review Report on the Bujagali Hydro-
power and Interconnection Projects (Jun. 20, 2008), available at .
39 See Memorandum of Understanding, The World Bank Inspection Panel and the Compliance
Review and Mediation Unit of the African Development Bank (Nov. 28, 2007) in World Bank
Inspection Panel, supra note 27, at 214–16.
Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination 183
The 2005 Paris Declaration on Aid Effectiveness further supported this
harmonization trend.40 This declaration highlights the need to, inter alia, im-
plement common arrangements, increase complementarity, and strengthen
incentives for collaborative behavior. The donors committed to harmonizing
standards in order to increase the effectiveness of aid programs41—legal har-
monization is undoubtedly one way to avoid duplication.42
In this context, the Legal Harmonization Initiative (LHI) is a step in this
direction. It is a joint undertaking of several IFIs, including the World Bank,
regional �nancial institutions, bilateral aid agencies, and UN agencies, in sup-
port of the implementation of commitments expressed in the Paris Declara-
tion to improve aid effectiveness through harmonization and alignment. The
LHI is aimed at harmonizing and streamlining legal tools among donors and
partner countries. It is conceived of as a forum for legal, operational, and pol-
icy advisers to discuss and share knowledge across institutions on legal and
policy issues relevant to the harmonization and alignment agenda.43
Cooperation and Coordination in the Fight
against Corruption
Another step in terms of cooperative practices among institutions has been
the establishment of mechanisms for cooperation and mutual recognition be-
tween the World Bank and regional development banks. In the �ght against
corruption, the actions undertaken and policies adopted by the World Bank
and the regional development banks have inspired cooperation. In this re-
spect, in September 2006, the Uniform Framework for Preventing and Com-
bating Fraud and Corruption was put into place by the leaders of the AfDB
Group, the ADB, the EBRD, the EIB Group, the IMF, the IDB, and the World
Bank Group.44 The uniform framework has two main components: the adop-
tion of common de�nitions of fraud and corruption and the development of
common investigatory principles. It was developed by the International Fi-
nancial Institutions Anti-Corruption Task Force.45 The goal of the task force
40 Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD), the Paris Declaration on
Aid Effectiveness (2005), and the Accra Agenda for Action (2008), available at . The international organizations adhering to the
Paris Declaration and the Accra Agenda for Action include the World Bank, the IDB, the
ADB, the AfDB, the EBRD, and the EIB.
41 OECD, Summary—Paris Declaration, available at .
42 See also Working Party on Aid Effectiveness, Aid Effectiveness: A Progress Report on
Implementing the Paris Declaration (2008), available at .
43 Additional information is available at .
44 Available at .
45 The IFI task force was established to develop the framework and was afterward
disbanded.
184 The World Bank Legal Review
was to work toward developing a coherent and harmonized strategy in the
�ght against corruption in respect to the activities and operations of partici-
pating regional and universal �nancial institutions.
Each member institution of the IFI task force has a distinct mechanism for
addressing and sanctioning violations of its anticorruption policies. The task
force laid the groundwork for the mutual recognition of decisions made by
each of the enforcement mechanisms. Similarly, the IFI task force recommend-
ed that each participating institution require that all bidders taking part in the
activities �nanced by a participating institution disclose any penalty imposed
on a corporation or an individual by a participating institution, although this
recommendation was not put into practice. The task force adopted principles
and guidelines for investigations46 applicable to the integrity of�ces of the IFIs
when executing their investigative mandate.
An additional step was taken by ensuring the mutual recognition and en-
forcement of decisions made by competent bodies within these institutions.47
The AfDB Group, the ADB, the EBRD, the IDB Group, and the World Bank
Group af�rmed their mutual commitment to implementing each other’s deci-
sions in an agreement concluded on April 9, 2010.48 The agreement states:
1. Each Participating Institution will enforce debarment decisions
made by another Participating Institution, in accordance with the
terms and conditions of this Agreement.
To this end, the concerned institutions—having undertaken, under the uni-
�ed framework in 2006, to adopt harmonized de�nitions of sanctionable prac-
tices and to establish investigation procedures that meet common due process
principles to conduct fair, impartial, and thorough investigations49—agreed to
implement decisions made by each of them, except in circumstances “where
such enforcement would be inconsistent with the institution’s legal or other
institutional considerations.�50 The enforcement of the decisions is subject to
the conditions that
a) the decision was based, in whole or in part, on a �nding of a com-
mission of one or more of the sanctionable practices de�ned in the
Uniform Framework;
b) the decision is made public by the Sanctioning Institution;
c) the initial period of debarment exceeds one year;
46 See supra note 44.
47 A common debarment regime in the form of a joint sanctions board, as advocated by the
World Bank, did not get off the ground. It was argued that it would facilitate a uni�ed
approach. Zimmermann & Fariello, supra note 4.
48 Agreement for Mutual Enforcement of Debarment Decisions (Apr. 9, 2009), available at
.
49 Id., at paragraph 2(b).
50 Id., at paragraph 7.
Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination 185
d) the decision was made after this Agreement has entered into force
with respect to the Sanctioning Institution;
e) the decision by the Sanctioning Institution was made within ten
years of the date of commission of the sanctionable practice; and
f) the decision of the Sanctioning Institution was not made in re-
cognition of a decision made in a national or other international
forum.51
Although each organization generally carries out its own investigation,
in some cases, an organization may need to share information with another
one. In fact, �nancial institutions share information routinely on matters of
common interest, such as in cases of co�nanced projects. In this context, rather
than duplicating efforts through parallel investigations, the institutions may
coordinate investigations or one �nancial institution may take the lead in an
investigation.52 These situations, as well as the cross-debarment regime itself,
call for enhancing common approaches such as the harmonization of policies
and practices in relation to sanctions.53 This harmonization aspect has not yet
taken shape, although discussions are currently taking place.54
The adoption of harmonized de�nitions and investigation procedures that
meet common due process principles coupled with a system of mutual recog-
nition and enforcement is seen by the different development banks as helping
win the battle against corruption. In the end, this trend may lead to an even
more inclusive harmonization of anticorruption safeguards;55 that is, although
each institution maintains its own rules, the essential elements of these rules
are fundamentally the same and pursue the same objective. This trend will
also simplify and enhance cooperation among the institutions in the suppres-
sion of corruption.
The Development of a Droit Commun in the Field
of Development Finance
The practices that have been identi�ed in this chapter relate to situations that
were not envisaged when the IFIs were created. The World Bank, because of
its political and economic status, has played an influential role in the forma-
tion and dissemination of many of these common practices; the other IFIs have
contributed to the elaboration of the practices. The resulting emulation effects
51 Id., at paragraph 4.
52 See World Bank Group, The World Bank Group: Mutual Enforcement of Debarment Decisions
among Multilateral Development Banks 3, paragraph 9 (Mar. 3, 2010), available at .
53 Zimmermann & Fariello, supra note 4.
54 Id.
55 Due to differences among �nancial institutions, as for example with respect to the nature of
sanctions, a trend toward the adoption of common rules is unlikely in the short term. Id.
186 The World Bank Legal Review
have led to harmonization practices among these institutions. They have
adopted similar standards. Rules on mutual recognition and on the enforce-
ment of decisions are also appearing. All these actions promote the emergence
of a droit commun in the �eld of development �nance.
This common body of law includes procedures of conformity with the
various standards and practices that are put into place. Although differentia-
tion and re�nement by individual organizations might occur, a new body of
law common to all such institutions is emerging. These converging trends are
reinforced through meetings of the legal advisers or compliance of�cers of the
various IFIs that allow for exchanges on respective practices. Insights can be
drawn and practical problems can be solved in the context of these networks.
The same can be said about electronic exchanges, which allow for comments
from the various partners. These various elements contribute to the elabora-
tion of a common legal and policy language among �nancial institutions.
The legal consequences of this emerging body of law remain to be as-
sessed. Once rules and standards have been harmonized, their respective in-
terpretation, albeit decentralized and in the hands of each institution, will be
informed by the others’ interpretative approaches. In terms of enforcement
measures, procedures such as those of mutual recognition and enforcement in
the �ght against corruption are but one step in the direction of a common ac-
tion. The same can be said about the cooperative arrangements put into place
by the inspection and compliance mechanisms with respect to information
exchange and collaborative practices.
In a decentralized system, the various practices bear witness to the close
links that have been established between the various institutions. Such prac-
tices are remarkable, and their importance should not be lessened by assessing
them in the light of the establishment or the nonestablishment of joint bodies.
The existence of joint bodies is intrinsically dependent on the willingness of
the member states and organizations to move toward greater political integra-
tion. Another avenue can be one institution granting competence to an organ
of another institution. The Administrative Tribunal of the International Labor
Organization, which by its statute allows other international organizations to
recognize its jurisdiction, is an example of this phenomenon.56 This opens up
another path toward the emergence of a droit commun in this area that could
be further explored.
Various types of relationships have developed between IFIs. The relations
between these organizations are forged in a variety of ways both for the sake
of better cooperation and as a matter of pragmatism and ef�ciency. The new
legal practices and rules form part of an emerging corpus juris that interacts
56 At the 32d session of the International Labour Conference in 1949, Article II of the Statute
of the ILO Tribunal was amended to permit other international organizations approved by
the ILO’s governing body to recognize the jurisdiction of the tribunal. See .
Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination 187
with, and bene�ts from,57 the emergence of the global administrative law ap-
proach, especially from the principles of transparency, public participation,
and accountability.58 These principles provide the basis for, and ground the
legitimacy of, the decision-making and implementation processes of rules and
procedures developed through emulation and coordination.
57 For a similar opinion, see Pascale Hélène Dubois & Aileen Elizabeth Nowlan, Global Ad-
ministrative Law and the Legitimacy of Sanctions Regimes in International Law, 36 Yale J. Intl.
L. Online 15 (2010), available at .
58 On these principles see Symposium, Global Administrative Law in the Operations of International
Organizations (Laurence Boisson de Chazournes, Lorenzo Casini, & Benedict Kingsbury ed.),
6 Intl Organizations L. Rev. 315 (2009).
Coordinating the Fight
against Fraud and Corruption
Agreement on Cross-Debarment among
Multilateral Development Banks
STEPHEN S. ZIMMERMANN AND FRANK A. FARIELLO, JR.*
The �ght against fraud and corruption took a major step forward in April 2010
when the heads of �ve leading multilateral development banks (MDBs)—the
African Development Bank Group1 (AfDB), the Asian Development Bank
(ADB), the European Bank for Reconstruction and Development (EBRD),
the Inter-American Development Bank Group2 (IDB), and the World Bank
Group3—signed the Agreement for Mutual Enforcement of Debarment Deci-
sions. As of this writing (August 2011), the agreement has become effective for
four of the �ve signatories—ADB, EBRD, IDB, and the World Bank Group—
after they put into place the required changes to their respective policies and
procedures. It is anticipated that AfDB will be in a position to begin imple-
mentation of the agreement by the end of 2011.
This chapter examines the policy rationale behind the agreement, the his-
tory that led up to it, its principal provisions, and some key issues and chal-
lenges faced by MDBs in crafting the agreement. The chapter concludes by
looking at the prospects for deeper and wider harmonization in the near- to
medium-term future.
In principle, aggressively tackling fraud and corruption in development
projects should be a central part of the common agenda of MDBs. The “cancer
of corruption� undermines efforts to combat poverty and wastes the scarce
resources of the international aid community. But until relatively recently,
a number of obstacles had made it dif�cult for international organizations
to move forward. For many years, corruption was seen as primarily, if not
exclusively, a political problem with little or no relevance to economic devel-
opment. Moreover, work on corruption was felt to contravene the so-called
*
The authors would like to thank Roman Majtan, LEG consultant, for his valuable assistance
in the preparation of this article.
1 The African Development Bank Group consists of the African Development Bank, the
African Development Fund, and the Nigeria Trust Fund.
2 The Inter-American Bank Group consists of the Inter-American Development Bank, the
Inter-American Investment Corporation, and the Multilateral Investment Fund.
3 In this article, the term “World Bank Group� means, collectively, the International Bank for
Research and Development (IBRD), the International Development Association (IDA), the
International Finance Corporation (IFC), and the Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency
(MIGA). The term “World Bank� refers to the IBRD and the IDA alone. 189
190 The World Bank Legal Review
political prohibition that is hardwired into the constituent documents of most
(but not all) MDBs, barring them from interfering in the political affairs of
their members.4 Recently, however, the nexus between corruption and gover-
nance issues, on the one hand, and development, including economic devel-
opment, on the other, has become clear.5 It has also become clear that, if done
right, governance issues may be addressed without violating the political pro-
hibition.6
When it comes to sanctions, the MDBs owe a �duciary duty to their stake-
holders, enshrined in the MDBs’ constituent documents, to safeguard the
proper use of the stakeholders’ funds.7 It is that �duciary duty that under-
lies sanctions, which operate as a key disincentive against the misuse of MDB
funds. Although the MDBs will never be able to investigate and sanction every
instance of misuse, sanctions—in particular public sanctions—can leverage a
relatively small number of cases to create broader deterrence.
Application of this tool is not always straightforward. On a political
level, for example, the MDBs face challenges due to their cooperative gover-
nance structures, in which their shareholders—member countries—may face
pressures from their private sector “champions� that may be subject to MDB
4 The IBRD Articles of Agreement, for example, contain a provision that states that “the Bank
and its of�cers shall not interfere in the political affairs of any member; nor shall they be in-
fluenced in their decisions by the political character of the member or members concerned.�
See IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article IV, Section 10 (as amended Feb. 18, 1989). The
IDA Articles of Agreement contain an identical provision. See IDA Articles of Agreement,
Article V, Section 6 (Sep. 24, 1960). Almost identical provisions are contained in the
Agreement Establishing the Inter-American Development Bank, Article VIII, Section 5(f)
(last amended Jul. 31, 1995); the Articles of Agreement of the Asian Development Bank,
Chapter VI, Article 36 (Aug. 22, 1966); and the Agreement Establishing the African Develop-
ment Bank, Chapter V, Article 38 (Jul. 2002). In contrast, the constituent documents of the
EBRD and EIB do not contain any such restriction. See also Hassane Cissé, Should the Political
Prohibition in Charters of International Financial Institutions Be Revisited? The Case of the World
Bank, in this volume.
5 Ibrahim Shihata, Corruption: A General Review with an Emphasis on the Role of the World Bank,
15 Dick. J. Intl. L. 451, 455 (1997) (noting that “the vested interests established through cor-
rupt practices tend to weaken public institutions and delay attempts to reform the system,
thus inhibiting the development of new activities and reducing economic growth�); Claes
Sandgren, Combating Corruption: The Misunderstood Role of Law, 39 Intl. Law 717, 718 (2005)
(suggesting that corruption reduces economic growth).
6 Ibrahim Shihata, The World Bank Legal Papers ch. 9, 219–44 (Kluwer Law International 2000),
sets out points made earlier in the legal opinion from Ibrahim Shihata, senior vice president
and general counsel, Prohibition of Political Activities in the Bank’s Work, July 12, 1995 (internal
doc. SecM95-707).
7 The IBRD Articles of Agreement, for example, state that “the Bank shall make arrangements
to ensure that the proceeds of any loan are used only for the purposes for which the loan was
granted, with due attention to considerations of economy and ef�ciency.� See IBRD Articles of
Agreement, Article III, Section 5(b), supra note 5. The IDA articles contain an identical provi-
sion. See IDA Articles of Agreement, Article V, Section 1(g), supra note 5. See also Agreement
Establishing the Inter-American Development Bank, Article III, Section 1, supra note 5; Articles
of Agreement of the Asian Development Bank, Chapter III, Article 8, supra note 5; Agreement
Establishing the African Development Bank, Chapter V, Article 14, supra note 5; and Agreement
Establishing the European Bank for Reconstruction and Development, Chapter III, Article 8.
Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption 191
sanction. And, although sanctions are not aimed at government, the investi-
gations that lead to sanctions often uncover wrongdoing by government of-
�cials, which can be a sensitive issue for the MDBs’ member countries.
Notwithstanding these challenges, by the early 2000s, the leading MDBs
had established mechanisms to investigate and possibly sanction fraud and
corruption in the projects they �nanced. Although similar in purpose and
with generally common goals, these mechanisms were each developed sepa-
rately, drawing on the distinct institutional cultures and political tolerances
of the individual MDBs. Although the MDBs have similar business models,
little effort was made to harmonize the speci�c provisions of these fairly novel
programs.
Certain core elements were common to most of these sanctions mecha-
nisms. Rather than rely on local law in each country, each MDB decided to
create a “level playing �eld� by adopting a single set of anticorruption policies
applicable in all of its projects. Each MDB created an “integrity� of�ce to in-
vestigate allegations of violations of these anticorruption policies. Each MDB
also created its own adjudicative mechanism to determine when the policy
had, in fact, been violated. And, �nally, each MDB settled on ineligibility, aka
debarment, as the most likely sanction to be imposed.8
As the sanctions mechanisms were implemented, it became clear that the
devil was in the details. How should fraud and corruption be de�ned? What
rules should govern the investigative process? How much due process must
or should be afforded to an accused party? Collectively, the MDBs came to
realize that uniformity among them would allow them to set the standard
for best practices. Each MDB would then be able to point to the policies of
the others as a basis on how to proceed. Moreover, while the MDBs did often
compete for business on price and product among their client countries, there
was recognition that flexibility on issues of integrity should not be used to win
business. Setting a single standard would allow the MDBs to draw a line that
none should cross.
Rationale and Background for the Agreement
In February 2006, a Joint International Financial Institution Anti-corruption
Task Force (the “IFI Task Force�), including the AfDB, ADB, EBRD, IDB,
and World Bank Group, as well the European Investment Bank (EIB) and
the International Monetary Fund (IMF), was formed to work toward a
8 The World Bank, for example, de�nes debarment as a declaration that the debarred �rm or
individual is “ineligible, either inde�nitely or for a stated period of time (x) to be awarded
a contract . . . for any Bank Project; (y) to be a nominated sub-contractor, consultant, man-
ufacturer or supplier, or service provided of an otherwise eligible �rm being awarded a
Bank-�nanced contract; and (z) to receive the proceeds of any loan made by the Bank or
otherwise participate in the preparation or implementation of any Bank Project.� See World
Bank Sanctions Procedures, Section 9.01(c)(i) (Jan. 1, 2011), available at .
192 The World Bank Legal Review
“consistent and harmonized approach to combat corruption in the activities and
operations of the member institutions,�9 recognizing that “a uni�ed and
coordinated approach is critical to the success of the shared effort to �ght
corruption and prevent it from undermining the effectiveness of their work.�10
The work of the IFI Task Force culminated in September 2006 with the signing
of a Uniform Framework for Preventing and Combating Corruption (Uniform
Framework), which included two key components: a common set of de�ni-
tions of sanctionable conduct and a common set of principles and guidelines
for investigations.
The members of the IFI Task Force agreed that, as a threshold matter,
consensus needed to be reached on harmonized de�nitions of the types of il-
licit conduct they would consider sanctionable. Each member institution had
already established four sanctionable offenses: corrupt practice, fraudulent
practice, collusive practice, and coercive practice. The task before them there-
fore was to align their respective de�nitions of these practices. After much
debate, the IFI Task Force agreed on de�nitions, thus creating a single set of
violations applicable in every project �nanced by participating institutions.11
The adoption of these harmonized de�nitions would not only provide unifor-
mity to governments and �rms executing development projects �nanced by
different IFIs but also create a single benchmark by which all the IFIs could
judge whether a sanctionable practice had occurred.
Attention then turned to the creation of a uni�ed set of principles and
guidelines (the IFI Principles and Guidelines for Investigations) to govern
how the integrity of�ces of the respective MDBs would execute their inves-
tigative mandates. Starting with the investigative guidelines adopted by the
Third International Investigators Conference,12 the IFI Task Force was able to
agree on a set of core elements: de�nitions of misconduct and the standard of
proof; rights and obligations of witnesses, subjects, and investigative of�ce
staff; procedural guidelines on sources of complaints, receipt of complaint,
9 International Financial Institutions Anti-Corruption Task Force, Uniform Framework for
Preventing and Combating Fraud and Corruption (Sep. 2006).
10 World Bank, Mutual Enforcement of Debarment Decisions among Multilateral Development
Banks (Mar. 3, 2010).
11 The World Bank Group subsequently adopted a �fth de�nition for “obstructive practices,�
as did the IDB and ADB. See IDB, Integrity Principles and Guidelines 4 et seq. (May 2010). For
more information on integrity at the IDB, see . Some MDBs have also adopted other
sanctionable practices. The ADB, for example, may sanction for conflict of interest and retali-
ation against whistleblowers. The IDB does not consider its list of enumerated sanctionable
practices to be exclusive; it may sanction any conduct that it deems to constitute fraud or
corruption. See IDB, Policies for the Procurement of Goods and Works Financed by the Inter-
American Development Bank, Section 1.14. The World Bank Group, by contrast, sanctions
only the �ve practices enumerated in this article.
12 The International Investigators Conference is an annual gathering of the investigative of�ces
from more than 35 international organizations to discuss issues of common interest, explore
opportunities for harmonization, and identify best practices in the detection, investigation,
and sanctioning of misconduct in the execution of development projects.
Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption 193
preliminary evaluation, case prioritization, and investigative activity; investi-
gative �ndings; referrals to national authorities; review and amendment; and
publication.
During the �nal meetings of the IFI Task Force in 2006, discussion turned
to whether institutions were prepared to recognize and enforce each other’s
sanction decisions. It became clear that the work to reach agreement on de�-
nitions and guidelines had expended available political will; the MDBs were
not yet willing to surrender the independence and “sovereignty� of decision
making that would be implicit in accepting mutual recognition of each other’s
debarment systems. Each MDB �rmly believed that it must maintain control
over whom the institution would sanction and the terms of the sanction. The
initial agreements would have to take root before further agreement could
be reached. Indeed, the initiatives agreed to by the IFI Task Force required
the approval of both the respective heads and, on some matters, the boards of
the MDBs.
In September 2006, the heads of the institutions represented on the IFI
Task Force met at the annual meetings of the World Bank and IMF in Singa-
pore and signed the Uniform Framework, laying down the cornerstone for
future harmonization among the banks in the area of fraud and corruption.
The Uniform Framework included not only an agreement on harmonized
de�nitions and investigative guidelines but also a placeholder for future dis-
cussions on cross-debarment, by stating that the institutions would “explore
further how compliance and enforcement actions taken by one institution can
be supported by the others,� an undertaking predicated on the understanding
that “mutual recognition of . . . enforcement actions would substantially assist
in deterring and preventing corrupt practices.�13
Over the next several years, each MDB successfully won approval from its
management and governing bodies for the harmonized de�nitions and imple-
mented the Uniform Framework. Their new partnership fostered closer ties
in responding to integrity issues and due diligence in private sector �nanc-
ing activities as well. Constant communication and frequent contact led to an
increase in trust and con�dence among and between the maturing integrity
of�ces. This sense of community was further supported by the movement of
staff from one of�ce to leadership positions in others, building a shared un-
derstanding of the issues each institution faced.
Harmonization took another step forward when, in early 2009, some of
the MDBs that had been part of the IFI Task Force in 2006 expressed an interest
in reopening a dialogue as to the possibility of setting up arrangements for the
mutual enforcement of sanctions.
The �rst proposal on the table, advocated principally by the World Bank,
was the establishment of a joint sanctions board (JSB) that would act as
an autonomous body that would hear sanctions cases from each of the
13 See Uniform Framework, supra note 9.
194 The World Bank Legal Review
participating MDBs using a uniform set of procedures. The internal proce-
dures for the initial vetting of cases would be left to each MDB to work out,
although some MDBs expressed an interest in a �gure along the lines of the
World Bank Group’s evaluation and suspension of�cers.14 The proponents
of the JSB believed that the JSB would play an important role in facilitating
a uni�ed approach to decreasing fraud and corruption in MDB-supported
projects.
However, the JSB idea quickly ran into a number of stumbling blocks,
driven primarily by the wide variance in adjudicative mechanisms employed
by the MDBs.15 The World Bank Group sat at one end of the spectrum, with
a quasi-judicial two-tiered system that included an oral hearing, an appeals
mechanism, and detailed procedures governing the proceedings. None of
the other MDBs was employing systems as elaborate as those of the World
Bank Group, and none was prepared to move signi�cantly in that direction.
Although all recognized the need to provide adequate notice and some due
process to the accused parties, each believed that its own mechanisms were
suf�cient. Moreover, each institution continued to feel strongly that it should
have sole control over who the decision makers would be.
The debate raised some fundamental issues on which the MDBs diverged:
should the sanctions process of the MDBs be viewed simply as a business
decisions as to whom the MDB chooses to do business with, or, given that the
focus is on acts of fraud and corruption that are traditionally crimes, as well as
the consequences of sanctions that go beyond the economic, should the sanc-
tions process be treated as a judicial or quasi-judicial action requiring more
robust due process? Are anticorruption policies more akin to due diligence by
traditional investment banks, or have the MDBs taken on a role and therefore
the responsibilities of an international regulator? Underlying the questions is
a more fundamental point: do �rms and individuals have a right to do busi-
ness with the MDBs under the open procurement principles that each MDB
has embraced? If so, then it follows that those �rms and individuals should
not be deprived of their rights without robust due process. If not, then the
14 The World Bank Group has a two-tiered sanctions process. The �rst tier consists of a review
of the case by a Bank of�cer called the Evaluation and Suspension Of�cer (EO). The Bank
EO reviews the case for suf�ciency of evidence and recommends a sanction, if any, to be
imposed. If the respondent does not wish to accept the EO’s determination, it may refer the
case to the World Bank Group Sanctions Board, an autonomous body consisting of seven
members, four of whom are external to the Bank, for de novo consideration. See World Bank
Sanctions Procedures, supra note 8, at Sections 3.01, 5.01, 8.01.
15 There was also a belief that a joint sanctions process might have a negative impact on the
privileges and immunities of individual MDBs. In reality, the opposite was probably true. In
deciding whether to uphold the immunities of international organizations, national courts
(particularly in Europe) often look to whether alternative forms of redress that conform with
fundamental notions of due process are available. One key feature of these notions of due
process is independent decision making. See Article 10 of the Universal Declaration of Hu-
man Rights, GA Res. 217(III), UN GAOR, 3d Sess., Supp. No. 13, UN Doc. A/810 (1948)
(“Everyone is entitled in full equality to a fair and public hearing by an independent and
impartial tribunal, in the determination of his rights and obligations�).
Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption 195
decision to debar is essentially a unilateral business decision by the MDB, and
the only due process required is that which is suf�cient to ensure that the deci-
sion itself is not arbitrary. A JSB would therefore make good sense under the
former view, but would be excessively burdensome under the latter.
Each MDB addressed these issues indirectly through the manner in which
it chose to implement its anticorruption programs. And although all the
MDBs’ systems rely on the same central precepts, none of the MDBs was yet
ready to sacri�ce the nuances of, and the policy assumptions underlying, its
own decision-making mechanisms in favor of the others.
In light of these thorny issues, the MDBs agreed that the JSB was a “bridge
too far,� and that the most logical next step in the harmonization of sanc-
tions processes would be the creation of an effective cross-debarment regime.
Therefore, representatives of the six MDBs that had met in early 2009—AfDB,
ADB, EBRD, EIB,16 IDB, and World Bank Group—met regularly to discuss and
agree on the key elements of a cross-debarment regime based not on common
rules or procedures but on common core principles of due process that they
all shared.
It was expected that cross-debarment would serve many of the same pur-
poses as a JSB while preserving each MDB’s autonomy of policy and decision
making. As stated in the Uniform Framework, cross-debarment among MDBs
would greatly enhance deterrence and thus prevention of corrupt practices,
advancing and strengthening integrity efforts and safeguarding development
resources from corrupt participants. Cross-debarment would also signi�-
cantly enhance the deterrent effect of sanctions by any one MDB, effectively
multiplying the impact of a debarment on a �rm or individual by foreclosing the
possibility of the �rm or individual winning contracts with the other MDBs.
Cross-debarment would also address some of the signi�cant �duciary
and reputational risks associated with the �nancing of contracts with �rms
and individuals sanctioned by other MDBs. Other than the EBRD,17 none of
the MDBs had previously had a process in place for cross-debarment. Thus,
under the open procurement principles that were adopted, each of the MDBs,
�rms, and individuals sanctioned by one MDB are free to continue doing busi-
ness with other MDBs, potentially engaging in further misconduct in relation
16 In the end, the EIB did not join the agreement. Its sanctions system is still in the develop-
ment stage and, when the EIB does impose sanctions, its debarment decisions will be subject
to review by courts and institutional bodies within the European Union (EU). Therefore, if
the EIB were to cross-debar based on the debarments of another MDB, including the World
Bank Group, the debarment could be subject to review by an EU court or institutional body.
Because of these circumstances, including the EIB in the cross-debarment regime seemed
premature. The EIB is continuing to participate in the discussions among the MDBs on sanc-
tions harmonization and is reviewing how it might join the agreement at a later time.
17 In February 2007, the �rst instance of cross-debarment occurred when the EBRD debarred
Lahmeyer International following debarment by the World Bank as a result of its involve-
ment in the Lesotho Highland Waters Project. See Transparency International, Transparency
Watch (Apr. 2007).
196 The World Bank Legal Review
to contracts �nanced by such other MDBs.18 This situation exposed the MDBs’
borrowers and donors and, most important, the bene�ciaries of the projects
they �nance to further prejudice, while at the same time leaving the MDBs
open to serious reputational risks for continuing to engage with �rms and
individuals found by a sister institution to have committed acts of fraud or
corruption.19
In addition, although each MDB would retain its own sanctions process
and standards within the core principles, it was hoped that cross-debarment
would facilitate and encourage deeper harmonization among the MDBs. The
logic of cross-debarment would lead the MDBs toward consistency of sanc-
tions across MDBs, in both their level (that is, the length of debarment) and
scope (for example, which af�liates are subject to sanction). Further, it was
anticipated that cross-debarment would facilitate broader harmonization be-
yond the circle of the major MDBs. It was felt that smaller, regional MDBs
would likely be more willing to take part in a cross-debarment regime than a
JSB, for the same reasons that made the JSB proposal problematic for the larger
MDBs. Similarly, the desire to join the cross-debarment regime should serve as
an incentive for regional MDBs to put the core principles in place.
Key Terms of the Agreement
The agreement is based on representation by each signatory MDB that its sanc-
tions regime meets certain common core principles. First, that the MDB has ad-
opted the four harmonized de�nitions of fraud and corruption in the Uniform
Framework. Second, that the MDB follows the IFI Principles and Guidelines
for Investigations. Third, that the MDB has sanctions processes with certain
key due process elements, including an internal investigative authority and a
distinct decision-making authority, written and publicly available procedures
that require notice to accused parties and an opportunity to respond, a “more
probably than not� standard of proof or equivalent, and a range of sanctions
that take into account the principle of proportionality, including aggravating
and mitigating factors.
In relying on these representations, each signatory MDB agrees to recog-
nize and enforce any debarment decisions of the other signatories that meet
the following criteria:
18 The term “open procurement� refers to the fact that the MDBs’ borrowers, not the MDBs,
carry out the procurement of goods, works, and services �nanced by the MDBs. To ensure
an open and competitive process, borrowers are allowed to exclude bidders based on spe-
ci�c enumerated criteria for ineligibility—one of which is debarment by the MDB. Without
cross-debarment, there was no legal basis for �rms not debarred by the �nancing MDBs to
be excluded simply because another MDB had debarred them.
19 Knowledge that a �rm or individual has been debarred by another MDB for fraud and
corruption could be used as a basis for further due diligence, but unless the due diligence
�nds independent reasons not to do business with the debarred party, an MDB is obliged to
�nance contracts with that party under open procurement principles.
Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption 197
• The debarment is for fraud and corruption under one or more of the four
harmonized de�nitions (that is, fraudulent, corrupt, coercive, or collusive
practices).
• The debarment is made public.
• The debarment period exceeds one year.
• The conduct that gave rise to the debarment occurred no more than ten
years prior to the debarment decision.
• The decision to debar is made after the agreement takes effect with respect
to that MDB.
If the debarment decision meets these criteria, cross-debarment by the
other MDBs is essentially automatic. There is no review by the other MDBs of
the underlying decision or the reasons for it. The original debarring MDB de-
termines the period of debarment and, where there are conditions for release
from debarment, when the �rm is released from debarment. However, each
MDB has a right to “opt out� of a particular debarment if it determines that
the debarment is inconsistent with “institutional or legal considerations.�
The agreement provides that other IFIs20 can join if they sign a letter of
adherence and meet the core principles and standards and all existing signa-
tories consent to their adherence. Signatories are free to leave the arrangement
by written notice to the other signatories.
Key Issues and Challenges
The proposal for a mutual enforcement regime raised a number of issues and
challenges that needed to be ironed out among the signatory MDBs. Some of
the key issues and challenges that the MDBs faced and their resolution are
described below.
Why Is Cross-Debarment Automatic?
The MDBs considered but rejected a system whereby each MDB would be able
to engage in a de novo review of a sanctions decision before agreeing to cross-
debarment in a particular case. The working group concluded that allowing
de novo reviews would not only be costly and laborious, because each case
from each participating MDB would have to be reviewed again on its merits,
but could well result in inconsistent decisions among participating MDBs, ex-
posing both the original debarring MDB and the non-cross-debarring MDB to
reputational risks. Moreover, inconsistent results might encourage litigation
by sanctioned entities or individuals against the organization that imposed
20 Several other regional MDBs have expressed an interest in joining a mutual-recognition-
of-debarment regime. See Mutual Enforcement of Debarment Decisions, supra note 10, at
paragraph 35.
198 The World Bank Legal Review
the strictest sanction. The MDBs agreed that the more effective form of cross-
debarment would be one that is triggered automatically, subject only to the
speci�ed criteria and the opt-out.
Why Insist on Cross-Debarring for Public Debarments Only?
The MDBs agreed that it would be essential that only public debarments (i.e.,
those announced publicly, typically by a listing on the MDBs’ websites) would
be cross-debarred, even though this effectively excluded most sanctions im-
posed by the ADB.21 There were several reasons for this approach. Although a
degree of transparency is not stated explicitly as a core principle, most MDBs
believe that a degree of transparency is an essential element of due process.
The duty to cross-debar a nonpublic debarment would oblige the other MDBs
to adopt nonpublic debarments, something they were not willing to do on
policy grounds as well as on practical ones: it is through publication that the
MDB borrowers’ implementing agencies and other interested parties are made
aware of debarments so that they may enforce them in their own procurement
decisions.22 Moreover, public debarments maximize the deterrent impact; an
insistence on publicity reinforces this effect.
Was the Creation of a Safe Harbor for Debarments of One Year or
Less the Right Thing to Do?
The MDBs recognized that some case-speci�c circumstances may not warrant
the onerous impact of cross-debarment. After all, for �rms that are heavily re-
liant on MDB-�nanced business, cross-debarment could put them out of busi-
ness. Although this would most certainly be a strong deterrent to engaging
in sanctionable practices, it might also be viewed as being a disproportion-
ate consequence for lesser offenses. In an effort to balance these competing
concerns, the agreement allows for a “safe harbor� in that cross-debarment
is applicable only to debarments exceeding one year. It is hoped that this safe
harbor will incentivize �rms under investigation to cooperate with the MDBs
with a view to mitigating their sanctions enough to avoid cross-debarment.
The Opt-Out Clause: A Giant Loophole or a Necessary Escape Valve?
The MDBs wanted to allow for exceptional situations in which individ-
ual MDBs might need to opt out of the cross-debarment regime when
there are overriding “legal or other institutional considerations.� For ex-
ample, the World Bank Group would normally not sanction a �rm that is
participating in its Voluntary Disclosure Program (VDP).23 Similarly, the World
21 The ADB discloses debarments only in two cases: violation by a debarred �rm of the terms of
its debarment by bidding on ADB-�nanced contracts and repeat offenses. See ADB, Anticor-
ruption and Integrity, Integrity Principles and Guidelines, paragraph 98 (Oct. 2010).
22 On the other hand, ADB nonpublic debarments rely on voluntary restraint by the debarred
party. Id.
23 Under the VDP, a �rm is required to disclose misconduct on World Bank Group–supported
projects. If the �rm is sanctioned by another MDB for misconduct unrelated to a World Bank
Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption 199
Bank Group would not be able to enforce a sanction through cross-debarment
against a �rm with which the World Bank Group has resolved a case through
negotiation (aka settlement) if the terms of the negotiated resolution related,
in whole or in part, to the conduct for which the other MDB debarred the
�rm. Given the current lack of common sanctioning guidelines among the
MDBs, this opt-out right also allows MDBs to decline enforcement of a debar-
ment decision that may be egregiously sweeping in scope or duration, signi�-
cantly impairing the development missions of the other MDBs. It also allows
for “one-off� exceptions, as when a debarred party is playing a crucial devel-
opment role, particularly in emergency situations.
Any decision to opt out does not affect the decision of the other partici-
pating MDBs to cross-debar in the same case. If an MDB chooses to exercise
this clause, it is required to provide written notice of its decision to each of
the other participating MDBs. Although the MDB is not required to supply
the reasons for its decision, which would be based on “sovereign� matters of
internal policy, this noti�cation requirement alone should incentivize MDBs to
make only exceptional use of the clause. In any event, the participating MDBs
know that anything other than highly exceptional use of the opt-out clause
would endanger the credibility of the system as a whole, to the detriment of
all of the participating MDBs.
Opt-out clauses are a common feature of bilateral and multilateral agree-
ments. The inclusion of such clauses is not a statement of expectation that the
clause will be used, but rather an acknowledgment of the reality that excep-
tional circumstances do in fact arise from time to time.24 As of this writing,
none of the MDBs has invoked its opt-out right.
In the absence of an opt-out clause, an MDB confronted with a legal or
institutional matter that would preclude the imposition of a particular cross-
debarment would be faced with a Hobson’s choice of either committing a
breach of or having to withdraw from the agreement. Given this alternative,
the opt-out clause can be seen as the lesser of two evils.
Group–supported project, the �rm is still protected by the VDP vis-à -vis the World Bank
Group. See World Bank Department of Institutional Integrity, Voluntary Disclosure Program:
Terms & Conditions, Article 3.
24 See Jeffrey L. Friesen, The Distribution of Treaty-Implementing Powers in Constitutional Federa-
tions: Thoughts on the American and Canadian Models, 94 Colum. L. Rev. 1415, 1445 (1994) (not-
ing that “the opt-out provisions provide some safeguard for the autonomy of the nation that
has the option to exercise it, while the agreement or standard is otherwise presumptively
in force. The burden to opt out is on the nation seeking to exercise the option, and it will
presumably do so only when it perceives a genuine threat to its interests�); Ariel M. Ezrahi,
Opting Out of Opt-Out Clauses: Removing Obstacles to International Trade and International Peace,
31 L. & Policy Intl. Bus. 123, 142 (Fall 1999) (referring to Article XI of the General Agreement
on Tariffs and Trade, which provides for exceptions to the general prohibition on quotas
under certain circumstances, such as the need to relieve shortages of food and other essential
products).
200 The World Bank Legal Review
A Special Challenge for the World Bank:
Applying Cross-Debarment to Existing Projects
MDB cross-debarment required a change in World Bank procurement policy,
which in turn necessitated amendments to the relevant legal framework for
the World Bank’s loans and grants, including the procurement, consultant,
and anticorruption guidelines, as well as the general conditions.25 Unlike
other MDBs, the World Bank customarily applies changes in policies only to
new loans and grants. The existing portfolio—even if there is new procure-
ment—is not affected by changes in policy unless the Bank and its borrowers
agree otherwise.
The Bank has traditionally declined to apply policy changes to its existing
portfolio on fairness grounds. Once the Bank and its borrower have agreed to
apply a certain set of policy-based rules to govern a particular project, it has
been felt that it would not be fair for the Bank to unilaterally change the “rules
of the game� in midcourse.
In the case of MDB cross-debarment, however, the Bank’s usual prospec-
tive application posed at least two problems:
• The other MDBs intended to apply cross-debarment to new contracts in
both new and existing projects. At least one MBD found it unacceptable
that the Bank would not apply cross-debarment in this same way and
viewed nonapplication of the regime to the Bank’s existing projects as a
potential deal breaker because the nonapplication violated the principle
of reciprocity that was central to the agreement.
• The Bank itself faced major reputational risk, because the Bank would
have been hard-pressed to explain to the press and public at large why it
was continuing to �nance contracts with cross-debarred �rms on some—
and, in the short term, most—of its projects.
A consensus formed that the World Bank needed to �nd a way to apply
cross-debarment to its existing portfolio. The Bank’s lawyers concluded that
the only legally valid way to do so was to amend all existing legal agree-
ments with the Bank’s borrowers. International law principles did not al-
low the Bank to do this unilaterally, but the task of undertaking individual
amendments to hundreds of agreements, cosigned by borrowers, seemed
onerous at best. The Bank therefore adopted a somewhat novel approach: it
drew up omnibus amendments to the legal agreements with each borrower
on an absence–of-objection basis, so that unless the borrower objected within
a de�ned period of time, the Bank would consider the amendment to take
effect automatically.
25 Guidelines Procurement under IBRD Loans and IDA Credits, paragraph 1.8 and 1.14 (May
1, 2010); Guidelines Selection and Employment of Consultants under IBRD Loans and
IDA Credits & Grants by World Bank Borrowers, paragraph 23 (Jan. 2011); Guidelines on
Preventing and Combating Fraud and Corruption in Projects Financed by IBRD Loans and
IDA Credits and Grants, paragraph 11 (Jan. 2011); General Conditions for Loans, Article VII
(Jul. 31, 2010).
Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption 201
This approach was not without controversy. A relatively small number
of borrowers did, in fact, object or ask for more time to consider the amend-
ment. The Bank allowed more time for those borrowers who asked for it, and
actively engaged those borrowers that objected; as of this writing, only a
handful of borrowers have continued to object to the amendments.
This issue brought out an interesting point: none of the other MDBs
needed to go through this exercise in order to effect the policy changes needed
to implement the cross-debarment regime. In some cases, the MDBs’ policies
were broadly enough stated to allow for cross-debarment without a change
in procurement policy. In other cases, changes in policy were automatically
applied to existing projects because their legal agreements incorporated their
policies “as amended from time to time.�
This experience has led some at the World Bank to question why the World
Bank takes such a different approach to policy changes than its sister institu-
tions. The “fairness� argument that underlies the Bank’s current practice is
open to challenge, and not simply because other MDBs do not share the prac-
tice. Bank policies are adopted only after extensive consultation with member
countries and other stakeholders. Moreover, the Bank, like its sister MDBs,
is a cooperative institution; its borrowers are also its member countries, rep-
resented in the Bank’s governing bodies. Any amendments to Bank policies
require the approval of those bodies, and it is not immediately obvious that
changes in policy should always be assumed to redound to the detriment of
the Bank’s borrowers.
More often than not, in fact, the opposite is true, which is why many bor-
rowers agree with the Bank, either formally or informally, to apply new poli-
cies to ongoing projects. The Bank’s position that the loan agreement requires
formal amendment, however, means that there is often a mismatch between
the formal legal framework for a project and the reality in the �eld. And, ironi-
cally, even if the Bank’s approach to policy changes is fairer in substance, it
does not always appear so to the Bank’s borrowers. In this case, for example,
the Bank was perceived by some borrowers as imposing a change, when it was
actually asking borrowers to consent to a change that other MDBs were imple-
menting automatically.
What Is the Likely Impact of Cross-Debarment
on the Private Sector?
There is some concern that cross-debarment could have a “chilling effect� on
bidders in MDB-�nanced procurement. However, we believe that the chilling
effect would likely apply mainly to those �rms and individuals whose prac-
tices are already questionable. In this sense, “chilling effect� is just another
way to talk about deterrence. Honest �rms with effective integrity compliance
programs should have nothing to fear from cross-debarment.
The risk of cross-debarment should incentivize �rms to reevaluate
their governance and compliance systems in an effort to mitigate the risk of
202 The World Bank Legal Review
sanction and cross-debarment. In the wake of the adoption of model compli-
ance principles as part of the reform of its own sanctions process, the World
Bank Group intends to engage in outreach with the business community and
other stakeholders to explain the cross-debarment regime and what steps they
can take to mitigate the risk of cross-debarment. Cross-debarment should also
serve to further incentivize company managers to come forward voluntarily
as soon as they learn of misconduct in their operations, leading to expansion
of the VDP and the use of negotiated resolutions. And although it is dif�cult at
this point to assess the impact on corporate behavior overall, debarment deci-
sions by the MDBs are beginning to have an impact outside the development
arena; private �rms have begun to include a review of debarment decisions by
the MDBs as part of their integrity research.26
Experience with Cross-Debarment So Far
As of this writing, the agreement has become effective with respect to four out
of the �ve signatory MDBs. The ADB and EBRD were the �rst signatories to
implement the cross-debarment regime; they signed the agreement on June 9,
2010. The World Bank Group followed, announcing its implementation of the
accord on July 19, 2010, and the IDB announced implementation in May 2011.
Implementation by the AfDB is anticipated by the end of 2011.
As of August 1, 2011, the World Bank had cross-debarred 16 �rms and
individuals, all of which were originally debarred by the ADB. The ADB, in
turn, has cross-debarred 21 entities originally debarred by the World Bank.
The EBRD has recognized all of these debarments issued by the World Bank
and the ADB. In line with expectations, no debarment by any of the signato-
ries was subject to an opt-out by another signatory.
Next Steps for Harmonization among MDBs and Beyond
As signi�cant as it is, the harmonization of sanctions policies among MDBs
should not, and will not, stop with their agreement on cross-debarment. The
future is likely to see deeper and broader harmonization among MDBs and
other international organizations.
Further Harmonization among the MDBs
Cross-debarment should further cement the MDBs’ role as a leader in the
global effort to combat corruption. By encouraging MDBs to work together,
cross-debarment should reinforce the momentum behind their anticorruption
26 The Bank is planning to undertake a review of its sanctions regime. One of the issues that the
Bank will attempt to assess will be the deterrent effect of the system. Recognizing that any
direct or precise measurements are virtually impossible, the Bank hopes it will �nd “prox-
ies� that will provide some useful, if rough, appraisal of the regime’s effectiveness.
Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption 203
efforts and provide an “enabling environment� that will help them overcome
the ever-present challenges discussed at the outset of this chapter.
We hope and expect that Agreement for Mutual Enforcement of Debar-
ment Decisions will lead to deeper and wider harmonization of sanctions
policies and practices. Already, there are discussions under way among the
participating MDBs to harmonize their sanctioning guidelines, as well as to
seek a common approach to the scope of sanctions when dealing with cor-
porate groups.27 Moreover, cross-debarment has underscored the need for
closer cooperation and exchange of information among the MDBs. Parallel or
joint investigations between MDBs and with national authorities have already
become more common.
Although it is premature at this juncture to talk about an established
droit commun among the MDBs,28 these developments certainly open up that
possibility. There is signi�cant congruence among the MDBs in the forms of
misconduct they consider sanctionable and shared due process principles for
the adjudication of cases. The upcoming publication of sanctions decisions
by the World Bank Group will begin to create a jurisprudence to �ll out the
detailed contours of these general principles. To the extent that other MDBs
choose to rely on such jurisprudence or may be willing to follow suit and
publish their own decisions, a common body of law may emerge in this area
among MDBs.
Harmonization beyond the Major MDBs
The agreement opened up the possibility of broadening the harmonization
efforts to other IFIs. The World Bank Group and other participating MDBs
have started working with smaller, regional MDBs to help them develop
and implement anticorruption programs that will conform to the core prin-
ciples. Some of these MDBs have expressed interest in participating in a cross-
debarment regime and have indicated that they may unilaterally recognize
cross-debarment decisions. Others have made participation in the cross-
debarment regime a speci�c goal for their institution. Although work remains to
be done before MDBs can be added to the cross-debarment regime, the addition
of other MDBs would be a positive development that would further strengthen
27 The World Bank recently adopted comprehensive guidance for dealing with corporate
groups that, among other things, allows for the derivative sanctioning of af�liated parties of
a sanctioned party under certain circumstances. As a general matter, subsidiaries controlled
by the sanctioned parties will be sanctioned as a routine matter to avoid their use as a vehicle
for circumvention, while parent companies are sanctioned only if they were involved in the
misconduct or bear some responsibility for allowing it to happen. In addition, the Bank will
also generally sanction successors to the extent necessary to ensure that the ongoing busi-
ness continues to be sanctioned. As the sanctioning processes continue to converge, the har-
monized treatment of corporate groups has become a topic of signi�cant discussion among
the MDBs.
28 Laurence Boisson de Chazournes, Partnerships, Emulation, and Coordination: Toward the Emer-
gence of a Droit Commun in the Field of Development Finance, in this volume.
204 The World Bank Legal Review
deterrence, harmonization, and collaboration—key components in the �ght
against fraud and corruption.
There are also inchoate efforts to extend a degree of harmonization be-
yond the IFI community to United Nations (UN) agencies and even bilateral
aid agencies. On February 19–20, 2008, at the �rst Roundtable of the Legal
Harmonization Initiative (LHI), sponsored by the World Bank, the idea of the
harmonization of approaches to fraud and corruption among major MDBs,
several UN agencies, and bilateral aid agencies was floated for the �rst time.
Although the LHI roundtable participants expressed openness to the idea in
principle, they also agreed that reaching that level of harmonization would
require considerable discussion and effort, given the wide disparities in in-
stitutional governance structures, operational models, policies, and practices,
including on the basic question of how they de�ne “corruption.�
Since the LHI roundtable, harmonization has proceeded along a number
of parallel “paths of least resistance.� As discussed in this chapter, the major
MDBs, which share similar business models and had roughly similar sanc-
tions regimes, found common ground in cross-debarment largely outside the
LHI framework. At the same time, as part of the LHI, the MDBs and key bi-
lateral aid agencies successfully negotiated a framework for operating with
sectorwide approaches and co�nancing situations that included some basic
common understandings on the handling of fraud and corruption issues. The
UN common system29 has launched a process to harmonize sanctions pro-
cesses that is at a fairly advanced stage.
In November 2010, the G20 issued an Anti-corruption Action Plan that
called for increasing international cooperation in combating fraud and cor-
ruption among international organizations. Although the details of imple-
mentation remain under discussion, the action plan provides an important
impetus for harmonization among MDBs and beyond.
Notwithstanding the signi�cant challenges that need to be faced as the
MDBs, the United Nations, and bilateral aid agencies deepen their harmoni-
zation, and the broader international community develops even more robust
approaches to fraud and corruption more generally, there remains room to
extend the dialogue on a more comprehensive approach to harmonization on
integrity among international actors. We believe that the importance of the
�ght against corruption, the logic of harmonization, and the potential bene�ts
that we have discussed in this chapter demand it.
29 The High Level Committee on Management adopted recommendations on vendor sanctions
for consideration by the organizations of the United Nations system, including agencies,
funds, and programs and the Model Policy Framework on Vendor Sanctions for Agencies of
the United Nations System.
PART II
LEGAL OBLIGATIONS AND
INSTITUTIONS OF DEVELOPING
COUNTRIES: RETHINKING
APPROACHES OF IFIS
The Rule of Law and Development
In Search of the Holy Grail
MICHAEL TREBILCOCK
Recent empirical research on the relationship between the nature and quality
of a country’s institutions and the quality of its development outcomes pur-
ports to demonstrate, inter alia, that improvements in the rule of law are likely
to have dramatic impacts on development outcomes. For example, according
to Daniel Kaufmann, an improvement in the rule of law by one standard de-
viation from the current levels in Ukraine to the middling levels prevailing in
South Africa would lead to a fourfold increase in per capita income in Ukraine
in the long run.1 Similarly, according to Dani Rodrik, Arvind Subramanian,
and Francesco Trebi, an “increase in institutional quality� (measured largely
in terms of the strength of private property rights and the rule of law) “of one
standard deviation, corresponding roughly to the difference between mea-
sured institutional quality in Bolivia and South Korea, produces a 2 log-points
rise in per capita incomes, or a 6.4-fold difference.�2
Reflecting this view of the relationship between the rule of law and de-
velopment, there has been a massive surge in development assistance since
the 1990s for law reform projects in developing and transitioning economies
involving investments of many billions of dollars.3 There has also been a major
resurgence of scholarly interest in the relationship between law and develop-
ment.
Proponents of an optimistic view of the relationship between the rule of
law, or law more generally, and development have made bold claims about
the potentially bene�cial impact of legal reforms. For example, in his influ-
ential book The Other Path, Hernando De Soto claims: “The legal system may
be the main explanation in the difference in development that exists between
industrialized countries and those that are not industrialized.�4 He also argues
that “development is possible only if ef�cient legal institutions are available to
1 Daniel Kaufmann, Governance Redux: The Empirical Challenge, in The Global Competitiveness
Report 2003-2004 137 (Xavier Sala-i-Martin ed., Oxford U. Press 2004).
2 Dani Rodrik, Arvind Subramanian, & Francesco Trebi, Institutions Rule: The Primacy of Insti-
tutions over Geography and Integration in Economic Development, 9 Journal of Economic Growth
141 (2004).
3 See David Trubek, The Rule of Law and Development Assistance: Past, Present and Future, in The
New Law and Economic Development: A Critical Appraisal 74 (David Trubek & Alvaro Santos
ed., Cambridge U. Press 2006).
4 Hernando De Soto, The Other Path: The Invisible Revolution in the Third World 185 (Basic Books
1989). 207
208 The World Bank Legal Review
all citizens�5 and that “the law is the most useful and deliberate instrument of
change available to people.�6
In contrast, various law skeptics doubt the ability of legal reformers to
identify appropriate legal reforms and contend that legal reforms often face
potentially insurmountable economic, political, and cultural obstacles. They
also argue that legal reform is frequently irrelevant because informal alter-
natives to law are of overriding importance as social control mechanisms.7
In this respect, skeptics point to the failure of the �rst law and development
movement in the late 1950s to early 1970s—discussed in more detail later in
this chapter—and argue that we may be condemning ourselves to repeating
earlier mistakes by ignoring the lessons of history.
In examining the relationship of law to development, several questions
must be addressed:
• What do terms such as “law,� “legal institutions,� and “the rule of law�
connote?
• Do law and legal institutions in fact signi�cantly determine a country’s
development prospects (given particular conceptions of the ends of devel-
opment)?
• To the extent that they do, why do many countries have chronically poor
laws, legal institutions, or adherence to the rule of law (or in Mancur
Olson’s terms, why are they “leaving big bills on the sidewalk�)?8
• If a country has chronically weak legal infrastructure, legal institutions,
or rule of law, what measures are important and feasible in a law reform
strategy?
• What is the appropriate role for external actors in promoting rule of law
reforms in developing countries?
The De�nition of Law, Legal Institutions, and the Rule of Law
“Law� could connote an almost in�nite number of areas of substantive law,
from commercial and corporate law to tax law, family law, property law, con-
tract law, and administrative law. Nobody possesses the requisite expertise
across all these areas to judge whether a country’s laws reveal de�ciencies in
one respect or another as evaluated against some conception of the outcomes
of development efforts. Instead, this chapter focuses on the major classes of le-
gal institutions, which include courts, police, prosecutors, correctional institu-
5 Id., at 186.
6 Id., at 187.
7 See Kevin Davis & Michael Trebilcock, The Relationship between Law and Development:
Optimists versus Skeptics, 56 Am. J. Com. L. 895 (2008).
8 Mancur Olson, Big Bills Left on the Sidewalk: Why Some Nations Are Rich, and Others Poor, 10 J.
Econ. Perspectives 3 (1996).
The Rule of Law and Development 209
tions, specialized regulatory or law enforcement bodies, legal education insti-
tutions, and professional regulatory bodies, and examines the characteristics
of these institutions with respect to various conceptions of the rule of law.
Problems of evaluation begin with widely divergent understandings of
the concept of the rule of law, which, despite its fashionable preeminence in
many development circles, has been the subject of long-standing normative
debates and is highly contested terrain. According to Brian Tamanaha in an
intellectual history of the rule of law, “there are almost as many conceptions of
the rule of law as there are people defending it.�9 I (with Ron Daniels) have re-
viewed these debates in some detail in previous work.10 For present purposes,
suf�ce it to say that conceptions of the rule of law run the gamut from the de-
ontological (protection of basic human rights) to the instrumental (protection
of property rights and contracts to promote investment and growth). They
also run from extremely “thick� conceptions that largely equate the rule of
law with a just legal system, which in turn is largely elided with a just society,
to very “thin� or formalistic conceptions that emphasize that laws should be
publicly promulgated; be predictable in their application; apply to all citizens,
including government of�cials; and be subject to some form of neutral adjudi-
cation in the event of disputes as to their interpretation or application.
Objections to thick conceptions of the rule of law point out that such
notions largely deprive the rule of law concept of independent meaning by
equating it with “justice� in all its manifestations—and hence with particular
conceptions of the ends of development—rather than as a means of vindi-
cating those ends.11 Objections to thin conceptions of the rule of law point
out that even grossly unjust or immoral societies, such as Nazi Germany or
apartheid South Africa, might meet purely formalistic criteria while lacking
any elements of basic civil and political rights.12 Intermediate conceptions of
the rule of law stress due process or natural justice values of the kind familiar
to Western constitutional and administrative lawyers, as well as basic civil
rights.13
It is important to identify the causal mechanisms that translate improve-
ments in the quality of the rule of law into enhanced development outcomes.
From an economic perspective, much of the literature emphasizes that pro-
tection of private property rights and enforcement of contracts translate into
enhanced incentives to engage in productive investments and hence en-
hanced economic growth. The stability and predictability of a legal system are
regarded as having similar effects. From a noninstrumental or deontological
perspective, such as that adopted by Amartya Sen in Development as Freedom,
9 Brian Z. Tamanaha, On the Rule of Law: History, Politics, Theory 3 (Cambridge U. Press 2004).
10 Michael J. Trebilcock & Ronald J. Daniels, Rule of Law Reform and Development: Charting the
Fragile Path of Progress 1–57 (Edward Elgar 2008).
11 Id., at 23–25.
12 Id.
13 For an argument along these lines, see Tom Bingham, The Rule of Law (Allen Lane 2010).
210 The World Bank Legal Review
an enhanced commitment to the rule of law may be justi�ed as an end in it-
self. The rule of law provides greater protections for the freedoms of concern
to Sen, and their protection does not need to be justi�ed by reference to in-
strumental objectives but presumably legal institutions can still be empirically
evaluated by how well these freedoms are in fact protected.14
The Relationship between the Rule of Law and Development
Recent empirical evidence is often advanced to support the claim that the
quality of a country’s commitment to the rule of law signi�cantly, even dra-
matically, affects its economic development prospects. However, this claim is
not new. A version of this claim appeared in the 1960s in what became known
as “the law and development movement.� Based on an assumption that law
is central to development, the movement’s proponents believed that educat-
ing developing countries’ legal professionals would advance the countries’
reform efforts.15 The view did not endure; shortly after its inauguration, it was
declared dead by two of its founders, David Trubek and Marc Galanter, in a
widely cited paper,16 in which they extensively critiqued, in a development
context, the “model of legal liberalism� that motivated the initial movement.
According to Trubek and Galanter, the components of the liberal legalism
paradigm are �vefold. First, society is made up of individuals, intermediate
groups into which individuals voluntarily organize themselves, and the state.
The state is the primary locus of supra individual control in society, and thus
state action involves the coercion of individuals. Second, the state exercises
its control over the individual through law—bodies of rules addressed uni-
versally to all individuals similarly situated. Third, rules are consciously de-
signed to achieve social purposes or effectuate basic social principles, which
are for the society as a whole, not for limited groups within it. Fourth, when the
rules made through this process are applied, they are enforced equally for all
citizens, and in a fashion that achieves the purposes for which the rules were
consciously designed. Fifth, the legal order applies, interprets, and changes
universalistic rule. The courts have the principal responsibility for de�ning
the effect of legal rules and concepts on individual and group behavior, and
thus normally have the �nal say in de�ning the social meaning of laws. In this
respect, the courts are the central institutions of the legal order. Finally, the be-
havior of social actors tends to conform to the rules: of�cials are guided by the
rules, not by personal, class, regional, or other bases of decision making; and a
large number of the rules will be internalized by most of the population.
14 Amartya Sen, Development as Freedom (Anchor Books 2000).
15 World Bank, Law and Development Movement, available at .
16 David Trubek & Marc Galanter, Scholars and Self-Estrangement: Some Reflections on the Crisis in
Law and Development Studies in the United States, 4 Wis. L. Rev. 1062 (1974).
The Rule of Law and Development 211
However, according to Trubek and Galanter, this paradigm has little ap-
plication or relevance to many, perhaps most, developing countries:
The ethnocentric quality of liberal legalism’s model of law in soci-
ety is apparent. Empirically, the model assumes social and political
pluralism, while in most of the Third World we �nd social strati�ca-
tion and class cleavage juxtaposed with authoritarian or totalitarian
political systems. The model assumes that state institutions are the
primary locus of social control, while in much of the Third World
the grip of tribe, clan, and local community is far stronger than that
of the nation-state. The model assumes that rules both reflect the in-
terests of the vast majority of citizens and are normally internalized
by them, while in many developing countries rules are imposed on
the many by the few and are frequently honoured more in the breach
than in the observance. The model assumes that courts are central
actors in social control, and that they are relatively autonomous
from political, tribal, religious, or class interests. Yet in many nations
courts are neither very independent nor very important.17
This critique of the relevance of even a relatively thin conception of the
rule of law to many developing countries has in turn attracted criticism. For
example, Brian Tamanaha,18 in a review of the paper by Trubek and Galanter,
points out:
One of the major sources of oppression and rapaciousness in de-
veloping countries today is authoritarian governments. The central
premise of the liberal rule-of-law system is the protection of indi-
viduals from the tyranny of the government. Law-and-development
theorists should be striving to devise ways in which the rule-of-law
model can be adapted to local circumstances and nurtured into ma-
turity, rather than expending the bulk of their efforts in tearing this
model down.
Informative though it was, the legal liberal paradigm elucidated by
Trubek and Galanter was seriously misleading insofar as it implied
that all the elements described were prerequisite to a rule-of-law
system. Even the United States, as they observed, did not satisfy the
description. Operating around the world today are many variations
of the rule of law, coexisting with individualist-oriented as well as
with communitarian-oriented cultures. It has always consisted more
of a bundle of ideals than a speci�c or necessary set of institutional
arrangements.
A minimalist account of the rule of law would require only that the
government abide by the rules promulgated by the political author-
ity and treat its citizens with basic human dignity, and that there be
access to a fair and neutral (to the extent achievable) decision maker
or judiciary to hear claims or resolve disputes. These basic elements
17 Id., at 1080–81.
18 Brian Tamanaha, The Lessons of Law and Development Studies, 89 Am. J. Intl. L. 470 (1995).
212 The World Bank Legal Review
are compatible with many social-cultural arrangements and, not-
withstanding the potential conflicts, they have much to offer to de-
veloping countries.19
Tamanaha also points out that the critique of liberal legalism developed
by Trubek and Galanter (and other scholars) often leads to a “state law bad,
folk law good� attitude, when in fact often “folk law is the culprit� in sancti-
fying various basic human rights abuses of, for example, women and ethnic
or religious minorities.20 This raises an important issue regarding the relative
value of formal and informal rules and norms. For reformers, this is often a
chicken versus egg problem: should informal rules come �rst and serve as the
basis for formal rules and norms, or vice versa? Trubek and Galanter seem to
assume that informal rules should precede and support formal norms, and
recent research partially supports their assumption. Katharina Pistor, Antara
Haldar, and Amrit Amirapu show that the status of women in society is rela-
tively weakly associated with various rule of law indices and that in poor
countries this association disappears altogether. They suggest that this oc-
curs because the status of women in society is determined primarily by social
norms about gender equality and these norms are only weakly affected by le-
gal institutions.21 In contrast, in the excerpt above, Tamanaha seems to suggest
the opposite: formal rules can predominate over informal rules, even when
they conflict with them. Similarly, scholars such as Richard McAdams have
argued that formal law and legal institutions have the potential to shape and
modify social norms over time22—that is to say, social or cultural norms and
practices should not necessarily be viewed as a timeless given.
Reasons for the Chronically Poor Quality of the Rule of Law
and Related Legal Institutions in Many Countries
Rule of law de�ciencies are persistent and serious in many developing coun-
tries despite the widely claimed instrumental and intrinsic importance of the
rule of law to development, and despite the fact that external donors have
invested billions of dollars in rule of law reform initiatives in many develop-
ing countries. The World Bank’s governance data on the status of the rule of
law reported that only 3 out of 18 Latin American countries had positive rule
of law ratings in 2008 (Chile, Costa Rica, and Uruguay). In sub-Saharan Africa
only 6 out of 47 countries had positive rule of law ratings in 2008 (Botswana,
Cape Verde, Mauritius, Namibia, the Seychelles, and South Africa). Ratings
19 Id., at 476.
20 Id., at 481, 484.
21 Katharina Pistor, Antara Haldar, & Amrit Amirapu, Social Norms, Rule of Law, and Gender
Reality, in Global Perspectives on the Rule of Law 241 (James Heckman, Robert Nelson, & Lee
Cabatongian ed., Routledge 2010).
22 See Richard McAdams, The Origin, Development and Regulation of Norms, 96 Mich. L. Rev. 338
(1997); Richard H. McAdams, The Legal Construction of Norms: A Focal Point Theory of Expres-
sive Law, 86 Va. L. Rev. 1649 (2000).
The Rule of Law and Development 213
were negative in 12 countries of the former Soviet Union in 2008. The coun-
tries of Eastern Europe present a far more positive picture, and Asia presents a
mixed bag, with its huge diversity of countries, which vary enormously in size,
colonial history, legal heritage, political ideology, and religious complexion.
Notable exceptions to generally low rule of law ratings are Singapore and Hong
Kong, SAR China. Over the course of the prior decade, few countries with weak
ratings had signi�cantly improved their score and some deteriorated further.
Although rule of law measures used by the World Bank in its governance
database23 are susceptible to methodological criticisms,24 the general conclu-
sion about the serious and persistent impediments to establishing the rule of
law in developing countries is not unfounded. Many developing countries
also perform poorly on a conception of the rule of law as encompassing the
protection of various civil and political rights (as Amartya Sen’s conception of
development as freedom does),25 and with respect to corruption.26 Ratings on
the rule of law, freedom, and corruption indices are often highly correlated.
This body of experience has led some scholars to question the value and
sustainability of the entire rule of law reform enterprise. Recall that the post-
war law and development movement was declared by some of its founders to
be a failure by the mid-1970s.27 The movement’s most recent variant faces the
risk of meeting the same fate. Indeed, according to Thomas Carothers,
One cannot get through a foreign policy debate these days without
someone proposing the rule of law as a solution to the world’s trou-
bles. The concept is suddenly everywhere—a venerable part of west-
ern political philosophy enjoying a new run as a rising imperative
of the era of globalization. Unquestionably, it is important to live in
peaceful, free, and prosperous societies. Yet its sudden elevation as
a panacea for the ills of countries in transition from dictatorships or
statist economies should make both patients and prescribers wary.
The rule of law promises to move countries past the �rst, relatively
easy phase of political and economic liberalization to a deeper level
of reform. But that promise is proving dif�cult to ful�ll.28
23 The World Bank de�nes the rule of law thus: “Rule of law captures perceptions of the ex-
tent to which agents have con�dence in and abide by the rules of society, and in particular
the quality of contract enforcement, property rights, the police, and the courts, as well as
the likelihood of crime and violence.� Daniel Kaufmann, Aart Kraay, and Massimo Mas-
truzzi, World Bank Governance Indicators Project 2010, available at .
24 See Kevin Davis, What Can the Rule of Law Variables Tell Us about Rule of Law Reforms? 26 Mich.
J. Intl. L. 141 (2004).
25 See Freedom House, Decline in Rule of Law Seen in New Data Released by Freedom House
(Jun. 26, 2007), available at .
26 See Transparency International, Global Corruption Report 2008, available at .
27 See Trubek & Galanter, supra note 16.
28 Thomas Carothers, The Rule of Law Revival, 77 Foreign Affairs 95 (Mar./Apr. 1998).
214 The World Bank Legal Review
In a similar vein, Yves Dezalay and Bryant Garth claim that
the rule of law has become a new rallying cry for global missionaries.
“Money doctors� selling competing economic expertises continue to
be very active on the global plane, but the 1990s also witnessed a
tremendous growth in rule doctors armed with their own compet-
ing prescriptions for legal reforms and new legal institutions at the
national and transnational level. . . . So far the rule of law industry
cannot claim too many successes in the latest campaign.29
According to Brian Tamanaha,
For all but the most sanguine observers, the triumphalist con�dence
of the 1990s has dissolved. . . . Amidst this host of new uncertainties
there appears to be wide-spread agreement, traversing all fault lines,
on one point, and one point only: that the “rule of law� is good for
everyone. . . . This apparent unanimity in support of the rule of law
is a feat unparalleled in history. No other single political ideal has
ever achieved global endorsement. . . . Notwithstanding its quick
and remarkable ascendance as a global ideal, however, the rule of
law is an exceedingly elusive notion. . . . If it is not already �rmly in
place, the rule of law appears mysteriously dif�cult to establish.�30
Tamanaha, in a somewhat more pessimistic assessment of the effects of
the law and development movement over the past �fty years, argues that the
fundamental problem confronting rule of law reformers is that factors that
influence law extend far beyond law itself. These factors include the history,
tradition, and culture of a society; its political and economic system; the dis-
tribution of wealth and power; the degree of industrialization of the ethnic,
linguistic, and religious compositions of the society; the level of education of
the populace; the extent of urbanization; and the geopolitical surroundings.
He calls this the “connectedness of law principle� and argues that discrete
rule of law reform initiatives typically ignore or discount the many intercon-
nections surrounding the formal and informal institutions and the broader
social context.31
Even after adopting a relatively minimalist or procedural conception
of the rule of law and an eclectic notion of the ends served by the rule of
law, recent studies provide extensive evidence of how little we know about
29 Yves Dezalay & Bryant Garth, Introduction, in Global Prescriptions: The Production, Exportation
and Importation of a New Legal Orthodoxy Vol. 1, 1 (Yves Dezalay & Bryant Garth ed., U. of
Michigan Press 2002).
30 Tamanaha, supra note 9, at 3.
31 Brian Z. Tamanaha, The Primacy of Society and the Failures of Law and Development: Decades of
Stubborn Refusal to Learn, Washington U. in St. Louis School of Law Faculty Research Paper
Series No. 10-03-02 (Mar. 26, 2010).
The Rule of Law and Development 215
promoting the rule of law in developing countries.32 After reviewing the evi-
dence, Carothers concludes:
The rapidly growing �eld of rule of law assistance is operating
from a very thin base of knowledge at every level—with respect to
the core rationale of the work, the question of where the essence of
the rule of law actually resides in different societies, how change of
rule of law occurs, and what the real effects are of changes that are
produced.33
In earlier work, Ron Daniels and I have hypothesized that the potential
impediments that countries may encounter in implementing even a limited,
procedural conception of the rule of law fall into four crude (and often over-
lapping) categories.34
Resource Constraints
The �rst of these impediments is technical or resource related. Despite po-
litical will on the part of their leadership and citizens, poor countries simply
lack the �nancial, technical, or specialized human capital resources needed to
implement good institutions generally, and legal institutions more speci�cally.
This lack of resources impairs a country’s development prospects (whatever
one’s conception of development) by making it poorer (in some relevant nor-
mative sense), which in turn further diminishes its ability to establish good
institutions, hence creating a vicious downward spiral.
With respect to such resource-related impediments, the general orientation
of reform requires more effective or ef�cient deployment of existing resources
devoted to a country’s legal system, a reordering of a country’s domestic pri-
orities and reallocation of resources from other areas of expenditure to the
legal system, or the infusion of resources from external donors (in the form of
�nancial assistance or technical advice and training and the like). Indeed, re-
garding the narrowly instrumental economic rationale for rule of law reform,
governments lacking the necessary resources should be prepared to borrow
the money required to fund the needed reforms and �nance borrowing costs
from future economic growth and increased tax revenues. However, other
obstacles are likely to exist.
32 See Carothers, supra note 28, and Thomas Carothers, The Problem of Knowledge, in Promot-
ing the Rule of Law Abroad: In Search of Knowledge 15 (Thomas Carothers ed., Carnegie En-
dowment for International Peace 2006); Beyond Common Knowledge: Empirical Approaches to
the Rule of Law (Erik G. Jensen & Thomas C. Heller ed., Stanford U. Press 2003), especially
Thomas Heller, An Immodest Postscript, in id., 382.
33 Thomas Carothers, The Problem of Knowledge, in Promoting the Rule of Law Abroad: In Search
of Knowledge 15, 27 (Thomas Carothers ed., Carnegie Endowment for International Peace
2006).
34 Trebilcock & Daniels, supra note 10. The following discussion is derived from this book.
216 The World Bank Legal Review
Social-Cultural-Historical Constraints
Another category of impediments to reform relates to a set of social or cultural
values, norms, attitudes, or practices that are inhospitable to even a limited
procedural conception of the rule of law.35 For example, Amir Licht, Chanan
Goldschmidt, and Shalom Schwartz, in a recent paper in which they correlate
scores on world value surveys with scores on rule of law, democracy, and
corruption indices, argue that societies that accord higher weight to social
embeddedness and hierarchy than to individual autonomy and egalitarian-
ism exhibit lower commitments to the rule of law, democracy, and noncor-
rupt governance, although there is signi�cant unexplained variance around
the mean.36 Whether culture is conceived of as a form of consciousness or as
a form of lawlike social norms, the policy prescriptions needed to overcome
this class of impediment are not nearly as obvious as in the case of technical
or resource-related obstacles, nor is any impact likely to be immediate, dra-
matic, or predictable. In other words, changing culture, however conceived,
may present at least as formidable a set of challenges as resource constraints
to changing laws and legal institutions, particularly if the purpose is to change
human behavior.37
An important historical perspective on the emergence of the rule of law
is presented in recent works by Douglas North, John Wallis, and Barry Wein-
gast38 and by Weingast, the latter of which has parallels with path-dependence
theories reviewed by Mariana Prado and me in a separate paper39 and over-
laps with political economy constraints, discussed below.40
According to North, Wallis, and Weingast, the most common social order
throughout history is the limited-access order or natural state, which solves
the problem of violence through rent creation, granting powerful individu-
als and groups valuable rights and privileges so that they have incentives to
cooperate rather than to �ght. The resulting rents, limits on competition, and
limited access to organizations hinder long-term economic and political de-
velopment of these societies. In contrast, open-access orders use competition
and open access to organizations and institutions to control violence and are
characterized by rent erosion and long-term growth.
35 See Rosa Ehrenreich Brooks, The New Imperialism: Violence, Norms, and the Rule of Law, 101
Mich. L. Rev. 2275 (2003); Amy Cohen, Thinking with Culture in Law and Development, 57 Buff.
L. Rev. 511 (2009).
36 Amir N. Licht, Chanan Goldschmidt, & Shalom H. Schwartz, Culture Rules: The Foundations
of the Rule of Law and Other Norms of Governance, 35 J. Comp. Econ. 659 (2007).
37 See Cohen, supra note 35.
38 Douglas North, John Wallis, & Barry Weingast, Violence and Social Order: A Conceptual Frame-
work for Understanding Recorded Human History (Cambridge U. Press 2009).
39 Mariana Prado & Michael Trebilcock, Path Dependence, Development, and the Dynamics of Insti-
tutional Reform, 59 U. Toronto L.J. 341 (2009).
40 Barry Weingast, Why Developing Countries Prove So Resistant to the Rule of Law, in Global
Perspectives on the Rule of Law 28 (James Heckman, Robert Nelson, & Lee Cabatingan ed.,
Routledge 2010). Much of the following discussion is drawn from this chapter.
The Rule of Law and Development 217
The authors argue that the transition from a limited-access order to an
open-access order is a “dif�cult process, and only two or two-and-a-half
dozen states have successfully completed it.� They divide the transition into
two parts, the “doorstep conditions� and the transition proper. There are three
doorstep conditions:
• Rule of law for elites
• The perpetual state (the creation of perpetually lived organizations)
• Consolidated control over violence and the military
The transition proper occurs when suf�cient numbers of people become
citizens in the sense that the state treats a large category of people imperson-
ally and identically. At the same time, processes must begin that afford citi-
zens access to organizations in both politics and economics, granting them the
ability to compete as they wish in either system.
In a subsequent paper, Weingast emphasizes two core aspects of the rule
of law. First, the impersonal aspects of law: the certainty or predictability of
the law, including the absence of arbitrary actions by the state against indi-
viduals; transparency; and the requirement that the state treat individuals
as citizens with equality before the law. Second, that the state be able to honor
these aspects of the rule of law tomorrow, even if it experiences turnover in
of�cials.
By this de�nition, natural states have substantial dif�culties creating the
rule of law. First, the rule of law contrasts with the typical natural state domi-
nated by personal relationships. Second, natural states have dif�culty creating
the predictability necessary for the rule of law. Third, natural states often seem
to act arbitrarily. Finally, and perhaps most important, natural states have
great dif�culty in providing credible enduring commitments.
According to Weingast, rule of law reforms virtually always fail for two
reasons: violence and the absence of perpetuity. Transplanting open-access-
order institutions—such as markets, elections, and legal systems—cannot
create an open-access order. These reforms seek to dismantle the natural state
systems of privilege and limited access, and therefore they threaten violence
and disorder. Rather than making everyone better off, as the reformers in-
tend, these reforms threaten to make everyone worse off. Also central to cre-
ating the rule of law is creating a perpetual state whose institutions, rules,
and policies do not depend on the identity of current of�cials or dominant
coalitions. The problem with natural states in the developing world is that
almost not one is a perpetual state. Thus, in order to gain the rule of law,
natural states must enter the transition from limited-access order to open-
access order. Fragile natural states must become basic ones; basic natural
states must become mature ones; and mature natural states must begin the
transition with the doorstep conditions. Only at this stage of development are
states capable of beginning to create the institutional and organizational basis
for the rule of law.
218 The World Bank Legal Review
Even though North, Wallis, and Weingast present an important histori-
cal approach to the relationship between culture and institutions, their argu-
ment seems rather deterministic and has a strong modernization theory fla-
vor, somewhat akin to Walt Rostow’s “stages of growth� theory.41 There are
good reasons to call attention to the path-dependence element of institutional
development (which may have little to do with deep-seated cultural values),
as discussed below. However, path dependent does not mean that societies are
stuck in a phased trajectory and that they will not be able to evolve unless they
follow all the steps in a prescribed sequence. Indeed, path dependence should
not dissuade citizens and decision makers in developing countries from pur-
suing institutional reforms, acknowledging that change will be dif�cult and
protracted, and outcomes unpredictable. A core element of path dependence
is that there is no linearity: societies are complex, and change will be unpre-
dictable. Thus, I do not subscribe to the sequence North, Wallis, and Wein-
gast offer (basic natural states, mature natural states, open-access societies)
because there are likely to be multiple equilibria, and progress will not be as
linear and predictable as the authors suggest.42
Political Economy Constraints
A third class of potential impediments to the effective implementation of even
a limited conception of the rule of law might be loosely characterized as poli-
tical economy–based impediments. Here the lack of effective political de-
mand for reforms, on the one hand, and vested supply-side interests, on the
other, render reforms politically dif�cult to realize even if (by assumption)
they would make most citizens better off in terms of their own values.
On the demand side, a procedurally oriented conception of the rule of law
has many of the attributes of the public good—“everybody’s business is no-
body’s business�—creating a major collective-action problem. In other words,
diffuse citizen commitment to the rule of law is unlikely to translate into ef-
fective political mobilization for reforms. Moreover, one should not naively
assume that all external constituencies are likely to bene�t from rule of law
reform; indeed, those who derive bene�ts from corruption, cronyism, favorit-
ism, and the like in existing institutional arrangements and legal processes are
likely to resist such changes.43
41 See, for a summary of the �ve stages of growth theory, Walt W. Rostow, The Stages of Economic
Growth: A Non-Communist Manifesto 4–17 (3d ed., Cambridge U. Press 1990).
42 See Prado & Trebilcock, supra note 39.
43 See Daniel Kaufmann, Rethinking Governance: Empirical Lessons Challenge Orthodoxy (dis-
cussion draft, Mar. 2003), available at ; Joel Hellman & Daniel Kaufmann, The Inequality of Influ-
ence (preliminary draft, Dec. 2002), available at ; Karla Hoff & Joseph Stiglitz, After the Big Bang?
Obstacles to the Emergence of the Rule of Law in Post-Communist Societies, 94 Am. Econ. Rev. 753
(2004).
The Rule of Law and Development 219
Curtis Milhaupt and Katharina Pistor emphasize the importance of the
demand side,44 arguing that the economic literature implicitly considers only
the supply of law in a given society, largely neglecting the role of demand. The
authors suggest that because the relation between law and markets functions
according to a continuous feedback loop, the causal connection runs both
ways and there is “endogeneity� in the relationship. Law can play an impor-
tant coordination function in markets, and it can enhance the credibility of
state-supplied governance structures. Milhaupt and Pistor conclude that the
demand for law as a governance device is likely to be affected by the extent
to which potentially effective constituencies are allowed to participate in law
making and law enforcement and to promote legal adaptations to changing
economic and social conditions.
On the supply side are vested or incumbent interests in institutions or
processes that do not comport even with a minimalist, procedurally oriented
conception of the rule of law. For example, a corrupt or incompetent judiciary,
public prosecution, police, correctional system, tax administration, or other
specialized law enforcement, administrative, or regulatory agency, as well as
a member of a private bar or legal education institution, is likely to resist re-
forms that threaten its interests.
The critical relationship between the rule of law and issues of political
economy is insightfully articulated by José Maravall and Adam Przeworski:
To develop a positive conception of the rule of law one must start
with political forces, their goals, their organization and their context.
It is not stability that distinguishes the rule of law but the distribu-
tion of power. When power is monopolized, the law is at most an
instrument of the rule of someone. Only if conflicting political actors
seek to resolve their conflicts by recourse to law does law rule. Rule
of law emerges when self-interested rulers willingly restrain them-
selves and make their behaviour predictable in order to obtain sus-
tained, voluntary cooperation of well-organized groups command-
ing valuable resources. In exchange for such cooperation, rulers will
protect the interests of these groups by legal means . . .
The difference between rule by law and rule of law lies in the distri-
bution of power, the dispersion of material resources, the multipli-
cation of organized interests; in societies that approximate the rule
of law, no group becomes so strong as to dominate the others, and
law, rather than reflect the interests of a single group, is used by
the many. The rule of law is conceivable only if institutions tame
or transform brute power. As organized interests multiply, a society
will come closer to the rule of law, power will not be monopolized,
and the law will not be used by the few against the many.45
44 Curtis J. Milhaupt & Katharina Pistor, Law & Capitalism: What Corporate Crises Reveal about
Legal Systems and Economic Development around the World (U. of Chicago Press 2008).
45 José MarÃa Maravall & Adam Przeworski, Introduction, in Democracy and the Rule of Law 1, 2–4
(José MarÃa Maravall & Adam Przeworski ed., Cambridge U. Press 2003).
220 The World Bank Legal Review
Stephen Holmes similarly argues:
Why do people with power accept limits to their power? An even
more pointed formulation is: why do people with guns obey peo-
ple without guns? An economic twist is: why would the rich ever
voluntarily part with a portion of their wealth? In legal theory, the
parallel question runs: why do politicians sometimes hand power to
judges? Why do politicians allow judges, who control neither purse
nor sword, to overturn and obstruct their decisions and sometimes
even to send of�ce-holders to jail? . . . Societies may approximate
the rule of law if they consist of a large number of power-wielding
groups, comprising a majority of the population, and if none of them
become so strong as to be able thoroughly to dominate the others.
We may be able to loosen the grip of a few organized interests on
power by forcing them to share political leverage with a variety of
other groups. This is polyarchy; it is also rough justice, the only kind
human beings will ever experience. Formulated differently, the bal-
ancing of many partialities is the closest we can come to impartiality.
This may not sound particularly ideal, but it is nevertheless histori-
cally quite rare and very dif�cult to achieve.46
Legal Origins Constraints
Another explanation for the puzzle of differential legal performance is associ-
ated with the rapidly proliferating body of literature, principally in the �nancial
development �eld, that focuses on whether legal origins have influenced coun-
tries’ �nancial development, with the assertion that legal origins are a major
determinant of rates of economic growth. In a widely cited paper in 1997,47 fol-
lowed by similar works, LaPorta, Lopez-De-Silanes, Shleifer, and Vishny (fre-
quently referred to as LLSV),48 assert a causal linkage between legal origins and
�nancial development and, indirectly, economic growth. This claim is largely
based on cross-country studies that purport to show that judicial systems based
on common law have developed more sophisticated �nancial institutions and
�nancial markets than those based on civil law. Among civil law jurisdictions,
the French civil law system has lagged behind others, including those of Ger-
many and Scandinavia. The authors conclude that countries with more sophis-
ticated �nancial markets generally recognize more extensive shareholder and
creditor rights and that common law jurisdictions are superior in these respects
to civil law jurisdictions, in particular to the system in France.
LLSV rely on two interrelated mechanisms through which legal origin in-
fluences �nance. The political mechanism holds that (a) legal traditions differ
46 Stephen Holmes, Lineages of the Rule of Law, in Democracy and the Rule of Law 19, 24 (José Marîa
Maravall & Adam Przeworski ed., Cambridge U. Press 2003).
47 Rafael LaPorta, Florencio Lopez-De-Silanes, Andrei Shleifer, & Robert W. Vishny, Legal Deter-
minants of External Finance, 52 J. Finance 1131 (1997).
48 Rafael LaPorta, Florencio Lopes-De-Silanes, & Andrei Shleifer, The Economic Consequences of
Legal Origins, National Bureau of Economic Research Working Paper No. 13608 (2007).
The Rule of Law and Development 221
in terms of the priority they attach to private property, compared with the
rights of the state (or as the authors put it, “common law stands for the strat-
egy of social control that seeks to support private market outcomes, whereas
civil law seeks to replace such outcomes with state-desired allocations�); and
(b) the protection of private contracting rights forms the basis of �nancial de-
velopment. The adaptability mechanism stresses that (a) legal traditions differ
in their formalism and ability to evolve with changing conditions; and (b) legal
traditions that adapt ef�ciently to minimize the gap between the contracting
needs of the economy and the legal system’s capabilities will more effectively
foster �nancial development than more rigid systems.
This literature49 is persuasively critiqued by Kenneth Dam, The Law-
Growth Nexus: The Rule of Law in Economic Development.50 In this book, Dam
points out that the regulation of shareholder and creditor rights in most ju-
risdictions (civil and common law) is a matter of relatively recent statutes
and not common law or private law civil codes, and thus drawing sharp dif-
ferences between civil and common law systems on this account is unwar-
ranted.51 Dam also notes that France enjoyed more rapid per capita economic
growth than Britain from 1820 to 1998 as a whole; recent governance studies
by the World Bank �nd legal origins to have a small-to-nonexistent impact on
the quality of the rule of law or economic growth records, especially among
poorer countries;52 and the much broader governance measures employed by
the World Bank provide a more helpful framework of analysis for an insti-
tutional reform agenda. In a similar vein, Gillian Had�eld, in “The Levers of
Legal Design: Institutional Determinants of the Quality of Law,�53 argues that
the binary classi�cation of legal systems as either common law or civil law
obscures many institutional differences that do not closely track this binary
categorization.
Based on recent comparative legal research with which I have been
associated,54 the performance of common law systems in former colonies that
inherited these systems from their British imperial overseers varies markedly
on numerous measures, including contemporary appraisals of the rule of law.
Thus, variations in performance within legal families are often much greater
49 The empirical evidence that proponents and critics rely on is masterfully surveyed in a paper
by Thorsten Beck & Ross Levine, Legal Institutions and Financial Development, in Handbook of
New Institutional Economics 251 (Claude Ménard & Mary M. Shirley ed., Springer 2008).
50 Kenneth Dam, The Law-Growth Nexus: The Rule of Law in Economic Development 26–55 (Brook-
ings Institution Press 2006).
51 See also Mark Roe, Legal Origins, Politics and Modern Stock Markets, 120 Harv. L. Rev. 460
(2006).
52 See Kaufmann, supra note 1.
53 Gillian Had�eld, The Levers of Legal Design: Institutional Determinants of the Quality of Law, 36
J. Comp. Econ. 43 (2006); see also Symposium, Economics and Comparative Law, 59 U. Toronto
L.J. 179 (2009).
54 Ron Daniels, Michael Trebilcock, & Lindsey Carson, The Legacy of Empire: The Common Law
Inheritance and Commitments to Legality in Former British Colonies, 59 Am. J. Comp. L. 111
(2011).
222 The World Bank Legal Review
than variations between them. This suggests that many variables other than
legal origins alone explain subsequent legal performance, in particular, I
argue, the degree to which the British colonial authorities afforded repre-
sentation to the indigenous population in legislative bodies, and the extent
to which indigenous and British common law courts and animating values
were integrated, thereby fostering the development of a localized common
law jurisprudence.
A Brief Review of Rule of Law Reform Experience
I now turn to a brief review (elaborated on elsewhere)55 of the ef�cacy of
recent reforms to legal institutions in Latin America, Africa, Central and East-
ern Europe, and Asia, relating these reform efforts to notions of path depen-
dence that Mariana Prado and I have reviewed in a separate publication.56
Although path dependence in its purest form is constraining and deter-
ministic, we are not prisoners of our past. Mariana Prado and I have argued
that path dependence provides insights for those promoting institutional
reforms. Indeed, the path-dependence literature provides a wealth of infor-
mation for those promoting institutional reforms. First, the concepts of self-
reinforcing mechanisms and switching costs, for instance, show that reforms
in key institutional nodes of any system are likely to fail if they do not address
both the nature and the scale of switching costs faced by internal and external
actors engaged in or with these institutions. Second, to the extent that par-
ticular institutions have become embedded, over time, in a broader matrix
of mutually reinforcing institutional interdependencies, nodal reform that ig-
nores this fact is likely to be further compromised. Third, the concept of criti-
cal junctures shows that comprehensive or ambitious reforms in minimally
functional institutions (or networks of institutions) during “normal times� can
be disruptive and are likely to be strongly resisted by affected stakeholders.
As path-dependence theory emphasizes, much institutional change will be
incremental and will occur on the margins; indeed, attempting too much may
be a recipe for achieving too little.
Judicial Reform
A prominent focus of rule of law reforms has been judicial reform such as
reducing court backlogs, which are large and growing in many developing
countries. Reform efforts to this end have involved improving court record
keeping through enhanced information technology and more proactive case-
management techniques. Complementary reform initiatives have often in-
volved externally supported judicial training programs.57 In some cases, these
55 See Trebilcock & Daniels, supra note 10.
56 See Prado & Trebilcock, supra note 39.
57 Trebilcock & Daniels, supra note 10.
The Rule of Law and Development 223
initiatives have had a positive impact on court backlogs, although various
scholars have noted that enhancing judicial capacity by increasing the volume
of cases processed says little or nothing about the quality of judicial decision
making.58 Judicial corruption and incompetence are endemic in many devel-
oping countries, particularly at lower levels of the court systems and outside
major urban centers. Reform efforts have barely penetrated these courts and
are thus largely ineffective, because most citizens have contact (if any at all)
only with courts at the lowest level of the system.59
One persistent challenge is that reforms often ignore self-reinforcing
mechanisms at the individual level, where the belief systems or patterns of
behavior on the part of internal and external actors may have adjusted to the
former institutional arrangement and might not readily adapt to the new re-
gime. These forms of adaptive behavior will likely increase the costs of mov-
ing to a new system because they will generate resistance to reforms akin to
the “installed base problem� (for example, the resistance to moving from an
imperial to a metric system of weights and measures).60
Legal Education
Individual belief systems or patterns of behavior are often reinforced by legal
education. Historically, such education in many developing countries has fo-
cused heavily on rote learning and regurgitation on exams.61 In Latin America,
many public law schools suffer from overpopulation and too many part-time
students and instructors.62 Although private law schools have recently prolif-
erated in many developing countries, they are of highly variable quality, rang-
ing from internationally recognized law schools to those offering only part-
time degrees or considered to be diploma mills. Legal education institutions
in Central and Eastern Europe have historically been tightly controlled by the
state, which has led to a standardized, inflexible, and increasingly inappropri-
ate legal curriculum.63 In some countries in this region, with the support of
international nongovernmental organizations (NGOs) and other institutions,
58 See Heller, supra note 32.
59 Id.
60 The term “installed base� refers to early adopters of a technology, who will bear a dispro-
portionate share of transient incompatibility costs and may therefore resist the adoption of
a newer technology. The larger the installed base, the more inertia it will generate. Joseph
Farrell & Garth Saloner, Installed Base and Compatibility: Innovation, Product Preannouncements,
and Predation, 76 Am. Econ. Rev. 940 (1986).
61 Trebilcock & Daniels, supra note 10, at 307–31; Joseph Tome, Heading South but Looking North:
Globalization and Law Reform in Latin America, Wis. L. Rev. 691 (2000); Cheng Han Tan et al.,
Legal Education in Asia, 1 Asian J. Comp. L. 17 (2006).
62 Stephen Meili, Legal Education in Argentina and Chile, in Educating for Justice around the World:
Legal Education, Legal Practice and the Community 138, 142 (Louise G. Trubek & Jeremy Cooper
ed., Aldershot 1999).
63 See George E. Glos, Soviet Law and Soviet Legal Education in an Historical Context: An Interpreta-
tion, 15 Rev. Socialist L. 227, 257 (1989); Susan Finder, Legal Education in the Soviet Union, 15
Rev. Socialist L. 197, 207 (1989).
224 The World Bank Legal Review
efforts have been made to reform the curriculum to be more relevant to new
economic, social, and political environments and to reduce or eliminate the
ideological connection between law and the state that prevailed in the com-
munist era.64
Legal education in Africa is extremely varied with respect to institutional
support, funding, and curriculum development. South Africa, a relatively rich
nation, has a considerable legal education infrastructure, but continues to suf-
fer from underfunding and the low quality of historically black institutions.
Many other African countries have much weaker legal education systems that
contend with a serious lack of resources, including such basic resources as
teaching and library materials. As in Latin America, many African law schools
continue to emphasize rote learning, although signi�cant efforts have been
made recently to incorporate both clinical legal education and human rights
dimensions into some law school curricula.65 In many Asian countries, there
are a large number of legal education institutions that are of widely variable
quality, with a dramatic proliferation of these schools in China in particular.66
Resistance to legal reforms in many developing countries seems attrib-
utable in part to the vested interests of the professors, judges, and existing
practitioners who seek to insulate themselves from curriculum changes or
substantive or procedural reforms of the existing legal system, in part because
these might entail a depreciation of their existing human capital and require
investments in retraining and retooling. Lawyers who were trained and prac-
tice, adjudicate, or teach in a socially dysfunctional legal system and have
made substantial investments in human capital in learning how to function in
such a system are often not a progressive force for legal reform.
A more general problem with judicial reforms is that they do not account
for relevant macroprocesses that connect what happens inside the courtroom
with events that precede or succeed the courtroom proceedings (for example,
the enforcement of judgments). In particular, recent rule of law reforms often
neglect the most relevant law enforcement agency, the police force, despite the
fact that historically in many countries the police have been viewed as a form
of paramilitary organization, primarily dedicated to regime maintenance in
64 European Commission: Education and Training, available at ; Louis F. Del. Duca, Cooperation in Internationalizing Legal Education in
Europe—Emerging New Players, 20 Penn. St. Intl. L. Rev. 9 (2001).
65 Manu Ndulo, Legal Education in Africa in the Era of Globalization and Structural Adjustment, 20
Penn. St. Intl. L. Rev. 489 (2002); Philip F. Iya, From Lecture Room to Practice: Addressing the
Challenges of Reconstructing and Regulating Legal Education and Legal Practice in the New South
Africa, Third World Legal Studies 141, 144, 151 (2000–03).
66 Tan et al., supra note 61; Mei-Ying Hung, China’s WTO Commitment on Independent Judicial Re-
view: Impact on Legal and Political Reform, 52 Am. J. Comp. L. 77 ( 2004); Vincent Cheng Tang,
Judicial and Legal Training in China: Current Status of Professional Development and Topics of Hu-
man Rights, China-OHCHR National Workshop for Lawyers and Judges (2002), available at
(citing the
of�cial China News Net Report on Chinese Legal Aid System Basically Formed, 600,000
People Aided in 5 Years, Sep. 29, 2002).
The Rule of Law and Development 225
societies dominated by military or authoritarian governments.67 This has made
policing of secondary importance in many developing and transitional econo-
mies and has led incumbent political regimes to support or at least acquiesce
in extensive human rights abuses by police forces, including torture, coerced
confessions, inde�nite detention without trial, and rampant corruption.68
In an attempt to deal with this abuse, modest efforts have been made in
some countries to implement civilian police oversight mechanisms and reform
criminal procedure laws.69 These laws, at least in theory, enable courts to act
as a check on these forms of abuse, through, for example, rules that deem evi-
dence to be inadmissible when obtained illegally. However, in practice, courts
in these countries have not been assertive monitors of abuses of public of-
�ce, in part because of their historical subservience to the executive branch of
government in terms of appointments, promotions, and resources.70 Attempts
at strengthening judicial independence through the creation of semiautono-
mous judicial councils to vet appointments and promotions and to maintain
a disciplinary regime for judicial misconduct have often been met with �erce
resistance from the executive and legislative branches of government, as well
as the judiciary itself.71
Correctional Institutions
The problem of ignoring elements of the legal system, such as the police, in
rule of law promotion strategies is replicated in penal reform efforts.72 These
reforms seek to improve correctional institutions in developing countries and
transition economies while ignoring these institutions’ relationship with the
criminal justice system. Reform efforts in this context have focused on de-
veloping correctional institutions as professional public establishments, often
through training programs for correctional personnel provided by interna-
tional agencies and NGOs and the provision of paralegal advisory services to
67 Article 1 of United Nations Code of Conduct for Law Enforcement Of�cials, adopted by the
General Assembly in 1979, GA Res. 34/169, UN GAOR, 34th Sess., Supp. No. 46, UN Doc.
A/34/46 (1979); Rachel Nield, Confronting a Culture of Impunity: The Promise and Pitfalls of Ci-
vilian Review of Police in Latin America, in Civilian Oversight of Policing: Governance, Democracy
and Human Rights 223 (Andrew Goldsmith & Colleen Lewis ed., Hart 2000).
68 Mercedes S. Hinton, A Distant Reality: Democratic Policing in Argentina and Brazil, 5(1) Crim.
Justi. 75, 95 (2005); Paul Chevigny, De�ning the Role of the Police in Latin America, in The (Un)
Rule of Law and the Underprivileged in Latin America 49 (Juan E. Mendez, Guillermo O’Donnell,
& Paulo Sergio Pinheiro ed., U. of Notre Dame Press 1999).
69 Colleen Lewis, The Politics of Civilian Oversight: Serious Commitment or Lip Service? in Civil-
ian Oversight of Policing: Governance, Democracy and Human Rights 19 (Andrew Goldsmith &
Colleen Lewis ed., Hart 2000).
70 Nield, supra note 67.
71 See Linn Hammergren, Do Judicial Councils Further Judicial Reform? Lessons from Latin America,
Carnegie Endowment for International Peace Working Paper No. 28 (Apr. 2002).
72 Standard Minimum Rules for the Treatment of Prisoners, adopted by the First United Na-
tions Congress on the Prevention of Crime and the Treatment of Offenders, held in Geneva
in 1955, and approved by the Economic and Social Council by its resolution 663 C(XXIV) of
July 31, 1957, and 2076 (LXII) of May 13, 1977.
226 The World Bank Legal Review
inmates to advise them of their rights as prisoners relating to abuses suffered
within correctional institutions and their related legal rights under the coun-
try’s criminal justice system.73 Some countries, especially in Latin America,
have appointed of�cial ombudsmen to investigate prisoners’ complaints and
report thereon to government, while in other countries (such as several in
sub-Saharan Africa), pursuant to regional treaty commitments, of�cial rap-
porteurs make periodic visits to correctional institutions and report publicly
on conditions therein.74
Historically, the role of prisons in many countries was tied principally not
to crime, punishment, or rehabilitation, but to suppressing political opposi-
tion and/or extracting labor from vast populations of captive workers (es-
pecially in the former Soviet Union). Severe prison overcrowding has been a
chronic problem, leading to a very high incidence of infectious diseases such
as HIV/AIDS and tuberculosis.75 However, prison reform efforts focused on
correctional institutions often ignore the fact that a signi�cant source of the
overcrowding problem in correctional institutions in many developing coun-
tries is the high percentage of inmates held on remand awaiting trial for of-
ten lengthy periods due to the inef�ciencies in the broader criminal justice
system. Where reforms to the criminal justice system have been undertaken,
for example, providing judges with greater discretion to impose noncustodial
forms of sentences, the judiciary has often shown a reluctance to invoke these
powers, particularly in contexts of widespread public concern over high and
rising violent-crime rates.76 Thus, as with other reform efforts, penal reform
efforts need to deal with the prison institution’s relationship to the broader
criminal justice system.
Corrections, dealing as it does with a small and marginalized subset of the
population, is (perhaps more than any other institution) inextricable from the
broader successes and failures of the wider rule of law reform. Penal reform
depends, at least in part, on the ef�ciency of court processes, the effective-
ness of law enforcement, the broader complex of social factors determining
crime rates more generally, a vigorous legal bar willing to defend prisoners’
rights, and a culture of human rights robust enough to conceptualize prison-
ers within its ambit.
73 Penal and Prison Reform in Africa, vols. 13–14 Political Risk Insurance Newsletter 5 (Apr.
2001).
74 The United Nations Latin American Institute for the Prevention of Crime and Treatment of
Offenders, ILANUD Activities in 2002 and 2003 Work Programme.
75 See the Introduction to the Draft Inter-American Declaration Governing the Rights and the Care of
Persons Deprived of Liberty, developed by the government of Costa Rica in conjunction with
Penal Reform International; Centre for the Study of Violence and Reconciliation, Annual Re-
port 2001/2002 Criminal Justice Programme (2002), available at .
76 Mark Ungar, Prisons and Politics in Contemporary Latin America 25 Hum. Rights Q. 909, 912
(2003).
The Rule of Law and Development 227
Administrative Agencies
Other relevant institutional interconnections involve bureaucracy. In both de-
veloped and developing countries, important aspects of the administration of
justice are vested in specialized law enforcement or administrative agencies
that deal with matters as diverse as tax administration, public utilities regu-
lation, environmental regulation, competition law enforcement, and election
management bodies. These agencies are more easily detachable from the ex-
isting bureaucracy, entailing less complex or sweeping reforms that therefore
may be less likely to suffer from path-dependence problems.
Tax administration is a specialized law enforcement or regulatory function
that is weak in most developing countries and hence provides an important
example of the challenges that these countries face.77 Effective tax administra-
tion is of critical importance to all developing countries because a constrained
ability to collect revenues legally due limits a government’s ability to fund
development priorities. In many countries, the gap between taxes nomi-
nally due and taxes actually collected is extremely large—often in the range
of 40 percent—suggesting great potential for improved tax administration
performance.
To improve the tax system, a number of developing countries have set
up large taxpayer units (LTUs) with a view to building specialized and inte-
grated expertise in tax assessment, given that LTUs are the source of much of
the effective taxable capacity. In addition, a number of countries have also set
up semiautonomous revenue agencies (SARAs), designed to ensure the �scal
autonomy of the organization and greater freedom in personnel policies and
information technology development.78 These reforms appear to have been
successful in broadening the taxpayer base and increasing the percentage
of taxes nominally due that are actually collected. However, the experience
with SARAs over time has been mixed—typically, these agencies are initially
successful in increasing tax collection, but their performance tends to de-
cline in effectiveness, in some cases because of rampant corruption within
the agency,79 and in other cases because of increasing political interference
from the ministry of �nance or other executive arm of the government in
personnel and assessment processes.80 This trend suggests that the ability
of these agencies to maintain themselves over time as “islands of virtue� in
77 Malcolm Gillis, Tax Reform: Lessons from Postwar Experience in Developing Nations, in Tax Re-
form in Developing Countries 492, 493 (Malcolm Gillis ed., Duke U. Press 1989); for examples
from India, Indonesia, Mexico, Singapore, Spain, and the Philippines, see Arindam Das-
Gupta & Dilip Mukherjee, Incentives and Institutional Reforms in Tax Enforcement: An Analysis
of Developing Country Experience (Oxford U. Press 1998).
78 Trebilcock & Daniels, supra note 10, at 200–235.
79 Susan Rose-Ackerman, Corruption and Government: Causes, Consequences, and Reform 86
(Cambridge U. Press 1999) (showing that in tax reform, incentive schemes can be used only
if levels of performance can be measured by external monitors).
80 Robert Taliercio, Jr., Unsustainably Autonomous? Challenges to the Revenue Authority Model in
Latin America Tax Agencies in Developing Countries (World Bank 2001).
228 The World Bank Legal Review
an otherwise corrupt or incompetent general public administration may be
quite limited without complementary reforms, over time, of the surrounding
institutional matrix.
Another similarly motivated example of reforms is the implementation
of independent regulatory agencies (IRAs) for infrastructure sectors, such as
telecommunications, electricity, and water. During the 1990s U.S.-style IRAs
were created in many Latin American countries81 to insulate regulatory deci-
sions from electoral politics. To secure this insulation, IRAs were accorded a
series of institutional guarantees of independence. For instance, in presiden-
tial systems, these guarantees would include �xed terms of of�ce for commis-
sioners, congressional approval of presidential nominations, and alternative
sources of funds to ensure �nancial autonomy.82 In the context of privatization
of state-owned utility companies, this insulation was intended to provide a
credible commitment by the government to existing rules and norms, theoreti-
cally protecting investors from arbitrary and unjusti�able subsequent modi�-
cations in the regulatory framework.
However, the establishment of U.S.-style IRAs has met with a series of
obstacles.83 In some cases, their creation was resisted by bureaucrats who were
also opposed to privatization and a competitive environment in infrastruc-
ture services, thereby exemplifying high switching costs and the installed base
problem. In other cases, the transfer of civil servants from the preexisting bu-
reaucracy to the IRAs brought deeply embedded practices that are dif�cult
to change, impairing some of the institutional innovations adopted by IRAs,
such as those designed to insulate these agencies from political and electoral
interests. This reality illustrates the dif�culty of mitigating self-reinforcing
mechanisms, especially when they are embedded in the institutional culture.
Finally, some of the institutional guarantees of independence in these agencies
were not effective due to the fact that they were operating in a different insti-
tutional matrix from the country of origin of the transplant. Thus, the creation
of IRAs largely ignored the importance of institutional interconnections.
A related class of administrative agency is competition agencies.84 About
sixty mainly developing or transitioning countries have competition agencies
that are �fteen years old or younger.85 The World Bank reports that a 2000 sur-
81 Jacint Jordana & David Levi-Faur, Hacia un estado regulador Latinoamericano? La difusión de
agencias reguladoras autónomas por paises e sectores (2005). See also Giandomenico Majone, The
Rise of the Regulatory State in Europe, 17 West Eur. Pol. 77 (1994) (discussing the European
experience).
82 Warrick Smith, Utility Regulators—the Independence Debate, Public Policy for the Pri-
vate Sector, note 127 (Oct. 1997), available at .
83 Mariana Mota Prado, The Challenges and Risks of Creating Independent Regulatory Agencies: A
Cautionary Tale from Brazil, 41Vand. J. Transnatl. L. 435 (2008).
84 For a recent survey, see Michael Trebilcock & Edward Iacobucci, Designing Competition Law
Institutions: Values, Structure, and Mandate, 41 Loy. U. Chi. L.J. 455 (2010).
85 A recent survey and analysis of the competition laws of 102 countries found mild prelimi-
The Rule of Law and Development 229
vey found that, on average, competition agencies in industrial countries are
40 percent more effective than competition authorities in developing
countries.86 Surveys or evaluations of the experience of such agencies by the
Competition Policy Implementation Working Group of the International
Competition Network (ICN),87 and the International Development Research
Centre (Ottawa)88 have identi�ed a number of challenges in this regard.
First, many countries have borrowed heavily from developed countries
in designing their respective laws, and the legislative framework does not ad-
dress effectively the realities of the jurisdiction that these agencies are called
upon to regulate. Some statutes fail to deal with important anticompetitive
forms of conduct because of carve-outs or exceptions for industrial policy, po-
litical economy, or other reasons. Others are expansive in their scope, but fail
to establish any set of priorities for the agency consistent with its resources
and capabilities. Others do not provide for the compulsory ex ante noti�ca-
tion of mergers, while others set noti�cation thresholds so low that agencies
are overwhelmed with merger noti�cations that they are not able to review
effectively. In yet other cases, agencies are not invested with adequate inves-
tigative powers to unearth and eliminate anticompetitive conduct; they are
unable to enforce compulsory disclosure laws successfully and lack powers
to grant immunities to facilitate cartel investigations. In yet others, �nes and
other penalties are too low to induce effective deterrence or cannot be effec-
tively enforced.
Second, young agencies commonly report a lack of cooperation and coor-
dination of policy and effort from particular government ministries and other
regulatory bodies in their attempt to enforce and promote competition policy,
in part as a result of the recent introduction of competition laws without provi-
sions that address prior conflicting legislation or sectoral regulatory regimes.
In some cases, these problems have been partly mitigated by memoranda of
understanding with other agencies as to respective roles and responsibilities.
Third, many agencies in developing countries face major obstacles in
dealing with cross-border anticompetitive conduct, especially international
cartels, and often lack formal and informal cooperative mechanisms with
nary support for the claim that competition law has a positive, albeit quite limited, effect
on the intensity of competition within a nation. Much of the impact appears to be due to
the strength of enforcement in particular areas rather than the scope of the substantive law,
largely through reducing collusive practices. The study �nds that merger or abuse of domi-
nance law does not seem to enhance competition intensity. Keith N. Hylton & Fei Deng, An-
titrust around the World: An Empirical Analysis of the Scope of Competition Laws and Their Effects,
74 Antitrust L.J. 271 (2007).
86 World Bank, World Development Report 2002: Building Institutions for Markets 141 (Oxford U.
Press 2001).
87 International Competition Network, Implementation Working Group, Lessons to Be Learnt
from the Experiences of Young Competition Agencies (May 2006).
88 Taimoon Stewart, Julilan Clarke, & Susan Joekes, Competition Law in Action: Experiences from
Developing Countries (International Development Research Centre May 2007).
230 The World Bank Legal Review
those countries’ authorities that have more effective jurisdiction over potential
wrongdoers.
Fourth, many agencies responding to the ICN survey pointed to numer-
ous challenges relating to the interface between the competition authority and
the judiciary and reported that cases often take years to process, partly as a
result of a lack of specialized competence among public prosecutors, attor-
neys, and the local judiciary. An earlier ICN survey of competition agencies in
developing and transition economies noted that
the all but unanimous view expressed is that the judiciary is a major
stumbling block in the path of effective competition enforcement—
the judges do not understand competition law and are content to
avoid the necessity to learn through diverting competition issues
into a maze of esoteric administrative and procedural side-streets
out of which the substantive matters at issue rarely emerge.89
Fifth, many new agencies suffer from extreme �nancial and human re-
source constraints that pose major challenges in priority setting, as well as
political cronyism, which compromises the quality of key appointments. De-
veloping and retaining specialized human capital within agencies and comple-
mentary educational and professional institutions are pressing challenges.90
Finally, the studies note the lack of a competition culture in many of the
jurisdictions in which these new agencies operate, reflected in an unaware-
ness of the rules of competition law among the business community, govern-
ment agencies, nongovernment agencies, the media, the judiciary, and the
general public. There is also a general ignorance of the overall responsibility
to ensure that such rules are observed in the interest of competition and eco-
nomic development. Many of these new agencies are operating in economies
in transition from command to market-based economies, with major state-
owned enterprises (SOEs) or recently privatized SOEs often operating in high-
ly concentrated sectors. In many developing countries with long histories of
state-led development policies and import substitution policies that severely
restrict import competition and foreign investment, extensive state-owned en-
terprises and highly concentrated economic sectors are subject to extensive
price, entry, and exit regulation, which implies that both within and outside
government there are substantial vested interests that are antithetical to effec-
tive competition.91 An earlier ICN report concluded:
89 International Competition Network Working Group, Capacity Building and Technical As-
sistance: Building Credible Competition Authorities in Developing and Transition Economies 35
(Jun. 23–25, 2003).
90 See Daniel Sokol, The Development of Human Capital in Latin American Competition Policy, in
Competition Law and Policy in Latin America 13 (Eleanor Fox & Daniel Sokol ed., Hart 2009).
91 See Ignacio de Leon, A Market Process Analysis of Latin American Competition Policy, available
at .
The Rule of Law and Development 231
In the end, we have been persuaded that the over-arching challenge
confronting competition authorities in developing and transition
countries relates to their stature and standing within the ranks of
key stakeholders or interest groups, as well as the public at large. In
other words, all struggle to make themselves heard and it is this that
constitutes the gravest challenge confronting competition authori-
ties in these countries.92
I have reviewed elsewhere the empirical evidence on the ef�cacy of an
instrumental (property rights/contract enforcement) conception of the rule
of law and do not explore it here.93 However, it is important to note here sig-
ni�cant discon�rming evidence of the causal relationship between the rule of
law and instrumental development outcomes, especially at relatively early
stages of economic development. In particular, it is worth noting the so-called
China enigma: over the past three decades China, has attracted enormous
levels of domestic and foreign investment and recorded historically unprec-
edented growth rates, despite its mediocre rankings on conventional rule of
law criteria.
Identifying Feasible Reform Strategies
Approaches to rule of law reforms that do not take into account adaptive be-
havior with respect to the particular institutional context, as well as mutually
reinforcing effects among interdependent institutions, are unlikely to be suc-
cessful. If one takes path dependence seriously, future reform strategies will
be signi�cantly constrained and shaped by the legacies of history. The lessons
of path dependence lead to a conundrum because path dependence shows
that isolated institutional reforms focused on microprocesses are likely to ig-
nore both self-reinforcing mechanisms and institutional interdependencies,
and are therefore often doomed to failure. However, systemwide ambitious
reforms during “normal times� are also disruptive and likely to fail because
of the serious switching costs that they are likely to entail (and the resistance
that these will engender). Thus, despite institutional interdependencies, all-
encompassing reforms are simply not feasible. This is true during normal
times, and there seems to be evidence that even in postconflict societies (which
may present more opportunities or at least greater urgency for change),
all-encompassing reforms often achieve very limited success.94
Are reformers then left only with windows of opportunities (critical junc-
tures) in which major reforms can be successfully implemented? Is there any
92 International Competition Network Working Group, supra note 89, at 74.
93 See, further, Michael Trebilcock & Paul-Erik Veel, Property Rights and Development: The Con-
tingent Case for Formalization, 30 U. Pa. J. Intl. L. 397 (2008); Michael Trebilcock & Jing Leng,
The Role of Formal Contract Law and Enforcement in Economic Development, 92 Va. L. Rev. 1517
(2006).
94 Marina Ottaway, The Post-War “Democratic Reconstruction Model�: Why It Can’t Work, Paper
presented at United States Institute for Peace (2002).
232 The World Bank Legal Review
way that reformers can take note of the lessons of path-dependence theory
without being in a potentially eternal waiting period for the right moment? As
Dani Rodrik puts it, “the challenge for the empirical literature on institutions
is to explore these [path-dependent] patterns without falling into the trap of
reductionism or of historical and geographical determinism.�95
There are two potential (and complementary) strategies for dealing with
this conundrum. First, reformers may be able to identify some institutions
that can be more easily detached from a broader mutually reinforcing insti-
tutional matrix or be created de novo (such as semiautonomous revenue
agencies, new constitutional or human rights courts or commissions, semi-
independent regulatory agencies, or one-stop government agencies, like the
Brazilian Poupatempo)96 for issuing, for example, passports, driver’s licens-
es, identi�cation cards, and health cards, and providing alternative forms of
dispute resolution.97 This strategy may enable more ambitious stand-alone re-
forms that nevertheless have important showcase effects with lower switching
costs or greater bene�ts than skeptics had assumed, although even here the
experience with semiautonomous revenue and independent regulatory agen-
cies suggests that these institutions are likely to be fragile in the absence of
complementary reforms, over time, to the surrounding institutional matrix.
The second strategy is to reform existing institutions that are intercon-
nected and mutually reinforcing by limiting reforms to certain core changes,
followed in the future by complementary reforms to reinforce the initial ef-
forts. This strategy implies that reforms should be incremental, which is quite
different from many current reform practices that are either stand-alone or so
sweeping as to be infeasible.
One of the lessons of path dependence is that we are not writing on a
blank slate. It is true that in certain times, or at critical junctures—for example,
the aftermath of economic collapse, civil war, or military invasion—the cred-
ibility and legitimacy of incumbent elites may be weakened, creating new
political openings for marginalized constituencies.98 At the same time, it is
unlikely that all preexisting economic, social, and cultural factors that create
95 Dani Rodrik, Feasible Globalizations, KSG Working Paper Series RWP02-029, at 6-8 (2002),
at . See also
Dani Rodrik, One Economics, Many Recipes: Globalization, Institutions, and Economic Growth
153–92 (Princeton U. Press 2007); see also Francis Fukuyama, Development and the Limits of
Institutional Design, in Political Institutions and Development: Failed Expectations and Renewed
Hopes 21 (Natalia Dinello & Vladimir Popov ed., Edward Elgar 2007); Francis Fukuyama,
Statebuilding: Governance and World Order in the 21st Century (Cornell U. Press 2004).
96 See Mariana Prado & Ana Carolina Charin, Bureaucratic Reforms and Development: How Inno-
vative Was the Poupatempo (Saving Time) Experience in Brazil? (unpublished paper 2010) (copy
on �le with University of Toronto Faculty of Law).
97 See Heller, supra note 32; Mariana Prado, Institutional Bypass: An Alternative to Development
Reform (unpublished paper 2010) (copy on �le with University of Toronto Faculty of Law).
98 See Michael Trebilcock, Journeys across the Divides, in The Origins of Law and Economics: Essays
by the Founding Fathers 422 (Francesco Parisi & Charles Rowley ed., Edward Elgar 2005).
The Rule of Law and Development 233
costs for switching to new institutional regimes can be ignored99 (as contem-
porary challenges to institutional reform in, for example, Iraq and Afghanistan
exemplify). Not only should reformers recognize the importance of switching
costs, but they should also be sensitive to the different kinds of switching costs
associated with reform.100
First, in terms of political economy considerations, switching costs may be
high for those who bene�t from the institutional status quo101 but may be miti-
gated by reforms that create or strengthen a countervailing political constitu-
ency that bene�ts.102 Alternatively, vested interests may need to be “bought
off� or grandfathered in some way to mute opposition. Second, switching
costs may involve individual learning costs in adapting to a new regime (the
“installed base� problem), although these can be lessened by state-sponsored
public education programs and gradual processes of transition that avoid the
need for abrupt adaptation to a new regime. Third, switching costs may re-
flect the scarcity of �nancial and human resources required to implement new
institutional regimes, which can be alleviated by external �nancial and techni-
cal assistance. Finally, switching costs may include the disruption of deeply
embedded cultural bene�ts or practices that are resistant to change.103 Here,
reforms that adapt traditional institutions (such as traditional forms of alter-
native dispute settlement or communal property rights) may moderate prob-
lems of cultural dissonance, and reforms implemented over time may lead to
modi�cations in cultural belief systems.
In this respect, alternative dispute resolution (ADR) is a class of reforms
that have shown signi�cant promise, largely through demonstration effects.
ADRs sometimes build on traditional or community-based forms of dispute
settlement, such as adaptations of the Lok Adalat system in India, the Shalish
system in Bangladesh, the Gacaca tribunals in Rwanda in the aftermath of
years of civil war and genocide, the Casas de Justicia in Latin America, and
alternative law groups in the Philippines.
99 This can be true even in postconflict societies; see Susan Rose-Ackerman, Corruption and Post-
Conflict Peace-Building, 34 Ohio N.U.L. Rev. 405 (2008).
100 This section draws on the analysis developed in Ronald J. Daniels & Michael J. Trebilcock,
The Political Economy of Rule of Law Reform in Developing Countries, 26 Mich. J. Intl. L. 99
(2004).
101 Resistance to reform can also be higher if there is uncertainty regarding the identity of poten-
tial bene�ciaries. The uncertainty is higher in large-scale reforms. Dani Rodrik & Raquel Fer-
nandez, Resistance to Reform: Status Quo Bias in the Presence of Individual-Speci�c Uncertainty,
81 Am. Econ. Rev. 1148 (1991).
102 How much instability these reforms should generate, that is, how much room for constant
contestation would be good for future reforms, is a topic that deserves further research. For
an insightful analysis, see Susan Rose-Ackerman, Was Mancur a Maoist? An Essay on Kleptoc-
racy and Political Stability, 15 Eco. and Pol. 163 (2003).
103 See, for instance, how informal institutions for contract enforcement in the footwear industry
resisted the changes brought by an open-trade regime when NAFTA was implemented in
Mexico; Christopher Woodruff, Contract Enforcement and Trade Liberalization in Mexico’s Foot-
wear Industry, 26 World Development 979 (1998).
234 The World Bank Legal Review
These ADRs have sought to marry indigenous methods of dispute set-
tlement with broader rule of law norms such as equality before the law to
minimize cultural switching costs. In these cases, reformers have struggled to
navigate the dif�cult compromise between two sometimes conflicting models
of dispute resolution and the respective roles of the formal court system and
informal modes of dispute settlement. Despite these dif�culties, these ADRs
have been shown to have a major bene�t: they acknowledge and rely on
context-speci�c forms of institutional vindication or instantiation of rule of
law values, thereby reducing cultural switching costs and nurturing an in-
creasingly robust domestic constituency for rule of law reforms over time. In
this sense, these reforms enable a broadly representative range of social, eco-
nomic, and political interests to see that their concerns and values are aligned
with the promotion and preservation of the rule of law.
The Role of External Actors in Promoting Rule of Law Reform
in Developing Countries
A tailored approach, overtly attentive to the domestic political context of the
countries in question, will enhance the likelihood of success of external efforts
at promoting rule of law reform in developing countries. If, as many have
persuasively argued, the rule of law is ultimately a political phenomenon,
such political attention only makes sense. In this regard, Daniels and I have
proposed a set of hypothetical political formulations with varying degrees of
support for rule of law reform that are useful in considering how reforms can
be sensitive to different political contexts.104 These paradigmatic formations,
each of which can be related to real-life examples, will pose different kinds
of challenges for rule of law reformers and create a range of openings and
opportunities for an international role. Thus, the relative salience of each ob-
stacle to reform discussed above will vary with each different formation (and
the almost in�nite variations between them)—and with them, the role of the
international community.
The �rst stylized formation (Type I) is characterized by an environment of
broad political support for the rule of law. The state that Daniels and I envi-
sion has progressive-minded political leadership at the highest levels, strong
support from within the ruling party, and broad popular support for legal
reforms. The archetypal administration is that of Nelson Mandela in South
Africa, particularly in the early days after his election in 1994. Not only did
Mandela himself have a strong mandate, but public support for legal reform
was widespread as well. Another, perhaps more contentious, example is Lee
Kuan Yew, prime minister of Singapore from 1959 to 1990 and senior govern-
ment minister thereafter, who was strongly committed to a highly competent,
meritocratic, noncorrupt public administration throughout his lengthy term
as prime minister, although the independence of the judiciary in cases involv-
104 Trebilcock & Daniels, supra note 10.
The Rule of Law and Development 235
ing government of�cials has been more problematic. Additional examples in-
clude several countries in Central Europe following the collapse of the Soviet
Union.
The second stylized formation (Type II) is more ambiguous in its support
for rule of law reform. There is a strong desire for such reform at the high-
est political levels, but more systematic opposition from a variety of complex
economic and social relationships operating below the political surface. This
kind of opposition might be rooted, for instance, in an entrenched ideological
orientation inconsistent with the rule of law, or in powerful public or private
interests with a stake in a general state of lawlessness. These administrations
will often be identi�able by the rise of a charismatic or prominent leader in
a time of general political or economic turmoil. Somewhat ironic examples
include Mikhail Gorbachev, Boris Yeltsin, and Vladimir Putin. At least in their
early days, these leaders brought tremendous promise of reform, despite,
among other problems, the meteoric rise of an oligarchic class of extraordi-
narily powerful organized criminals, rampant corruption, and the pervasive
influence of communist ideology, which retained a not-insigni�cant degree of
popular support.
The third stylized formation (Type III) is marked by a highly corrupt po-
litical leadership with strong incentives for maintaining the status quo and
no predisposition to reform. In such states, there may be varying degrees of
organized popular opposition in the form of NGO or other civil society activ-
ity, and there may be some degree of opposition from, or some tendency to-
ward, or pockets of reform within, the leadership of some governing factions
or government agencies. However, where the political leadership establishes
any sort of lasting foothold, it will almost invariably have complex webs of
support in military, administrative, or judicial branches of government, and
often among some segments of the public. There are myriad examples of
authoritarian and kleptocratic administrations to pick from, including the
long-standing regime of Robert Mugabe as prime minister and then presi-
dent of Zimbabwe, President Mobutu in Zaire, the Duvaliers in Haiti, and
Saparmurat Niyazov, self-anointed “leader of the Turkmens,� as president of
Turkmenistan. Although these states will very often be undemocratic or au-
thoritarian, it is not an absence of democracy per se but rather hostility to the
rule of law that places an administration in this category. Governments with
nominal election procedures in an otherwise repressive context may be hostile
to rule of law reform—indeed, Mugabe is an example par excellence. More
legitimate, popular elections may also produce governments hostile to many
of the characteristics of the rule of law, as with the popular election of Yasser
Arafat’s Palestinian Authority in 1996.
There are several ways in which this trichotomy should be viewed as
merely suggestive rather than exhaustive or de�nitive. First, the lines be-
tween these three categories are not strictly demarcated boundaries: states
may slide in and out of each category as governments change policy and char-
acter over time. Moreover, ruling parties in any given state may have differing
236 The World Bank Legal Review
interests across different institutions and therefore support reform efforts in
some institutions, and in some respects, but not in others. Second, there may
be substantially different political formations within each category, with sig-
ni�cant implications for rule of law reform prescriptions. The categories fol-
low not the markings of democracy but rather those of the rule of law. Conse-
quently, within each category, there are likely to be widely differing political
contexts to which reformers (domestic and external) will have to be attentive
when selecting appropriate strategies for reform. For instance, in states with
authoritarian governments—even those generally in favor of reform—it may
be dif�cult to pursue legal remedies against the state or its representatives in
court proceedings (Singapore may be an example).
As one moves along the spectrum from Type I to Type III states, top-down,
state-centric reform strategies become less feasible, and bottom-up, com-
munity-based reform strategies become a more promising option.
Type I States
In Type I states, where broad political and popular support for rule of law
reform exists, the role of the international community should be focused most
on alleviating resource constraints. Although sociocultural factors and vari-
ous forms of vested interests may act as important barriers to reform, in these
states, domestic governments, rather than the international community, will
be best placed to address these concerns.
The preferred method of intervention in the most favorable (although
admittedly rare) cases should be unconditional aid, again leaving to the do-
mestic government the choice of reform priorities and strategies and sources
of technical advice, unless for credible commitment and signaling purposes
the recipient government requests conditionality. The “mallet�-like political
pressure of accession conditions on membership in regional or multilateral
economic or political associations will play little fruitful role, because the state
is already generally politically aligned with the viewpoint of reformers. Simi-
larly, because trade policy (preferences or sanctions) does not direct new re-
sources to rule of law initiatives, it will be irrelevant in these circumstances.
Due to their punitive nature, economic sanctions are entirely misplaced.
Although there is a case for conditional aid in more equivocal cases,
it is important to emphasize that government policy may be fluid, and that
strongly pro reform administrations can shift policies quickly, particularly
when they come to power in a period of transition or during a key “constitu-
tional moment.� Donors must therefore be vigilant in monitoring the trajec-
tory of Type I governments and enforcing conditions where appropriate—a
historical weakness of development agencies.
The funding of nonstate drivers of rule of law reform such as local NGOs
can play a role in these states, as it can in almost any situation. However, in
these cases, NGOs that cooperate with, rather than oppose, government poli-
cies are likely to be more effective.
The Rule of Law and Development 237
Type II States
In states with generally reform-minded political leadership but with a less
secure political base and widespread opposition from vested interests within
state agencies, including legal institutions and perhaps private sector par-
ties who bene�t from dysfunctional public institutions, a more diverse set of
strategies will be necessary. In these cases, resources may be scarce, but in-
ternational agencies or external donors cannot responsibly commit to uncon-
ditional aid. Even where high-level political leadership supports reform, in-
creased aid flows to antagonistic public or legal institutions can be misdirected
and wasted or used for regressive purposes. Governments truly committed to
reform may agree to conditional aid that binds them to a policy and protects
them from internal special interests. A case can be made for conditionality
through accession or trade preferences on similar grounds. Also, there may be
a good case for nonstate-led reforms through local NGOs or alternative law
groups operating more independently than the state in institutional contexts
in which independence of legal institutions is likely to be problematic.
Type III States
Governments unequivocally opposed to rule of law reform will rarely be
sensitive to state-level pressure mechanisms such as trade or other economic
sanctions and forms of conditionality attached to aid, debt relief, trade pref-
erences, or accession to regional or multilateral economic or political asso-
ciations. As Ernest Preeg argues in respect to U.S. sanctions (such as denial
of most-favored-nation trading status) against China, “the basic reason why
these unilateral economic sanctions are ineffective is that the foreign policy ob-
jective is to change the oppressive behavior of an authoritarian or totalitarian
government, which constitutes a direct threat to its control if not survival.�105
Although U.S. sanctions in this instance were intended to stimulate democ-
racy more than the rule of law, the point is the same.
In these cases, the role of nonstate actors should become a central aspect
of rule of law reform efforts, with a particular focus on local and international
NGOs developing reforms independent of state agencies and on providing
�nancial and technical assistance to these groups. In China and Laos, NGOs
have played an important role as de facto monitoring mechanisms for cor-
rectional institutions where the state has denied access to formal state-level
monitoring channels. Properly designed and implemented nonstate dispute-
resolution mechanisms, often based on traditional forms of community-based
dispute settlement, can also be a vital element of access to justice in circum-
stances in which courts suffer from chronic backlog, corruption, or bias and
hence a lack of legitimacy.
105 Ernest H. Preeg, Feeling Good or Doing Good with Sanctions: Unilateral Economic Sanctions and
the US National Interest 201 (Center for Strategic and International Studies 1999).
238 The World Bank Legal Review
Conclusion
States may evolve either negatively or positively from one stylized type to
another in the foregoing typology, requiring the international community con-
tinually to reassess its rule of law reform promotion strategies and to readjust
its menu of strategies accordingly. However, even acknowledging this fact,
and acknowledging further that all desirable rule of law reforms cannot be
realistically embarked upon simultaneously, if only because of resource con-
straints, even in the most favorable (Type I) political environments, issues
of prioritization and sequencing will invariably arise. Although these issues
must largely be resolved by domestic constituencies committed to rule of law
reform, as must the particular forms of institutional vindication or instantia-
tion of rule of law values, nurturing over time an increasingly robust domestic
constituency for the rule of law that reflects a demand-side perspective re-
quires that a genuinely representative range of social, economic, and political
interests come to see that their concerns and values are compatible with the
promotion and preservation of the rule of law.
In this respect, I (along with others) question the aptness of the relatively
high priority that the international community has often accorded to formal
judicial reform in the rule of law initiatives that it has promoted in develop-
ing countries in recent years.106 This is often accompanied by a relative lack of
attention to institutional reforms that are more likely to affect the day-to-day
interactions of the citizenry with the legal system, such as police, prosecu-
tors, and specialized law enforcement and administrative agencies, including
agencies of government that issue, for example, passports, driver’s licenses,
identi�cation cards, health cards, building permits, and business licenses.107
These institutional reforms also would include access-to-justice initiatives
such as informal community-based dispute-resolution mechanisms (often
reflecting adaptations to and elaborations of traditional dispute-settlement
mechanisms), through which more visible and immediate material bene�ts
from successful institutional reform are likely to be experienced by a wide
cross-section of the citizenry. Recent civil justice needs surveys of representa-
tive samples of the population in a number of developed countries108 provide
helpful examples of instruments for identifying the relative frequency and
shortcomings of citizen interactions with state agencies.
106 See Carothers, supra note 28; Stephen Golub, A House without Foundation, in Promoting the Rule
of Law Abroad: In Search of Knowledge 105 (Thomas Carothers ed., Carnegie Endowment for
International Peace 2006); Bryant Garth, Building Strong and Independent Judiciaries for the New
Law and Development: Beyond the Paradox of Consensus Programs and Perpetually Disappointing
Results, 52 DePaul L. Rev. 383 (2002–03).
107 Famously described by Charles Reich as “the new property,� Charles A. Reich, The New
Property, 73 Yale L.J. 733 (1964); lack of effective access to which in many developing coun-
tries is equally famously described by Hernando De Soto in The Other Path, supra note 4, and
is increasingly well documented in various reports in the World Bank’s “Doing Business�
surveys.
108 See, for example, Jamie Baxter, Michael Trebilcock, & Albert Yoon, The Ontario Civil Needs
Project: A Comparative Analysis of the 2009 Survey Data (unpublished paper Aug. 27, 2010)
(copy on �le with University of Toronto Faculty of Law).
The Rule of Law and Development 239
Although the success of institutional reforms in one context ultimately of-
ten depends, to an important extent, on complementary institutional reforms
in other contexts,109 not everything can be pursued at once. Judicial reforms
(and reforms to legal education) are likely to have longer-term and less visible
social payoffs to citizens at large and hence are less likely to engage their inter-
est and support than other reforms noted above, given the many more press-
ing and immediate survival challenges citizens in developing countries often
face. Thus, both domestic and international proponents of rule of law reform
in developing countries face a hitherto underacknowledged challenge of ren-
dering rule of law reform politically salient to most citizens of these countries.
Strategic choices on sequencing are important in addressing this challenge.
109 See Rachel Kleinfeld, Competing De�nitions of the Rule of Law: Implications for Practitioners,
Carnegie Endowment for International Peace Working Paper No. 55 (2005).
Rethinking Justice Reform in Fragile
and Conflict-Affected States
The Capacity of Development Agencies and
Lessons from Liberia and Afghanistan
DEVAL DESAI, DEBORAH ISSER, AND MICHAEL WOOLCOCK
In order to truly address the problems afflicting post-conflict countries, do-
nors must not settle for super�cial, humbug solutions. Instead, they must
presume that a problem they are encountering here is unique and idiosyn-
cratic, presume it is incredibly complex and nuanced, and presume it is no-
where close to monolithic and that the symptoms in one part of the country
or in one part of the world must stem from entirely different pathologies
than those working to create the same symptoms in another part. At a mini-
mum, such presumptions will force donors to do the foundational diligence
that is truly necessary to accomplish sustainable change.
— Christiana Tah, minister of justice, Liberia1
Introduction: Justice and Conflict2
There is broad and growing recognition across a range of development actors
that fragile and conflict-affected states (FCSs) pose particular development
challenges; indeed, they are a key development challenge of the coming de-
cade. Home to approximately 1.5 billion people, FCSs contain many of the
world’s poorest and most vulnerable. People in FCSs are more than twice as
likely to be undernourished as those in other developing countries, more than
three times as likely to be unable to send their children to school, twice as
likely to see their children die before the age of �ve, and more than twice as
likely to lack clean water. No low-income FCS has yet achieved a single Mil-
lennium Development Goal.3
1 From a presentation delivered by Christiana Tah to the World Bank’s Law, Justice, and De-
velopment Week 2010 in Washington, DC. See Abdul Salam Azimi and Christiana Tah, Justice
Development Programming in Fragile and Conflict-Affected Areas: Perspectives of Two Leaders in
Justice Administration, 15 Justice and Development Working Paper Series 1, 12 (2011).
2 This chapter draws on Deval Desai & Caroline Sage, Justice, an Input Paper for the World De-
velopment Report 2011 (Nov. 5, 2010), available at , and
presentations made by Minister of Justice Tah of Liberia, Chief Justice Azimi of Afghanistan,
Michael Woolcock (World Bank), and Pablo de Greiff (International Center for Transitional Justice)
at the World Bank’s Law, Justice and Development Week, Washington, DC, November 2010.
3 World Bank, World Development Report 2011: Conflict, Security and Development 2–6 (World
Bank 2011) (“WDR2011�). 241
242 The World Bank Legal Review
Multilateral development groups and organizations have highlighted FCSs
in their recent strategies: the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and
Development (OECD) Development Asisistance Committee (OECD-DAC) has
convened the International Network on Conflict and Fragility (INCAF), which
has developed a series of materials and guidance notes designed to improve in-
volvement—or reduce the harm of “poorly-conceived involvement�—in these
“most challenging [of] development situations.� Such states “face severe devel-
opment challenges such as lack of security, weak governance, limited admin-
istrative capacity, chronic humanitarian crises, persistent social tensions, vio-
lence or the legacy of civil war.�4 The United Nations Development Programme
(UNDP),5 the African Development Bank,6 and the European Commission7 have
followed suit, seeking improved donor engagement in FCSs. Bilateral donors—
including the British,8 Dutch,9 French,10 and German governments11—have also
taken clear positions on FCSs as a priority development challenge.
As development actors have directed their attention toward FCSs, there
has been a concomitant burgeoning recognition of the importance of laws,
norms, and justice institutions in meeting the particular challenges posed by
such situations. The president of the World Bank, Robert Zoellick, has argued
that “a fundamental prerequisite for sustainable development [in FCSs] is an
effective rule of law,� using this as a rallying cry for broader development
engagement in justice reform in FCSs:
4 OECD-INCAF, About the Fragile States Principles, available at . See also OECD-
DAC, Principles for Good International Engagement in Fragile States and Situations (Apr.
2007), available at .
5 Executive Board of the United Nations Development Programme and of the United Nations
Population Fund, Role of UNDP in Crisis and Post-conflict Situations, UN Doc. DP/2001/4
(2000), available at .
6 African Development Fund, Strategy for Enhanced Engagement in Fragile States (Jan.
2008), available at .
7 European Commission, Communication from the Commission to the Council, the European
Parliament, the European Economic and Social Committee and the Committee of the Re-
gion, Towards an EU Response to Situations of Fragility: Engaging in Dif�cult Environments
for Sustainable Development, Stability and Peace, SEC (2007) 1417, available at .
8 Department for International Development, Building Peaceful States and Societies: A DFID
Practice Paper (2010), available at .
9 Ministry of Foreign Affairs (Development Cooperation), Our Common Concern: Invest-
ing in Development in a Changing World (2007), available at .
10 France Coopération, Fragile States and Situations of Fragility: France’s Policy Paper (2007),
available at .
11 Federal Ministry for Economic Cooperation and Development, Development-Oriented
Transformation in Conditions of Fragile Statehood and Poor Government Performance
(2007), available at .
Rethinking Justice Reform 243
A legal order is a safeguard against the serious risk of criminalisation
of the state. Corruption adds to fragility and undermines legitimacy.
Abuse of state power destroys con�dence, and ultimately the state’s
core purpose. Building the rule of law is also vital to public safety—
poorly trained and paid police usually add to fragility by arming
and empowering predators. In much of Afghanistan, the greatest se-
curity fear for businesspeople is kidnapping, often by the police.12
Most recently, this entreaty was taken up by World Development Report
2011: Conflict, Security and Development (hereafter WDR “2011�),13 which tack-
les the development challenges presented by FCSs. Building on the work of
North, Wallis, and Weingast, and others,14 the WDR 2011 highlights justice as
one of three key areas (the others being security and jobs) on which donors
should focus in order to build effective and sustainable transitions out of situ-
ations characterized by endemic conflict and fragility.15
However, while legal, regulatory, and justice institutions are now seen as
an important part of the solution to problems of conflict, fragility, and devel-
opment, this recognition is not matched by a correspondingly clear sense of
what should be done, how it should be done, by whom, in what order, or how
success may be determined. Nor is this a new problem. The effort to forge
theories and operational models on the role of justice initiatives in laying a
path out of fragility must build on the experiences of the constituent �elds of
conflict and development: the former, a �eld that has been the domain of those
engaged in rule of law reform as a component of state building in countries
emerging from conflict,16 the latter the domain of actors concerned primarily
with economic growth. Both �elds have struggled with a similar conundrum:
on the one hand, there is a broad North-South, left-right consensus that justice,
or rule of law, is key to achieving their respective goals; and on the other hand,
a recognition that sure�re ways of achieving rule of law remain elusive.17
12 Robert Zoellick, Fragile States: Securing Development, 50 Survival 67, 75–76 (2008).
13 Supra note 3.
14 See Douglass North, John Joseph Wallis, & Barry Weingast, Violence and Social Orders (Cam-
bridge U. Press 2009). See also Douglass North, Institutions, Institutional Change, and Economic
Performance 54 (Cambridge U. Press 1990) (claiming that the absence of a low-cost means
of enforcing contracts is “the most important source of both historical stagnation and con-
temporary underdevelopment in the Third World�); Dani Rodrik, Arvind Subramanian, &
Francesco Trebbi, Institutions Rule: The Primacy of Institutions over Geography and Integration in
Economic Development, 9 J. Econ. Growth 131 (2004).
15 Supra note 3.
16 See Kirsti Samuels, Rule of Law Reform in Post-conflict Countries: Operational Initiatives and Les-
sons Learnt, World Bank Social Development Papers: Conflict Prevention and Reconstruction
No. 37, 4–6 (2006), available at (arguing that, save multilateral assistance to post-Soviet transition coun-
tries, the majority of rule of law work in FCSs has been carried out by USAID and the United
Nations Department of Peacekeeping Operations).
17 Thomas Carothers, Promoting the Rule of Law Abroad: The Problem of Knowledge, Carnegie Pa-
per No. 34, 6–7 (2003). See also Brian Tamanaha, On the Rule of Law: History, Politics, Theory
127–37 (Cambridge U. Press 2004); Rachel Kleinfeld, Competing De�nitions of the Rule of Law,
244 The World Bank Legal Review
This chapter contributes to the discourse of justice (or rule of law) reform
in FCSs in the following way: while other critiques have focused on extremely
important failings of planning, technique, and execution (such as inadequate
donor coordination, a lack of readily available and appropriately skilled in-
ternational personnel, and excessively curtailed time horizons),18 this chapter
seeks to problematize the conceptual underpinnings of justice reform efforts. This
chapter begins by exploring the conceptual bases and corresponding opera-
tionalization of the two dominant paradigms of justice reform—that of rule
of law linked to state building, and that of justice reform linked to economic
growth. Using the examples of Liberia and Afghanistan, the chapter examines
the shortcomings of these models. It explores a lack of capacity, not in the tradi-
tional sense of technical expertise on the part of actors in countries, but on the
part of donors to understand those countries and contexts in which they are
working and to support processes that lead to sustainable change. The chapter
seeks not to lessen or discount the vital importance and legitimacy of national
policymakers but to problematize donor action, arguing that failings in jus-
tice programs can often be traced to the predilection of development actors to
treat challenges requiring fundamental changes in people’s attitudes, percep-
tions, values, and behavior (as governance and legal reform invariably does)
as variants on technical problems that focus on—in Minister Tah’s words—
“super�cial, humbug solutions.�19
The current convergence of the two �elds—state building and develop-
ment—may present an opportunity to rethink conceptual underpinnings of
justice reform efforts at the nexus of conflict and development, leading to more
successful operational approaches. The latter part of the chapter explores the
dynamic that may ensue from a convergence of these two �elds and offers
ways to avoid mutual negative reinforcement of the two models that could re-
sult in “securitizing�20 the approach of development actors, overemphasizing
existential threats to development goals, and undermining broader consider-
ations of the state-society compact on which the ef�cacy of any institutional
reform effort ultimately turns.
in Promoting the Rule of Law Abroad: In Search of Knowledge 31 (Thomas Carothers ed., Carne-
gie Endowment for International Peace 2006). See, generally, Promoting the Rule of Law Abroad:
In Search of Knowledge (Thomas Carothers ed., Carnegie Endowment for International Peace
2006); Richard E. Messick, Judicial Reform and Economic Development: A Survey of the Issues, 14
World Bank Research Observer 117 (1999); Samuels, supra note 16; and Stephan Haggard,
Andrew MacIntyre, & Lydia Tiede, The Rule of Law and Economic Development, 11 Annual Rev.
Pol. Science 205 (2008).
18 Samuels, supra note 16; World Bank: Report on Headline Seminar, Rule of Law in Fragile and
Conflict-Affected Situations (Jul. 21, 2009), available at .
19 Azimi & Teh, supra note 1. See, generally, Lant Pritchett & Michael Woolcock, Solutions When the
Solution Is the Problem: Arraying the Disarray in Development, 32(2) World Development 191 (2004).
20 Ole Waever, Securitization and Desecuritization, in On Security 46 (Ronnie Lipschutz ed., Co-
lumbia U. Press 1995).
Rethinking Justice Reform 245
The (In)capacity of Concepts and Models
The elevation of the rule of law to the status of a sine qua non for peace and
development has occurred on two tracks that, although parallel, have re-
mained largely discrete. One track emerged in the 1990s as the United Na-
tions experienced an unprecedented demand for peace interventions, from
Haiti to the Balkans, El Salvador to East Timor. As mission mandates took on
ever more ambitious tasks of civilian administration, the justice components
of those mandates quickly grew from police reform to reform of all compo-
nents of the criminal and civil justice system. The fundamental importance of
the rule of law to the project of post-conflict state building was set out by the
secretary-general of the United Nations in 2004, in a document that embodies
the paradigm that this chapter calls the “state-building� model. The document
sets out a de�nition of the rule of law that equates it with a political system
with substantive content—a state that generates, promulgates, and is ruled by
laws that ful�ll certain technical and normative criteria:
[The rule of law] refers to a principle of governance in which all per-
sons, institutions and entities, public and private, including the State
itself, are accountable to laws that are publicly promulgated, equally
enforced and independently adjudicated, and which are consistent
with international human rights norms and standards. It requires, as
well, measures to ensure adherence to the principles of supremacy
of law, equality before the law, accountability to the law, fairness
in the application of the law, separation of powers, participation in
decision-making, legal certainty, avoidance of arbitrariness and pro-
cedural and legal transparency.21
The UNDP further de�nes the primary modality of the rule of law in its
clear nexus with security and recurrence of conflict: “Conflicts may be caused
by or result in the breakdown of law and order, or a collapse of state institu-
tions. Preventive measures can be taken to help strengthen local capacity to
prevent conflict occurring and to support the institutional structures that sup-
port dispute resolution and democratic governance. Strengthening the rule
of law can be a critical tool for conflict prevention.�22 As a result, the UNDP
takes a state-centric approach, placing national institutions at the center of its
model: “the initial focus needs to be on building the capacity of national insti-
tutions and stakeholders to prevent and bring an end to violations, insecurity
and impunity through their own capacity and resilience.�23 In this way, the
rule of law, as a way of de�ning and constraining state power and of contain-
ing and managing disputes, is linked to the aims and ends of state building:
the rule of law is intrinsically tied to the construction of a functioning state
21 The Rule of Law and Transitional Justice in Conflict and Post-conflict Societies: Report of the
Secretary-General, at 4, UN Doc. S/2004/616 (2004).
22 UNDP Bureau for Crisis Prevention and Recovery, The Rule of Law in Fragile and Post-
conflict Situations 1 (2009), available at .
23 Id., at 7.
246 The World Bank Legal Review
and—through its ability to contain conflict—is part of the establishment of a
monopoly over violence. Consequently, justice interventions in this paradigm
focus primarily on strengthening the capacity of state law-and-order institu-
tions while bringing substantive laws into compliance with international hu-
man rights standards.
The second dominant approach to rule of law reform began even earlier,
with origins commonly attributed to the law and development movement of
the 1960s and 1970s. This “economic development� paradigm seeks to enhance
the quality of the legal underpinnings deemed necessary to support inclu-
sive economic growth. Most commonly associated with the World Bank but
broadly reflecting neoclassical economic orthodoxy, this approach stresses the
importance to growth of legal concerns such as property rights, contract en-
forcement, and judicial predictability and ef�ciency. This paradigm is distinct
from the state-building one in terms of nomenclature: it uses the term “jus-
tice� to encapsulate a range of issues that would likely fall under the rubric of
“rule of law reform� when considered by state-building actors. Its approach is
also substantively distinct. While the Bank has long shared the United
Nations’ “belief that reconstructing countries devastated by warfare [is] an
international responsibility,�24 it has consistently used a strictly economic—
rather than political—lens to examine the role of law and justice. According to
Eugene Meyer, the �rst head of the World Bank:
Prosperity, like peace, must . . . be viewed as indivisible. And even
from the narrowest considerations of self-interest, each of us must be
concerned with the economic development of the world as a whole.
For we shall prosper individually only as we prosper collectively.
But there are even larger considerations than material wel-
fare which dictate our recognition of the world’s essential unity.
Economic distress is a prime breeder of war; it makes for a despera-
tion from which aggression seems the only avenue of escape. . . .
We are engaged in the �rst large-scale, practical implementation of
the United Nations spirit. . . . Our endeavor is a concrete test of the
capacity of nations to work cooperatively toward the solution of a
speci�c common problem.25
The economic development paradigm consequently focuses predomi-
nantly on the role and functioning of justice institutions, many of which
enable market activity, and the locus of which is generally the nation-state
24 World Bank, World Development Report 2011: Concept Note i (2010), available at .
25 International Bank for Reconstruction and Development, First Annual Meeting of the Board
of Governors: Proceedings and Related Documents 15–16 (World Bank 1946).
Rethinking Justice Reform 247
(given the mandate and history of the Bank and the fact that its members are
states-parties).26 Functioning legal frameworks and institutions may be seen as
developmental goods in themselves, allowing people to uphold and exercise
their rights.27 More important, in this paradigm, they are also instrumental in
realizing a range of other development goals: without justice, people cannot
easily receive or access public goods and basic services, nor can they effec-
tively access a range of markets.28
It is important to note that these two paradigms are, of course, stylized,
and as such gloss over internal differences and pluralities among agencies
and donors. There is both heuristic and narrative utility in boiling down the
complex conceptual, political, and organizational underpinnings of these two
broad approaches to justice reform as state building and economic develop-
ment. Both the heuristic and narrative values can be seen in �gure 1, which
forms part of the Capstone Doctrine of the United Nations’ Department for
Peacekeeping Operations.29 The Capstone Doctrine, which was devised by the
UN Peacekeeping Best Practices Section, is an attempt to outline the funda-
mental principles and core objectives of peacekeeping in response to new chal-
lenges, as a revamp of the General Guidelines on UN Peacekeeping issued in
1995.30 It thus forms both a useful analytical tool and a narrative around which
to structure interventions, and clearly shows the division that actors have seen
between state building and economic development.
26 Alvaro Santos, The World Bank’s Uses of the “Rule of Law� Promise in Economic Development,
in The New Law and Economic Development: A Critical Appraisal 253 (David M. Trubek &
Alvaro Santos ed., Cambridge U. Press 2006). See, generally, Stephen Humphreys, Theatre of
the Rule of Law: Transnational Legal Intervention in Theory and Practice 131–49 (Cambridge U.
Press 2010). On the role of nonstate justice institutions, see infra; see also Varun Gauri, How
Do Local-Level Legal Institutions Promote Development? World Bank Policy Research Working
Paper 5108 (2009).
27 Amartya Sen, What Is the Role of Legal and Judicial Reform in the Development Process? 2 World
Bank Legal Rev. 33 (2005).
28 See, generally, Amartya Sen, Development as Freedom (Oxford U. Press 2001); see also, on the
importance of customary and formal law and norms to land market access, Klaus Deininger,
Land Policy Reforms, in Analyzing the Distributional Impact of Reforms: A Practitioners’ Guide
to Trade, Monetary and Exchange Rate Policy, Utility Provision, Agricultural Markets, Land, and
Education vol. 1, 213 (Aline Coudouel & Stefano Paternostro ed., World Bank 2005).
29 United Nations, Department for Peacekeeping Operations, United Nations Peacekeeping Op-
erations: Principles and Guidelines (United Nations 2008) (hereafter “Capstone Doctrine�).
30 Jean Marie-Guéhenno, Under-Secretary-General for Peacekeeping Operations, Remarks to
the Fourth Committee of the General Assembly (Oct. 19, 2006), available at .
248 The World Bank Legal Review
Figure 131
Models
While the paradigms highlighted here may differ in terms of stylized philo-
sophical underpinnings, there are distinct similarities in the models32 used to
apply those underpinnings to real-world situations. This section examines four
ways that these paradigms are translated into operational models that exhibit
similar features and suffer from similar flaws: state-centrism, organizational
isomorphism, short time frames, and linear trajectories of change. This analysis
draws on two key arguments made by Pritchett and Woolcock33 regarding con-
ceptual failures of development practice. First, that the goal of much of develop-
ment is “to ensure that the provision of key services . . . is assured by effective,
rules based, meritocratic, and politically accountable public agencies—that is,
something resembling Weberian bureaucracies.�34 Second, that the problems
associated with realizing this objective are compounded by “skipping straight
to Weber�; that is, an “attempt to remedy problems of ‘inadequate services’
by calling upon a centralized bureaucracy to supply a top-down and uniform
public service,� providing “a technical (supply) solution . . . implemented by
an impersonal, rules driven, provider.� In doing so, development actors give
short shrift to a key link in the implementation chain, namely, those ongo-
ing, face-to-face “interactions between citizens, the state, and providers� that
31 Supra note 29, at 23.
32 We acknowledge those who would seek to limit the use of the word “model� and draw a
keen distinction between it and “ideology.� See Joel M. Ngugi, The World Bank and the Ideology
of Reform and Development in International Economic Development Discourse, 14 Cardozo J. Intl.
& Comp. L. 313, 319–23 (2007). We use the term in a much more general sense here, as an
attempt to refer to organizing logics that might be ascribed to families of intervention.
33 Pritchett & Woolcock, supra note 19, at 191.
34 Id., at 192.
Rethinking Justice Reform 249
necessarily entail deep contextual knowledge, adaptive strategies, and en-
gagement beyond institutional forms.35
State-Centrism
As established above, state-building and economic development practitioners
generally place state institutions at the center of their justice reform work in
FCSs (although the expressions of this can differ, with the former placing a
greater emphasis on the monopoly over violence36 and the latter engaging
with aspects of institutions that support economic development and service
delivery).37 In general, there is good reason to support the tradition of political
philosophy and policy that holds that state-backed formal institutions are a
desirable means to a range of development ends, including security, political
participation, and economic growth.38 However, an exclusive focus on state
institutions as the appropriate form promoting capable legal and regulatory
institutions may miss the mark. In many FCSs, these institutions are either
decimated or captured by political, criminal, or other interests, and may be in-
accessible owing to economic, political, geographic, or linguistic factors. State
institutions in such contexts characteristically lack infrastructure or institu-
tional capacity, and can be remote, unaffordable, delayed, and seen as unfair,
incomprehensible, and/or a foreign imposition, thus effectively denying legal
protection to ordinary people. In many countries, customary systems operat-
ing outside the state regime are often the dominant form of regulation and
site of dispute resolution. For example, in Sierra Leone about 85 percent of the
population is predominantly governed by customary law; with a population
of approximately 5 million people, the country had an estimated 125 legally
trained personnel in 2003, 95 percent of whom were based in the capital, Free-
town.39 According to the Liberian minister of justice, in the aftermath of the
ravaging civil war,
[l]egal institutions barely functioned as many of the well educated
and well trained citizens in law enforcement and the law fled the
country in the 1990s. The few who remained in the country tried to
provide a semblance of law and order, but were often threatened
into submission, leaving citizens very distrustful of the formal legal
system. Corruption among judges and other public of�cials became
more prevalent than in the past, due to the fact that civil servants
regularly received meager salaries several months in arrears. Ul-
timately, the formal justice system virtually collapsed and, conse-
quently, most citizens (educated and uneducated) resorted to the
35 Id., at 193.
36 UNDP, Evaluation of UNDP Assistance to Conflict-Affected Countries vii, 57 (2006), avail-
able at .
37 Supra note 14.
38 See, generally, WDR 2011.
39 Paul James-Allen, Accessing Justice in Rural Sierra Leone: A Civil Society Response, Open Society
Justice Initiatives: Legal Aid Reform and Access to Justice 57 (Feb. 2004).
250 The World Bank Legal Review
informal justice system as a viable alternative. In a few instances,
vigilante justice or mob violence prevailed.40
The existence of plural legal orders is not just a question of access; they
may also be hotly contested political arenas with deep implications for the al-
location of power, mechanisms of social accountability, governance structures,
and the ethnic and ideological identity of the state. In Afghanistan, for exam-
ple, efforts by the Kabul government to expand its reach to areas traditionally
governed by nonstate justice systems—jirgas and shuras—have historically
been met with hostile resistance that threatened state legitimacy and control.41
In Liberia, while “progressive� voices call for the elimination of customary
justice systems as a means of remedying the historical legacy of discrimina-
tion, many citizen users of customary justice consider the idea of a single (for-
mal) justice system for all Liberians to be a further unwanted imposition of a
Monrovia-based elite.42 In such situations, external interventions that focus
exclusively on state institutions are seen as—and indeed are—political choices
with considerable consequences.
In recent years, the state-building approach has moved discursively to
embrace the importance of nonstate justice systems.43 The nature of this rhe-
torical engagement is, in its weaker form, disconnected; that is, nonstate jus-
tice systems are a “thing� to be engaged with, with strategies of engagement
remaining ad hoc. In its stronger form, engagement is still underpinned by
state-centrism; nonstate institutions are to be harmonized or embedded orga-
nizationally (through laws and structural reforms) and normatively (through
the transmission and enforcement of human rights norms) into the state sys-
tem.44 Justice actors therefore focus on “entry points� for the transformation of
such systems along a state-centric model.45
This trend has been mirrored in the literature on economic development.
Recognition of the importance of nonstate systems has been rhetorical (e.g.,
accounting for them discursively as “alternative dispute resolution� alongside
40 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 8–9.
41 Thomas Bar�eld, Neamat Nojumi, & J. Alexander Thier, The Clash of Two Goods: State and
Non-state Dispute Resolution in Afghanistan, in Customary Justice and the Rule of Law in War-Torn
Societies (Deborah H. Isser ed., USIP Press, forthcoming 2011).
42 Deborah H. Isser, Stephen C. Lubkemann, & Saah N’Tow, Looking for Justice: Liberian
Experiences with and Perceptions of Local Justice Options, USIP Peaceworks No. 63 (Nov. 2009).
43 See Strengthening and Coordinating United Nations Rule of Law Activities: Report of
the Secretary-General, at 11, UN Doc. A/63/226 (2008). See, generally, Ewa Wojkowska,
Doing Justice: How Informal Justice Systems Can Contribute (UNDP Oslo Governance
Centre 2006).
44 Deborah H. Isser, The Problem with Problematizing Legal Pluralism, in Legal Pluralism and the
Future of Development: Dialogues for Success (Caroline Sage, Brian Tamanaha, & Michael Wool-
cock ed., Cambridge U. Press, forthcoming 2012).
45 Wojkowska, supra note 43.
Rethinking Justice Reform 251
other nonstate systems such as commercial arbitration).46 In its more muscular
state-centric form, the literature has pressed for harmonization and formaliza-
tion as a means of providing economic goods: Hernando de Soto’s call for the
formalization of customary land rights as a means to develop an asset base for
the poor can be seen in this light.47
Unless the conceptual underpinnings of both justice paradigms shift
away from state institutions as the answer, these trends will run into the same
problems as their orthodox antecedents: an overemphasis on particular forms
rather than on the actual functions they are meant to perform. Rather than
starting with predetermined notions of the “right� institutional formulation,
an alternative conception of an array of justice institutions starts with an anal-
ysis of the prevailing justice needs of citizens; the ways in which the vari-
ous institutions mediate power, rights, and accountability; and the process
through which such institutions can be made to deliver justice more fairly and
effectively. As Minister Tah puts it, assume that every situation is “unique and
idiosyncratic,� “incredibly complex and nuanced.�48
Organizational Isomorphism
The second key feature underpinning both paradigms is the presumption that
inputs, incentives, and information deemed successful by experts in one con-
text will work in the same way elsewhere; or, put differently, that a particular
organization’s functionality (what it does) is a product of its design (what it
looks like), thereby justifying the transplanting of best practices (e.g., a given
country’s constitution or commercial code) from one context to another. This
phenomenon follows closely from the �rst feature: the assumption of state-
centrism is itself a form of isomorphism. Isomorphism further encompasses
the limited engagement with social context on the part of donors and derives
from stylized views of the relationship between individual and society. An
alternative approach is rooted in the notion that institutions are instead in-
tersubjectively constructed; that is, communities build shared understandings
through social interaction of what an institution is, what it does, and how it
should be assessed and (where necessary) improved.49 For example, in the
context of Liberia, legalized notions of human rights—such as the right to a
fair trial—while important, may not “automatically assuage the concerns and
46 See, for example, International Council on Human Rights Policy, When Legal Worlds Overlap:
Human Rights, State and Non-state Law 3–5 (ICHRP 2009).
47 Hernando de Soto, The Mystery of Capital: Why Capitalism Triumphs in the West and Fails Ev-
erywhere Else (Basic Books 2000). See also Commission on Legal Empowerment of the Poor,
Making the Law Work for Everyone vol. 1 (CLEP & UNDP 2008).
48 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 12..
49 See Varun Gauri, Michael Woolcock, & Deval Desai, Intersubjective Meaning and Collective
Action in “Fragile� Societies: Theory, Evidence, and Policy Implications, Policy Research Working
Paper No. 5707, World Bank (2011).
252 The World Bank Legal Review
distrust of a public that for so long has been alienated from the formal justice
system� and that is looking for the meting out of justice.50
In FCSs, such isomorphism may render reform ineffectual; it may also lead
to increased conflict. In Liberia, insistence on the best practice of prohibiting
customary courts from handling serious crime has—in the absence of both suf-
�cient capacity and a shared sense of what constitutes justice—led to impunity
and mob justice, and has undermined the legitimacy of the fledgling demo-
cratic state.51 To take land and justice as an example, there is a broad52 (albeit
nuanced and critiqued)53 literature on the value of formalizing land rights that
is rooted in concepts of legal certainty and access to justice. However, compet-
ing claims can be extremely dif�cult to regulate owing to the plurality of ways
by which people conceive of land and land rights—for example, on a spectrum
between communal and individual goods (indeed, for some disputants, it may
be inconceivable that land be considered a good amenable to exchange). In a
study regarding land privatization in Mongolia, a Mongolian pastoralist be-
ing interviewed regarding a murder in a �ght over a campsite reflected: “This
land ownership is the worst possible thing for livestock husbandry. Cropland
can be privatized and protected, OK. Livestock husbandry must certainly not
be settled. The climatic conditions are extremely dif�cult and changeable here.
Therefore, pasture must be shared among herders and used in common . . . it
must be left as it is and has been for hundreds of years.�54
Short Time Frames
A related issue, stemming from the above point, is that reform is expected to
take place within highly unrealistic time frames—three to �ve years being the
limit of an electoral cycle and/or the (maximum) time a task manager may
oversee a given project before moving on.55 Imperatives to support projects
meeting predetermined targets (such as the Millennium Development Goals)
and to prioritize for support those projects that demonstrably work can mean
50 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 9.
51 Isser, Lubkemann, & N’Tow, supra note 42.
52 See de Soto, supra note 47; Sebastian Galiani & Ernesto Schargrodsky, Property Rights for the
Poor: Effects of Land Titling, Ronald Coase Institute Working Paper No. 7 (2009); Timothy Bes-
ley, Property Rights and Investment Incentives: Theory and Evidence from Ghana, 103 J. Pol. Econ.
903 (1995).
53 Deininger, supra note 28; Antara Haldar & Joseph Stiglitz, The Dialectics of Law and Devel-
opment: Analyzing Formality and Informality, paper prepared for the Initiative for Policy
Dialogue’s China Task Force (2008), available at ; Klaus Deininger & Hans Biswanger, The Evolu-
tion of the World Bank’s Land Policy: Principles, Experience, and Future Challenges, 14 World Bank
Research Observer 247 (1999).
54 Maria Fernandez-Gimenez & Batjav Batbuyan, Law and Disorder: Local Implementation of Mon-
golia’s Land Law, 35 Dev. and Change 141, 154–5 (2004).
55 Lant Pritchett, Michael Woolcock, & Matt Andrews, Capability Traps? The Mechanisms of
Persistent Implementation Failure, Center for Global Development Working Paper No. 234
(2010).
Rethinking Justice Reform 253
rule of law projects face unwarranted expectations and, when they fail to
meet them, suffer doubly when rival initiatives are lauded. As the WDR 2011
notes, attaining a one-standard deviation improvement in the rule of law (as
measured by the World Bank’s governance indicators) takes an average of 41
years in the 20 fastest reforming developing countries, let alone FCSs (where, in
effect, the timescale for improvement is in�nite, since their recent trajectory is
inexorably downward). Such time frames are a daunting challenge not only
to FCSs but also to donors and international agencies; embarking on crucial
reforms whose realization, by their very nature, is likely to span multiple gen-
erations (let alone careers and budget cycles) suggests the need for an entirely
different response framework.
Linear Trajectories of Change
A fourth problem, which characterizes the assessment of development proj-
ects more generally, is that change is presumed to take place along a lin-
ear trajectory, enabling relatively quick judgments to be made about project
ef�cacy now and into the future.56 In terms of political and legal reform,
institutions change along trajectories that are likely to be anything but lin-
ear57—a more realistic view would characterize such change processes as
“step-functions� (or “punctuated equilibriums�: long periods of stasis fol-
lowed by abrupt transformation) or “J-curves� (wherein things get worse
before they get better). If this is so, it makes evaluating institutional reform
efforts highly problematic: without knowing where a given project lies in its
trajectory, it is highly likely that a false diagnosis (i.e., inaccurately declaring
failure or success) will be rendered. In a world where time frames are short,
patience is thin, uncertainty is high, and trajectories are unknown (or even
unknowable), however, institutional reform projects that can claim to deliver
clear and predictable results in a short time will be highly favored, privileg-
ing the familiar tropes of best practice. Care must be taken to shift the incen-
tives for “super�cial, humbug solutions� that reinforce cycles of bad projects
in favor of engaging with complexity and basing projects on “foundational
diligence.�58
The cumulative upshot of these similarities is that both the state-building
and the economic development approaches miss the interconnectedness of
institutions and the social networks in which they are embedded. As a result,
donor help is lopsided.59 Fragile governments are called on to make complex
and dif�cult trade-offs within unrealistic time frames, generating in the pro-
cess outcomes that are less than satisfactory and that, through failing in this
56 Michael Woolcock, Toward a Plurality of Methods in Project Evaluation: A Contextualized Ap-
proach to Understanding Impact Trajectories and Ef�cacy, 1 J. Dev. Eff. 1 (2009).
57 Michael Woolcock, Simon Szreter, &Vijayendra Rao, How and Why Does History Matter for
Development Policy? 47 J. Dev. Studs. 70 (2011).
58 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1.
59 Id., at 12.
254 The World Bank Legal Review
way, delegitimize the very idea of reform, erode the likelihood that pro-reform
coalitions will be sustained over time, and stifle long-run organizational in-
novation and indigenous learning, thereby undermining the very possibility
of more effective reform in this domain.
Ideas for Experimentation
Thus far, this chapter has sketched out the dynamics of the gradual convergence
of two distinct and powerful paradigms for development interventions—state
building and economic development—that both reinforce and undermine
the best and worst in each other. This convergence is new and unusual: in
Kennedy’s60 and Kennedy’s61 genealogies of development, paradigms or con-
sensuses have tended to collapse under critique in particular “moments� rath-
er than to converge and assimilate or mutate. How such convergence might
affect the supranational and national spaces for justice reform is anybody’s
guess; however, it is safe to assume that, as others have said in the context
of the convergence of paradigms in education, it will result in “nontrivial
changes in the structure, culture and organization�62 of such reform in FCSs.
It might thus be possible to sketch out the following dynamic between
evolving concepts in rule of law/justice reform in FCSs: there is a move by de-
velopment actors to engage in space that has traditionally been the domain of
those engaged in state building. This brings a development lens to the causes
and consequences of conflict: for example, the need to resolve underlying dis-
putes, such as those over land or labor, which might otherwise spill over into
conflict.63 This broadening has the potential to enrich justice reform in FCSs.
However, development actors moving into this space are simultaneously en-
gaging with those who take a state-building approach, which requires the
ability to adopt a security lens, a lens that underscores the state monopoly
over force. This can lead to initiatives that undermine local institutions that
may be fundamental to containing the spread of violence and that focus on
law, order, and the control of deviance, with less consideration of rights and
entitlements—that is, “legitimate� grievances, and control and oversight over
state power.64 Broader questions of the state legal architecture—the nature of a
rule of law state—and state/citizens relationships tend to be ignored.
60 Duncan Kennedy, Three Globalizations of Law and Legal Thought: 1850–2000, in The New Law
and Economic Development: A Critical Appraisal 19 (David Trubek and Alvaro Santos ed., Cam-
bridge U. Press 2006).
61 David Kennedy, The “Rule of Law,� Political Choices, and Development Common Sense, in The
New Law and Economic Development: A Critical Appraisal 95 (David Trubek and Alvaro Santos
ed., Cambridge U. Press 2006).
62 Martin Carnoy & Diana Rhoten, What Does Globalisation Mean for Educational Change? A Com-
parative Approach, 46 Comp. Ed. Rev. 1, 7 (2002).
63 WDR 2011, at xvi.
64 Desai & Sage, supra note 2; and supra notes 18 and 19, and accompanying text.
Rethinking Justice Reform 255
The �rst moves in this conceptual and policy reorientation are being made.
We are starting to see a discursive engagement with nonstate justice at the pol-
icy level in the WDR 2011,65 at the analytic level through the work of the Justice
for the Poor program,66 and at the operational level (discussions currently tak-
ing place around the next phase of the Afghanistan Justice Sector Reform Proj-
ect envisage building links between state and nonstate institutions).67 More
broadly, emerging research on societal fragility68 attempts to shift the locus of
fragility from the state to society. It remains to be seen, however, whether such
concepts will receive the fulsome embrace of reconceptualization or the minor
recognition of marginal �xes at the institutional and/or operational level.
In the coming few years, donors will have to adapt to a new and rapidly
changing conceptual terrain. They will have to acquire the capacity to react
to changing concepts and to engage with the realities in the �eld.69 Given the
recondite, evolving, and dynamic nature of justice reform in FCSs, any pre-
scriptions for donor policy or action are likely to prove unhelpful. This brave
new world, however, will undoubtedly open up spaces for experimentation,70
and actors will explore what works in this new space. In this spirit, let us con-
duct an early exploration of what this emerging space might look like through
some modest sketches and brief suggestions that might support effective ex-
perimentation to underpin future efforts in this �eld, doing so through the
lenses of analysis, operations, and policy.
The WDR 2011 is an appropriate frame for such efforts. The key �ndings
of the WDR 2011 as regards justice in FCSs respond to the four problems with
models outlined above:
• Exclusion of signi�cant portions of the population (be that on the basis of
ethnicity, religion, geography, etc.) from political voice, access to services,
and economic opportunity establishes the conditions for triggering and
65 WDR 2011, at 155–6, 169, 260.
66 Sage, Tamanaha, & Woolcock, supra note 44. See, generally, Justice for the Poor website, at
< http://web.worldbank.org/WBSITE/EXTERNAL/TOPICS/EXTLAWJUSTICE/
EXTJUSFORPOOR/0,,menuPK:3282947~pagePK:149018~piPK:149093~theSitePK:3282787,00
.html>.
67 As discussions are currently taking place, the nature of the project is in flux; this view rep-
resents that contained in World Bank, Afghanistan Justice Sector Reform Project: DRAFT
Concept Note (2011) (copy on �le with the authors).
68 World Bank, Societal Dynamics and Fragility: Engaging Societies in Responding to Fragile Situa-
tions (World Bank 2011).
69 We do not seek to diminish the importance of national policymakers to effective reform, and
we stress that the arguments advanced in this chapter are inspired by the insights afforded
to us by national policymakers from Afghanistan and Liberia.
70 We also appreciate the cautionary note in Aldous Huxley’s eponymous novel, which painted
a picture of a world organized to be the antithesis of local experimentation. Just as Huxley
wrote of dystopian human homogeneity and highly strati�ed and rigid social structures and
hierarchies, we, too, caution against the continued use by donors of presumptions of hu-
man homogeneity and of rigid human and social models: Aldous Huxley, Brave New World
(HarperCollins 1998).
256 The World Bank Legal Review
fueling conflict (requiring a response to state-centrism and organizational
isomorphism).71
• Institutions, particularly nonstate institutions, that can mediate conflict
and navigate and manage complex change are essential if societies are
to emerge from cyclical conflict and endemic fragility (responding to
state-centrism and, as a challenge to the idea of postconflict transitional
moments, responding to short time frames).72
• The state-society compact needs to be broadened over time so that political
settlements have broad-based legitimacy, which is a foundational require-
ment for a functioning rule of law (responding to short time frames).73
• Developing institutional capability and legitimacy is an inherently un-
even (responding to linear trajectories of change) but endogenous process
(responding to organizational isomorphism) that is generational in time-
scale (responding to short time frames).74
Implications for Analysis
Minister Tah provides clear guidance from the perspective of the daily reali-
ties faced by policymakers in the �eld. She highlights the importance of going
beyond state-centrism and taking a holistic approach to available justice insti-
tutions in FCSs, outlining the tension between the expectations placed by the
people on the government as a resolver of grievances75 and the social fact that
most citizens turn (at least initially) to nonstate institutions in their quest for
justice.76 She also stresses that what we have termed organizational isomor-
phism (“a cookie cutter approach�)77 remains inadequate: the particularities
of FCSs—in the case of Liberia, a country where a “persistent traumatized
population [routinely encounters] weakness in capacity-building programs
due to lack of foundational preparedness of trainees and, most importantly,
a disintegrated value system�78—suggests that there needs to be an enhanced
appreciation of the importance of context as the foundation for effective
engagement.
71 See, for example, WDR 2011, at 6, 13, 18.
72 See, for example, WDR 2011, at 119, 156.
73 See, generally, WDR 2011, at 193–97 (arguing that international support—rooted in local
context—can help broaden state-society compacts, creating a double compact between state
and citizen, and state and international community).
74 WDR 2011, at 251.
75 “The public . . . expects all grievances, past and present, to be redressed by the government
with immediacy and without regard to resource limitations.� Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 9.
76 “A public that for so long has been alienated from the formal justice system.� Azimi & Tah,
supra note 1, at 9.
77 Id., at 12.
78 Id., at 10.
Rethinking Justice Reform 257
As a result, donors need broad-based analytical capacity to try to make
sense of complex, often fractured settings—in other words, to enable “a dili-
gent inquiry into the deep[-]rooted causes that will guide an innovative and
unique perspective.�79 The implication of these words is to appreciate the im-
portance of justice beyond the narrowly de�ned “justice sector� to engage
with a range of sources and drivers of societal stress, to which development
initiatives themselves can contribute.80
Such capacity will allow donors to put the state into context and to be
sensitive to nonlinearity in the evolution of the justice sector in FCSs. For ex-
ample, trade-offs need to be made, such as between “the immediate release of
those held in violation of their constitutional right to a speedy trial� per the
demands of human rights advocates, and “the general public demands that
the accused individuals remain incarcerated inde�nitely to ensure that public
safety is not compromised.�81 This will help build donor capacity to navigate
transitional steps out of fragility, with an appreciation of the value of interim
institutions and processes.82
This involves bringing to bear a much more plural set of expertise, disci-
plines, and methodologies than is the current norm (which disproportionately
bears the imprint of lawyers, political scientists, and economists).83 The disci-
plines that inform these might include the following:
• History, particularly the history of the dynamics and legacies of conflict.
Chief Justice Azimi of Afghanistan noted the dif�cult legacy of the ca-
pacity and capability of judges that postinvasion Afghanistan inherited.84
Minister Tah commented on the flight of trained legal personnel during
the civil war.85
79 Id., at 12.
80 The WDR 2011 supports this view, seeing justice as, in part, a set of “institutions required to
address underlying disputes that contribute to violence�: WDR 2011, at xvi.
81 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 9.
82 Desai & Sage, supra note 2, at 5–6.
83 Yves Dezalay & Bryant Garth, The Internationalization of Palace Wars: Lawyers, Economists, and
the Contest to Transform Latin American States 163–85, especially 163–76 (U. of Chicago Press
2002). See, generally, David Kennedy, The Mystery of Global Governance, 34 Ohio Northern
U.L. Rev. 827 (2008).
84 “[W]ithin the judiciary over many years, all kinds of people were in of�ce occupying the
position of judge or court administrator. Most particularly, there were unquali�ed people
and illegally appointed people. Personnel of the court system had been appointed during
different political regimes, different governments, including the communist government,
then the Mujahedeen government, then the Taliban government, then even after the Bonn
Conference.� Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 2.
85 “Legal institutions barely functioned as many of the well educated and well trained citizens
in law enforcement and the law fled the country in the 1990s.� Azimi & Tah, supra note 1,
at 8.
258 The World Bank Legal Review
• Psychology, noting Minister Tah’s comments on psycho-social trauma86
but also the ways in which perceptions of legitimacy, credibility, and ef-
fectiveness can vary among different actors, with serious consequences
for the sustainability and ef�cacy of reform efforts.
• Sociology, to provide, for example, insights into the patterns of norma-
tive “disintegration� during periods of societal transition, the dynamics
of conflict that accompany these transitions as power oscillates between
different groups, and understandings of the conditions under which dif-
ferent aspects of people’s identities become politically salient.87
• Anthropology, to generate, for example, a closer understanding of, and pro-
vide explanatory force for, the social role played by “trial by ordeal.�88
• Communications (including drama and performance), especially between
groups who have very different ways of making and interpreting knowl-
edge claims (such as illiterate villagers and social scientists).89
Implications for Operations
Donor interventions in Liberia expect “the justice system to function today as
any other justice system in the region and, in some instances, on international
standards, without regard to cultural diversity, limited resources or consider-
ation of the abyss from which the country has ascended.�90 If this situation is
to change, donors must avoid organizational isomorphism and the presump-
tion of linear trajectories of change, instead developing an understanding of
the situation in which they are intervening before designing operations. For
example, they need to be sensitive to long-run time horizons and the trade-
offs that need to be made in the short term in order that a state-society com-
pact might be built in the long term. Minster Tah’s call provides an important
framework for donor experimentation.
Operations need to be highly sensitive to the context of the situations in
which they intervene. This is not a new observation.91 However, this chapter’s
86 “Security, rule of law, and the level of productivity in the country all depend on how well we
address the psycho-social problems of the society and restore to the country the value system
that was so badly damaged during the years of war.� Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 10.
87 See, on the contribution of sociology to enriching legal understandings of norms and norm
diffusion, Robert Ellickson, Law and Economics Discovers Social Norms, Yale Law School
Faculty Scholarship Series Paper 407 (1998), available at . See, generally, on the importance of interdisciplinary approaches
to studying and understanding social norms, Robert Axelrod, An Evolutionary Approach to
Norms, 80 Am. Pol. Science Rev. 1095 (1986).
88 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 10. On the potential role of ethnographic �eld research on this
issue in Liberia, see Isser, Lubkemann, & N’Tow, supra note 42.
89 Supra notes 80 and 81.
90 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 9.
91 See, for example, World Bank: Report on Headline Seminar, supra note 18; Rodrik, Subrama-
nian, & Trebbi, supra note 14; Sage, Tamanaha, & Woolcock, supra note 44.
Rethinking Justice Reform 259
analysis of the two paradigms, coupled with Minister Tah’s analysis, suggests
three new ways to reconceptualize interventions:
• Levels of intervention: the limits of states in FCSs often (but not always92)
coupled to settings of deep legal pluralism, imply that operations should
be decentralized (including engagement with legal pluralism) rather than
privileging state-centrism.
• Type of intervention: the nature of interventions designed to strengthen
the operation of justice systems and institutions, especially at the local
level, might be broadened in two ways. First, they might be targeted at
speci�c issues underlying fragility at the social as well as the state level
(e.g., to combat psycho-social trauma93 among the Liberian population94).
Second, they might be designed to shift social norms and expectations,95
particularly through communication and education strategies96 targeted at
the public (e.g., “public education as to evidentiary standards�),97 avoid-
ing organizational isomorphism.
• Modality of intervention: given the contexts in which they occur, inter-
ventions need to have long time horizons98 and modest aims, particularly
because they need to be sensitive to policy trade-offs, avoiding short time
frames and linear trajectories of change.
92 The Kosovo context, for example, was one of a state that retained signi�cant formal capacity
in spite of the conflict: Alexandros Yannis, The UN as Government in Kosovo, 10 Glob. Gover-
nance 67 (2004).
93 See, for example, Cheryl de la Rey & Ingrid Owens, Perceptions of Psychosocial Healing and the
Truth and Reconciliation Commission in South Africa, 4 Peace & Conflict: J. of Peace Psychology
257 (1998). See also, for a critical perspective, Laurel Fletcher & Harvey Weinstein, Violence
and Social Repair: Rethinking the Contribution of Justice to Reconciliation, 24 Hum. Rights. Q.
573, 638–9 (2002), which concludes that “a comprehensive community-based approach that
includes the opinions and ideas of those whose lives have been most directly affected is
critical,� but that “international interventions should be implemented in the context of an
ecological understanding of social repair.�
94 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 10, 12.
95 This builds on the work by Martha Nussbaum, Arjun Appadurai, and others on adaptive
expectations: see, for example, Martha Nussbaum, Women and Human Development: The Capa-
bilities Approach (Cambridge U. Press 2000); Arjun Appadurai, The Capacity to Aspire: Culture
and the Terms of Recognition, in Culture and Public Action 59 (Vijayendra Rao & Michael Walton
ed., World Bank 2004). See also Pablo de Greiff, Comments (World Bank’s Law, Justice and
Development Week, Nov. 2010) (on �le with authors) (arguing that justice needs to engage
with “adaptive preferences . . . the argument is that people who are under constant condi-
tions of the prevision, in order to avoid constantly defeated expectations, adjust their prefer-
ence forward, and that this has an impact on the way in which they participate in, among
other things, economic activities�).
96 See, for example, on community literature, theater, and radio, Milena Stefanova, Raewyn
Porter, & Rod Nixon, Leasing in Vanuatu: Findings and Community Dissemination on Epi Island,
5(4) Justice for the Poor Brie�ng Note 1 (2010); Saumya Pant, Arvind Singhal, & Usha Bhasin,
Using Radio Drama to Entertain and Educate: India’s Experience with the Production, Reception,
and Transcreation of Dehleez, 13 J. Dev. Comm. 52 (2002).
97 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 9.
98 “[T]he transformation we so impatiently desire will occur over time.� Id.
260 The World Bank Legal Review
As a result, it might be useful to experiment with justice projects that seek
to internalize norms in a particular social setting, that favor the provision of
equitable spaces, or that support institutions engaging with a wide range of
social fault-lines and fractures.99
Implications for Policy
Donors engaged in promoting justice in FCSs need to make context-sensitive
policy. A �rst step in this direction could be to launch experimental programs
that respond to the analytical and operational implications outlined in the pre-
ceding sections. Pilot programs and reports based on methodologies beyond
the orthodox (historical analyses, for example) can provide an evidence base
for effective, context-based policymaking that avoids state-centrism, organiza-
tional isomorphism, short time frames, and linear trajectories of change. For ex-
ample, a donor might devise a strategy for engagement with nonstate systems,
or might develop an holistic approach to avoid lopsided policy that supports
one institution (such as the police) at the expense of the system as a whole.100
At the same time, however, donors need to ensure that counterparts in
FCSs have the capacity to engage when determining policy and priorities. Af-
ghanistan provides a cautionary tale. Chief Justice Azimi recounts that
although the international community sought from us a list of our
priorities, a plan for the future development of the judiciary and the
priorities we wished to apply, we did not adequately express our
needs. Up until only four years ago, we failed to specify what we
needed, to set our priorities or to estimate the likely costs of those
priorities. This led the international community to assume that ev-
erything was okay in the judiciary. Some simple donor-funded train-
ing programs were conducted from time to time, which seemed the
best thing to be done; and donors were happy that these efforts were
meeting our expectations.101
Donors thus need to rethink their engagement with the state, incorpo-
rating or reemphasizing building the state’s policy expertise into their policy
development practices.
Conclusion
The default assumption in most development work is that weak implemen-
tation systems are in large part a function of capacity constraints on the part
of line ministries in recipient countries, and that as such performance can be
best improved by engaging in various concrete activities—training sessions,
99 See Daniel Adler, Caroline Sage, & Michael Woolcock, Interim Institutions and the Development
Process: Opening Spaces for Reform in Cambodia and Indonesia, Brooks World Poverty Institute
Working Paper No. 86 (Mar. 2009).
100 Azimi & Tah, supra note 1, at 12.
101 Id.
Rethinking Justice Reform 261
policy change, infrastructure provision, organizational reform—designed to
strengthen the prevailing structures and upgrade the skills of the agents work-
ing within them. Moreover, in a world of development assistance in which
skepticism is high, time horizons are short, and resources are stretched, high-
uncertainty issues such as enhancing justice in fragile and conflict-affected
states generate multiple pressures for donors to show some form of short-
term accomplishment; all too often, these pressures are relieved by pointing to
changes in institutional form (what institutions look like)—laws passed, court-
houses built, reporting procedures altered—as opposed to function (what they
actually do), and by justifying actions on the basis that experts elsewhere have
deemed them a best practice. Some of this work has been successful, but the
considered assessment of most rule of law reform efforts, whether undertaken
in the name of state building or economic development, is that, at best, much
remains to be learned.
So understood, capacity de�cits are as much a problem for international
agencies as for FCSs themselves, and improving the effectiveness of justice ini-
tiatives therefore requires revisiting the theories and corresponding practices
that inform current approaches.
Justice reform is best understood as an adaptive rather than (primarily)
technical problem, one that requires a sustained commitment to understand-
ing the idiosyncrasies of the context(s) in order to more correctly identify
binding constraint problems and possible solutions. With this in mind, donors
should seek to improve their capacity to broaden the range of groups with
whom they engage at the operational level, the methodological base on which
key decisions are made, and their willingness and ability to engage with ac-
tors beyond the state—and the formal justice sector itself—in the larger task of
enhancing the quality and accessibility of justice for all.
International Norms and Standards
Applicable to Situations
of State Fragility and Failure
An Overview
CHIARA GIORGETTI*
State fragility and failure are best de�ned legally as the incapacity of a state
to perform its obligations toward its citizens and toward the international
community in general.1 Fragile, failing, and failed states are characterized by
an implosion of state structures, which results in the incapability of govern-
* Some of the ideas in this article are also developed in the author’s book, A Principled
Approach to State Failure: International Community Actions in Emergency Situations (Martinus
Nijhoff 2010). The views expressed in this article are hers alone.
1 Contemporary governance has resulted in a new standard of governance that has increased
the overall responsibilities of each state. States must perform innumerable actions daily, di-
rected at their own people, other states, and the international community. This requirement
results in the obligation of each state to provide numerous goods and services, including
protection, a functioning legal system, a working judiciary, an effective education system,
health care, an ef�cient administration able to deliver goods and services, infrastructures,
and the possibility of participating in the global economy. Moreover, the modern economic
system requires each state to provide trade facilities, a �nancial market, communication sys-
tems, a road network, air connections, port access, and security. Further, any functioning
contemporary state needs a large infrastructure to provide for the health and education of
its citizens, as well as for terrestrial and aerial transport of people and goods. It needs to be
able to support complicated �nancial and banking transactions, and must be able to support
a functioning legal system. At the same time, the world has become more interdependent.
The development of communication and the ease of travel have created a world society in
which values, expectations, and political and economic views are broadly shared. Moreover,
what happens in one part of the world can have immediate repercussions in other parts
of the world and in a variety of domains, including �nancial transactions, environmental
emergencies, health crises, and security risks. Further, the number of international conven-
tions and bilateral and multilateral treaties has increased substantially. (The collection of the
United Nations Treaty Series currently contains more than 158,000 bilateral and multilat-
eral treaties deposited between 1946 and 2003, available at .) However, certain states are un-
able to operate in this new system of increased responsibility, in terms of obligations toward
other states, the international community, and their citizens. These states—often referred to
as fragile, failing, or failed states—have become ineffective actors on the international stage,
posing multiple problems for the international community as certain necessary obligations
and required acts fail to be performed, weakening the entire system. One of these problems
is that the rights of domestic populations are eroded. Health and other basic rights can-
not be assured. As the failing of state sovereignty continues, the lack of respect for basic
rights worsens, often giving rise to humanitarian crises. Another problem is that state failure
has consequences in the international community. Failing and failed states are unable to
perform their obligations toward the international community, for example, because they are
unable to guarantee protection of their borders or airspace or are unable to address health
emergencies.
263
264 The World Bank Legal Review
mental authorities to perform their functions, including providing security,
respecting the rule of law, exercising control, supplying education and health
services, establishing commercial and banking systems, and maintaining
economic and structural infrastructures.2
State fragility is multifaceted and can be depicted as a continuum, as the
state becomes progressively less capable of performing its functions and slides
deeper into the category of “failed.� Complete state collapse is the ultimate,
and rare, result; different stages of state fragility can be encountered along
a continuum. A rigorous analysis of the legal implications, signi�cance, and
consequences of state fragility is—despite its importance—missing.3
The World Bank de�nes fragile states as states that are affected by conflict
or have a country policy and institutional assessment (CPIA) index of 3.2 or
below.4 The CPIA index rates countries against sixteen criteria grouped into
four clusters: economic management; structural policies; policies for social in-
clusion and equity; and public sector management and institutions.5
2 In particular, as Zartman describes, in fragile and failing sates, “as the decision-making cen-
ter of the government, the state is paralyzed and inoperative: laws are not made, order is
not preserved, and societal cohesion is not enhanced. As a symbol of identity, it has lost its
power of conferring a name on its people and a meaning to their social action. As a terri-
tory, it no longer assures security and provisionment by a central sovereign organization.
As the authoritative political institution, it has lost its legitimacy, which is therefore up for
grabs, and so has lost its right to command and conduct public affairs. As a system of so-
cioeconomic organization, its functional balance of inputs and outputs is destroyed; it no
longer receives supports from, nor exercise controls over its people, and it no longer is even
the target of demands, because its people know that it is incapable of providing supplies.
No longer functioning, with neither traditional nor charismatic nor institutional sources of
legitimacy, it has lost the right to rule.� I. William Zartman, Introduction: Posing the Problem of
State Collapse, in Collapsed States: The Disintegration and Restoration of Legitimate Authority 1, 5
(I. William Zartman ed., Lynne Rienner 1995) (internal citation omitted).
3 In fact, because de�nitions of what constitutes such states are, in general, informed by the
analysts’ de�nition of the state and their own views of the functions and role of the state, in-
ternational law has not recognized and named the phenomenon of state failure and fragility.
International law focuses on the creation and dissolution of a state, but has not focused on
the evolution, changes, or temporary failures that may occur after a state is created. Further-
more, an agreed-upon de�nition of “fragility� or “failure� does not exist, with many actors
criticizing the use of the terms “failing� and “failed� states. See Chiara Giorgetti, A Principled
Approach to State Failure: International Community Actions in Emergency Situations (Martinus
Nijhoff 2010).
4 Using 2005 data, for example, the CPIA of the following countries was less than 3.2: Alba-
nia, Angola, Azerbaijan, Bangladesh, Bosnia and Herzegovina, Burundi, Cambodia, Central
African Republic, Chad, Comoros, Congo, Côte d’Ivoire, Democratic Republic of Congo,
Djibouti, Dominica, Eritrea, The Gambia, Grenada, Guinea, Guinea-Bissau, Guyana, Haiti,
Honduras, Indonesia, Kenya, Kiribati, Kyrgyz Republic, Lesotho, Mali, Mongolia, Mozam-
bique, Nepal, Niger, Nigeria, Papua New Guinea, Republic of Yemen, Rwanda, São Tomé
and PrÃncipe, Sierra Leone, Solomon Islands, Sudan, Tajikistan, Togo, Tonga, Vanuatu,
Zimbabwe. Id.
5 World Bank, CPIA—Policies and Institutions for Environmental Sustainability, available at
. The World Bank created the Fragile States Ini-
tiative in 2003 to respond to state fragility. The Bank supports its initiative in this sector with
the Post-Conflict Fund, the Low-Income Countries Under Stress Implementation Trust Fund,
and other funds. See Rumu Sarkar, International Development Law 160 (Oxford U. Press 2009).
International Norms and Standards 265
Fragility and conflict have repercussions on domestic populations. The
World Bank estimates that one billion people live in countries affected by
fragility and conflict; in these countries, poverty rates average 54 percent, com-
pared with 22 percent for low-income countries as a whole. These countries
are de�ned by weak political, legal, and economic institutions. The impact of
warfare is also a protracted development challenge; achieving the Millennium
Development Goals is dif�cult in fragile states.6
International law plays a central role in multiple aspects of state fragility,
from de�ning the state and sanctioning its existence to—increasingly—regu-
lating how to assist a state in postconflict rebuilding. In fact, as is discussed
in this chapter, international norms and standards increasingly shape peace-
building and state-building efforts in fragile and conflict-affected areas. At the
urging of multilateral organizations and bilateral aid agencies, transnational
benchmarks and prescriptions are applied to such diverse activities as fram-
ing constitutions; holding elections; establishing legislatures and courts; writ-
ing business, commercial, and tax laws; creating procurement arrangements;
and reforming the security sector.7
The use of international standards and prescriptions in fragile states has
substantially affected the form and conduct of emerging political and admin-
istrative institutions and, in turn, influenced reconstruction and development
outcomes. In some instances, international benchmarking has helped fragile
and conflict-affected areas develop transparent and effective governance and
service-delivery arrangements. However, in other areas, no such arrange-
ments exist or benchmarking has resulted in impositions that have impeded,
rather than contributed to, achieving development objectives.8
6 World Bank, Fragile and Conflict-Affected Countries, available at .
7 See, for example, Karin Von Hippel, Democracy by Force: U.S. Intervention in the Post–Cold War
World (Cambridge U. Press 2000); Kirsti Samuels, Post-conflict Peace-Building and Constitution-
Making, 6 Chi. J. Intl. L. 1 (2006); Sunil Bastian & Robin Luckham, Introduction: Can Democracy
Be Designed? in Can Democracy Be Designed? The Politics of Institutional Choice in Conflict-Torn
Societies 1, 5 (Sunil Bastian & Robin Luckham ed., Zed 2003); OSCE/ODIHR Draft Paper,
International Standards and Commitments on the Right to Democratic Elections: A Practi-
cal Guide to Democratic Elections (Nov. 2002), available at ; UNDP, Governance in Conflict Prevention and Recovery: A Guidance
Note (Dec. 2009), available at ; UNDP, Evidence Informed Policy in
Post-conflict Contexts: Nepal, Peru and Serbia (Sept. 2009), available at ; Security Sector Reform in Challenging Environments (Hans Born & Albrecht Scharbel ed.,
LIT Verlag 2009); and OECD DAC, Principles of Good International Engagement in Fragile
States: Learning and Advisory Process on Dif�cult Partnerships (2006), available at . See also The Role of International Law in Rebuilding Societies after Conflict—
Great Expectations (Brett Bowden, Hilary Charlesworth, & Jeremy Farrall ed., Cambridge U.
Press 2009).
8 See, in general, Governance in Post-conflict Societies: Rebuilding Fragile States (D. Brincker-
off ed., Routledge 2007); J. Paul Dunne, After the Slaughter: Reconstructing Mozambique and
Rwanda, 1(2) Economics of Peace and Security J. 38 (2006); Joanna MacRae, Dilemmas of
�Post�-Conflict Transition: Lessons from the Health Sector, ODI Network Paper No. 12 (1995).
266 The World Bank Legal Review
This chapter describes and examines the diverse ways in which inter-
national norms and standards influence state “rehabilitation,� focusing on
how they impact peace-building and state-building activities in fragile and
conflict-affected areas. It also constructs an analytical framework to account
for and evaluate the role of international law in reconstruction, development,
and state-building activities.
Speci�cally, this chapter focuses on three sets of international norms and
standards: those that constitute a framework that must be followed to regulate
the creation or reestablishment of the state as a legal entity to reintegrate the
fragile state into the international community; those that establish minimum
standards of protection afforded to the individual; and those that guide the
reconstruction of the domestic legal system.
The International Law Framework
The �rst sphere in which international law plays an obvious role in assessing
and assisting fragile and conflict-affected states is the de�nition of statehood
and sovereignty. These issues are explored below, �rst to provide an overview
of the process of creating and recognizing postconflict states and then to ex-
amine relevant transitional arrangements for states that may provide useful
alternatives in postconflict reconstruction.
How International Law De�nes States:
The Montevideo Convention
States are essentially a legal creation and are legal entities in international
law. International law plays a fundamental role in de�ning states and in
sanctioning their existence. The 1933 Montevideo Convention on the Rights
and Duties of States embodies the commonly agreed-on de�nition of what
a state is. Article 1 of the convention provides that “the state as a person in
international law should possess the following quali�cations: A permanent
population; A de�ned territory; Government; and Capacity to enter into
relations with other States.� This latter criterion is often equated with inde-
pendence. Any state, therefore, should possess these quali�cations in order to
be considered a state under international law. This de�nition is valid today,
although it is challenged by state fragility.9
9 In reality, this de�nition is probably too static and does not reflect changes in statehood.
Fragile and failing states often witness major shifts in population dynamics. Often, large por-
tions of the population migrate outside the state border, as in Sudan and Somalia. Moreover,
people may shift their allegiance from the central to the local level, as shown in Afghanistan
and the Democratic Republic of Congo. However, neither of these changes alters the condi-
tion of a “state� when that condition has already been acquired. Similarly, fragile and failed
states are often characterized by porous borders and the inability of a government to exercise
territorial sovereignty. Their territory is often controlled by several groups and militias. Typi-
cally, the recognized government is capable of controlling only circumscribed areas around
the capital. Examples include the Democratic Republic of Congo, whose government, for
certain periods, controlled little territory outside the capital; Afghanistan, where the Taliban,
International Norms and Standards 267
In reality, effective entities have existed that, for political reasons, were
not recognized as states (for example, Rhodesia and Somaliland), while nonef-
fective entities have been recognized as states (for example, Poland in World
War II and Kuwait in 1990–91).10 Nonetheless, the Montevideo criteria play an
important initial role in assessing the viability of a new, postconflict state and
should therefore be duly analyzed.
Relevant Peremptory Norms
In addition to providing an initial de�nition of state, international norms pro-
vide a framework of binding principles that guide postconflict reconstruction
and affect the creation and establishment of states. In fact, the development of
peremptory norms of international law guides the creation and reestablish-
ment of conflict-affected states. Several norms are relevant.
Self-Determination
The principle of self-determination provides fundamental guidance in
conflict-affected areas. It is recognized as a peremptory norm by several bind-
ing international instruments, as well as by decisions of the International Court
of Justice.11 The principle provides that peoples should be able to freely deter-
mine their own legal and political status within a given territory, particularly
and not the recognized government, controls most of the country; Sudan, where domestic
rebel groups claim independence of parts of the southern territory; Somalia; Liberia; and
Côte d’Ivoire. Further, one of the main characteristics of failed and failing states is a weak
and ineffective government that does not and cannot provide for its people. However, dur-
ing decolonization, several states gained independence even when there were no existing
powers capable of exercising governmental functions. The Democratic Republic of Congo,
for example, obtained its independence from Belgium on June 30, 1960, in the midst of inter-
nal �ghting. A few days after independence, the Congolese Public Force mutinied, Belgian
troops intervened, and one of the provinces, Katanga, announced secession from the main
territory. However, the Democratic Republic of Congo was admitted to the United Nations
in September 1960, as two different factions of government sought to be accepted at the UN
as legitimate representatives. The independence of Guinea-Bissau from Portugal is another
example. Although still under Portuguese rule, the African Party for the Independence of
Guinea and Cape Verde declared independence unilaterally in 1973. A UN General Assem-
bly vote in the same year denounced illegal Portuguese aggression and occupation, and
discussed the issue of “illegal occupation by Portuguese forces� of the territory of Guinea-
Bissau. Western states denied the existence of the necessary criteria for statehood, but GA
Resolution 3061(XXVIII) accepted the “recent accession to independence of Guinea-Bissau,�
although its government controlled neither a majority of the population nor its main towns.
Thus, as Higgins concludes, “statehood for purposes of UN admission, was attributed even
when the new governments clearly lacked effective control.� Rosalyn Higgins, Problems and
Process, International Law and How We Use It 40 (Oxford U. Press 1994).
10 James Crawford, The Creation of States in International Law (2d ed., Oxford U. Press 2006).
11 For example, Article 1 of the UN Charter states the “purposes of the United Nations are
. . . (2) to develop friendly relations among nations based on respect for the principle of equal
rights and self-determination of peoples.� Similarly, Article 55 of the UN Charter provides:
“With a view to the creation of conditions of stability and well-being which are necessary
for peaceful and friendly relations among nations based on the respect for the principle of
equal rights and self-determination of peoples.� See also UN Declaration on the Granting of
Independence to Colonial Countries and Peoples, GA Res. 1514 (XV), UN GAOR, 15th Sess.,
Supp. No. 16, UN Doc. A/4684 (1961).
268 The World Bank Legal Review
in relation to colonial territories. It played a fundamental role in the achieve-
ment of statehood at the end of the colonial period, and it reassumed rele-
vance in the post–Cold War fragmentation that resulted in the establishment
of many new states. It is still relevant today, especially in assessing the claims
of minorities in postconflict situations such as Kosovo, Sudan, and Somalia.
Other international binding norms are also relevant in postconflict situa-
tions. The application of diverse binding norms, all simultaneously relevant,
however, may create tension between principles and dif�culties in their ap-
plication. For example, the UN Charter endorses the principle of territorial
integrity, by which the integrity of a territory of a member state is recognized
as paramount.12 Yet the principle of territorial integrity may be at odds with
the principle of self-determination.
In general, it is recognized that the principle of self-determination applies
as a matter of right only after a unit of self-determination has been determined,
not just to any group of people desiring independence and self-government.
As such, the principle applies to territories established and recognized as
separate political units, including mandates, trusts, states, and other terri-
tories forming distinct political-geographical areas whose inhabitants have
been arbitrarily excluded from government so as to have become “non-self-
governing.� Examples of the latter are Eritrea and Kosovo.13 The dif�culty is
to de�ne a non-self-governing territory precisely. The International Court of
Justice sanctioned the validity of the unilateral declaration of independence
of Kosovo from Serbia, �nding that the declaration was not in violation of
international law.14
The Use of Force
Article 2 of the UN Charter prohibits the threat or use of force against the ter-
ritorial integrity or political independence of a state unless the threat is made
or force is used in self-defense after an armed attack or is authorized by the
Security Council under Chapter VII of the UN Charter to maintain interna-
tional peace and security.
The international community has refused to accept the legal validity of
acts derived by the illegal use of force. The tension between the principle
of self-determination and the prohibition of the unlawful use of force is par-
ticularly relevant for conflict resolution and postconflict reconstruction. In
12 Article 2(4) of the UN Charter provides that “all Members shall refrain in their international
relations from the threat or use of force against territorial integrity or political independence
of any state, or in any other manner inconsistent with the Purposes of the United Nations.�
13 See Crawford, supra note 10, at 126–27.
14 Accordance with International Law of the Unilateral Declaration of Independence in Respect of
Kosovo, Advisory Op. (Jul. 22, 2010), available at .
International Norms and Standards 269
practice, this principle has not undermined actions by secessionist movements
exercising their right to self-determination.
The tension is especially important when considering the legality of the
use of force by external powers in conflict situations in accordance with or in
violation of an applicable right to self-determination. The intervention of the
international community in Kosovo is a case in point. In recent history, in fact,
many critics have argued for the legality of “humanitarian interventions� as
an exception to the prohibition of the use of force.
Humanitarian interventions are interventions by the international
community or single actors therein to assist populations that suffer grave
violations of human rights. Whether such interventions are approved by the
United Nations and are therefore legal is of great importance to the process of
postconflict reconstruction and the ability of multilateral and regional devel-
opment partners to assist in that reconstruction. In Afghanistan, for example,
following the Bonn Accords, the World Bank and other development agencies
were able to reengage and assist in reconstruction and rebuilding. Conversely,
the initial postconflict reconstruction efforts in Iraq encountered many dif-
�culties. However, as the example of Somalia demonstrates, the legality of an
intervention cannot completely guarantee local support.
State Recognition
State recognition is an international law issue that is relevant to the establish-
ment of states. To enter fully into the international community, states must be
recognized by other members of this community and thus by other states. It
has been argued that recognition of a state by fellow states is in fact a requisite
for statehood, “effectively forming an additional category to those stipulated
in the Montevideo Convention.�15 Two main theories on the nature of recogni-
tion exist: is recognition of states by other states declaratory or constitutive?
Although it is generally accepted that recognition is in principle declaratory
(the Institut de Droit International expressly acknowledged that recognition
has a declaratory effect and noted that the existence of a new state with all
the legal effects attached to that existence would not be affected by the refusal
of recognition by one or more states), recognition by other states is of great
importance for the existence of states. For example, during the conflict in the
former Yugoslavia, the recognition by some European Union members of the
independent status of former constituent parts of the Socialist Federal Repub-
lic of Yugoslavia was crucial to ensure their viability. Similarly, in the Somalia
crisis, withholding the recognition of the breakaway northern territory of So-
maliland plays an important role in Somalia’s existence.
Some authors think that only states that embrace democracy and
human rights may effectively be recognized as members of the international
15 Higgins, supra note 9, at 41.
270 The World Bank Legal Review
community.16 This view is supported by the practice of states vis-Ã -vis the rec-
ognition of new states that were formerly part of the Soviet Union. In 1991,
when the Soviet Union began to dissolve, the European Council issued a
declaration containing guidelines on the recognition of new states in Eastern
Europe and the Soviet Union establishing respect for democracy and human
rights as a criterion for recognition.17 A similar requirement was imposed on
the former members of the Socialist Federal Republic of Yugoslavia by the
Badinter Arbitration Commission, although the practice in this case is more
complex.18 At the moment, the practice of an additional requirement for rec-
ognition seems to have been imposed only on certain states.
Importantly, under international law, there is an established duty of col-
lective nonrecognition of a state by other states if certain peremptory norms
of international law have been violated, including the prohibition of the use
of force and the principles of nondiscrimination and self-determination. Situ-
ations in which the duty of collective nonrecognition was exercised include
South Africa–controlled Namibia, Rhodesia, Kuwait after the invasion by
Iraq, Northern Cyprus, and East Timor.
Admission to International Organizations
International law plays an important role in the establishment of a state by
regulating admission to international organizations. Article 4 of the UN Char-
ter stipulates that only “peace-loving States� can be admitted to the United
Nations. By doing so, it restricts admission to only those states that meet
certain (minimal) legal requirements. Other international organizations in-
clude similar provisions. Of course, rules of admission vary in relation to each
international organization. Under the World Bank Articles of Agreement, a
country must join the International Monetary Fund (IMF) prior to becoming a
member of the Bank. Membership in the International Development Associa-
tion (IDA), the International Finance Corporation (IFC), and the Multilateral
Investment Guarantee Agency (MIGA) is conditioned on membership in the
International Bank for Reconstruction and Development (IBRD). Historically,
this issue has been important for consideration of the admission of micro-
states.19 The issue assumed renewed importance with the dissolution of Rus-
sia and Yugoslavia, especially for the admission of Yugoslavia itself and, more
16 See, in general, Democratic Governance and International Law (Gregory H. Fox & Brad R. Roth
ed., Cambridge U. Press 2000).
17 Resolution of December 16, 1991, available at .
18 See Sean D. Murphy, Democratic Legitimacy and the Recognition of States and Governments, in
Democratic Governance and International Law 123 (Gregory H. Fox & Brad R. Roth ed., Cam-
bridge U. Press 2000).
19 As Higgins concludes, citing, inter alia, the examples of Rwanda and Burundi, “statehood
for purposes of UN admission, was attributed even when the new governments clearly
lacked effective control.� See Higgins, supra note 10.
International Norms and Standards 271
recently, Kosovo.20 Interestingly, Kosovo has been a member of the IMF—and
thus the World Bank—since June 2009, although it has not yet become a mem-
ber of the United Nations.
Rules relating to the admission of international organizations must be
clear and detailed. Although the United Nations requires states to be “peace
loving,� Article 1 of the European Bank for Reconstruction and Development
(EBRD) speci�es that
contributing to economic progress and reconstruction, the purpose
of the Bank shall be to foster the transition towards open market-
oriented economies and to promote private and entrepreneurial ini-
tiative in the Central and Eastern European countries committed to
and applying the principles of multiparty democracy, pluralism and
market economics.
States wishing to join the European Union must sign onto the 1950 Euro-
pean Convention for the Protection of Human Rights and Fundamental Free-
doms. Member candidates are required to ful�ll the 1993 Copenhagen criteria,
which include
stable institutions that guarantee democracy, the rule of law, human
rights and respect for and protection of minorities; a functioning
market economy, as well as the ability to cope with the pressure of
competition and the market forces at work inside the Union; the abil-
ity to assume the obligations of membership, in particular adherence
to the objectives of political, economic and monetary union.
An interesting question related to admission to international organizations
is whether there is any value in sequencing admission between institutions by,
for example, allowing admission to one organization as a stepping stone to
joining more complex organizations. A possible sequencing could provide ad-
mission to the Organisation for Security and Co-operation in Europe (OSCE),
then to the Council of Europe, and �nally to the EU.
Forms of and Alternatives to Statehood
States are not univocal, but are complex and multiformed entities. Principles
of international law are relevant when considering different forms of states
and alternatives to statehood. Internally, states can be constructed in many
different ways—they can be more or less centralized. Some states are federal
states and are made up of rather independent territories. Other states guaran-
tee a large amount of autonomy to certain parts of their territory, which can
enjoy varying degrees of self-government.
20 IBRD Articles of Agreement, Article I, available at . The term “World Bank� refers to the International Bank for Reconstruction and
Development (IBRD) and the International Development Association (IDA).
272 The World Bank Legal Review
In postconflict situations, considering the different internal structures
a state can enjoy is important in fostering durable peace. A certain degree of au-
tonomy could be granted to encourage reconciliation between �ghting groups
in internal conflicts. The development of a “menu of options� could be used
to propose diverse state structures during peace negotiations. This approach
was used in Somalia in the mid-1990s; such a menu was developed with the
assistance of the European Union, which envisaged confederation, federation,
decentralized unitary state, and consociation as possible options for reaching
a peace agreement. Although the process did not produce tangible results in
Somalia, it could be used to foster peace in other conflict situations.21
Temporary or permanent alternatives to statehood could be used as tran-
sitional arrangements for postconflict situations. For example, many differ-
ent arrangements exist vis-Ã -vis statehood. There are several dependencies,
including U.S. and British territories (including the U.S. and British Virgin
Islands and Puerto Rico), and French Overseas Departments and Territories
(DOM/TOM, Départements d’outre-mer and territoires d’outre-mer). Mini-
states such as Monaco and San Marino have fostered close ties with bigger
neighbors, many of which provide services, security, and defense. Other un-
usual sovereignty arrangements include the Holy See, which is the Episcopal
jurisdiction of the Pope; the Palestinian Authority; and the Western Sahara.
Additionally, alternatives to statehood include mandates, trusteeships,
colonies, international administrations, and other ad hoc solutions.
Historically, the League of Nations—and subsequently the United Na-
tions—created mandate or trusteeship mechanisms to deal with non-self-
governing territories and former colonies. The mandate system was established
under the League of Nations after World War I; trusteeship agreements are
characteristic of the post–World War II system. According to these arrange-
ments, member states were to administer trust territories until their inde-
pendence and under the supervision of the Trusteeship Council (Chapter
XII, Article 73, of the UN Charter). Both arrangements were temporary and
emphasized the priority of local interests and the obligations of the adminis-
trating states to guarantee and respect their well-being, with the objective of
developing self-government or independence. Usually the administration of
territories and trusteeships was taken up by former colonial powers. In very
few cases, the United Nations directly took on the role of trustee. For example,
in 1962–63, during the transition period from Dutch to Indonesian rule, the
Netherlands and Indonesia requested that the Trusteeship Council adminis-
ter New Jaya. Namibia is another example. In this case, because of South Af-
rica’s prolonged refusal to expedite the independence process of Namibia, the
United Nations took over the administration of Namibia without the consent
of the trustee state, South Africa, and created the Council for Namibia.
21 Von Hippel, supra note 7, at 86–89.
International Norms and Standards 273
There are at present no trusteeship arrangements; because of the past
record and colonial abuses, trusteeships are unlikely to return. However,
some authors have suggested the use of some form of trusteeship to deal
with state failure and to transfer the responsibility for states in disarray to
the UN Trusteeship Council.22 This proposal has created a lively debate;
although it is widely agreed that a return of the UN Trusteeship Council
is impossible, alternative arrangements for fragile states should be appro-
priately considered.23 Any new arrangements must be based on the duty
of states to cooperate and provide assistance to one another, and must be
devoid of any colonial undertones.24
The United Nations has indeed engaged in territorial administra-
tion of postconflict territories—international territorial administration is
not new. In fact, since its inception, the United Nations—and before it,
the League of Nations—has been entrusted by its members with some
form of temporary administration power for international territories in
special circumstances. The League administered the Free City of Danzig
from 1920 to 1939; the United Nations was to do the same for the planned
Free Territory of Trieste in 1947 (the territory was never released for rea-
sons unrelated to the United Nations).25 The involvement of the United
Nations in the administration of special territories has grown, espe-
cially during peace-keeping missions such as those in West Papua and
Namibia.26 Two more recent UN interventions pushed the nation-build-
ing role further, creating international authorities to administer territories
in Kosovo and East Timor. Both efforts were directed at the creation of
new states, and their mandates encompassed most traditional governance
functions and included speci�c provisions for running current affairs. Both
missions were temporary and directed at the reconstruction of an ef�cient
administration for the creation of a politically viable autonomous entity.
The United Nations Interim Administration of Kosovo
In Kosovo, the General Assembly gave the power to the secretary-gener-
al “to establish in the war-ravaged province of Kosovo an interim civil-
ian administration led by the United Nations under which its people could
progressively enjoy substantial autonomy.� In particular, Security Council
22 Gerald Helman & Steven Ratner, Saving Failed States, 89 Foreign Policy 3 (Winter 1993).
23 See Ruth Gordon, Saving Failed States: Sometimes a Neocolonialist Notion, 12 Am. U.J. Intl L. &
Pol’y 903 (1997): see also Ralph Wilde, International Territorial Administration: How Trusteeship
and the Civilizing Mission Never Went Away (Oxford U. Press 2008).
24 See Giorgetti, supra note 3, at 179–92.
25 See British–United States Zone, Allied Military Government, Of�cial Gazette, Free Territory
of Trieste, Trieste, 1947; Department of Legal Affairs, Headquarters Allied Military Govern-
ment, British-U.S. Zone, Judicial Decisions and Legal Opinions on Matters of Jurisdiction
Relating to the Free Territory of Trieste, 1951.
26 Bruce Jones with Feryal Cherif, Evolving Models of Peacekeeping: Policy Implications and
Responses, External Study 11 (Center on International Cooperation, NYU undated).
274 The World Bank Legal Review
Resolution 1244 (1999) authorized the United Nations Interim Administration
in Kosovo (UNMIK) to
Perform basic civilian administrative functions; Promote the estab-
lishment of substantial autonomy and self-government in Kosovo;
Facilitate a political process to determine Kosovo’s future status; Co-
ordinate humanitarian and disaster relief of all international agen-
cies; Support the reconstruction of key infrastructure; Maintain civil
law and order; Promote human rights; and Ensure the safe and un-
impeded return of all refugees and displaced persons to their homes
in Kosovo.
The same resolution, approved under Chapter VII of the UN Charter, au-
thorized the deployment of the Kosovo Force (KFOR), a peace-keeping force
led by NATO. The mandate for UNMIK included a special representative of
the secretary-general for Kosovo, who presided over the work of the adminis-
tration and facilitated the political process designed to determine Kosovo’s fu-
ture status. The special representative was appointed by the secretary-general
under the advice of UN member states. In June 1999, UNMIK set up the Joint
Interim Administrative Structure to reestablish and deliver central and mu-
nicipal administrative services. In most municipalities, municipal assemblies
with presidents, deputies, chief executive of�cers, and mandatory committees
on policy and �nance, communities, and mediation were elected by the end
of 2000.
UNMIK regulated several internal matters that included international
obligations. For example, the special representative adopted several regu-
lations establishing customs and taxes and Regulation 1999/12, which
established an international postal service. Regulation 1999/20 created the
Banking and Payments Authority of Kosovo and included speci�c provi-
sions for international technical cooperation. Regulation 2000/25 established
the administrative department of transport and infrastructure and included
special provisions for air transport directed at supervising and regulating
“air transport carriers, air transport system operations, including air traf�c
and air transport facility construction and maintenance.� UNMIK approved
a constitutional framework that established provisional institutions of self-
government for Kosovo, including an assembly and a government headed by
a prime minister. These institutions were created in tandem with the transfer
of administrative powers to them from UNMIK.
The United Nations Transitional Authority in East Timor
The United Nations mission in East Timor was based on a framework simi-
lar to the one developed in UNMIK. UN Security Council Resolution 1272
provides that the United Nations Transitional Authority in East Timor (UN-
TAET) “has overall responsibility for the administration of East Timor and is
International Norms and Standards 275
empowered to exercise all legislative and executive authority, including the
administration of justice.� This 1999 resolution mandates UNTAET
to provide security and maintain law and order throughout the
territory of East Timor; to establish an effective administration; to
assist in the development of civil and social services; to ensure the
coordination and delivery of humanitarian assistance, rehabilita-
tion and development assistance; to support capacity-building for
self-government; to assist in the establishment of conditions for
sustainable development.
UNTAET’s mandate was subsequently elaborted upon in various reso-
lutions. Regulations adopted in 1999–2001, including Regulation 2000/12,
Provisional Tax and Custom Regimes, and Regulation 2001/30, Banking and
Payment Authority, include speci�c provisions for international technical co-
operation. East Timor became an independent country on May 20, 2002. On the
same day, the United Nations Mission of Support in East Timor (UNMISET)
succeeded UNTAET. UNMISET was established under UN Security Council
Resolution 1410 (2002) with the aim of providing assistance to administrative
structures of the now-independent East Timor.
UNMIK and UNTAET created substantial debate among international
lawyers, some criticizing these efforts as too invasive and opportunistic,
while others praised the decisive involvement of a usually hesitant interna-
tional community.27 For the purpose of this chapter, it is useful to remember
that the international community can be involved at different levels and in
different forms in postconflict reconstruction. Furthermore, in both UNMIK
and UNTEAT, domestic legislation was enacted by following existing nor-
mative standards on issues as diverse as banking, taxes, and transportation.
In the immediate future, the actions of the international community in Af-
ghanistan and Iraq will provide material for consideration. Furthermore,
different examples of internal structures of the state should be examined in
fragile states.
International Law Ensures That the Basic Rights
of Individuals Are Respected
Human rights can play a fundamental role in postconflict and fragile situa-
tions. The successful creation of an international legal regime for human rights
is a great achievement of the international community, and its consequence for
postconflict reconstruction is substantial. The relevance of human rights in in-
ternational law has substantially increased in the past twenty years. States can
no longer make sovereignty claims in defense of egregious rights abuses. As
27 For a summary of the debate, see Wilde, supra note 23.
276 The World Bank Legal Review
Rosalyn Higgins argues, “there is now a yardstick against which the behavior
of states may be judged and a point of reference for the individual in the asser-
tion of his claim.�28 Human rights principles provide a framework that directs
state behavior toward its domestic population. Individuals have acquired a
large range of rights vis-Ã -vis their own governments, which cannot claim do-
mestic sovereignty privileges. Importantly, the rights acquired by individuals
from their governments derive from international legal conventions and insti-
tutions to which states have voluntarily consented.
Human rights principles provide important structure and support for
individuals, particularly those living in unstable situations.
Basic Human Rights Provisions
In general, human rights principles provide a speci�c framework within
which states must act toward their citizens; that framework must include cer-
tain speci�c freedoms and rights. Obligations to confer rights on individuals
are enumerated by international binding agreements, principally concluded
under the aegis of the United Nations. There are six main widely rati�ed
human rights conventions: the Universal Declaration of Human Rights; the In-
ternational Covenant on Civil and Political Rights; the International Covenant
on Economic, Social and Cultural Rights; the Convention against Torture and
Other Cruel, Inhuman or Degrading Treatment or Punishment; the Conven-
tion on the Elimination of All Forms of Discrimination against Women; and
the Convention on the Rights of the Child.
The rights afforded by states to their populations in accordance with these
treaties include the right to life, the right to equality, the right to religious
freedom, the right to a fair trial, the prohibition of cruel and unusual punish-
ment, the prohibition of child labor and of recruiting child soldiers, the right to
work, and the right of equality for women in education and work. Historically,
there has been a distinction between civil and political rights on one side and
economic, social, and cultural rights on the other. Since the end of the Cold
War, a new (third) wave of human rights has surged that includes the right to
development and the right to a clean environment. Although these rights are
still emerging, they are increasingly gaining international recognition. These
rights provide a framework within which a state must act toward its citizens
and guide strategies for assisting fragile states.
International and Regional Provisions
The United Nations Charter provides for the ful�llment of personal rights of
individuals by promoting “higher standards of living, full employment, and
conditions of economic and social progress and development� as well as “so-
lutions of international economic, social, health, and related problems; and in-
ternational cultural and educational cooperation� and “universal respect for,
28 Rosalyn Higgins, Conceptual Thinking about the Individual in International Law, 4 British J. Intl.
Studies 24 (1978).
International Norms and Standards 277
and observance of, human rights and fundamental freedoms for all without
distinction as to race, sex, language, or religion� (Article 55). These obligations
fall on each member state. In fact, each member of the organization pledges to
take action to achieve these goals (Article 56). As such, the United Nations is
an organizational structure made up of agencies and programs to monitor the
development and implementation of these rights by each state.
At the same time, regional organizations—including the European Union,
the African Union, and the Organization of American States—have been cre-
ated in practically every region of the world (with the notable exception of
Asia). These organizations also impose obligations on each of their members,
including numerous individual civil and political rights, as well as economic
and social rights and rights of protection for minorities. Importantly, these
regional organizations include judicial organs, which interpret the content
of states’ human rights obligations and can, in certain circumstances, allow
individuals to obtain redress from states for human rights violations. These
mechanisms can be fundamental in conflict situations.
For example, the European Court of Human Rights heard several cases
related to the Georgia-Russia and Cyprus conflicts.29 Similarly, the Inter-
American Court of Human Rights played an important in role in providing
redress to victims of human rights abuses in Latin America.30 The European
Court of Human Rights can directly entertain individual complaints.31
Human Rights in Fragile and Conflict-Affected States
Rati�cation of international human rights instruments is important in frag-
ile and conflict-affected states. As Helen Durham argues, treaty rati�cation
can assist a state in reassembling domestic legal infrastructure and demon-
strate public support for important international principles that can assist in
easing conflict.32 In postconflict and fragile states, treaty rati�cation can also
29 See, for example, Cyprus v. Turkey I & II (case no. 6780/74, joined with case. no. 6780/75);
Cyprus v. Turkey (case no. 8007/77); Georgia v. Russia I (13255/07) (2007); Georgia v. Russia II
(case no. 38263/08) (2008); and Georgia v. Russia III (case no. 61186/09). For a complete list, see
. The complete case law of the court is available at
.
30 Information about the Inter-American Court of Human Rights is available at .
31 See Article 34 of the European Human Rights Convention, as amended by Protocol 11
(stating, “The Court may receive applications from any person, non-governmental organi-
sation or group of individuals claiming to be the victim of a violation by one of the High
Contracting Parties of the rights set forth in the Convention or the Protocols thereto. The
High Contracting Parties undertake not to hinder in any way the effective exercise of this
right�), available at .
32 Helen Durham, From Paper to Practice: The Role of Treaty Rati�cation Post-conflict, in The Role of
International Law in Rebuilding Societies after Conflict 177 (Brett Bowden, Hilary Charlesworth,
& Jeremy Farrall ed., Cambridge U. Press 2009).
278 The World Bank Legal Review
incorporate recognized international legal standards into national norms and
practice. Furthermore, treaty rati�cation can foster a connection between in-
ternational norms and local understandings of them, providing a link between
the postconflict society and the international community. Additionally, rati�-
cation of international treaties may have a bene�cial symbolic effect on coun-
tries that underwent conflict as a demonstration that they are now full-fledged
participants in the international community. For example, in the aftermath of a
vicious civil war, Liberia chose to sign, ratify, or access 103 treaties on a sin-
gle day in 2005, an occasion that was celebrated by the UN secretary-general
as “a landmark in Liberia’s journey away from a dif�cult past and toward a
more tenable future grounded in the rule of law, respect for human rights, and
good democratic governance.�33 Aside from the symbolic importance of such
gestures,34 however, this issue raises important questions on the implementa-
tion of these treaties and the need for personnel and �nancial resources to
support implementation. The rati�cation of international treaties is also a means
of allowing fragile states to continue engagement with the international com-
munity in general, as well as with institutions like the World Bank.35
International Human Rights in Fragile States:
Superiority vis-Ã -vis Contradictory Local Norms
International human rights principles can directly influence conflict and fra-
gility in many ways. In signatory states, international human rights standards
take precedence over any contradictory local or domestic norms. In certain
cases, as in Kosovo, human rights standards are implemented through bind-
ing declarations of the international administrations, mandating the respect
of international law over any other sources of norms. It is important to ensure
that there is no confusion about the correct application of international law.
33 Id., at 189.
34 Scholars have struggled to explain why states choose to ratify international human rights
treaties and to assess the consequence of rati�cation. Oona Hathaway argues that although
the countries that have rati�ed human rights treaties generally have a better human rights
record than those that have not, noncompliance with treaty obligations appears common.
She further argues that treaty rati�cation may in fact be associated with worse practices than
otherwise expected. See Oona Hathaway, Do Human Rights Treaties Make a Difference? 111 Yale
L.J. 1870 (2002). Alternatively, some scholars argue that the rati�cation of international hu-
man rights instruments has a positive impact on the enjoyment of human rights by domestic
populations. Beth Simmons argues that evidence suggests that governments that have rati-
�ed the ICCPR are more likely than those that have not to reduce their interference in the free
practice of religion. Rati�ed treaties have their strongest effects in countries that are neither
stable democracies nor stable autocracies. For example, the CAT has had a more signi�cant
impact on transitioning countries than on stable ones. See Beth A. Simmons, Mobilizing for
Human Rights: International Law in Domestic Politics 355–63 (Cambridge U. Press 2009).
35 Durham, supra note 32, at 189.
International Norms and Standards 279
International Human Rights in Fragile States:
Restoration of Previously Restricted Rights
The implementation of international human rights is especially important in
fragile states; international human rights norms can be instrumental in reviv-
ing previously restricted civil liberties and freedoms such as speech, expres-
sion, and religious exercise, which may have been a cause of conflict. As such,
human rights principles have the potential to foster reconciliation, shorten
conflict, and blunt recidivism. The extent to which these rights can be mean-
ingfully implemented depends on the nature of the conflict and of postconflict
institutions.
International Human Rights Norms Applicable Only in Fragile States
Certain human rights principles are speci�cally directed at guiding states’
behavior in conflict situations. For example, certain basic human rights can
never be derogated, even at times of public emergencies. Under the ICCPR,
these basic rights include the right to life; the prohibition of slavery and of tor-
ture or cruel, inhuman, or degrading treatment or punishment; the freedom
of thought, conscience, and religion; and the principle of nondiscrimination.
Additionally, human rights law provides speci�c protections that can assist
the reconciliation process. For example, Article 20 of the ICCPR prohibits war
propaganda and the advocacy of national, racial, or religious hatred that con-
stitutes incitement to discrimination, hostility, or violence. Such norms can be
instrumental in supporting cease-�re and peace agreements.
International Human Rights and the International Community
Human rights principles have at times been criticized as Western based.36
However, a detailed study of human rights principles and customary prin-
ciples applicable in most states demonstrates the similarities of these norms.
Furthermore, although cultural sensitivities intrinsically run through all in-
ternational law considerations, the issue of human rights relativity seems at
times to be an opportunistic argument to avoid compliance. For example,
in Somalia, the International Committee of the Red Cross (ICRC) was able
to translate and explain the main essential tenets of Article 3 of the Geneva
Convention by depicting it using local and traditional norms.
Human Rights Approach
It is now common for donors and aid agencies to adopt a rights-based
approach.37 In 2003, UN secretary-general Ko� Annan requested all UN agen-
cies to mainstream human rights in all their activities and programming.
36 See, for example, Michael A. Freeman, Human Rights: An Interdisciplinary Approach 101–55 (2d
ed., Polity Press 2011).
37 For a position on human rights by the World Bank, see Ana Palacio, The Way Forward:
Human Rights and the World Bank (2006), available at .
280 The World Bank Legal Review
In practice, this means that international human rights principles guide all
phases of programming, including assessing, analyzing, planning, designing,
implementing, monitoring, and evaluating any assistance program.38 Under
this approach, the priority of international agencies and donors is to ensure
that human rights are respected. As such, rights holders and their entitlements
are identi�ed, as are the corresponding duty bearers and their obligations.
Assistance is provided to ful�ll rights and obligations. This approach can be
useful when resolving existing conflict. For example, on issues related to com-
peting claims for shared resources, the World Bank sponsored the indepen-
dent World Commission on Dams, which held that recognition of rights and
assessment of risk would provide the basis for negotiated decisions of dams
and their alternatives.39
Electoral Assistance
There is an increasing emphasis on ensuring that transitional administrations
and new governments respect basic human rights principles and minority pro-
tections. Several UN programs assist with and supervise the fair occurrence of
elections. Under Resolution 51/31, the UN General Assembly pledged to sup-
port the efforts of governments to promote and consolidate new or restored
democracies. The Electoral Assistance Division of the UN Department for
Political Affairs received 363 of�cial requests for electoral assistance between
1989 and 2005 and provided electoral services in 96 countries.40 Similarly, the
European Union undertook to promote human rights and democratization
in non-EU countries: for example, the Cotonou Agreement, concluded with
African, Caribbean, and Paci�c countries, bases the allocation of a part of
the European Development Fund (governance initiative) on the bene�ciary
countries’ commitment to institutional reforms in several governance-related
�elds, including human rights, democracy, and the rule of law. Humanitarian
aid, however, is not related to the bene�ciary country’s respect for human
rights.41
Right to Democracy
Similarly, there has been an increasing emphasis on ensuring that new and
postconflict states are democratic. As Anne Peters argues, citing Lebanon,
Cambodia, Afghanistan, East Timor, and the Democratic Republic of Congo,
“post-conflict regime-building with international support has always been
38 UNICEF, The Human Rights Based Approach: A Statement of Common Understanding,
available at .
39 Of�ce of the United Nations High Commissioner for Human Rights, Frequently Asked
Questions on a Human Rights–Based Approach to Development Cooperation, available at
.
40 See Electoral Assistance Division, Overview Information, available at .
41 See Communication from the Commission to the Council and the European Parliament of 8
May 2001—The European Union’s Role in Promoting Human Rights and Democratization
in Third Countries (2001).
International Norms and Standards 281
democratic.�42 This concept entails that the running of the state must be
decided through periodical, free elections that are open to the entire adult
population and requires the state to act upon its obligations to grant interna-
tionally recognized human rights and provide a minimum standard of living
and freedom that allows all its citizens to enjoy a productive, free, and digni-
�ed life. However, the claim that international law should require states to
be democratic has been criticized on the grounds that such a requirement is
externally imposed and can be a vehicle for neocolonialism.43 Critics also argue
that in situations of fragility and conflict, it is too dif�cult for external actors to
maintain their neutrality and independence within the political discourse of a
nascent state.44
International Transitional Justice
Human rights principles play a fundamental role in ensuring transitional jus-
tice in postconflict situations. Transitional justice seeks recognition for victims
and promotes possibilities for peace, reconciliation, and democracy.
Transitional justice relates to the accountability of human rights abuses
and humanitarian law violation in postconflict situations and can assist so-
cieties in transition in reestablishing cohesion and providing retribution, de-
terrence, historical recording, and understanding and closure to the victims
of abuse. Transitional justice can take many forms, including international
or national criminal prosecutions, truth commissions, reparations programs,
gender justice, security system reform, and memorialization efforts.
Truth and reconciliation commissions, which were common in Latin
America and in post-apartheid South Africa, are essentially locally driven
processes. Their goal is to provide a historical account of what happened and
foster reconciliation. Often, criminal prosecutions are exchanged for public
confessions and acknowledgment by perpetrators of past wrongdoings. Truth
commissions are often of�cial state bodies whose members are highly respect-
ed individuals, including international law practitioners. They make recom-
mendations to remedy abuse and to prevent its recurrence.
Increasingly, transitional justice has taken on a judicial aspect, with the
creation of international or internationalized courts or tribunals and the use
of domestic courts. International ad hoc tribunals include the Tribunal for the
Former Yugoslavia (ICTY) and the Rwanda Tribunal (ICTR), which were cre-
ated as organs of the United Nations acting in its Chapter VII capacity. They
42 Anne Peters, Dual Democracy, in The Constitutionalization of International Law 263, 276 (Jan
Klabbers, Anne Peters, & Geir Ulfstein ed., Oxford U. Press 2009).
43 For a thorough discussion on the topic, see Democratic Governance and International Law
(Gregory H. Fox & Brad R. Roth ed., Cambridge U. Press 2000).
44 For example, on the issue of humanitarian intervention, see, in general, Lea Brilmayer,
What Is the Matter with Selective Intervention? 37 Ariz. L. Rev. 955 (1995) (analyzing in-
terventions by the United States); Christine Gray, International Law and the Use of Force
(Oxford U. Press 2004); and Humanitarian Intervention: Ethical, Legal and Political Dilemmas
(J. L. Holzgrefe & Robert O. Keohane ed., Cambridge U. Press 2003).
282 The World Bank Legal Review
prosecute war crimes, crimes against humanity, and crimes of genocide. The
ICTY and ICTR are the �rst post-Nuremberg examples of international crimi-
nal tribunals and have been fundamental in the development of international
criminal law and ensuring retribution. However, they have been criticized for
being too expensive and too detached from local realities and for providing
“too little, too late.�45
Several hybrid tribunals have been created, including the Sierra Leone
Special Court and the Cambodia Extraordinary Chambers, that blend domes-
tic and international principles and personnel.
In 2002, the International Criminal Court (ICC) was created as a �rst
permanent tribunal mandated to prosecute individuals for war crimes,
crimes against humanity, and genocide committed in the territories of signa-
ture countries or by nationals of signature countries or in special situations
approved by the UN Security Council. The ICC’s 110 members do not in-
clude the United States, China, Russia, or India.46 The court can act only when
national courts are unwilling or unable to investigate or prosecute such crimes.
At present, the ICC is investigating events in Uganda, the Democratic Repub-
lic of Congo, the Central African Republic, Kenya, Darfur (Sudan—referred
by the Security Council), and Libya (also referred to the prosecutor by the
Security Council).47
In situations of state fragility and conflict, mechanisms must be estab-
lished to ensure that international transitional justice and the international
community can play a fundamental role. The United Nations and other inter-
national actors are involved in providing and developing justice mechanisms,
and it is important at this stage to assess all available instruments and lessons
learnt so that prompt and targeted advice can be given in postconflict recon-
struction efforts.
International Humanitarian Law
International humanitarian law is a distinct body of law that is important in
fragile and conflict-affected states. In times of armed conflict, international
human rights law and international humanitarian law apply in a comple-
mentary manner. Humanitarian law regulates the conduct of hostilities
and establishes minimum protection for civilians and victims of conflict; it
prohibits direct attacks against civilians and civilian infrastructures and
mandates parties to take precautionary measures to avoid or minimize
45 See Mahnoush A. Arsanjani & W. Michael Reisman, The Law-in-Action of the International
Criminal Court, 99 Am. J. Intl. L. 385 (2005); Robert D. Sloane, Sentencing for the “Crime of
Crimes�: The Evolving “Common Law� of the International Criminal Tribunal for Rwanda, 5 J. Intl.
Crim. Just. 713 (2007); and, generally, Jens David Ohlin, Applying the Death Penalty to Crimes
of Genocide, 99 Am. J. Intl. L. 747 (2005).
46 A list of the states that are parties to the Rome Statute can found at .
47 For a short overview of the cases, see .
International Norms and Standards 283
incidental injuries to civilians. Since 1999 (and as a consequence of the shames
of Srebenica and Rwanda), the mandates of all UN peace-keeping missions
and operations led by regional organizations such as the African Union and
the EU include a speci�c authorization to provide civilian protection.48 A 2001
report by the International Commission on Intervention and State Sovereignty
argues that states have a “responsibility to protect� civilians in situations of
grave human rights abuses.49
Human rights principles can play an important role in fragile states by
ensuring minimum rights of all people, by providing redress—including by
judicial proceedings—when those rights are violated, and by guiding actions
of the fragile state.
International Law Provides Support and Models
to Reestablish a Functioning Domestic Legal Order
In addition to providing a general legal framework to guide state rebuilding
and guarantee basic rights to individuals, international norms play an im-
portant role in reconstructing a domestic legal system, including writing con-
stitutions, establishing domestic institutions, and promulgating legal codes.
Sources of models include international and comparative legal regimes and
standards and norms developed by international organizations.
Development and Humanitarian Assistance Programs
in Fragile States
In situations where a state cannot entirely provide for the needs and rights of
its people, donor countries have established cooperation programs and agen-
cies to provide economic and technical development assistance. In these situa-
tions, international organizations and foreign states often provide substantial
budgetary and technical support for essential governmental activities. In some
cases, international experts manage key internal functions of a government.
Development projects can range from the delivery of healthcare services to the
restructuring of the legal and judicial systems. These types of interventions
have generally been pursued with the consent of the government where the
interventions took place.
Development and humanitarian assistance include the delivery of food,
mainly by the World Food Program (WFP) and Food and Agriculture Or-
ganization of the United Nations (FAO), and water, sanitation, and health
products, mainly by the World Health Organization (WHO) and the United
48 See Siobhán Wills, Protecting Civilians: The Obligations of Peacekeepers (Oxford U. Press 2009).
49 Report of the International Commission on Intervention and State Sovereignty, the Re-
sponsibility to Protect (Dec. 2001), available at .
284 The World Bank Legal Review
Nations Children’s Fund (UNICEF). Other international actors, national aid
agencies, and NGOs participate with these organizations in the implementa-
tion and delivery of development and humanitarian programs.
In fragile states where a national government cannot control large parts
of the country that it represents or in situations where a government is absent,
the international community has tried to provide development and humani-
tarian assistance with the consent of the local authorities in control of the ter-
ritories. For example, UNICEF implements vaccination campaigns with the
support of local authorities.
In certain situations of fragility, international organization conduct in sev-
eral areas of internal affairs has been extensive to the point that international
organizations affect the conduct of national affairs. The extent of their influ-
ence is particularly relevant in cases of very weak governments. For example,
in Somalia, which has been without a government since 1991, the internation-
al community has been involved in port and road rehabilitation, judicial and
legal restructuring, health service delivery and vaccination, and education—
including choosing curriculum and the language of instruction.
A special body, the Somalia Aid Coordination Body (SACB),50 was formed
in December 1993 and restructured in 2006 to coordinate and organize funding
and projects to provide assistance to the people of Somalia by the organiza-
tions working on and in Somalia. It comprised donor countries, UN agencies
and programs, and NGOs. The framework for the SACB was outlined in the
Addis Ababa Declaration51 and the Code of Conduct for International Rehabil-
itation and Development Assistance.52 In practice, the SACB coordinated and
controlled most of the aid given to Somalia; it developed and implemented
policies and guidelines for interventions, and in many cases it is a veritable
partial substitute for government action.53
The risks of over-influencing domestic constituencies and imposing solu-
tions are real and must be attentively scrutinized.
In providing assistance to fragile and conflict-affected countries, in-
ternational organizations and other donors often refer to settled norms of
international law. This situation is particularly visible in the implementation
of rule of law and governance projects.
Rule of Law Projects
The powerful notion at the heart of the rule of law principle is that nobody is
above the law, which implies that all people are equal in front of the law, all
50 See Somalia Aid Coordination Body, Handbook (2001).
51 Id., at 2.
52 Id., at 10.
53 Working arrangements between the international aid community and responsible Somali
authorities, Nairobi, June 1996. See UN Doc. A/51/315, available at .
International Norms and Standards 285
laws are applied equally, and political power should be exercised in accor-
dance with agreed-upon law. Cognizant of the fundamental role played by the
rule of law in ensuring long-lasting political and economic recovery, several
international donors have implemented projects directed at strengthening the
rule of law in peace-keeping and postconflict operations.54
The UN Security Council has espoused the principle and the 2000 Millen-
nium Declaration55 lists the goal of strengthening respect for the rule of law as
the �rst of its objectives. The importance of the rule of law is also recognized in
the 2000 Report of the Panel on UN Peace Operations (the Brahimi Report).56
In their concrete application, rule of law programs normally include four
areas: supporting, restructuring, and retraining a national police force; assist-
ing in the reconstruction of correction facilities and training of its personnel;
rebuilding, reopening, and ensuring the functioning of the national court sys-
tem; and promoting the protection of human rights and creating a mechanism
of transitional justice. The implementation of rule of law projects in postcon-
flict situations, including in Haiti and Liberia, has been rather problematic.57
In fact, efforts of the international community have been perceived as inef-
fective and, at times, partisan and unbalanced, giving the “winning side� the
instruments to consolidate its power.58
Governance Projects
Governance projects have been similarly criticized. The World Bank and the
United Nations were the �rst international organizations to study and expand
the model of good governance as a development policy. For example, the
work of the United Nations Environment Programme (UNDP) is directed at
strengthening democratic governance. The UNDP is active in parliamentary
development, electoral systems and processes, access to justice and human
rights, access to information, decentralization and local governance and pub-
lic administration, and civil service reform. Projects in this area include assis-
tance in setting up effective parliamentary “structures, systems, processes and
procedures,� as well as providing training to parliamentarians; providing
assistance for electoral processes and for the establishment of systems of justice
and laws, including legal and judicial reforms such as “improving the structure,
organization and administration of court systems; training judges, magistrate,
lawyers and support personnel.� In 2008, the UNDP provided US$1.4 billion
54 See Jeremy Farrall, Impossible Expectations? The UN Security Council’s Promotion of the Rule of
Law after Conflict, in The Role of International Law in Rebuilding Societies after Conflict 134 (Brett
Bowden, Hilary Charlesworth, & Jeremy Farrall ed., Cambridge U. Press 2009).
55 UN Millennium Declaration, UN Doc. A/Res./55/2, available at .
56 Report of the Panel on United Nations Peace Operations, UN Doc. A/55/305–S/2000/809
(Aug. 22, 2002), available at .
57 Id., at 148–53.
58 See, in general, The Role of International Law in Rebuilding Societies after Conflict: Great Expecta-
tions (Brett Bowden, Hilary Charlesworth, & Jeremy Farrall ed., Cambridge U. Press 2009).
286 The World Bank Legal Review
to programs fostering democratic governance in 129 countries. For example,
it supported electoral reform efforts in Lebanon through national awareness
campaigns and the publication and dissemination of draft law booklets in sev-
eral languages to libraries, universities, and the public in general.
In both governance and rule of law projects, international institutions and
donor countries play a role at the very core of the running of the state. This as-
sistance is therefore invaluable in postconflict societies. Lessons learned from
the �eld show that avoiding the pitfalls of perceived favoritism, overdue influ-
ence, and overpromising is particularly important in postconflict societies.59
Emergency Assistance and Special Programming
by International Organizations in Fragile and Failing States
International assistance by international organizations is normally based on
an of�cial agreement between the international organization and the recipient
country.60 In some exceptional cases, however, some international organiza-
tions can act without the speci�c agreement of the host state. Two examples
are important.
The WFP was established61 by the United Nations and the FAO in 1963
to �ght hunger62 and provide emergency food aid and associated nonfood
59 For a critical overview, see Thomas G. Weiss & Ramesh Thakur, Global Governance and the
UN: An Un�nished Journey (Indiana U. Press 2009), and Jörg Friedrichs, Global Governance as
the Hegemonic Project of Transatlantic Civil Society, in Criticizing Global Governance 45 (Markus
Lederer & Philipp S. Müller ed., Palgrave Macmillan 2005).
60 See, for example, UN GA Res. 46/182, UN GAOR, 46th Sess., Supp. No. 49, UN Doc. A/46/49
(1991), which created the Of�ce for the Coordination of Humanitarian Affairs (OCHA) (stat-
ing, “The sovereignty, territorial integrity and national unity of states must be fully respected
in accordance with the Charter of the United Nations. In this context, humanitarian assistance
should be provided with the consent of the affected country and in principle on the basis of
an appeal by the affected country�). Similarly, the General Assembly resolution establish-
ing UNICEF provides that “the Fund in agreement with the Government concerned, shall
take all measures as are deemed appropriate to ensure the proper distribution of supplies or
other assistance it provides� and further requires UNICEF not to engage in activity in any
country “except in consultation with, and the consent of, the government concerned.� See GA
Res. 57(I), UN GAOR, 1st Sess., UN Doc. A/64/Add.1 (1946). The UNDP operates under the
same premises. See the Standard Basic Assistance Agreement (SBAA) between the Recipient
Government and the UNDP, available at . See also Decision 1998/2, in Decision Adopted by the Executive Board during 1998,
DP/1999/2 (Oct. 5, 1998), available at .
61 World Food Programme, General Regulations and General Rules, Article I (Nov. 2010 ed.),
available at .
62 The WFP performs both emergency and longer-term activities; namely, it provides food as-
sistance in refugee crises and other emergencies; improves nutrition for the world’s most
vulnerable, and promotes longer-term self-reliance of poor people and communities. See
World Food Programme, Operations, available at . In order to carry out its mandate in
situations of emergency, the WFP Executive Board established several program catego-
ries, including a Development Programme Category, for food aid programs and projects
to support economic and social development; an Emergency Relief Program Category, for
food assistance to meet emergency needs; a Protracted Relief Program Category for food
International Norms and Standards 287
items and logistics support at the request of the UN secretary-general. In ex-
ceptional cases, assistance “shall be fully coordinated with the United Nations
system and efforts of governments, intergovernmental and non-governmental
organizations in the areas concerned.�63 Further, Article X provides that bilat-
eral donors, UN agencies, and NGOs can request “WFP services for opera-
tions which are consistent with the purposes of WFP and which complement
WFP’s operations.�64
Similarly, the Governing Council of the UNDP may, under special circum-
stances, grant power to the administrator to approve assistance on a project-
by-project basis without a formal agreement with the host country. This ar-
rangement has been used in Myanmar and Somalia.65
The possibility that certain international organizations may directly pro-
vide or ask for assistance without the need for an of�cial agreement or request
by the government may provide a useful instrument in situations of state fra-
gility and failure because it allows international organizations to, essentially,
bypass the obstacle of government absence or lack of control. The very pos-
sibility of such an instrument is especially signi�cant and should be kept in
careful consideration for actions in situations of state failure.
assistance to meet protracted relief needs; a Special Operations Program Category for in-
terventions undertaken to rehabilitate and enhance transport and logistics infrastructure to
permit timely and ef�cient delivery of food assistance, especially to meet emergency and
protracted relief needs and to enhance coordination within the United Nations System and
with other partners through the provision of designated common services. See World Food
Programme, General Regulations and General Rules, General Rule II.2. Recent interventions
by WFP include assistance to refugees and internally displaced persons, including in places
like Cote d’Ivoire and Libya, and providing assistance to population hit by tropical storm
Matthew in Nicaragua and by floods in the Gambia. See World Food Programme, Operations
List, available at .
63 See World Food Programme, General Regulations and General Rules, Article IX, Eligibility
for Assistance.
64 Id., Article X, Requests for Assistance.
65 For example, in Myanmar, Governing Council Decision 1993/21, reaf�rmed by the board in
decision 1996/1, to authorize the administrator to approve project extensions on a project-by-
project basis. See UNDP Governing Council Decision 1993/21 (stating that the Governing
Council decides “that, until a country programme for Myanmar is considered at an appro-
priate time, all future assistance from the United Nations Development Programme and
related funds to Myanmar should be clearly targeted towards programmes having grass-
roots-level impact in a sustainable manner, as called for in the aforesaid decision 92/26,
particularly in the areas of primary health care, the environment, HIV/AIDS, training and
education, and food security; [. . . and] requests the Administrator to continue to approve
assistance to Myanmar on a project-by-project basis and to present to the Governing Council
a report on the status of approval and implementation of new projects and recommendations
for future programming, for its review at its forty �rst session (1994)�), available at . The same arrangement is valid for some
UNDP projects in Somalia. See also Giorgetti, supra note 3, at 30–35.
288 The World Bank Legal Review
International Conventional Norms of General Applicability
In addition to international standards applicable speci�cally to fragile states,
several international norms can assist in strengthening the legal systems of
postconflict countries and states coming out of fragility. These include laws,
standards, and best practice on diverse issues such as establishing central bank
and �scal supervisory and regulatory structures and strengthening transpar-
ency and accountability institutions, such as anticorruption agencies, supreme
audit institutions, parliamentary committees, and antinarcotics enforcement.
In general, speci�c obligations derive from treaties and conventions,
which are sources of international law and are binding only on states that have
expressly agreed to be bound. The number of international conventions and
bilateral and multilateral treaties increased substantially between 1946 and
2006. International norms ensuing from international treaties include rules on
contracts for the international sale of goods, regulation of sea resources and
air space traf�c, regulations on trade, intellectual property protection, and in-
ternational telecommunication. Some of these treaties recognize the special
challenges faced by developing countries. A speci�c body of the United Na-
tions, the International Law Commission (ILC), congregates recognized inter-
national legal experts for the promotion of the progressive development and
codi�cation of international law. The ILC developed a draft of the Rome Con-
vention establishing the ICC, the Vienna Convention on Consular Relations,
and the Vienna Convention on the Succession of States in Respect of Treaties.
For example, the 2005 UN Convention against Corruption is a broadly
rati�ed treaty with 140 parties. Its widely recognized principles have resulted
in the introduction and implementation of concrete obligations in domestic
legal systems. To foster compliance, a group of experts representing vari-
ous legal systems and observers from several UN organizations developed a
legislative guide for the implementation of the convention to assist states
seeking to ratify and implement the convention by identifying legislative
requirements and developing the necessary legislation.66
Similarly, the 1980 UN Convention on the International Sale of Goods
(CISG) provides legal rules governing the formation of a commercial contract
for the international sale of goods and sets forth the rights and obligations
of the buyer and seller. The convention has 74 parties and includes remedies
for breach of contract as well as other aspects of the selling contract.67
Many other examples exist. The World Trade Organization (WTO), with
153 members, provides legal ground rules for international commerce, with
66 The 300-page Legislative Guide is available at .
67 The text of the convention and an explanatory note are available at .
International Norms and Standards 289
the purpose of helping trade flow as freely as possible.68 The Convention
on International Aviation (Chicago Convention) includes norms regulating
air space and overflight rights, air craft registrations, and safety.69 The 1982
United Nations Convention on the Law of the Sea (UNCLOS) regulates the
rights and responsibility of states in their use of the world’s oceans and estab-
lishes guidelines for business, the environment, and the management of natu-
ral resources. UNCLOS de�nes territorial waters and extends the exclusive
economic zone to 200 nautical miles, allowing coastal nations sole exploitation
rights over all natural resources therein.70
Each of these widely rati�ed treaties includes general rules that could be
applicable in postconflict situations and could assist in developing domestic
norms and in their integration into the international economic system.
Uniform and Model Rules
Additionally, the United Nations has developed uniform and model rules that
provide a framework for and examples of legislation to be included in domes-
tic legal systems.
The UN Commission on International Trade Law (UNCITRAL) plays
an important role in developing a legal framework to facilitate internation-
al trade and investment, two core economic issues in postconflict recon-
struction. UNCITRAL has a mandate to prepare and promote the use and
adoption of legislative and nonlegislative instruments. UNCITRAL has
developed, through an international process involving a variety of partici-
pants, texts on international commercial arbitration and conciliation, in-
ternational sale of goods and related transactions, security interests, insol-
vency, international payments, international transport of goods, electronic
commerce and procurement, and infrastructure development.
UNCITRAL adopted model laws on the procurement of goods,
construction, and services. These model laws cover topics such as in-
ternational bidding rules, promotion of competition, and the fair and
equal treatment of suppliers and contractors. 71 In 2003, UNCITRAL
adopted a model law on privately financed infrastructure projects that
includes rules governing the selection of the concessionaire, the im-
plementation of the concession contract, and its duration, extension,
68 A short description of the WTO is available at .
69 The text of the Chicago Convention is available at .
70 The text of UNCLOS as well as a historical perspective of the convention is available at
.
71 The text of these model laws is available at .
290 The World Bank Legal Review
and termination.72 In 2002, UNCITRAL adopted a model law on international
commercial arbitration that includes rules on key aspects of international ar-
bitration that are recognized worldwide. The model law covers all stages of
the arbitral proceedings. UNCITRAL also developed a model law on interna-
tional credit transfers that covers issues such as obligation of sender, time of
payment, and bank liability.73 UNCITRAL’s Guide on Secured Transactions
provides assistance to states in developing modern secured transaction.74
The United Nations Of�ce of Drug and Crime (UNODC) plays an impor-
tant role in the development of model laws and rules. UNODC has created
model provisions (for civil and common law systems) on money laundering,
terrorist �nancing, preventive measures for and proceeds of crime (in collabo-
ration with the IMF), a model terrorist �nancing bill, a model bill on money
laundering, proceeds of crime and terrorist �nancing, a model mutual assis-
tance in criminal matters bill, and a model extradition (amendment) bill (all
for common law systems). For civil law systems, UNODC has created model
legislation on money laundering, con�scation and international cooperation in
relation to the proceeds of crime, a model law on drug traf�cking and related
offenses, and a model law on international cooperation (extradition and
mutual legal assistance) with regard to illicit traf�c in narcotic drugs, psycho-
tropic substances, and precursors.75
Model laws are particularly important for fragile states because they can
be immediately used and promote the uni�cation of applicable rules and stan-
dards, thereby increasing recognition and easing implementation.
International Norms Developed by International Organizations
The use of recommendations, guidelines, and informal notes by the World
Bank and other international organizations plays a role in developing gener-
ally applicable norms and standards.76 These norms influence international
law and have signi�cant implications for national administrations and indi-
viduals, as well as for states.
In fact, relevant international norms are developed and spread by the
work of international organizations themselves, importantly by the World
72 The text of the Model Legislative Provisions is available at .
73 Available at .
74 2007 UNCITRAL Legislative Guide on Secured Transactions, available at .
75 The texts of all these model laws are available at .
76 Some scholars argue that this development can be framed as a new discipline of interna-
tional law: global administrative law. See, for example, Benedict Kingsbury, Nico Krisch, &
Richard B. Stewart, The Emergence of Global Administrative Law, 68 L. & Contemp. Probs. 15
(2005).
International Norms and Standards 291
Bank, including on issues of environmental assessment, involuntary resettle-
ment, and other social standards. In effect, as Galit Sarfaty argues,
World Bank operational policies are becoming de facto global stan-
dards among other development banks as well as institutions en-
gaged in project �nance. For example, they serve as a model for
the Equator Principles, a set of voluntary social and environmental
guidelines that have been adopted by at least twenty-nine private
banks.77
Further, the World Bank plays an important role in enforcing social and
environmental standards in borrower countries, for example, by attempting
to incorporate into domestic law provisions related to indigenous people
through binding loan agreements.78 Similarly, the IFC, part of the World Bank
Group, applies environmental and social standards to all projects it �nances to
minimize adverse impacts for the communities.79
Other international organizations develop guidelines and recommenda-
tions that have an effect on the work. For example, the International Tele-
communication Union adopts resolutions every year on issues such as the
management of radio frequency and satellite orbits and terrestrial and sat-
ellite radio communication broadcasting that are accepted by its members.
Similarly, recommendations of the International Labour Organization, the In-
ternational Civil Aviation Organization, and the United Nations Educational,
Scienti�c, and Cultural Organization (UNESCO) are often considered as norm
setting by their members.80
International Norms Developed by Hybrid
Intergovernmental Administration
Finally, norms developed by hybrid intergovernmental administration create
international norms and standards that are relevant for fragile states.
For example, the Codex Alimentarius Commission includes members of
FAO, WHO, and several NGOs and develops standards for food safety. Simi-
larly, the Internet Corporation for Assigned Names and Numbers (ICANN), a
public corporation that includes both NGOs and government representatives,
regulates the internet address protocol.81
77 See Galit A. Sarfaty, The World Bank and the Internationalization of Indigenous Rights Norms, 114
Yale L.J. 1791 (2005).
78 Id.
79 The IFC’s Policy on Social and Environmental Sustainability is available at .
80 See Benedict Kingsbury & Lorenzo Casini, Global Administrative Law Dimensions of Interna-
tional Organizations Law, 6 Intl. Organizations L. Rev. 319 (2009).
81 Kingsbury, Krisch, & Stewart, supra note 76, at 22.
292 The World Bank Legal Review
Conclusion
The abundance of international norms and standards that can have an impact
on postconflict reconstruction is clear, but they are complex to assess given
the multiplicity of sources. Two sets of norms are particularly relevant—those
linked to sovereignty and those linked to human rights.
Several international norms and standards can frame and guide the recon-
struction of a domestic legal system to reintegrate a fragile state into the in-
ternational community. The sources of these norms are international treaties,
model laws, and guiding principles developed by a variety of international
organizations.
There is a growing tendency to request that countries adopt speci�c norms
and standards, agreed to and shared by the international community. This de-
velopment can be viewed as positive because it ensures minimum standards
and a shared understanding of applicable principles. However, it can also be
seen as an external imposition that may create resentment.
Legal Obligations and Institutions
of Developing Countries
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance
ANNIE PETSONK*
The Failure of Efforts to Develop Global Governance of Forests
Confronting dramatic forest destruction, particularly in the tropics, U.S. presi-
dent George H. W. Bush called for a global agreement to conserve forests at
the 1990 Houston Economic Summit.1 The attention given to forests at Hous-
ton prompted nations to raise the topic of a global forest agreement for consid-
eration in the run-up to the United Nations Conference on Environment and
Development (UNCED), the “Earth Summit� held at Rio in 1992. The topic
of forests turned out to be one of the most contentious at Rio.2 Sharp differ-
ences between developed and developing countries, and within the devel-
oped countries’ and developing countries’ negotiating groups, made the adop-
tion of the �rst global nonbinding consensus on forests reached at UNCED
seem to be a considerable advance at the time.3 The Forest Principles4 and
Chapter 11 of the Rio Agenda 215 set forth overarching principles and an
action plan for sustainable forest management. Although they were non-
binding, the hope was that they would provide a foundation for a future
treaty establishing global norms for forest governance.
* The views expressed are entirely the author’s, as is responsibility for any errors or omissions.
For valuable insights on the topics covered, and for permission to cite works in progress, the
author is grateful to Danae Azura, Thomas Blackburn, William Boyd, Daniel Dudek, Jason
Funk, Alexander Golub, Steven Hamburg, Sarah Hoagland, Korinna Horta, Peter Jenkins,
Andrew Long, Ruben Lubowski, Christina McCain, Christopher Meyer, Michael Oppen-
heimer, Stephan Schwartzman, Gustavo Silva-Chavez, Richard Stewart, Charlotte Streck,
Jonathan Wiener, and Dan Zarin. The chapter is dedicated to Edward M. Petsonk, whose
delight in the natural world remains my inspiration.
1 White House Statement on the Forests for the Future Initiative (Aug. 14, 1992), available at .
2 Personal knowledge of the author, who attended UNCED as a member of the U.S. delegation.
3 See, for example, Susan Braatz, International Forest Governance: International Forest Policy,
Legal and Institutional Framework (Invited Paper, XIIth World Forestry Congress, Quebec City,
2003), available at .
4 The Forest Principles are the Non–Legally Binding Authoritative Statement of Principles for
a Global Consensus on the Management, Conservation and Sustainable Development of All
Types of Forest Adopted at UNCED, UN Doc. A/CONF.151/26 (1992), available at .
5 Text available at . 293
294 The World Bank Legal Review
After Rio, a range of activities took place under UN auspices aimed at
strengthening the Rio principles and implementing an action plan, but the
picture never sharpened into an international forest convention. Starting in
1995, the UN Commission on Sustainable Development (CSD), the Intergov-
ernmental Panel on Forests (IPF), and the Intergovernmental Forum on For-
ests convened regularly to attempt to strengthen “soft-law� pronouncements
on forest management into a binding “hard-law� forest convention.6 But al-
though the soft–law-hard-law progression succeeded in some other areas and
generated broad momentum in favor of more environmental treaties, it failed
to produce a forest convention.7
Proponents of a convention argued that existing instruments with legally
binding commitments, such as the Convention on Biological Diversity (CBD),8
did not cover all aspects of forest management and conservation; strengthen-
ing synergies between and among various instruments, binding and nonbind-
ing, could �ll gaps and address inadequacies; a legally binding instrument
could be more effective in mobilizing funding; and binding obligations were
needed in order to spur national implementation commitments and generate
the in-depth monitoring and enforceability crucial to effective implementation
of those commitments.9 These arguments were similar to those that had been
put forward in the late 1980s in favor of a convention on biological diversity.
By the late 1990s, concerns were being voiced about the CBD’s effectiveness
as well as the institutional and capacity-building demands that rapidly pro-
liferating environmental treaties were placing on developing countries. Some
critics began to question whether environmental negotiations had acquired
a content-free momentum of their own.10 Many in government doubted that
coordinating forest policies across disparate forest types, economic drivers of
deforestation, and geographical, cultural, and other differences would yield
bene�ts signi�cant enough to justify the endeavor.11 More fundamentally, at
national and subnational levels, many governments simply did not want to
undertake the surrender of sovereignty that would ensue from signing a bind-
ing commitment to manage forests under a global governance treaty. Their
unwillingness to participate was compounded by the turn of signi�cant seg-
ments of civil society away from a global forest convention, and spurred by
6 The International Tropical Timber Agreement (ITTA) is perhaps the sole binding treaty ex-
clusively focused on forests. Its coverage is not global and stemming forest destruction is not
its primary objective.
7 Radoslav S. Dimitrov, Hostage to Norms: States, Institutions and Global Forest Politics, 5(4)
Global Envtl. Politics 1, 10 (Nov. 2005).
8 UN Convention on Biological Diversity, 31. I.L.M. 818 (1992).
9 Braatz, supra note 3; Richard G. Tarasofsky, The International Forestry Regime—Legal and Policy
Issues (International Union for the Conservation of Nature and Natural Resources and World
Wide Fund for Nature 1995); Barbara M. G. S. Ruis, No Forest Convention but Ten Tree Treaties,
52(206) Unasylva 3 (2001).
10 Dimitrov, supra note 7.
11 Id.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 295
concerns that a national government–based negotiation could undermine ef-
forts to establish nationally recognized rights of indigenous peoples.12 By Feb-
ruary 2000, the most that nations could agree to was yet another institutional
home for soft-law discussions, the United Nations Forum on Forests (UNFF).13
Since then, various talks under UN auspices have produced a loose “in-
ternational arrangement� on forests comprising the UNFF, the Collaborative
Partnership on Forests (CPF), and various other programs that seek to facili-
tate and coordinate sustainable forest management at national, regional, and
global levels through nonbinding means.14
As efforts to achieve a global forest convention crumpled in early 2000, various
commentators warned that failure to reverse the economic trends favoring contin-
ued destruction, rather than preservation, of forests, would diminish the effective-
ness of the already weak basket of soft-law pronouncements.15 But proponents of
global forest governance failed utterly to comprehend the core ingredient missing
from any such regime: a strategy that makes forests worth more alive than dead.16
Filling the Void: Six Efforts to Rebalance Forest Economics
In the governance vacuum left by the collapse of the global forest con-
vention negotiations, efforts seeking to rebalance economic drivers of forest
destruction focused on six areas:
12 Id.; see also David Humphreys, Rede�ning the Issues: NGO Influence on International Forest
Negotiations, 4(2) Global Envtl. Politics 51 (May 2004).
13 See Dimitrov, supra note 7, and Braatz, supra note 3; see also David R. Downes, Global Forest
Policy and Selected International Instruments: A Preliminary Review, in Assessing the International
Forestry Regime 65 (Richard G. Tarasofsky ed., International Union for the Conservation of
Nature and Natural Resources 1999).
14 Report of the World Summit on Sustainable Development, UN Doc. A/CONF.199/20 (2002);
Braatz, supra note 3. Cf. Progress or Peril? Partnerships and Networks in Global Environmental
Governance: The Post-Johannesburg Agenda (Charlotte Streck, Jan Martin Witte, & Thorsten
Benner ed., Global Public Policy Institute 2003).
15 See, for example, Dimitrov, supra note 7.
16 Neither the international environmental governance framework of the Convention on Biodi-
versity nor the forestry regime has been able to achieve signi�cant change in on-the-ground
environmental outcomes. Andrew Long, Global Climate Governance to Enhance Biodiversity
and Well-Being: Integrating Non-state Networks and Public International Law in Tropical Forests,
41 Environmental Law 95 (2011). As one commentator notes, nations have economic disin-
centives to participate in multilateral global forest governance because any resulting policy
for sustainable forest management would reduce economic bene�ts from logging and from
clearing forests for agriculture. According to one estimate, losing 1 percent of global forest
cover would cost $47 billion, that is, nine times less than the commercial bene�ts from log-
ging it. See Dimitrov, supra note 7. Talks under the auspices of the UNFF continued, post-
2000, to try to develop �nancial and institutional modalities, with much debate about po-
tential sources of funding (see Braatz, supra note 3), but the discussion remained stuck in the
frame of a search for �nancial mechanisms to cover incremental costs of sustainable forest
management—a frame that has proven cumbersome in the context of the Global Environ-
mental Facility (GEF) and that never enabled the UNFF or related forums to formulate a
strategy that could counteract the economic disparities that Dimitrov cites.
296 The World Bank Legal Review
• Reform of international �nancial institution (IFI) forest-related policies
• Legal mechanisms for protecting indigenous forest-dependent peoples
• Creation of protected areas
• Legal frameworks for requiring the sharing of economic bene�ts derived
from forests
• Programs for certifying products derived from sustainably managed
forests
• Campaigns to combat illegal logging
These efforts have achieved varying degrees of success in particular for-
est areas and locales. That their success has varied is not surprising given the
diverse drivers of deforestation across ecosystems and economies.
Reform of IFI Forest Lending Practices
In the late 1980s, coalitions “characterized by . . . professionalism, care-
ful fact-�nding, rigorous economic and legal analysis, and subtle political
savvy�17 began pressing multilateral development banks to reform their
lending practices in light of the dramatically poor environmental perfor-
mance of many development bank–funded undertakings, including lending
policies that amped, rather than damping, the economics that made trees
worth more dead than alive.18 In response, the World Bank formulated its
1991 Forest Strategy. The strategy was prompted by estimates that defor-
estation was affecting tens of millions of hectares a year in the develop-
ing world; tropical rain forests were shrinking inexorably; and the Bank’s
lending activities had contributed to these trends.19 The 1991 strategy was
conservation oriented and sought to better de�ne the relationships between
and among biodiversity, climate, forests, and development. Eventually clas-
si�ed as an operational safeguard, the policy included something environ-
mentalists had demanded: a ban on Bank �nancing of commercial logging
in moist tropical forests.20
17 Zygmunt J. B. Plater, Multilateral Development Banks, Environmental Diseconomies, and Interna-
tional Reform Pressures on the Lending Process: The Example of Third World Dam-Building Proj-
ects, 9 B.C. Third World L.J. 169 (1989).
18 See, for example, Bruce Rich, The Multilateral Development Banks, Environmental Policy, and
the United States, 12 Ecol. L.Q. 681 (1985); submission of Bruce Rich, Esq., on behalf of the
Environmental Defense Fund, in Environmental Performance of the Multilateral Develop-
ment Banks: Hearings before the Subcommittee on International Development Institutions
and Finance of the House Committee on Banking, Finance, and Urban Affairs, 100th Cong.,
1st Sess. (1987); Bruce Rich, Funding Deforestation: Conservation Woes at the World Bank, The
Nation (Jan. 1989); Bruce Rich, The Emperor’s New Clothes—The World Bank and Environmental
Reform, 7 World Policy J. 305 (Spring 1990).
19 Uma Lele, et al. The World Bank Forest Strategy: Striking the Right Balance (World Bank 2000).
20 Id.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 297
But even under the new strategy, deforestation continued at alarming
rates, generating a new wave of criticism that Bank policies were exacerbat-
ing, not containing, economic trends favoring deforestation. Shortly after ef-
forts to reach a global forest convention came to a close in early 2000, the Bank
published an in-depth internal review that con�rmed much of the activists’
critique. The reviews determined that although the Bank’s strategy
diagnosed the problem of externalities, it did not provide �nancing
mechanisms to address the divergent costs and bene�ts of conserva-
tion at the local and global levels. At the local and national levels,
communities and governments, given other pressing imperatives
and their limited ability to bear these costs, perceive the costs of con-
servation relative to their bene�ts to be higher than does the global
community.21
The review also found, inter alia, that the strategy was too narrowly fo-
cused on microeconomic issues such as the length and price of timber con-
cessions; it underestimated the powerful effect of globalization and economic
liberalization on forest outcomes.22 The result was that a number of tropical
nations experienced the Bank’s involvement in their forest sectors as a kind of
pendulum, swinging from a deforestation-exacerbating lending phase in the
mid- to late 1980s and early 1990s to a no-lending phase in the mid-1990s, and
then to an adjustment lending phase in the late 1990s in which the Bank pro-
moted growth in processing and related export industries, even though that
drove deforestation and the attendant adverse impacts on forest-dependent
poor people.23
In the aftermath of the failure of the global forest convention, and bol-
stered by the internal operational review, civil society organizations intensi-
�ed their pressure on the Bank to revise its policies. In 2002 the Bank did so,
adopting a revised forests strategy and Operational Policy (OP) 4.36—Forests,
which sought to take into account, comprehensively, the impacts of activities,
policies, and practices inside and outside the sector on forests and people who
depend on forests for their livelihoods. The strategy was founded on three
pillars: harnessing the potential of forests to reduce poverty in a sustainable
manner; integrating forests more effectively into sustainable development;
and protecting vital local and global environmental services and values.
To the dismay of some environmentalists, the 2002 strategy removed
the outright prohibition of World Bank �nancing of commercial logging op-
erations in primary moist tropical forests, replacing it with an approach of
21 Id.
22 The review also found that the Bank’s forest policy failed to address governance issues and
omitted important stakeholder perspectives that were crucial determinants of actual out-
comes in the �eld. Id.
23 Madhur Gautam, et al., Indonesia: The Challenges of World Bank Involvement in Forests (World
Bank Operations Evaluation Department 2000), available at .
298 The World Bank Legal Review
improved forest management with targeted conservation of critical natural
habitats in all types of forests. But it also incorporated safeguards requiring
World Bank–�nanced investment operations to comply with independent cer-
ti�cation standards. The strategy represented a shift to “cautious reengage-
ment,� including selective engagement with forest-priority countries and a
deliberate focus on partnerships such as the World Bank–World Wildlife Fund
(WWF) Alliance, the Program on Forests (PROFOR), and Forest Law Enforce-
ment and Governance (FLEG) initiatives, which entail coordination among cli-
ent countries, donors, international nongovernmental organizations (NGOs),
research institutions, and civil society.24 A key element of the 2002 strategy was
its focus on emerging opportunities for innovative �nancing—a recognition of
the need for more proactive efforts to rebalance the economics of forests; this
focus, in turn, helped prepare the Bank to play a facilitating role in the area of
forest carbon (discussed below).
Legal Protection for Indigenous Peoples and Their Lands
From the late 1980s through the mid-1990s, while environmentalists were
mounting the critique of multilateral development bank forest-destructive
lending practices, social scientists and development activists were beginning
to express concern about the impact of those practices on indigenous peoples.
Indigenous peoples and activists on their behalf began to focus on two legal
pathways: speci�c recognition, under national/domestic law, of indigenous
lands,25 and broad recognition, under public international law, of indigenous
rights.
Both pathways were extremely controversial, and efforts to pursue them
led to confrontations that turned violent on more than one occasion.26 The pur-
suit itself spoke volumes about the deep mistrust between indigenous com-
munities around the world and the governments that, from a public interna-
tional law perspective, were assumed to represent them in international treaty
negotiations. Time and again, real cases bore out the basis of that mistrust,
leading indigenous groups and their supporters to denounce the multilateral
negotiations on global forest governance27 and redouble their efforts to pursue
domestic and international recognition of indigenous rights.
Indigenous peoples all over the world had long valued lands differently
than nonindigenous. As an indigenous leader stated so eloquently more than
a century ago:
Our land is more valuable than your money. As long as the sun
shines and the waters flow, this land will be here to give life to men
24 Forests Sourcebook: Practical Guidance for Sustaining Forests in Development Cooperation (World
Bank 2008).
25 See, for example, Stephan Schartzman, Ana Valéria Araújo, & Paulo Pankararu, Brazil: The
Legal Battle over Indigenous Land Rights, 29(5) NACLA Report on the Americas 36 (1996).
26 See, for example, Scott Wallace, Farming the Amazon, National Geographic (Jan. 2007).
27 See Dimitrov, supra note 7.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 299
and animals. We cannot sell the lives of men and animals. It was
put here by the Great Spirit and we cannot sell it because it does not
belong to us.28
Domestic legislation speci�cally recognizing indigenous rights to particu-
lar areas of land, such as formal demarcation of indigenous lands in the Bra-
zilian Amazon, did not in and of itself alter the neoclassical economic view of
the relative value of forests for exploitation as opposed to forests for conserva-
tion. But as anthropologist Stephan Schwartzman notes, “Where Indian lands
begin is where deforestation ends.�29 A crucial stick in the West-conceived
“bundle� of property rights is the right to exclude others. Legal recognition
of the boundaries of indigenous lands provided indigenous peoples with an
essential tool by which they could begin to rebalance the sharp difference in
economic perception of land values between themselves and those seeking to
exploit forestlands for private gain.
In Brazil in particular, the movement for legal recognition of indigenous
land boundaries proved that if legal systems recognized indigenous peoples’
land rights, then in order to protect the resource they valued so highly, the
indigenous peoples would exercise and defend their right to exclude from
their lands those who would destroy the forests. Under Brazil’s constitution,
indigenous peoples hold generic rights to the lands they have traditionally
occupied, but prior to the movement for demarcation, the amount of lands
formally recognized as indigenous was zero. Today, as a direct result of the
demarcation movement, more than 20 percent of the Brazilian Amazon is
formally recognized as indigenous lands.30 Moreover, empirical evidence
indicates that the legal demarcation of indigenous lands has been a power-
ful factor in Brazil’s success in reducing deforestation. As Erika Yamada and
Raul Telles do Valle report, although indigenous lands have been subjected
to intensive deforestation pressures, Brazil’s Instituto Nacional de Pesquisas
Espaciais (INPE, National Institute for Space Research) estimates that defor-
estation in the roughly 1 million hectares of designated indigenous lands in
the Amazon amounts to only about 2 percent of deforestation nationally; of
the deforestation occurring in indigenous lands, more than 95 percent is due
to external forces.31
As demarcation began to prove an effective tool, its effectiveness
depended greatly on several variables, including the domestic gover-
28 Quoted in “The Story of Crowfoot’s Encounter,� Blackfoot Crossing Historical Park, avail-
able at .
29 Quoted in Wallace, supra note 26.
30 See Biviany J. Garzón, REDD in Indigenous Territories of the Amazon Basin: Will Indigenous Peoples
Be Direct Bene�ciaries? (Instituto Socioambiental 2009), available at .
31 Erika M. Yamada & Raul S. Telles do Valle, Forest Activities in Indigenous Lands and Carbon Cred-
its Ownership in Brazil (Instituto Socioambiental 2009), available at .
300 The World Bank Legal Review
nance situation in the nation undertaking the legal demarcation.32 To bolster
the case for indigenous rights to lands even in the absence of strong national
governance capacities, advocates simultaneously pursued a public interna-
tional law declaration recognizing indigenous rights. Many industrial country
governments opposed such a declaration, fearing that it would spawn fresh
rounds of domestic litigation challenging national or federal sovereignty over
indigenous lands. But after an extensive global campaign, the United Nations
Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous Peoples was agreed on in 2007.33 The
declaration, while admittedly “soft law� and therefore not legally binding, is
increasingly being referred to in a range of international and domestic legal
settings, an important step toward accreting the legitimacy needed for it to
play a signi�cant role in the economic rebalancing that is so crucial for forest
protection to go forward.34
32 See, for example, Wallace, supra note 26.
33 GA Res. 61/295, UN GAOR, 61st Sess., UN Doc. A/RES/61/295 (2007). United Nations
Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous Peoples (UNDRIP) was adopted by 144 states.
Eleven states—including the Russian Federation—abstained. Four—Australia, New Zea-
land, Canada, and the United States—voted against. All four have since clari�ed their posi-
tion, with many quali�cations. On December 16, 2010, at a tribal nations conference hosted
by the White House, U.S. president Barack Obama announced that the United States is
“lending support� to the UNDRIP, and the U.S. State Department issued a statement ex-
plaining what “lending support� means (it does not mean full endorsement). See Arctic In-
digenous Peoples Secretariat, Quali�ed UNDRIP Support (Feb. 21, 2011), available at , and U.S. Department of State, An-
nouncement of U.S. Support for the United Nations Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous
Peoples (Dec. 16, 2010), available at .
34 Of particular note in the forest context are Articles 26, 27, 28, 29.1, and 32 of the UNDRIP:
Article 26
1. Indigenous peoples have the right to the lands, territories and resources which they have
traditionally owned, occupied or otherwise used or acquired.
2. Indigenous peoples have the right to own, use, develop and control the lands, territories
and resources that they possess by reason of traditional ownership or other traditional oc-
cupation or use, as well as those which they have otherwise acquired.
3. States shall give legal recognition and protection to these lands, territories and resources.
Such recognition shall be conducted with due respect to the customs, traditions and land
tenure systems of the indigenous peoples concerned.
Article 27
States shall establish and implement, in conjunction with indigenous peoples concerned, a
fair, independent, impartial, open and transparent process, giving due recognition to indig-
enous peoples’ laws, traditions, customs and land tenure systems, to recognize and adju-
dicate the rights of indigenous peoples pertaining to their lands, territories and resources,
including those which were traditionally owned or otherwise occupied or used. Indigenous
peoples shall have the right to participate in this process.
Article 28
1. Indigenous peoples have the right to redress, by means that can include restitution or,
when this is not possible, just, fair and equitable compensation, for the lands, territories and
resources which they have traditionally owned or otherwise occupied or used, and which
have been con�scated, taken, occupied, used or damaged without their free, prior and in-
formed consent.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 301
Creation of Protected Areas
In the aftermath of the failure to reach a global forest convention, conserva-
tion organizations focused many of their efforts on the creation of protected
areas and the challenge of securing durable funding to support those areas.
In parallel, another group of actors, namely, social movements in developing
countries, which had protested large-scale fossil fuel extraction, opposed the
construction of big dams, and contested illegal timber extraction, also began
to broaden their focus in support of land protection.35 In some cases, social
movements and conservation organizations worked together to support the
creation of networks and mosaics of legally recognized indigenous lands,
strictly protected natural areas, and sustainable-use reserves.36
Typically, funding was sought from governments, private foundations,
and to a much more limited extent, ecotourism. Given the erratic nature of
government �nancing and how widely tourism fluctuates with business cy-
cles, one innovation in �nancing of protected areas was the attempt to de-
velop trust funds that would be large enough to be self-sustaining over time.
For example, in 2002, the WWF, the Brazilian government, and other partners
jointly launched the Amazon Region Protected Areas (ARPA) program, aimed
at creating a system of well-managed preservation areas and sustainable-use
2. Unless otherwise freely agreed upon by the peoples concerned, compensation shall take
the form of lands, territories and resources equal in quality, size and legal status or of mon-
etary compensation or other appropriate redress.
Article 29
1. Indigenous peoples have the right to the conservation and protection of the environment
and the productive capacity of their lands or territories and resources. States shall establish
and implement assistance programmes for indigenous peoples for such conservation and
protection, without discrimination.
[…]
Article 32
1. Indigenous peoples have the right to determine and develop priorities and strategies for
the development or use of their lands or territories and other resources.
2. States shall consult and cooperate in good faith with the indigenous peoples concerned
through their own representative institutions in order to obtain their free and informed
consent prior to the approval of any project affecting their lands or territories and other
resources, particularly in connection with the development, utilization or exploitation of
mineral, water or other resources.
3. States shall provide effective mechanisms for just and fair redress for any such activities,
and appropriate measures shall be taken to mitigate adverse environmental, economic, so-
cial, cultural or spiritual impact.
35 Stephan Schwartzman, et al., Social Movements and Large-Scale Tropical Forest Protection on the
Amazon Frontier: Conservation from Chaos, 19 J. Env. Development 274 (2010).
36 Id. See also Stephan Schwartzman & Barbara Zimmerman, Conservation Alliances with Indig-
enous Peoples of the Amazon, 19(3) Conservation Biology 721 (Jun. 2005).
302 The World Bank Legal Review
reserves based on rigorous scienti�c planning and careful public consulta-
tion.37 ARPA received initial funding from the Global Environment Facility
(GEF), through the World Bank, the German KfW Development Bank, and
WWF-Brazil.38 ARPA’s �rst phase, from 2003 to 2009, established more than
62 million acres of new protected areas—an area about the size of the U.S. state
of Wyoming.
ARPA provided timely support to the Brazilian Environment Ministry’s
broader vision, articulated by Minister of Environment Marina Silva39 and
embodied in Brazil’s National Plan to Prevent and Control Deforestation, of
major reductions in deforestation achieved in part through the creation of a
large mosaic of signi�cant protected areas and sustainable-use areas.40 The
national plan was of critical importance for many reasons, among the most
important of which was the fact that the government of Brazil backed the plan
with funding to implement it. The plan also provided a mechanism for coordi-
nating efforts between and among those seeking to create protected areas and
those seeking to help indigenous forest-dependent people gain legal recogni-
tion of their lands. The development of institutional capacities for undertak-
ing such coordination is particularly important in order to reduce or at least
manage gaps, conflicts, and duplication of efforts between and among these
stakeholders. Early evidence of the plan’s implementation indicates that the
managed mosaic approach, embracing both legal recognition of indigenous
lands and creation of protected areas, can be an effective strategy for forest
governance; the effectiveness is dependent on funding and governance.41
Bene�t-Sharing Agreements
In 1989, the National Institute of Biodiversity (InBio) was established in Costa
Rica;42 one of its earliest initiatives was the development of a bioprospect-
ing partnership, with bene�t sharing, with the Merck pharmaceutical com-
pany.43 At the time, it was hoped that such arrangements could provide durable
37 See World Wildlife Fund, Amazon Region Protected Areas (ARPA), available at .
38 Fundo Brasileiro para a Biodiversidade (Funbio), Solutions ARPA, available at .
39 See, generally, Marina Silva, The Brazilian Protected Areas Program, 19(3) Conservation Biology
608 (Jun. 2005).
40 ARPA’s second phase, from 2010 to 2013, seeks to create and improve management of
an even larger set of new protected areas. A primary objective of this second phase is the
implementation of complementary �nancing mechanisms to cover in perpetuity the recur-
ring expenses of ARPA’s large network of protected areas. See World Wildlife Fund, supra
note 37.
41 See, for example, Taylor H. Ricketts et al., Indigenous Lands, Protected Areas, and Slowing
Climate Change, 8(3) PLoS Biology (Mar. 2010).
42 Additional information about InBio is available at .
43 See, for example, Ana Sittenfeld & Annie Lovejoy, Biodiversity Prospecting, 6(4) Our Planet
20 (1994), and Ana Sittenfeld, InBio-Merck Collaborative Biodiversity Research Agreement, Costa
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 303
conservation �nancing by sharing royalties from patenting drugs and other
products derived from biologically active molecules, particularly those found
in tropical forested countries. This hope also formed the basis for signi�cant
portions of the Convention on Biological Diversity (CBD) agreed to at Rio
in 1992.
Although some additional bioprospecting or bene�t-sharing agreements
were developed in the 1990s, the number and breadth of such arrangements in-
creased signi�cantly after 2000. A 2008 survey done for the CBD secretariat,44 a
database compiled by the World Intellectual Property Organization (WIPO),45
and other research indicate bene�t-sharing agreements (including model and
actual agreements) in a wide range of countries, including Australia,46 Brazil,
Canada, China, Costa Rica, Czech Republic, Ethiopia, India, Kenya, Lebanon,
Nigeria, Pakistan, Russian Federation, South Africa, Sri Lanka, Thailand, and
the United States.47
Bene�t sharing varies by sector, but according to the CBD review, CBD
standards for best practice in bene�t sharing have become widely accepted.
Although unscrupulous and ill-informed companies continue to bypass these
standards, the larger or more socially responsible companies today would not
consider genetic resources freely available. Bene�ts typically include a mix
Rica, in Partnerships for Change 33 (Department of the Environment, UK 1994). See, generally,
“Biodiversity Prospecting Publications,� available at .
44 Sarah Laird & Rachel Wynberg, Access and Bene�t-Sharing in Practice: Trends in Partnerships
across Sectors, CBD Technical Series No. 38 (Secretariat of the Convention on Biological
Diversity 2008).
45 WIPO maintains a database of biodiversity-related access and bene�t-sharing agreements.
The database includes both model and actual agreements, as well as documents from a
diverse group of industrial and developing countries; it is available at .
46 See, for example, Australia’s model biodiversity access agreements, available at .
47 See, for example, Kurt Repanshek, National Park Service Finalizes “Bene�ts-Sharing Agreement�
That Could Bene�t Parks (Apr. 6, 2010), available at : “Park Service Director Jon Jarvis said the bene�ts-sharing agreement ‘would
not lead to commercialization of national parks, but could return some royalties to the parks
that would be put to work on conservation issues. . . . Implementing these changes is not
about commercializing the parks,’ said Mr. Jarvis in a press release. ‘This decision is about
the public receiving some bene�t from commercial projects that result from analysis of
samples collected in national parks.’ The decision does not change the existing strict NPS
research permit process, which remain[s] separate from any bene�ts-sharing negotiations.
The commercial use or sale of park specimens is still prohibited, as is damage to or the con-
sumptive use of park resources. In other words, while a researcher or company might sign
a bene�ts-sharing agreement with a speci�c park, it can’t begin collecting specimens until it
has obtained a permit to do so from the park. Those permits are not automatic just because
a bene�ts-sharing agreement has been signed, the document states.�
304 The World Bank Legal Review
of monetary bene�ts, such as fees per sample, royalties, and licensing agree-
ments, and nonmonetary bene�ts, such as training, capacity building, research
exchanges, equipment, technology transfer, and joint publications.48
Although hopes for bene�t-sharing agreements have been high, their abil-
ity to deliver durable compensation for the protection of forests has been un-
even at best, for several reasons. Industry sectors have waxed and waned in
their participation; for example, many pharmaceutical companies with natu-
ral product drug discovery programs in the 1990s had closed their programs
by 2008.49 Bureaucracies for implementing such agreements can be formida-
ble, entailing years of applications for permits; bioprospecting companies re-
gularly avoid some countries because of “national regulatory labyrinths.�50
Bene�t sharing in some sectors is complicated by the long chain of connec-
tion between the gathering of a biological material and the sale of a consum-
er product. For example, in the seed industry, plant breeding is cumulative;
product development may take place across several companies; companies
may market intermediate products without sharing bene�ts; and if bene�t
sharing is triggered only when seeds are sold to farmers, bene�ts arising from
the sale of foodstuffs to �nal consumers may not be shared.51
The CBD review found that in only a very few cases, such as in InBio-Merck,
did bioprospecting partnerships include payments to support protected areas
and local conservation activities, and that the most signi�cant conservation
bene�ts came from the discovery of new information that helps set conserva-
tion priorities. But, the review cautions, many nations initiating bioprospect-
ing or bene�t-sharing agreements tend to focus on future royalties, “which are
unlikely to materialize.�52 So, although developments since 2000 have sought
to regularize and increase the use of bene�t-sharing arrangements, including
the 2010 completion of the Nagoya Protocol on Access to Genetic Resources
48 Laird & Wynberg, supra note 44, at 117–18. For example, the U.S. Biotechnology Industry
Organization (BIO) published voluntary guidelines for bioprospecting that encourage mem-
bers to engage in bene�t-sharing agreements with providers of their research specimens.
Repanshek, supra note 47.
49 Laird and Wynberg note that stimulating increased demand for wild germplasm will require
considerable effort from provider countries. They also note that Costa Rica, for example, has
spent a lot of resources in developing an inventory and taxonomy of its biodiversity and
“�lling its shop window� for potential customers (users) and that some argue other coun-
tries should do likewise. At the same time, they implicitly caution nations not to raise high
hopes. They quote a representative from the seed sector as saying: “Modern varieties are far
more important to us. They contain more relevant genetic material than landraces or gene
bank material. Maybe once in ten years we need to look at disease resistance or any other
speci�c characteristic and need access to landraces and/or wild relatives. Modern varieties
bring quality—wild products cannot be used directly and need a lot of work before they
result in a product that can be sold.� Laird & Wynberg, supra note 44, at 17.
50 Id., at 25.
51 Id., at 50–51.
52 Id., at 30–31.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 305
and the Fair and Equitable Sharing of Bene�ts Arising from Their Utilization
to the Convention on Biological Diversity,53 bene�t sharing can be said at best
to provide an occasional thumb on the scale balancing the economics of forest
protection against the economics of forest destruction.
Combating Illegal Logging
Illegal logging for timber sale, land clearing, or other purposes has been dis-
cussed in many international institutions; the discussion became more heated
following the collapse of the forest convention negotiations.54 In 2002–04, hu-
man rights organizations focused on the role of timber in conflict areas.55 A
result was a group of initiatives seeking to combat illegal logging by using
the power of timber-importing countries to reduce the demand for illegally
logged timber, including timber logged in conflict areas. In 2003, the European
Union launched its Forest Law Enforcement, Governance and Trade (FLEGT)
Action Plan.56 That same year, U.S. president George W. Bush launched a
53 The Nagoya Protocol on Access to Genetic Resources and the Fair and Equitable Sharing
of Bene�ts Arising from Their Utilization to the Convention on Biological Diversity is an
international agreement that aims to share the bene�ts arising from the utilization of genetic
resources in a fair and equitable way, including by appropriate access to genetic resources
and by appropriate transfer of relevant technologies, taking into account all rights over those
resources and to technologies, and by appropriate funding, thereby contributing to the con-
servation of biological diversity and the sustainable use of its components. It was adopted by
the Conference of the Parties to the Convention on Biological Diversity at its 10th meeting,
October 29, 2010, in Nagoya, Japan. See .
54 According to the UK-AID-�nanced organization Illegal Logging.Org, forums for discussing
illegal logging have included the EU’s FLEGT process, the regional Forest Law Enforcement
and Governance (FLEG) conferences, the Asia Forest Partnership, International Tropical
Timber Organization (ITTO), the Food and Agriculture Organization (FAO), the United Na-
tions Forum on Forests (UNFF), the UN Economic Commission for Europe, the Ministerial
Conference for the Protection of Forests in Europe (MCPFE), the CBD, the Convention on
International Trade in Endangered Species (CITES), the Congo Basin Forest Partnership, the
World Trade Organization’s (WTO) Committee on Trade and Environment, and the Group
of Eight, among others. See .
55 See, for example, Global Witness, Logging Off: How the Liberian Timber Industry Fuels Libe-
ria’s Humanitarian Disaster and Threatens Sierra Leone (2002), available at ; and Amnesty International, Open Letter to Members of
the United Nations Security Council (Nov. 13, 2002), available at .
56 FLEGT components include the negotiation of bilateral voluntary partnership agreements
(VPAs) with producer countries, with licensing systems to identify legal products exported
from partner countries and license them for import to the EU and deny entry to unlicensed
products; capacity-building assistance to partner countries to set up licensing, improve en-
forcement, and reform laws; examination of EU member states’ existing domestic legislation,
and consideration of additional legislative options, to prohibit the import of illegal timber;
encouragement of government procurement policies to limit purchases to legal (and sus-
tainable) sources; encouragement of voluntary industry initiatives to control supply chains,
and thereby exclude illegal products; and encouragement of �nancial institution scrutiny of
flows of �nance to the forestry industry. See EU FLEGT Overview at .
306 The World Bank Legal Review
presidential initiative against illegal logging.57 A 2004 World Bank study58
placing the market value of losses from illegal forest cutting at over US$10
billion per year heightened attention to the problem, as did a study done for
the American Forest and Paper Association,59 an industry trade group, that
suggested that illegal harvesting was depressing forest product prices by
7–16 percent globally, and U.S. prices by 2–4 percent.
Both FLEGT and the president’s initiative against illegal logging were pre-
mised on voluntary partnerships, and both were dependent on government
funding.60 Each made some progress, but as the Bush administration drew to
a close, stronger action was clearly needed, because the �nancing, capacity
building, and voluntary partnerships were not enough to counterbalance the
gains from illegal logging.
In May 2008, the U.S. Congress enacted, and President Bush signed into
law, the Food, Conservation, and Energy Act of 2008, which, by amending
the Lacey Act, banned the import of illegally harvested wood and wood
products.61 In 2010, the European Union62 followed suit. The laws are broad
in scope and have led to at least one high-pro�le enforcement action. In No-
vember 2009, agents of the U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service executed a search
warrant on Gibson Guitars of Nashville, Tennessee. The raid was based on an
57 See .
58 Sustaining Forests: A Development Strategy 17 (World Bank 2004), available at .
59 Seneca Creek Associates & Wood Resources International, “Illegal� Logging and Global Wood
Markets: The Competitive Impacts on the U.S. Wood Products Industry, study prepared for the
American Forest and Paper Association (2004), available at .
60 The Bush initiative sought partnerships in the Congo basin, the Amazon basin, and South/
Southeast Asia, and was backed by initial funding of up to $15 million in 2003. See . To date, only
one FLEGT VPA has been concluded (with Ghana); see (accessed Feb. 2011).
61 The Lacey Act makes it a crime to import �sh or wildlife taken illegally under the rules
of the country of origin. As amended in 2008 (P.L. 110-246, 16 U.S.C. 3372), the Lacey Act
extends to plants and wood products, making it a violation of U.S. law to import, export,
transport, sell, receive, acquire, or purchase in interstate or foreign commerce any plant,
with some limited exceptions, taken in violation of the laws of a U.S. state or any foreign
law that protects plants. The Lacey Act also makes it unlawful to make or submit any false
record, account, or label for, or any false identi�cation of, any plant. The prohibition makes it
unlawful to import any product containing wood or plant material that was illegally taken.
See U.S. Department of Agriculture Animal and Plant Health Inspection Service [Docket No.
APHIS–2008–0119] Implementation of Revised Lacey Act Provisions, Notice, 74 Federal Reg-
ister No. 169, at 45415-45417 (Sep. 2, 2009).
62 See Regulation (EU) No. 995/2010 of the European Parliament and of the Council of
October 20, 2010, laying down the obligations of operators who place timber and timber
products on the market. The legislation prohibits the sale of timber logged illegally under the
rules of the country of origin, and requires companies to exercise due diligence to ascertain
that the timber they sell in the EU was harvested legally. The regulation takes effect in 2013.
Implementing regulations are being drafted; the full text of the regulation is available at
.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 307
af�davit and published reports alleging that Gibson was using rosewood and
mahogany illegally harvested in Madagascar and shipped to the United States
through Germany.63 In 2010, the United States commenced action to seize the
alleged illegally harvested wood.64
Closing markets to the products of illegal logging and stepping up the
enforcement of such closures are certainly key elements in rebalancing the
economics of forest destruction, particularly where high-value rare woods
like mahogany are concerned. The effectiveness of the effort to combat ille-
gal logging depends, however, in part on how broadly market closures are
achieved; to date, they seem to be occurring primarily in industrial countries.
Even within industrial countries, uneven enforcement could undermine the
effectiveness of the bans. For example, the new EU law leaves it up to each
member state to decide what penalties it will apply to those who trade in il-
legally harvested wood, raising the possibility that member states that choose
to adopt weak penalties might become entrepots of illegal timber.65
Forest Certi�cation
In the aftermath of the failure of efforts to achieve a global forest convention,
interest in forest certi�cation programs increased signi�cantly.66 Forest certi-
�cation has been called a form of nonstate market-driven global governance
that relies on consumer behavior, mediated through market preference, to
influence forest management.67 Forest certi�cation programs seek to encour-
age consumers to choose certi�ed forest products based on improved envi-
ronmental performance and to encourage producers to go through the certi-
�cation process in order to gain market share, price premiums, reputational
advantage, or other bene�ts. Forest certi�cation thus assumes that purchasers
will prefer sustainably produced forest products and will demand them in the
63 Miller & Chevalier, Gibson Guitar Raid (Nov. 2009), available at .
64 E. Thomas Wood, What the Feds Found at Gibson, Nashville Post (Aug. 12, 2010).
65 The member states’ penalties may include “�nes proportionate to the environmental dam-
age, the value of the timber or timber products concerned and the tax losses and economic
detriment resulting from the infringement, calculating the level of such �nes in such way as
to make sure that they effectively deprive those responsible of the economic bene�ts derived
from their serious infringements, without prejudice to the legitimate right to exercise a pro-
fession, and gradually increasing the level of such �nes for repeated serious infringements�
as well as immediate suspension of authorization to trade; however, there is no mandatory
minimum penalty, so the deterrent value is unclear. See Reg. (EU) No. 995/2010, Article 19.
66 See, for example, Steven Bernstein & Benjamin Cashore, Non-state Global Governance: Is Forest
Certi�cation a Legitimate Alternative to a Global Forest Convention? in Hard Choices, Soft Law:
Combining Trade, Environment, and Social Cohesion in Global Governance 33 (John Kirton &
Michael Trebilcock ed., Ashgate Press 2004).
67 See Long, supra note 16, and Kelly Levin et al., Can Non-state Governance “Ratchet-Up� Global
Standards? Assessing Their Indirect Effects and Evolutionary Potential, Rev. Eur. Community &
Intl. Envtl. L. 1, 4–5 (2007).
308 The World Bank Legal Review
marketplace with public education campaigns and the organization of buyer
groups to educate and socialize retailers.68
Nearly 60 forest certi�cation systems operate around the world,69 rang-
ing from those organized primarily by conservation advocates to those or-
ganized primarily by industry, with each side expressing concerns about the
other’s program.70 Although several hundred million acres of forest have been
certi�ed, the Nature Conservancy estimates that the percentage of certi�ed
wood reaching global markets represents a very small fraction—less than
5 percent—of the international forest products trade.71
Why have these programs not captured more of the market for forest prod-
ucts? First, substantial investment in certi�cation programs and chain of cus-
tody is necessary, making certi�ed products often more expensive than their
uncerti�ed competitors. So, rather than balancing the scales against economic
forces favoring deforestation, certi�cation programs fundamentally depend
on the willingness of purchasers and end consumers to pay higher prices for
sustainably managed and veri�ed products. Thus, market forces work against
certi�cation programs to a certain degree.
Second, although many efforts have been undertaken to create buyer
groups, nonbinding voluntary certi�cation programs are unable to deploy the
tool that has been so effective in some other environmental �elds at reducing
leakage and addressing competitiveness, in effect counterbalancing economic
incentives to engage in trade in environmentally harmful products. That tool
is a ban on trade with nonparties in products that don’t meet the environ-
mental standard. Such bans are key elements of the Montreal Protocol on the
Ozone Layer, the Basel Convention on Hazardous Wastes, and the Conven-
tion on International Trade in Endangered Species of Flora and Fauna.72 But al-
though unilateral bans on trade in illegally harvested wood products are being
adopted and enforced,73 applying such unilateral bans to trade on products
68 Bernstein & Cashore, supra note 66, at 38.
69 Nature Conservancy, Forest Conservation and Responsible Trade (2011), available at .
70 Bernstein and Cashore identify the Forest Stewardship Council (FSC) as a program orga-
nized primarily by NGOs, and identify as industry organized the American Forest and Pa-
per Association’s Sustainable Forestry Initiative program in the United States, the Canadian
Standards Association program initiated with support from the Canadian Pulp and Paper
Association (now the Forest Products Association of Canada), and the Pan European Forest
Certi�cation system, created by landowner associations that felt excluded from the FSC pro-
cess. See Bernstein & Cashore, supra note 66, at 38.
71 Nature Conservancy, supra note 69.
72 See Carol A. Petsonk, The Role of the United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP) in the
Development of International Environmental Law, 5 Am. U.J. Intl. L. & Policy 351 (1990).
73 The Gibson case illustrates the challenges faced by forest certi�cation programs. Since 1996,
Gibson’s Nashville factory has held an FSC chain-of-custody certi�cate guaranteeing that all
certi�ed wood comes from legal sources, such as community-managed forests in Honduras
and Guatemala. Gibson’s factory and the guitars are subject to annual FSC inspection and
were recerti�ed in September 2008. Notwithstanding the FSC 2008 inspection and certi�ca-
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 309
that fail to meet voluntary nonstate forest certi�cation programs would likely
raise substantial issues under the rules of the multilateral trading system.74
Can Recognizing REDD+ in Carbon Markets Help?
A different lens through which to view the forest governance program is the
concept of carbon markets as a countervailing force against the economic
pressures that favor deforestation.75 This section examines why the concept
of carbon markets did not gain acceptance in the implementation of the 1997
Kyoto Protocol, traces the origin and evolution of the Reducing Emissions
from Deforestation in Developing Countries (REDD) approach, and examines
prospects for its future application.
Why Was Forest Carbon Largely Left Out of the Kyoto Protocol?
The demise of the global forest convention in early 2000 coincided with a
crescendo in the negotiations on rules for implementing the Kyoto Protocol
on Climate Change.76 The protocol agreed to in 1997 placed binding caps on
the greenhouse gas emissions of more than 30 industrial nations for the years
tion, published reports alleged that certain wood in Gibson’s factory was illegally harvested
from Madagascar, and the United States commenced the legal action discussed above fol-
lowing the 2008 amendment of the Lacey Act. See Miller & Chevalier, supra note 63. Gibson
has since committed to ensure that all of the wood that it uses comes from FSC-certi�ed or
otherwise veri�ed legal sources. See Rainforest Alliance, Gibson Guitars Working with Rainfor-
est Alliance on Wood Sourcing Legality (Jul. 2010), available at .
74 Cf. Duncan Brack, Combating Illegal Logging: Interaction with WTO Rules (Environment
and Resource Governance Series IL BP 2009/1, Jun. 2009), available at .
75 “The international community has lurched from one policy approach to another, throwing
too little money and too many plans at the problem and hoping for the best, without any
overall effort to forge a coherent, performance-based approach that addresses directly the
structural tensions embedded in forest governance and the basic forces driving forest de-
struction. Explanations of the failure of global forest governance have focused on a variety of
factors, including the tremendous variability in the forces driving deforestation, deep-seated
conflicts over sovereignty and control of forest resources, and limited institutional and forest
governance capacities at national and sub-national levels. . . . In short, efforts to frame tropi-
cal deforestation as a global problem have not translated into workable solutions in part be-
cause deforestation is not a unitary phenomenon amenable to easy generalization, much less
global governance. Previous ways of seeing the problem, in other words, have not provided
a suf�cient foundation for effective governance, raising the important question of whether
a climate policy approach to deforestation (a very different way of seeing the problem) will
succeed where past efforts have failed.� William Boyd, Ways of Seeing in Environmental Law:
How Deforestation Became an Object of Climate Governance, 37 Ecol. L.Q. 843, 866 (2010). See
also William Boyd, Deforestation and Emerging Greenhouse Gas Compliance Regimes: Toward a
Global Environmental Law of Forests, Carbon, and Climate Governance, in Deforestation and Cli-
mate Change: Reducing Carbon Emissions from Deforestation and Forest Degradation 1 (Valentina
Bosetti & Ruben Lubowski ed., Edward Elgar 2010).
76 Kyoto Protocol to the United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change, UN Doc.
FCCC/CP/1997/7/Add.1, December 10, 1997, 37 I.L.M. 22 (1998) (entered into force Feb. 16,
2005) (Kyoto Protocol).
310 The World Bank Legal Review
2008–12, issued each nation an amount of emissions allowances equal to their
emissions caps, gave nations flexibility to reallocate their emissions allowanc-
es among themselves in order to meet their obligations jointly, and authorized
nations that reduced emissions below capped levels to save their surplus al-
lowances for future use or transfer them to other nations.77 This kind of emis-
sions cap-and-trade system had been tested in the United States and proven
very effective at reducing emissions of sulfur dioxide, a major cause of acid
rain;78 the Clinton-Gore administration advocated strongly for its inclusion in
the Kyoto Protocol.
In the Kyoto negotiations, the United States also supported a New Zealand
proposal for inclusion of provisions explicitly allowing developing nations
voluntarily to take caps on emissions and participate in emissions trading.
But the 77 developing countries and China solidly opposed the New Zealand
proposal, citing the 1995 negotiating mandate for the protocol, in which na-
tions had agreed that the protocol would result in no new commitments for
developing countries.79 A few developing countries, wanting to test the pos-
sibility of trading but not wanting to adopt a cap, did support the proposition
that any developing country that voluntarily wished to could allow inves-
tors to develop projects in its territory that reduced emissions below what
would have otherwise occurred and transfer the resulting “emissions offset�
to industrial nations—an idea that became the protocol’s clean development
mechanism (CDM).80
The question of whether the CDM would recognize offsets from reduced
deforestation was not dealt with at Kyoto in 1997. The resolution of that ques-
tion, as well as other forest-related issues and carbon market issues, was
pushed into negotiations that took place from 1998 to 2000 on rules elaborating
the relatively spare prose of the Kyoto Protocol and clarifying its implemen-
tation. At talks in The Hague in late 2000, after an all-night session in which
U.S. negotiators pressed for some recognition of forest carbon in the rules for
implementing Kyoto’s market mechanisms, the gray rainy dawn found ex-
hausted American delegates sitting at an empty table. The Europeans, oppos-
ing any ambit for forests in carbon markets, had walked out. By the time the
negotiations reconvened in the spring of 2001, newly elected U.S. president
George W. Bush had renounced both Kyoto and his campaign pledge to cap
carbon dioxide emissions. The United States wasn’t coming back to the table.
77 Kyoto Protocol, Articles 3, 4, and 17.
78 U.S. Clean Air Act Amendments of 1990, Title IV, 42 U.S.C. Sections 7652 et seq. See also
Andrew Aulisi et al., From Obstacle to Opportunity: How Acid Rain Emissions Trading Is Deliv-
ering Cleaner Air (Environmental Defense Fund 2000), available at .
79 Conference of the Parties to the United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change,
Berlin, F.R.G., March 28–April 7, 1995, Addendum, Decision 1/CP.1, Section II(2)(b), FCCC/
CP/1995/7/Add.1 (Jun. 6, 1995) (Berlin Mandate).
80 Kyoto Protocol, Article 12.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 311
Why was the issue of including forests in carbon markets so controver-
sial in the climate treaty talks?81 The U.S. interest in it was a long-standing
one. In the early 1990s, the Bush administration began to explore market-
based policies for inclusion in the 1992 United Nations Framework Conven-
tion on Climate Change (UNFCCC) and advocated a “comprehensive ap-
proach� in which all greenhouse gases, their sources, and sinks—including
forests—would be included.82 President Bush also developed a “forests for the
future initiative� to begin to address tropical deforestation in the �eld.83 In
the negotiations leading up to Kyoto and following the protocol’s adoption, the
Clinton administration maintained this position, expanding it to support
binding caps on emissions, which the previous administration had eschewed,
and broad opportunities for crediting forest carbon.
The European Union was much more cautious about both “market mecha-
nisms� and forest carbon. The EU supported the idea of reallocation of targets
among nations in a group (like the EU itself), but agreed to emissions trading
only grudgingly, after the United States had offered to tighten the target that
it would inscribe as its Kyoto commitment.84 Many Europeans were skeptical
that market mechanisms would work. Some objected to market mechanisms
on moral grounds, arguing that emissions trading amounted to the sale of
indulgences. Many Europeans were also skeptical about forest protection as
an element of climate mitigation. They regarded forest protection as a moral
obligation, and the history of failed initiatives in tropical forest conservation
made them reluctant to consider the possibility that “forest sinks� would be
durable enough to justify using them to offset increases in fossil fuel emissions.
Consequently, proposals to bring forest protection into market mechanisms
generated bitter and strong opposition from many Europeans.85
81 See, generally, Federica Bietta, From the Hague to Copenhagen: Why It Failed Then and Why It
Could Be Different, in Deforestation and Climate Change: Reducing Carbon Emissions from Deforesta-
tion and Forest Degradation 27 (Valentina Bosetti & Ruben Lubowski ed., Edward Elgar 2010).
82 See, for example, Case No. 147516CU 5 P-5: Memo from Dick Stewart to Allan Bromley and
List, Work of the Task Force to Further Develop the “Comprehensive� and “Trading� Approaches to
Possible Climate Change Agreement (copy on �le with George H. W. Bush Library).
83 See White House Statement on the Forests for the Future Initiative, supra note 1.
84 “Some of you here have, perhaps, heard from your home capitals that President Clinton and
I have been burning up the phone lines, consulting and sharing new ideas. Today let me add
this. After talking with our negotiators this morning and after speaking on the telephone
from here a short time ago with President Clinton, I am instructing our delegation right
now to show increased negotiating flexibility if a comprehensive plan can be put in place,
one with realistic targets and timetables, market mechanisms, and the meaningful participa-
tion of key developing countries.� Remarks as prepared for delivery for Vice President Al
Gore, Kyoto Climate Change Conference (Dec. 8, 1997), available at .
85 During the 2000 climate talks in The Hague, European environmentalists displayed an enor-
mous banner reading “Don’t SINK the Kyoto Protocol!� In their view, and in the view of
some of their governments, allowing credit for uptake of carbon dioxide by forest sinks
would give the United States an unfair advantage, because the United States was experienc-
ing increases in its forest cover, whereas Europe’s forest cover was thought to be relatively
stable, with few opportunities for increasing forestlands.
312 The World Bank Legal Review
Important at the time was the position of the Brazilian government. Brazil
had supported, some might even say originated, the idea of the CDM. But in
the late 1990s, the government of Brazil adamantly opposed including credit-
ing of forest carbon in the CDM, arguing that such crediting would be tanta-
mount to locking up Brazilian forests. European environmentalists opposed to
forest carbon crediting pointed to the lack of good measurement data on tropi-
cal deforestation. Brazilian civil society representatives, attending the climate
talks for the �rst time, realized that their government had taken a position on
a crucial issue for civil society, namely, whether forest-dependent communi-
ties could be remunerated for protecting forests that mitigate climate change,
without consulting with those communities to ascertain their views—and that
this position also conveniently allowed their government to protect the con�-
dentiality of data about the very high rates of deforestation nationwide.86
Origin and Evolution of REDD+
When the negotiations in The Hague fell apart in November 2000, these civil
society representatives decided to commence broad consultation in Brazil
with forest communities and others concerned about the Amazon. They also
undertook an intensive examination of the objections to forest carbon credit-
ing that had caused The Hague talks to founder and found that a main objec-
tion to the inclusion of forest carbon projects in the CDM was the high poten-
tial for leakage; that is, while trees might be protected in one place and credits
awarded that avoided deforestation, the emission reductions might be ne-
gated if loggers simply increased tree cutting elsewhere.87 Much of the acri-
mony in The Hague had been focused on whether to allow crediting for
uptake of carbon dioxide by trees in forest sinks, whereas the problem that
concerned the civil society representatives most was reducing deforestation
and its attendant greenhouse gas emissions.
On the basis of their consultations and research, and working with forest
scientists and anthropologists, this group crafted a new proposal that did not
involve crediting for uptake by sinks. The group proposed that reductions in
deforestation in developing countries be compensated through carbon mar-
kets and that the reductions be achieved at national scale over multiyear peri-
ods. They initially presented this “compensated reduction� proposal in 2003,88
and published a key paper on it in 2005.89
86 Eli Kintisch & Antonio Regalado, Cancun Delegates See the Trees through a Forest of Hot Air, 330
Science 1597 (Dec. 17, 2010).
87 Id.
88 See Bernhard Schlamadinger et al., Should We Include Avoidance of Deforestation in the Inter-
national Response to Climate Change? in Tropical Deforestation and Climate Change 53 (Paulo
Moutinho & Stephan Schwartzman ed., Instituto de Pesquisa Ambiental da Amazônia
2005).
89 Márcio Santilli et al., Tropical Deforestation and the Kyoto Protocol: An Editorial Essay, 71(3) Cli-
matic Change 267 (2005); see also Kintisch & Regalado, supra note 86.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 313
The compensated reduction proposal addressed virtually all the key ob-
jections to forest carbon crediting. It tackled the issue of leakage from indi-
vidual projects, because crediting would only occur for reductions achieved
across large scales (at the national level). It provided a basis for addressing
the issue of measurement, because the proposal could succeed only if gov-
ernments made public their data about deforestation. In fact, the proposal
triggered a flurry of activity among forest scientists, who began sharing their
data and methodologies and demonstrating to governments that advances
in remote sensing could provide a solid basis for implementing the compen-
sated reduction proposal.90 The proposal addressed the issue of durability, or
permanence, by requiring that reductions be demonstrated over multiyear
periods and through provisions suggesting that portions of reduction credits
be held in reserve as insurance against forest �res and other disasters.91 And,
as one commentator observed,
it reframed the issue from one focused on forests as carbon sinks—
the dominant framing during the Kyoto Protocol discussions—to one
focused on the forest sector as a source of emissions, thereby putting
the problem in the same regulatory lexicon as fossil fuel emissions
and smoothing the way for an integration into climate policy.92
More fundamentally, the compensated reduction proposal sought to pro-
vide what no previous efforts at forest governance had achieved: a powerful
framework for rebalancing the economics of forest destruction in every forest
ecosystem, in every nation around the world. At the Eleventh Conference of
the Parties to the United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change,
held in Montreal, Canada, in late 2005, delegates from Papua New Guinea
and Costa Rica, supported by delegates from developing countries from Cen-
tral America, South America, and Africa working together in a Coalition for
Rainforest Nations (CfRN), formally introduced the concept of compensating
nations for reducing emissions from deforestation. Zeroing in on the funda-
mental issue of rebalancing, the group said:
In the absence of revenue streams from standing forests, commu-
nities and governments in many developing nations have little in-
centive to prevent deforestation. As a consequence, communities
must bear losses of the services from forests that are not currently
valued economically, while globally, we all must assume the conse-
quences of increased greenhouse gases in the Earth’s atmosphere. It is
90 See, for example, Ruth DeFries et al., “Reducing Greenhouse Gas Emissions from Deforestation
in Developing Countries: Considerations for Monitoring and Measuring,� Report of the Glob-
al Terrestrial Observing System (GTOS), No. 46; Global Observation of Forest Cover–Global
Observation of Land Dynamics (GOFC-GOLD), Report No. 26 (2006), available at ; and Gregory P. Asner et al., Condition and Fate of Logged
Forests in the Brazilian Amazon, 103 Proceedings of the National Academy of Science (PNAS),
No. 34, at 12947–12950 (Aug. 22, 2006).
91 Santilli et al., supra note 89.
92 William Boyd, Ways of Seeing in Environmental Law: How Deforestation Became an Object of
Climate Governance, 37 Ecol. L.Q. 843, 846 (2010).
314 The World Bank Legal Review
estimated that tropical countries could reduce 1.5GtC emissions
from tropical deforestation over ten years and generate billions
of dollars in conservation and climate mitigation revenue. Without
a more complete market valuation, standing forests cannot over-
come the economic opportunity costs associated with their
conservation . . . As developing nations, we are prepared to stand
accountable for our contributions to global climate stability, pro-
vided international frameworks are appropriately modi�ed, namely
through fair and equitable access to carbon emissions markets.93
CfRN titled its intervention “Reducing Emissions from Deforestation in
Developing Countries (REDD): Approaches to Stimulate Action.�94
The effect of REDD on the climate treaty talks was dramatic. Nation after
nation rose to speak in support of opening a discussion on the concept.95 That
in itself was remarkable, because inherent in the proposal was a greater de-
gree of developing-country participation than the iron-clad division between
industrial and developing countries embodied in the Berlin Mandate. But it
was also remarkable in that the quiet eloquence of REDD broke through the
acrimony that had encrusted forest issues since the collapse of The Hague
meeting half a decade earlier.
Although REDD originated in the context of the climate treaty talks, it
quickly began to exert a powerful gravitational pull on the forest governance
debate. There were several reasons. The �rst was time horizons. Previous ef-
forts at forest governance had failed to produce a framework that could de-
liver incentives for forest protection durably over the multidecade periods
needed for forest conservation and sound forest management. REDD in car-
bon markets provided a way to match forest governance with greenhouse gas
emissions management, a similarly long-term task requiring sustained du-
rable investment over multidecade periods. Because demand for greenhouse
gas emission reductions would continue far into the future, matching the two
93 UNFCCC, Submission by the Governments of Papua New Guinea and Costa Rica: Reduc-
ing Emissions from Deforestation in Developing Countries; Approaches to Stimulate Action,
at 4-7 U.N. Doc. FCCC/CP/2005/MISC.1 (Nov. 11, 2005), available at .
94 Id. Although the World Bank began calling for such rebalancing as early as 2002, a frame-
work for rebalancing was unlikely to emerge in the climate treaty talks unless championed
by a substantial grouping of developing countries themselves. Cf. Sustaining Forests: A World
Bank Strategy 8-9 (World Bank 2002), available at . (“There is
a need for creative mechanisms to pay for the protection of forest environmental services
of both local and global importance. It is highly unlikely that governments will be able to
signi�cantly scale down log extraction, unless the costs in terms of foregone revenue can
be offset in some way. Moreover, very few countries would be prepared to borrow funds—
from the World Bank or other sources—to �nance forest protection as a substitute for forest
production. We must therefore help foster new markets and payment systems for environ-
mental services from forest ecosystems, and to interest developing countries in activities that
will improve forest management and conservation.�)
95 Personal knowledge of the author, who attended the conference as an observer.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 315
problems offered the potential to exert a downward pressure on deforestation
rates over a very long time horizon, giving those who would invest in for-
est carbon crediting an incentive to support improved forest governance over
commensurately long times.
The second reason was scale. Prior to REDD, climate treaty talks had paid
scant attention to the large role that deforestation played in global greenhouse
emissions. Analyses of global emissions, and ranking of nations in terms of
largest emitters, had typically considered only emissions from the combustion
of fossil fuel. But the compensated reduction proposal prompted experts to
take emissions from deforestation into account, with results that many experts
found surprising. Although most climate policy experts knew that the largest
and second-largest emitting nations were the United States and China, most
didn’t realize that numbers three and four were Indonesia and Brazil, with
70 percent or more of their national greenhouse gas emissions from deforesta-
tion.96 Most experts also didn’t realize that deforestation was responsible for
an amount of emissions roughly comparable to the entire global transporta-
tion sector. But if deforestation emerged as a large component of the climate
puzzle, deploying carbon markets in the service of compensating reductions
in deforestation offered the opportunity to generate incentives for very large
scale reductions in deforestation. No previous effort to improve forest gov-
ernance had the potential to exert as broad a downward pressure on global
deforestation rates.97
The third reason was urgency. Forest scientists were warning that if dra-
matic reductions in deforestation rates were not made swiftly, the world’s
native forests could simply disappear. Climate scientists were warning that
without rapid early emission reductions, the goal of averting dangerous inter-
ference with the climate system—which many interpreted as warming more
than 2 degrees Celsius above preindustrial levels—could be permanently fore-
closed. REDD in carbon markets offered the possibility of spurring investment
96 Eveline Trines et al., Integrating Agriculture, Forestry, and Other Land Use in Future Climate
Regimes: Methodological Issues and Policy Options, Climate Change Scienti�c Assessment and
Policy Analysis WAB Report 500102 002, at 82 (Government of the Netherlands 2006), avail-
able at . See also Bryan Walsh, Getting Credit for Saving
Trees, Time (Jul. 12, 2007). (“Pop quiz for all you global-warming experts: After China and
the U.S., which country emits the greatest quantity of greenhouse gases per year? Answer
high-tech Japan or industrial Germany, and you flunk. . . . It’s rural Indonesia, which emits
3.3 billion tons of carbon dioxide annually—almost entirely from deforestation.�)
97 This point was subsequently taken up in Europe, including in Nicholas Stern, The Economics
of Climate Change: The Stern Review (Cambridge U. Press 2007), and Johan Eliasch, Climate
Change: Financing Global Forests—The Eliasch Review (Earthscan 2008).
316 The World Bank Legal Review
in cost-effective,98 large-scale, immediately available99 emission reductions,
buying precious time for new low-carbon fossil fuel technologies to mature.100
Although some critics feared, and continue to fear, that REDD could drive
carbon prices down and crowd out more costly low-carbon energy technolo-
gies, subsequent analyses have demonstrated that REDD will not flood car-
bon markets as long as market actors are allowed to “bank,� or save, surplus
emission reductions,101 and that bringing options for REDD into carbon mar-
kets could actually broaden the ambit for innovation in low-carbon fossil fuel
technologies.102
The fourth had to do with equity. For �fteen years, “equity� in the climate
talks had stood for the concept that industrial countries should go �rst and
no new commitments should be introduced for developing countries. But the
way that Papua New Guinea and Costa Rica presented REDD addressed a
98 Including a global program to reduce deforestation within a global carbon market system
lowers the estimated total costs of a policy to achieve 535 ppmv of CO2-equivalent con-
centrations in 2100 by up to 25 percent. Alternatively, a global REDD program could en-
able additional reductions of about 20 ppmv by 2100 with no added costs compared with
an energy-sector-only policy. Valentina Bosetti, Ruben Lubowski, Alexander Golub, & Anil
Markandya, Linking Reduced Deforestation and a Global Carbon Market: Implications for Clean
Energy Technology and Policy Flexibility, Environment and Development Economics/First-
View Article (2011).
99 Early emissions reductions have particular value as a global insurance policy for maintain-
ing climatic options in light of scienti�c uncertainty. Linking deforestation reductions to a
market system in combination with credit banking also would encourage greater reductions
in the near term, allowing targets to be met ahead of schedule. In addition to helping indi-
vidual �rms buffer against carbon market volatility, this has value at the global level in terms
of enhancing flexibility to potentially tighten emission targets at lower cost in response to
future scienti�c information, taking into account effects on technological innovation in the
energy sector. See Bosetti et al., supra note 98.
100 Some of the concern over avoiding “flooding� has centered on concerns that REDD credits
might reduce carbon prices and thus reduce incentives for the development and deploy-
ment of clean energy technologies. Recent research suggests that such effects are likely to be
modest relative to the bene�ts of implementing ambitious climate policies and may actually
slightly boost research and innovation within some energy technology sectors, including
carbon capture and storage; see Bosetti et al., supra note 98. The flexibility provided by REDD
could also grant �rms some time to more ef�ciently schedule their long-lived capital invest-
ments in new technologies, such as carbon capture and storage. This could spur �rms to
invest in more research and development and then leapfrog to new technologies available in
a few years’ time rather than sinking costs into the technological options that are currently
available. See Sabine Fuss, et al., Options on Low-Cost Abatement and Investment in the Energy
Sector: New Perspectives on REDD, Environment and Development Economics/FirstView
Article (2011); and Alexander Golub, Options on REDD as a Hedging Tool for Post-Kyoto Climate
Policy, in Deforestation and Climate Change: Reducing Carbon Emissions from Deforestation and
Forest Degradation 165 (Valentina Bosetti & Ruben Lubowski ed., Edward Elgar 2010).
101 See Pedro Piris-Cabezas, REDD and the Global Carbon Market: The Role of Banking, in Deforesta-
tion and Climate Change: Reducing Carbon Emissions from Deforestation and Forest Degradation
151 (Valenina Bosetti & Ruben Lubowski ed., Edward Elgar 2010); and Bosetti et al., supra
note 98. See also Brian C. Murray, Ruben Lubowski, & Brent Sohngen, Including International
Forest Carbon Incentives in Climate Policy: Understanding the Economics, Nicholas Institute for
Environmental Policy Solutions Report 09-03 (2009).
102 Fuss et al., supra note 100.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 317
different conception of equity, namely, the fact that many smaller tropical for-
est nations felt disempowered in the climate treaty talks because forest carbon
projects had been shut out of the CDM. By framing their proposal as an issue
of “fair and equitable access to carbon emissions markets,� they put REDD
at center stage in the climate treaty talks and opened a new way of thinking
about issues in forest governance.
The �fth was community. Some policy experts had argued that market-
based approaches could not work to protect tropical forests because unclear
land tenure, including communal ownership of the forest resources, would
make it dif�cult to tell who owned the carbon, hamper interactions with car-
bon markets, and expose the resources to destructive “free riding� and the
classic “tragedy of the commons.�103 But new empirical analyses of common-
pool resources and social-economic organization indicated that some variables
seemed to enhance the chances that communities would self-organize in favor
of sustainable management of jointly held resources.104 These variables could
encourage community members to work together to promote sustainability
and thereby maximize the return to the overall community.105
REDD’s proponents explicitly framed their intervention in terms of
community,106 and it quickly became clear that REDD, applied at the level of
communally held forest resources, had the potential to connect many vari-
ables.107 The question of legal recognition of land rights played a pivotal role.
For example, the reason many indigenous peoples and rubber tappers in the
103 Garrett Hardin, The Tragedy of the Commons, 162 Science 1243 (1968).
104 See, for example, Elinor Ostrom, Roy Gardner, & James Walker, Rules, Games and Common-
Pool Resources (University of Michigan Press 1994); and People and Forests: Communities, In-
stitutions, and Governance (Clark C. Gibson, Margaret A. McKean, & Elinor Ostrom ed., MIT
Press 2000). See, generally, Elinor Ostrom, Governing the Commons: The Evolution of Institutions
for Collective Action (Cambridge U. Press, 1990), identifying common aspects of successful
communally owned resource management:
1. Clearly de�ned boundaries (effective exclusion of external unentitled parties)
2. Rules on appropriation and provision of common resources are adapted to local condi-
tions
3. Collective choice allows most resource appropriators to participate in decision making
4. Effective monitoring by monitors who are part of or accountable to the appropriators
5. Graduated sanctions for resource appropriators who violate community rules
6. Cheap and easily accessible mechanisms of conflict resolution
7. The self-determination of the community is recognized by higher-level authorities
8. In the case of larger common-pool resources, organization in the form of multiple layers
of nested enterprises, with small local common-pool resources at the base level
105 See Bjorn Vollan & Elinor Ostrom, Cooperation and the Commons, 330 Science 923 (Nov. 12,
2010).
106 Submission by the Governments of Papua New Guinea and Costa Rica, supra note 93, at 4.
107 See Elinor Ostrom, A General Framework for Analyzing Sustainability of Social-Ecological Sys-
tems, 325 Science 419 (Jul. 24, 2009). Additional relevant variables include size of the resource
system, predictability of system dynamics, and low mobility of the resource unit. Id., at 421.
318 The World Bank Legal Review
Amazon, particularly in Brazil, supported REDD —and a central reason that
Brazil has at least some of the governance capacity necessary to control defor-
estation—is that the indigenous peoples and rubber tappers had largely won
the struggle for legal recognition of their rights to the land on the forest fron-
tier, and their communities and the government thus had greater capacity to
connect with sensitively undertaken programs to reduce deforestation. In the
�sheries sector, analyses indicated that imposing total allowable catch quotas
for a given �shery resource in some instances led to widespread dumping of
unwanted �sh, misrepresentation of catches, and closure of the �shery; but as-
signing transferable �shery quotas and requiring neutral observers on board
ships transformed the variables to favor communal restoration of the �shery
to sustainability.108 In a similar way, sensitively developed REDD programs
had the potential to connect economic incentives for forest protection with
communally held forest resources.
Thus, REDD evolved remarkably quickly in the global climate treaty
talks. A series of UNFCCC technical workshops in 2006–08 explored ques-
tions of measurability, permanence, and baselines. REDD gained support
from a broad range of developing countries. In 2007, the government of Brazil
adopted a decree on climate change that, inter alia, established a domestic
target of a 70 percent reduction in deforestation from historical average levels
(1996–2005) by 2017.109 Brazil’s presentation of this plan exerted a major ef-
fect in the global discussion of REDD. China and India, having gone through
a cycle of deforestation and having commenced reforestation, pressed to ex-
pand the concept of REDD to include forest management, and so the proposal
evolved into REDD+. At the contentious Copenhagen Climate Conference in
2009, REDD made as much proress as, if not more than, any other single issue.
And although disagreements remain over whether REDD should be applied
exclusively at national levels or at subnational levels as well, the climate talks
at Cancún, Mexico, in 2010 resolved most outstanding issues in terms of broad
principles for the operation of REDD+, including such safeguards as explicit
recognition of the UN Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous Peoples.
What Does the Future Look Like for REDD+?
As nations build on the framework of REDD+ and associated principles and
develop the “robust and transparent� national forest-monitoring systems and
rules “for measuring, reporting and verifying anthropogenic forest-related
emissions� called for under the Cancún agreements,110 they will try to reach
108 Colin W. Clark, The Worldwide Crisis in Fisheries: Economic Models and Human Behavior
(Cambridge U. Press 2006).
109 Government of Brazil, Interministerial Committee on Climate Change, Decree No. 6263 of
November 21, 2007, available at .
110 See Kintisch & Regalado, supra note 86.
Rethinking Approaches to Forest Governance 319
agreement on approaches to formulating national baselines from which
to credit REDD+ and to develop frameworks for the distribution of carbon
market bene�ts, including approaches to compensating high-forest, low-
deforestation countries for protecting forest stocks (an activity that yields no
emission reductions and therefore is not susceptible to compensation directly
in carbon markets).111 Some nations have also proposed that they negotiate
provisions to ensure that REDD+ delivers biodiversity and social bene�ts
along with carbon bene�ts.112
REDD’s original proponents anticipated its adoption as a freestanding pro-
tocol under the UNFCCC or a set of decisions under the Kyoto Protocol.113 Ef-
forts to implement such mechanisms are still going on; however, it may not be
possible to reach agreement on a legally binding path forward under UNFCCC
or Kyoto auspices before December 31, 2012, when the current Kyoto Protocol
commitments expire. Certainly the failure of the United States to enact climate
legislation has compounded the dif�culty of reaching multilateral agreement
in the near future. Consequently, it seems increasingly likely that there will be
an interim period in which national, regional, state, and provincial carbon mar-
kets, operating separately but linked by the fungibility of carbon, play a princi-
pal role in addressing both climate change mitigation and forest governance.
This decentralized approach to carbon markets offers substantial oppor-
tunity for creativity and learning by doing, particularly with regard to bring-
ing REDD+ into carbon markets, but it also entails substantial risks. Carbon
markets that adopt weak criteria for the inclusion of REDD+ risk undermining
the effectiveness of global efforts to combat climate change and entrenching
constituencies in favor of those weak rules. Markets that adopt overly strin-
gent criteria for the inclusion of REDD+ risk choking off the best near-term op-
portunity to obtain rapid, cost-effective, global-scale reductions in greenhouse
gas emissions and improvements in forest governance. Bringing REDD+ into
national, subnational, and regional emissions trading systems via programs
that hew closely to the core elements needed for effective, high-integrity, link-
able carbon markets114 offers the best prospects for near-term climate mitiga-
tion that values and saves the world’s remaining great forests and compen-
sates the communities that depend on them.
111 Andre Cattaneo, Incentives to Reduce Emissions from Deforestation: A Stock-Flow Approach with
Target Reductions, in Deforestation and Climate Change: Reducing Carbon Emissions from Defor-
estation and Forest Degradation 93 (Valentina Bosetti & Ruben Lubowski ed., Edward Elgar
2010).
112 See, for example, Michael Obersteiner et al., Towards a Sound REDD: Ensuing Globally Consis-
tent Reference Scenarios and Safeguarding Sustainability Co-bene�ts, in Deforestation and Climate
Change: Reducing Carbon Emissions from Deforestation and Forest Degradation 121 (Valentina
Bosetti & Ruben Lubowski ed., Edward Elgar 2010); and Long, supra note 16 (proposal to
require nonstate actor certi�cation of sustainability of REDD forest carbon).
113 Submission by the Governments of Papua New Guinea and Costa Rica, supra note 93, at 8.
114 See, for example, Annie Petsonk, “Docking Stations�: Designing a More Open Legal and Policy
Architecture for a Post-2012 Framework to Combat Climate Change, 19 Duke J. of Intl. & Comp.
L. 433 (2009).
320 The World Bank Legal Review
IFIs can play a helping role, but they must tread lightly and cautiously in
order to facilitate, rather than frustrate, the process. The World Bank’s Forest
Carbon Partnership Facility115 has made an important start in this regard, but
some critics think it has tried to do too much too fast. Moving forward, IFI
efforts to assist nations with building capacity for REDD and REDD+ must
be coordinated with broader IFI efforts to assist nations with carbon market
readiness.
115 Benoit Bosquet, Stefano Pagiola, & André Aquino, Preparing for REDD: The Forest Carbon
Partnership Facility, in Deforestation and Climate Change: Reducing Carbon Emissions from De-
forestation and Forest Degradation 71 (Valentina Bosetti & Ruben Lubowski ed., Edward Elgar
2010).
PART III
INTERNATIONAL FINANCE AND THE
CHALLENGES OF
REGULATORY GOVERNANCE
Networks In(-)Action?
The Transgovernmental Origins of, and
Responses to, the Financial Crisis
CHRIS BRUMMER
Most accounts seeking to examine the causes of the global �nancial crisis
identify the culprit as the weak regulatory supervision in the United States.
Certainly, the international �nancial crisis started on American shores, and
its origins have been partially located in weak regulatory oversight and lax
monetary policy: U.S. �nancial authorities substantially lowered interest rates
to stimulate the economy following the collapse of the tech bubble and, inad-
vertently or otherwise, gave rise to speculative real estate lending practices for
subprime borrowers. Mortgage and other types of loans were then bundled
together before being sliced and diced to be sold off to �nancial institutions. In
turn, these institutions restructured and engineered the risk inherent in these
loans through an alphabet soup of complex �nancial instruments known as
collateralized debt obligations or credit default swaps, bought and sold in
largely unregulated over-the-counter markets. Other oversight mechanisms,
such as those provided by credit rating agencies, also were lax. Burdened by
powerful conflicts of interest and a privileged position in the market for their
services, agencies provided scant scrutiny of the risks residing in the real es-
tate on which the �nancial edi�ce had been constructed.
Yet U.S. rules and regulations were not the only ones that failed to predict
the onset and spread of this crisis and subsequently to counter its ill effects.
As this chapter discusses, a variety of international codes and standards were
on the books and widely disseminated by international standard-setting bod-
ies and transgovernmental networks of �nancial authorities, yet these were
unable to foresee or prevent the crisis. As a result, the �nancial crisis seeped
into the slipstream of the entire global economy. Following the crisis and in
recognition of oversight failures, a considerable collection of international
agenda- and standard-setting organizations were developed and the interna-
tional regulatory community proceeded to set out various initiatives at break-
neck speed to �ll some of the prudential and supervisory gaps at not only
national but international levels of regulatory cooperation and governance.
This chapter reviews some key international efforts launched to regulate
global systemic risk. It �rst surveys the global regulatory architecture just
prior to the crisis and the international approaches in place geared toward
mitigating and addressing systemic risk. Despite a growing and evolving set of
international �nancial standards, major lacunae pervaded transnational leg-
islative initiatives touching sectors as diverse as banking, payment systems,
323
324 The World Bank Legal Review
accounting, and executive compensation. The chapter then highlights key co-
ordination efforts undertaken by regulators in the wake of the crisis. Finally, it
briefly outlines some criticisms of the evolving regulatory system and draws les-
sons for international �nancial law as a tool for combating global systemic risk.
Creating the Network: The First Steps of
Global Financial Regulation
Perhaps the most important means of regulating credit risk in the decade lead-
ing up to 2008 was through the regulation of “capital� held by systemically
important �nancial institutions, most importantly, banks. Capital represents,
from a legal standpoint, “the portion of a bank’s assets that have no associ-
ated contractual commitment for repayment.�1 It constitutes a cash (or liquid)
cushion against which a bank can draw if its lending or investment decisions
turn out poorly. Capital can thus provide a gauge to determine the prospective
safety and soundness of a �nancial institution.
The �rst international accord geared toward regulating capital was
devised in 1988 by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision. Under the
accord (widely referred to as “Basel I�), banks were required to meet two capi-
tal adequacy requirements, expressed in practice as meeting two ratios that
measure the capital on a bank’s books against the bank’s risk-weighted as-
sets. Although it was an important step forward in providing the �rst global
standards for bank supervision, Basel I generated a variety of problems that
became apparent as it was implemented. Most important, the risk-weighting
system was somewhat arbitrary and failed to distinguish risks among credi-
tors belonging to the same risk category. For example, because all commercial
loans were weighted at 100 percent, a bank could earn greater returns by lend-
ing to a less-than-creditworthy corporation than to an established company
with a better credit history.2
“Basel II,� launched in 2004 and only partially implemented by banks by
the time the crisis struck, spoke to these problems in part by adopting two
broad methodologies—a standardized and an internal risk-based approach—
to provide more tailored risk assessments. Under the standard approach, bank
asset risk was determined by the rating assigned to the borrower or issuer in
question. That is, where a borrower had a credit rating from a recognized rat-
ing agency (for example, Moody’s or Standard & Poor’s), the lending bank
could use that rating as a basis of calculating the risk associated with that
borrower. The higher the credit rating of the borrower, the lower the capital
charges associated with the bank’s assets.
1 Douglas J. Elliott, Basel III, the Banks and the Economy 3 (Brookings Inst. 2010), available
at .
2 Daniel K. Tarullo, Administrative Accountability and International Regulatory Networks 23
(Nov. 4, 2008) (on �le with author).
Networks In(-)Action? 325
Critically, Basel II allowed the biggest international banks to use their own
internal risk calculations as a basis for calculating capital charges under vari-
ous iterations of the “internal ratings-based approach.� In light of this, banks
were allowed to develop their own empirical models, which were subject to
regulatory approval, to measure and account for the credit risk on their books
and to ensure that there was suf�cient provision to protect against default by
customers and clients of the bank.
In addition to regulating bank capital, international standards and codes
sought to shore up the market infrastructure used by �nancial institutions in
their transactional dealings with each other. Payment and settlement systems
operated as the transmission channels for the transfer of cash and securities
between �nancial market participants. The safety and soundness of market
infrastructure mechanisms were thus seen as critical to assuring safety and
soundness across the market. By 2001, the Committee on Payment and Settle-
ment Systems (CPSS) had offered ten general principles setting out consensus
on best practice for the operation of sound �nancial systems, as well as the
role central banks should play in supervising systemically important institu-
tions. The CPSS and the International Organization of Securities Commissions
jointly developed a set of conceptual recommendations for securities settle-
ment systems and clearinghouses.
In addition to international efforts aimed at regulating the conduct of in-
ternational market participants, efforts were also geared toward helping in-
vestors better understand the �nancial health and stability of �nancial �rms.
Under fair value accounting methods adopted under U.S. generally accepted
accounting principles and international �nancial reporting standards (IFRS),
the assets of all companies, including �nancial institutions, are generally ac-
counted for and priced in light of their current market value. In doing so, fair
value differs substantially from approaches that focused on historic costs of
assets, enabling �rms to create hidden reserves on their balance sheets.
Network Shortcomings: International Standards
and Codes Miss Their Mark
Despite the existence of standards and codes, just a few of which are discussed
here, the international regulatory system failed to predict the onset of the cri-
sis and stop its quick progression through the global �nancial system. As the
dust has settled, a number of critical areas have been noted where coverage
was either incomplete or nonexistent. A few examples are noted below.
Few international standards in place in 2008 addressed the web of �nan-
cial institutions such as hedge funds, investment banks, and securities �rms
that grew during the previous decades to become central sources of credit
in ways that rivaled and even eclipsed traditional deposit-taking institutions
(that is, traditional “banks�). The Basel Agreements had limited implications
for the shadow banking industry because such institutions were not deposit-
taking banks as traditionally understood and de�ned by existing regulations.
326 The World Bank Legal Review
This meant that in practice, national authorities could choose the extent to
which the accords would apply to their local �nancial institutions—an out-
come that led to varying regulatory approaches.
Not only did shadow banking largely escape the attention of the interna-
tional regulatory community; so did the activities in which shadow banks par-
ticipated. This was particularly the case with derivatives instruments such as
credit default swaps and other types of esoteric credit derivative instruments,
which allowed credit risk to be hedged and transacted off balance sheets, free-
ing �nancial institutions to take on more and greater risks in the expectation
that these too could be engineered and sold into the �nancial markets.3 The
vast webs of transactions involving such instruments made locations of risk
dif�cult to identify. When the web came undone, most vividly after the col-
lapse of Lehman Brothers in 2008, the dissolution included institutions, such
as AIG, that had taken substantial positions in the credit derivative market.
No international best practice standards had been developed to address such
instruments or the infrastructure supporting derivatives trading. As a result,
derivatives such as credit default swaps were commonly traded off exchanges
in most countries and escaped registration and disclosure obligations that
would ordinarily apply in the case of most securities transactions.4
Fair value accounting, meanwhile, was not without its trade-offs and
risks. Of perhaps greatest importance is procyclicality. Fair value accounting
allows institutions to record excessively high values for their assets, such as
derivatives contracts and mortgage-backed securities. High asset valuations
in turn feed high recorded pro�ts on investments, inflate bonuses for �nancial
services executives, and lead to more irrational exuberance in a self-enforcing
cycle.5 When market cycles turn and markets crash, procyclicality can (and
did) fuel irrational despair. Falling prices often activate margin calls by banks
seeking to limit their own exposures to borrowers and in the process contrib-
ute to a downward spiral in market prices as securities are sold off into the
market.6
The international community had failed to devise global rules to prevent
institutions from becoming too large or too interconnected to fail. This gap
was all the more notable given the proliferation of large universal banks and
3 Credit default swaps operate much like insurance contracts, whereby the credit risk of an
obligation can be reduced by entering into an agreement with a counterparty, requiring that
counterparty to pay for losses arising if there is a default on the obligation. In return for
regular payments, the counterparty thus agrees to protect the obligation holder from losses
arising if this obligation goes into default.
4 Michael Greenberger, University of Maryland School of Law, statement, The Role of Deriva-
tives in the Financial Crisis: Hearing before the Fin. Crisis Inquiry Comm’n (2010), available at
.
5 Adair Turner, The Turner Review: A Regulatory Response to the Global Banking Crisis 65 (Fin.
Serv. Auth. 2009), available at .
6 Andreas Nölke, The Politics of Accounting Regulation: Responses to Subprime Crisis, in Global
Finance in Crisis: The Politics of International Regulatory Change 43 (Eric Helleiner et al. ed.,
Routledge 2010).
Networks In(-)Action? 327
the well-known collapse in the 1990s of the Bank of Credit and Commerce
International, an event that writ large the regulatory challenges of winding
down large and complex �nancial institutions. The absence of global rules
on “too big to fail� as well as cross-border resolution meant that, in a global-
ized world, institutions were capable of reaching a size and breadth of ac-
tivities that few regulators could have predicted a decade before, and whose
failure could give rise to international contagion and deep uncertainty regard-
ing how assets could and should be located and distributed upon insolvency.
The 30 largest institutions around the world are deeply international, with
53 percent of their assets abroad, and have on average 1,000 subsidiaries, of
which 68 percent operate abroad and 12 percent in offshore �nancial centers.
By 2008, a number of international banks and �nancial institutions operated
across the globe, including in developing countries, where their services pro-
vided key channels for local persons and businesses to access �nance. The ab-
sence of international standards and codes on the regulation of bank size and
cross-border resolution carries particular salience for regulators in developing
countries, which may be especially vulnerable to �nancial services providers
failing and repatriating their assets to their home-state jurisdictions.
Finally, oversight and surveillance of international �nancial standards
were far from robust leading up to the 2008 �nancial crisis. Central to the
global surveillance system administered by the International Monetary Fund
(IMF) and the World Bank is the Financial Sector Assessment Program (FSAP).
Under FSAP, the World Bank and the IMF assess a country’s implementation
of key �nancial standards deemed necessary for a stable �nancial system.
However, FSAP suffered from a variety of weaknesses. Only those countries
that were recipients of loans from the World Bank and the IMF were formally
required to participate in the program. Thus, most countries, including the
United States, never underwent surveillance of any sort. And when countries
did participate, the data provided to international institutions was largely self-
reported by national authorities—and depended on information provided by
regulated �nancial entities that were themselves subject to little supervisory
oversight.7 The information gained by surveillance was published only with
the permission of the inspected country; the monitored country thus had dis-
cretion as to whether information regarding its compliance could be shared
with other regulators or market participants.
Networks in Action: Responses by the International
Regulatory Community
In the wake of the �nancial crisis, many countries, including the United States,
were spurred to reform their domestic regulatory systems as well as the inter-
national regulatory system. Taking the lead in coordinating at the global level
7 World Bank, Financial and Private Sector Development—Financial Sector Assessment Program,
available at .
328 The World Bank Legal Review
was the Group of 20 (G20), which assumed from the Group of Seven (G7) the
role as the leading agenda setter for international �nance. In the organiza-
tion’s �rst leaders’ summit, in Washington, DC, in 2008, heads of state tasked
�nance ministers with enhancing global �nancial regulation and promoting
the integrity and stability of international �nancial markets. To carry out the
mandate, working groups were established to make recommendations in ar-
eas as diverse as accounting and disclosure and prudential oversight while de-
veloping recommendations to dampen cyclical forces in the �nancial system.
The Washington Summit’s declaration contained a detailed action plan based
in part on the principle that all �nancial markets, products, and participants—
including shadow banking institutions—must be subject to prudential regu-
lation. In London in 2009, the G20 published a Leaders Statement that went
a step forward by committing to do whatever was necessary to strengthen
global �nancial supervision and regulation. Participant countries laid out a
framework for improving prudential regulation that included tackling a range
of issues inadequately addressed in the previous regulatory order, such as
hedge funds, credit derivatives, and executive compensation. The work in the
wake of these two summits continued in Pittsburgh (2009) and Seoul (2010),
and covered not only �nancial regulatory matters but also trade, currency,
and monetary affairs. This section presents a general overview of some key
�nancial market initiatives following the panic of 2008.
As the centerpiece of initial international regulatory efforts, broader
wholesale reforms of capital ratios for banking regulatory purposes were in-
troduced. First, the methodology for determining risk weightings of trading
assets was tightened and made stricter.8 Under the 2010 “Basel III� process,
regulators shifted the focus of their gaze from the issue of risk weighting (the
denominator in the ratio) to the capital requirements themselves (the numera-
tor in the ratio), and then to the ratio itself. Under Basel III, banks are required
to hold three times as much capital on reserve as compared with before the cri-
sis, an effort to move banks toward making more risk-averse decisions and to
force them to maintain a larger cushion of safety against sudden and longer-
term losses. In addition, Basel III requires banks to hold more tier I capital, that
is, better-quality capital, such as common equity. (Basel III raises the amount
of common equity that must be held to 7 percent of assets from 2 percent by
2015.) In addition, banks are subject to an additional “conservation buffer� of
2.5 percent in times of strong economic growth, meaning in effect that a bank
will need 7 percent common equity, 8.5 percent tier 1 capital, and 10.5 per-
cent tier 2 capital to meet its capital requirements; if a bank cannot meet this
threshold, it will not be able to pay dividends. Finally, a countercyclical capital
buffer can be applied by regulators, requiring that banks hold more capital in
times of growth as a check against procyclicality. Such a buffer is expected to
be enforced up to the maximum of 2.5 percent.9
8 Elliott, supra note 1.
9 Felix Salmon, Reuters: Felix Salmon Blog, Basel III Arrives, (Sept. 12, 2010).
Networks In(-)Action? 329
The Basel Committee introduced several new capital ratios alongside
risk-weighted prudential requirements in order to enhance the stability of the
global �nancial system. Banks must now satisfy a leverage ratio measuring
tier I capital against total risk adjusted assets. The leverage ratio sets a back-
stop on the amount of debt that a bank can take on. Two additional liquidity
coverage ratios were introduced, mandating that �nancial institutions main-
tain an “adequate level of assets that can be converted into cash to meet its
liquidity needs� for short (30 calendar days) and long-term (up to a year) time
horizons under a severe liquidity stress scenario speci�ed by national banking
supervisors.10
The international regulatory community also moved to better supervise
institutions that in the past had often escaped scrutiny from banking regula-
tors. In October 2010, the Financial Stability Board (FSB), an agenda-setting
body launched from the Financial Stability Forum in the wake of the crisis,
issued its report Intensity and Effectiveness of SIFI Supervision. The report rec-
ommends that all “systemically important �nancial institutions� be subject to
capital charges even more exacting than those spelled out in Basel III. The FSB
also announced that it would “develop criteria for assessing which institu-
tions pose global systemic risk� in order to help ensure consistent implemen-
tation throughout the jurisdictions of its members.11 As part of its work, the
international community, in this case acting mainly under the auspices of the
International Organization of Securities Commissions (IOSCO), has sought
to create standards for the regulation of players formerly operating in the
shadow banking system, notably hedge funds, that had in the run-up to the
crisis largely escaped oversight.12
In May 2010, and in response to G20 agenda items calling for the stan-
dardization and trading of derivatives instruments, the CPSS and IOSCO
published the report Guidance on the Application of the 2004 CPSS-IOSCO Rec-
ommendations for Central Counterparties to OTC Derivatives CCPs to promote
consistent applications of existing standards so as to better address risks asso-
ciated with clearing over-the-counter derivatives and bolster the effectiveness
of central counterparties as risk-mitigating devices.13 The CPSS and IOSCO
also published Considerations for Trade Repositories in OTC Derivatives Markets,
which lays out factors that trade repositories should consider in designing
10 Daniel Pruzin, Basel Panel Issues Final Basel III Package; Version Contains New Liquidity Rule
Details, Intl. Bus. & Fin. Daily Online (BNA) (Dec. 17, 2010).
11 Fin. Stability Bd., Progress since the Washington Summit in the Implementation of the G20
Recommendations for Strengthening Financial Stability 8 (2010), available at (hereinafter, 2010 Financial
Stability Report).
12 Technical Comm., IOSCO, Hedge Funds Oversight (2009), available at .
13 Comm. on Payment and Settlement Sys. & Technical Comm. of the Int’l Org. of Securities
Comm’ns, Guidance on the Application of the 2004 CPSS-IOSCO Recommendations for Central
Counterparties to OTC Derivatives CCPs (2010), available at .
330 The World Bank Legal Review
and operating their services and relevant authorities should consider in regu-
lating and overseeing trade repositories.14
Various efforts at improving transparency have been introduced for ac-
counting standards. In 2009, the International Accounting Standards Board
promulgated a new standard, IFRS 9, as part of the �rst phase of account-
ing reforms. IFRS 9 addresses the classi�cation and measurement of �nan-
cial assets; the second and third phases will address impairment and hedge
accounting, respectively. The major advantage of IFRS is its simplicity and
effectiveness at measuring �nancial instruments. IAS 39, the older account-
ing regime, categorized all assets according to four different asset categories.
IFRS 9 requires all �nancial assets to be measured at either “amortized cost�
or “fair value� after considering the business model of the entity for managing
the �nancial asset and the contractual cash flow characteristics of the �nancial
asset.15 Amortized cost is less sensitive to market conditions than fair value,
which can fluctuate based on market movements and can potentially depress
the value of assets on the books in a depressed market.
At the level of surveillance, the IMF has approved making �nancial stabil-
ity assessments a regular and mandatory part of its surveillance for members
that host systemically important �nancial sectors. Previously, participation in
an FSAP was voluntary for all IMF members. Now, however, FSAPs are man-
datory for all countries determined to have systemically important �nancial
sectors. Twenty-�ve jurisdictions were identi�ed by the IMF in 2010 as hav-
ing systemically important �nancial sectors, according to a methodology that
evaluates both the size and the interconnectedness of each country’s �nancial
sector: Australia; Austria; Belgium; Brazil; Canada; China; France; Germany;
Hong Kong SAR, China; Italy; Japan; India; Ireland; Luxembourg; Mexico;
the Netherlands; the Republic of Korea; Russia; Singapore; Spain; Sweden;
Switzerland; Turkey; the United Kingdom; and the United States.16 Nearly 90
percent of the global �nancial system is represented by this group, as well as
80 percent of global economic activity.17 It also includes 15 of the G20 member
countries and more than half of the membership of the FSB. Each country will
have to undertake an FSAP assessment every �ve years, and all can volunteer
for more frequent surveillance. The methodology will be reviewed periodi-
cally to make sure it continues to include countries that are systemically im-
portant to the global �nancial system. Finally, peer reviews were launched
by institutions such as the FSB to assist in evaluating the implementation or
achievement of international regulatory objectives.
14 2010 Financial Stability Report, supra note 11, at 13.
15 PricewaterhouseCoopers, Signi�cant Changes to the Classi�cation and Measurement of Financial
Assets: IFRS 9 Financial Instruments (Feb. 23, 2010), available at .
16 Id.
17 Id.
Networks In(-)Action? 331
New Networks Deconstructed: Criticisms Thus Far
As is clear from the analysis above, in the years immediately following the
�nancial crisis, the international regulatory community can boast a staggering
range of advances and achievements that strengthened the �nancial system
more than most people, including many experts, realize.
It is worth noting, however, that like most regulatory reforms, global ef-
forts are not without flaws. In my book Soft Law and the Global Financial System:
Rule Making in the 21st Century, I elaborate potential progress and shortcom-
ings in more depth; for the purposes of this chapter, I will outline three general
complaints. Perhaps most important, various commentators have criticized
the scope of the reforms. Although capital requirements have increased for
certain derivatives-related trading, there are still no internationally recog-
nized best practices with regard to disclosure requirements for derivatives
instruments or under what conditions they should be registered and what in-
stitutions should be permitted to deal in them. Similarly, although regulation
for particular regulatory matters and participants has improved, a variety of
institutions, in particular hedge funds and private equity funds, have escaped
scrutiny and international regulatory efforts. As such, risky transactions will
potentially move from regulated sectors of the economy such as banking to
less or unregulated sectors of the �nancial economy. Even where international
standards have been developed, compliance with many of these standards
remains beyond the scope of monitoring activities practiced by international
�nancial institutions such as the World Bank and the IMF, as well as by market
participants.
Other criticisms have focused on the belief that the rules emerging from
international coordination efforts are not suf�ciently strict. Some studies have
suggested, for example, that the socially optimal amount of capital that banks
should hold may be in excess of Basel III standards. Complicating matters
further, these standards are not required to be implemented formally until
2019. In the interim, regulators permit compliance with Basel II’s lower capital
requirements, thus giving time for distressed �nancial institutions to improve
their balance sheets or to game laxer requirements before they have to switch
to the new regime. As many critics have argued, by 2019, the world may have
experienced more �nancial crises, and measures responding to these crises
may counteract Basel III’s effectiveness in practice.
Finally, although the efforts mark important advances in initiating better
regulatory cooperation, these efforts remain super�cial in many sectors. Most
commentators agree, for example, that the architecture for cross-border regu-
latory cooperation remains inadequate to deal with another �nancial crisis.
The Basel Committee’s work has identi�ed the need for greater coordination
in light of the failures of the crisis and calls on authorities to develop a frame-
work for greater cooperation. Similarly, although the FSB initiatives have
made important headway in developing capital standards for systemically
important institutions, and the FSB is presumably on its way to generating
standards for identifying such institutions, the FSB’s work thus far provides
332 The World Bank Legal Review
no details on how such communication and cooperation should take place. A
challenge is the difference and variety of global �nancial institutions with re-
gard to their structures and activities and, by extension, the nature and degree
of the risks they pose to the global �nancial system. Furthermore, many regu-
lators do not have even the basic mandates or independence required to shut
down distressed institutions that pose imminent systemic dangers, much less
cooperate internationally, and as a result, collaboration will likely take years
to implement.18 Much of the remit is instead enjoyed by judges, who, unlike
regulators, are unaccustomed to international coordination of their work. As a
result, bankruptcy of a large �nancial institution would still cause many of the
same dislocations and chaos as experienced in prior crises.
None of the issues addressed above poses insurmountable obstacles to
success, and two to three years of regulatory effort in this regard is too short
a time to formulate a de�nitive statement of failure. These are dif�cult and
charged issues, often evidencing considerable domestic policy priorities, risk
and cost allocations, and national interests. Challenges with few obvious solu-
tions take time to resolve. The complexity of the process is further embedded
in the dynamics and obstacles that inform most cross-border regulatory ef-
forts, for example, in relation to international coordination between domestic
agencies and tensions that may arise owing to domestic politics and interest.
First, at a fundamental level, �nancial authorities and stakeholders may be
at odds regarding the role that the state should play in overseeing the market.
For example, on the issue of executive compensation, prior to the 2009 G20
meeting in Pittsburgh, some national leaders, and with special vigor President
Nicholas Sarkozy of France, called for international limits on the amount of
pay a banker could earn. However, the notion of government-dictated com-
pensation is anathema to U.S. conceptions of free market capitalism, and the
U.S. government resisted any regulation of banker pay. Because of this deep
difference in philosophy and competitive considerations, the international
community opted for a compromise focusing not so much on pay but on the
determination of pay and the alignment of incentives between executives and
their �rms.
Second, competitive considerations continue to inform virtually every el-
ement of regulatory decision making, even in the wake of the �nancial crisis.
For example, the Volcker rule, which is part of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street
Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (H.R. 4173), bars banks from
dealing on their own account in speculative derivatives and (mortgage-
backed) securities and in investing more than 3 percent of their capital in
hedge funds and private equity. The Volcker rule was introduced as part of
more extensive U.S. efforts to address the too-big-to-fail problem. However, it
gained little traction among EU countries, including the United Kingdom, for
reasons beyond differences in regulatory philosophies: European banks have
historically adhered closely to a universal banking model that has allowed
18 2010 Financial Stability Report, supra note 11.
Networks In(-)Action? 333
them to undertake a number of banking as well as investment banking activi-
ties and to thus compete �ercely with markets that constrain the activities of
banks. By contrast, the United States, since the Great Depression, under the
auspices of the Glass-Steagall Act, maintained regulatory walls between bank-
ing and investment banking, restrictions that were dismantled in 1999 owing
to the pressures of competition on U.S. institutions from European �rms. If
adopted in Europe, the Volcker rule would force many highly pro�table Euro-
pean banks to change their historical business model fundamentally. For U.S.
banks, adjustment costs, although signi�cant, are likely familiar and arguably
less onerous overall.
Third, the perceived sovereignty costs accompanying stricter or more
robust standards and institutional mechanisms can limit international coor-
dination. International rules often undermine the ability of a government to
act in the best interest of its local economy. Many countries have shied away
from cross-border resolution and bankruptcy cooperation because binding
rules on the matter could impair the ability of local institutions to determine
when �nancial institutions are insolvent, as well as how the institutions are re-
structured or liquidated. Regulators could face considerable complexities and
challenges in making determinations of when and how distressed �nancial
institutions should be recognized as being insolvent. This particular challenge
can be especially costly for countries where a distressed bank is a systemically
important institution that serves as a primary source of capital. International
rules could also diminish prospects for courts to decide on the best method
for the disposition of assets to most optimally bene�t local economic interests
and protect local creditors.
International surveillance and monitoring of countries’ compliance with
best practices likewise generate considerable sovereignty costs. International
standards exhibit their most powerful compliance pull when they are acknowl-
edged by the market as being important and when both regulators and mar-
kets can evaluate a jurisdiction’s compliance with them. Where surveillance
is strong and information about lack of compliance with standards is shared
with the market, �rms in noncompliant countries may experience higher costs
of capital, and governmental authorities may suffer reputational costs in the
international community. As a result, many regulators from both developed
and developing countries resisted efforts in 1999 to make the FSAP a formal
requirement of membership in the IMF or to impose obligations on all coun-
tries to adhere to the standards. Countries did not wish to become subject to
oversight where the quality of the regulatory oversight could be scrutinized
both by the market and by the international community, and where their na-
tional constituents could face the economic costs associated with perceptions
of higher risk. The 2008 crisis changed the calculation of many countries, espe-
cially as the economic costs of poor �nancial supervision became increasingly
evident. That said, although the G20 has committed to participation, not every
IMF member has, and the IMF has not taken every step possible to heighten
market discipline and transparency with regard to compliance with interna-
tional standards and leveraging market discipline.
334 The World Bank Legal Review
Concluding Thoughts
The transgovernmental origins of the crisis shed light on the international
regulatory community. Standards in place at the time of the crisis did little
to prevent the crisis and, because of their weaknesses, channeled its interna-
tionally contagious reach. Efforts since the crisis have fallen short of ensuring
that these shortcomings are fully addressed. That said, a number of critical
advances and achievements have been made in the global regulation of sys-
temic risk that, when fully implemented, will signi�cantly improve the inter-
national �nancial system.
Some of the success stems from the fact that “systemic� risks are viewed
or experienced as broadly shared.19 And when actors internalize the costs of �-
nancial instability or decline, cooperation becomes much easier. Furthermore,
unlike many other species of international economic law, agreements concern-
ing international �nancial market regulation are not undergirded by treaties
and are technically nonbinding. Thus, reneging on international regulatory
commitments entails fewer legal consequences, which may induce some par-
ties to come to the negotiating table—even though in some instances stan-
dards may be backed by a variety of disciplinary mechanisms. In contrast to
hard law instruments that require domestic political processes and rati�cation
procedures, international �nancial law can be operationalized largely through
domestic administrative agencies.
The changes in international standards implemented since 2008 demon-
strate that even when a strong demand for cross-border regulation arises, in-
ternational �nancial law is no panacea, even with the conditions that make
agreement possible and the qualitative features that can give it advantages
in the coordination process. Standard setting is an arduous process that can
be fraught by misaligned and antagonistic interests between national super-
visory agencies and regulators. Therefore, agreement between �nancial au-
thorities is not guaranteed, even when rules are not legally binding. Especially
when issues could carry steep distributive and asymmetric consequences for
interested parties by disadvantaging local market participants or binding the
flexibility of governments to tailor solutions according to their policy prefer-
ences, gaps may persist throughout the regulatory architecture.
19 See, for example, Christopher Brummer, How International Financial Law Works (and How It
Doesn’t), 99 Geo. L.J. 257, 322 (2011) (noting the implications of making the surveillance of
international rules more robust); Christopher Brummer, Why Soft Law Dominates Finance—
and Not Trade, 13 J. Intl. Econ. L. 623 (2010) (same).
Mitigating the Impact of Financial Crises
on the Brazilian Capital Market
ALEXANDRE PINHEIRO DOS SANTOS*
Introduction
The recent international �nancial crisis highlighted the importance of continu-
ing cooperation and exchange of information between all regulators of �nan-
cial or capital markets and the need for supervision of the �nancial system
as a whole from the perspective of �nancial stability. The crisis also showed
that non�nancial institutions can be equally relevant from the standpoint of
systemic risk. A yet more far-reaching revelation was that markets and prod-
ucts can affect market stability and, therefore, should be supervised from that
perspective.
In this sense, one of the challenges for regulators around the world is the
abandonment of old ideas, such as notions that regulation stifles innovation;
that self-regulation should prevail over state regulation; that investors and
markets behave rationally; that quali�ed investors are always able to evalu-
ate the products they acquire; that products and services for quali�ed inves-
tors do not need regulation and supervision; and that only the public markets
should be strictly regulated.
The main objective of this chapter is to present an overview of the situa-
tion of Brazil in the recent �nancial crisis and the current conditions of the Bra-
zilian capital market. The chapter spotlights the role of the Brazilian Securities
Commission (Comissão de Valores Mobiliários, CVM), a federal agency estab-
lished by Law 6385 of December 7, 1976.1 CVM is headed by a chair and four
commissioners, all of whom are appointed by the Brazilian president from
among persons of good reputation and recognized competence in the �eld of
capital markets. All board members must undergo a public hearing before the
Senate; once con�rmed, they serve for �ve years.
CVM’s mandate is to regulate, supervise, oversee, and promote the secu-
rities market. In its institutional role, CVM ensures the regular and ef�cient
operation of capital markets. In performing this mandate, CVM also develops
a regulatory function in which it must observe not only national laws but also
international standards of conduct, especially when it comes to the �eld of
∗
This chapter is based on the author’s participation in the panel Mitigating the Impact of Fi-
nancial Crises on Emerging Markets and Transition Economies, which was part of the event
Law, Justice, and Development Week 2010, conducted by the World Bank in November 2010.
This chapter represents the views of the author and not necessarily of the Brazilian Securities
Commission (CVM).
1 The statute is available at (in
Portuguese). 335
336 The World Bank Legal Review
capital markets as part of an increasingly globalized and interconnected �-
nancial system. Brazil actively participates in the Group of Twenty (G20), the
Financial Stability Board (FSB), and the International Organization of Securi-
ties Commissions (IOSCO),2 and adheres closely to the policies pursued by
such bodies. CVM, faithfully observing the constitutionally sheltered tenets
of market economics,3 pursues an ef�cient securities market, which needs to
be free, competitive, informed, and reliable. Such qualities depend on the ade-
quate protection and harmonization of the interests of all players in the global
�nancial system.
The basic principle that informs the actions of CVM is full and fair dis-
closure. The agency is inspired by the example of the U.S. Securities and Ex-
change Commission (SEC).
The regulatory system of the Brazilian capital market is essentially a rules-
based system. However, CVM seeks to permanently encourage and make ap-
propriate use of a system of self-regulation in Brazil,4 a system that is both
mandatory5 and voluntary and that extends to the enforcement of market
rules.6 This support for self-regulation, however, does not prevent CVM from
adopting an effective risk-based supervision system, whose inspiration in-
cludes the experience of the Financial Services Authority (FSA).7 CVM usually
conducts public hearings regarding its regulatory projects to obtain sugges-
tions from market participants and other interested parties.
This standard of conduct enables CVM, despite its continued alignment
with the international consensus on matters related to capital markets (which
contributes considerably to the prevention of cross-border arbitrage), to issue
rules that address in a balanced way the transnational perspective and the
peculiarities of the country.
2 In 2011, CVM chair Maria Helena Santana was appointed chairwoman of IOSCO’s Execu-
tive Committee. Additional information regarding this subject is available at .
3 On the subject, see Article 170 of the Constitution of the Federative Republic of Brazil, avail-
able at (in
Portuguese).
4 This regulation is in line with the IOSCO Objectives and Principles of Securities Regula-
tion, which are among the FSB Key Standards for Sound Financial Systems. The IOSCO
Objectives and Principles of Securities Regulation are available at .
5 On the subject, see Article 17 of Law No. 6385, of December 7, 1976, available at (in Portuguese).
6 An example of state use of a self-regulatory role in the capital market is given in Article
49, paragraph 5, of CVM Instruction No. 461 of 2007, which provides that in relation to
penalties for violations of rules under its jurisdiction, CVM may deduct those penalties that
have already been imposed under a mandatory self-regulation. This document is available at
(in Portuguese).
7 For more information regarding this subject, see CVM Deliberation No. 521 of 2007 (as
amended), available at (in Portuguese).
Mitigating the Impact of Financial Crises 337
Brazil, like other countries with a similar level of importance in the world,
has experienced signi�cant economic development in recent years and has not
suffered severely from the effects of the recent crisis. One aim of this chapter is
to highlight a few characteristics of the Brazilian scenario that may have made
possible this relatively smooth path through the crisis and its aftermath. The
chapter also discusses some trends and regulatory measures that were taken
after the crisis to mitigate its impact and prevent further similar occurrences,
with a particular focus on the capital market.
Economy and Performance of Brazil before the Financial Crisis
In recent years, the most important economic indexes in Brazil have behaved
positively, and market participants expect that this will be the case for the
coming years. For instance, Brazil’s gross domestic product is expected to in-
crease 4.5 percent in 2011; the country’s inflation rate is under control; and the
public debt is considered comfortable.8
Strong economic foundations, alongside the remarkable improvement in
corporate governance practices adopted by publicly held companies, have
boosted trading volume, market capitalization, and the number of IPOs, all
of which have grown substantially in the past 10 years. Brazilian market capi-
talization jumped from US$225 billion in 2000 to US$1.5 trillion in 2010; the
daily average trading of shares rocketed from US$348 million to more than
US$3 billion. During the same period, the number of investors, especially in-
dividual investors, has increased markedly.
In terms of capital activities, almost all categories of products have grown
substantially in the past decade. For instance, public offerings of equities to-
taled US$ 133 billion in 2010, more than double the 2009 �gure. Even if the
public offering of Petrobras, the largest Brazilian publicly held company, is
excluded from the �gure for 2010, the results remain positive. It is instructive
to note the evolution of IPOs over the same period: at the beginning of the
2000s, there were no IPOs in Brazil; today, the Brazilian market is considered
one of the most active. The total amount of IPOs reached about US$2.1 billion
in the �rst quarter of 2011.
Collective investment vehicles such as funds and investment clubs have
become signi�cantly more popular. Investment funds have showed great di-
versity, with an emphasis on structured funds. Investment clubs have grown
impressively, enrolling a larger number of small investors. The number of in-
vestment funds almost doubled in the past decade to more than 10,000, while
the number of investment clubs grew tenfold. Today, there are more than 3,000.
The market has been an effective option for �nancing Brazilian companies.
8 Additional information regarding this subject is available at (in Portuguese).
338 The World Bank Legal Review
Several factors have allowed Brazil to recover rapidly after the recent cri-
sis, even though the crisis affected the country in terms of the lack of global
liquidity. First of all, the effects of the crisis in Brazil were short-lived. A sec-
ond factor is that, before the crisis, the Brazilian economy was probably in its
best shape in many years because of the implementation of economic reforms
and the general growth in the global economy. Moreover, the Brazilian capital
market was growing strongly without arti�cial incentives. In fact, the signi�-
cant development of the Brazilian market in recent years is due mainly to a
natural process of maturation. This is in stark contrast to what occurred in the
early days of the Brazilian capital market, when tax relief was seen as central
to the country’s economy.
A third factor is the existence of a comprehensive, high-quality regula-
tory and oversight framework, with well-de�ned responsibilities between the
Brazilian Central Bank and CVM. Basically, the Central Bank is responsible for
prudential and systemic regulation, while CVM regulates conduct in the capi-
tal market. There is strong and increasing coordination between the two regu-
lators, a development spurred by the fact that many institutions are subject to
regulation by both the Central Bank and CVM. In terms of systemic risk, for
example, the Central Bank has access to information within the capital market
that is deemed necessary at the international level.
Modern rules and regulations, such as the law that restructured the Bra-
zilian Payment System,9 have prevented the sudden appearance, growth, and
spread of risks in most segments of the Brazilian �nancial and capital mar-
ket. Further, when risk does appear, this legislation provides tools to handle
and reduce the exposure. The present Corporate Insolvency Law10 also helped
ensure stability within payment systems, because it recognizes collateral
granted by market participants and also con�rms netting agreements in case
of insolvency.
Some current recommendations of the FSB are already in place in Brazil,
thanks in large part to the conservative path followed by the Central Bank
regarding the banking system. In practical terms, a mechanism already exists
to deal with banks in distressed �nancial condition;11 the leverage is lower
than allowed in other jurisdictions; capital requirement is higher than that set
out in Basel II;12 and banks are required to consolidate the assets held through
9 Available at (in
Portuguese).
10 Available at (in
Portuguese).
11 Since 1974, a statute has been in force that subjects �nancial institutions, including credit
unions, to intervention or extrajudicial liquidation by the Central Bank (Law No. 6024, of
March 13, 1974). The grounds include losses arising from mismanagement, violation of
banking legislation, and violation by management of bylaws or statutory rules or of regula-
tions from the Central Bank and the National Monetary Council.
12 National Monetary Council (CMN) Resolution No. 2099, of August 17, 1994, and its subse-
quent amendments, established the minimum capital and net assets requirements for the
Mitigating the Impact of Financial Crises 339
offshore vehicles. Brazil supported proposals to revise the standards of inter-
national banking regulation that led to Basel III.13
Regarding the Brazilian capital market, the legal and regulatory frame-
work helped the country avoid or at least reduce some weaknesses that may
have contributed to the �nancial crisis. For example, Brazil adheres to the �-
nal bene�ciary model14 and the central counterparty solution,15 and requires
registration for almost all transactions in the capital market.16 Even so, Brazil
was affected to a limited extent by the �nancial crisis, which prompted the
country to take regulatory measures to deal with the crisis as well as to make
its system more resilient.
Regulation and Regulatory Trends in the Brazilian Capital Market
In 2008, CVM issued a rule (CVM Instruction No. 475 of 2008)17 designed to
improve the quantity and the quality of information rendered to investors
by publicly held companies regarding �nancial and derivative instruments,
including the requirement for a sensitivity analysis. Another important rule
(CVM Instruction No. 480 of 2009),18 which was adopted in 2009 and came into
force in 2010, broadened transparency requirements and improved the qual-
ity of information provided by publicly held companies. Among the require-
ments of this latter rule is the duty of the issuer to disclose its compensation
policy; its stock option programs; and the maximum, minimum, and average
compensation paid to its directors and executive of�cers. The �nancial crisis
provided notorious examples of why it is essential to clearly identify the re-
muneration given to directors and management. Indeed, an issuer’s compen-
sation policy provides valuable information about its incentives system. It is
through its compensation packages that an issuer can encourage its managers
to adopt a short-, medium-, or long-term outlook and to pursue goals set by
�nancial institutions authorized to operate in Brazil by the Central Bank. This document is
available at (in Portuguese).
13 Additional information regarding this subject is available at .
14 CVM Instruction No. 122 of 1990 provides for the identi�cation of �nal investors in trans-
actions on stock exchanges. This document is available at (in Portuguese).
15 A central counterparty is an institution that stands between operations and contracts, be-
coming the buyer for every seller and the seller for every buyer.
16 In this regard, it is worth mentioning that the Brazilian Clearing and Depository Corporation
(CBLC), the Central Securities Depository (CSD) operated by BM&FBOVESPA S.A. (Bolsa de
Valores, Mercadorias e Futuros), acts as the central counterparty in all transactions within
that institution.
17 Available at (in
Portuguese).
18 Available at (in Portuguese).
340 The World Bank Legal Review
the organization. For these reasons, and in line with the current level of inter-
national consensus on the need for a high level of transparency on pay and
incentive programs,19 CVM decided to speci�cally address the subject in In-
struction No. 480. That instruction also requires the issuers to disclose, among
other pieces of information, their corporate governance practices, their risk
management and control policies, and the main risks they face.
In 2010, CVM Instruction No. 481 of 200920 entered into force, regulating
public requests to exercise voting rights by proxy at meetings of publicly held
companies and stipulating the information such companies must provide to
shareholders before the meetings (e.g., the curriculum of candidates for po-
sitions in administration, the proposed remuneration of directors, and com-
ments on a company’s �nancial statements). Due to the increasing number of
companies with dispersed ownership in Brazil, the regulation of these issues
has grown increasingly important, especially if Brazil is to see a more ef�cient
organization of the shareholders of large corporations.
In relation to public requests for proxies, Instruction No. 481 seeks to pro-
mote the participation (particularly through the Internet) of shareholders in
decision-making processes. The instruction provides that shareholders repre-
senting more than 0.5 percent of capital may include candidates for the board
or the supervisory board in the public requests made by the administration;
companies that have an electronic system for proxy requests should allow
shareholders with more than 0.5 percent of the capital to make their requests
through this system; and companies that have not established an electronic
system must bear a portion of the costs of public requests promoted by share-
holders representing more than 0.5 percent of the capital, within certain limits.
Instruction No. 481 also requires that all materials used in public requests for
proxies, and information and documents relating to meetings, be made avail-
able to shareholders on the CVM website. This rule has signi�cantly reduced
the costs associated with the exercise of voting rights and facilitated the super-
vision of the business by shareholders.
Brazil has also tackled two other issues that are usually high on the agen-
das of regulators: OTC derivatives and collective-investment vehicles.
Most problems spawned by the recent crisis relate to markets and prod-
ucts that were previously unregulated, notably OTC derivatives, which are
negotiated and settled directly between the parties. Regulators worldwide
have been encouraged to adopt a series of measures to enhance transparency
of the OTC market and thereby permit better management of the risks its par-
ticipants encounter, and to enable closer monitoring of such markets. Some
of these measures were present in the Brazilian market even before the crisis
occurred.
19 On the topic, see, for example, G20 Leaders’ Statement at Pittsburgh Summit, available at
.
20 Available at (in
Portuguese).
Mitigating the Impact of Financial Crises 341
The vast majority of derivative instruments in Brazil are currently traded
on the stock market, as opposed to the scenario commonly found in other
economies, where many derivative instruments are traded in the OTC mar-
ket. Moreover, even the transactions in Brazil’s organized OTC market are
subject to a registration procedure,21 and �nancial institutions, which are nor-
mally the counterparties in this kind of transaction, are required to carry out
these sorts of transactions only in organized markets.22 Brazil also has rules
for the approval of standards for derivative contracts by CVM.23 In general,
the Brazilian system is widely considered to be adequate to meet international
standards,24 and Brazil’s experience can help inform the development of mar-
ket infrastructure in other jurisdictions.
Notwithstanding the positive impact of such regulation, and in order to
support an initiative by market institutions to establish an external body that
would gather and consolidate information on operations carried out in all
markets, in 2010 CVM issued Instruction No. 486.25 This rule changed CVM
Instruction No. 467 of 2008 and expressly authorized the creation of mecha-
nisms for sharing information necessary for the success of the initiative.
Brazil’s efforts to tackle collective-investment vehicles (more speci�cally,
collective-investment funds) have been spurred by the international recogni-
tion that hedge funds need to be brought under regulation in those countries
where they currently have the status of unregulated entities.
In Brazil, all investment funds (private equity, hedge funds, etc.) and
their managers are registered with CVM. As a result, Brazil already enjoys a
high degree of monitoring and transparency regarding transactions and port-
folios.26 Nonetheless, CVM is assessing further regulation in relation to certain
issues, such as liquidity, suitability, the quality of assets, and conflict of inter-
ests, in addition to the certi�cation of managers. CVM is also addressing secu-
ritization. CVM has recently reformed the substantive rules and statements re-
garding investment funds in receivables so as to ensure, among other things,
21 Currently, the rules on this matter are contained in CVM Instruction No. 461 of 2007
(as amended), available at (in Portuguese).
22 It is worth mentioning that Provisional Measure No. 539 of July 26, 2011, established as a
condition of validity of any derivative contract to carry out a registration procedure with
institutions authorized to perform such activity by the Brazilian Central Bank or CVM. This
document is available at (in Portuguese).
23 For more information regarding this subject, see CVM Instruction No. 467 of 2008 (as
amended), available at (in Portuguese).
24 On the topic, see, for example, G20 Leaders’ Statement at Pittsburgh Summit, supra note 16.
25 Available at (in
Portuguese).
26 These developments are consistent with the IOSCO Objectives and Principles of Securities
Regulation, which are among the FSB Key Standards for Sound Financial Systems.
342 The World Bank Legal Review
regular dissemination of information on the repurchase of loans and to estab-
lish a standard chart of accounts.
As regards the convergence of Brazilian standards with International
Financial Reporting Standards (IFR), corporations’ �nancial statements for the
year 2010 already follow the new standards.
Among other regulatory issues under discussion at CVM is the issue of
suitability. In 2009, the Committee for Regulation and Supervision of Financial
Markets, Capital, Insurance and Private Pension Plans (COREMEC), whose
members are CVM, the Central Bank, and other relevant Brazilian regulators,
issued Resolution No. 7, recommending that COREMEC’s members adopt
rules that specify, for supervised institutions, the duty to verify the adequacy
of �nancial products or services to meet the needs, interests, and objectives of
clients or participants in bene�ts plans.27
COREMEC also approved in 2010 the results of a study conducted by its
members about laws and regulations regarding the use of the work of rating
agencies. The study indicated that risk ratings are used in industry regulations
primarily for three purposes: for the identi�cation or classi�cation of assets
or institutions; as a public offering of securities resulting from securitization
transactions; and as a requirement of transparency. The Brazilian Central Bank,
it should be noted, does not condone the use of such ratings for purposes of
prudential regulation. COREMEC subsequently established a group, through
its Resolution No. 14, whose main task is to evaluate the possibility of elimi-
nating or mitigating references to credit ratings in the existing rules.28 This
is important because there is a perception that the use of such ratings can be
interpreted as a stamp of approval from the regulator, which might discour-
age careful diligence in the selection of assets by �nancial institutions, asset
managers, and institutional investors, ultimately increasing systemic risk.
This work is in line with the document issued by the FSB and submitted to
the G20 meeting in Seoul in 2010, which outlines principles for reducing reli-
ance on ratings in regulations and seeks to encourage market institutions to
make their own risk analysis29 (the G20 adopted these principles). A report on
the results of the work is to be submitted to COREMEC by the end of 2011.
In addition to having discussions and adopting speci�c regulatory
measures, CVM has been improving its relationship with other regulators
whose performance contributes to the proper functioning of the market.
Such cooperation will contribute to the prevention of problems such as those
27 This resolution is available at (in Portuguese).
28 This resolution is available at (in Portuguese).
29 Available at .
Mitigating the Impact of Financial Crises 343
that arose in the recent international crisis. For instance, CVM and the Brazil-
ian Central Bank signed in 2010 a cooperation agreement that, among other
improvements, enhanced the process of exchanging information between
the two institutions during investigations of possible wrongdoing. CVM also
signed in 2010 a technical cooperation agreement with the Department of
Consumer Protection and Defense of the Brazilian Ministry of Justice for the
exchange of information, improvement of regulatory activities, and monitor-
ing and education related to capital market investors.
Better education of investors was also an objective of the National Strat-
egy for Financial Education (Enef), an initiative of COREMEC that has the
broad goal of strengthening the ef�ciency and robustness of the Brazilian �-
nancial system. Enef was introduced at the end of 2010 by Presidential Decree
No. 7397.30 Through targeted projects and coordinated actions, Enef aims to
improve consumer understanding about �nancial products, promoting secu-
rity in making investment decisions. It is hoped that the strategy will enable
people to develop �nancial skills that help in identifying risks and opportuni-
ties of �nancial and capital markets.
Overview of Enforcement in the Brazilian Capital Market
In the aftermath of the �nancial crisis, the adoption of an appropriate enforce-
ment policy by regulators of �nancial or capital markets is becoming increas-
ingly important. In light of this, it may be of interest to outline the current en-
forcement activities of CVM and CVM’s relationship with federal prosecutors
and the federal police in Brazil.
Today, administrative investigations are conducted by public federal at-
torneys together with specialized investigators of CVM staff. This model was
created in 2008, since when the investigation period has been reduced, with
even the most complex procedures being concluded in about 10 months.31
Another important element that has contributed to the good performance
of the Brazilian Securities Commission in its enforcement activities is the role
played by the Committee for Settlements of Proceedings. This committee de-
livers opinions on proposals for settlement of administrative cases made by
defendants or people under investigation prior to a �nal determination by
CVM commissioners. The committee can even negotiate the terms of an agree-
ment. The agreement that may be proposed to CVM is called termo de compro-
misso and clearly has its roots in the SEC’s experience regarding settlements
and consent decrees. Basically, a settlement may be concluded with CVM if
the defendant or person under investigation undertakes to cease the practice
30 The decree is available at (in Portuguese).
31 For more information regarding this subject, see Julya Sotto Mayor Wellisch & Alexandre
Pinheiro dos Santos, A evolução do processo administrativo sancionador no âmbito da Comissão de
Valores Mobiliários, 48 Revista de Direito Bancário e do Mercado de Capitais 53 (2010).
344 The World Bank Legal Review
of unlawful acts or activities and correct the irregularities, including indemni-
fying losses. The agreement is not subject to court approval.32
Furthermore, CVM, after participating in joint actions to prevent and stop
unfair practices, signed cooperation agreements with the Federal Prosecutors
Of�ce, as well as with the Brazilian Federal Police Department. Many positive
results have already been achieved, including the freezing of wrongdoers’ as-
sets and the beginning of criminal lawsuits related to insider trading. In 2011,
CVM and the Federal Prosecutors Of�ce obtained the �rst criminal conviction
in Brazil for insider trading. Two former executives of Sadia S.A. were con-
victed by a court and sentenced to prison and a �ne.33 This case is particularly
signi�cant given that insider trading became a criminal offense in Brazil only
in 2002. CVM and federal prosecutors have also entered into agreements with
some potential lawbreakers to indemnify losses or to restrict activities in the
capital market.
CVM’s commitment to cooperation in enforcement is underscored by
CVM’s signing, in 2009, of the IOSCO Multilateral Memorandum of Under-
standing for Cooperation and Assistance.34
Conclusion
As this chapter has shown, Brazilian regulators, especially CVM, have
adopted some important measures in the run-up to and the aftermath of
the recent �nancial crisis. Those measures aim, inter alia, at creating more
certainty, predictability, transparency, and ef�ciency in the Brazilian �nan-
cial and capital markets. In that respect, they are likely to help prevent future
similar crises.
Brazil’s abiding concern to foster a healthy and predictable environment
in the capital market has enhanced the credibility of the �nancial system as a
whole, which in turn has promoted international recognition of the strength
of the Brazilian economy.
32 For more information regarding this subject, see Julya Sotto Mayor Wellisch & Alexandre
Pinheiro dos Santos, O termo de compromisso no âmbito do mercado de valores mobiliários, 53
Interesse Público 137 (2009).
33 The ruling was appealed.
34 Essentially, enforcement in the Brazilian capital market is in line with the IOSCO Objectives
and Principles of Securities Regulation, which are among the FSB Key Standards for Sound
Financial Systems.
Developments in Climate Finance
from Rio to Cancun
CHARLOTTE STRECK AND THIAGO CHAGAS
International climate policy seeks to de�ne solutions to mitigate climate
change as well as adapt to the adverse effects of climate change by reducing
greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions. Climate change has an impact on liveli-
hoods, food security, and the economic output of countries. Research shows
that in anomalously warm years, gross domestic product (GDP) goes down,
particularly in developing countries.1 Climate change is also associated with
increasing water scarcity and declining water quality, warming and acidi�-
cation of the world’s oceans, a rise in the sea level (and associated coastal
impacts), extreme weather events, climate-related impacts on public health,
and additional threats to forest ecosystems and endangered species. Develop-
ing countries are likely to suffer disproportionally from these effects of global
climate change.2
In the effort to alleviate the effects of climate change, international �nan-
cial institutions can help developing countries cover the additional adaptation
costs and support other mitigation efforts and equitable solutions while rec-
ognizing differences in historic responsibility, wealth, and capacities.3 Climate
�nance has been a central issue in the development of the UN climate regime.
There is consensus that mitigation pledges and commitments proposed so far
fall short of the level of action required by science; in addition, countries are
still far from any agreement on how to share the economic burden that en-
hanced mitigation actions demand.
Developing countries are reluctant to assume the additional costs for miti-
gating global problems that they consider the legacy of developed countries’
1 For an analysis of the relationship between development and climate change, see World De-
velopment Report 2010: Development and Climate Change ch. 1 (World Bank 2010), available at
.
2 McKinsey Global GHG Abatement Cost Curve, Version 2.0 (Jan. 2009); Project Catalyst,
Project Catalyst Brief: Synthesis Paper (Dec. 2009), available at .
3 Nicola Ranger, Alex Bowen, & Bob Ward, Mitigation Climate Change through Reductions in
Greenhouse Gas Emissions: Background, in Mitigating Climate Change through Reductions in
Greenhouse Gas Emissions: The Science and Economics of Future Paths for Global Annual Emissions
4 (Alex Bowen & Nicola Ranger ed., Grantham Research Institute on Climate Change and
the Environment 2009), available at